99 04 Honda Odyssey
99 04 Honda Odyssey
99 04 Honda Odyssey
NOTE: Refer to the following list to look up A/C Compressor Relief Valve ABS Modulator Unit
DTCs, symptoms, fuses, connectors, wire Replacement ......................................... 21-53 Removal/Installation ............................ 19-76
harnesses, specifications, maintenance
schedules, and general service A/C Condenser ABS-TCS Components
information: Replacement ......................................... 21-54 Component Location Index ........... 19-40, 80
Description ..................................... 19-47, 89
DTC Troubleshooting Indexes A/C Condenser Fan High Speed Circuit Circuit Diagram ............ 19-56, 106, 108, 110
A/C ........................................................... 21-9 Troubleshooting ................................... 21-30
ABS-TCS Components ........................ 19-45 ABS-TCS Control Unit
Automatic Climate Control ................. 21-71 A/C Pressure Switch Circuit How-to Information ............................. 19-81
Automatic Transaxle ............................. 14-7 Troubleshooting .......................... 21-35, 110 Replacement ....................................... 19-160
Doors ................................................... 22-294
Fuel and Emissions ................................ 11-6 A/C Signal Circuit ABS-TCS Modulator Unit
SRS ........................................................ 23-48 Troubleshooting ........................ 11-188, 190 Removal/Installation .......................... 19-158
03/07/29 10:43:59 61S0X050_260_0002
(contd)
ATF Blower Motor Low Speed Circuit, Rear A/C Bumper, Rear
Inspection ................................... 14-136, 367 Troubleshooting ................................ 21-127 Removal/Installation .......................... 20-130
Replacement .............................. 14-137, 368
Blower Motor Middle Speed Circuit,
ATF Cooler Rear A/C
Repair .......................................... 14-155, 388 Troubleshooting ................................ 21-129 C
ATF Cooler Lines and Hoses Blower Power Transistor
Replacement .............................. 14-156, 389 Test ...................................................... 21-120 Cable Reel
Replacement ....................................... 23-376
ATF Feed Pipes, End Cover Blower Unit
Replacement ....................................... 14-422 Removal/Installation ............................ 21-45 Camshaft
Inspection ............................................... 6-43
ATF Pump Blower Unit Components, Rear A/C Installation .............................................. 6-54
Inspection ................................... 14-200, 432 Replacement ....................................... 21-142
Cargo Area Light
ATF Temperature Sensor Blower Unit, Rear A/C Test ...................................................... 22-151
Replacement ....................................... 14-366 Removal/Installation .......................... 21-142
Carpet
Audio Unit Brake Booster Replacement ......................................... 20-65
Removal/Installation .................. 22-159, 342 Test ........................................................ 19-17
Description ......................................... 22-160 Replacement ......................................... 19-18 Catalytic Converter System
How-to Information ............................. 11-89
Audio/Entertainment Brake Calipers
Component Location Index ...... 22-157, 331 Overhaul ......................................... 19-15, 28 Center Lower Console
Circuit Diagram .......................... 22-158, 340 Removal/Installation ............................ 20-68
Description ......................................... 22-332 Brake Discs
Inspection ....................................... 19-14, 27 Center Lower Pocket
Automatic Climate Control Removal/Installation ............................ 20-67
Component Location Index ................. 21-64 Brake Drums
Description ........................................... 21-73 Inspection ............................................. 19-19 Center Pocket Light
Circuit Diagram .............................. 21-76, 78 Replacement ....................................... 22-152
Brake Fluid Level Switch
Automatic Transaxle Test ........................................................ 19-11 Charging System
Description ................................... 14-18, 262 Component Location Index ................... 4-19
Circuit Diagram ...................... 14-66, 68, 314 Brake Light Failure Sensor Circuit Diagram ................................ 4-20, 21
Test .............................................. 14-125, 352 Test ...................................................... 22-108 Troubleshooting ..................................... 4-22
Connecting Rod Bearings Cruise Control Actuator Cable Differential Oil Seals, A/T
Replacement ............................................. 7-9 Adjustment ............................................. 4-52 Replacement .............................. 14-239, 479
(contd)
D4 Indicator Circuit Fenderwell Trim Fuel Pump
Troubleshooting ........................ 14-166, 169 Replacement ....................................... 20-149 Test ...................................................... 11-218
Replacement ....................................... 11-230
Final Driven Gear, A/T
Replacement .............................. 14-238, 478 Fuel Supply System
E Component Location Index .............. 11-203
Frame Adjustment ......................................... 11-215
Repair Chart ........................................ 20-162 Test ...................................................... 11-216
ECT Sensor Circuit
Troubleshooting ................................ 21-106 Front Doors Fuel Tank
Component Location Index ................... 20-2 Replacement .............................. 11-231, 232
Emblems Adjustment ........................................... 20-24
Replacement ....................................... 20-144 Fuel Tank Vapor Control Valve
Front Driveshaft Assembly Test ...................................................... 11-298
End Cover, A/T Inspection ............................................... 16-3 Replacement ....................................... 11-301
Removal ...................................... 14-188, 418 Removal .................................................. 16-3
Installation .......................................... 14-469 Disassembly ........................................... 16-5 Fuses
Resassembly .......................................... 16-9 (See first page of this Index)
Engine Assembly Installation ............................................ 16-16
Removal .................................................... 5-2
Installation .............................................. 5-12 Front Impact Sensors
Replacement .............................. 23-388, 389 G
Engine Block Assembly
Component Location Index ..................... 7-3 Front Seats
Component Location Index .............. 22-175 Gauge Assembly
Engine Block, Bare Circuit Diagram .................................. 22-176 Replacement ....................................... 22-100
Inspection ............................................... 7-15
Repair ...................................................... 7-17 Front Speakers Gauges
Replacement ....................................... 22-161 Component Location Index ................. 22-93
Engine Mount Control System Circuit Diagram .................................... 22-96
Component Location Index ................... 4-54 Front Suspension
Circuit Diagram ...................................... 4-55 Component Location Index ................... 18-3 General Information
Troubleshooting ..................................... 4-56 (See section 1)
Fuel and Emissions
Entertainment Controller and Screen Description ........................................... 11-10 Glove Box
Removal/Installation .......................... 22-343 Removal/Installation ............................ 20-71
Fuel Fill Door Latch
Entry Light Control System Replacement ....................................... 20-156 GPS Antenna
Component Location Index .............. 22-138 Removal/Installation .......................... 22-385
Circuit Diagram .................................. 22-139 Fuel Fill Door Opener
Replacement ....................................... 20-155 Grille
EVAP Control System Replacement ....................................... 20-142
Component Location Fuel Fill Door Opener Cable Disassembly/Reassembly ................. 20-143
Index .................................. 11-258, 259, 260 Replacement ....................................... 20-153
(contd)
Map Light/Spotlight Oil Pan PGM-FI Main Relay Circuit
Test .............................................. 22-149, 150 Removal .................................................. 7-11 Troubleshooting ........................ 11-209, 212
Installation .............................................. 7-28
MIL Circuit Piston Rings
Troubleshooting ........................ 11-166, 169 Oil Pressure Switch Replacement ........................................... 7-21
Test ............................................................ 8-4
Mirrors Replacement ........................................... 8-12 Pistons
Component Location Index ................. 20-32 Replacement ........................................... 7-18
Oil Pump, Engine
Mode Control Motor Overhaul ................................................... 8-8 Power Door Locks
Replacement ......................................... 21-38 Component Location Index .............. 22-254
Test ........................................................ 21-38 Oil, Engine Circuit Diagram .......................... 22-258, 263
Replacement ............................................. 8-5
Mode Control Motor Circuit, Rear A/C Power Quarter Window Motor
Troubleshooting ................................ 21-134 OPDS Unit Test ...................................................... 22-214
Replacement ....................................... 23-387
Mode Control Motor, Rear A/C Power Seat Linkage
Replacement ....................................... 21-139 Output Shaft (Countershaft) Speed Sensor Disassembly/Reassembly ................... 20-98
Test ...................................................... 21-139 Replacement ....................................... 14-364
Power Seat Motors
Multiplex Control System Outside Air Temperature Sensor Test ...................................................... 22-178
Component Location Index .............. 22-241 Replacement ....................................... 21-118
Circuit Diagram .................................. 22-242 Test ...................................................... 21-118 Power Seat Switch
Description ......................................... 22-243 Test/Replacement .............................. 22-177
Troubleshooting ........ 22-244, 247, 248, 249 Outside Manual Mirrors
Input Test ............................................ 22-250 Replacement ......................................... 20-34 Power Sliding Door Switches
Test ...................................................... 22-312
Multiplex Control Unit, Drivers Outside Mirror Holders
Input Test Replacement ......................................... 20-35 Power Sliding Doors
Dash Lights Brightness Control .... 22-154 Component Location Index .............. 22-287
Entry Light Control System ........... 22-140 Outside Power Mirror Actuators Description ......................................... 22-288
Interlock System ..................... 14-184, 414 Test ...................................................... 22-184 Circuit Diagram .................................. 22-296
Lights, Exterior ............................... 22-124 Replacement ....................................... 22-185 Troubleshooting ................................ 22-308
Lights-on Reminder ....................... 22-110
Power Door Locks .......................... 22-267 Outside Power Mirror Switch Power Steering Fluid
Power Windows ............................. 22-204 Test ...................................................... 22-183 Replacement ......................................... 17-14
Wiper/Washer ................................. 22-226
Outside Power Mirrors Power Steering Lines and Hoses
Replacement ......................................... 20-33 Replacement ......................................... 17-15
Component Location Index .............. 22-179
N Circuit Diagram .......................... 22-180, 181 Power Steering Pump
Test ...................................................... 22-182 Test .................................................... 17-9, 10
Replacement ......................................... 17-16
Navigation Overhaul ............................................... 17-17
Component Location Index .............. 22-349
How-to Information ........................... 22-350 P Power Steering Pump Belt
Description ......................................... 22-353 Inspection/Adjustment ........................ 17-12
Circuit Diagram .................................. 22-364
Troubleshooting ...... 22-366, 367, 368, 369, Park Lever Position Stop Power Window Control Unit
370, 373 Inspection/Adjustment .............. 14-190, 420 Input Test ............................................ 22-201
Test ...................................................... 22-376
Repair .................................................. 22-383 Park Pin Switch Power Window Motor, Drivers
Adjustment ......................................... 22-386 Test ...................................................... 14-187 Test ...................................................... 22-212
Test/Replacement .............................. 14-417
Navigation Display Unit Power Window Motors, Passengers
Removal/Installation .......................... 22-385 Parking Brake Test ...................................................... 22-213
Inspection/Adjustment .......................... 19-7
Navigation Unit Inspection ............................................. 19-29 Power Window Relay
Removal/Installation .......................... 22-384 Test ........................................................ 22-88
Parking Brake Cable
Navigation Unit DVD-ROM Replacement ......................................... 19-37 Power Window Switch, Master
Replacement ....................................... 22-383 Replacement ....................................... 22-215
Parking Brake Shoes
Replacement ......................................... 19-31 Power Window Switch, Passengers
Repair .................................................... 19-34 Test ...................................................... 22-214
O Replacement ....................................... 22-215
Parking Brake Switch
Test ........................................................ 19-11 Power Windows
Oil Filter Component Location Index .............. 22-187
Replacement ............................................. 8-5 PCV Valve Circuit Diagram .................. 22-188, 192, 196
Test/Inspection ................................... 11-257 Description ......................................... 22-200
Oil Filter Feed Pipe
Replacement ............................................. 8-7
03/07/29 10:44:02 61S0X050_260_0007
PSP (Power Steering Pressure) Switch Rear Window Defogger Wires Seat Cover, Second
Signal Circuit Repair .................................................. 22-168 Replacement .............................. 20-112, 116
Troubleshooting ........................ 11-196, 197 Test ...................................................... 22-168
Seat Cover, Third
Rear Window Glass Replacement ....................................... 20-124
Replacement ......................................... 20-45
Q Seat Cushion Latch Lever, Third
Rear Window Wiper Control Unit Replacement ....................................... 20-121
Input Test ............................................ 22-224
Quarter Window Glass Seat Cushion Latch, Third
Replacement ......................................... 20-55 Receiver/Dryer Desiccant Replacement ....................................... 20-122
Replacement ......................................... 21-55
Quarter Window Hinge Base Seat Heater Elements
Replacement ......................................... 20-56 Recirculation Control Motor Test ...................................................... 22-330
Replacement ......................................... 21-39
Test ........................................................ 21-39 Seat Heater Switches
Test ...................................................... 22-330
R Recirculation Control Motor Circuit
Troubleshooting .......................... 21-21, 107 Seat Heaters
Component Location Index .............. 22-328
Radiator Refrigerant Circuit Diagram .................................. 22-329
Test ........................................................ 10-10 Replacement ............................. 21-56, 57, 58
Replacement ......................................... 10-16 Test ........................................................ 21-59 Seat Position Sensor, Drivers
Replacement ....................................... 23-392
Radiator and Condenser Fans Common Refrigerant Oil
Circuit Replacement ........................................... 21-6 Seat Riser, Front Passengers
Troubleshooting ....................... 10-22, 23, 24 Disassembly/Reassembly ........... 20-99, 100
Regulator Valve Body
Radiator and Condenser Fans High Speed Disassembly/Inspection/ Seat Riser, Second
Circuit Reassembly .............................. 14-201, 433 Disassembly/Reassembly ......... 20-110, 111
Troubleshooting ................................... 21-31
Remote Control Battery Seat Strikers, Second
Radiator and Condenser Fans Low Speed Replacement ....................................... 22-345 Replacement ....................................... 20-112
Circuit
Troubleshooting ................................... 21-27 Rocker Arm Assembly Seat Torsion Bar
Removal .................................................. 6-38 Replacement ....................................... 20-101
Radiator Cap Disassembly/Reassembly ..................... 6-39
Test ........................................................ 10-10 Seat Weight Sensor Unit
Rocker Arms Replacement ....................................... 23-391
Radiator Fan Assembly Test .......................................................... 6-12
Test ........................................................ 10-11 Inspection ............................................... 6-41 Seat Weight Sensor, Front Passengers
Replacement ....................................... 23-390
Radiator Fan Switch Roof Moldings
Test ........................................................ 10-25 Replacement ....................................... 20-146 Seat Wire Harness, Drivers
Installation ............................................ 20-94
Radio Remote Switch Roof Rails
Test ...................................................... 22-160 Replacement ....................................... 20-145 Seat, Front
Removal/Installation ............................ 20-81
Rear A/C Lines Disassembly/Reassembly ..... 20-86, 87, 88,
Replacement ....................................... 21-145 89, 90, 91, 92, 93
S
Rear Air Outlet Seat, Third
Replacement ....................................... 20-150 Removal/Installation .......................... 20-119
Safety Indicator System
Rear Heater-A/C Component Location Index .............. 22-103 Seat-back Recline Cable, Third
Component Location Index .............. 21-122 Circuit Diagram .................................. 22-104 Replacement ....................................... 20-123
Circuit Diagram .................................. 21-124 Input Test ............................................ 22-106
Seat-back Recline Lever, Third
Rear Heater-A/C Main Switch Seat Belts Replacement ....................................... 20-120
Removal/Installation .......................... 21-140 Component Location Index ................... 23-3
Test ...................................................... 21-140 Seats
Seat Belts, Front Component Location Index ................. 20-80
Rear Heater-A/C Passengers Control Replacement ........................................... 23-4
Panel Inspection ............................................. 23-15 Seats, Second
Removal/Installation .......................... 21-141 Disassembly/Reassembly ......... 20-108, 109
Test ...................................................... 21-141 Seat Belts, Second
Replacement ........................................... 23-8 Secondary Shaft Bearing, Torque
Rear Suspension Converter Housing
Component Location Index ................... 18-4 Seat Belts, Third Replacement .............................. 14-205, 439
Replacement ......................................... 23-11
Rear Window Defogger Secondary Shaft Idler Gear Bearing
Component Location Index .............. 22-166 Seat Cover, Front Replacement .............................. 14-216, 451
Circuit Diagram .................................. 22-167 Replacement ....................................... 20-102 (contd)
03/07/29 10:44:03 61S0X050_260_0008
(contd)
Servo Body Sliding Doors Steering Wheel
Disassembly/Inspection/ Component Location Index ................... 20-4 Inspection ............................................... 17-7
Reassembly .............................. 14-202, 434 Removal/Installation ............................ 20-25 Removal ................................................ 17-22
Adjustment ........................................... 20-28 Disassembly/Reassembly ................... 17-23
Shift Control Solenoid Valves Installation ............................................ 17-24
Replacement ...................... 14-131, 358, 359 Spare Tire Well Access Panel
Test ...................................... 14-131, 358, 359 Replacement ....................................... 20-159 Subframe, Front
Replacement ....................................... 20-160
Shift Lock Solenoid Spark Plugs
Test .............................................. 14-185, 415 Inspection ............................................... 4-18 Subframe, Rear
Replacement .............................. 14-186, 416 Replacement ....................................... 20-161
Specifications
Shift Lock System Circuit (See section 2) Sunlight Sensor
Troubleshooting ........................ 14-179, 409 Replacement ....................................... 21-119
Springs Test ...................................................... 21-119
Side Airbag, Drivers Replacement ......................................... 18-32
Replacement ....................................... 23-372 Suspension
SRS Adjustment ............................................. 18-5
Side Impact Sensors Component Location Index ..... 23-18, 19, 20
Replacement .............................. 23-385, 386 Description ............................... 23-56, 57, 59
Circuit Diagram ........................ 23-63, 64, 66
Side Sill Panels Inspection/Replacement ................... 23-367 T
Replacement ....................................... 20-148
SRS Indicator Circuit
Slide Motor Revolution Sensor, Left Troubleshooting ...... 23-337, 340, 346, 349, Tailgate
Test ...................................................... 22-318 353, 361, 365 Replacement ....................................... 20-136
Adjustment ......................................... 20-138
Slide Motor Revolution Sensor, Right SRS Unit
Test ...................................................... 22-319 Replacement ....................................... 23-382 Tailgate Handle
Replacement ....................................... 20-157
Sliding Door Buzzer Starter
Test ...................................................... 22-309 Test ............................................................ 4-7 Tailgate Latch
Replacement ............................................. 4-8 Replacement ....................................... 20-158
Sliding Door Closer Motor Overhaul ................................................... 4-9
Test ...................................................... 22-310 Tailgate Latch Switch
Starter Solenoid Test ...................................................... 22-148
Sliding Door Control Unit Test ............................................................ 4-6
Input Test ............................................ 22-300 Tailgate Lock Actuator
Removal/Installation .......................... 22-320 Starter Switch Signal Circuit Test ...................................................... 22-285
Troubleshooting ................................ 11-195
Sliding Door Glass Tailgate Lock Cylinder
Component Location Index ................. 20-38 Starting System Replacement ....................................... 20-158
Replacement ......................................... 20-49 Component Location Index ..................... 4-3
Circuit Diagram ........................................ 4-4 Tailgate Lock Knob Switch
Sliding Door Handle Switch Troubleshooting ....................................... 4-5 Test ...................................................... 22-285
Test ...................................................... 22-317
Steering Tailgate Spoiler
Sliding Door Hook Pin Component Location Index ................... 17-3 Replacement ....................................... 20-140
Replacement ......................................... 20-18 Troubleshooting ..................................... 17-6
Inspection ......................................... 17-7, 11 Tailgate Support Struts
Sliding Door Junction Switch Replacement ....................................... 20-139
Test Steering Column
Power Sliding Doors ...................... 22-313 Removal/Installation ............................ 17-25 Tailgate Weatherstrip
Sliding Door Lock System ............. 22-326 Inspection/Adjustment ........................ 17-27 Replacement ....................................... 20-141
Torque Converter VSP (Vehicle Speed Pulse) Sensor 1st Clutch Hub
Description ................................... 14-62, 309 Replacement ....................................... 22-384 Replacement ....................................... 14-452
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Valve VTEC Solenoid Valve 1st Gear One-way Clutch
Test Test .......................................................... 6-10 Inspection ........................................... 14-452
A/T Electronic Control
System ................................... 14-130, 357 1st/1st-hold/2nd Clutch Assembly
Torque Converter ................... 14-127, 354 Disassembly ....................................... 14-453
Replacement W Inspection ........................................... 14-455
A/T Electronic Control Resassembly ...................................... 14-458
System ................................... 14-130, 357
Washer Fluid Level Switch
Trailing Arms Test ...................................................... 22-230
Removal/Installation ............................ 18-29 2
Washer Fluid Reservoir
Transmission Housing Replacement ....................................... 22-232
Removal ...................................... 14-191, 423 2nd Clutch Transmission Fluid Pressure
Installation .................................. 14-228, 466 Washer Motor, Windshield Switch
Test ...................................................... 22-230 Replacement ....................................... 14-135
Transmission Range Switch
Test .............................................. 14-173, 403 Washer Tube, Windshield
Replacement .............................. 14-174, 404 Replacement ....................................... 22-233
3
Trim Water Pump
Component Location Index ................. 20-57 Inspection ............................................. 10-12
Removal/Installation .......... 20-58, 59, 60, 61 Replacement ......................................... 10-12 3rd Accumulator Body Spring
Disassembly/Inspection/
Troubleshooting Wheel Bearings Reassembly ...................................... 14-437
(See first page of this Index) Inspection ............................................... 18-8
3rd Clutch Ball Bearing
Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Wheel Speed Sensors Replacement ....................................... 14-447
Test ...................................................... 22-136 Inspection ..................................... 19-77, 160
Replacement ................................. 19-78, 161 3rd Clutch Transmission Fluid Pressure
Turn Signal/Hazard Warning Lights Switch
Component Location Index .............. 22-134 Wheels and Tires Replacement .............................. 14-135, 365
Circuit Diagram .................................. 22-135 Inspection ............................................... 18-9
3rd/4th Clutch Assembly
Windows Inspection ................................... 14-207, 220
Component Location Index ................. 20-37 Disassembly ....................................... 14-217
U Resassembly ...................................... 14-222
Windshield Glass
Replacement ......................................... 20-39
Under-dash Fuse/Relay Box, Drivers
Removal/Installation ............................ 22-86 Wiper Motor, Rear Window
Replacement ....................................... 22-232
(contd)
03/07/29 10:44:04 61S0X050_260_0010
(contd)
03/07/29 09:02:13 61S0X050_000_0002
INTRODUCTION
General Info
How to Use This Manual
This manual is divided into 23 sections. The first page of each
section is marked with a black tab that lines up with its
Specifications
corresponding thumb index tab on this page and the back cover.
You can quickly find the first page of each section without
looking through a full table of contents. The symbols printed at
the top corner of each page can also be used as a quick
reference system. Maintenance
Each section includes:
1. A table of contents, or an exploded view index showing:
Parts disassembly sequence.
Bolt torques and thread sizes.
Page references to descriptions in text. Engine Electrical
2. Disassembly/assembly procedures and tools.
3. Inspection.
4. Testing/troubleshooting.
5. Repair.
6. Adjustments. Engine
Safety Messages
Your safety, and the safety of others, is very important. To help
you make informed decisions, we have provided safety
Cooling
messages, and other safety information throughout this manual.
Of course, it is not practical or possible to warn you about all the
hazards associated with servicing this vehicle. You must use
your own good judgment.
You will find important safety information in a variety of forms
Fuel and Emissions
including:
Safety Labels on the vehicle.
Safety Messages preceded by a safety alert symbol and
one of three signal words, DANGER, WARNING, or CAUTION.
These signal words mean:
Transaxle
You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if
you dont follow instructions.
You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if
you dont follow instructions.
Steering
You CAN be HURT if you dont follow
instructions.
Instructions how to service this vehicle correctly and safely.
Suspension
All information contained in this manual is based on the latest
product information available at the time of printing. We reserve
the right to make changes at any time without notice. No part of
this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, Brakes
or transmitted, in any form by any means, electronic,
mechanical, photocopying, recording, or otherwise, without the (Including ABS)
prior written permission of the publisher. This includes text,
figures, and tables.
As you read this manual, you will find information that is Body
preceded by a symbol. The purpose of this message is
to help prevent damage to your vehicle, other property, or the
environment.
Heating, Ventilation
First Edition 08/2003 2,464 pages HONDA MOTOR CO.,LTD. and Air Conditioning
All Rights Reserved Service Publication Office
Specifications apply to U.S.A. and Canada
Restraints
03/07/29 09:02:14 61S0X050_000_0003
To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could lead to personal injury or death in the event of a severe frontal
collision, all SRS service work must be performed by an authorized Honda dealer.
Improper service procedures, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, could lead to personal injury
caused by unintentional deployment of the airbags and/or side airbags.
Do not bump the SRS unit. Otherwise, the system may fail in a collision, or airbags may deploy if the ignition switch
is ON (II).
SRS electrical connectors are identified by yellow color coding. Related components are located in the steering
column, front console, dashboard, dashboard lower panel, in the dashboard above the glove box, in the front seats,
and around the floor. Do not use electrical test equipment on these circuits.
03/07/29 09:02:58 61S0X050_010_0001
General Information
03/07/29 09:02:59 61S0X050_010_0002
General Information
a. Engine Type
a. Manufacturer, Make, and Type of Vehicle J35A1: 3.5 SOHC VTEC Sequential Multiport
2HJ: HONDA OF CANADA MFG., Fuel-injected engine
HONDA CANADA INC. b. Serial Number
HONDA Light duty truck
2HK: HONDA OF CANADA MFG.,
HONDA CANADA INC. Transmission Number
HONDA Multipurpose passenger vehicle
b. Line, Body, and Engine Type
RL1: ODYSSEY/J35A1 B7TA - 6700001
c. Body Type and Transmission Type
8: 5-door/4-speed Automatic
d. Vehicle Grade (Series)
U.S. model
1: VAN
4: LX a. Transmission Type
5: LX B7TA: 4-speed Automatic
6: EX b. Serial Number
Canada model
4: LX with bench seat
5: LX with captains seat Paint Code
6: EX
e. Check Digit Code Color U.S. Canada
f. Model Year B-89P Deep Velvet Blue Pearl
X: 1999 G-87P Dark Emerald Pearl
g. Factory Code G-501M Granite Green Metallic
H: Ontario Factory in Canada NH-615M Canyon Stone Silver
h. Serial Number Metallic
500001: U.S. model YR-520M Mesa Beige Metallic
000001: Canada model
COLOR LABEL
1-2
03/07/29 09:03:00 61S0X050_010_0003
a. Engine Type
a. Manufacturer, Make, and Type of Vehicle J35A1: 3.5 SOHC VTEC Sequential Multiport
2HJ: HONDA OF CANADA MFG., Fuel-injected engine
HONDA CANADA INC. b. Serial Number
HONDA Light duty truck
2HK: HONDA OF CANADA MFG.,
HONDA CANADA INC. Transmission Number
HONDA Multipurpose passenger vehicle
b. Line, Body, and Engine Type
RL1: ODYSSEY/J35A1 B7TA - 7000001
c. Body Type and Transmission Type
8: 5-door/4-speed Automatic
d. Vehicle Grade (Series)
U.S. model
1: VAN without captains seat
5: LX a. Transmission Type
6: EX B7TA: 4-speed Automatic
7: EX with Navigation System b. Serial Number
Canada model
3: DX
5: LX Paint Code
6: EX
e. Check Digit Code Color U.S. Canada
f. Model Year B-89P Deep Velvet Blue Pearl
Y: 2000 G-87P Dark Emerald Pearl
g. Factory Code G-501M Granite Green Metallic
H: Ontario Factory in Canada NH-578 Taffeta White
h. Serial Number NH-615M Canyon Stone Silver
500001: U.S. model Metallic
g. 000001: Canada model YR-520M Mesa Beige Metallic
COLOR LABEL
1-3
03/07/29 09:03:01 61S0X050_010_0004
General Information
a. Engine Type
a. Manufacturer, Make, and Type of Vehicle J35A1: 3.5 SOHC VTEC Sequential Multiport
2HJ: HONDA OF CANADA MFG., Fuel-injected engine
HONDA CANADA INC. b. Serial Number
HONDA Light duty truck
2HK: HONDA OF CANADA MFG.,
HONDA CANADA INC. Transmission Number
HONDA Multipurpose passenger vehicle
b. Line, Body, and Engine Type
RL1: ODYSSEY/J35A1 B7TA - 8000001
c. Body Type and Transmission Type
8: 5-door/4-speed Automatic
d. Vehicle Grade (Series)
U.S. model
1: VAN without captains seat
5: LX a. Transmission Type
6: EX B7TA: 4-speed Automatic
7: EX with Navigation System b. Serial Number
Canada model
3: DX
5: LX Paint Code
6: EX
e. Check Digit Code Color U.S. Canada
f. Model Year G-87P Dark Emerald Pearl
1: 2001 G-501M Granite Green Metallic
g. Factory Code NH-578 Taffeta White
H: Ontario Factory in Canada NH-615M Canyon Stone Silver
h. Serial Number Metallic
500001: U.S. model NH-638M Starlight Silver Metallic
000001: Canada model YR-520M Mesa Beige Metallic
COLOR LABEL
1-4
03/07/29 09:03:02 61S0X050_010_0005
a. Engine Type
J35A4: 3.5 SOHC VTEC Sequential Multiport
Fuel-injected engine
a. Manufacturer, Make, and Type of Vehicle b. Serial Number
2HJ: HONDA OF CANADA MFG., 1500001: Produced in Canada
HONDA CANADA INC. 1000001: Produced in Alabama
HONDA Light duty truck
2HK: HONDA OF CANADA MFG.,
HONDA CANADA INC. Transmission Number
HONDA Multipurpose passenger vehicle
5FN: HONDA MGF ., BYBA - 9000001
OF ALABAMA LLC.
HONDA Multipurpose passenger vehicle
b. Line, Body, and Engine Type
RL1: ODYSSEY/J35A4
c. Body Type and Transmission Type
8: 5-door/5-speed Automatic a. Transmission Type
d. Vehicle Grade (Series) BYBA: 5-speed Automatic
U.S. model b. Serial Number
0: EXL with Rear Entertainment System
1: VAN without captains seat
5: LX Paint Code
6: EX Code Color U.S. Canada
7: EXL with Navigation System BG-50M Havasu Blue Metallic
9: EXL G-501M Granite Green Metallic
Canada model G-510P Evergreen Pearl
5: LX NH-578 Taffeta White
6: EX NH-638M Starlight Silver Metallic
9: EXL R-519P Redrock Pearl
e. Check Digit YR-520M Mesa Beige Metallic
f. Model Year
2: 2002
g. Factory Code
H: Ontario Factory in Canada COLOR LABEL
B: Lincoln Factory in Alabama
h. Serial Number
500001: U.S. model (produced in Canada)
000001: Canada model (produced in Canada)
000001: U.S. model (produced in Alabama)
1-5
03/07/29 09:03:03 61S0X050_010_0006
General Information
a. Engine Type
J35A4: 3.5 SOHC VTEC Sequential Multiport
Fuel-injected engine
a. Manufacturer, Make, and Type of Vehicle b. Serial Number
2HJ: HONDA OF CANADA MFG., 2800001: Produced in Canada
HONDA CANADA INC. 2000001: Produced in Alabama
HONDA Light duty truck
2HK: HONDA OF CANADA MFG.,
HONDA CANADA INC. Transmission Number
HONDA Multipurpose passenger vehicle
5FN: HONDA MGF ., BYBA - 5000001
OF ALABAMA LLC.
HONDA Multipurpose passenger vehicle
5FP: HONDA MGF .,
OF ALABAMA LLC.
HONDA Light duty truck a. Transmission Type
b. Line, Body, and Engine Type BYBA: 5-speed Automatic
RL1: ODYSSEY/J35A4 b. Serial Number
c. Body Type and Transmission Type
8: 5-door/5-speed Automatic
d. Vehicle Grade (Series) Paint Code
U.S. model Code Color U.S. Canada
0: EXL with Rear Entertainment System B-92P Nighthawk Black Pearl
1: VAN without captains seat B-518P Midnight Blue Pearl
5: LX BG-50M Havasu Blue Metallic
6: EX G-510P Evergreen Pearl
7: EXL with Navigation System NH-578 Taffeta White
9: EXL NH-638M Starlight Silver Metallic
Canada model NH-662P Sage Brush Pearl
0: EXL with Rear Entertainment System R-519P Redrock Pearl
5: LX YR-542M Sandstone Metallic
6: EX
9: EXL
e. Check Digit COLOR LABEL
f. Model Year
3: 2003
g. Factory Code
H: Ontario Factory in Canada
B: Lincoln Factory in Alabama
h. Serial Number
500001: U.S. model (produced in Canada) Vehicle Identification Number
500001: Canada model (produced in Alabama) and Federal Motor Vehicle
Safety Standard Certification.
000001: U.S. model (produced in Alabama) Vehicle Identification Number
000001: Canada model (produced in Canada) and Canadian Motor Vehicle
Safety Standard Certification.
1-6
03/07/29 09:03:04 61S0X050_010_0007
a. Engine Type
J35A4: 3.5 SOHC VTEC Sequential Multiport
Fuel-injected engine
a. Manufacturer, Make, and Type of Vehicle b. Serial Number
2HK: HONDA OF CANADA MFG., 3800001: Produced in Canada
HONDA CANADA INC. 3000001: Produced in Alabama
HONDA Multipurpose passenger vehicle
5FN: HONDA MGF.,
OF ALABAMA LLC. Transmission Number
HONDA Multipurpose passenger vehicle
HONDA Light duty truck BYBA - 6000001
b. Line, Body, and Engine Type
RL1: ODYSSEY/J35A4
c. Body Type and Transmission Type
8: 5-door/5-speed Automatic
d. Vehicle Grade (Series) a. Transmission Type
U.S. model BYBA: 5-speed Automatic
0: EXL with Rear Entertainment System b. Serial Number
5: LX
6: EX
7: EXL with Navigation System Paint Code
9: EXL Code Color U.S. Canada
Canada model B-92P Nighthawk Black Pearl
0: EXL with Rear Entertainment System B-518P Midnight Blue Pearl
5: LX BG-50M Havasu Blue Metallic
6: EX NH-578 Taffeta White
9: EXL NH-638M Starlight Silver Metallic
e. Check Digit NH-662P Sage Brush Pearl
f. Model Year R-519P Redrock Pearl
4: 2004 YR-542M Sandstone Metallic
g. Factory Code
H: Ontario Factory in Canada
B: Lincoln Factory in Alabama COLOR LABEL
h. Serial Number
500001: U.S. model (produced in Canada)
500001: Canada model (produced in Alabama)
000001: U.S. model (produced in Alabama)
000001: Canada model (produced in Canada)
1-7
03/07/29 09:03:05 61S0X050_010_0008
General Information
Engine Number
Transmission Number
(5-speed for 2002-2004 models)
Transmission Number
(4-speed for 1999-2001 models)
1-8
03/07/29 09:03:06 61S0X050_010_0009
FRONT PASSENGER
AIRBAG WARNING
(CHILD SEAT)
1992-2001 models
FRONT PASSENGER
MODULE DANGER
STEERING
COLUMN
NOTICE
MONITOR NOTICE FRONT SEATBELT
TENSIONER CAUTION
FRONT PASSENGER
AIRBAG WARNING TAG
(CHILD SEAT)
2002-2004 models
(contd)
1-9
03/07/29 09:03:06 61S0X050_010_0010
General Information
SRS
WARNING
LABEL
2002-2004
models
TIRE INFORMATION
SIDE AIRBAG
INFORMATION
AIR
CONDITIONING
INFORMATION
BATTERY CAUTION
RADIATOR
CAP
CAUTION
1-10
03/07/29 09:03:10 61S0X050_010_0011
Example:
X HNX T 03.5 EA3
a. Model Year
X: 1999
b. Manufacturer Subcode
HNX: HONDA
c. Family Type
T: LDT
d. Displacement
e. Sequence Characters
50 States LEVCFVNLEV
Evaporative Family:
THIS VEHICLE CONFORMS TO U.S. EPA NLEV AND
CLEAN-FUEL VEHICLE AND CALIFORNIA
REGULATIONS APPLICABLE TO GASOLINE FUELED X HNX E 0130 AAE
1999 MODEL YEAR NEW LEV LIGHT-DUTY TRUCKS.
a. Model Year
X: 1999
b. Manufacturer Subcode
HNX: HONDA
c. Family Type
E: EVAP
d. Canister Work Capacity
e. Sequence Characters
1-11
03/07/29 09:03:13 61S0X050_010_0012
General Information
Example:
Y HNX T 03.5 EA3
a. Model Year
Y: 2000
b. Manufacturer Subcode
HNX: HONDA
c. Family Type
T: LDT
d. Displacement
e. Sequence Characters
a. Model Year
Y: 2000
b. Manufacturer Subcode
HNX: HONDA
c. Family Type
E: EVAP
d. Canister Work Capacity
e. Sequence Characters
1-12
03/07/29 09:03:18 61S0X050_010_0013
Example:
1 HNX T 03.5 DH2
a. Model Year
1: 2001
b. Manufacturer Subcode
HNX: HONDA
c. Family Type
T: LDT
d. Displacement
e. Sequence Characters
CANADIAN TIER 1
a. Model Year
THIS VEHICLE CONFORMS TO CANADIAN TIER 1 1: 2001
STANDARDS FOR 2001 MODEL YEAR NEW LIGHT- b. Manufacturer Subcode
DUTY TRUCKS. HNX: HONDA
c. Family Type
R: EVAP/ORVR
d. Canister Work Capacity
e. Sequence Characters
1-13
03/07/29 09:03:19 61S0X050_010_0014
General Information
Example:
4 HNX T 03.5 1AT
VEHICLE EMISSION CONTROL INFORMATION
THIS VEHICLE CONFORMS TO U. S. EPA NLEV
AND CFV AND CALIFORNIA REGULATIONS PCV VALVE
APPLICABLE TO GASOLINE FUELED 2003 TO
MODEL YEAR NEW LEV LIGHT-DUTY TRUCKS. EV AP CAN ISTER
FU EL PR ES SUR E
EPA CERTIFICATION TEST FUEL FOR CFV:
REGULATOR
EPA UNLEADED GASOLINE
1-14
03/07/29 09:03:20 61S0X050_010_0015
A
C
B C
3. Raise the hoist to full height, and inspect the lift 4. Position the safety stands under the support points
points for solid contact with the lift blocks. and adjust them so the vehicle will be level.
1-15
03/07/29 09:03:20 61S0X050_010_0016
General Information
Towing
If the vehicle needs to be towed, call a professional Wheel Lift Equipment The tow truck uses two
towing service. Never tow the vehicle behind another pivoting arms that go under the tires (front or rear) and
vehicle with just a rope or chain. It is very dangerous. lift them off the ground. The other two wheels remain
on the ground.
Emergency Towing
There are three popular methods of towing a vehicle. Sling-type Equipment The tow truck uses metal
cables with hooks on the ends. These hooks go around
Flat-bed Equipment The operator loads the vehicle parts of the frame or suspension and the cables lift that
on the back of a truck. This is the best way of end of the vehicle off the ground. The vehicles
transporting the vehicle. suspension and body can be seriously damaged if this
method of towing is attempted.
To accommodate flat-bed equipment, the vehicle is
equipped with a towing hook (A) and tie down hook If the vehicle cannot be transported by flat-bed, it
hooking slots (B). should be towed with the front wheels off the ground. If
due to damage, the vehicle must be towed with the
The towing hook can be used with a winch to pull the front wheels on the ground, do the following:
vehicle onto the truck, and the tie down hook hooking Release the parking brake.
slots can be used to secure the vehicle to the truck. Start the engine.
Shift to D4 position or D position, then N position.
Turn off the engine.
1-16
03/07/29 09:03:21 61S0X050_010_0017
Parts Marking
To deter vehicle theft, certain major components are marked with the vehicle identification number (VIN). Original
parts have self-adhesive labels. Replacement body parts have generic self-adhesive labels. The original engine or
transmission VIN plate is transferred to a replacement engine or transmission and attached with break-off bolts.
NOTE: Be careful not to damage the parts marking labels during body repair. Mask the labels before repairing the part.
1-17
03/07/29 09:03:21 61S0X050_010_0018
General Information
1-18
03/07/29 09:03:21 61S0X050_010_0019
1-19
03/07/29 09:03:21 61S0X050_010_0020
03/07/29 09:04:31 61S0X050_020_0001
Specifications
Design Specifications
Dimensions ................................................................... 2-22
Weight (U.S.A.) ............................................................. 2-22
Weight (CANADA) ........................................................ 2-22
Engine ............................................................................ 2-22
Starter ............................................................................ 2-22
4-speed Automatic Transmission
1999-2001 Models ..................................................... 2-22
5-speed Automatic Transmission
2002-2004 Models ..................................................... 2-22
Steering ......................................................................... 2-23
Suspension ................................................................... 2-23
Wheel Alignment .......................................................... 2-23
Brakes ............................................................................ 2-23
Tires ............................................................................... 2-23
Air Conditioning ........................................................... 2-23
Electrical Ratings .......................................................... 2-24
Body Specifications
Illustration ..................................................................... 2-25
03/07/29 09:04:31 61S0X050_020_0002
Engine Assembly
Item Measurement Qualification Standard or New Service Limit
Compression Pressure Minimum 930 kPa (9.5 kgf/cm2, 135 psi)
Check the engine with the starter
cranking. Maximum 200 kPa (2.0 kgf/cm2, 28 psi)
(See Design Specs for ratio.) variation
2-2
03/07/29 09:04:31 61S0X050_020_0003
Cylinder Head
Item Measurement Qualification Standard or New Service Limit
Head Warpage 0.05 mm (0.002 in.)
Height 120.95121.05 mm (4.7624.766 in.)
Camshaft End play 0.050.20 mm (0.0020.008 in.) 0.20 mm (0.008 in.)
Camshaft-to-holder oil clearance 0.0500.089 mm (0.00200.0035 in.) 0.15 mm (0.006 in.)
Total runout 0.03 mm (0.001 in.) max. 0.04 mm (0.002 in.)
Cam lobe height (1999-2001 models) Intake, primary 35.832 mm (1.4107 in.)
Intake, 31.066 mm (1.2231 in.)
secondary
Exhaust 35.763 mm (1.4080 in.)
Cam lobe height (2002-2004 models) Intake, primary 34.737 mm (1.3676 in.)
Intake, mid 36.445 mm (1.4348 in.)
Intake, 34.919 mm (1.3748 in.)
secondary
Exhaust 36.326 mm (1.4302 in.)
Valve Clearance (cold) Intake 0.200.24 mm (0.0080.009 in.)
Exhaust 0.280.32 mm (0.0110.013 in.)
Stem O.D. Intake 5.4855.495 mm (0.21590.2163 in.) 5.455 mm (0.2148 in.)
Exhaust 5.4505.460 mm (0.21460.2150 in.) 5.420 mm (0.2134 in.)
Stem-to-guide clearance Intake 0.0200.045 mm (0.00080.0018 in.) 0.08 mm (0.003 in.)
Exhaust 0.0550.080 mm (0.00220.0031 in.) 0.12 mm (0.005 in.)
Valve seat Width Intake 1.251.55 mm (0.0490.061 in.) 2.00 mm (0.079 in.)
Exhaust 1.251.55 mm (0.0490.061 in.) 2.00 mm (0.079 in.)
Stem installed height Intake 46.7547.55 mm (1.8411.872 in.) 47.80 mm (1.882 in.)
Exhaust 46.6847.48 mm (1.8381.869 in.) 47.73 mm (1.879 in.)
Valve spring Free length (1999-2001 models) Intake 50.07 mm (1.9713 in.)
Exhaust 53.48 mm (2.106 in.)
Free length (2002-2004 models) Intake 51.54 mm (2.029 in.)
Exhaust 51.06 mm (2.010 in.)
Valve guide I.D. Intake 5.5155.530 mm (0.21710.2177 in.) 5.55 mm (0.219 in.)
Exhaust 5.5155.530 mm (0.21710.2177 in.) 5.55 mm (0.219 in.)
Installed height Intake 21.2022.20 mm (0.8350.874 in.)
Exhaust 20.6321.63 mm (0.8120.852 in.)
Rocker arm Arm-to-shaft clearance Intake 0.0260.067 mm (0.00100.0026 in.) 0.067 mm (0.0026 in.)
Exhaust 0.0260.077 mm (0.00100.0030 in.) 0.077 mm (0.0030 in.)
2-3
03/07/29 09:04:32 61S0X050_020_0004
2-4
03/07/29 09:04:32 61S0X050_020_0005
Engine Lubrication
Item Measurement Qualification Standard or New Service Limit
Engine oil Capacity Engine overhaul 5.0 (5.3 US qt)
Oil change, 4.4 (4.6 US qt)
including filter
Oil change, 4.0 (4.2 US qt)
without filter
Oil pump Inner-to-outer rotor clearance 0.040.16 mm (0.0020.006 in.) 0.20 mm (0.008 in.)
Pump housing-to-outer rotor clearance 0.140.19 mm (0.0060.007 in.) 0.20 mm (0.008 in.)
Pump housing-to-outer rotor axial 0.020.07 mm (0.0010.003 in.) 0.12 mm (0.005 in.)
clearance
Oil pressure with oil temperature at At idle 70 kPa (0.7 kgf/cm2, 10 psi) min.
176F (80C) At 3,000 rpm 490 kPa (5.0 kgf/cm2, 71 psi) min.
Cooling
Item Measurement Qualification Standard or New
Radiator Coolant capacity (includes engine, Engine overhaul
heater, hoses and reservoir) with rear A/C 9.4 (9.9 US qt)
without rear A/C 7.4 (7.8 US qt)
Coolant change
with rear A/C 7.5 (7.9 US qt)
without rear A/C 5.5 (5.8 US qt)
Reservoir Coolant capacity 0.6 (0.6 US qt)
Radiator cap Opening pressure 93123 kPa (0.951.25 kgf/cm2, 1418 psi)
Thermostat Opening temperature Begins to open 163171F (73 77C)
(1999-2001
models)
Begins to open 169176F (76 80C)
(2002-2004
models)
Fully open 194F (90C)
Valve lift at fully open 10.0 mm (0.39 in.) min.
Radiator fan Thermoswitch ON temperature 196203F (91 95C)
switch Thermoswitch OFF temperature Subtract 515F (3 8C) from actual ON temperature
Fan timer ON temperature 205216F (96 102C)
Fan timer OFF temperature Subtract 518F (3 10C) from actual ON temperature
2-5
03/07/29 09:04:32 61S0X050_020_0006
2-6
03/07/29 09:04:33 61S0X050_020_0007
2-7
03/07/29 09:04:33 61S0X050_020_0008
2-8
03/07/29 09:04:33 61S0X050_020_0009
2-9
03/07/29 09:04:33 61S0X050_020_0010
2-10
03/07/29 09:04:34 61S0X050_020_0011
2-11
03/07/29 09:04:34 61S0X050_020_0012
2-12
03/07/29 09:04:34 61S0X050_020_0013
(contd)
2-13
03/07/29 09:04:35 61S0X050_020_0014
2-14
03/07/29 09:04:35 61S0X050_020_0015
(contd)
2-15
03/07/29 09:04:35 61S0X050_020_0016
2-16
03/07/29 09:04:35 61S0X050_020_0017
(contd)
2-17
03/07/29 09:04:36 61S0X050_020_0018
2-18
03/07/29 09:04:36 61S0X050_020_0019
2-19
03/07/29 09:04:36 61S0X050_020_0020
Suspension
Item Measurement Qualification Standard or New Service Limit
Wheel alignment Camber Front 000 1
Rear 030 45
Caster Front 207 1
Total Toe Front 02 mm (01/16 in.)
Rear 02 mm (01/16 in.)
Front wheel turning angle Inside wheel 4146 2
Outside wheel 3328 (Reference)
Aluminum wheel Runout Axial 00.7 mm (00.03 in.) 2.0 mm (0.08 in.)
Radial 00.7 mm (00.03 in.) 1.5 mm (0.06 in.)
Steel wheel Runout Axial 01.0 mm (00.04 in.) 2.0 mm (0.08 in.)
Radial 01.0 mm (00.04 in.) 1.5 mm (0.06 in.)
Wheel bearing End play Front 00.05 mm (00.002 in.)
Rear 00.05 mm (00.002 in.)
2-20
03/07/29 09:04:36 61S0X050_020_0021
Air Conditioning
Item Measurement Qualification Standard or New
Refrigerant Type HFC-134a (R-134a)
Capacity of system Dual 850900 g (2932 oz)
Single 600650 g (2123 oz)
Refrigerant oil Type DENSO: ND-OIL 8 (P/N 38897-PR7-A01AH or 38899-PR7-A01)
Capacity of components Condenser 35 m (1 1/6 fl oz)
Evaporator 40 m (1 1/3 fl oz)
Each line and 10 m (1/3 fl oz)
hose
Compressor 210 m (6 fl oz)
Compressor Starter coil resistance At 68F (20C) 3.4 3.8
(DENSO) Pulley-to-pressure plate 0.50.15 mm (0.020.006 in.)
clearance
2-21
03/07/29 09:04:37 61S0X050_020_0022
Design Specifications
Item Measurement Qualification Specification
DIMENSIONS Overall length 5,110 mm (201.2 in.)
Overall width 1,920 mm (75.6 in.)
Overall height VAN, LX 1,740 mm (68.5 in.)
EX, EXL 1,770 mm (69.7 in.)
Wheelbase 3,000 mm (118.1 in.)
Track Front 1,680 mm (66.1 in.)
Rear 1,680 mm (66.1 in.)
Ground clearance 163 mm (6.4 in.)
Seating capacity Seven (7)
WEIGHT (U.S.A.) Gross Vehicle Weight Rating 1999-2001 models 5,567 lbs
(GVWR) 2002-2004 models 5,665 lbs
WEIGHT (CANADA) Gross Vehicle Weight Rating 1999-2001 models 2,525 kg
(GVWR) 2002-2004 models 2,570 kg
ENGINE Type Water-cooled, 4-stroke SOHC VTEC V6 gasoline
engine
Cylinder arrangement 60 V6-cylinder, transverse
Bore and stroke 89.0 x 93.0 mm (3.50 x 3.66 in.)
Displacement 3,471 cm3 (m ) (222 cu in.)
Compression ratio 1999-2001 models 9.4
2002-2004 models 10.0
Valve train Belt driven, SOHC VTEC 4 valves per cylinder
Lubrication system Forced, wet sump, with trochoid pump
Oil pump displacement At 6,000 rpm 58.4 (61.7 US qt)/minute
Water pump displacement At 6,000 rpm 172 (182 US qt)/minute
Fuel required UNLEADED gasoline with Pump Octane Number of 86
or higher
STARTER Type Gear reduction
Normal output 1.6 kW
Normal voltage 12 V
Hour rating 30 seconds
Direction of rotation Clockwise as viewed from gear end
4-speed AUTOMATIC Type Electronically controlled automatic, 4-speed forward, 1
TRANSMISSION reverse
(1999-2001 models) Primary reduction Direct 1:1
Gear ratio 1st 2.534
2nd 1.502
3rd 0.947
4th 0.608
Reverse 1.846
Final reduction Type Single helical gear
Gear ratio 3.941
5-speed AUTOMATIC Type Electronically controlled automatic, 5-speed forward, 1
TRANSMISSION reverse
(2002-2004 models) Primary reduction Direct 1:1
Gear ratio 1st 2.563
2nd 1.552
3rd 1.021
4th 0.727
5th 0.520
Reverse 1.846
Final reduction Type Single helical gear
Gear ratio 4.200
2-22
03/07/29 09:04:37 61S0X050_020_0023
(contd)
2-23
03/07/29 09:04:37 61S0X050_020_0024
Design Specifications
(contd)
Item Measurement Qualification Specification
ELECTRICAL Battery 12 V20/5 HR 65A
RATINGS Starter 12 V1.6 kW
Alternator 12 V130A
Fuses Under-hood fuse/relay box 120A, 50A, 40A, 30A, 20A, 15A, 7.5A
Under-dash drivers fuse/ 30A, 15A, 10A, 7.5A
relay box
Under-dash passengers 20A, 15A, 10A, 7.5A
fuse/relay box
Multi-fuse/relay box 40A, 30A, 20A
(1999-2002 models)
Under-hood subfuse box 40A, 30A, 20A
(2003-2004 models)
Light bulbs Headlights high/low 12 V60/55 W
Front turn signal/Front side 12 V21 W/5 W (two filaments)
marker lights
Rear turn signal lights 12 V21 W
Brake/Taillights 12 V21/5 W
Inner Taillights 12 V5 W
High mount brake light 12 V18 W
Back-up lights 12 V21 W
License plate light 12 V5 W
Cargo area light 12 V8 W
Vanity mirror lights 12 V1.8 W
Center pocket light 12 V3.4 W
Front individual map lights 12 V4 cp
Rear individual map lights 12 V10 W
Gauge lights 12 V3.0 W, 3.4 W, 1.4 W
Indicator lights 12 VLED, 14 V0.84 W, 1.4 W
Panel and pilot lights 14 V0.7 W
Front heater control panel 8 V1.2 W, 14 V1.12 W, 1.4 W
lights
Rear heater control panel 14 V1.4 W
lights
2-24
03/07/29 09:04:38 61S0X050_020_0025
Body Specifications
*1: VAN, LX
*2: EX, EXL
2-25
03/07/29 09:04:38 61S0X050_020_0026
03/07/29 09:06:11 61S0X050_030_0001
Maintenance
Maintenance Schedule
Listed by Distance/Time
for Nomal Conditions
1999-2000 Models ........................................................ 3-4
Listed by Distance/Time
for Severe Conditions
1999-2000 Models ........................................................ 3-7
Listed by Distance/Time
for Nomal Conditions
2001 Model .................................................................... 3-10
Listed by Distance/Time
for Severe Conditions
2001 Model .................................................................... 3-13
Listed by Distance/Time
for Nomal Conditions
2002-2003 Models ........................................................ 3-16
Listed by Distance/Time
for Severe Conditions
2002-2003 Models ........................................................ 3-19
Listed by Distance/Time
for Nomal Conditions
2004 Model .................................................................... 3-22
Listed by Distance/Time
for Severe Conditions
2004 Model .................................................................... 3-25
03/07/29 09:06:11 61S0X050_030_0002
For the details of lubrication points and type of lubricants to be applied, refer to the illustrated index and various work
procedures (such as Assembly/Reassembly, Replacement, Overhaul, Installation, etc.) contained in each section.
3-2
03/07/29 09:06:12 61S0X050_030_0003
NOTE:
Lubricate all hinges, latches, and locks once a year.
In corrosive areas, more frequent lubrication is necessary.
We recommend Honda White Lithium Grease.
3-3
03/07/29 09:06:12 61S0X050_030_0004
Maintenance Schedule
3-4
03/07/29 09:06:12 61S0X050_030_0005
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, and E as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
A Replace engine oil (see page 8-5).
Capacity: without oil filter 4.0 (4.2 US qt), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 1 year.
Rotate tires, and check tire inflation and condition, every 7,500 miles (12,000 km).
Follow the pattern shown in the Owners Manual.
B Replace engine oil filter (see page 8-5).
Capacity: with oil filter 4.4 (4.6 US qt), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check front and rear brakes (see page 19-2), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check pads and discs for wear (thickness), damage, and cracks.
Check calipers for damage, leaks, and tightness of mount bolts.
Check wheel cylinders for leaks.
Check brake linings for cracking, glazing, wear, or contamination.
Check parking brake adjustment (see page 19-7), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Number of clicks (3 to 5) when parking brake pedal is pressed with 294 N (30 kgf, 66 lbf) of force.
Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and gearbox boot (see page 17-3), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km)
or 1 year.
Check rack grease and steering linkage.
Check boots for damage and leaking grease.
Check fluid lines for damage and leaks.
Inspect suspension components (see page 18-3), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check bolts for tightness.
Inspect driveshaft boots (see page 16-3), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check boots for cracks and boot bands for tightness.
Inspect brake hoses and lines including ABS (see page 19-35), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check the master cylinder and ABS modulator for damage and leakage.
Inspect all fluid levels and condition of fluids, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Automatic transmission fluid (ATF-Z1) (see page 14-136).
Power steering fluid (see page 17-14).
Brake fluid (see page 19-9).
Windshield washer fluid.
Engine coolant (see page 10-13).
Inspect cooling system hoses and connections (see page 10-2), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check for damage, leaks, and deterioration.
Check for proper fan operation.
Inspect exhaust system (see page 9-10) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check catalytic converter heat shield, exhaust pipe, and muffler for damage, leaks, and tightness.
Inspect fuel lines and connections (see page 11-219) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check for loose connections, cracks, and deterioration; retighten loose connections, and replace
damaged parts.
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will
not void the customers emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at
the recommended intervals to ensure long-term reliability.
(contd)
3-5
03/07/29 09:06:13 61S0X050_030_0006
Maintenance Schedule
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, and E as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
C Replace air cleaner element (see page 11-240), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km).
Inspect and adjust drive belts, every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Look for cracks and damage, then check belt deflection by pushing on the belt about 98 N (10 kgf, 22
lbf) midway between the pulleys.
P/S pump belt: 13.016.5 mm (1/25/8 in.) (see page 17-13).
Replace dust and pollen filter (see page 21-44), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Replace the filter as often (at 15,000 miles/24,000 km intervals) if the vehicle is driven mostly in urban
areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air from industry and diesel-powered vehicles.
Replace the filter whenever airflow from the heating and cooling/climate control system is less than
normal.
D Replace engine coolant (see page 10-13), at 45,000 miles (72,000 km) or 3 years, then every 30,000 miles
(48,000 km) or 2 years.
Use Honda All Season Antifreeze/coolant Type 2.
Replace transmission fluid (see page 14-137), at 45,000 miles (72,000 km) or 3 years, then every 30,000
miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Capacity: 2.9 (3.1 US qt), use Honda ATF-Z1.
E Inspect the valve clearance, otherwise adjust only if noisy (see page 6-15), every 105,000 miles (168,000
km) or 7 years.
Intake: 0.200.24 mm (0.0080.009 in.), Exhaust: 0.280.32 mm (0.0110.013 in.).
Replace spark plugs (see page 4-18), every 105,000 miles (168,000 km) or 7 years.
GAP: 1.01.1 mm (0.0390.043 in.), use PZFR5F11 (NGK) or PKJ16CR-L11 (DENSO).
Replace timing belt (see page 6-20), and inspect water pump (see page 10-12), every 105,000 miles
(168,000 km) or 7 years.
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will
not void the customers emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at
the recommended intervals to ensure long-term reliability.
3-6
03/07/29 09:06:13 61S0X050_030_0007
(contd)
3-7
03/07/29 09:06:13 61S0X050_030_0008
Maintenance Schedule
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, E, F, G, and H as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
A Replace engine oil (see page 8-5).
Capacity: without oil filter 4.0 (4.2 US qt), every 3,750 miles (6,000 km) or 6 months.
Replace engine oil filter (see page 8-5).
Capacity: with oil filter 4.4 (4.6 US qt), every 3,750 miles (6,000 km) or 6 months.
B Check front and rear brakes (see page 19-2), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months.
Check pads and discs for wear (thickness), damage, and cracks.
Check calipers for damage, leaks, and tightness of mount bolts.
Check wheel cylinders for leaks.
Check brake linings for cracking, glazing, wear, or contamination.
Rotate tires, and check tire inflation and condition, every 7,500 miles (12,000 km).
Follow the pattern shown in the Owners Manual.
Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and gearbox boot (see page 17-3), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months.
Check rack grease and steering linkage.
Check boots for damage and leaking grease.
Check fluid lines for damage and leaks.
Inspect suspension components (see page 18-3), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months.
Check bolts for tightness.
Check condition of ball joint boots for deterioration and damage.
Inspect driveshaft boots (see page 16-3), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months.
C Check parking brake adjustment (see page 19-7), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Number of clicks (3 to 5) when parking brake pedal is pressed with 294 N (30 kgf, 66 lbf) of force.
Lubricate all hinges, locks, and latches, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
With Honda White Lithum grease.
Inspect brake hoses and lines including ABS (see page 19-35), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check the master cylinder, proportioning contorol valve, and ABS modulator for damage and leakage (see page 19-35).
Inspect all fluid levels and condition of fluids, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Automatic transmission fluid (ATF-Z1) (see page 14-136).
Power steering fluid (see page 17-14).
Brake fluid (see page 19-9).
Windshield washer fluid.
Engine coolant (see page 10-13).
Inspect cooling system hoses and connections (see page 10-2), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check for damage, leaks, and deterioration.
Check for proper fan operation.
Inspect exhaust system (see page 9-10) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check catalytic converter heat shield, exhaust pipe, and muffler for damage, leaks, and tightness.
Inspect fuel lines and connections (see page 11-219) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check for loose connections, cracks, and deterioration; retighten loose connections and replace damaged parts.
Check lights and controls, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check function of interior and exterior lights and position of the headlights (see page 22-130).
Inspect vehicle underbody, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check the paint for damage, scratches, stone chipping, and dents.
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will not void the customers
emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at the recommended intervals to ensure long-term
reliability.
3-8
03/07/29 09:06:14 61S0X050_030_0009
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, E, F, G, and H as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
D Clean air cleaner element with low pressure air (see page 11-240), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
E Replace air cleaner element (see page 11-240), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Inspect and adjust drive belts, every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Look for cracks and damage, then check belt deflection by pushing on the belt about 98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbf) midway between the
pulleys.
P/S pump belt: 13.016.5 mm (1/25/8 in.) (see page 17-13).
Replace dust and pollen filter (see page 21-44), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Replace the filter as often (at 15,000 miles/24,000 km intervals) if the vehicle is driven mostly in urban areas that have high
concentrations of soot in the air from industry and diesel-powered vehicles.
Replace the filter whenever airflow from the heating and cooling/climate control system is less than normal.
Replace transmission fluid (see page 14-137), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Capacity: 2.9 (3.1 US qt), use Honda ATF-Z1.
F Replace engine coolant (see page 10-13), at 45,000 miles (72,000 km) or 3 years, then every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Use Honda All Season Antifreeze/coolant Type 2.
G Replace timing belt (see page 6-20), and inspect water pump (see page 10-12), every 60,000 miles (96,000 km) or 4 years.
H Inspect the valve clearance, otherwise adjust only if noisy (see page 6-15), every 105,000 miles (168,000 km) or 7 years.
Intake: 0.200.24 mm (0.0080.009 in.), Exhaust: 0.280.32 mm (0.0110.013 in.).
Replace spark plugs (see page 4-18), every 105,000 miles (168,000 km) or 7 years.
GAP: 1.01.1 mm (0.0390.043 in.), use PZFR5F11 (NGK) or PKJ16CR-L11 (DENSO).
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will not void the customers
emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at the recommended intervals to ensure long-term
reliability.
3-9
03/07/29 09:06:14 61S0X050_030_0010
Maintenance Schedule
3-10
03/07/29 09:06:14 61S0X050_030_0011
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, E, and F as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
A Replace engine oil (see page 8-5).
Capacity: without oil filter 4.0 (4.2 US qt), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 1 year.
Rotate tires, and check tire inflation and condition, every 7,500 miles (12,000 km).
Follow the pattern shown in the Owners Manual.
B Replace engine oil filter (see page 8-5).
Capacity: with oil filter 4.4 (4.6 US qt), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check front and rear brakes (see page 19-2), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check pads and discs for wear (thickness), damage, and cracks.
Check calipers for damage, leaks, and tightness of mount bolts.
Check wheel cylinders for leaks.
Check brake linings for cracking, glazing, wear, or contamination.
Check parking brake adjustment (see page 19-7), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Number of clicks (3 to 5) when parking brake pedal is pressed with 294 N (30 kgf, 66 lbf) of force.
Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and gearbox boot (see page 17-3), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km)
or 1 year.
Check rack grease and steering linkage.
Check boots for damage and leaking grease.
Check fluid lines for damage and leaks.
Inspect suspension components (see page 18-3), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check bolts for tightness.
Inspect driveshaft boots (see page 16-3), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check boots for cracks and boot bands for tightness.
Inspect brake hoses and lines including ABS (see page 19-35), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check the master cylinder and ABS modulator for damage and leakage.
Inspect all fluid levels and condition of fluids, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Automatic transmission fluid (ATF-Z1) (see page 14-136).
Power steering fluid (see page 17-14).
Brake fluid (see page 19-9).
Windshield washer fluid.
Engine coolant (see page 10-13).
Inspect cooling system hoses and connections (see page 10-2), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check for damage, leaks, and deterioration.
Check for proper fan operation.
Inspect exhaust system (see page 9-10) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check catalytic converter heat shield, exhaust pipe, and muffler for damage, leaks, and tightness.
Inspect fuel lines and connections (see page 11-219) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check for loose connections, cracks, and deterioration; retighten loose connections and replace
damaged parts.
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will
not void the customers emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at
the recommended intervals to ensure long-term reliability.
(contd)
3-11
03/07/29 09:06:15 61S0X050_030_0012
Maintenance Schedule
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, E, and F as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
C Replace air cleaner element (see page 11-240), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km).
Inspect and adjust drive belts, every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Look for cracks and damage, then check belt deflection by pushing on the belt about 98 N (10 kgf, 22
lbf) midway between the pulleys.
P/S pump belt: 13.016.5 mm (1/25/8 in.) (see page 17-13).
Replace dust and pollen filter (see page 21-44), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Replace the filter as often (at 15,000 miles/24,000 km intervals) if the vehicle is driven mostly in urban
areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air from industry and diesel-powered vehicles.
Replace the filter whenever airflow from the heating and cooling/climate control system is less than
normal.
D Replace transmission fluid (see page 14-137), at 45,000 miles (72,000 km) or 3 years, then every 30,000
miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Capacity: 2.9 (3.1 US qt), use Honda ATF-Z1.
E Inspect the valve clearance, otherwise adjust only if noisy (see page 6-15), every 105,000 miles (168,000
km) or 7 years.
Intake: 0.200.24 mm (0.0080.009 in.), Exhaust: 0.280.32 mm (0.0110.013 in.).
Replace spark plugs (see page 4-18), every 105,000 miles (168,000 km) or 7 years.
GAP: 1.01.1 mm (0.0390.043 in.), use PZFR5F11 (NGK) or PKJ16CR-L11 (DENSO).
Replace timing belt (see page 6-20), and inspect water pump (see page 10-12), every 105,000 miles
(168,000 km) or 7 years.
F Replace engine coolant (see page 10-13), at 120,000 miles (192,000 km) or 10 years, then every 60,000
miles (96,000 km) or 5 years.
Use Honda All Season Antifreeze/coolant Type 2.
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will
not void the customers emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at
the recommended intervals to ensure long-term reliability.
3-12
03/07/29 09:06:15 61S0X050_030_0013
(contd)
3-13
03/07/29 09:06:15 61S0X050_030_0014
Maintenance Schedule
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, E, F, G, and H as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
A Replace engine oil (see page 8-5).
Capacity: without oil filter 4.0 (4.2 US qt), every 3,750 miles (6,000 km) or 6 months.
Replace engine oil filter (see page 8-5).
Capacity: with oil filter 4.4 (4.6 US qt), every 3,750 miles (6,000 km) or 6 months.
B Check front and rear brakes (see page 19-12), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months.
Check pads and discs for wear (thickness), damage, and cracks.
Check calipers for damage, leaks, and tightness of mount bolts.
Check wheel cylinders for leaks.
Check brake linings for cracking, glazing, wear, or contamination.
Rotate tires, and check tire inflation and condition, every 7,500 miles (12,000 km).
Follow the pattern shown in the Owners Manual.
Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and gearbox boot (see page 17-3), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months.
Check rack grease and steering linkage.
Check boots for damage and leaking grease.
Check fluid lines for damage and leaks.
Inspect suspension components (see page 18-3), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months.
Check bolts for tightness.
Check condition of ball joint boots for deterioration and damage.
Inspect driveshaft boots (see page 16-3), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months.
C Check parking brake adjustment (see page 19-7), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Number of clicks (3 to 5) when parking brake pedal is pressed with 294 N (30 kgf, 66 lbf) of force.
Lubricate all hinges, locks, and latches, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
With Honda White Lithum grease.
Inspect brake hoses and lines including ABS (see page 19-35), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check the master cylinder, proportioning contorol valve, and ABS modulator for damage and leakage (see page 19-35).
Inspect all fluid levels and condition of fluids, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Automatic transmission fluid (ATF-Z1) (see page 14-136).
Power steering fluid (see page 17-14).
Brake fluid (see page 19-9).
Windshield washer fluid.
Engine coolant (see page 10-13).
Inspect cooling system hoses and connections (see page 10-2), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check for damage, leaks, and deterioration.
Check for proper fan operation.
Inspect exhaust system (see page 9-10) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check catalytic converter heat shield, exhaust pipe, and muffler for damage, leaks, and tightness.
Inspect fuel lines and connections (see page 11-219) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check for loose connections, cracks, and deterioration; retighten loose connections and replace damaged parts.
Check lights and controls, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check function of interior and exterior lights and position of the headlights (see page 22-130).
Inspect vehicle underbody, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check the paint for damage, scratches, stone chipping, and dents.
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will not void the customers
emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at the recommended intervals to ensure long-term
reliability.
3-14
03/07/29 09:06:16 61S0X050_030_0015
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, E, F, G, and H as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
D Clean air cleaner element with low pressure air (see page 11-240), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
E Replace air cleaner element (see page 11-240), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km).
Inspect and adjust drive belts, every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Look for cracks and damage, then check belt deflection by pushing on the belt about 98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbf) midway between the
pulleys.
P/S pump belt: 13.016.5 mm (1/25/8 in.) (see page 17-13).
Replace dust and pollen filter (see page 21-44), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Replace the filter as often (at 15,000 miles/24,000 km intervals) if the vehicle is driven mostly in urban areas that have high
concentrations of soot in the air from industry and diesel-powered vehicles.
Replace the filter whenever airflow from the heating and cooling/climate control system is less than normal.
Replace transmission fluid (see page 14-137), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Capacity: 2.9 (3.1 US qt), use Honda ATF-Z1.
F Replace timing belt (see page 6-20), and inspect water pump (see page 10-12), every 105,000 miles (168,000 km) or 7 years.
G Inspect the valve clearance, otherwise adjust only if noisy (see page 6-15), every 105,000 miles (168,000 km).
Intake: 0.200.24 mm (0.0080.009 in.), Exhaust: 0.280.32 mm (0.0110.013 in.).
Replace spark plugs (see page 4-18), every 105,000 miles (168,000 km).
GAP: 1.01.1 mm (0.0390.043 in.), use PZFR5F11 (NGK) or PKJ16CR-L11 (DENSO).
H Replace engine coolant (see page 10-13), at 45,000 miles (72,000 km) or 3 years, then every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Use Honda All Season Antifreeze/coolant Type 2.
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will not void the customers
emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at the recommended intervals to ensure long-term
reliability.
3-15
03/07/29 09:06:16 61S0X050_030_0016
Maintenance Schedule
3-16
03/07/29 09:06:16 61S0X050_030_0017
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, E, and F as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
A Replace engine oil (see page 8-5).
Capacity: without oil filter 4.0 (4.2 US qt), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 1 year.
Rotate tires, and check tire inflation and condition, every 7,500 miles (12,000 km).
Follow the pattern shown in the Owners Manual.
B Replace engine oil filter (see page 8-5).
Capacity: with oil filter 4.4 (4.6 US qt), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check front and rear brakes (see page 19-3), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check pads and discs for wear (thickness), damage, and cracks.
Check calipers for damage, leaks, and tightness of mount bolts.
Check brake linings for cracking, glazing, wear, or contamination.
Check parking brake adjustment (see page 19-7), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Number of clicks (4 to 6) when parking brake pedal is pressed with 294 N (30 kgf, 66 lbf) of force.
Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and gearbox boot (see page 17-3), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km)
or 1 year.
Check rack grease and steering linkage.
Check boots for damage and leaking grease.
Check fluid lines for damage and leaks.
Inspect suspension components (see page 18-3), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check bolts for tightness.
Check condition of ball joint boots for deterioration and damage.
Inspect driveshaft boots (see page 16-3), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check boots for cracks and boot bands for tightness.
Inspect brake hoses and lines including ABS (see page 19-35), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check the master cylinder and ABS modulator for damage and leakage.
Inspect all fluid levels and condition of fluids, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Automatic transmission fluid (ATF-Z1) (see page 14-367).
Power steering fluid (see page 17-14).
Brake fluid (see page 19-9).
Windshield washer fluid.
Engine coolant (see page 10-13).
Inspect cooling system hoses and connections (see page 10-2), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check for damage, leaks, and deterioration.
Check for proper fan operation.
Inspect exhaust system (see page 9-10) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check catalytic converter heat shield, exhaust pipe, and muffler for damage, leaks, and tightness.
Inspect fuel lines and connections (see page 11-219) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check for loose connections, cracks, and deterioration; retighten loose connections, and replace
damaged parts.
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will
not void the customers emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at
the recommended intervals to ensure long-term reliability.
(contd)
3-17
03/07/29 09:06:17 61S0X050_030_0018
Maintenance Schedule
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, E, and F as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
C Replace air cleaner element (see page 11-240), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km).
Inspect and adjust drive belts, every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Look for cracks and damage, then check belt deflection by pushing on the belt about 98 N (10 kgf, 22
lbf) midway between the pulleys.
P/S pump belt: 13.016.5 mm (1/2 5/8 in.) (see page 17-13).
Replace dust and pollen filter (see page 21-44), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Replace the filter as often (at 15,000 miles/24,000 km intervals) if the vehicle is driven mostly in urban
areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air from industry and diesel-powered vehicles.
Replace the filter whenever airflow from the heating and cooling/climate control system is less than
normal.
D Replace transmission fluid (see page 14-368), at 45,000 miles (72,000 km) or 3 years, then every 30,000
miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Capacity: 3.3 (3.5 US qt), use Honda ATF-Z1.
E Inspect the valve clearance, otherwise adjust only if noisy (see page 6-15), every 105,000 miles (168,000
km).
Intake: 0.200.24 mm (0.0080.009 in.), Exhaust: 0.280.32 mm (0.0110.013 in.).
Replace spark plugs (see page 4-18), every 105,000 miles (168,000 km).
GAP: 1.01.1 mm (0.0390.043 in.), use PZFR5F11 (NGK) or PKJ16CR-L11 (DENSO).
Replace timing belt (see page 6-20), and inspect water pump (see page 10-12), every 105,000 miles
(168,000 km) or 7 years.
F Replace engine coolant (see page 10-13), at 120,000 miles (192,000 km) or 10 years, then every 60,000
miles (96,000 km) or 5 years.
Use Honda All Season Antifreeze/coolant Type 2.
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will
not void the customers emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at
the recommended intervals to ensure long-term reliability.
3-18
03/07/29 09:06:17 61S0X050_030_0019
(contd)
3-19
03/07/29 09:06:17 61S0X050_030_0020
Maintenance Schedule
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, E, F, and G as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
A Replace engine oil (see page 8-5).
Capacity: without oil filter 4.0 (4.2 US qt), every 3,750 miles (6,000 km) or 6 months.
Replace engine oil filter (see page 8-5).
Capacity: with oil filter 4.4 (4.6 US qt), every 3,750 miles (6,000 km) or 6 months.
B Check front and rear brakes (see page 19-3), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months.
Check pads and discs for wear (thickness), damage, and cracks.
Check calipers for damage, leaks, and tightness of mount bolts.
Check brake linings for cracking, glazing, wear, or contamination.
Rotate tires, and check tire inflation and condition, every 7,500 miles (12,000 km).
Follow the pattern shown in the Owners Manual.
Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and gearbox boot (see page 17-3), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months.
Check rack grease and steering linkage.
Check boots for damage and leaking grease.
Check fluid lines for damage and leaks.
Inspect suspension components (see page 18-3), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months.
Check bolts for tightness.
Check condition of ball joint boots for deterioration and damage.
Inspect driveshaft boots (see page 16-3), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months.
C Replace air cleaner element (see page 11-240), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Only in dusty conditions, if not use the Nomal Conditions schedule.
Check parking brake adjustment (see page 19-7), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Number of clicks (4 to 6) when parking brake pedal is pressed with 294 N (30 kgf, 66 lbf) of force.
Lubricate all hinges, locks, and latches, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
With Honda White Lithum grease.
Inspect brake hoses and lines including ABS (see page 19-35), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check the master cylinder, proportioning contorol valve, and ABS modulator for damage, and leakage (see page 19-35).
Inspect all fluid levels and condition of fluids, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Automatic transmission fluid (ATF-Z1) (see page 14-367).
Power steering fluid (see page 17-14).
Brake fluid (see page 19-9).
Windshield washer fluid.
Engine coolant (see page 10-13).
Inspect cooling system hoses and connections (see page 10-2), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check for damage, leaks, and deterioration.
Check for proper fan operation.
Inspect exhaust system (see page 9-10) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check catalytic converter heat shield, exhaust pipe, and muffler for damage, leaks, and tightness.
Inspect fuel lines and connections (see page 11-219) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check for loose connections, cracks, and deterioration; retighten loose connections and replace damaged parts.
Check lights and controls, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check function of interior and exterior lights and position of the headlights (see page 22-130).
Inspect vehicle underbody, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check the paint for damage, scratches, stone chipping, and dents.
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will not void the customers
emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at the recommended intervals to ensure long-term
reliability.
3-20
03/07/29 09:06:18 61S0X050_030_0021
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, E, F, and G as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
D Inspect and adjust drive belts, every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Look for cracks and damage, then check belt deflection by pushing on the belt about 98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbf) midway between the
pulleys.
P/S pump belt: 13.016.5 mm (1/25/8 in.) (see page 17-13).
Replace dust and pollen filter (see page 21-44), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Replace the filter as often (at 15,000 miles/24,000 km intervals) if the vehicle is driven mostly in urban areas that have high
concentrations of soot in the air from industry and diesel-powered vehicles.
Replace the filter whenever airflow from the heating and cooling/climate control system is less than normal.
Replace transmission fluid (see page 14-368), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Capacity: 3.3 (3.5 US qt), use Honda ATF-Z1.
E Replace timing belt (see page 6-20), and inspect water pump (see page 10-12), every 105,000 miles (168,000 km) or 7 years.
F Inspect the valve clearance, otherwise adjust only if noisy (see page 6-15), every 105,000 miles (168,000 km).
Intake: 0.200.24 mm (0.0080.009 in.), Exhaust: 0.280.32 mm (0.0110.013 in.).
Replace spark plugs (see page 4-18), every 105,000 miles (168,000 km).
GAP: 1.01.1 mm (0.0390.043 in.), use PZFR5F11 (NGK) or PKJ16CR-L11 (DENSO).
G Replace engine coolant (see page 10-13), at 45,000 miles (72,000 km) or 3 years, then every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Use Honda All Season Antifreeze/coolant Type 2.
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will not void the customers
emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at the recommended intervals to ensure long-term
reliability.
3-21
03/07/29 09:06:18 61S0X050_030_0022
Maintenance Schedule
3-22
03/07/29 09:06:18 61S0X050_030_0023
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, E, and F as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
A Replace engine oil (see page 8-5).
Capacity: without oil filter 4.0 (4.2 US qt), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 1 year.
Rotate tires, and check tire inflation and condition, every 7,500 miles (12,000 km).
Follow the pattern shown in the Owners Manual.
B Replace engine oil filter (see page 8-5).
Capacity: with oil filter 4.4 (4.6 US qt), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check front and rear brakes (see page 19-3), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check pads and discs for wear (thickness), damage, and cracks.
Check calipers for damage, leaks, and tightness of mount bolts.
Check brake linings for cracking, glazing, wear, or contamination.
Check parking brake adjustment (see page 19-7), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Number of clicks (4 to 6) when parking brake pedal is pressed with 294 N (30 kgf, 66 lbf) of force.
Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and gearbox boot (see page 17-3), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km)
or 1 year.
Check rack grease and steering linkage.
Check boots for damage and leaking grease.
Check fluid lines for damage and leaks.
Inspect suspension components (see page 18-3), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check bolts for tightness.
Inspect driveshaft boots (see page 16-3), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check boots for cracks and boot bands for tightness.
Inspect brake hoses and lines including ABS (see page 19-35), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check the master cylinder and ABS modulator for damage and leakage.
Inspect all fluid levels and condition of fluids, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Automatic transmission fluid (ATF-Z1) (see page 14-367).
Power steering fluid (see page 17-14).
Brake fluid (see page 19-9).
Windshield washer fluid.
Engine coolant (see page 10-13).
Inspect exhaust system (see page 9-10) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check catalytic converter heat shield, exhaust pipe, and muffler for damage, leaks, and tightness.
Inspect fuel lines and connections (see page 11-219) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check for loose connections, cracks, and deterioration; retighten loose connections, and replace
damaged parts.
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will
not void the customers emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at
the recommended intervals to ensure long-term reliability.
(contd)
3-23
03/07/29 09:06:19 61S0X050_030_0024
Maintenance Schedule
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, E, and F as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
C Replace air cleaner element (see page 11-240), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km).
Inspect and adjust drive belts, every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Look for cracks and damage, then check belt deflection by pushing on the belt about 98 N (10 kgf, 22
lbf) midway between the pulleys.
P/S pump belt: 13.016.5 mm (1/25/8 in.) (see page 17-13).
Replace dust and pollen filter (see page 21-44), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Replace the filter as often (at 15,000 miles/24,000 km intervals) if the vehicle is driven mostly in urban
areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air from industry and diesel-powered vehicles.
Replace the filter whenever airflow from the heating and cooling/climate control system is less than
normal.
D Replace transmission fluid (see page 14-368), at 45,000 miles (72,000 km) or 3 years, then every 30,000
miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Capacity: 3.3 (3.5 US qt), use Honda ATF-Z1.
E Inspect the valve clearance, otherwise adjust only if noisy (see page 6-15), every 105,000 miles (168,000
km).
Intake: 0.200.24 mm (0.0080.009 in.), Exhaust: 0.280.32 mm (0.0110.013 in.).
Replace spark plugs (see page 4-18), every 105,000 miles (168,000 km).
GAP: 1.01.1 mm (0.0390.043 in.), use PZFR5F11 (NGK) or PKJ16CR-L11 (DENSO).
Replace timing belt (see page 6-20), and inspect water pump (see page 10-12), every 105,000 miles
(168,000 km) or 7 years.
F Replace engine coolant (see page 10-13), at 120,000 miles (192,000 km) or 10 years, then every 60,000
miles (96,000 km) or 5 years.
Use Honda All Season Antifreeze/coolant Type 2.
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will
not void the customers emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at
the recommended intervals to ensure long-term reliability.
3-24
03/07/29 09:06:19 61S0X050_030_0025
(contd)
3-25
03/07/29 09:06:19 61S0X050_030_0026
Maintenance Schedule
3-26
03/07/29 09:06:19 61S0X050_030_0027
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, E, F, and G as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
A Replace engine oil (see page 8-5).
Capacity: without oil filter 4.0 (4.2 US qt), every 3,750 miles (6,000 km) or 6 months.
Replace engine oil filter (see page 8-5).
Capacity: with oil filter 4.4 (4.6 US qt), every 3,750 miles (6,000 km) or 6 months.
B Check front and rear brakes (see page 19-3), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months.
Check pads and discs for wear (thickness), damage, and cracks.
Check calipers for damage, leaks, and tightness of mount bolts.
Check brake linings for cracking, glazing, wear, or contamination.
Rotate tires, and check tire inflation and condition, every 7,500 miles (12,000 km).
Follow the pattern shown in the Owners Manual.
Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and gearbox boot (see page 17-3), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km)
or 6 months.
Check rack grease and steering linkage.
Check boots for damage and leaking grease.
Check fluid lines for damage and leaks.
Inspect suspension components (see page 18-3), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months.
Check bolts for tightness.
Check condition of ball joint boots for deterioration and damage.
Inspect driveshaft boots (see page 16-3), every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 6 months.
C Replace air cleaner element (see page 11-240), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
Only in dusty conditions, if not use the Nomal Conditions schedule.
Check parking brake adjustment (see page 19-7), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Number of clicks (4 to 6) when parking brake pedal is pressed with 294 N (30 kgf, 66 lbf) of force.
Lubricate all hinges, locks, and latches, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
With Honda White Lithum grease.
Inspect brake hoses and lines including ABS (see page 19-35), every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check the master cylinder, proportioning contorol valve, and ABS modulator for damage and leakage
(see page 19-35).
Inspect all fluid levels and condition of fluids, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Automatic transmission fluid (ATF-Z1) (see page 14-367).
Power steering fluid (see page 17-14).
Brake fluid (see page 19-9).
Windshield washer fluid.
Engine coolant (see page 10-13).
Inspect exhaust system (see page 9-10) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check catalytic converter heat shield, exhaust pipe, and muffler for damage, leaks, and tightness.
Inspect fuel lines and connections (see page 11-219) , every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check for loose connections, cracks, and deterioration; retighten loose connections and replace
damaged parts.
Check lights and controls, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check function of interior and exterior lights and position of the headlights (see page 22-130).
Inspect vehicle underbody, every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 1 year.
Check the paint for damage, scratches, stone chipping, and dents.
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will
not void the customers emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at
the recommended intervals to ensure long-term reliability.
(contd)
3-27
03/07/29 09:06:20 61S0X050_030_0028
Maintenance Schedule
Do the items in parts A, B, C, D, E, F, and G as required for the mileage/time interval listed.
Part Maintenance Items
D Inspect and adjust drive belts, every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Look for cracks and damage, then check belt deflection by pushing on the belt about 98 N (10 kgf, 22
lbf) midway between the pulleys.
P/S pump belt: 13.016.5 mm (1/25/8 in.) (see page 17-13).
Replace dust and pollen filter (see page 21-44), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Replace the filter as often (at 15,000 miles/24,000 km intervals) if the vehicle is driven mostly in urban
areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air from industry and diesel-powered vehicles.
Replace the filter whenever airflow from the heating and cooling/climate control system is less than
normal.
Replace transmission fluid (see page 14-368), every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 2 years.
Capacity: 3.3 (3.5 US qt), use Honda ATF-Z1.
E Replace timing belt (see page 6-20), and inspect water pump (see page 10-12), every 105,000 miles
(168,000 km) or 7 years.
F Inspect valve clearance, otherwise adjust only if noisy (see page 6-15), every 105,000 miles (168,000 km).
Intake: 0.200.24 mm (0.0080.009 in.), Exhaust: 0.280.32 mm (0.0110.013 in.).
Replace spark plugs (see page 4-18), every 105,000 miles (168,000 km).
GAP: 1.01.1 mm (0.0390.043 in.), use PZFR5F11 (NGK) or PKJ16CR-L11 (DENSO).
G Replace engine coolant (see page 10-13), at 120,000 miles (192,000 km) or 10 years, then every 60,000
miles (96,000 km) or 5 years.
Use Honda All Season Antifreeze/coolant Type 2.
NOTE: According state and federal regulations, failure to do the maintenance items marked with an asterisk ( ) will
not void the customers emissions warranties. However, Honda recommends that all maintenance services be done at
the recommended intervals to ensure long-term reliability.
3-28
03/07/29 09:07:12 61S0X050_040_0001
Engine Electrical
Engine Electrical
Special Tools ................................................................. 4-2
Starting System
Component Location Index ......................................... 4-3
Circuit Diagram ............................................................. 4-4
Starter Circuit Troubleshooting .................................. 4-5
Starter Solenoid Test ................................................... 4-6
Starter Performance Test ............................................. 4-7
Starter Replacement .................................................... 4-8
Starter Overhaul ........................................................... 4-9
Ignition System
Component Location Index ......................................... 4-14
Circuit Diagram ............................................................. 4-15
Ignition Timing Inspection ........................................... 4-16
Ignition Coil Removal/Installation ............................... 4-17
Spark Plug Inspection .................................................. 4-18
Charging System
Component Location Index ......................................... 4-19
Circuit Diagram ............................................................. 4-20
Charging Circuit Troubleshooting .............................. 4-22
Alternator-Compressor Belt Inspection ...................... 4-26
Alternator-Compressor Belt Replacement ................. 4-26
Alternator Replacement ............................................... 4-27
Auto-tensioner Inspection ........................................... 4-28
Auto-tensioner Replacement ...................................... 4-29
Tensioner Pulley Replacement ................................... 4-31
Alternator Overhaul ..................................................... 4-32
Cruise Control
Component Location Index ......................................... 4-42
Circuit Diagram ............................................................. 4-43
Symptom Troubleshooting Index ............................... 4-44
Cruise Control Communication
Circuit Troubleshooting ........................................... 4-46
Cruise Control Unit Input Test ..................................... 4-48
Cruise Control Main Switch Test/Replacement ......... 4-50
Cruise Control Set/Resume/Cancel Switch
Test/Replacement ..................................................... 4-51
Brake Pedal Position Switch Test ................................ 4-51
Cruise Control Actuator/Cable Replacement ............. 4-52
Cruise Control Actuator Cable Adjustment ................ 4-52
03/07/29 09:07:13 61S0X050_040_0002
Engine Electrical
Special Tools
Ref. No. Tool Number Description Qty
A973X-041-XXXXX Vacuum Pump/Gauge, 030 in.Hg 1
07746-0010300 Attachment, 42 x 47 mm 1
07749-0010000 Driver 1
4-2
03/07/29 09:07:15 61S0X050_040_0003
Starting System
UNDER-DASH DRIVERS
FUSE/RELAY BOX (BACK SIDE)
BATTERY
4-3
03/07/29 09:07:16 61S0X050_040_0004
Starting System
Circuit Diagram
YEL
STARTER DRIVERS
CUT UNDERDASH
RELAY FUSE/RELAY BOX
No.13 (7.5A)
PCM
PGMFI TRANSMISSION
MAIN RELAY RANGE SWITCH
(Closed : P and N position)
BLK/WHT BLK
B S
M SOLENOID
STARTER
G101
4-4
03/07/29 09:07:16 61S0X050_040_0005
Recommended Procedure: NOIf the starter will not crank the engine at all, go
Use a starter system tester. to step 5. If it cranks the engine erratically or too
Connect and operate the equipment in accordance slowly, go to step 7. If it wont disengage from the
with the manufacturers instructions. torque converter ring gear when you release the
key, check for the following until you find the cause.
Alternate Procedure
Solenoid plunger and switch malfunction
1. Hook up the following equipment: Dirty drive gear or damaged overrunning clutch.
Ammeter, 0 400A around both negative battery
cables 5. Make sure the transmission is in P or N, then
Voltmeter, 0 20 V (accurate within 0.1 volt) disconnect the BLK/WHT wire (A) from the starter
Tachometer, 0 1,200 rpm solenoid (B). Connect a jumper wire from the
battery positive terminal to the solenoid terminal.
B
Did the starter crank the engine normally? NORemove the starter, repair or replace as
necessary.
YESThe starting system is OK.
NOGo to step 4.
(contd)
4-5
03/07/29 09:07:17 61S0X050_040_0006
Starting System
YESGo to step 8.
YESGo to step 9.
4-6
03/07/29 09:07:18 61S0X050_040_0007
BODY
S (GROUND)
M
12 V
BATTERY
6. Clamp the starter firmly in a vise.
S
M B
4. Disconnect the battery from the M terminal. If the
pinion does not retract, the hold-in coil of the A
solenoid is working properly.
STARTER
S
M
12 V
BATTERY
12 V
BATTERY
Specifications:
1.6 kW 80A or less (Electric current),
2,600 rpm or more (Motor-speed)
4-7
03/07/29 09:07:18 61S0X050_040_0008
Starting System
Starter Replacement
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio 5. Install in the reverse order of removal. Make sure
and the navigation system, then write down the the crimped side of the ring terminal (A) is facing
frequencies for the radios preset buttons. out.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery first,
then disconnect the positive cable.
D
10 x 1.25 mm
44 Nm (4.5 kgfm,
33 lbfft)
A
C
4-8
03/07/29 09:07:19 61S0X050_040_0009
Starter Overhaul
Disassembly/Reassembly
END COVER
BRUSH HOLDER
ARMATURE
NUT
9 Nm (0.9 kgfm, 7 lbfft)
(Apply molybdenum
disulfide.)
VENT
TUBE
(Apply molybdenum
disulfide.)
STARTER SOLENOID
SOLENOID LEVER
GEAR HOUSING
OVERRUNNING
CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
GEAR HOUSING
COVER
(contd)
4-9
03/07/29 09:07:20 61S0X050_040_0010
Starting System
4-10
03/07/29 09:07:20 61S0X050_040_0011
7. Check the mica depth (A). If the mica is too high (B), 9. Place the armature (A) on an armature tester (B).
undercut the mica with a hacksaw blade to the Hold a hacksaw blade (C) on the armature core.
proper depth. Cut away all the mica (C) between If the blade is attracted to the core or vibrates while
the commutator segments. The undercut should the core is turned, the armature is shorted. Replace
not be too shallow, too narrow, or V-shaped (D). the armature.
Commutator Mica Depth B C
Standard (New): 0.40.5 mm (0.0160.020 in.)
Service Limit: 0.15 mm (0.006 in.)
B C
C A
B
(contd)
4-11
03/07/29 09:07:21 61S0X050_040_0012
Starting System
11. Measure the brush length. If it is not within the 12. Check that there is no continuity between the ()
service limit, replace the brush holder assembly. brush holder (A) and () brush holder (B). If there
is continuity, replace the brush holder assembly.
Brush Length
Standard (New): 15.816.2 mm (0.620.64 in.) B
B
Service Limit: 11.0 mm (0.43 in.)
A A
13. Insert the brush (A) into the brush holder, and bring
the brush into contact with the commutator, then
attach a spring scale (B) to the spring (C). Measure
the spring tension at the moment the spring lifts off
the brush.
Spring Tension:
15.717.7 N (1.61.8 kgf, 3.533.97 lbf)
4-12
03/07/29 09:07:22 61S0X050_040_0013
14. Pry back each brush spring with a screwdriver, then Overrunning Clutch Inspection
position the brush about halfway out of its holder,
and release the spring to hold it there. 17. Slide the overrunning clutch along the shaft.
Replace it if it does not slide smoothly.
B
19. If the starter drive gear (B) is worn or damaged,
replace the overrunning clutch assembly; the gear
is not available separately.
16. Install the starter end cover (A) to retain the brush 20. Reassemble the starter in reverse order of
holder (B). disassembly.
B
4-13
03/07/29 09:07:23 61S0X050_040_0014
Ignition System
4-14
03/07/29 09:07:23 61S0X050_040_0015
Circuit Diagram
*
No.11 (15A) : 19992000 models
No.7 (15A) : 20012004 models
UNDERHOOD FUSE/RELAY BOX IGNITION SWITCH
BATTERY
No.41 (120A) No.42 (50A) BAT
WHT BLK/YEL
IG1
PCM BLK/YEL
IGNITION
COILS
SPARK
PLUGS
G101
4-15
03/07/29 09:07:24 61S0X050_040_0016
Ignition System
2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with Ignition Timing:
no load shift lever in Park or Neutral, until the 10 2 BTDC (RED mark (B)) during idling in Park
radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. or Neutral
A
3. Check the idle speed, and adjust it if necessary (see
page 11-201).
B
7. If the ignition timing differs from the specification,
check the cam timing, and the top dead center
(TDC) and crankshaft position (CKP) sensors. If
necessary, substitute a known-good powertrain
control module (PCM) and recheck (see page 11-5).
4-16
03/07/29 09:07:25 61S0X050_040_0017
6 x 1.0 mm
A 12 Nm
(1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
2002-2004 models:
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
4-17
03/07/29 09:07:26 61S0X050_040_0018
Ignition System
Worn or deformed
electrodes
Improper gap
Oil-fouling
Carbon deposits
Cracked center
Damaged electrode insulator
gasket 3. Replace the plug at the specified interval, or if the
center electrode is rounded (A). Use only the spark
plugs listed.
Spark Plugs:
Cracked
insulator NGK: PZFR5F-11
DENSO: PKJ16CR-L11
4-18
03/07/29 09:07:27 61S0X050_040_0019
Charging System
BATTERY
ALTERNATOR BELT Test, page 22-87
Inspection, page 4-26
Replacement, page 4-26
ALTERNATOR
Alternator/Regulator Test, step 1 on page 4-23
Replacement, page 4-27
4-19
03/07/29 09:07:27 61S0X050_040_0020
Charging System
Circuit Diagram
1999-2001 models
BAT IGNITION
IG1 SWITCH
ELD UNIT
No.6 DRIVERS
(15A) UNDERDASH
FUSE/RELAY BOX
CHARGING BRAKE
SYSTEM INDICATOR
INDICATOR
LIGHT
BULB
(1.4W)
PCM WHT/BLU
PCM
BLK WHT/GRN BLK/YEL WHT/BLU
ALTERNATOR B C IG L
FIELD WINDING
RECTIFIER
BLK
G201
4-20
03/07/29 09:07:28 61S0X050_040_0021
2002-2004 models
BLK/YEL BLK/YEL
BLK GRN/RED
CHARGING
SYSTEM
INDICATOR
PCM LIGHT
G201 BULB
(1.4W)
PCM
ALTERNATOR B C IG L
VOLTAGE REGULATOR
FR
FIELD WINDING
RECTIFIER
4-21
03/07/29 09:07:28 61S0X050_040_0022
Charging System
YESGo to step 2.
NOGo to step 6.
Does the charging system indicator come on?
2. Start the engine.
YESGo to step 9.
Does the charging system indicator go of f ?
NOTurn the ignition switch OFF. Check for a
YESCharging system indicator circuit is OK. Go blown No. 6 (15A) fuse and a blown charging
to Alternator and Regulator Circuit Test. system light bulb. If the fuse and bulb are OK,
repair the open in the BLK/YEL or WHT/BLU wire to
NOGo to step 3. the indicator bulb.
3. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 9. Measure the voltage at the No. 1 terminal of the
alternator 4P connector with the ignition switch ON
4. Disconnect the alternator 4P connector from the (II).
alternator.
ALTERNATOR 4P CONNECTOR
5. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
NOGo to step 9.
4-22
03/07/29 09:07:29 61S0X050_040_0023
Alternator and Regulator Circuit Test 9. Raise the engine speed to 2,000 rpm, and hold it
there.
1. Be sure the battery connections are good, and that
the battery is sufficiently charged. (see page 22-87). Is the voltage less than 13.5 V ?
2. Connect a VAT-40 (or equivalent tester), and turn YESGo to alternator control system test.
the test selector switch to position 1 (starting).
NOGo to step 10.
LOAD ADJUSTER FULL FIELD TESTER
(CARBON PILE) LEAD (BLU) 10. Apply a load with the VAT-40 until the battery
VOLTMETER voltage drops to between 1213.5 V.
NEGATIVE
LEAD (BLK)
Is the amperage 7 5A ( 87 .5A f or 2002-2004
VOLT VOLTMETER
POSITIVE models) or more?
SELECTOR LEAD (RED)
YESThe charging system is OK.
FIELD
SELECTOR NO
TEST SELECTOR NEGATIVE TESTER 1999-2001 models: Go to step 11.
SWITCH CABLE (BLK) 2002-2004 models: Go to Alternator Control
POSITIVE TESTER System Test.
CABLE (RED)
INDUCTIVE
PICK-UP (GRN) 11. With the engine speed still at 2,000 rpm, full-field
B TERMINAL the alternator. Attach the probe to the VAT-40 full-
INDUCTIVE PICK-UP
field test lead, and insert the probe into the full field
access hole at the back of the alternator. Switch the
3. Shift to Park or Neutral, and start the engine. Hold field selector to the A (Ground) position
the engine at 3,000 rpm, with no load until the momentarily, and check the amperage reading.
radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. Because voltage will rise quickly when the
alternator is full-fielded, do not allow the voltage to
4. Raise the engine speed to 2,000 rpm, and hold it exceed 18 V: it may damage the electrical system.
there.
REGULATOR
(Located inside
Is the voltage over 15.1 V ? the end cover)
NOGo to step 5.
8. Place the inductive pick-up over the B terminal wire YESReplace the voltage regulator.
of the alternator so that the arrow points away from
the alternator. NOGo to Alternator Control System Test.
(contd)
4-23
03/07/29 09:07:30 61S0X050_040_0024
Charging System
ALTC
2. Disconnect the alternator 4P connector from the (WHT/GRN)
alternator.
2001 model:
BATTERY
PCM CONNECTOR B (24P)
ALTC (WHT/GRN)
C (WHT/GRN)
ALTC
(WHT/GRN)
NOGo to step 5.
Is there continuity?
4-24
03/07/29 09:07:31 61S0X050_040_0025
ALTC
(WHT/GRN) C (WHT/GRN) Is there continuity?
2001 model:
ALTC
(WHT/GRN)
C (WHT/GRN)
ALTERNATOR
PCM CONNECTOR B (24P) 4P CONNECTOR
4-25
03/07/29 09:07:32 61S0X050_040_0026
Charging System
A A
4-26
03/07/29 09:07:32 61S0X050_040_0027
Alternator Replacement
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio 5. Remove the mounting bolt (A) and alternator
and the navigation system, then write down the bracket mounting bolt (B), then remove the harness
frequencies for the radios preset buttons. clamp (C) from the alternator bracket.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery first, C 6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
then disconnect the positive cable. 8.7 lbfft)
B
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
A 16 lbfft)
10 x 1.25 mm
44 Nm (4.5 kgfm, 33 lbfft)
4-27
03/07/29 09:07:33 61S0X050_040_0028
Charging System
Auto-tensioner Inspection
1999-2001 models 5. Remove the auto-tensioner (see page 4-29).
1. Check the position of the auto-tensioner indicators 6. Clamp the auto-tensioner (A) by using two bolts
pointer (A) with the engine not running. Start the (6 mm diameter) (B) and vise (C) as shown. Do not
engine, then check the position of the pointer again. clamp the auto-tensioner itself.
If the position changes, replace the auto-tensioner. A
4-28
03/07/29 09:07:34 61S0X050_040_0029
Auto-tensioner Replacement
2002-2004 models 1999-2001 models
1. Check the position of the auto-tensioner indicators 1. Remove the alternator-compressor belt (see page
pointer (A) with the engine not running. Start the 4-26).
engine, then check the position of the pointer again.
If the position changes, replace the auto-tensioner. 2. Remove the auto-tensioner.
A
4. Move the auto-tensioner back and forth within its 3. Install the auto-tensioner in the reverse order of
limit with the wrench in the direction shown. Check removal.
that the tensioner moves smoothly and without any
abnormal noise. If the tensioner does not move
smoothly or there is abnormal noise, replace the
auto-tensioner.
4-29
03/07/29 09:07:35 61S0X050_040_0030
Charging System
45
45
3. Clean the tensioner and pivot bolt (A), and clean the
threads of the pivot bolt hole (B) with a tap.
C A
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
16 lbfft)
4-30
03/07/29 09:08:08 61S0X050_040_0031
4-31
03/07/29 09:08:09 61S0X050_040_0032
Charging System
Alternator Overhaul
Exploded View - 1999-2001 models
SPACER RING
PULLEY
PULLEY LOCKNUT
VOLTAGE REGULATOR
DIODE (RECTIFIER)
ASSEMBLY
REAR HOUSING
BRUSH HOLDER
ASSEMBLY
TERMINAL INSULATOR
4-32
03/07/29 09:08:10 61S0X050_040_0033
Special Tools Required 5. Remove the washer nut (A) and insulator (B) from
Driver 07749-0010000 the B terminal, then remove the end cover (C)
Attachment, 42 x 47 mm 07746-0010300 and dust seal (D).
NOTE: Refer to the Exploded View as needed during A
this procedure. C
4. Remove the three flange nuts (A) and the screw (B)
from the alternator, then remove the plate terminal
(C).
A
B
(contd)
4-33
03/07/29 09:08:11 61S0X050_040_0034
Charging System
8. Remove the four screws (A), then remove the 10. Remove the four insulators (A), rear housing (B)
rectifier (B) and rubber seal (C). and washer (C).
A
B A
C
C
4-34
03/07/29 09:08:12 61S0X050_040_0035
11. If you are not replacing the front bearing and/or 14. With a hammer and commercially available tools
rear bearing, go to step 18. Otherwise, remove the shown, install a new rear bearing in the rotor shaft.
rotor from the stator drive end housing.
12. Inspect the rotor shaft for galling, and inspect the 15. Remove the front bearing retainer plate.
bearing journal surface in the stator housing for
seizure marks.
(contd)
4-35
03/07/29 09:08:13 61S0X050_040_0036
Charging System
B1 B4
17. With a hammer and the special tools, install a new
front bearing in the stator housing.
B1 B3
07749-0010000
B2
A B1
07746-0010300
B1
B2
B3
B4
4-36
03/07/29 09:08:14 61S0X050_040_0037
19. Measure the length of both brushes (A) with a 22. Check that there is continuity between each pair of
vernier caliper (B). leads (A).
If either brush is shorter than the service limit, If there is continuity, go to step 23.
replace the brush assembly. If there is no continuity, replace the alternator.
If the brush length is OK, go to step 20. A
A B
4-37
03/07/29 09:08:15 61S0X050_040_0038
Charging System
BEARING RETAINER
FRONT BEARING
DRIVE-END HOUSING
PULLEY
PULLEY LOCKNUT
SEAL RING
END COVER
BRUSH HOLDER
ASSEMBLY
4-38
03/07/29 09:08:16 61S0X050_040_0039
Special Tools Required 5. Remove the end cover (A) and seal ring (B).
Driver 07749-0010000
Attachment, 42 x 47 mm 07746-0010300 A
A B
(contd)
4-39
03/07/29 09:08:17 61S0X050_040_0040
Charging System
B
C
4-40
03/07/29 09:08:17 61S0X050_040_0041
12. With a hammer and special tools, install a new Rotor Slip Ring Test
front bearing in the drive end housing.
14. Check that there is continuity between the slip rings
(A).
07746-0010300
A
Alternator Brush Inspection
B
13. Measure the length of both brushes (A) with vernier
calipers (B). 15. Check that there is no continuity between each slip
ring and the rotor (B) and the rotor shaft (C).
If either brush is shorter than the service limit,
replace the brush holder assembly. If there is no continuity, replace the rear housing
If the brush length is OK, go to step 14. assembly, and go to step 16.
If there is continuity, replace the rotor assembly.
Alternator Brush Length
Standard (New): 10.5 mm (0.41 in.) 16. Reassemble the alternator in reverse order of
Service Limit: 1.5 mm (0.06 in.) disassembly, and note these items:
A
B
4-41
03/07/29 09:08:20 61S0X050_040_0042
Cruise Control
SET/RESUME/CANCEL
SWITCH
Test, page 4-51
Replacement,
MAIN SWITCH page 4-51
Test:
1999-2001 models, page 4-50
2002-2004 models, page 4-50
Replacement:
1999-2001 models, page 4-50
2002-2004 models, page 4-50
4-42
03/07/29 09:08:21 61S0X050_040_0043
Circuit Diagram
( ) : 20022004models
DRIVERS UNDERDASH
UNDERHOOD FUSE/RELAY BOX IGNITION SWITCH FUSE/RELAY BOX
BATTERY
No.41 (120A) No.42 (50A) BAT No.9 (10A)
WHT BLK/YEL
IG1
No.47 No.6
(20A) IG1 HOT in ON (II) (15A)
and START (III) COMBINATION
LIGHT SWITCH
HORN
RELAY
BLK/YEL RED/BLK
LT GRN/BLU
INDICATOR LIGHT
CRUISE (0.84W) (0.84W)
CONTROL
HORN 1 HORN SWITCH MAIN
SWITCH
CRUISE
CONTROL 2 (4) 1 (7) 5 (2)
SET/
CAN RE CANCEL
SET CEL SUME RESUME LT GRN BLK RED RED/BLK
SWITCH
3 2
5 2 6 7 12 4 13
CRUISE CONTROL UNIT 10
9 11 1 8 14 3
3 4 2
TRANSMISSION
CRUISE CONTROL RANGE
ACTUATOR PCM SWITCH
ON : 2, D3, D4
1
4-43
03/07/29 09:08:21 61S0X050_040_0044
Cruise Control
4-44
03/07/29 09:08:22 61S0X050_040_0045
4-45
03/07/29 09:08:22 61S0X050_040_0046
Cruise Control
Does the cruise control operate? 8. Connect a voltmeter between the No. 8 terminal of
the cruise control unit 14P connector and body
YESGo to step 3. ground. Drive the vehicle at speeds over 25 mph
(40 km/h) with the cruise control set, and watch the
NOCheck the cruise control unit or cruise control voltmeter.
actuator.
CRUISE CONTROL UNIT 14P CONNECTOR
3. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Is there about 1 V ?
YESGo to step 9.
Is there continuity?
NOGo to step 6.
4-46
03/07/29 09:08:23 61S0X050_040_0047
2001 model:
PCM CONNECTOR E (31P)
CRS (BLU/GRN)
2002-2004 models:
CRS (BLU/GRN)
4-47
03/07/29 09:08:23 61S0X050_040_0048
Cruise Control
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
If the terminals look OK, go to step 4.
BLK/YEL WHT/BLK
GRY LT GRN/RED
BRN BLK LT GRN/BLK
Wire side of
female terminals
14P CONNECTOR
Cavity Wire Test condition Test: Desired result Possible cause if result is
not obtained
1 BRN Connect battery power Check the operation of the Faulty actuator
magnetic clutch: Clutch Poor ground (G201)
should click and output link An open in the wire
should be locked. Short to ground
9 BRN/ WHT Connect battery power to Check the operation of the Faulty actuator
11 BRN/ BLK the BRN/WHT terminal and actuator motor: You should An open in the wire
ground to the BRN/BLK be able to hear the motor
terminal
4-48
03/07/29 09:08:24 61S0X050_040_0049
Cavity Wire Test condition Test: Desired result Possible cause if result is not
obtained
4 BLK/YEL Ignition switch ON (II) Check for voltage to ground: Blown No. 6 (15A) fuse in the
There should be battery voltage. under-dash drivers fuse/relay
box
An open in the wire
13 LT GRN Ignition switch ON (II) and main Check for voltage to ground: Blown No. 6 (15A) fuse in the
switch ON There should be battery voltage. under-dash drivers fuse/relay
box
Faulty main switch
An open in the wire
3 BLK Ignition switch ON (II) and main Check for voltage to ground: Poor ground (G501)
switch ON There should be continuity less An open in the wire
than 1 V.
2 GRY Ignition switch ON (II), main Check for voltage to ground: Misadjusted brake pedal
switch ON and brake pedal There should be 0 V with the pedal position switch
depressed, then released pressed and battery voltage with Faulty brake pedal position
the pedal released. switch
An open in the wire
Open in cruise control main
switch
Blown No. 6 (15A) fuse in the
drivers under-dash fuse/relay
box
5 WHT/BLK Brake pedal pressed, then Check for voltage to ground: Blown No. 47 (20A) fuse in the
released There should be battery voltage under-hood fuse/relay box
with the pedal pressed, and 0 V Misadjusted brake pedal
with the pedal released. position switch
Faulty brake pedal position
switch
An open in the wire
6 LT GRN/RED Set button pressed Check for voltage to ground: There Blown No. 47 (20A) fuse in the
should be battery voltage. under-hood fuse/relay box
When testing terminal No. 6, there Faulty horn relay
should be no voltage on terminal Faulty set/resume/cancel
No. 7. switch
7 LT GRN/BLK Resume button pressed Check for voltage to ground: There Faulty cable reel
should be battery voltage. An open in the wire
When testing terminal No. 7, there
should be no voltage on terminal
No. 6.
8 BLU/GRN Reconnect the cruise control Check for voltage to ground: There Loose connection at the PCM
unit 14P connector, start the should be about 1 V. Faulty cruise control unit
engine, main switch ON and Short to ground
drive the vehicle to speeds over An open in the wire
25 mph (40 km/h) with the cruise Faulty PCM
control set
10 BLU/BLK Ignition switch ON (II) Attach to ground: Blown bulb
Cruise indicator light in the gauge Blown No. 9 (10A) fuse in the
assembly should come on. under-dash drivers fuse/relay
box
Faulty dimming circuit in the
gauge assembly
An open in the wire
12 BLU/WHT Ignition switch ON (II) and main Check for voltage between the An open in the wire
switch ON; raise the front of the BLU/WHT () and BLK () Short to ground
vehicle, and rotate one wheel terminals: Faulty PCM
slowly while holding the other There should be 05 V or more,
wheel or 05 V or more
repeatedly.
14 LT BLU Shift lever in 2, D3 or D4 Check for voltage to ground: Faulty transmission range
There should be less than 1 V. switch
Poor ground (G101)
An open in the wire
6. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system. If all the input tests prove OK, the cruise control unit
may be faulty. Substitute a known-good cruise control unit and retest. If the system works properly, replace the cruise control unit.
4-49
03/07/29 09:08:24 61S0X050_040_0050
Cruise Control
Terminal side of C
male terminals
A B
B
2. Disconnect the 8P connector (B) from the switch.
2. Disconnect the 5P connector (B) from the switch. 3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each
switch position according to the table. If there is no
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each continuity, replace the illumination bulbs (C) or the
switch position according to the table. switch.
If the continuity is not specified, replace the Terminal
illumination bulbs or the switch. 4 7 5 1 2
Position
If OK, install the switch
OFF
Terminal
ON
1 2 3 4 5
Position
OFF
ON
4-50
03/07/29 09:08:25 61S0X050_040_0051
A
A
CANCEL (ON)
4-51
03/07/29 09:08:26 61S0X050_040_0052
Cruise Control
1. Loosen the locknut (A), then disconnect the 1. Check that the actuator cable (A) moves smoothly
actuator cable (B) from the throttle linkage. with no binding or sticking.
B A
D
C
B A
2. Start the engine, and turn the main switch ON. Hold
the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load in Park or
2. Disconnect the 4P connector (A) from the cruise Neutral until the radiator fan comes on, then let it
control actuator. idle.
B
6 x 1.0 mm 3. Measure the amount of movement of the output
A 12 Nm linkage (B) until the engine speed starts to increase.
(1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft) At first, the output linkage should be located at the
fully closed position (C). The free play (D) should be
3.750.5 mm (0.150.02 in.).
4-52
03/07/29 09:08:27 61S0X050_040_0053
B
C
4-53
03/07/29 09:08:27 61S0X050_040_0054
FRONT MOUNT
4-54
03/07/29 09:08:28 61S0X050_040_0055
Circuit Diagram
WHT
BAT IGNITION
IG1 SWITCH
BLK/YEL
No.6 DRIVERS
(15A) UNDERDASH
FUSE/RELAY BOX
BLK/YEL
ENGINE MOUNT
CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE
GRN/WHT
PCM
BLK
G101
4-55
03/07/29 09:08:28 61S0X050_040_0056
Troubleshooting
Special Tools Required 6. Measure voltage between the No. 2 terminal and
Vacuum pump/gauge, 030 in.Hg body ground.
A973X-041-XXXXX
ENGINE MOUNT CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
NOTE:
Check the vacuum hoses and lines for damage and
proper connections before troubleshooting. IG 1
Before performing engine mount control system (BLK/YEL)
troubleshooting, check for damage to the suspension,
Wire side of
subframe, body, or exhaust. female terminals
3. With the transmission in gear, have an assistant 7. Measure voltage between the engine mount
disconnect and reconnect the 2P connector at the control solenoid valve 2P connector No. 1 terminal
engine mount control solenoid valve. and No. 2 terminal.
Is there a noticeable change in idle smoothness ENGINE MOUNT CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
when the engine mount control solenoid valve 2P
connector is disconnected?
MCS
YESReconnect the engine mount control IG 1 (GRN/WHT)
solenoid valve 2P connector to the solenoid valve. (BLK/YEL)
The engine mount control system is OK.
NOGo to step 4.
YESGo to step 8.
4-56
03/07/29 09:08:29 61S0X050_040_0057
8. Raise the engine speed above 1,000 rpm. 12. Release the vacuum, then apply vacuum again.
9. Measure voltage between the engine mount Is there a noticeable change in idle smoothness
control solenoid valve 2P connector No. 1 terminal with and without vacuum applied ?
and No. 2 terminal.
YESGo to step 13.
ENGINE MOUNT CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
NOReplace the front engine mount.
MCS
IG 1 (GRN/WHT) 13. Disconnect the upper vacuum hose (A) from the
(BLK/YEL) engine mount control solenoid valve (B) and
connect a vacuum pump/gauge to a hose
connected to the engine mount control valve.
B
Wire side of
female terminals
11. Disconnect the upper vacuum hose (A) from the YESReplace the engine mount control solenoid
engine mount control solenoid valve (B), and valve.
connect a vacuum pump/gauge to the hose. Apply
vacuum for 20 seconds. NOA hose is restricted or the intake manifold part
is plugged.
B
A973-041-XXXXX
4-57
03/07/29 09:08:29 61S0X050_040_0058
03/07/29 09:09:07 61S0X050_050_0001
Engine Mechanical
Engine Assembly
Engine Removal ........................................................... 5-2
Engine Installation ........................................................ 5-12
03/07/29 09:09:08 61S0X050_050_0002
Engine Assembly
Engine Removal
NOTE: 4. Remove the intake manifold cover (A) and ignition
Use fender covers to avoid damaging painted coil cover (B) (2002-2004 models).
surfaces.
To avoid damage, unplug the wiring connectors
carefully while holding the connector portion.
Mark all wiring and hoses to avoid misconnection. A
Also, be sure that they do not contact other wiring or
hoses, or interfere with other parts.
2. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio
and the navigation system, then write down the
frequencies for the radios preset buttons.
5-2
03/07/29 09:09:09 61S0X050_050_0003
2002-2004 models:
C
A
B
(contd)
5-3
03/07/29 09:09:10 61S0X050_050_0004
Engine Assembly
C 1999-2001 models:
A
B
11. Remove the throttle cable (A) and cruise control
actuator cable (B) by loosening the locknuts (C), 2002-2004 models:
then slip the cable ends out of the accelerator
linkage. Take care not to bend the cables when
C
removing them. Always replace any kinked cable
with a new one.
C B
A
14. Remove the EVAP canister hose (C) (2002-2004
C models).
5-4
03/07/29 09:09:11 61S0X050_050_0005
15. Remove the brake booster vacuum hose (A). 17. Disconnect the powertrain control module (PCM)
connectors from the PCM.
1999-2001 models:
A
18. Remove the engine wire harness clamps (A).
B
2002-2004 models:
C A
(contd)
5-5
03/07/29 09:09:12 61S0X050_050_0006
Engine Assembly
B
B
21. Remove the alternator-compressor belt (see page 25. Remove the radiator cap.
4-26).
26. Raise the vehicle on the hoist to full height.
22. Loosen the adjusting nut (A), and remove the
locknut (B) and mounting bolt (C), then remove the 27. Remove the front tires/wheels.
power steering (P/S) pump belt (D) and pump
without disconnecting the P/S hoses. 28. Remove the splash shield.
A
C D
5-6
03/07/29 09:09:13 61S0X050_050_0007
29. Drain the engine coolant (see page 10-13). 36. Remove the bolts (A) securing the shift cable holder
(B), then remove the shift cable cover (C).
30. Drain the automatic transmission fluid (ATF). To prevent damage to the control lever joint, be
Reinstall the drain plug using a new washer for sure to remove the bolts securing the shift cable
1999-2001 models (see page 14-137) or 2002-2004 holder before removing the bolts securing the shift
models (see page 14-368). cable cover.
31. Drain the engine oil. Reinstall the drain bolt using a
new washer (see page 8-5).
F
32. Disconnect the primary heated oxygen sensor
(primary HO2S) connector (A), then remove
exhaust pipe A (B).
A
C
E
D
37. Remove the lock bolt (D) securing the control lever
(E), then remove the shift cable (F) with the control
lever. Take care not to bend the shift cable while
removing it.
38. Unplug the P/S hose clamps (A), and remove the
B P/S hose clamp mounting bolt (B).
A B
33. Disconnect the stabilizer links (see page 18-19).
(contd)
5-7
03/07/29 09:09:14 61S0X050_050_0008
Engine Assembly
40. Remove the stiffeners. 42. Remove the steering gearbox mount from the front
subframe.
5-8
03/07/29 09:09:15 61S0X050_050_0009
43. Remove the bolts securing the rear mount. 46. Remove the heater hoses.
47. Remove the ATF cooler hoses, then plug the ATF
44. Lower the hoist, then remove the upper radiator cooler hoses and lines.
hose (A) and lower radiator hose (B).
C
A
(contd)
5-9
03/07/29 09:09:16 61S0X050_050_0010
Engine Assembly
5-10
03/07/29 09:09:17 61S0X050_050_0011
51. Raise the hoist to full height. 54. Hang the steering gearbox with a rope to the frame.
52. Draw alignment marks on the front subframe.
5-11
03/07/29 09:09:18 61S0X050_050_0012
Engine Assembly
Engine Installation
1. Install the accessory brackets. Tighten their bolts and nuts to the specified torques.
10 x 1.25 mm
38 Nm REAR MOUNT
(3.9 kgfm, 28 lbfft) BRACKET
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm
(2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
P/S PUMP
BRACKET
FRONT MOUNT
BRACKET
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
16 lbfft)
ENGINE MOUNT
BRACKET
10 x 1.25 mm
38 Nm (3.9 kgfm,
28 lbfft)
10 x 1.25 mm
44 Nm (4.5 kgfm,
33 lbfft)
10 x 1.25 mm
44 Nm (4.5 kgfm,
33 lbfft) A/C COMPRESSOR
BRACKET
5-12
03/07/29 09:09:19 61S0X050_050_0013
2. Position the engine/transmission assembly under 4. Install the front subframe. Align the reference
the vehicle. Attach the chain hoist to the engine, marks on the front subframe, then tighten the bolts.
then lift the engine into position in the vehicle.
12 x 1.25 mm
117 Nm
(11.9 kgfm,
86 lbfft)
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
12 x 1.25 mm 14 x 1.5 mm
74 Nm 103 Nm (10.5 kgfm,
(7.5 kgfm, 76 lbfft)
54 lbfft) Replace.
(contd)
5-13
03/07/29 09:09:20 61S0X050_050_0014
Engine Assembly
10 x 1.25 mm
38 Nm (3.9 kgfm,
28 lbfft)
12 x 1.25 mm
54 Nm (5.5 kgfm,
40 lbfft)
10 x 1.25 mm
42 Nm (4.3 kgfm,
31 lbfft)
5-14
03/07/29 09:09:21 61S0X050_050_0015
11. Raise the vehicle on the hoist to full height. 14. Install the stiffeners.
10 x 1.25 mm
12. Remove the rope from the steering gearbox, and 59 Nm
install it on the subframe. (6.0 kgfm,
43 lbfft)
10 x 1.25 mm
39 Nm
(4.0 kgfm, 29 lbfft)
10 x 1.25 mm
58 Nm (5.9 kgfm, 43 lbfft)
15. Tighten the P/S hose clamp mounting bolt (A), and
13. Tighten the power steering (P/S) hose clamp install the P/S hose in the clamps (B).
mounting bolts (A), and install the harness clamp
A
(B). 6 x 1.0 mm
B
12 Nm
A (1.2 kgfm,
6 x 1.0 mm 8.7 lbfft)
B 12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
(contd)
5-15
03/07/29 09:09:22 61S0X050_050_0016
Engine Assembly
19. Install exhaust pipe A (A); use new gaskets (B) and
new self locking nuts (C).
D
C
10 x 1.25 mm
D B 54 Nm (5.5 kgfm,
B E
40 lbfft)
Replace.
A
8 x 1.25 mm
C 22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
B 16 lbfft)
6 x 1.0 mm
14 Nm (1.4 kgfm, 10 lbfft)
22. Install the lock bolt (B) with a new lock washer (C),
then bend the lock tab of the lock washer.
23. Install the shift cable cover (D), then install the shift
cable holder (E) on the shift cable cover.
C
C A 10 x 1.25 mm
10 x 1.25 mm 33 Nm (3.4 kgfm,
54 Nm (5.5 kgfm, 25 lbfft)
40 lbfft) Replace.
Replace. 10 x 1.25 mm
38 Nm (3.9 kgfm,
28 lbfft)
5-16
03/07/29 09:09:23 61S0X050_050_0017
24. Install the splash shield. 29. Install the heater hoses.
26. Lower the vehicle on the hoist. 30. Install the automatic transmission fluid (ATF) cooler
hoses for 1999-2001 models (see page 14-156) or
27. Install the upper radiator hose (A) and lower 2002-2004 models (see page 14-389).
radiator hose (B).
C
A
(contd)
5-17
03/07/29 09:09:25 61S0X050_050_0018
Engine Assembly
8 x 1.25 mm
9 Nm (0.9 kgfm,
B 7 lbfft)
A C
32. Install the alternator-compressor belt.
37. Install the harness clamps (C).
33. Loosely install the P/S pump and P/S pump belt.
38. Connect the PCM connectors.
34. Adjust the P/S pump belt (see step 3 on page 17-12).
5-18
03/07/29 09:09:25 61S0X050_050_0019
39. Install the brake booster vacuum hose (A). 41. Install the fuel feed hose (A) and fuel return hose
(B), using new washers (C).
1999-2001 models:
1999-2001 models:
B
A
A B
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
16 lbfft)
2002-2004 models:
2002-2004 models:
A
D
22 Nm
C (2.2 kgfm,
16 lbfft)
(contd)
5-19
03/07/29 09:09:27 61S0X050_050_0020
Engine Assembly
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
16 lbfft)
48. Install the intake air duct (A), then install the
vacuum hose(s) (B) and breather pipe (C).
1999-2001 models:
A
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
16 lbfft)
46. Install the ground cable (A), relay box bracket (B)
and attach the harness clamp (C).
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, D
B C B
8.7 lbfft)
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 2002-2004 models:
8.7 lbfft)
A
C C
A D
5-20
03/07/29 09:09:27 61S0X050_050_0021
50. Install the ignition coil cover (A) and intake 60. Inspect the ignition timing (see page 4-16).
manifold cover (B) (2002-2004 models).
61. Check the wheel alignment (see page 18-5).
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft) 62. Set the clock.
B
52. Refill the engine with engine oil (see page 8-5).
55. Move the shift lever to each gear, and verify that
the A/T gear position indicator follows the
transmission range switch.
57. Enter the anti-theft code for the radio and the
navigation system, then enter the customers radio
station presets.
58. Perform the PCM idle learn procedure (see page 11-
202), and power window control unit reset
procedure (2003-2004 models) (see page 22-200).
5-21
03/07/29 09:09:27 61S0X050_050_0022
03/07/29 09:10:23 61S0X050_060_0001
Engine Mechanical
Cylinder Head
Special Tools ................................................................. 6-2
Component Location Index ......................................... 6-3
DTC Troubleshooting ................................................... 6-6
VTEC Solenoid Valve Test ........................................... 6-10
Engine Compression Inspection ................................. 6-11
VTEC Rocker Arm Test ................................................. 6-12
Valve Clearance Adjustment ....................................... 6-15
Crankshaft Pulley Removal and
Installation ................................................................. 6-18
Timing Belt Inspection ................................................. 6-19
Timing Belt Removal .................................................... 6-20
Timing Belt Installation ................................................ 6-23
Timing Belt Adjuster Replacement ............................. 6-33
Timing Belt Drive Pulley Replacement ....................... 6-33
Cylinder Head Cover Removal .................................... 6-34
Cylinder Head Cover Installation ................................ 6-34
Cylinder Head Removal ............................................... 6-35
Cylinder Head Inspection for
Warpage .................................................................... 6-38
Rocker Arm Assembly Removal ................................. 6-38
Rocker Arm and Shaft
Disassembly/Reassembly .......................................... 6-39
Rocker Arm and Shaft Inspection ................................ 6-41
Camshaft Inspection .................................................... 6-43
Valve, Spring, and Valve Seal
Removal ..................................................................... 6-46
Valve Inspection ........................................................... 6-47
Valve Stem-to-Guide Clearance
Inspection .................................................................. 6-48
Valve Guide Replacement ........................................... 6-49
Valve Seat Reconditioning .......................................... 6-51
Valve, Spring, and Valve Seal
Installation ................................................................. 6-53
Camshaft, Rocker Arm, Camshaft
Seal, and Pulley Installation ..................................... 6-54
Cylinder Head Installation ........................................... 6-55
CMP (TDC) Sensor Replacement ................................ 6-60
CKP Sensor Replacement ............................................ 6-61
03/07/29 09:10:25 61S0X050_060_0002
Cylinder Head
Special Tools
Ref. No. Tool Number Description Qty
07AAJ-PNAA100 Air Regulator 1
07HAH-PJ7A100 Valve Guide Reamer, 5.5 mm 1
07JAA-001020A Socket, 19 mm 1
07JAB-001020A Holder Handle 1
07MAB-PY3010A Holder Attachment, 50 mm Offset 1
07NAJ-P07010A Pressure Gauge Adapter 1
07PAD-0010000 Stem Seal Driver 1
07VAJ-P8A010A VTEC Air Adapter 1
070AJ-0030100 VTEC Air Stopper 1
-1 07406-0070300 A/T Low Pressure Gauge W/Panel 1
-2 07MAJ-PY4011A A/T Pressure Hose, 2,210 mm 1
-3 07MAJ-PY40120 A/T Pressure Hose Adapter 1
07742-0010100 Valve Guide Driver, 5.5 mm 1
07757-PJ1010A Valve Spring Compressor Attachment 1
-1, -2, -3
6-2
03/07/29 09:10:27 61S0X050_060_0003
TIMING BELT
Inspection, page 6-19
Removal, page 6-20
Installation, page 6-23
LOWER COVER
BACK COVER
PULLEY BOLT
Replacement, page 6-18
(contd)
6-3
03/07/29 09:10:28 61S0X050_060_0004
Cylinder Head
RUBBER SEAL
O-RING
CYLINDER HEAD
COVER
Removal,page 6-34
Installation,
page 6-34
CYLINDER
HEAD
DOWEL PINS
6-4
03/07/29 09:10:32 61S0X050_060_0005
O-RING
CAMSHAFT
Inspection, page 6-43
VALVE KEEPERS
SPRING RETAINER
INTAKE VALVE SPRING
SOLID DOWEL
PINS (FRONT BANK) EXHAUST VALVE
HOLLOW DOWEL SPRING
INTAKE VALVE SEAL PINS (REAR BANK)
EXHAUST VALVE
SEAL
VALVE SPRING SEAT
VALVE SPRING
SEAT
EXHAUST VALVE
GUIDE
INTAKE VALVE Inspection, page 6-48
GUIDE Replacement, page 6-49
HOLLOW DOWEL
PINS (FRONT BANK)
SOLID DOWEL
PINS (REAR BANK)
INJECTOR BASE
OIL SEAL
GASKET
6-5
03/07/29 09:10:33 61S0X050_060_0006
Cylinder Head
DTC Troubleshooting
DTC P1259: A problem in the VTEC Oil 7. Check for continuity on the VTEC oil pressure
Pressure Switch circuit or VTEC Solenoid switch between the pressure switch 2P connector
Valve circuit terminals No. 1 and No. 2.
VTEC OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Special Tools Required 2P CONNECTOR
Pressure gauge adapter 07NAJ-P07010A
A/T low pressure gauge w/panel 07406-0070300
A/T pressure hose, 2,210 mm 07MAJ-PY4011A
A/T pressure adapter 07MAJ-PY40120
6-6
03/07/29 09:10:33 61S0X050_060_0007
10. Measure voltage across the VTEC oil pressure 14. Remove the VTEC oil pressure switch (A). Install
switch harness 2P connector. the special tools as shown, then reinstall the VTEC
oil pressure switch.
VTEC OIL PRESSURE SWITCH HARNESS
2P CONNECTOR
A 07NAJ-P07010A
07MAJ-PY40120
NORepair open in the wire between the VTEC oil 16. Connect a tachometer.
pressure switch and G101.
17. Warm up the engine to normal operating
11. Turn the ignition switch OFF. temperature (cooling fan comes on).
12. Disconnect the VTEC solenoid valve 1P connector. 18. Check oil pressure at engine speeds of 1,000, 2,000
and 3,000 rpm. Keep measuring time as short as
13. Check for continuity on the VTEC solenoid valve possible because the engine is running with no
between the solenoid valve 1P connector terminal load (less than 1 minute).
and body ground.
Is pressure below 49 kPa ( 0.5 kgf / cm2 , 7 psi)?
VTEC SOLENOID VALVE
1P CONNECTOR
YESGo to step 19.
YESGo to step 14. Is pressure above 390 kPa ( 4.0 kgf / cm2, 57 psi)?
(contd)
6-7
03/07/29 09:10:35 61S0X050_060_0008
Cylinder Head
1999-2000 models: 26. Check for continuity between the VTEC solenoid
valve harness 1P connector terminal and PCM
PCM CONNECTOR C (31P)
connector terminal B12 (1999-2000, 2002-2004
models) or B2 (2001 model).
VTPSW
(BLU/BLK)
1999-2000 models:
VTEC SOLENOID VALVE HARNESS
1P CONNECTOR
PCM CONNECTOR
B (25 P)
VTS (GRN/YEL)
2001 model:
Wire side of female terminals
PCM CONNECTOR A (31P) 2001 model:
VTEC SOLENOID VALVE HARNESS
1P CONNECTOR
PCM CONNECTOR
B (24P)
VTM (BLU/BLK) VTS (GRN/YEL)
2002-2004 models:
2002-2004 models:
PCM CONNECTOR C (31P)
VTEC SOLENOID VALVE HARNESS
1P CONNECTOR
VTPSW
(BLU/BLK) PCM CONNECTOR
B (25 P)
VTS (GRN/YEL)
6-8
03/07/29 09:10:35 61S0X050_060_0009
Is there continuity?
6-9
03/07/29 09:10:36 61S0X050_060_0010
Cylinder Head
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
16 lbfft)
6-10
03/07/29 09:10:36 61S0X050_060_0011
3. Remove the ACGS (15A) fuse from the under-hood Compression Pressure
fuse/relay box. Above 930 kPa (9.5 kgf/cm2, 135 psi)
4. Start the engine and let it run until it stalls. 10. Perform the same measurement on the remaining
cylinders.
5. Remove the six ignition coils (see page 4-17).
Maximum Variation:
6. Remove the six spark plugs. Within 200 kPa (2.0 kgf/cm2, 28 psi)
7. Attach the compression gauge to a spark plug hole. 11. If the compression is not within specifications,
check the following items, then re-measure the
compression.
6-11
03/07/29 09:10:37 61S0X050_060_0012
Cylinder Head
07VAJ-P8A010A
6-12
03/07/29 09:10:38 61S0X050_060_0013
9. Move the intake secondary rocker arm (A) for the 2002-2004 models
No. 1 cylinder. The primary rocker arm (B) and
secondary rocker arm should move together. 1. Remove the cylinder head cover (see page 6-34).
If the intake primary rocker arm does not move, 2. Set the No. 1 piston at TDC (see step 2 on page 6-
remove the primary and secondary intake rocker 15).
arms as an assembly, and check that the piston in
the primary rocker arm moves smoothly. 3. Push on the intake mid rocker arm (A) for the No. 1
cylinder. The mid rocker arm should move
independently of the primary rocker arm (B) and
secondary rocker arm (C).
B C
(contd)
6-13
03/07/29 09:10:39 61S0X050_060_0014
Cylinder Head
070AJ-0030100 07VAJ-P8A010A
REAR:
B C
070AJ-0030100
07AAJ-PNAA100
10. Remove the tools.
07VAJ-P8A010A
6-14
03/07/29 09:10:40 61S0X050_060_0015
EXHAUST
REAR:
FRONT:
EXHAUST
(contd)
6-15
03/07/29 09:10:41 61S0X050_060_0016
Cylinder Head
B B
A A
8. Check and, if necessary, adjust the valve clearance 12. Check and, if necessary, adjust the valve clearance
on No. 4 cylinder. on No. 5 cylinder.
9. Rotate the crankshaft clockwise. Align the pointer 13. Rotate the crankshaft clockwise. Align the pointer
(A) on the front upper cover with the No. 2 piston (A) on the front upper cover with the No. 3 piston
TDC mark (B) on the front camshaft pulley. TDC mark (B) on the front camshaft pulley.
B B
A A
10. Check and, if necessary, adjust the valve clearance 14. Check and, if necessary, adjust the valve clearance
on No. 2 cylinder. on No. 3 cylinder.
6-16
03/07/29 09:10:41 61S0X050_060_0017
6-17
03/07/29 09:10:42 61S0X050_060_0018
Cylinder Head
C
A
A B
07JAB-001020A 07MAB-PY3010A
C
07JAA-001020A
(or commercially available)
6-18
03/07/29 09:10:43 61S0X050_060_0019
2. Remove the intake manifold cover (A) and ignition 4. Inspect the timing belt for cracks and oil or coolant
coil cover (B) (2002-2004 models). soaking. Replace the belt if it is oil or coolant
soaked or cracked. Remove any oil or solvent that
gets on the belt.
A
B
6-19
03/07/29 09:10:44 61S0X050_060_0020
Cylinder Head
B
D
6-20
03/07/29 09:10:46 61S0X050_060_0021
7. Support the engine with a jack and wood block 11. Remove the front upper cover (A), rear upper cover
under the oil pan. (B) and lower cover (C).
B
8. Remove the side engine mount bracket.
(contd)
6-21
03/07/29 09:10:46 61S0X050_060_0022
Cylinder Head
B
A
6-22
03/07/29 09:10:47 61S0X050_060_0023
B
A
REAR:
B
A
(contd)
6-23
03/07/29 09:10:48 61S0X050_060_0024
Cylinder Head
6-24
03/07/29 09:10:49 61S0X050_060_0025
13. Install the auto-tensioner. 14. Screw the battery clamp bolt in as shown to hold
the timing belt adjuster in its current position.
NOTE: Make sure the holder (pin for 00-04 models) Tighten it by hand, do not use a wrench.
stays in place.
1999 model:
15. Apply liquid thread lock to the idle pulley bolt, then
loosley install the idler pulley.
B
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
A
(contd)
6-25
03/07/29 09:10:49 61S0X050_060_0026
Cylinder Head
1999 model:
10 x 1.25 mm
44 Nm (4.5 kgfm, 33 lbfft)
2000-2004 models:
19. Remove the battery clamp bolt from the back cover.
6-26
03/07/29 09:10:50 61S0X050_060_0027
20. Install the engine mount bracket. 22. Install the lower cover (A), front upper cover (B)
and rear upper cover (C).
C
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
B
A
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
10 x 1.25 mm
44 Nm (4.5 kgfm, 33 lbfft)
23. Install the crankshaft pulley (see page 6-18).
21. Install the timing belt guide plate as shown.
24. Rotate the crankshaft pulley about five or six turns
clockwise so the timing belt positions on the
pulleys.
(contd)
6-27
03/07/29 09:10:52 61S0X050_060_0028
Cylinder Head
12 x 1.25 mm
54 Nm (5.5 kgfm, 40 lbfft)
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
6-28
03/07/29 09:10:52 61S0X050_060_0029
REAR:
B
A
(contd)
6-29
03/07/29 09:10:53 61S0X050_060_0030
Cylinder Head
10 x 1.25 mm
44 Nm (4.5 kgfm, 33 lbfft)
10 x 1.25 mm
44 Nm (4.5 kgfm, 33 lbfft)
6-30
03/07/29 09:11:38 61S0X050_060_0031
10. Install the timing belt guide plate as shown. 14. Turn the crankshaft pulley so its white mark (A)
lines up with the pointer (B).
B
11. Install the lower cover (A), front upper cover (B)
and rear upper cover (C). 15. Check the camshaft pulley marks.
C
If the camshaft pulley marks are at TDC, go to
step 16.
If the camshaft pulley marks are not at TDC,
remove the timing belt and repeat steps 2
through 14.
A
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
(contd)
6-31
03/07/29 09:11:39 61S0X050_060_0032
Cylinder Head
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
17. Install and adjust the P/S pump belt (see page 17-
12).
12 x 1.25 mm
54 Nm (5.5 kgfm, 40 lbfft)
6-32
03/07/29 09:11:39 61S0X050_060_0033
2. Remove the auto-tensioner. 1. Remove the timing belt (see page 6-20).
3. Remove the bolt (A), then remove the timing belt 2. Remove the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor (see
adjuster (B) and collar (C). page 6-61).
A
25 Nm (2.6 kgfm, 19 lbfft)
6-33
03/07/29 09:11:40 61S0X050_060_0034
Cylinder Head
6-34
03/07/29 09:11:41 61S0X050_060_0035
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio,
then write down the frequencies for the radios
preset buttons.
A
E
A
B
C D
10. Remove the evaporative emission (EVAP) canister
6. Remove the P/S hose clamp (E). hose (C) (2002-2004 models).
(contd)
6-35
03/07/29 09:11:42 61S0X050_060_0036
Cylinder Head
12. Remove the six ignition coils (see page 4-17). 1999-2001 models:
13. Remove the timing belt (see page 6-20).
15. Remove the vacuum hoses (A) from the intake air
bypass control thermal valve (B).
A A
B
6-36
03/07/29 09:11:44 61S0X050_060_0037
17. Remove the upper radiator hose (A) and lower 21. Remove the camshaft pulleys (A) and back cover
radiator hose (B). (B).
B
A
A B
22. Remove the cylinder head covers.
18. Remove the heater hoses. 23. Remove the cylinder head bolts. To prevent
warpage, unscrew the bolts, in sequence, 1/3 turn
at a time. Repeat the sequence until all bolts are
loosened.
6-37
03/07/29 09:11:45 61S0X050_060_0038
Cylinder Head
1. Remove the cylinder head (see page 6-35). 2. Loosen the adjusting screws (A).
A
2. Inspect the camshaft (see page 6-43).
6-38
03/07/29 09:11:45 61S0X050_060_0039
1999-2001 models:
A B A B
SPRING
EXHAUST ROCKER EXHAUST ROCKER
ARM B ARM A
(contd)
6-39
03/07/29 09:11:45 61S0X050_060_0040
Cylinder Head
A B A B
SPRING
EXHAUST ROCKER EXHAUST ROCKER
ARM B ARM A
6-40
03/07/29 09:11:46 61S0X050_060_0041
(contd)
6-41
03/07/29 09:11:46 61S0X050_060_0042
Cylinder Head
NOTE:
Apply new engine oil to the pistons when
reassembling.
When reassembling the primary rocker arm (B),
carefully apply air pressure to the oil passage of
the rocker arm.
1999-2001 models:
A
2002-2004 models:
6-42
03/07/29 09:11:47 61S0X050_060_0043
Camshaft Inspection
1. Remove the timing belt (see page 6-20). 4. Seat the camshaft by pushing it toward the rear of
the cylinder head.
2. Remove the rocker arms (see page 6-38).
5. Zero the dial indicator against the end of the
3. Put the rocker shafts on the cylinder head, then camshaft. Push the camshaft back and forth and
tighten the bolts to the specified torque. read the end play. If the end play is beyond the
service limit, replace the thrust cover and recheck.
Specified torque If it is still beyond the service limit, replace the
8 x 1.25 mm camshaft.
24 Nm (2.4 kgfm, 17 lbfft)
Apply new engine oil to the bolt threads and Camshaft End Play
flange Standard (New): 0.050.20 mm
(0.0020.008 in.)
Service Limit: 0.20 mm (0.008 in.)
(contd)
6-43
03/07/29 09:11:48 61S0X050_060_0044
Cylinder Head
6-44
03/07/29 09:11:49 61S0X050_060_0045
11. Check total runout with the camshaft supported on 12. Measure cam lobe height.
V-blocks.
Cam Lobe Height Standard (New):
If the total runout of the camshaft is within the
service limit, replace the cylinder head. INTAKE EXHAUST
If the total runout is beyond the service limit,
replace the camshaft and recheck the oil 1999- PRI 35.832 mm 35.763 mm
clearance. If the oil clearance is still out of 2001 (1.4107 in.) (1.4080 in.)
tolerance, replace the cylinder head. models:
SEC 31.066 mm
Camshaft Total Runout (1.2231 in.)
Standard (New): 0.03 mm (0.001 in.) max.
Service Limit: 0.04 mm (0.002 in.) 2002- PRI 34.737 mm 36.326 mm
2004 (1.3676 in.) (1.4302 in.)
models:
MID 36.445 mm
(1.4348 in.)
SEC 34.919 mm
(1.3748 in.)
Rotate camshaft
while measuring
PRI : Primary MID : Mid SEC : Secondary
T/B : Timing Belt
1999-2001 models:
PRI SEC
REAR BANK
EX IN EX
T/B
SEC PRI
FRONT BANK
EX IN EX
T/B
2002-2004 models:
PRI MID SEC
REAR BANK
EX IN EX
T/B
SEC MID PRI
FRONT BANK
EX IN EX
T/B
6-45
03/07/29 09:11:50 61S0X050_060_0046
Cylinder Head
6-46
03/07/29 09:11:50 61S0X050_060_0047
Valve Inspection
1999-2001 models 2002-2004 models
1. Remove the valves (see page 6-46). 1. Remove the valves (see page 6-46).
2. Measure the valve in these areas. 2. Measure the valve in these areas.
B
D
6-47
03/07/29 09:11:51 61S0X050_060_0048
Cylinder Head
6-48
03/07/29 09:11:51 61S0X050_060_0049
A 5.3 mm
(0.21 in.)
87 mm 57 mm
(3.43 in.) (2.24 in.)
10.8 mm
(0.42 in.)
(contd)
6-49
03/07/29 09:11:52 61S0X050_060_0050
Cylinder Head
Turn reamer in
clockwise direction only.
07742-0010100
07HAH-PJ7A100
6-50
03/07/29 09:11:53 61S0X050_060_0051
2. Renew the valve seats in the cylinder head using a Valve Seat Width
valve seat cutter. Standard (New): 1.251.55 mm (0.0490.061 in.)
Service Limit: 2.00 mm (0.079 in.)
1999-2001 models:
7. The actual valve seating surface (B), as shown by
30
the blue compound, should be centered on the seat.
45
60 If it is too high (closer to the valve stem), you
must make a second cut with the 60 cutter (1999-
2001 models and 2002-2004 models exhaust
side) or the 67.5 cutter (2002-2004 models intake
side) to move it down, then one more cut with the
45 cutter to restore seat width.
If it is too low (close to the valve edge), you must
make a second cut with the 30 cutter to move it
up, then make one more cut with the 45 cutter to
restore seat width.
2002-2004 models:
NOTE: The final cut should always be made with
30
the 45 cutter.
45
(contd)
6-51
03/07/29 09:11:53 61S0X050_060_0052
Cylinder Head
6-52
03/07/29 09:11:54 61S0X050_060_0053
4. Install the new valve seals (A) using the valve guide
seal installer (B).
E C
B
07PAD-0010000
NOTE: Use 5.5 mm side.
6-53
03/07/29 09:11:55 61S0X050_060_0054
Cylinder Head
1 Tap the new camshaft oil seal in squarely. 7. Tighten each bolt two turns at a time in the
2 Tap the oil seal in the cylinder head about sequence shown to ensure that the rockers do not
0.51.5 mm (0.020.06 in.) from the surface bind on the valves.
of the cylinder head.
Specified torque:
8 x 1.25 mm 8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
24 Nm (2.4 kgfm, 17 lbfft)
Apply new engine oil to the bolt threads and
flange
D
8 x 1.25 mm B
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
6-54
03/07/29 09:11:56 61S0X050_060_0055
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft) 1. Clean the cylinder head and block surfaces.
A
B
B
12 x 1.25 mm
90 Nm (9.2 kgfm, 67 lbfft)
Apply new engine oil to the bolt threads.
C
B
A
(contd)
6-55
03/07/29 09:11:56 61S0X050_060_0056
Cylinder Head
REAR:
B
A
6-56
03/07/29 09:11:57 61S0X050_060_0057
7. Apply new engine oil to the threads and flanges of 9. Install the timing belt (see page 6-23).
the cylinder head bolts.
10. Adjust the valve clearance (see page 6-15).
8. Tighten the cylinder head bolts sequentially in
three steps. 11. Install the cylinder head cover (see page 6-34).
NOTE: Perform each step twice. 12. Install the exhaust manifold and tighten the nuts in
a crisscross pattern in two or three steps,
1st step torque: 39 Nm (4.0 kgfm, 29 lbfft) beginning with the inner nut (see page 9-10).
2nd step torque: 69 Nm (7.0 kgfm, 51 lbfft) Always use a new exhaust manifold gasket.
3rd step torque: 98.1 Nm (10.0 kgfm, 72.3 lbfft)
13. Install the nuts securing the exhaust pipe A and
Use a beam-type torque wrench. When using a exhaust manifold, then install the cover on the
preset-type torque wrench, be sure to tighten exhaust manifold.
slowly and not to overtighten.
If a bolt makes any noise while you are torquing it, 14. Install the water passage (A). Always use a new O-
loosen the bolt, and retighten it from the first step. ring (B) and new gaskets (C).
B
Cylinder Head Bolts Torque Sequence
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm
(2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
(contd)
6-57
03/07/29 09:11:59 61S0X050_060_0058
Cylinder Head
2002-2004 models:
6 x 1.0 mm
9.8 Nm(1.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft)
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm
(1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
6-58
03/07/29 09:11:59 61S0X050_060_0059
18. Install the upper radiator hose (A) and lower 24. Install the fuel feed hose (A) and fuel return hose
radiator hose (B). (B), using new washers (C).
1999-2001 models:
A
A B
B
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
16 lbfft)
19. Install the intake manifold (see page 9-7).
20. Loosely install the power steering (P/S) pump and 2002-2004 models:
P/S pump belt.
D
21. Adjust the P/S pump belt (see step 3 on page 17-12).
(contd)
6-59
03/07/29 09:12:00 61S0X050_060_0060
Cylinder Head
29. Refill the radiator with engine coolant, and bleed 5. Remove the front camshaft pulley.
air from the cooling system with the heater valve
open (see step 8 on page 10-13).
12 x 1.25 mm
90 Nm (9.2 kgfm, 67 lbfft)
Apply engine oil to
the bolt threads.
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
6-60
03/07/29 09:12:01 61S0X050_060_0061
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
6-61
03/07/29 09:12:01 61S0X050_060_0062
03/07/29 09:12:47 61S0X050_070_0001
Engine Mechanical
Engine Block
Special Tools ................................................................. 7-2
Component Location Index ......................................... 7-3
Connecting Rod and Crankshaft End Play
Inspection .................................................................. 7-6
Crankshaft Main Bearing Replacement ...................... 7-7
Connecting Rod Bearing Replacement ...................... 7-9
Oil Pan Removal ........................................................... 7-11
Crankshaft and Piston Removal .................................. 7-12
Crankshaft Inspection .................................................. 7-14
Block and Piston Inspection ........................................ 7-15
Cylinder Bore Honing............................................................ 7-17
Piston, Pin, and Connecting Rod Replacement ......... 7-18
Piston Ring Replacement ............................................. 7-21
Crankshaft and Piston Installation .............................. 7-23
Oil Pan Installation ....................................................... 7-28
Pulley End Crankshaft Seal Installation - In Car ......... 7-29
Transmission End Crankshaft Seal
Installation - In Car .................................................... 7-29
03/07/29 09:12:48 61S0X050_070_0002
Engine Block
Special Tools
Ref. No. Tool Number Description Qty
070AD-RCA0100 Oil Seal Driver, 64 mm 1
070AD-RCA0200 Driver Attachment, 106 mm 1
07749-0010000 Driver 1
7-2
03/07/29 09:12:50 61S0X050_070_0003
OIL PAN
Removal, page 7-11
Installation, page 7-28
BAFFLE PLATE
DOWEL PIN
WASHER
O-RING
O-RING
(contd)
7-3
03/07/29 09:12:51 61S0X050_070_0004
Engine Block
CRANKSHAFT
End play, page 7-6
Inspection, page 7-14
Installation, page 7-23
MAIN BEARINGS
Oil clearance, page 7-7 THRUST WASHERS
Selection, page 7-7
DOWEL PIN
7-4
03/07/29 09:12:55 61S0X050_070_0005
PISTON RINGS
Replacement, page 7-21
SNAP RING
PISTON PIN
Removal, page 7-18
Installation, step 1 on page 7-20
Inspection, step 1 on page 7-19
PISTON
Removal, page 7-12
Measurement, page 7-15
CONNECTING ROD
End play, page 7-6
Small end measurement,
step 1 on page 7-19
ENGINE BLOCK
Cylinder bore inspection, step 4 on page 7-16
Warpage inspection, step 5 on page 7-16
Cylinder bore honing, page 7-17
Ridge removal, step 5 on page 7-12
DOWEL PIN
7-5
03/07/29 09:12:56 61S0X050_070_0006
Engine Block
7-6
03/07/29 09:12:56 61S0X050_070_0007
3. Place one strip of plastigage across each main 7. If the plastigage shows the clearance is still
journal. incorrect, try the next larger or smaller bearing (the
color listed above or below that one), and check
NOTE: If the engine is still in the car when you bolt again. If the proper clearance cannot be obtained
the main cap down to check the clearance, the by using the appropriate larger or smaller bearings,
weight of the crankshaft and drive plate will flatten replace the crankshaft and start over.
the plastigage further than just the torque on the
cap bolt and give you an incorrect reading. For an
accurate reading, support the crank with a jack
under the counterweights, and check only one
bearing at a time.
(contd)
7-7
03/07/29 09:12:57 61S0X050_070_0008
Engine Block
7-8
03/07/29 09:12:57 61S0X050_070_0009
PLASTIGAGE STRIP
(contd)
7-9
03/07/29 09:12:58 61S0X050_070_0010
Engine Block
1 or I 2 or II 3 or III 4 or IIII
7-10
03/07/29 09:12:59 61S0X050_070_0011
7-11
03/07/29 09:13:00 61S0X050_070_0012
Engine Block
C
8. If you can feel a ridge of metal or hard carbon
around the top of any cylinder, remove it with a
ridge reamer (A). Follow the reamer manufacturers
instructions. If the ridge is not removed, it may
damage the piston as its pushed out.
A
A
5. Remove the oil pan (see page 7-11).
7-12
03/07/29 09:13:00 61S0X050_070_0013
9. Remove the connecting rod caps after setting the 10. Remove the bearing from the cap. Keep all caps/
crank pin at bottom dead center (BDC) for each bearings in order.
cylinder. Remove the piston assembly by pushing
on the connecting rod. Take care not to damage the 11. Remove the upper bearing halves from the
crank pin or cylinder with the connecting rod. connecting rods, and set them aside with their
respective caps.
CORRECT
12. After removing a piston/connecting rod assembly,
reinstall the cap on the rod.
INCORRECT
(contd)
7-13
03/07/29 09:13:01 61S0X050_070_0014
Engine Block
15. Remove the bearing cap bolts (A) and bearing cap 1. Remove the crankshaft from the cylinder block (see
side bolts (B), then remove the bearing cap (C). page 7-12).
A
C
2. Clean the crankshaft oil passages with pipe
cleaners or a suitable brush.
Journal Out-of-Round
Standard (New): 0.005 mm (0.0002 in.) max.
Service Limit: 0.010 mm (0.0004 in.)
Journal Taper
Standard (New): 0.005 mm (0.0002 in.) max.
17. Reinstall the main caps and bearings on the Service Limit: 0.010 mm (0.0004 in.)
cylinder block in the proper order.
7-14
03/07/29 09:13:02 61S0X050_070_0015
(contd)
7-15
03/07/29 09:13:03 61S0X050_070_0016
Engine Block
7-16
03/07/29 09:13:03 61S0X050_070_0017
NOTE:
Use only a rigid hone with 400 grit or finer stone,
SERVICE LIMIT
such as Sunnen, Ammco, or equivalent.
0.08 mm (0.003 in.) Do not use stones that are worn or broken.
60
7-17
03/07/29 09:13:04 61S0X050_070_0018
Engine Block
7-18
03/07/29 09:13:05 61S0X050_070_0019
(contd)
7-19
03/07/29 09:13:05 61S0X050_070_0020
Engine Block
7-20
03/07/29 09:13:06 61S0X050_070_0021
A
B
A 1520 mm
(0.60.8 in)
Top Ring
Standard (New): 0.200.35 mm
(0.0080.014 in.)
Service Limit: 0.60 mm (0.024 in.)
Second Ring
Standard (New): 0.400.55 mm
(0.0160.022 in.)
Service Limit: 0.70 mm (0.028 in.)
Oil Ring
Standard (New): 0.200.70 mm
(0.0080.028 in.)
Service Limit: 0.80 mm (0.031 in.)
(contd)
7-21
03/07/29 09:13:06 61S0X050_070_0022
Engine Block
C
A
7-22
03/07/29 09:13:07 61S0X050_070_0023
20 mm
(0.79 in.) B
(contd)
7-23
03/07/29 09:13:08 61S0X050_070_0024
Engine Block
14. Install the piston with the arrow (A) facing the
timing belt side of the engine.
A
C
D
B
E
10 x 80 mm
E
10 x 60 mm 15. Position the piston in the cylinder, and tap it in
using the wooden handle of a hammer (A).
E Maintain downward force on the ring compressor
10 x 109 mm (B) to prevent the rings from expanding before
entering the cylinder bore.
A
E E
10 x 80 mm 10 x 60 mm
7-24
03/07/29 09:13:09 61S0X050_070_0025
17. Line up the mark (A) on the connecting rod and cap, 21. Torque the bearing cap bolts (A), then torque the
then install the cap. bearing cap side bolts (B). Follow the numbered
sequence shown.
18. Apply new engine oil to the bolt threads. Torque
the bolts (B) to 20 Nm (2.0 kgfm, 14 lbfft). NOTE: Whenever any crankshaft or connecting rod
bearing is replaced, it is necessary after
B reassembly to run the engine at idling speed until it
reaches normal operating temperature, then
continue to run it for about 15 minutes.
A B
11 x 1.5 mm 10 x 1.25 mm
76 Nm (7.8 kgfm, 49 Nm (5.0 kgfm,
56 lbfft) 36 lbfft)
19. Mark the connecting rod (A) and bolt head (B) as
shown.
B
20. Tighten the bolt until the mark on the bolt head
lines up with the mark on the connecting rod (turn
the bolt 90).
(contd)
7-25
03/07/29 09:13:10 61S0X050_070_0026
Engine Block
B
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
7-26
03/07/29 09:13:11 61S0X050_070_0027
28. Clean and dry the oil pump mating surfaces. 32. Install the timing belt drive pulley (A), then install
the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor (B).
29. Install the oil pump (A).
C
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft) A
30. Install the baffle plate (D), then install the oil screen
(E).
7-27
03/07/29 09:13:11 61S0X050_070_0028
Engine Block
7-28
03/07/29 09:13:12 61S0X050_070_0029
070AD-RCA0100
070AD-RCA0200
4. Clean any excess grease off the crankshaft, and
check that the oil seal lip is not distorted.
7-29
03/07/29 09:13:12 61S0X050_070_0030
03/07/29 09:13:41 61S0X050_080_0001
Engine Mechanical
Engine Lubrication
Special Tools ................................................................. 8-2
Component Location Index ......................................... 8-3
Oil Pressure Switch Test .............................................. 8-4
Oil Pressure Test ........................................................... 8-4
Engine Oil Replacement .............................................. 8-5
Engine Oil Filter Replacement ..................................... 8-5
Oil Filter Feed Pipe Replacement ................................ 8-7
Oil Pump Overhaul ....................................................... 8-8
Oil Pressure Switch Replacement ............................... 8-11
03/07/29 09:13:41 61S0X050_080_0002
Engine Lubrication
Special Tools
Ref. No. Tool Number Description Qty
070AD-RCA0100 Oil Seal Driver, 64 mm 1
07912-6110001 Oil Filter Wrench 1
8-2
03/07/29 09:13:44 61S0X050_080_0003
VTEC SOLENOID
VALVE FILTER
BAFFLE
DOWEL PIN PLATE
O-RING
OIL FILTER
FEED PIPE DOWEL PIN
Replacement,
page 8-7
OIL PUMP
Removal, page 8-9
Inspection, page 8-9
Installation, page 8-10
DRAIN BOLT
WASHER
OIL PAN
Installation, step 7 on page 8-11
8-3
03/07/29 09:13:44 61S0X050_080_0004
Engine Lubrication
2. Check for continuity between the positive terminal 2. Start the engine. Shut it off immediately if the
(C) and the engine (ground). There should be gauge registers no oil pressure. Repair the problem
continuity with the engine stopped. There should before continuing.
be no continuity with the engine running.
3. Allow the engine to reach operating temperature
3. If the switch fails to operate, check the engine oil (fan comes on at least twice). The pressure should
level. If the engine oil level is OK, check the engine be:
oil pressure.
Engine Oil Temperature 176F (80C)
Engine Oil Pressure
At Idle: 70 kPa (0.7 kgf/cm2, 10 psi)
minimum
At 3,000 rpm: 490 kPa (5.0 kgf/cm2, 71 psi)
minimum
8-4
03/07/29 09:13:45 61S0X050_080_0005
Change interval 2. Inspect the threads (A) and rubber seal (B) on the
Every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 12 months new filter. Wipe off the seat on the engine block,
(Normal conditions) then apply a light coat of new engine oil to the filter
Every 3,750 miles (6,000 km) or 6 months rubber seal. Use only filters with a built-in bypass
(Severe conditions). system.
B
1. Warm up the engine.
2. Remove the drain bolt (A), and drain the engine oil.
B
A A
39 Nm (4.0 kgfm, 29 lbfft)
Do not overtighten.
Capacity
4.0 (4.2 US qt) at oil change.
4.4 (4.6 US qt) at oil change including filter.
5.0 (5.3 US qt) after engine overhaul.
(contd)
8-5
03/07/29 09:13:45 61S0X050_080_0006
Engine Lubrication
Number when 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
rubber seal is
seated
Number after 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
tightening
8-6
03/07/29 09:13:46 61S0X050_080_0007
3. Install the two 20 x 1.5 mm nuts (A) onto the new oil
filter feed pipe. Hold the nut with a wrench, then
tighten the other nut.
8-7
03/07/29 09:13:46 61S0X050_080_0008
Engine Lubrication
6 x 1.0 mm
ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH 6 Nm (0.6 kgfm, 4 lbfft)
18 Nm (1.8 kgfm, 13 lbfft)
1/8 in. BSPT (British standard pipe taper)
28 threads/inch. Use the
proper liquid sealant.
O-RING
Replace.
PUMP COVER
OUTER ROTOR
INNER ROTOR
OIL SEAL
Replace.
PUMP HOUSING
Apply liquid gasket
to the mating surface of
the cylinder block
when installing.
RELIEF VALVE
Valve must slide freely
in the housing bore. 6 x 1.0 mm
Replace if it is scored. 12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
SEALING BOLT
39 Nm (4.0 kgfm, 29 lbfft)
SPRING
8-8
03/07/29 09:13:47 61S0X050_080_0009
1. Drain the engine oil. 2. Check the inner-to-outer rotor radial clearance
between the inner rotor (A) and outer rotor (B). If
2. Turn the crankshaft so that the No. 1 piston is at top the inner-to-outer rotor clearance exceeds the
dead center (see page 6-20). service limit, replace the oil pump assembly.
3. Remove the timing belt (see page 6-20). Inner Rotor-to-Outer Rotor Radial Clearance
Standard (New): 0.040.16 mm
4. Remove the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor, then (0.0020.006 in.)
remove the timing belt drive pulley (see step 4 on Service Limit: 0.20 mm (0.008 in.)
page 7-12).
B
3. Check the housing-to-rotor axial clearance between
the rotors (A) and pump housing (B). If the housing-
to-rotor axial clearance exceeds the service limit,
replace the oil pump assembly.
(contd)
8-9
03/07/29 09:13:48 61S0X050_080_0010
Engine Lubrication
A B
070AD-RCA0100
8-10
03/07/29 09:13:49 61S0X050_080_0011
5. Install the oil pump (A). 9. Install the oil pan on the cylinder block.
1 Apply liquid gasket, P/N 08718-0001 or 08718-
0003, evenly to the block mating surface of the
oil pump and to the inner threads of the bolt
holes.
6 x 1.0 mm
D 12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
NOTE: Do not install the parts if 4 minutes or more 12. Install the timing belt drive pulley, then install the
have elapsed since applying liquid gasket. Instead, CKP sensor (see step 32 on page 7-27).
reapply liquid gasket after removing the old
residue. 13. Install the idler pulley.
8-11
03/07/29 09:13:49 61S0X050_080_0012
Engine Lubrication
18 Nm
(1.8 kgfm, 13 lbfft)
8-12
03/07/29 09:14:13 61S0X050_090_0001
Engine Mechanical
03/07/29 09:14:13 61S0X050_090_0002
BOOST PLATE
GASKET
6 x 1.0 mm Replace.
12 Nm GASKET 6 x 1.0 mm
(1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft) Replace. 12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
O-RING
INTAKE MANIFOLD Replace.
END PLATE
12 x 1.5 mm
GASKET 26 Nm (2.7 kgfm, 20 lbfft)
Replace. (99 model)
DOWEL PIN
INTAKE MANIFOLD
Replace if it is cracked or
if the mating surface is
damaged.
GASKET GASKET
Replace. Replace.
GASKET
Replace.
SPACER
THROTTLE
BODY
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm
(2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
9-2
03/07/29 09:14:15 61S0X050_090_0003
6 x 1.0 mm
UPPER COVER 12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
Replace if it is cracked or
if the mating surface is
damaged.
REAR INTAKE
MANIFOLD CHAMBER
INTAKE MANIFOLD Replace if it is cracked or
FUNNEL if the mating surface is
GASKET damaged.
Replace.
IAT SENSOR
GASKET 18 Nm (1.8 kgfm,
Replace. 13 lbfft)
O-RING
8 x 1.25 mm Replace.
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
16 lbfft)
INTAKE MANIFOLD
FUNNEL
GASKET
Replace.
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
12 x 1.5 mm
26 Nm (2.7 kgfm,
20 lbfft)
GASKET
Replace.
SPACER
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm
(1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft) GASKET 8 x 1.25 mm
FRONT INTAKE Replace. 22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
MANIFOLD CHAMBER 16 lbfft)
Replace if it is cracked or GASKET
if the mating surface is Replace.
damaged. THROTTLE
BODY
INTAKE MANIFOLD
Replace if it is cracked or
if the mating surface is
damaged.
(contd)
9-3
03/07/29 09:14:16 61S0X050_090_0004
2002-2004 models: A C B
A 2002-2004 models:
D
9-4
03/07/29 09:14:17 61S0X050_090_0005
4. Remove the throttle cable (A) and cruise control 6. Remove the brake booster vacuum hose (A) and
cable (B) by loosening the locknuts (C), then slip the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) hose (B).
cable ends out of the accelerator linkage. Take care
not to bend the cables when removing them. 1999-2001 models:
Always replace any kinked cable with a new one. C
B
C B
A
2002-2004 models:
C
A
(contd)
9-5
03/07/29 09:14:18 61S0X050_090_0006
1999-2001 models:
A B
2002-2004 models:
11. Remove the upper cover (A), then remove the
intake manifold (B) and spacer (C) (2002-2004
models).
C
A
B
A
B
9-6
03/07/29 09:14:19 61S0X050_090_0007
Installation 3. Install the upper cover. Tighten the bolts and nuts
sequentially in two or three steps. Always use a
1. Put the gasket and spacer on the injector base new intake manifold gasket (2002-2004 Models).
(2002-2004 models).
Specified torque:
2. Install the intake manifold. Tighten the bolts and 6 x 1.0 mm
nuts sequentially in two or three steps. Always use a 12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
new intake manifold gasket.
Specified torque:
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
1999-2001 models:
2002-2004 models:
(contd)
9-7
03/07/29 09:14:20 61S0X050_090_0008
A B A
A
B
9-8
03/07/29 09:14:22 61S0X050_090_0009
10. Install the intake air duct (A), then install the 12. Install the ignition coil cover(s) (A) and intake
vacuum hose(s) (B) and breather pipe (C). manifold cover (B).
A
D C B
2002-2004 models:
2002-2004 models:
B
A
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
D
13. Clean up any spilled engine coolant.
11. Install the EVAP canister hose (D) (1999-2001
models) or vacuum hose (D) (2002-2004 models). 14. After installation, check that all tubes, hoses and
connectors are installed correctly.
9-9
03/07/29 09:14:22 61S0X050_090_0010
FRONT:
SELF-LOCKING NUT
GASKET 8 x 1.25 mm
Replace. 31 Nm (3.2 kgfm,
23 lbfft)
Apply engine oil to the
nut threads.
Replace.
COVER
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
16 lbfft)
REAR:
GASKET
Replace.
SELF-LOCKING NUT
8 x 1.25 mm
31 Nm (3.2 kgfm, 23 lbfft)
8 x 1.25 mm Apply engine oil to the
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft) nut threads.
Replace.
9-10
03/07/29 09:14:23 61S0X050_090_0011
HEAT SHIELD
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm MUFFLER
(1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
HEAT SHIELD
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm
(1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
SECONDARY HEATED
OXYGEN SENSOR
(SECONDARY HO2S)
44 Nm
(4.5 kgfm, 33 lbfft)
GASKET
GASKETS Replace.
Replace.
SELF-LOCKING NUT
10 x 1.25 mm
33 Nm GASKET THREE WAY
(3.4 kgfm, 25 lbfft) Replace. CATALYTIC
Replace. CONVERTER
(TWC)
6 x 1.0 mm
9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
EXHAUST PIPE A
SELF-LOCKING NUTS
10 x 1.25 mm
54 Nm (5.5 kgfm, 40 lbfft)
Replace.
SELF-LOCKING NUT
10 x 1.25 mm
33 Nm
(3.4 kgfm, 25 lbfft)
PRIMARY HEATED OXYGEN Replace. THREE WAY CATALYTIC
SENSOR CONVERTER (TWC)
(PRIMARY HO2S) TIGHTENING SEQUENCE
44 Nm (4.5 kgfm, 33 lbfft) 10 x 1.25 mm
38 Nm (3.9 kgfm, 28 lbfft)
9-11
03/07/29 09:14:23 61S0X050_090_0012
03/07/29 09:15:07 61S0X050_100_0001
Engine Cooling
Cooling System
Component Location Index ......................................... 10-2
Coolant Temperature Gauge Testing ......................... 10-5
Sending Unit Test ......................................................... 10-9
Radiator Cap Test ......................................................... 10-10
Radiator Test ................................................................. 10-10
Fan Motor Test .............................................................. 10-11
Thermostat Test ........................................................... 10-11
Water Pump Inspection ............................................... 10-12
Water Pump Replacement ........................................... 10-12
Coolant Replacement ................................................... 10-13
Thermostat Replacement ............................................ 10-15
Radiator and Fan Replacement ................................... 10-16
Fan Controls
Component Location Index ......................................... 10-19
Symptom Troubleshooting Index ............................... 10-20
Circuit Diagram ............................................................. 10-21
Radiator and Condenser Fan Circuit
Troubleshooting A .................................................... 10-22
Radiator and Condenser Fan Circuit
Troubleshooting B .................................................... 10-23
Radiator and Condenser Fan Circuit
Troubleshooting C .................................................... 10-24
Radiator and Condenser Fan
High Speed Circuit Troubleshooting ...................... 10-24
Radiator Fan Switch Test ............................................. 10-25
03/07/29 09:15:09 61S0X050_100_0002
Cooling System
RADIATOR FAN
RADIATOR CAP
RESERVOIR
TANK
FAN MOTOR
Test, page 10-11 O-RING
DRAIN PLUG
ATF COOLER
HOSES
RADIATOR
Replacement, page 10-16
A/C CONDENSER FAN ASSEMBLY
Replacement, page 10-16
Fan Motor Test, page 10-11
10-2
03/07/29 09:15:10 61S0X050_100_0003
1999-2001 models:
HEATER HOSES
UPPER RADIATOR HOSE
THERMOSTAT COVER
WATER PASSAGE
RADIATOR
LOWER RADIATOR HOSE
2002-2004 models:
HEATER HOSES
HEATER VALVE
THERMOSTAT COVER
RADIATOR
(contd)
10-3
03/07/29 09:15:11 61S0X050_100_0004
Cooling System
COOLANT TEMPERATURE
GAUGE SENDING UNIT
(1999-2000 models)
Test, page 10-9
O-RING
GASKETS
WATER PUMP
Inspection, page 10-12
Replacement, page 10-12 O-RINGS
CONNECTING PIPE
O-RING O-RING
10-4
03/07/29 09:15:12 61S0X050_100_0005
ECTOUT
(YEL/GRN)
(contd)
10-5
03/07/29 09:15:12 61S0X050_100_0006
Cooling System
ECTOUT
(YEL/GRN)
ECTOUT
(YEL/GRN)
YESReplace the fuel and temperature gauge 2. Turn the ignition switch ON (ll).
assembly.
Af ter 30 seconds or more, does the temperature
NOGo to step 5. gauge needle move to the hot side?
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF, and check for YESSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
continuity between PCM connector terminal E14 (see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
and gauge assembly connector terminal C2. away, replace the original PCM (see page 11-4).
(YEL/GRN)
Is there continuity?
10-6
03/07/29 09:15:13 61S0X050_100_0007
4. Connect the negative cable to the battery. Turn the Coolant Temperature Gauge Needle Goes
ignition switch ON (ll), and measure voltage Past the Hot Mark - 2001 model
between PCM connector terminal A31 and body
ground. 1. Turn the ignition switch OFF, and disconnect the
negative cable from the battery. Then disconnect
PCM CONNECTOR A (32P) PCM connector E (31P).
YESGo to step 3.
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF, and check for YESReplace the fuel and temperature gauge
continuity between PCM connector terminal A31 assembly.
and gauge assembly connector terminal C2.
NOThe temperature gauge needle went past the
PCM CONNECTOR A (32P) Hot mark after about 30 seconds or more. Go to
step 4.
(YEL/GRN)
Is there continuity?
(contd)
10-7
03/07/29 09:15:13 61S0X050_100_0008
Cooling System
YESGo to step 3.
GAUGE ASSEMBLY CONNECTOR C (16P)
Wire side of female terminals NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
Is there continuity? away, replace the original PCM (see page 11-4).
YESRepair a short in the wire between PCM 3. Turn the ignition switch OFF, then turn it ON (II)
connector E14 terminal and gauge connector again, and watch the coolant temperature gauge.
terminal C2.
Does the temperature gauge needle immediately
NOReplace the fuel and temperature gauge go past the Hot mark?
assembly.
YESReplace the fuel and temperature gauge
assembly.
10-8
03/07/29 09:15:14 61S0X050_100_0009
ECTOUT
(YEL/GRN)
(YEL/GRN)
Is there continuity?
10-9
03/07/29 09:15:14 61S0X050_100_0010
Cooling System
4. If the pressure drops, replace the cap. 3. Inspect for engine coolant leaks and a drop in
pressure.
10-10
03/07/29 09:15:15 61S0X050_100_0011
A B
Standard Thermostat
Lift height: above 10.0 mm (0.39 in.)
Starts opening:
99-01 models: 163171F (73 77C)
02-04 models: 169176F (76 80C)
Fully open: 194F (90C)
10-11
03/07/29 09:15:16 61S0X050_100_0012
Cooling System
2. Turn the water pump pulley counterclockwise. 2. Remove the timing belt (see page 6-20).
Check that it turns freely.
3. Remove the timing belt tensioner.
3. Check for signs of seal leakage. A small amount of
weeping from the bleed holes (A) is normal. 4. Remove the water pump (A) by removing five bolts.
A
A
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
10-12
03/07/29 09:15:16 61S0X050_100_0013
Coolant Replacement
1. Set the heater temperature control dial to 7. Remove, drain, and reinstall the reservoir.
maximum heat. Make sure the engine and radiator
are cool to the touch. 8. Pour Honda All Season Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2
(P/N OL999-9001) into the radiator up to the base of
2. Remove the radiator cap. the filler neck.
3. Loosen the drain plug (A), and drain the engine NOTE:
coolant. Always use Honda All Season Antifreeze/Coolant
A Type 2. Using a non-Honda coolant can result in
corrosion, causing the cooling system to
malfunction or fail.
Honda All Season Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2 is a
mixture of 50 % antifreeze and 50 % water.
Pre-mixing is not required.
B
9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft) A
(contd)
10-13
03/07/29 09:15:17 61S0X050_100_0014
Cooling System
14. Check the level in the radiator, and add Honda All
Season Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2, if needed.
16. Check the level in the radiator, and add Honda All INTERIOR
TEMPERATURE F (C)
Season Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2, if needed.
22. Make sure you do not hear the sound of water
17. Set the temperature control dial to maximum. Start flowing near the rear heater unit. If you hear water
the engine. Hold the engine speed at 1,500 rpm for flowing, repeat steps 15 through 18 several more
3 minutes, then turn off the engine. times. Then loosely install the radiator cap and
recheck.
18. Check the level in the radiator, and add Honda All
Season Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2, if needed. 23. Fill the reserve tank with Honda All Season
Antifreeze/coolant Type 2 up to the MAX mark on
19. Repeat steps 15 through 18 until the coolant level the tank, then add an extra 0.4 (0.4 US qt) coolant.
dose not change in the radiator, then install the
radiator cap loosely.
10-14
03/07/29 09:15:17 61S0X050_100_0015
Thermostat Replacement
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft codes for the radio and navigation system, then write down the frequencies for
the radios preset buttons.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery first, then disconnect the positive cable.
PIN THERMOSTAT
COVER
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
THERMOSTAT
Install with pin up.
RUBBER SEAL
Replace.
7. Install the battery. Clean the battery posts and cable terminals with sandpaper, then assemble them and apply
grease to prevent corrosion.
8. Refill the radiator with engine coolant, and bleed the air from the cooling system (see step 8 on page 10-13).
10. Perform the powertrain control module (PCM) idle learn procedure (see page 11-202).
11. Enter the anti-theft codes for the radio and the navigation system, then enter the customers radio station presets.
10-15
03/07/29 09:15:18 61S0X050_100_0016
Cooling System
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm
(1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft) A
10-16
03/07/29 09:15:20 61S0X050_100_0017
9. Remove the three mounting bolts (A) and loosen 11. Remove the upper radiator hose (A), lower radiator
mounting bolt (B), then remove the battery base (C). hose (B) and automatic transmission fluid (ATF)
cooler hoses (C). Plug the ATF cooler hoses and
A
8 x 1.25 mm lines.
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
C 16 lbfft)
A
C
D
6 x 1.0 mm
B A 9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm,
B 7.2 lbfft)
8 x 1.25 mm 8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm, 22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
16 lbfft) 16 lbfft) 12. Remove the two bolts (D) securing the ATF cooler
line.
10. Remove the harness clamps (A), then remove the
fan motor connectors (B) and A/C compressor 13. Remove the radiator upper brackets/cushions (A)
clutch connector (C). and condenser bracket (B).
A 6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 6 x 1.0 mm
8.7 lbfft) 9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft)
B C
(contd)
10-17
03/07/29 09:15:21 61S0X050_100_0018
Cooling System
15. Remove the two condenser fan shroud upper 20. Enter the anti-theft code for the radio and the
mounting bolts (C) securing the condenser fan navigation system, then enter the customers radio
shroud, and loosen the two lower mounting bolts station presets.
(D) securing the condenser fan shroud, then
remove the condenser fan shroud assembly (E) 21. Perform the power window control unit reset
from the battery side. procedure (2003-2004 models) (see page 22-200).
10-18
03/07/29 09:15:22 61S0X050_100_0019
Fan Controls
UNDER-HOOD
RELAY BOX FUSE/RELAY BOX
RADIATOR FAN
MAIN RELAY
Test, page 22-88
10-19
03/07/29 09:15:23 61S0X050_100_0020
Fan Controls
10-20
03/07/29 09:15:23 61S0X050_100_0021
Circuit Diagram
DRIVERS
No.3 UNDERDASH
(7.5A) FUSE/RELAY
1 4 1 4 BOX
RADIATOR CONDENSER
FAN FAN
RELAY RELAY BLK/YEL BLK/YEL
2 3 2 3
CONDENSER
FAN MOTOR
BLU/RED BLK/YEL
1 5
RADIATOR
FAN MAIN
RELAY
4 2 3
BLU/BLK BLU/RED
GRN
PASSENGERS
BLU/BLK BLK BLU/RED BLU/RED UNDERDASH
FUSE/RELAY
BOX
GRN
2
1 RADIATOR 2 RADIATOR
RADIATOR FAN SWITCH B AIR FAN SWITCH A
FAN MOTOR Closed : Above CONDITIONING Closed : Above
210F (99C) SYSTEM 199F (93C)
2 1
1
10-21
03/07/29 09:15:24 61S0X050_100_0022
Fan Controls
Is the f use OK ?
JUMPER
YESGo to step 2. WIRE
NOReplace the under-hood fuse/relay box. YESRepair an open in the wire between the
radiator fan relay and the A/C pressure switch.
10-22
03/07/29 09:15:24 61S0X050_100_0023
8. Measure the voltage between fan motor 2P NOTE: Refer to the symptom troubleshooting index
connector terminal No. 2 and body ground. before troubleshooting.
RADIATOR FAN MOTOR 2P CONNECTOR 1. Disconnect the radiator fan switch A 2P connector.
Wire side of
female terminals
Is there continuity?
10-23
03/07/29 09:15:25 61S0X050_100_0024
Fan Controls
Radiator and Condenser Fan Circuit Radiator and Condenser Fan High
Troubleshooting C Speed Circuit Troubleshooting
NOTE: Refer to the symptom troubleshooting index NOTE: Refer to the symptom troubleshooting index
before troubleshooting. before troubleshooting.
1. Remove the condenser fan relay, and test it (see 1. Remove the radiator fan relay and condenser fan
page 22-88). relay from the under-hood fuse/relay box.
5. Check for continuity between radiator fan switch B Wire side of female terminals
2P connector terminal No. 1 and body ground.
YESGo to step 5.
BLU/BLK
10-24
03/07/29 09:15:26 61S0X050_100_0025
A
Wire side of female terminals
YESReplace radiator fan switch B. 3. Heat the coolant and check the temperature with a
thermometer (B). Do not let the thermometer touch
NORepair an open in the wire between radiator the bottom of the hot container.
fan switch B 2P connector terminal No. 2 and
ground G101. 4. Measure the continuity between terminal (No. 1)
and terminal (No. 2) according to the table.
Terminal
A B
Operation Temperature
196203F
ON (9195C)
SWITCH
A 515F (3 8C) lower
OFF than the temperature
when it goes on
205216F
ON (96102C)
SWITCH
B 518 (3 10) lower
OFF than the temperature
when it goes on
10-25
03/07/29 09:15:26 61S0X050_100_0026
03/07/29 09:17:42 61S0X050_110_0001
03/07/29 09:17:43 61S0X050_110_0002
Special Tools
Ref. No. Tool Number Description Qty
A973X-041-XXXXX Vacuum Pump/Gauge, 030 in.Hg 1
07JAZ-001000B Vacuum/Pressure Gauge, 04 in.Hg 1
07SAZ-001000A Backprobe Set 2
07VAJ-0040100 Fuel Pressure Gauge Attachment 1
07XAA-001010A Fuel Sender wrench 1
07406-004000A Fuel Pressure Gauge 1
11-2
03/07/29 09:17:44 61S0X050_110_0003
How to Use the HDS or a Scan Tool 3. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
If the MIL (Malfunction Indicator Lamp) has come on 4. Check the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and note
it. Also check the freeze data. Refer to the DTC
1. Start the engine, and check the MIL. Troubleshooting Index and begin the appropriate
troubleshooting procedure.
01-04 Models
NOTE: If the ignition switch is turned ON (II), and NOTE:
the engine is not started, the MIL will stay on for Freeze data indicates the engine conditions when the
1520 seconds (see page 11-89). first malfunction, misfire or fuel trim malfunction was
detected.
The HDS can read the DTC, freeze data, current data,
and other powertrain control module (PCM) data.
For specific operations, refer to the users manual
that came with the HDS.
(contd)
11-3
03/07/29 09:17:45 61S0X050_110_0004
D
C
F
B
11-4
03/07/29 09:17:46 61S0X050_110_0005
How to Troubleshoot Circuits at the PCM How to Substitute the PCM for Testing
Purposes
Special Tools Required
Digital Multimeter KS-AHM-32-003 (1) or a Use this procedure if you need a known-good PCM to
commercially available digital multimeter test a vehicle. It allows you to swap a PCM from a
Backprobe Set 07SAZ-001000A (2) donor vehicle without having to program it to the test
vehicles ignition key.
1. Connect the backprobe adapters (A) to the stacking
patch cords (B), and connect the cords to a digital 1. Cut a temporary ignition key for the test vehicle
multimeter (C). with a non-immobilizer key blank.
11-5
03/07/29 09:17:46 61S0X050_110_0006
11-6
03/07/29 09:17:46 61S0X050_110_0007
(contd)
11-7
03/07/29 09:17:47 61S0X050_110_0008
11-8
03/07/29 09:17:47 61S0X050_110_0009
11-9
03/07/29 09:17:47 61S0X050_110_0010
System Descriptions
Electronic Control System
The functions of the fuel and emission control systems are managed by the powertrain control module (PCM).
Fail-safe Function
When an abnormality occurs in the signal from a sensor, the PCM ignores that signal and assumes a pre-programmed
value for that sensor that allows the engine to continue to run.
Back-up Function
When an abnormality occurs in the PCM, the injectors are controlled by an independent back-up circuit to permit
minimal driving.
Self-diagnosis
When an abnormality occurs in the signal from a sensor, the PCM supplies ground for the malfunction indicator lamp
(MIL) and stores the diagnostic trouble code (DTC) in erasable memory. When the ignition is first turned on, the PCM
supplies ground to the MIL for 2 seconds (99-01 models) or for 15 to 20 seconds (02-04 models) to check the MIL bulb
condition.
11-10
03/07/29 09:17:47 61S0X050_110_0011
PCM Data
You can retrieve data from the PCM by connecting the OBD II scan tool or HDS to the data link connector (DLC). The
items listed in the table below conform to SAE recommended practice. The HDS also reads data beyond that
recommended by SAE to this data may help you find the causes of intermittent problems.
NOTE:
The operating values listed are approximate and may vary depending on the environment and the individual
vehicle.
Unless noted otherwise, at idle speed means idling with the engine completely warmed up, the transmission in
park or neutral, and the A/C and all accessories turned off.
(contd)
11-11
03/07/29 09:17:48 61S0X050_110_0012
11-12
03/07/29 09:17:49 61S0X050_110_0013
IGNITION SWITCH
B IG1 FUEL
PUMP P
ST
STARTER
BATTERY CUT B1 IGP1 PG1 B2
RELAY
B9 IGP2 PG2 B10
A
A24 STSW IMOFPR A15 F
B21 VBU
B20 LG1
INJECTORS
D B22 LG2
No. 1
INJ1 B11
No. 2
C20 TDC1 INJ2 B5
TDC No. 3
SENSOR 1 C21 TDC1 INJ3 B15
No. 4
C29 TDC2 INJ4 B4
TDC No. 5
SENSOR 2 C30 TDC2 INJ5 B3
No. 6
C8 CKP INJ6 B6
CKP
SENSOR C9 CKP
IACV B23
(contd)
11-13
03/07/29 09:17:50 61S0X050_110_0014
To IMMOBILIZER
IMOCD A25 UNIT
IMOEN A13 To IMMOBILIZER
UNIT
TP C28 VCC2
SENSOR
C27 TPS ILU A28 To MULTIPLEX
CONTROL UNIT
C18 SG2 (DRIVERS)
To GAUGE
EGR ASSEMBLY
VALVE
LIFT TEST TACHOMETER
SENSOR C6 EGRP NEP A16
CONNECTOR
B7 EGR CCS A5 To CRUISE
CONTROL UNIT
EGR
VALVE E
FTP
SENSOR
EVAP PURGE CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
A29 FTP PCS A6
ENGINE MOUNT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
C19 VCC1 MCS A2
A26 PSPSW
To
IGPLS1 C4 SPARK
ICM PLUG
A IGPLS2 C14
No. 1 IGNITION COIL
IGPLS3 C3
To
BRAKE SWITCH IGPLS4 C13 SPARK
ICM PLUG
A32 BKSW IGPLS5 C12
C VTEC
OIL PRESSURE IGPLS6 C23 No. 2 IGNITION COIL
SWITCH
C18 VTPSW To
SPARK
ICM PLUG
E C
No. 3 IGNITION COIL
To
SPARK
PRIMARY C1 PO2SHTC ICM PLUG
HO2S
(SENSOR 1)
C16 PHO2S No. 4 IGNITION COIL
To
SPARK
ICM PLUG
11-14
03/07/29 09:17:51 61S0X050_110_0015
* ATSFTP A11
* VREF A7
ABS/TCS
* TPSOUT A31 CONTROL
UNIT *
* PFINH E3
* FPTDR E1
OP3SW B24
D4
LOCKUP CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
LC D1
GAUGE SHIFT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE A
ASSEMBLY SHA D7
D6 ATPR
P
R
D9 ATPD4
D4 D8 ATPD3 LSAB17
NM D11
MAINSHAFT
NMSG D12 SPEED SENSOR
NC D10
COUNTERSHAFT
NCSG D16 SPEED SENSOR
* : with ABS/TCS
TERMINAL LOCATIONS
(contd)
11-15
03/07/29 09:17:52 61S0X050_110_0016
IGNITION SWITCH
B IG1 FUEL
PUMP P
ST
STARTER
BATTERY CUT A3 IGP1 PG1 A5
RELAY
A2 IGP2 PG2 A4
A
E8 STSW IMOFPR E1 F
A1 VBU
A26 LG1
INJECTORS
D A25 LG2
No. 1
INJ1 B14
No. 2
A11 TDC1 INJ2 B13
TDC No. 3
SENSOR 1 A23 TDC1 INJ3 B12
No. 4
A10 TDC2 INJ4 B22
TDC No. 5
SENSOR 2 A22 TDC2 INJ5 B21
No. 6
A12 CKP INJ6 B20
CKP
SENSOR A24 CKP
IACV B23
11-16
03/07/29 09:17:53 61S0X050_110_0017
To IMMOBILIZER
IMOCD E31 UNIT
IMOEN E30 To IMMOBILIZER
UNIT
ECTOUT E14 To COOLANT
TEMPERATURE
TP A30 VCC2
SENSOR To MULTIPLEX
A15 TPS ILU E15 CONTROL UNIT
(DRIVERS)
A28 SG2
To GAUGE
EGR ASSEMBLY
VALVE
POSITION NEP E3 TEST TACHOMETER
SENSOR A16 EGRP
CONNECTOR
B3 EGR CCS E17 To CRUISE
CONTROL UNIT
EGR
VALVE E
E6 VCC3
FTP
SENSOR E7 SG3
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VALVE
E28 FTP PCS E11
ENGINE MOUNT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
A31 VCC1 MCS E24
E20 PSPSW
To
IGPLS1 B10 SPARK
ICM PLUG
A IGPLS2 B9
No. 1 IGNITION COIL
IGPLS3 B8
To
BRAKE SWITCH IGPLS4 B19 SPARK
ICM PLUG
E9 BKSW IGPLS5 B16
C VTEC
OIL PRESSURE IGPLS6 B17 No. 2 IGNITION COIL
SWITCH
A20 VTPSW To
SPARK
ICM PLUG
E C
No. 3 IGNITION COIL
To
SPARK
PRIMARY B5 PO2SHTC ICM PLUG
HO2S
(SENSOR 1)
A5 PHO2S No. 4 IGNITION COIL
To
SPARK
ICM PLUG
(contd)
11-17
03/07/29 09:17:53 61S0X050_110_0018
* ATSFTP D11
* VREF D9
ABS/TCS
* TPSOUT D16 CONTROL
UNIT *
* PFINH D5
* FPTDR D3
OP2SW C11
OP3SW C19
D4 TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID VALVE
LC C10
GAUGE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE A
ASSEMBLY SHA C2
C21 ATPR
P
R
C13 ATPD4
D4 C4 ATPD3 LSAB7
TRANSMISSION LSBC8
RANGE A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
SWITCH CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE B
NM C7
MAINSHAFT
NMSG C5 SPEED SENSOR
NC C15
COUNTERSHAFT
NCSG C14 SPEED SENSOR
* : with ABS/TCS
TERMINAL LOCATIONS
11-18
03/07/29 09:17:54 61S0X050_110_0019
IGNITION SWITCH
B IG1 FUEL
PUMP P
ST
STARTER
BATTERY CUT B1 IGP1 PG1 B2
RELAY
B9 IGP2 PG2 B10
A
A24 STSW IMOFPR A15 F
B21 VBU
B20 LG1
INJECTORS
D B22 LG2
No. 1
INJ1 B11
No. 2
CMPA INJ2 B5
C20 (TDC1)
CMP SENSOR A No. 3
(TDC SENSOR 1)
C21 CMPA
(TDC1) INJ3 B15
No. 4
C29 CMPB
(TDC2) INJ4 B4
CMP SENSOR B No. 5
(TDC SENSOR 2) C30 CMPB
(TDC2) INJ5 B3
No. 6
C8 CKP INJ6 B6
CKP SENSOR
C9 CKP
IACV B23
(contd)
11-19
03/07/29 09:17:56 61S0X050_110_0020
To IMMOBILIZER CONTROL
IMOCD E2 UNIT-RECEIVER
IMOEN E12 To IMMOBILIZER CONTROL
UNIT-RECEIVER
TP C28 VCC2
SENSOR To DRIVERS MULTIPLEX
C27 TPS ILU A28 CONTROL UNIT
C18 SG2
To GAUGE
EGR ASSEMBLY
VALVE
POSITION NEP A19 TEST TACHOMETER
SENSOR C6 EGRP
CONNECTOR
B7 EGR CCS A5 To CRUISE
CONTROL UNIT
EGR
VALVE
ECTOUT A31 To COOLANT
TEMPERATURE
FTP
SENSOR E
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VALVE
A29 FTP PCS A6
G ENGINE MOUNT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
C19 VCC1 MCS A2
A26 PSPSW
ATF To
TEMPERATURE IGPLS1 C4 SPARK
SENSOR ICM PLUG
A C24 ATFT IGPLS2 C14
No. 1 IGNITION COIL
IGPLS3 C3
BRAKE PEDAL To
POSITION SWITCH IGPLS4 C13 SPARK
ICM PLUG
A32 BKSW IGPLS5 C12
C VTEC
OIL PRESSURE IGPLS6 C23 No. 2 IGNITION COIL
SWITCH
C10 VTPSW To
SPARK
ICM PLUG
E C
No. 3 IGNITION COIL
To
SPARK
PRIMARY C1 PO2SHTC ICM PLUG
HO2S
(SENSOR 1)
C16 PHO2S No. 4 IGNITION COIL
To
SPARK
ICM PLUG
11-20
03/07/29 09:17:56 61S0X050_110_0021
*1 ATSFTP E17
*1 VREF E6
1
ABS/TCS
* TPSOUT E5 CONTROL
UNIT *1
1
* PFINH E7
From
FUEL GAUGE E15 FLS05 *2 *1 FPTDR E16
SENDING UNIT,
GAUGE ASSEMBLY
4TH CLUTCH PRESSURE SWITCH
OP4SW B19
OP3SW D13
D
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID VALVE
LC D1
GAUGE SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE A
ASSEMBLY SHA D7
D6 ATPR LSAB17
P
LSAB8
R A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
D9 ATPD5 CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE A
D5 D8 ATPD3 LSBB25
TRANSMISSION LSCB24
RANGE A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
SWITCH CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE C
NM D11
INPUT SHAFT
NMSG D12 (MAINSHAFT)
SPEED SENSOR
NC D10 B
NCSG D16
OUTPUT SHAFT
(COUNTERSHAFT)
SPEED SENSOR
*1: with ABS/TCS
*2: 03-04 models
TERMINAL LOCATIONS
(contd)
11-21
03/07/29 09:17:57 61S0X050_110_0022
11-22
03/07/29 09:17:57 61S0X050_110_0023
(contd)
11-23
03/07/29 09:17:58 61S0X050_110_0024
11-24
03/07/29 09:17:59 61S0X050_110_0025
(contd)
11-25
03/07/29 09:17:59 61S0X050_110_0026
11-26
03/07/29 09:17:59 61S0X050_110_0027
(contd)
11-27
03/07/29 09:18:00 61S0X050_110_0028
11-28
03/07/29 09:18:00 61S0X050_110_0029
(contd)
11-29
03/07/29 09:18:01 61S0X050_110_0030
11-30
03/07/29 09:18:01 61S0X050_110_0031
(contd)
11-31
03/07/29 09:18:02 61S0X050_110_0032
11-32
03/07/29 09:18:02 61S0X050_110_0033
(contd)
11-33
03/07/29 09:18:03 61S0X050_110_0034
11-34
03/07/29 09:18:03 61S0X050_110_0035
(contd)
11-35
03/07/29 09:18:04 61S0X050_110_0036
11-36
03/07/29 09:18:05 61S0X050_110_0037
(contd)
11-37
03/07/29 09:18:05 61S0X050_110_0038
11-38
03/07/29 09:18:05 61S0X050_110_0039
(contd)
11-39
03/07/29 09:18:06 61S0X050_110_0040
MANIFOLD
ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
(MAP)
SENSOR
To ENGINE
MOUNT
CONTROL To EVAPORATIVE
SOLENOID VALVE EMISSION (EVAP)
CONTROL
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CANISTER
(EVAP) CANISTER
PURGE VALVE
EVAPORATIVE
EMISSION
LEAK CHECK PORT
FRONT OF
VEHICLE
11-40
03/07/29 09:18:06 61S0X050_110_0041
MANIFOLD
ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
(MAP) SENSOR
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION
(EVAP) CANISTER To EVAPORATIVE
PURGE VALVE EMISSION (EVAP)
CONTROL
CANISTER
To ENGINE
MOUNT
CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE
FRONT OF
VEHICLE
(contd)
11-41
03/07/29 09:18:07 61S0X050_110_0042
31
25
12 29
11
15 14
26
30 20
To 27
ENGINE
28
13
MOUNT
23
10 24
3
16
9
18 17
6 8
ENGINE
7
21
COOLANT
19
5
2
1
22
PRIMARY HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) VALVE and
(PRIMARY HO2S) (SENSOR 1) LIFT SENSOR
SECONDARY HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION (PCV) VALVE
(SECONDARY HO2S) (SENSOR 2) THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CANISTER
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL
KNOCK SENSOR (KS) CANISTER FILTER
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) PURGE CONTROL
FUEL INJECTION AIR (FIA) CONTROL VALVE SOLENOID VALVE
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CANISTER
THROTTLE BODY (TB) VENT SHUT VALVE
INJECTOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) TWO WAY VALVE
FUEL PULSATION DAMPER EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) BYPASS
FUEL FILTER SOLENOID VALVE
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR FUEL TANK PRESSURE (FTP) SENSOR
FUEL PUMP (FP) ENGINE MOUNT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
FUEL TANK FUEL TANK EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) VALVE
AIR CLEANER
AIR TEMPERATURE CONTROL VALVE
AIR VALVE
RESONATOR
11-42
03/07/29 09:18:08 61S0X050_110_0043
32
33
25
31
29
11
12
26
27
15 14 28
13 30
20
To
ENGINE 23
MOUNT
10 24
16
9
18 17
6 8
ENGINE
7 COOLANT
21
19
5
1 2
22
PRIMARY HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (PRIMARY EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) VALVE and
HO2S) (SENSOR 1) POSITION SENSOR
SECONDARY HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION (PCV) VALVE
(SECONDARY HO2S) (SENSOR 2) THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CANISTER
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL
KNOCK SENSOR (KS) CANISTER FILTER
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CANISTER PURGE
INTAKE AIR BYPASS CONTROL THERMAL VALVE VALVE
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP)
THROTTLE BODY (TB) CANISTER VENT SHUT VALVE
INJECTOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) TWO WAY VALVE
FUEL PULSATION DAMPER EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) BYPASS
FUEL FILTER SOLENOID VALVE
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR FUEL TANK PRESSURE (FTP) SENSOR
FUEL PUMP (FP) ENGINE MOUNT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
FUEL TANK FUEL TANK EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) VALVE
AIR CLEANER FUEL TANK VAPOR CONTROL VALVE
AIR TEMPERATURE CONTROL VALVE FUEL TANK VAPOR RECIRCULATION VALVE
AIR VALVE
RESONATOR
(contd)
11-43
03/07/29 09:18:10 61S0X050_110_0044
30
31
23
29
27
11
12
24
25
15 14 26
13 28
18
To
ENGINE 21 22
MOUNT
10
16
6 8
ENGINE
COOLANT
7
19
17
5
1 2
20
PRIMARY HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (PRIMARY EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) VALVE and
HO2S) (SENSOR 1) POSITION SENSOR
SECONDARY HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION (PCV) VALVE
(SECONDARY HO2S) (SENSOR 2) THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CANISTER
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CONTROL
KNOCK SENSOR (KS) CANISTER FILTER
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CANISTER PURGE
INTAKE AIR BYPASS CONTROL THERMAL VALVE VALVE
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP)
THROTTLE BODY (TB) CANISTER VENT SHUT VALVE
INJECTOR EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) TWO WAY VALVE
FUEL PULSATION DAMPER EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) BYPASS
FUEL FILTER SOLENOID VALVE
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR FUEL TANK PRESSURE (FTP) SENSOR
FUEL PUMP (FP) ENGINE MOUNT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
FUEL TANK FUEL TANK EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) VALVE
AIR CLEANER FUEL TANK VAPOR CONTROL VALVE
RESONATOR FUEL TANK VAPOR RECIRCULATION VALVE
11-44
03/07/29 09:18:10 61S0X050_110_0045
A/C Switch
The A/C (air conditioning) switch signals the PCM
whenever there is a demand for cooling.
Alternator Control
The alternator signals the PCM during charging. The
PCM then controls the voltage generated by the
alternator according to the electrical load determined
by the Electrical Load Detector (ELD) and driving mode. Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
This reduces engine load to improve fuel economy. The ECT sensor is a temperature dependent resistor
(thermistor). The resistance of the thermistor decreases
Barometric Pressure (BARO) Sensor as the engine coolant temperature increases.
The BARO sensor is inside the PCM. It converts
atmospheric pressure into a voltage signal that
modifies the basic duration of the fuel injection
discharge.
(contd)
11-45
03/07/29 09:18:11 61S0X050_110_0046
THERMISTOR
Knock Sensor
The knock control system adjusts the ignition timing for
the octane rating of the gasoline used.
01-04 Models
PIEZO CERAMIC
SENSOR UNIT
DIAPHRAGM
TERMINAL
11-46
03/07/29 09:18:12 61S0X050_110_0047
Primary Heated Oxygen Sensors (Primary HO2S) Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
The primary HO2S detects the oxygen content in the The TP sensor is a potentiometer connected to the
exhaust gas and sends signals to the PCM which varies throttle valve shaft. As the throttle position changes, the
the duration of fuel injection accordingly. To stabilize its sensor varies the signal voltage to the PCM. The TP
output, the sensor has an internal heater. The primary sensor is not available separately from the throttle body.
HO2S is installed in the exhaust pipe. BRUSH HOLDER
By controlling the air fuel ratio with primary HO2S and
secondary HO2S, the deterioration of the primary HO2S
can be evaluated by its feedback period. When the BRUSH
feedback period exceeds a certain value during stable
driving conditions, the sensor is considered
RESISTOR
deteriorated and the PCM sets a DTC.
HEATER
When the engine is cold, the A/C compressor is on, the
HEATER transmission is in gear, the brake pedal is pressed, the
TERMINALS
power steering load is high, or the alternator is
charging, the PCM controls current to the IAC valve to
Secondary Heated Oxygen Sensors (Secondary HO2S) maintain the correct idle speed. Refer to the System
The secondary HO2S detects the oxygen content in the Diagram to see a functional layout of the system.
exhaust gas downstream of the three way catalytic
converter (TWC) and sends signals to the PCM which Brake Pedal Position Switch
varies the duration of fuel injection accordingly. To The BPP switch signals the PCM when the brake pedal
stabilize its output, the sensor has an internal heater. is pressed.
The secondary HO2S is installed in the TWC.
Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve
ZIRCONIA SENSOR To maintain proper idle speed, the IAC valve changes
ELEMENT TERMINALS the amount of air bypassing the throttle body in
response to an electrical signal from the PCM.
From AIR To INTAKE
CLEANER MANIFOLD
HEATER HEATER
TERMINALS
Starting Control
When the engine is started, the PCM provides a rich VALVE
mixture by increasing fuel injector duration.
(contd)
11-47
03/07/29 09:18:13 61S0X050_110_0048
03-04 models
To GAUGE
ASSEMBLY
YEL/BLU
AIR VALVE
BLK
FUEL TANK
FUEL GAUGE SENDING UNIT
11-48
03/07/29 09:18:14 61S0X050_110_0049
FRONT
OF
To FUEL VEHICLE
To INJECTORS
INJECTORS INTAKE AIR
From BYPASS
AIR CONTROL
CLEANER THERMAL
VALVE THREE WAY
CATALYSTS
VALVE
: INTAKE
AIR Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) System
Throttle Body Refer to the System Diagram to see a functional layout
The throttle body is a single-barrel side draft type. The of the system.
lower portion of the throttle valve is heated by engine
coolant from the cylinder head. The idle adjusting EGR Valve
screw, which increases/decreases bypass air, is on top The EGR valve is designed to lower peak combustion
of the throttle body. temperatures and reduce oxides of nitrogen emissions
(NOx) by recirculating exhaust gas through the intake
IDLE ADJUSTING THROTTLE
POSITION (TP) manifold and into the combusition chambers.
SCREW
SENSOR
Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) System
The PCV valve prevents blow-by gasses from escaping
into the atmosphere by venting them into the intake
manifold.
INTAKE
MANIFOLD
BREATHER
PIPE
PCV
HOSE
PCV
VALVE
: BLOW-BY VAPOR
: FRESH AIR
(contd)
11-49
03/07/29 09:18:15 61S0X050_110_0050
To EVAP
CANISTER
VALVE DIAPHRAGM
VALVE
EVAP TWO WAY
VALVE
11-50
03/07/29 09:19:21 61S0X050_110_0051
After the engine starts, the IAC valve opens for a certain amount of time. The amount of air is increased to raise the
idle speed.
When the engine coolant temperature is low, the IAC valve is opened to obtain the proper fast idle speed. The
amount of bypassed air is thus controlled in relation to engine coolant temperature.
INTAKE
MANIFOLD IAC VALVE
ENGINE
COOLANT
From
YEL/ PGM-FI
BLK MAIN
RELAY
BLK
BLK/ VARIOUS
PCM SENSORS
RED
INTAKE AIR
BYPASS CONTROL
THERMAL VALVE BLK
(contd)
11-51
03/07/29 09:19:22 61S0X050_110_0052
The EGR valve position sensor detects the amount of EGR valve lift and sends it to the PCM. The PCM then compares it
with the ideal lift in its memory (based on signals sent from other sensors). If there is any difference between the two,
the PCM cuts current to the EGR valve.
EGR VALVE
POSITION YEL/
SENSOR BLU
1
GRN/ *
BLK
WHT/ VARIOUS
PCM SENSORS
BLK
*2
BLK PNK
EGR
VALVE
INTAKE
MANIFOLD
11-52
03/07/29 09:19:23 61S0X050_110_0053
The EVAP control canister is purged by drawing fresh air through it and into a port on the throttle body. The purging
vacuum is controlled by the EVAP purge control solenoid valve, which operates whenever engine coolant
temperature is above 147F (64C).
When vapor pressure in the fuel tank is higher than the set value of the EVAP two way valve, the valve opens and
regulates the flow of fuel vapor to the EVAP control canister.
LT GRN/
WHT VARIOUS
PCM SENSORS
FUEL TANK
RED/
YEL
BLK
(contd)
11-53
03/07/29 09:19:23 61S0X050_110_0054
The EVAP canister is purged by drawing fresh air through it and into a port on the intake manifold. The purging
vacuum is controlled by the EVAP canister purge valve, which operates whenever engine coolant temperature is
above 147F (64C).
When vapor pressure in the fuel tank is higher than the set value of the EVAP two way valve, the valve opens and
regulates the flow of fuel vapor to the EVAP control canister.
During refueling, the fuel tank vapor control valve opens with the pressure in the fuel tank, and feeds the fuel vapor
to the EVAP control canister.
01 model:
EVAP CANISTER
FUEL TANK VAPOR VENT SHUT from
VENT TUBE VALVE No.6 ECU
FUEL TANK VAPOR (PCM)
SIGNAL TUBE CRUISE
FTP SENSOR BLK/YEL CONTROL
FUEL TANK VAPOR FUEL TANK VAPOR (15A)
RECIRCULATION CONTROL VALVE EVAP YEL/BLU (in the drivers
TUBE TWO WAY LT GRN under-dash
VALVE GRN/BLK fuse/relay box)
BLU
VARIOUS
PCM SENSORS
LT GRN/WHT
RED/YEL
FUEL
FILL BLK
CAP
FUEL TANK VAPOR
RECIRCULATION FUEL TANK
EVAP BYPASS
VALVE SOLENOID VALVE
EVAP CANISTER
PURGE VALVE
EVAP CONTROL
CANISTER
FILTER
EVAP CONTROL
CANISTER
11-54
03/07/29 09:19:24 61S0X050_110_0055
02-04 models:
PCM VARIOUS
SENSORS
LT GRN/WHT
RED/YEL
FUEL BLK
FILL
CAP
FUEL TANK VAPOR FUEL TANK
RECIRCULATION EVAP BYPASS
VALVE SOLENOID VALVE
EVAP CANISTER
PURGE VALVE
EVAP CANISTER
FILTER
EVAP CANISTER
(contd)
11-55
03/07/29 09:19:24 61S0X050_110_0056
VCC1
C19 YEL/RED
MAP
C17 RED/GRN MAP SENSOR
SG1
C7 GRN/WHT1
ECT
C26 RED/WHT RED/WHT
GRN/BLK2
ECT SENSOR
To CLIMATE
CONTROL UNIT
IAT (EX model)
C25 RED/YEL2
GRN/BLK2
IAT SENSOR
VCC2
C28 YEL/BLU YEL/BLU
TPS GRN/BLK2
C27 RED/BLK2 TP SENSOR
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR D
EGRP
C6 WHT/BLK
EGR VALVE
POSITION
SENSOR
YEL/BLU
WHT/BLK
GRN/BLK2
EGR
B7 PNK2
BLK2
YEL/
BLU EGR VALVE
A B
JUNCTION
SG2 CONNECTOR D
C18 GRN/BLK2
C AC
11-56
03/07/29 09:19:25 61S0X050_110_0057
AC
PHO2S
C16 WHT3
GRN/BLK2
PO2SHTC BLK/YEL
2
C1 BLK/WHT
PRIMARY
HO2S (SENSOR 1)
VBSOL JUNCTION
D5 BLK/YEL CONNECTOR D
BLK/YEL
C101
VTSOL
B12 GRN/YEL
BLK/
YEL VTEC
SOLENOID
VALVE
D
VTPSW
C10 BLU/BLK1
BRN/BLK1
VTEC OIL
LG2 PRESSURE
B22 BRN/BLK2 SWITCH
E
LG1
B20 BRN/BLK1
PG1 JUNCTION
B2 BLK1 CONNECTOR B
PG2
B10 BLK2
W F B
G101
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR C
G H
TDC1
C20 GRN3
TDC
TDC1 SENSOR 1
C21 RED6
TDC2
C29 YEL3
TDC
TDC2 SENSOR 2
C30 BLK3
CKP
C8 BLU6
CKP
CKP SENSOR
C9 WHT2
(contd)
11-57
03/07/29 09:19:26 61S0X050_110_0058
ALTC
C2 WHT/GRN
ALTF
C5 WHT/RED5
ALT
VSSOUT To GAUGE
A9 BLU/WHT1
ASSEMBLY
LOCKUP CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE
LC
D1 YEL4
SHA
D7 BLU/YEL
SHIFT CONTROL
G SOLENOID VALVE A
SHB
D2 GRN/WHT3
BLK2
SHIFT CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE B
SHC
D3 GRN4
BLK2
SHIFT CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE C
NM
D11 RED7
NMSG
D12 WHT5
INPUT SAHFT
(MAINSHAFT)
SPEED SENSOR
NC
D10 BLU7
NCSG
D16 GRN5
OUTPUT SAHFT
(COUNTERSHAFT)
SPEED SENSOR
LSA
B17 RED4
LSA
B8 WHT1
A/T CLUTCH
PRESSURE CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE A
LSB
B25 ORN
LSB
B18 GRN2
A/T CLUTCH
PRESSURE CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE B
11-58
03/07/29 09:19:26 61S0X050_110_0059
YEL/BLK1
INJ1 2
B11 BRN
No.1 INJECTOR
1
YEL/BLK
INJ2
B5 RED3
No.2 INJECTOR
YEL/BLK1
INJ3
B15 BLU4
No.3 INJECTOR
1
YEL/BLK
INJ4
B4 YEL1
No.4 INJECTOR
YEL/BLK1
INJ5
B3 BLK/RED1
No.5 INJECTOR
1
YEL/BLK
INJ6
B6 WHT/BLU
No.6 INJECTOR
YEL/BLK1
IACV
B23 BLK/BLU
BLK2
IAC VALVE
IGP1 JUNCTION
B1 YEL/BLK1 CONNECTOR A
IGP2
B9 YEL/BLK2
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR C
(contd)
11-59
03/07/29 09:19:27 61S0X050_110_0060
C203
SHO2S
A23 WHT/RED2 WHT/RED3
GRN/BLK2
SO2SHTC BLK/YEL
A8 BLK/WHT3 BLK/WHT1
SECONDARY
HO2S
L M N (SENSOR 2)
C303 BLK/YEL
MCS
A2 GRN/WHT 1
GRN/WHT1
ENGINE MOUNT
O CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE
PCS
A6 RED/YEL1 RED/YEL1
BLK/YEL
EVAP CANISTER
PURGE VALVE
CCS
A5 BLU/GRN
CRUISE
D CONTROL UNIT
IMOIND
A12 PNK1
WHT/YEL
IMMOBILIZER
INDICATOR
P
NEP To
A19 BLU3 TACHOMETER
GAUGE ASSEMBLY
C303
TEST
BLU3 TACHOMETER
CONNECTOR
BLU3
AA
ILU
A28 WHT/RED3
DRIVERS
MULTIPLEX
CONTROL UNIT
C203
PSPSW 2
A26 GRN GRN1
BLK
PSP SWITCH
G201
FANC From
A20 BLU/RED RADIATOR FAN RELAY,
RADIATOR FAN SWITCH
11-60
03/07/29 09:19:27 61S0X050_110_0061
OP2SW
D13 BLU/BLK2
2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE SWITCH
C151
OP3SW
B24 WHT/RED4
3RD CLUTCH
IMOCD PRESSURE SWITCH
A25 RED2
To IMMOBILIZER UNIT
IMOEN
A13 BLU2
MIL MIL
A18 GRN/ORN
YEL
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR D
J
D4IND
A14 GRN/BLK1
K
BLK/BLU P
C402
WHT4 R
PNK3 PNK3 D3
BLU3 BLU3 2
BRN3 BRN3 1
C102 C303
GAUGE ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR K
ATPR BLU/BLK
D6 WHT4 C301
WHT4 DRIVERS
UNDER-DASH
C102 CONNECTOR E FUSE/RELAY
WHT4 BOX
ATPD4
D9 YEL5
BLU/BLK
ATPD3 BLU/WHT2
D8 PNK3
BLU/BLK P
R
RED/BLK N
ATP2
D14 BLU6 D4
D3
2
ATP1
D15 BRN3 1
A/T GEAR
POSITION SWITCH
(contd)
11-61
03/07/29 09:19:28 61S0X050_110_0062
C501
VSV
A4 LT GRN/WHT LT GRN/WHT
BLK/YEL
EVAP CANISTER
VENT SHUT VALVE
YEL/BLU
FTP
A29 LT GRN2 LT GRN2
GRN/BLK2
2WBS
A3 BLU1 FTP SENSOR
BLU1
C101
VBU BLK/YEL
DTC 5V B21 WHT/YEL
EVAP BYPASS
SOLENOID VALVE
M J K D C A DRIVERS UNDER-DASH
CONNECTOR B FUSE/RELAY BOX
CPU
BLK/YEL
GRN/ BLU/ GRN/
BLK2 WHT2 BLK2 GRN/BLK2
YEL/
BLU YEL/BLU
CONNECTOR E
A
BLK/YEL
C102 C101
YEL/BLU
GRN/BLK2
BLK/YEL
BLU/WHT2
WHT/YEL
CONNECTOR I
GRN/BLK2
B
YEL
K-LINE C
A21 GRY BLK/YEL
X R Z
SCS CONNECTOR K
A10 BRN1
STSW D
A24 BLU/ORN
BKSW
A32 WHT/BLK
Y
STARTER
CUT
RELAY
CONNECTOR M
IG1
IGNITION ST
SWITCH
B
E
FUSES
A:No. 11 IG COIL (15A)
B:No. 9 BACK UP LIGHT
INSTRUMENT LIGHT (7.5A)
C:No. 6 ECU (PCM)
CRUISE CONTROL (15A)
D:No. 13 STARTER SIGNAL (7.5A)
E:No. 1 FUEL PUMP (15A)
11-62
03/07/29 09:19:29 61S0X050_110_0063
CONNECTOR Q
BLU/ORN
CONNECTOR O
RED/WHT
BLK/YEL
WHT/BLK1
WHT/YEL
C201 CONNECTOR P
WHT
WHT CONNECTOR A
BLK/YEL
Y X DRIVERS UNDER-DASH
FUSE/RELAY BOX
U Q
From
SRS UNIT
GRY
LT BLU
BRN1
DATA LINK
BRN/BLK1 CONNECTOR
WHT/GRN
BLK
T AB
G501
WHT/ WHT/BLK1
GRN WHT/YEL
C203
BRAKE SWITCH
C202
S
WHT/
GRN
F W I C553
BLK/YEL BLK/YEL
P
BLK
BLK
FUEL PUMP
C102 C101 WHT/GRN
C301
YEL/BLK1 YEL/BLK1 G552
1
BLK BLK1
BRN/BLK1 BRN/BLK1
V
RED/WHT
C402
IMOFPR BLU/ORN
A15 GRN/YEL1 GRN/YEL1
BLK/YEL
PGM-FI
MAIN RELAY
(contd)
11-63
03/07/29 09:19:29 61S0X050_110_0064
N O
CONNECTOR C
BLK/YEL
BLK/YEL
E
YEL
BRN/BLK1
To A/C BLU/RED2
PRESSURE SWITCH
P L AB
ACS
A27 BLU/RED2 CONNECTOR H
BRN/BLK1
WHT/YEL
V U R BLU/RED2
CONNECTOR I
BLK/YEL
CONNECTOR J
WHT/YEL
BRN/BLK1
PASSENGERS UNDER-DASH
FUSE/RELAY BOX
S Q T
CONNECTOR B F
WHT
CONNECTOR D G
WHT/GRN
C201 CONNECTOR C
H
WHT/YEL WHT/YEL
I
YEL
ELD J
C203 BLK/YEL
ELD
A30 GRN/RED GRN/RED
BLK
CONNECTOR A
ACC 1 To A/C
A17 RED RED1 CLUTCH RELAY
UNDER-HOOD
G201 FUSE/RELAY BOX
FUSES
E:No. 13 CLOCK BACK UP (7.5A) BATTERY
F:IG MAIN (50A)
G:ACGS (15A)
H:STOP (20A)
I:BACK UP ACC (30A)
J:BATTERY (120A)
G1
11-64
03/07/29 09:19:30 61S0X050_110_0065
BLK/YEL
IGPLS1
C4 YEL/GRN To
ICM SPARK
BLK1 PLUG
No. 1 IGNITION COIL
BLK/YEL
IGPLS2
C14 RED5 To
ICM SPARK
BLK1 PLUG
No. 2 IGNITION COIL
BLK/YEL
IGPLS3
C3 BLU5 To
ICM SPARK
BLK1 PLUG
No. 3 IGNITION COIL
BLK/YEL
IGPLS4
C13 YEL2 To
ICM SPARK
BLK1 PLUG
No. 4 IGNITION COIL
BLK/YEL
IGPLS5
C12 BLK/RED2 To
ICM SPARK
BLK1 PLUG
No. 5 IGNITION COIL
BLK/YEL
IGPLS6
C23 WHT/BLU To
ICM SPARK
BLK1 PLUG
No. 6 IGNITION COIL
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR B
BLK1
G101
Z JUNCTION
CONNECTOR B
C101
BLK/YEL BLK/YEL
C103
KS
C22 RED/BLU RED/BLU
KS
(contd)
11-65
03/07/29 09:19:30 61S0X050_110_0066
C302
ATSFTP *
A11 LT GRN1 LT GRN1
VREF *
A7 WHT/RED1 ORN/WHT
TPSOUT *
A31 RED/BLK1 RED/BLU
C504
PFINH *
E3 LT GRN/RED LT GRN/RED BLU3
FPTDR *
E1 PNK/BLK PNK/BLK PNK4
AA BLU3
* : with ABS/TCS
11-66
03/07/29 09:19:31 61S0X050_110_0067
VCC1
A31 YEL/RED
MAP
A27 RED/GRN MAP SENSOR
SG1
A29 GRN/WHT JUNCTION
CONNECTOR D
ECT
A13 RED/WHT RED/WHT
GRN/BLK
ECT SENSOR
To CLIMATE
CONTROL UNIT
IAT (EX model)
A14 RED/YEL
GRN/BLK
IAT SENSOR
VCC2
A30 YEL/BLU YEL/BLU
TPS GRN/BLK
A15 RED/BLK TP SENSOR
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR D
EGRP
A16 WHT/BLK
EGR VALVE
POSITION
SENSOR
YEL/BLU
WHT/BLK
GRN/BLK
EGR
B3 PNK
BLK
EGR VALVE
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR D
SG2
A28 GRN/BLK
GRN/
BLK
AC
(contd)
11-67
03/07/29 09:19:31 61S0X050_110_0068
AC
PHO2S
A6 WHT
GRN/BLK
PO2SHTC BLK/YEL
B5 BLK/WHT
PRIMARY
HO2S (SENSOR 1)
VBSOL JUNCTION
B24 BLK/YEL CONNECTOR B
BLK/YEL
C101
VTSOL
B2 GRN/YEL
BLK/
YEL VTEC
SOLENOID
VALVE
A
VTPSW
A20 BLU/BLK
BRN/BLK
VTEC OIL
LG2 PRESSURE
A25 BRN/BLK SWITCH
E
LG1
A26 BRN/BLK
PG1 JUNCTION
A5 BLK CONNECTOR B
PG2
A4 BLK
W F B
G101
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR C
G H
TDC1
A11 GRN
TDC
TDC1 SENSOR 1
A23 RED
TDC2
A10 YEL
TDC
TDC2 SENSOR 2
A22 BLK
CKP
A12 BLU
CKP
CKP SENSOR
A24 WHT
11-68
03/07/29 09:19:32 61S0X050_110_0069
ALTC
B6 WHT/GRN
ALTF
A19 WHT/RED
ALT
VSSOUT To GAUGE
E26 BLU/WHT
ASSEMBLY
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID VALVE
LC
C10 YEL
SHA
C2 BLU/YEL
SHIFT CONTROL
G SOLENOID VALVE A
SHB
C9 GRN/WHT
BLK
SHIFT CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE B
SHC
C17 GRN
BLK
SHIFT CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE C
NM
C7 RED
NMSG
C6 WHT
INPUT SAHFT
(MAINSHAFT)
SPEED SENSOR
NC
C15 BLU
NCSG
C14 GRN
OUTPUT SAHFT
(COUNTERSHAFT)
SPEED SENSOR
LSA
B7 RED
LSA
C1 WHT
A/T CLUTCH
PRESSURE CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE A
LSB
B16 ORN
LSB
C8 GRN
A/T CLUTCH
PRESSURE CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE B
(contd)
11-69
03/07/29 09:19:32 61S0X050_110_0070
YEL/BLK
INJ1
B14 BRN
No.1 INJECTOR
YEL/BLK
INJ2
B13 RED
No.2 INJECTOR
YEL/BLK
INJ3
B12 BLU
No.3 INJECTOR
YEL/BLK
INJ4
B22 YEL
No.4 INJECTOR
YEL/BLK
INJ5
B21 BLK/RED
No.5 INJECTOR
YEL/BLK
INJ6
B20 WHT/BLU
No.6 INJECTOR
YEL/BLK
IACV
B23 BLK/BLU
BLK
IAC VALVE
IGP1 JUNCTION
A3 YEL/BLK CONNECTOR A
IGP2
A2 YEL/BLK
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR C
11-70
03/07/29 09:19:33 61S0X050_110_0071
C203
SHO2S
E18 WHT/RED WHT/RED
GRN/BLK
SO2SHTC BLK/YEL
E2 BLK/WHT BLK/WHT
SECONDARY
HO2S
L M N (SENSOR 2)
C203
BLK/YEL
MCS
E24 GRN/WHT GRN/WHT
ENGINE MOUNT
O C CONTROL
C303 SOLENOID VALVE
PCS
E11 RED/YEL RED/YEL
BLK/YEL
EVAP CANISTER
PURGE VALVE
CCS
E17 BLU/GRN
CRUISE
D CONTROL UNIT
IMOIND
E29 PNK
WHT/YEL
IMMOBILIZER
INDICATOR
P
NEP To
E3 BLU TACHOMETER
GAUGE ASSEMBLY
C303
TEST
BLU TACHOMETER
CONNECTOR
BLU
AA
ILU
E15 WHT/RED
DRIVERS
MULTIPLEX
CONTROL UNIT
C203
PSPSW
E20 GRN GRN
BLK
PSP SWITCH
G201
FANC From
E13 BLU/RED RADIATOR FAN RELAY,
RADIATOR FAN SWITCH
(contd)
11-71
03/07/29 09:19:34 61S0X050_110_0072
OP2SW
C11 BLU/BLK
2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE SWITCH
C151
OP3SW
C19 WHT/RED
3RD CLUTCH
IMOCD PRESSURE SWITCH
E31 RED
To IMMOBILIZER
CONTROL
IMOEN UNIT-RECEIVER
E30 BLU
MIL MIL
E4 GRN/ORN
YEL
BLU/WHT JUNCTION
CONNECTOR B
J
D4IND
E5 GRN/BLK
K
BLK/BLU P
C402
WHT R
PNK PNK D3
JUNCTION PNK
CONNECTOR C BLU BLU BLU 2
BLU/WHT
ATP2 BLK/BLU P
C12 BLU
WHT R
RED/BLK N
ATP1 YEL D4
C20 BRN
PNK D3
BLU 2
BLU BRN 1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR C TRANSMISSION RANGE
SWITCH
BRN JUNCTION
WHT CONNECTOR C
11-72
03/07/29 09:19:34 61S0X050_110_0073
C501
VSV
E22 LT GRN/WHT LT GRN/WHT
BLK/YEL
EVAP CANISTER
VENT SHUT VALVE
YEL/BLU
FTP
E28 LT GRN LT GRN
GRN/BLK
2WBS
E23 BLU FTP SENSOR
BLU
C101
VBU BLK/YEL
DTC 5V A1 WHT/YEL
EVAP BYPASS
SOLENOID VALVE
M J K A D DRIVERS UNDER-DASH
CPU CONNECTOR B FUSE/RELAY BOX
BLK/YEL
GRN/ BLU/
BLK WHT GRN/BLK
WHT/
YEL YEL/BLU
YEL CONNECTOR E
A
BLK/YEL
C102
BLK/YEL
E6
E7 GRN/BLK BLU/WHT
WHT/YEL
CONNECTOR I
GRN/BLK
B
YEL
K-LINE
E27 GRY YEL/BLU
C
BLK/YEL
X R Z
SCS CONNECTOR K
E16 BRN
STSW D
E8 BLU/ORN
BKSW
E9 WHT/BLK
Y
STARTER
CUT
RELAY
CONNECTOR M
IG1
IGNITION ST
SWITCH
B
E
FUSES
A:No. 7 IG COIL (15A)
B:No. 9 BACK UP LIGHT
INSTRUMENT LIGHT (10A)
C:No. 6 ECU (PCM)
CRUISE CONTROL (15A)
D:No. 13 STARTER SIGNAL (7.5A)
E:No. 1 FUEL PUMP (15A)
(contd)
11-73
03/07/29 09:19:35 61S0X050_110_0074
CONNECTOR Q
BLU/ORN
CONNECTOR O
RED/WHT
BLK/YEL
WHT/BLK1
WHT/YEL
C201 CONNECTOR P
WHT
WHT CONNECTOR A
BLK/YEL
Y X DRIVERS UNDER-DASH
FUSE/RELAY BOX
U Q
From
SRS UNIT
GRY
LT BLU
BRN
DATA LINK
BRN/BLK CONNECTOR
WHT/GRN
BLK
T AB
G501
WHT/BLK1
WHT/YEL
BRAKE PEDAL
POSITION SWITCH
C401
S
WHT/
GRN
F W I C553
BLK/YEL BLK/YEL
P
BLK
BLK
FUEL PUMP
C102 C101 WHT/GRN
C301
YEL/BLK YEL/BLK G552
BLK BLK
BRN/BLK BRN/BLK
V
RED/WHT
C402
IMOFPR BLU/ORN
E1 GRN/YEL GRN/YEL
BLK/YEL
PGM-FI
MAIN RELAY
11-74
03/07/29 09:19:36 61S0X050_110_0075
N C O
CONNECTOR C
BLK/YEL
BLK/YEL
E
YEL
BRN/BLK
To A/C BLU/RED
PRESSURE SWITCH
P L AB
ACS
E21 BLU/RED CONNECTOR H
BRN/BLK
WHT/YEL
V U R BLU/RED
CONNECTOR I
BLK/YEL
CONNECTOR J
WHT/YEL
BRN/BLK
PASSENGERS UNDER-DASH
FUSE/RELAY BOX
S Q WHT/
GRN
C202
CONNECTOR B F
WHT
CONNECTOR D G
WHT/GRN
C201 CONNECTOR C
H
WHT/YEL WHT/YEL
I
YEL
ELD J
C203 BLK/YEL
ELD
E19 GRN/RED GRN/RED
BLK
CONNECTOR A
ACC To A/C
E12 RED RED CLUTCH RELAY
UNDER-HOOD
G201 FUSE/RELAY BOX
FUSES
E:No. 13 CLOCK BACK UP (7.5A) BATTERY
F:IG MAIN (50A)
G:ACGS (15A)
H:STOP (20A)
I:BACK UP ACC (30A)
J:BATTERY (120A)
G1
(contd)
11-75
03/07/29 09:19:36 61S0X050_110_0076
BLK/YEL
IGPLS1
B10 YEL/GRN To
ICM SPARK
BLK PLUG
No. 1 IGNITION COIL
BLK/YEL
IGPLS2
B9 RED To
ICM SPARK
BLK PLUG
No. 2 IGNITION COIL
BLK/YEL
IGPLS3
B8 BLU To
ICM SPARK
BLK PLUG
No. 3 IGNITION COIL
BLK/YEL
IGPLS4
B19 YEL To
ICM SPARK
BLK PLUG
No. 4 IGNITION COIL
BLK/YEL
IGPLS5
B18 BLK/RED To
ICM SPARK
BLK PLUG
No. 5 IGNITION COIL
BLK/YEL
IGPLS6
B17 WHT/BLU To
ICM SPARK
BLK PLUG
No. 6 IGNITION COIL
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR B
BLK
G102 G101
Z JUNCTION
CONNECTOR B
C101
BLK/YEL BLK/YEL
C103
KS
A9 RED/BLU RED/BLU
KNOCK SENSOR
11-76
03/07/29 09:19:37 61S0X050_110_0077
C302
ATSFTP *
D11 LT GRN LT GRN
VREF *
D9 WHT/RED ORN/WHT
TPSOUT *
D16 RED/BLK RED/BLU
PFINH *
D5 LT GRN/RED BLU
FPTDR *
D3 PNK/BLK PNK
AA BLU
ECTOUT To COOLANT
E14 YEL/GRN TEMPERATURE
GAUGE ASSEMBLY
* : with ABS/TCS
(contd)
11-77
03/07/29 09:19:37 61S0X050_110_0078
VCC1
C19 YEL/RED YEL/RED
MAP
C17 GRN/RED MAP SENSOR
SG1
C7 GRN/WHT JUNCTION
YEL/RED CONNECTOR B
AD
ECT
C26 RED/WHT RED/WHT
GRN/YEL
ECT SENSOR
To CLIMATE
CONTROL UNIT
IAT
C25 RED/YEL
GRN/YEL
IAT SENSOR
VCC2
C28 YEL/BLU YEL/BLU
TPS GRN/YEL
C27 RED/BLK TP SENSOR
JUNCTION
EGRP CONNECTOR A
C6 WHT/BLK
EGR VALVE
POSITION
SENSOR
YEL/BLU
WHT/BLK
GRN/YEL
EGR
B7 BLU/RED
BLK
YEL/ YEL/
BLU BLU EGR VALVE
A G B
JUNCTION
SG2 CONNECTOR B
C18 GRN/YEL
GRN/
YEL
AG C AC
11-78
03/07/29 09:19:38 61S0X050_110_0079
AG
PHO2S
C16 WHT
GRN/YEL
PO2SHTC BLK/YEL
C1 BLK/WHT
PRIMARY
HO2S (SENSOR 1)
VBSOL
D5 BLK/YEL JUNCTION
BLK/YEL CONNECTOR B
C101
VTSOL
B12 GRN/YEL
BLK/ BLK/
YEL YEL VTEC
SOLENOID
VALVE
D AE
VTPSW
C10 BLU/BLK
BRN/YEL
VTEC
LG2 PRESSURE
B22 BRN/YEL SWITCH
E
LG1
B20 BRN/YEL
PG1
B2 BLK JUNCTION
CONNECTOR C
PG2
B10 BLK
F B
G101
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR B
W H
CMPA(TDC1)
C20 GRN
CMP SENSOR A
CMPA(TDC1) (TDC SENSOR 1)
C21 RED
CMPB(TDC2)
C29 YEL
CMP SENSOR B
CMPB(TDC2) (TDC SENSOR 2)
C30 BLK
CKP
C8 BLU
CKP
CKP SENSOR
C9 WHT
(contd)
11-79
03/07/29 09:19:38 61S0X050_110_0080
ALTC
C2 WHT/GRN
ALTF
C5 WHT/RED
ALT
VSSOUT To GAUGE
A9 BLU/WHT
ASSEMBLY
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
LC VALVE
D1 YEL
BLK
SHA
D7 BLU/YEL
BLK
SHIFT
SOLENOID VALVE A
SHB
D2 GRN/WHT
BLK
SHIFT
SOLENOID VALVE B
SHC
D3 GRN
BLK
SHIFT
SOLENOID VALVE C
BLK
BLK
BLK
BLK
C151
G151
LSA
B17 RED
LSA
B8 WHT A/T CLUTCH
PRESSURE CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE A
LSB
B25 BRN/WHT
LSB
B18 GRN A/T CLUTCH
PRESSURE CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE B
LSC
B13 GRN/RED
LSC
B24 RED/BLU A/T CLUTCH
PRESSURE CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE C
11-80
03/07/29 09:19:39 61S0X050_110_0081
YEL/BLK
INJ1
B11 BRN
No. 1 INJECTOR
YEL/BLK
INJ2
B5 RED
No. 2 INJECTOR
YEL/BLK
INJ3
B15 BLU
No. 3 INJECTOR
YEL/BLK
INJ4
B4 YEL
No. 4 INJECTOR
YEL/BLK
INJ5
B3 BLK/RED
No. 5 INJECTOR
YEL/BLK
INJ6
B6 WHT/BLU
No. 6 INJECTOR
H
YEL/BLK
IACV
B23 BLK/RED
BLK
IAC VALVE
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR A
IGP1
B1 YEL/BLK
IGP2
B9 YEL/BLK
I
AD G
YEL/BLU
NM
D11 RED
NMSG
D12 WHT
INPUT SHAFT (MAINSHAFT)
SPEED SENSOR
YEL/RED
NC
D10 BLU
NCSG
D16 GRN
OUTPUT SHAFT
(COUNTERSHAFT)
SPEED SENSOR
(contd)
11-81
03/07/29 09:19:39 61S0X050_110_0082
C203
SHO2S
A1 WHT/RED WHT/RED
GRN/BLK
SO2SHTC BLK/YEL
A8 BLK/WHT BLK/WHT
SECONDARY
HO2S
L M N (SENSOR 2)
C203 BLK/YEL
MCS
A2 GRN/WHT GRN/WHT
ENGINE MOUNT
O AF AE CONTROL
C302 C102 SOLENOID VALVE
PCS
A6 RED/YEL RED/YEL RED/YEL
BLK/YEL
EVAP CANISTER
PURGE VALVE
CCS
A5 BLU/GRN
CRUISE
CONTROL UNIT
C504
IMOIND
E1 PNK PNK
WHT/YEL
IMMOBILIZER
INDICATOR
P
NEP To
A19 BLU TACHOMETER
GAUGE ASSEMBLY
C302
TEST
BLU TACHOMETER
CONNECTOR
BLU
AA
ILU
A28 WHT/RED
DRIVERS
MULTIPLEX
CONTROL UNIT
C203
PSPSW
A26 GRN GRN
BLK
PSP SWITCH
G201
FANC From
A20 BLU/RED RADIATOR FAN RELAY,
RADIATOR FAN SWITCH
11-82
03/07/29 09:19:40 61S0X050_110_0083
OP4SW
B19 BLU/YEL
4TH CLUTCH
TRANSMISSION FLUID
C151 PRESSURE SWITCH
OP3SW
D13 BLU/WHT
3RD CLUTCH
IMOCD TRANSMISSION FLUID
E2 RED PRESSURE SWITCH
To IMMOBILIZER UNIT
IMOEN
E12 BLU
MIL MIL
A18 GRN/ORN
YEL
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR B
J
DIND
A14 GRN/BLK
K
BLU/BLK P
C402
WHT R
RED RED D3
JUNCTION RED
CONNECTOR C BLU BLU BLU 2
BLU/WHT
ATP2 BLU/BLK P
D14 BLU
WHT R
RED/BLK N
ATP1 YEL D5
D15 BRN
RED D3
BLU 2
BLU BRN 1
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR C TRANSMISSION RANGE
SWITCH
BRN JUNCTION
WHT CONNECTOR C
(contd)
11-83
03/07/29 09:19:41 61S0X050_110_0084
C501
VSV
A4 LT GRN/WHT LT GRN/WHT
BLK/YEL
EVAP CANISTER
VENT SHUT VALVE
YEL/BLU
FTP
A29 LT GRN LT GRN
GRN/BLK
2WBS
A3 BLU FTP SENSOR
BLU
C101
VBU BLK/YEL
DTC 5V B21 WHT/RED
EVAP BYPASS
SOLENOID VALVE
M J K D C A DRIVERS UNDER-DASH
CONNECTOR B FUSE/RELAY BOX
CPU
BLK/YEL
GRN/ BLU/ GRN/
YEL WHT YEL GRN/BLK
WHT/ BLK/ YEL/
YEL YEL BLU YEL/BLU
YEL CONNECTOR E
A
BLK/YEL
C102 C101
YEL/BLU
GRN/BLK
BLK/YEL
BLU/WHT
WHT/YEL
CONNECTOR I
GRN/YEL
B
YEL
K-LINE C
A21 GRY BLK/YEL
X R Z
SCS CONNECTOR K
A10 BRN
STSW D
A24 BLU/ORN
BKSW
A32 WHT/BLK
Y
STARTER
CUT
RELAY
CONNECTOR M
IG1
IGNITION ST
SWITCH
B
E
FUSES
A:No. 7 IG COIL (15A)
B:No. 9 BACK UP LIGHT
INSTRUMENT LIGHT (7.5A)
C:No. 6 ECU (PCM)
CRUISE CONTROL (15A)
D:No. 13 STARTER SIGNAL (7.5A)
E:No. 1 FUEL PUMP (15A)
11-84
03/07/29 09:19:42 61S0X050_110_0085
CONNECTOR Q
BLU/ORN
CONNECTOR O
RED/WHT
BLK/YEL
WHT/BLK
WHT/YEL
C201 CONNECTOR P
WHT
WHT CONNECTOR A
BLK/YEL
Y X DRIVERS UNDER-DASH
FUSE/RELAY BOX
U Q
From
SRS UNIT
GRY
LT BLU
BRN
DATA LINK
BRN/YEL CONNECTOR
WHT/GRN
BLK
T AB
G501
WHT/ WHT/BLK
GRN WHT/YEL
BRAKE PEDAL
POSITION SWITCH
C202 C401
S
WHT/
GRN
F W I C553
BLK/YEL BLK/YEL
P
BLK
BLK
FUEL PUMP
C102 C101 WHT/GRN
C301
YEL/BLK YEL/BLK G552
BLK BLK
BRN/YEL BRN/YEL
V
RED/WHT
C402
IMOFPR BLU/ORN
A15 GRN/YEL GRN/YEL
BLK/YEL
PGM-FI
MAIN RELAY
(contd)
11-85
03/07/29 09:19:42 61S0X050_110_0086
N AF O
CONNECTOR C
BLK/YEL
BLK/YEL
E
YEL
BRN/YEL
To A/C BLU/RED
PRESSURE SWITCH
P L AB
ACS
A27 BLU/RED CONNECTOR H
BRN/BLK
WHT/YEL
V U R BLU/RED
CONNECTOR I
BLK/YEL
CONNECTOR J
WHT/YEL
BRN/YEL
PASSENGERS UNDER-DASH
FUSE/RELAY BOX
S Q T
CONNECTOR B F
WHT
CONNECTOR D G
WHT/GRN
C201 CONNECTOR C
H
WHT/YEL WHT/YEL
I
YEL
ELD J
C203 BLK/YEL
ELD
A30 GRN/RED GRN/RED
BLK
CONNECTOR A
ACC To A/C
A17 RED RED CLUTCH RELAY
UNDER-HOOD
G201 FUSE/RELAY BOX
FUSES
E:No. 13 CLOCK BACK UP (7.5A) BATTERY
F:IG MAIN (50A)
G:ACGS (15A)
H:STOP (20A)
I:BACK UP ACC (40A)
J:BATTERY (120A)
G1
11-86
03/07/29 09:19:43 61S0X050_110_0087
BLK/YEL
IGPLS1
C4 YEL/GRN To
ICM SPARK
BLK PLUG
No. 1 IGNITION COIL
BLK/YEL
IGPLS2
C14 BLU/RED To
ICM SPARK
BLK PLUG
No. 2 IGNITION COIL
BLK/YEL
IGPLS3
C3 WHT/BLU To
ICM SPARK
BLK PLUG
No. 3 IGNITION COIL
BLK/YEL
IGPLS4
C13 BRN To
ICM SPARK
BLK PLUG
No. 4 IGNITION COIL
BLK/YEL
IGPLS5
C12 BLK/RED To
ICM SPARK
BLK PLUG
No. 5 IGNITION COIL
BLK/YEL
IGPLS6
C23 BRN/WHT To
ICM SPARK
BLK PLUG
No. 6 IGNITION COIL
JUNCTION
CONNECTOR B
BLK
G102 G101
Z JUNCTION
CONNECTOR A
C101
BLK/YEL BLK/YEL
C103
KS
C22 RED/BLU RED/BLU
KNOCK SENSOR
(contd)
11-87
03/07/29 09:19:43 61S0X050_110_0088
C504 C302
ATSFTP *1
E17 LT GRN LT GRN LT GRN
VREF *1
E6 WHT/RED WHT/RED WHT/RED
TPSOUT *1
E5 RED/BLK RED/BLK RED/BLK
PFINH *1
E7 LT GRN/RED LT GRN/RED LT GRN/RED
FPTDR *1
E16 PNK/BLK PNK/BLK PNK/BLK
AA BLU
AC
C151
ATFT
C24 BLU/YEL BLU/YEL
GRN/YEL GRN/YEL
ATF TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
ECTOUT To COOLANT
A31 YEL/GRN TEMPERATURE
GAUGE ASSEMBLY
BLK
G503
BLK
C504 To FUEL
FLS05 *2 GAUGE
E15 YEL/BLU YEL/BLU
GAUGE ASSEMBLY
G501
C553
YEL/BLU YEL/BLU
BLK BLK
FUEL GAUGE
SENDING UNIT
*1: with ABS/TCS
*2: 0304 models
11-88
03/07/29 09:19:44 61S0X050_110_0089
(contd)
11-89
03/07/29 09:19:44 61S0X050_110_0090
Procedure
1. Connect the scan tool to the vehicles data link
connector (DLC), and bring up the tools generic
OBD II mode.
11-90
03/07/29 09:19:44 61S0X050_110_0091
Misfire Monitor and Readiness Code EGR Monitor and Readiness Code
This readiness code is always set to available NOTE:
because misfiring is continuously monitored. Do not turn the ignition switch off during the
Monitoring pauses, and the misfire counter resets, if procedure.
the vehicle is driven over a rough road. All readiness codes are cleared when the battery is
Monitoring also pauses, and the misfire counter disconnected or when the PCM is cleared with the
holds at its current value, if the throttle position OBD II scan tool or the HDS.
changes more than a predetermined value, or if
driving conditions fall outside the range of any Enable Criteria
related enable criteria. ECT at 176F (80C) or higher.
11-91
03/07/29 09:19:47 61S0X050_110_0092
PGM-FI System
ELECTRICAL LOAD
DETECTOR (ELD)
Troubleshooting, page 11-153
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE
PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR
Troubleshooting,
page 11-95
11-92
03/07/29 09:19:48 61S0X050_110_0093
99-00 models
INJECTORS
Replacement, page 11-177
01 model
INJECTORS
Replacement, page 11-177
(contd)
11-93
03/07/29 09:19:50 61S0X050_110_0094
PGM-FI System
INJECTORS
Replacement, page 11-179
11-94
03/07/29 09:19:50 61S0X050_110_0095
DTC Troubleshooting
DTC P010799-00 Models: MAP Sensor Is there about 5 V ?
Circuit Low Voltage
YESRepair open in the wire between the PCM
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). (C19) and the MAP sensor.
2. Check the MAP with the scan tool or the HDS. NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If normal MAP readings are
Is about 101 kPa ( 7 60 mmHg, 30 in.Hg), or 2.9 V indicated, replace the original PCM.
indicated?
8. Check the MAP with the scan tool or the HDS.
YESIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at Is about 2 kPa ( 15 mmHg, 0.6 in.Hg), 0.5 V or less
the MAP sensor and the PCM. indicated?
4. Disconnect the MAP sensor 3P connector. 9. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
5. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 10. Disconnect PCM connector C (31P).
6. Measure voltage between MAP sensor 3P 11. Check for continuity between MAP sensor
connector terminals No. 1 and No. 2. connector terminal No. 3 and body ground.
MAP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
MAP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
VCC1
(YEL/RED)
MAP
(RED/GRN)
SG1 (GRN/WHT)
11-95
03/07/29 09:19:51 61S0X050_110_0096
PGM-FI System
2. Check the MAP with the scan tool or the HDS. NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If normal MAP readings are
Is about 101 kPa ( 7 60 mmHg, 30 in.Hg), or 2.9 V indicated, replace the original PCM.
indicated?
8. Check the MAP with the scan tool or the HDS.
YESIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at Is about 2 kPa ( 15 mmHg, 0.6 in.Hg), 0.5 V or less
the MAP sensor and the PCM. indicated?
4. Disconnect the MAP sensor 3P connector. 9. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
5. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 10. Disconnect PCM connector A (31P).
6. Measure voltage between MAP sensor 3P 11. Check for continuity between MAP sensor
connector terminals No. 1 and No. 3. connector terminal No. 2 and body ground.
MAP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
MAP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
VCC1
(YEL/RED)
SG1
(GRN/WHT) MAP (RED/GRN)
YESGo to step 8.
Is there continuity?
NOGo to step 7.
YESRepair short in the wire between the PCM
7. Measure voltage between PCM connector (A27) and the MAP sensor.
terminals A29 and A31.
NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
PCM CONNECTOR A (31P) (see page 11-5). If normal MAP readings are
indicated, replace the original PCM.
VCC1
(YEL/RED)
SG1
(GRN/WHT)
11-96
03/07/29 09:19:52 61S0X050_110_0097
2. Check the MAP with the scan tool or the HDS. NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If normal MAP readings are
Is about 101 kPa ( 7 60 mmHg, 30 in.Hg), or 2.9 V indicated, replace the original PCM.
indicated?
8. Check the MAP with the scan tool or the HDS.
YESIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at Is about 2 kPa ( 15 mmHg, 0.6 in.Hg), 0.5 V or less
the MAP sensor and the PCM. indicated?
4. Disconnect the MAP sensor 3P connector. 9. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
5. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 10. Disconnect PCM connector C (31P).
6. Measure voltage between MAP sensor 3P 11. Check for continuity between MAP sensor
connector terminals No. 1 and No. 3. connector terminal No. 2 and body ground.
MAP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
MAP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
VCC1
(YEL/RED)
11-97
03/07/29 09:19:53 61S0X050_110_0098
PGM-FI System
4. Disconnect the MAP sensor 3P connector. NORepair open in the wire between the PCM (C7)
and the MAP sensor.
5. Install a jumper wire between MAP sensor 3P
connector terminals No. 2 and No. 3. 10. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
MAP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR 11. Connect PCM connector terminals C7 and C17 with
a jumper wire.
PCM CONNECTOR C (31P)
SG1 (GRN/WHT)
11-98
03/07/29 09:19:53 61S0X050_110_0099
DTC P010801 Model: MAP Sensor Circuit 9. Measure voltage between MAP sensor 3P
High Voltage connector terminals No. 1 and No. 3.
1. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with MAP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
no load (in Park or neutral) until the radiator fan
comes on, then let it idle.
VCC1
(YEL/RED)
2. Check the MAP with the scan tool or the HDS.
YESGo to step 3.
Wire side of female terminals
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at
the MAP sensor and the PCM. Is there about 5 V ?
4. Disconnect the MAP sensor 3P connector. NORepair open in the wire between the PCM
(A29) and the MAP sensor.
5. Install a jumper wire between MAP sensor 3P
connector terminals No. 2 and No. 3. 10. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
MAP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR 11. Connect PCM connector terminals A27 and A29
with a jumper wire.
PCM CONNECTOR A (31P)
JUMPER WIRE
MAP (RED/GRN) SG1 (GRN/WHT)
7. Check the MAP with the scan tool or the HDS. 12. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
Is more than 101 kPa ( 7 60 mmHg, 30 in.Hg), or 13. Check the MAP with the scan tool or the HDS.
more than 2.9 V indicated?
Is more than 101 kPa ( 7 60 mmHg, 30 in.Hg), or
YESGo to step 8. more than 2.9 V indicated?
11-99
03/07/29 09:19:54 61S0X050_110_0100
PGM-FI System
YESGo to step 3.
Wire side of female terminals
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at
the MAP sensor and the PCM. Is there about 5 V ?
4. Disconnect the MAP sensor 3P connector. NORepair open in the wire between the PCM (C7)
and the MAP sensor.
5. Install a jumper wire between MAP sensor 3P
connector terminals No. 2 and No. 3. 10. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
MAP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR 11. Connect PCM connector terminals C7 and C17 with
a jumper wire.
PCM CONNECTOR C (31P)
SG1 (GRN/WHT)
JUMPER WIRE
7. Check the MAP with the scan tool or the HDS. 12. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
Is more than 101 kPa ( 7 60 mmHg, 30 in.Hg), or 13. Check the MAP with the scan tool or the HDS.
more than 2.9 V indicated?
Is more than 101 kPa ( 7 60 mmHg, 30 in.Hg), or
YESGo to step 8. more than 2.9 V indicated?
11-100
03/07/29 09:21:09 61S0X050_110_0101
DTC P1128: MAP Sensor Signal Lower Than DTC P1129: MAP Sensor Signal Higher Than
Expected Expected
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 1. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with
no load (in Park or neutral) until the radiator fan
2. Check the MAP with the scan tool or the HDS. comes on, then let it idle.
Is 54.1 kPa ( 406 mmHg, 16.0 in.Hg), 1.6 V , or 2. Check the MAP with the scan tool or the HDS.
higher indicated?
Is 43.3 kPa ( 325 mmHg, 12.8 in.Hg), 1.4 V , or less
YESIntermittent failure, system is OK at this indicated?
time.
YESIntermittent failure, system is OK at this
NOReplace the MAP sensor. time.
11-101
03/07/29 09:21:09 61S0X050_110_0102
PGM-FI System
2. Check the IAT with the scan tool or the HDS. Is the correct ambient temperature indicated?
Is 302F ( 150C) or higher ( or H-Limit in the HDS), YESIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
or 0 V indicated? Check for poor connections or loose terminals at
the IAT sensor and the PCM.
YESGo to step 3.
NOReplace the IAT sensor.
NOGo to step 8.
YESGo to step 5.
IAT
(RED/YEL)
Is there continuity?
11-102
03/07/29 09:21:09 61S0X050_110_0103
DTC P011201 Model: IAT Sensor Circuit 8. Check the temperature reading on the scan tool.
Low Voltage If the engine is warm, the reading will be higher
than ambient temperature. If the engine is cold, the
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). IAT and ECT will have the same value.
2. Check the IAT with the scan tool or the HDS. Is the correct ambient temperature indicated?
Is 302F ( 150C) or higher ( or H-Limit in the HDS), YESIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
or 0 V indicated? Check for poor connections or loose terminals at
the IAT sensor and the PCM.
YESGo to step 3.
NOReplace the IAT sensor.
NOGo to step 8.
YESGo to step 5.
IAT
(RED/YEL)
Is there continuity?
11-103
03/07/29 09:21:10 61S0X050_110_0104
PGM-FI System
3. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 12. Check the IAT with the scan tool or the HDS.
4. Disconnect the IAT sensor 2P connector. Is 4F ( 20C) or less ( or L-Limit in the HDS),
or 5 V indicated?
5. Connect IAT sensor 2P connector terminals No. 1
and No. 2 with a jumper wire. YESSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
IAT SENSOR 2P CONNECTOR
(see page 11-5). If normal IAT readings are
indicated, replace the original PCM.
JUMPER WIRE
IAT (RED/YEL)
YESGo to step 8.
11-104
03/07/29 09:21:11 61S0X050_110_0105
DTC P011301 Model: IAT Sensor Circuit 10. Connect PCM connector terminals A14 and A28
High Voltage with a jumper wire.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). PCM CONNECTOR A (31P)
IAT (RED/YEL)
YESGo to step 8.
11-105
03/07/29 09:21:11 61S0X050_110_0106
PGM-FI System
1. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with Is 302F ( 150C) or higher ( or H-Limit in the HDS),
no load (in Park or neutral) until the radiator fan or 0 V indicated?
comes on, then let it idle.
YESGo to step 3.
2. Check the ECT with the scan tool or the HDS.
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
Is 17 6200F ( 80 93C) or 0.4 0.7 V Check for poor connections or loose terminals at
indicated? the ECT sensor and the PCM.
NOCheck the thermostat and the cooling system. 4. Check the ECT with the scan tool or the HDS.
If they are OK, replace the ECT sensor.
Is 302F ( 150C) or higher ( or H-Limit in the HDS),
3. Test drive the vehicle with the scan tool connected, or 0 V indicated?
and monitor the thermostat and cooling system for
abnormal fluctuations in temperature readings. YESGo to step 5.
Are there any f luctuations in the temperature NOReplace the ECT sensor.
readings?
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
YESCheck the thermostat and cooling system.
6. Disconnect PCM connector C (31P).
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this
time. 7. Check the continuity between ECT sensor 2P
connector terminal No. 2 and body ground.
ECT SENSOR 2P CONNECTOR
ECT
(RED/WHT)
Is there continuity?
11-106
03/07/29 09:21:11 61S0X050_110_0107
DTC P011701 Model: ECT Sensor Circuit 7. Check the continuity between ECT sensor 2P
Low Voltage connector terminal No. 2 and body ground.
ECT SENSOR 2P CONNECTOR
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
2. Check the ECT with the scan tool or the HDS. ECT
(RED/WHT)
Is 302F ( 150C) or higher ( or H-Limit in the HDS),
or 0 V indicated?
YESGo to step 3.
4. Check the ECT with the scan tool or the HDS. YESRepair short in the wire between the PCM
(A13) and the ECT sensor.
Is 302F ( 150C) or higher ( or H-Limit in the HDS),
or 0 V indicated? NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If normal ECT readings are
YESGo to step 5. indicated, replace the original PCM.
11-107
03/07/29 09:21:12 61S0X050_110_0108
PGM-FI System
YESGo to step 3.
4. Disconnect the ECT sensor 2P connector. 11. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
5. Connect ECT sensor 2P connector terminals No. 1 12. Check the ECT with the scan tool or the HDS.
and No. 2 with a jumper wire.
ECT SENSOR 2P CONNECTOR
Is 4F ( 20C) or less ( or L-Limit in the HDS),
or 5 V indicated?
YESGo to step 8.
11-108
03/07/29 09:21:12 61S0X050_110_0109
DTC P011801 Model: ECT Sensor Circuit 8. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
High Voltage
9. Remove the jumper wire.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
10. Connect PCM connector terminals A13 and A28
2. Check the ECT with the scan tool or the HDS. with a jumper wire.
Is 4F ( 20C) or less ( or L-Limit in the HDS), PCM CONNECTOR A (31P)
or 5 V indicated?
YESGo to step 3.
YESGo to step 8.
11-109
03/07/29 09:21:13 61S0X050_110_0110
PGM-FI System
TP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
TPS
11-110
03/07/29 09:21:14 61S0X050_110_0111
12. At the wire harness side, check for continuity 14. At the wire harness side, check for continuity
between TP sensor 3P connector terminal No. 2 between TP sensor 3P connector terminal No. 2
and body ground. and body ground.
TP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR TP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
YESRepair short in the wire between the PCM YESSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(C27) and the TP sensor. (see page 11-5). If the prescribed voltage is now
available, replace the original PCM.
NOGo to step 13.
NORepair open in the wire between the PCM
13. Connect PCM connector terminal C27 and body (C27) and the TP sensor.
ground with a jumper wire.
15. Measure voltage between PCM connector
PCM CONNECTOR C (31P) terminals C18 and C28.
PCM CONNECTOR C (31P)
SG2 (GRN/BLK)
SG2 (GRN/YEL)*
TPS (RED/BLK)
JUMPER WIRE
VCC2 (YEL/BLU)
Wire side of female terminals
Is there about 5 V ?
11-111
03/07/29 09:21:14 61S0X050_110_0112
PGM-FI System
TP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
VCC2
TPS
SG2 (GRN/BLK) VCC2 (YEL/BLU)
11-112
03/07/29 09:21:15 61S0X050_110_0113
12. At the wire harness side, check for continuity 14. At the wire harness side, check for continuity
between TP sensor 3P connector terminal No. 2 between TP sensor 3P connector terminal No. 2
and body ground. and body ground.
TP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR TP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
YESRepair short in the wire between the PCM YESSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(A15) and the TP sensor. (see page 11-5). If the prescribed voltage is now
available, replace the original PCM.
NOGo to step 13.
NORepair open in the wire between the PCM
13. Connect PCM connector terminal A15 and body (A15) and the TP sensor.
ground with a jumper wire.
15. Measure voltage between PCM connector
PCM CONNECTOR A (31P) terminals A28 and A30.
PCM CONNECTOR A (31P)
TPS (RED/BLK)
JUMPER WIRE
SG2 (GRN/BLK) VCC2
(YEL/BLU)
Is there about 5 V ?
11-113
03/07/29 09:21:16 61S0X050_110_0114
PGM-FI System
3. Check the throttle position with the scan tool or the VCC2 (YEL/BLU)
HDS.
Is there about 10 % or 0.5 V when the throttle is Wire side of female terminals
f ully closed and about 90 % or 4.5 V when the
throttle is f ully opened? Is there about 5 V ?
YESIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time. YESRepair open in the wire between the PCM
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at (C18) and the TP sensor.
the TP sensor and the PCM.
NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
NOGo to step 4. (see page 11-5). If the prescribed voltage is now
available, replace the original PCM.
4. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
TP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
Is there about 5 V ?
NOGo to step 8.
11-114
03/07/29 09:21:16 61S0X050_110_0115
DTC P012301 Model: TP Sensor Circuit 8. Measure voltage between PCM connector
High Voltage terminals A28 and A30.
1. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with PCM CONNECTOR A (31P)
no load (in Park or neutral) until the radiator fan
comes on, then turn the ignition switch OFF.
4. Turn the ignition switch OFF. NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If the prescribed voltage is now
5. Disconnect the TP sensor 3P connector. available, replace the original PCM.
TP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
Is there about 5 V ?
NOGo to step 8.
11-115
03/07/29 09:21:16 61S0X050_110_0116
PGM-FI System
2. Check the throttle position with the scan tool or the 2. Check the throttle position with the scan tool or the
HDS. HDS.
Is 13.3 %, 0.7 V , or higher indicated when the Is 13.3 %, 0.7 V , or less indicated when the
throttle is f ully opened? throttle is f ully closed?
11-116
03/07/29 09:21:17 61S0X050_110_0117
DTC P012802-04 Models: Cooling System 1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
Malfunction
2. Make sure the A/C off.
NOTE: If the DTCs listed below are stored at the same
time as DTC P0128, troubleshoot those DTCs first, then 3. Check the radiator fan.
recheck for P0128.
Does the radiator f an keep running?
P0107, P0108, P1128, P1129: Manifold Absolute
Pressure (MAP) sensor YESCheck the radiator fan circuit
P1106, P1107, P1108: Barometric Pressure (BARO) (see page 10-22), the radiator fan switch circuit (see
sensor page 10-22), and the radiator fan switch (see page
P1259: VTEC system 10-22). If they are OK, substitute a known-good
P0401, P1491, P1498: Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) PCM and recheck (see page 11-5). If the symptom/
system indication goes away, replace the original PCM.
P0116, P0117, P0118: Engine Coolant Temperature
(ECT) sensor NOGo to step 4.
P0112, P0113: Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor
P0335, P0336: Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor 4. Clear the DTC with the HDS.
P0300: Random misfire
P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306: No. 1, No. 2, 5. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with
No. 3, No. 4, No.5 or No. 6 cylinder misfire no load (in Park or neutral) until the radiator fan
P0505: Idle Control System Malfunction comes on.
P1519: Idle Air Control (IAC) valve
Is DT C P0128 indicated?
DTC P0128 can occasionally set when the hood is
opened while the engine is running. YESTest the thermostat (see page 10-11).
11-117
03/07/29 09:21:17 61S0X050_110_0118
PGM-FI System
YESGo to step 4.
Wire side of female terminals
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at Is there continuity?
the primary HO2S (Sensor 1) and the PCM.
YESRepair short in the wire between the PCM
4. Check the fuel pressure (see page 11-216). (C16) and the primary HO2S (Sensor 1).
YESGo to step 9.
11-118
03/07/29 09:21:17 61S0X050_110_0119
DTC P013101 Model: Primary HO2S 11. Check for continuity between primary HO2S
(Sensor 1) Circuit Low Voltage (Sensor 1) 4P connector terminal No. 1 and body
ground.
1. Reset the PCM (see page 11-4).
PRIMARY HO2S (SENSOR 1)
4P CONNECTOR
2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with
no load (in Park or neutral) until the radiator fan
comes on. PHO2S (WHT)
YESGo to step 4.
Wire side of female terminals
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at Is there continuity?
the primary HO2S (Sensor 1) and the PCM.
YESRepair short in the wire between the PCM
4. Check the fuel pressure (see page 11-216). (A6) and the primary HO2S (Sensor 1).
YESGo to step 9.
11-119
03/07/29 09:21:18 61S0X050_110_0120
PGM-FI System
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time. 11. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at
the primary HO2S (Sensor 1) and the PCM. 12. Check the primary HO2S (Sensor 1) output voltage
with the scan tool or the HDS.
4. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Is there 1.0 V or more?
5. Disconnect the primary HO2S (Sensor 1) 4P
connector. YESSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
6. Connect primary HO2S (Sensor 1) 4P connector away, replace the original PCM.
terminals No. 1 and No. 2 with a jumper wire.
PRIMARY HO2S (SENSOR 1) NORepair open in the wire between the PCM
4P CONNECTOR (C16, C18) and the primary HO2S (Sensor 1).
JUMPER WIRE
YESGo to step 9.
11-120
03/07/29 09:21:18 61S0X050_110_0121
DTC P013201 Model: Primary HO2S 9. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(Sensor 1) Circuit High Voltage
10. Connect PCM connector terminals A6 and A28 with
1. Reset the PCM (see page 11-4). a jumper wire.
2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with PCM CONNECTOR A (31P)
no load (in Park or neutral) until the radiator fan
comes on.
PHO2S (WHT)
3. Check the primary HO2S (Sensor 1) output voltage
with the scan tool or the HDS.
YESGo to step 9.
11-121
03/07/29 09:21:18 61S0X050_110_0122
PGM-FI System
11-122
03/07/29 09:21:19 61S0X050_110_0123
DTC P013799-00, 02-04 Models: 10. Check for continuity between secondary HO2S
Secondary HO2S (Sensor 2) Circuit Low (Sensor 2) 4P connector terminal No. 2 and body
Voltage ground.
NOTE: Information marked with an asterisk ( ) applies SECONDARY HO2S
(SENSOR 2) 4P CONNECTOR
to 02-04 models.
Does the voltage stay at 0.3 V or less? Terminal side of male terminals
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time. YESRepair short in the wire between the PCM
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at (A23, A1 ) and the secondary HO2S (Sensor 2).
the secondary HO2S (Sensor 2) and the PCM.
NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
4. Turn the ignition switch OFF. (see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
away, replace the original PCM.
5. Disconnect the secondary HO2S (Sensor 2) 4P
connector.
YESGo to step 8.
11-123
03/07/29 09:21:19 61S0X050_110_0124
PGM-FI System
YESGo to step 4.
4. Turn the ignition switch OFF. YESRepair short in the wire between the PCM
(E18) and the secondary HO2S (Sensor 2).
5. Disconnect the secondary HO2S (Sensor 2) 4P
connector. NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
6. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). away, replace the original PCM.
YESGo to step 8.
11-124
03/07/29 09:21:20 61S0X050_110_0125
DTC P013899-00, 02-04 Models: 8. Check the secondary HO2S (Sensor 2) output
Secondary HO2S (Sensor 2) Circuit High voltage with the scan tool or the HDS.
Voltage
Is there 1.0 V or more?
NOTE: Information marked with an asterisk ( ) applies
to 02-04 models. YESGo to step 9.
1. Reset the PCM (see page 11-4). NOReplace the secondary HO2S (Sensor 2).
2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with 9. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
no load (in Park or neutral) until the radiator fan
comes on. 10. Connect PCM connector terminals A23 and C18
(A1 and C18) with a jumper wire.
3. Check the secondary HO2S (Sensor 2) output
voltage at 3,000 rpm with the scan tool or the HDS. SHO2S PCM CONNECTORS
(WHT/RED)* A (32P)
Does the voltage stay at 1.0 V or more?
11-125
03/07/29 09:21:20 61S0X050_110_0126
PGM-FI System
YESGo to step 4.
YESGo to step 9.
11-126
03/07/29 09:21:20 61S0X050_110_0127
11-127
03/07/29 09:21:21 61S0X050_110_0128
PGM-FI System
* IG1 IG1
(BLK/YEL) (BLK/YEL)
PO2S SO2S
HTC HTC
(BLK/ (BLK/
WHT) WHT)*
11-128
03/07/29 09:21:22 61S0X050_110_0129
11. Check for continuity between PCM connector 13. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
terminal C1 (A8) and body ground.
14. Reconnect the HO2S (primary or secondary )
PCM CONNECTORS
(Sensor 1, Sensor 2 ) 4P connector.
PO2SHTC C (31P)
(BLK/WHT)
15. Disconnect PCM connector C (31P) (PCM connector
A, 32P) .
Is there continuity? PG
(BLK) B (25P)
YESRepair short in the wire between the PCM
(C1, A8 ) and the HO2S (primary or secondary )
(Sensor 1, Sensor 2 ).
11-129
03/07/29 09:21:23 61S0X050_110_0130
PGM-FI System
5. At the HO2S side, measure resistance between 8. Measure voltage between HO2S 4P connector
HO2S 4P connector terminals No. 3 and No. 4. terminals No. 3 and No. 4.
PRIMARY/SECONDARY* HO2S (SENSOR 1/
HO2S 4P CONNECTOR SENSOR 2*) 4P CONNECTOR
*
*
IG1 IG1
(BLK/YEL) (BLK/YEL)
PO2S SO2S
HTC HTC
(BLK/ (BLK/
WHT) WHT)*
11-130
03/07/29 09:21:24 61S0X050_110_0131
11. Check for continuity between PCM connector 13. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
terminal B5 (E2) and body ground.
14. Reconnect the HO2S (primary or secondary )
PCM CONNECTORS
(Sensor 1, Sensor 2 ) 4P connector.
PO2SHTC (BLK/WHT)
B (24P)
15. Disconnect PCM connector B (24P) (PCM connector
E, 31P) .
Is there continuity?
11-131
03/07/29 09:21:24 61S0X050_110_0132
PGM-FI System
Is f uel pressure OK ?
YESGo to step 2.
NOGo to step 4.
11-132
03/07/29 09:21:24 61S0X050_110_0133
1. Troubleshoot the following DTCs first if any of them were stored along with the random misfire DTC(s):
P0107, P0108, P1128, P1129: Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
P0131, P0132: Primary Heated Oxygen Sensor (Primary HO2S)
P0171, P0172: Fuel System
P0335, P0336: Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
P0340, P0341, P0365, P0366: Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor A/B (03-04 models)
P0401, P1491, P1498: Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) System
P0505: Idle Control System
P1259: VTEC System
P1361, P1362, P1366, P1367: Top Dead Center (TDC) 1/Top Dead Center (TDC) 2 Sensor (99-02 models)
P1519: Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve
3. Find the symptom in the chart below, and do the related procedures in the order listed until you find the cause.
11-133
03/07/29 09:21:24 61S0X050_110_0134
PGM-FI System
DTC P030299-00, 02-04 Models: No. 2 Is DT C P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, or
Cylinder Misfire Detected P0306, or T emporary DT C P1399 indicated?
4. Turn the ignition switch OFF. NOIntermittent misfire due to spark plug fouling,
etc. (no misfire at this time).
5. Exchange the ignition coil from the problem
cylinder with one from another cylinder. 13. Determine which cylinder had the misfire.
6. Test-drive the vehicle several times in the range of Does the misf ire occur in the cylinder where the
the freeze data or under various conditions if there spark plug was exchanged?
was no freeze data.
YESReplace the faulty spark plug.
11-134
03/07/29 09:21:25 61S0X050_110_0135
14. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 23. Measure voltage between ignition coil 3P
connector terminal No. 3 and body ground.
15. Exchange the injector from the problem cylinder
with one from another cylinder. IGNITION COIL 3P CONNECTOR
Wire side of
female terminals
Is there continuity?
(contd)
11-135
03/07/29 09:21:26 61S0X050_110_0136
PGM-FI System
IGPLS6
(WHT/
BLU) IGPLS4 IGPLS2
IGPLS6 (YEL) (RED) Wire side of female terminals
(BRN/ IGPLS4 IGPLS2
WHT)* (BRN)* (BLU/RED)*
11-136
03/07/29 09:21:26 61S0X050_110_0137
YESGo to step 30. 36. Disconnect the injector 2P connector from the
problem cylinder.
NORepair open in the wire between the PCM and
the ignition coil. 37. Measure resistance between injector 2P connector
terminals No. 1 and No. 2.
30. Check the engine compression (see page 6-11).
INJECTOR 2P CONNECTOR
Is the engine compression OK ?
INJ1 INJ3 INJ6 40. Test-drive the vehicle several times in the range of
(BRN) (BLU) (WHT/
BLU) the freeze data or under various conditions if there
was no freeze data.
(contd)
11-137
03/07/29 09:21:27 61S0X050_110_0138
PGM-FI System
Is there continuity?
11-138
03/07/29 09:21:28 61S0X050_110_0139
49. Connect injector 2P connector terminal No. 2 (No. 1 DTC P030101 Model: No. 1 Cylinder Misfire
on 99-00 models) to body ground with a jumper Detected
wire (see table).
DTC P030201 Model: No. 2 Cylinder Misfire
INJECTOR 2P CONNECTOR Detected
50. Check for continuity between body ground and the 3. Start the engine, and listen for a clicking sound
PCM connector terminal (see table). from the injector in the problem cylinder.
YESReplace the injector, then recheck. NOIntermittent misfire due to ignition coil fouling,
etc. (no misfire at this time).
NORepair open in the wire between the PCM and
the injector.
(contd)
11-139
03/07/29 09:21:28 61S0X050_110_0140
PGM-FI System
12. Check for a DTC or a Temporary DTC with the scan YESReplace the faulty injector
tool or the HDS. (see page 11-177).
11-140
03/07/29 09:21:29 61S0X050_110_0141
25. Check for continuity between ignition coil 3P YESRepair short in the wire between the PCM
connector terminal No. 2 and body ground. and the ignition coil.
JUMPER WIRE
Wire side of
female terminals
Is there continuity?
IGPLS3 (BLU)
IGPLS4 (YEL)
IGPLS6 IGPLS5
(WHT/ (BLK/
BLU) RED)
(contd)
11-141
03/07/29 09:21:29 61S0X050_110_0142
PGM-FI System
IGPLS3 (BLU)
NORepair open in the wire between the PCM and NOGo to step 43.
the ignition coil.
35. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
30. Check the engine compression (see page 6-11).
36. Disconnect the injector 2P connector from the
Is the engine compression OK ? problem cylinder.
11-142
03/07/29 09:21:30 61S0X050_110_0143
37. Measure resistance between injector 2P connector 43. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
terminals No. 1 and No. 2.
44. Disconnect the injector 2P connector from the
INJECTOR 2P CONNECTOR problem cylinder.
41. Check for a DTC or a Temporary DTC with the scan 47. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
tool or the HDS.
11-143
03/07/29 09:21:30 61S0X050_110_0144
PGM-FI System
11-144
03/07/29 09:21:31 61S0X050_110_0145
DTC P032599-00, 02-04 Models: Knock 7. Connect C103 knock sensor connector terminal
Sensor Circuit Malfunction No. 1 to body ground with a jumper wire.
1. Reset the PCM (see page 11-4). KNOCK SENSOR SUBHARNESS
1P CONNECTOR (C103)
2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with
no load (in Park or neutral) until the radiator fan
comes on, then let it idle.
KS
(RED/BLU)
3. Hold the engine at 3,0004,000 rpm for at least 60
seconds. JUMPER WIRE
Is DT C P0325 indicated?
KS
(RED/BLU) Wire side of female terminals
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 9.
11-145
03/07/29 09:21:32 61S0X050_110_0146
PGM-FI System
Is DT C P0325 indicated?
KS
(RED/BLU) Wire side of female terminals
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 9.
Wire side of female terminals NORepair open in the wire between the PCM (A9)
and the C103 knock sensor connector.
11-146
03/07/29 09:21:33 61S0X050_110_0147
DTC P033599-00, 02-04 Models: CKP 6. Check for continuity between body ground and CKP
Sensor Circuit No Signal sensor 2P connector terminals No. 1 and No. 2
individually.
DTC P033699-00, 02-04 Models: CKP
CKP SENSOR 2P CONNECTOR
Sensor Circuit Intermittent Interruption
1. Reset the PCM (see page 11-4).
YESGo to step 3.
4. Disconnect the CKP sensor 2P connector. YESReplace the CKP sensor (see page 6-61).
CKP CKP
(BLU) (WHT)
Is there 1,8502,450 ?
YESGo to step 6.
Is there 1,8502,450 ?
(contd)
11-147
03/07/29 09:21:33 61S0X050_110_0148
PGM-FI System
YESGo to step 3.
NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck 5. Measure resistance between CKP sensor 2P
(see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes connector terminals No. 1 and No. 2.
away, replace the original PCM.
CKP SENSOR 2P CONNECTOR
CKP CKP
Is there 1,8502,450 ?
YESGo to step 6.
11-148
03/07/29 09:21:34 61S0X050_110_0149
6. Check for continuity between body ground and CKP 10. Check for continuity between body ground and
sensor 2P connector terminals No. 1 and No. 2 PCM connector terminal A12.
individually.
PCM CONNECTOR A (31P)
CKP SENSOR 2P CONNECTOR
CKP (BLU)
CKP CKP
CKP (BLU)
CKP (WHT)
Is there 1,8502,450 ?
11-149
03/07/29 09:21:34 61S0X050_110_0150
PGM-FI System
YESGo to step 3.
CMPA CMPA
5. Measure resistance between the terminals of the Terminal side of male terminals
indicated sensor (see table).
Is there continuity?
CMP SENSOR A/B 4P CONNECTOR
YESReplace the CMP sensor A/B
(see page 6-60).
CMPA CMPA
NOGo to step 7.
11-150
03/07/29 09:22:45 61S0X050_110_0151
9. Measure resistance between the terminals of the DTC P056001 Model: Low Voltage in PCM
indicated sensor on the PCM connector (see table). Back Up Circuit
CMPB
(YEL)
Is there continuity?
11-151
03/07/29 09:22:45 61S0X050_110_0152
PGM-FI System
VBU
2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with
(WHT/YEL) no load (in Park or neutral) until the radiator fan
comes on, then let it idle.
11-152
03/07/29 09:22:45 61S0X050_110_0153
DTC P1107: BARO Sensor Circuit Low Voltage DTC P129799-00, 02-04 Models: ELD
Circuit Low Voltage
DTC P1108: BARO Sensor Circuit High
Voltage 1. Reset the PCM (see page 11-4).
ELD (GRN/RED)
Is there about 5 V ?
NOGo to step 8.
(contd)
11-153
03/07/29 09:22:46 61S0X050_110_0154
PGM-FI System
Is DT C P1297 indicated?
YESGo to step 4.
YESRepair short in the wire between the PCM 7. Measure voltage between body ground and ELD 3P
(A30) and the ELD. connector terminal No. 3.
ELD 3P CONNECTOR
NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
away, replace the original PCM. ELD (GRN/RED)
Is there about 5 V ?
NOGo to step 8.
11-154
03/07/29 09:22:46 61S0X050_110_0155
8. Turn the ignition switch OFF. DTC P129899-00, 02-04 Models: ELD
Circuit High Voltage
9. Disconnect PCM connector E (31P).
1. Reset the PCM (see page 11-4).
10. Check for continuity between body ground and
PCM connector terminal E19. 2. Start the engine.
Is DT C P1298 indicated?
YESGo to step 4.
YESRepair short in the wire between the PCM 7. Measure voltage between body ground and ELD 3P
(E19) and the ELD. connector terminal No. 1.
NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck ELD 3P CONNECTOR
(see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
away, replace the original PCM.
IG1 (BLK/YEL)
YESGo to step 8.
(contd)
11-155
03/07/29 09:22:47 61S0X050_110_0156
PGM-FI System
GND
(BLK)
ELD
(GRN/RED)
JUMPER WIRE
11. Check for continuity between body ground and YESReconnect the ELD 3P connector and PCM
PCM connector terminal A30. connector A (31P). Go to step 13.
PCM CONNECTOR A (32P) NORepair open in the wire between the ELD and
G201.
ELD (GRN/RED)
NOReplace ELD.
11-156
03/07/29 09:22:48 61S0X050_110_0157
DTC P129801 Model: ELD Circuit High 9. Connect ELD 3P connector terminal No. 3 to body
Voltage ground with a jumper wire.
1. Reset the PCM (see page 11-4). ELD 3P CONNECTOR
4. Turn the ignition switch and headlights OFF. 10. Disconnect PCM connector A (32P).
5. Disconnect the ELD 3P connector. 11. Check for continuity between body ground and
PCM connector terminal E19.
6. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
PCM CONNECTOR E (31P)
7. Measure voltage between body ground and ELD 3P
connector terminal No. 1.
ELD 3P CONNECTOR
ELD (GRN/RED)
IG1 (BLK/YEL)
Is there continuity?
Is there battery voltage? NORepair open in the wire between the PCM
(E19) and the ELD.
YESGo to step 8.
(contd)
11-157
03/07/29 09:22:48 61S0X050_110_0158
PGM-FI System
13. Start the engine, and let it idle. 3. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
14. While measuring voltage between PCM connector 4. Disconnect the TDC1/TDC2 sensor 4P connector.
terminals A26 and E19, turn the headlights on (low).
PCM CONNECTORS
A (31P)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
E (31P)
ELD (GRN/RED)
NOReplace ELD.
11-158
03/07/29 09:22:49 61S0X050_110_0159
5. Measure resistance between the terminals of 9. Measure resistance between the terminals of the
indicated sensor (see table). indicated sensor on the PCM connector (see table).
TDC1/TDC2 SENSOR 4P CONNECTOR PCM CONNECTOR C (31P)
TDC1 TDC1
TDC1 TDC1 (GRN) (RED)
TDC2 TDC2
TDC2 TDC2
(YEL) (BLK)
Terminal side of male terminals
Wire side of female terminals
SENSOR DTC SENSOR PCM WIRE
TERMINAL TERMINAL COLOR SENSOR DTC SENSOR PCM WIRE
TDC1 P1361 1 C20 GRN TERMINAL TERMINAL COLOR
P1362 2 C21 RED TDC1 P1361 1 C20 GRN
TDC2 P1366 3 C29 YEL P1362 2 C21 RED
P1367 4 C30 BLK TDC2 P1366 3 C29 YEL
P1367 4 C30 BLK
Is there 1,8502,450 ?
Is there 1,8502,450 ?
YESGo to step 6.
YESGo to step 10.
NOReplace the TDC1/TDC2 sensor
(see page 6-60). NORepair open in the indicated sensor wires (see
table).
6. Check for continuity to body ground on both
terminals of indicated sensor individually. 10. Check for continuity between body ground and
PCM connector terminal C20 and/or C29
TDC1/TDC2 SENSOR 4P CONNECTOR
individually.
TDC1 TDC1 PCM CONNECTOR C (31P)
TDC1 (GRN)
TDC2 TDC2
TDC2
(YEL)
Terminal side of male terminals
Is there continuity?
Wire side of female terminals
YESReplace the TDC1/TDC2 sensor (see page 6-
60). Is there continuity?
11-159
03/07/29 09:22:50 61S0X050_110_0160
PGM-FI System
YESGo to step 3.
TDC1 TDC1
11-160
03/07/29 09:22:51 61S0X050_110_0161
9. Measure resistance between the terminals of the DTC P167699-00 Models: FPTDR Signal
indicated sensor on the PCM connector (see table). Line Failure
YESGo to step 3.
TDC1 (RED)
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
TDC2 (BLK)
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at
Wire side of female terminals the ABS/TCS control unit and the PCM.
Is there continuity?
NOGo to step 6.
Is there continuity?
11-161
03/07/29 09:22:51 61S0X050_110_0162
PGM-FI System
Is DT C P167 6 indicated?
ABS/TCS CONTROL UNIT 16P
CONNECTOR YESGo to step 3.
NORepair open in the wire between the ABS/TCS 5. Check for continuity between body ground and
control unit and the PCM (E1). PCM connector terminal D3.
7. Reconnect PCM connector E (12P). PCM CONNECTOR D (17P)
PCM CONNECTORS
FPTDR E (12P)
(PNK/BLK)
JUMPER
WIRE C (31P)
VCC2
(YEL/BLU)
Is there continuity?
Wire side of female terminals
Is DT C P167 6 indicated?
11-162
03/07/29 09:22:52 61S0X050_110_0163
6. Check for continuity between ABS/TCS control unit DTC P167602-04 Models: FPTDR Signal
16P connector terminal No. 1 and PCM connector Line Failure
terminal D3.
1. Reset the PCM (see page 11-4).
PCM CONNECTOR D (17P)
Is DT C P167 6 indicated?
YESGo to step 3.
ABS/TCS CONTROL UNIT
16P CONNECTOR
NOIntermittent failure system is OK at this time.
FPTDR Check for poor connections or loose terminals at
(PNK/BLK)
the ABS/TCS control unit and the PCM.
Wire side of female terminals
NORepair open in the wire between the ABS/TCS 5. Check for continuity between body ground and
control unit and the PCM (D3). PCM connector terminal E16.
7. Reconnect PCM connector D (17P). PCM CONNECTOR (20P)
PCM CONNECTORS
A (31P)
FPTDR
(PNK/BLK)
FDTDR (PNK/BLK)
D (17P) Wire side of female terminals
Is there continuity?
Wire side of female terminals
Is DT C P167 6 indicated?
(contd)
11-163
03/07/29 09:22:53 61S0X050_110_0164
PGM-FI System
Is DT C P167 8 indicated?
FPTDR
(PNK/BLK) YESGo to step 3.
ABS/TCS CONTROL UNIT 16P
CONNECTOR
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at
FPTDR the ABS/TCS control unit and the PCM.
(PNK/BLK)
FPTDR
(PNK/BLK)
JUMPER
WIRE C (31P)
VCC2
(YEL/BLU)
Wire side of female terminals
Is DT C P167 6 indicated?
11-164
03/07/29 09:22:53 61S0X050_110_0165
DTC P0607: PCM Back Up Circuit Malfunction DTC P1607: PCM Internal Circuit Malfunction
1. Reset the PCM (see page 11-4). 1. Reset the PCM (see page 11-4).
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
YESSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck YESSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes (see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
away, replace the original PCM. away, replace the original PCM.
4. Cycle the ignition switch OFF and ON (II) five times. 4. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
5. Check for a DTC or a Temporary DTC with the scan 5. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
tool or the HDS.
6. Wait 10 seconds.
Is DT C P0607 indicated?
Is DT C P1607 indicated?
YESInspect the No. 13 CLOCK BACK UP (7.5A)
fuse in the passengers under-dash fuse/relay box. YESSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
If the fuse is OK, repair an open in the wire between (see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
the PCM (A1) and passengers under-dash fuse/ away, replace the original PCM.
relay box.
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time. A low battery can cause this problem. Ask the
A low battery can cause this problem. Ask the customer if the engine had to be jump-started
customer if the engine had to be jump-started recently.
recently.
11-165
03/07/29 09:22:53 61S0X050_110_0166
PGM-FI System
2. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), and read the HDS. YESIf the MIL always comes on and stays on, go
to step 22. But if the MIL sometimes works
Does the HDS communicate with the PCM? normally, first check for these problems:
Are any DT Cs indicated? NOIf the MIL is always off, go to step 6. But if the
MIL sometimes works normally, first check for
YESGo to the DTC Troubleshooting Index. these problems:
11-166
03/07/29 09:22:54 61S0X050_110_0167
6. Turn the ignition switch OFF and then ON (II) again. 11. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Is the low oil pressure indicator on? 12. Inspect the ACGS (15A) fuse in the under-hood
fuse/relay box.
YESGo to step 7.
Is the f use OK ?
NOCheck for these problems:
YESGo to step 13.
A blown No. 9 BACK UP LIGHT, INSTRUMENT
LIGHT (7.5A) fuse in the drivers under-dash NOCheck for these problems:
fuse/relay box.
A short or open in the wire between No. 9 BACK A short in the wire between the ACGS (15A) fuse
UP LIGHT, INSTRUMENT LIGHT (7.5A) fuse and and the PGM-FI main relay.
the gauge assembly. A short in the wire between the PGM-FI main
relay and the PCM, injectors, or IAC valve.
7. Try to start the engine.
13. Inspect the No. 1 FUEL PUMP (15A) fuse in the
Does the engine start? under-dash fuse/relay box.
9. Connect PCM connector terminal A18 to body A short in the wire between the No. 1 FUEL
ground with a jumper wire. PUMP (15A) fuse and the PGM-FI main relay.
A short in the wire between the PGM-FI main
PCM CONNECTOR A (32P) relay and the fuel pump.
A faulty PGM-FI main relay or a faulty fuel pump.
(contd)
11-167
03/07/29 09:22:54 61S0X050_110_0168
PGM-FI System
Is there continuity?
LG1 LG2
PG2 (BRN/BLK)
YESRepair short to body ground in the wire (BLK) (BRN/BLK)
(BRN/YEL)* (BRN/YEL)*
between PCM (C19) and the MAP sensor, or PCM
(C28) and the TP sensor, EGR valve position sensor
or FTP sensor. Wire side of female terminals
NOReplace the sensor that made continuity to Is there less than 1.0 V ?
body ground go away when disconnected.
YESSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
17. Disconnect the injectors and IAC valve connectors. (see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
away, replace the original PCM.
18. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
NORepair the open in the wire(s) between G101
19. Measure voltage between body ground and PCM and the PCM (B2, B10, B20, B22) that had more
connector terminals B1 and B9 individually. than 1.0 V.
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P) 22. Turn the ignition switch OFF, then turn it back ON
IGP1 (II), and measure voltage between PCM connector
(YEL/BLK) terminal A10 and body ground.
PCM CONNECTOR A (32P)
SCS (BRN)
IGP2
(YEL/BLK)
An open in the wire(s) between the PGM-FI main YESGo to step 26.
relay and PCM connector terminals B1 and B9.
Poor connections at the PGM-FI main relay. NOGo to step 23.
A faulty PGM-FI main relay (see page 11-209).
11-168
03/07/29 09:22:55 61S0X050_110_0169
25. Check for continuity between PCM connector 2. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), and read the HDS.
terminal A10 and body ground.
Does the HDS communicate with the PCM?
PCM CONNECTOR A (32P)
YESGo to step 3.
SCS (BRN)
NOGo to step 4.
NOGo to step 4.
Wire side of female terminals
(contd)
11-169
03/07/29 09:22:55 61S0X050_110_0170
PGM-FI System
NOIf the MIL is always off, go to step 6. But if the Does the engine start?
MIL sometimes works normally, first check for
these problems: YESGo to step 8.
11-170
03/07/29 09:22:56 61S0X050_110_0171
11. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 16. Disconnect the 3P connector from each of these
sensors, one at a time, and check for continuity
12. Inspect the ACGS (15A) fuse in the under-hood between body ground and PCM connector
fuse/relay box. terminals A30, A31, and E6 individually.
A short in the wire between the ACGS (15A) fuse Is there continuity?
and the PGM-FI main relay.
A short in the wire between the PGM-FI main YESRepair short to body ground in the wire
relay and the PCM, injectors, or IAC valve. between PCM (A31) and the MAP sensor, the PCM
(A30) and the TP sensor, or the EGR valve position
13. Inspect the No. 1 FUEL PUMP (15A) fuse in the sensor, the PCM (E6), and the FTP sensor.
under-dash fuse/relay box.
NOReplace the sensor that made continuity to
Is the f use OK ? body ground go away when disconnected.
YESGo to step 14. 17. Disconnect the injectors and IAC valve connectors.
NOCheck for these problems: 18. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
A short in the wire between the No. 1 FUEL 19. Measure voltage between body ground and PCM
PUMP (15A) fuse and the PGM-FI main relay. connector terminals A2 and A3 individually.
A short in the wire between the PGM-FI main
relay and the fuel pump. PCM CONNECTOR A (31P)
A faulty PGM-FI main relay or a faulty fuel pump.
IGP2 (YEL/BLK) IGP1 (YEL/BLK)
14. Disconnect PCM connector A (31P) and E (31P).
PCM CONNECTORS
A (31P)
Wire side of female terminals
VCC1
(YEL/
RED) Is there battery voltage?
VCC2 (YEL/BLU)
YESGo to step 16. 20. Reconnect the connectors to the sensors, then
reconnect PCM connectors A (31P) and E (31P).
NOGo to step 17.
(contd)
11-171
03/07/29 09:22:57 61S0X050_110_0172
PGM-FI System
PCM CONNECTOR A (31P) 25. Check for continuity between PCM connector
terminal E16 and body ground.
PG2 (BLK) PG1 (BLK)
PCM CONNECTOR E (31P)
LG2 LG1
(BRN/BLK) (BRN/BLK)
SCS (BRN)
11-172
03/07/29 09:22:57 61S0X050_110_0173
YESGo to step 5.
YESGo to step 4.
(contd)
11-173
03/07/29 09:22:58 61S0X050_110_0174
PGM-FI System
8. Check for continuity between DLC terminal No. 7 11. Disconnect PCM connector A (32P).
and body ground.
12. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
DATA LINK CONNECTOR (DLC)
13. Measure voltage between DLC terminals No. 5 and
No. 7.
K-LINE DATA LINK CONNECTOR (DLC)
(GRY)
GND K-LINE
(BRN/YEL) (GRY)
Is there continuity?
Terminal side of female terminals
YESRepair short to ground in the wire between
DLC terminal No. 7 and the PCM (A21).
Is there 0 V ?
NOGo to step 9.
YESSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
9. Check for continuity between DLC terminal No. 7 (see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
and PCM terminal A21. away with a known-good PCM, replace the original
DATA LINK CONNECTOR (DLC) PCM.
K-LINE (GRY)
Wire side of female terminals
Is there continuity?
11-174
03/07/29 09:22:59 61S0X050_110_0175
B (WHT/GRN)
B
(WHT/GRN)
Terminal side of female terminals
Is there battery voltage? NORepair open in the wire between DLC terminal
No. 5 and G101.
YESGo to step 3.
5. Measure voltage between DLC terminals No. 5 and
NORepair open in the wire between DLC terminal No. 7.
No. 16 and the ACGS (15A) fuse in the under-hood
fuse/relay box. DATA LINK CONNECTOR (DLC)
GND (BLK)
B (WHT/GRN)
Is there 8.5 V or more?
NOGo to step 6.
Is there battery voltage?
6. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
YESGo to step 4.
(contd)
11-175
03/07/29 09:23:00 61S0X050_110_0176
PGM-FI System
8. Check for continuity between DLC terminal No. 7 11. Disconnect PCM connector E (31P).
and body ground.
12. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
DATA LINK CONNECTOR (DLC)
13. Measure voltage between DLC terminals No. 5 and
No. 7.
K-LINE DATA LINK CONNECTOR (DLC)
(GRY)
GND K-LINE
(BRN/BLK) (GRY)
Is there continuity?
Terminal side of female terminals
YESRepair short to ground in the wire between
DLC terminal No. 7 and the PCM (E27).
Is there 0 V ?
NOGo to step 9.
YESSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
9. Check for continuity between DLC terminal No. 7 (see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
and PCM terminal E27. away with a known-good PCM, replace the original
DATA LINK CONNECTOR (DLC) PCM.
K-LINE
(GRY)
Wire side of female terminals
Is there continuity?
11-176
03/07/29 09:23:00 61S0X050_110_0177
Injector Replacement
99-01 models
1. Relieve the fuel pressure (see page 11-215).
2. Remove the intake manifold covers and the intake manifold (see page 9-4).
C
9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
4. Disconnect the vacuum hose and fuel return hose from the fuel pressure regulator (B). Place a rag or a shop towel
over the hoses before disconnecting them.
(contd)
11-177
03/07/29 09:23:01 61S0X050_110_0178
PGM-FI System
D
A
9. Coat the new O-rings (C) with clean engine oil, and put them on the injectors.
11. Coat new seal rings (E) with clean engine oil, and press them into the intake manifold.
14. Connect the vacuum hose and fuel return hose to the fuel pressure regulator.
16. Install the intake manifold and the intake manifold cover (see page 9-7).
17. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), but do not operate the starter. After the fuel pump runs for about 2 seconds, the
fuel pressure in the fuel line rises. Repeat this two or three times, then check for fuel leakage.
11-178
03/07/29 09:23:01 61S0X050_110_0179
02-04 models
1. Relieve the fuel pressure (see page 11-215).
2. Remove the intake manifold covers and the intake manifold (see page 9-4).
9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
B
4. Remove the retainer bolts (B) from the fuel rails (C) and harness holders (D), then discard the O-rings (E).
(contd)
11-179
03/07/29 09:23:02 61S0X050_110_0180
PGM-FI System
8. Coat new O-rings (C) with clean engine oil, and put them on the injectors.
10. Coat new seal rings (E) with clean engine oil, and press them into the intake manifold.
11. Install the fuel injectors and fuel rails into the intake manifold.
14. Install the intake manifold and the intake manifold covers (see page 9-7).
15. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), but do not operate the starter. After the fuel pump runs for approximately 2
seconds, the fuel pressure in the fuel line rises. Repeat this two or three times, then check for fuel leakage.
11-180
03/07/29 09:23:02 61S0X050_110_0181
1. Disconnect the primary HO2S 4P connector (A), 1. Disconnect the secondary HO2S 4P connector (A),
then remove the primary HO2S (B). then remove the secondary HO2S (B).
B A
44 Nm (4.5 kgfm, A
33 lbfft)
B
44 Nm
(4.5 kgfm, 33 lbfft)
11-181
03/07/29 09:23:03 61S0X050_110_0182
11-182
03/07/29 09:23:04 61S0X050_110_0183
DTC Troubleshooting
DTC P0505: Malfunction in Idle Control 7. Put your fingers on the lower port (A) in the throttle
System body.
NOTE: If DTC P1519 is stored at same time as DTC
P0505, troubleshoot DTC P1519 first, then recheck for
DTC P0505.
11-183
03/07/29 09:23:04 61S0X050_110_0184
Is DT C P1519 indicated?
GND (BLK)
YESGo to step 3.
6. Measure voltage between IAC valve 3P connector NORepair open in the wire between the IAC valve
terminal No. 2 and body ground. and G101.
YESGo to step 7.
Wire side of female terminals
NORepair open in the wire between the IAC valve
and the PGM-FI main relay. Is there continuity?
7. Turn the ignition switch OFF. YESRepair short in the wire between the IAC
valve and the PCM (B23).
11-184
03/07/29 09:23:05 61S0X050_110_0185
11. Connect IAC valve 3P connector terminal No. 3 to 15. Measure voltage between body ground and PCM
body ground with a jumper wire. connector terminal B23.
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
IAC VALVE 3P CONNECTOR
IACV (BLK/RED)
(99-00 models:
IACV (BLK/RED)
JUMPER WIRE IACV (BLK/BLU)) (99-00 models:
IACV (BLK/BLU))
12. Check for continuity between PCM connector Is there battery voltage?
terminal B23 and body ground.
YESSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
(see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
away, replace the original PCM.
IACV (BLK/RED)
(99-00 models:
IACV (BLK/BLU))
Is there continuity?
11-185
03/07/29 09:23:05 61S0X050_110_0186
Is DT C P1519 indicated?
GND (BLK)
YESGo to step 3.
6. Measure voltage between IAC valve 3P connector NORepair open in the wire between the IAC valve
terminal No. 2 and body ground. and G101.
IACV (BLK/BLU)
Wire side of female terminals
7. Turn the ignition switch OFF. YESRepair short in the wire between the IAC
valve and the PCM (B23).
11-186
03/07/29 09:23:06 61S0X050_110_0187
11. Connect IAC valve 3P connector terminal No. 3 to 15. Measure voltage between body ground and PCM
body ground with a jumper wire. connector terminal B23.
IAC VALVE 3P CONNECTOR PCM CONNECTOR B (24P)
IACV (BLK/RED)
IACV (BLK/BLU)
JUMPER WIRE
12. Check for continuity between PCM connector Is there battery voltage?
terminal B23 and body ground.
YESSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
PCM CONNECTOR B (24P) (see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
away, replace the original PCM.
IACV (BLK/BLU)
Is there continuity?
11-187
03/07/29 09:23:07 61S0X050_110_0188
6. Reconnect the A/C pressure switch 4P connector. 12. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
7. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 13. Disconnect PCM connector A (32P).
11-188
03/07/29 09:23:07 61S0X050_110_0189
14. Check for continuity between body ground and 16. Measure voltage between PCM connector
PCM connector terminal A27. terminals A27 and B20.
PCM CONNECTOR A (32P) PCM CONNECTORS
A (32P)
ACS (BLU/BLK)
ACS (BLU/RED) B (25P)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
Wire side of female terminals LG1 (BRN/YEL)*
11-189
03/07/29 09:23:08 61S0X050_110_0190
YESGo to step 9.
ACS
(BLU/RED) NOGo to step 15.
Wire side of female terminals
9. Start the engine.
Is there about 5 V ?
10. Turn the blower switch ON.
YESGo to step 5.
11. Turn the A/C switch ON.
NOGo to step 12.
Does the A/ C operate?
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
YESThe air conditioning signal is OK.
6. Reconnect the A/C pressure switch 4P connector.
NOGo to step 16.
7. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
12. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
11-190
03/07/29 09:23:09 61S0X050_110_0191
14. Check for continuity between body ground and 16. Measure voltage between PCM connector
PCM connector terminal E21. terminals A26 and E21.
PCM CONNECTORS
PCM CONNECTOR E (31P)
A (31P)
ACS
(BLU/RED)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
E (31P)
11-191
03/07/29 09:23:09 61S0X050_110_0192
NOTE: Information marked with an asterisk ( ) applies 10. Disconnect the alternator 4P connector.
to 02-04 models.
11. Connect alternator 4P connector terminal No. 4 to
1. Disconnect the alternator 4P connector. body ground with a jumper wire.
2. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). ALTERNATOR 4P CONNECTOR
PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P)
JUMPER WIRE
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
LG1 (BRN/YEL)* C (31P)
ALTF (WHT/RED)
Wire side of female terminals
YESGo to step 4.
6. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with Wire side of female terminals
no load (in Park or neutral) until the radiator fan
comes on, then let it idle. Is there continuity?
Does the voltage decrease when the headlights NORepair open in the wire between the PCM (C5)
and rear window def ogger are turned on? and the alternator.
YESThe alternator FR signal is OK. 13. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
11-192
03/07/29 09:23:10 61S0X050_110_0193
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
Is there continuity?
NOGo to step 8.
(contd)
11-193
03/07/29 09:23:11 61S0X050_110_0194
ALTF (WHT/RED)
ALTF (WHT/RED)
JUMPER WIRE
12. Check for continuity between body ground and Is there continuity?
PCM connector terminal A19.
YESRepair short in the wire between the PCM
PCM CONNECTOR A (31P) (A19) and the alternator.
Is there continuity?
11-194
03/07/29 09:23:11 61S0X050_110_0195
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
STSW
STSW (BLU/ORN) E (31P) (BLU/ORN)
B (25P)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
LG1 (BRN/YEL)* Is there battery voltage?
Wire side of female terminals
YESThe starter switch signal is OK.
Is there battery voltage?
NOGo to step 3.
YESThe starter switch signal is OK.
3. Inspect the No. 13 STARTER SIGNAL (7.5A) fuse in
NOGo to step 3. the drivers under-dash fuse/relay box.
11-195
03/07/29 09:23:12 61S0X050_110_0196
GND (BLK)
PCM CONNECTORS
A (32P) Wire side of female terminals
NOGo to step 6.
PSP SWITCH 2P CONNECTOR
3. Start the engine.
7. Disconnect the PSP switch 2P connector. NORepair open in the wire between the PSP
switch and G201.
8. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
13. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
11-196
03/07/29 09:23:13 61S0X050_110_0197
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
E (31P) PSPSW(GRN)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
Wire side of female terminals
(contd)
11-197
03/07/29 09:23:14 61S0X050_110_0198
PSPSW (GRN)
11. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 18. Disconnect PCM connector E (31P).
12. Check for continuity between PSP switch 2P 19. Check for continuity between body ground and
connector No. 2 terminal and body ground. PCM connector terminal E20.
PSP SWITCH 2P CONNECTOR PCM CONNECTOR E (31P)
PSPSW (GRN)
GND (BLK)
11-198
03/07/29 09:23:14 61S0X050_110_0199
1. Check the brake lights. YESRepair open in the wire between the brake
pedal position switch and the STOP (20A) fuse.
Are the brake lights on without pressing the brake Inspect the brake pedal position switch (see page
pedal? 19-6).
YESInspect the brake switch (see page 19-6). NORepair short in the wire between the PCM
(A32) and the STOP (20A) fuse. Replace the STOP
NOGo to step 2. (20A) fuse.
YESGo to step 3.
NOGo to step 4.
BKSW (WHT/BLK)
B (25P)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
LG1 (BRN/YEL)*
Wire side of female terminals
11-199
03/07/29 09:23:14 61S0X050_110_0200
NOGo to step 2. NORepair short in the wire between the PCM (E9)
and the STOP (20A) fuse. Replace the STOP (20A)
2. Press the brake pedal. fuse.
YESGo to step 3.
NOGo to step 4.
PCM CONNECTORS
A (31P)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
BKSW
E (31P) (WHT/BLK)
11-200
03/07/29 09:24:12 61S0X050_110_0201
11-201
03/07/29 09:24:12 61S0X050_110_0202
Procedure:
1. Make sure all electrical items (A/C, audio, rear
window defogger, lights, etc.,) are off.
11-202
03/07/29 09:24:15 61S0X050_110_0203
FUEL FILTER
Replacement, page 11-229
FUEL RETURN LINE
FUEL GAUGE SENDING UNIT
Test/Replacement,
page 11-234
FUEL TANK
Replacement, page 11-231
FUEL RAIL
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
Replacement, page 11-227
01 model
FUEL TANK
Replacement, page 11-232
FUEL RAIL
(contd)
11-203
03/07/29 09:24:17 61S0X050_110_0204
FUEL PUMP
FUEL VAPOR LINE Test, page 11-218
FUEL FEED LINE Replacement,
page 11-230
FUEL FILTER
Replacement,
page 11-229
FUEL RETURN LINE
FUEL GAUGE SENDING UNIT
Test/Replacement,
page 11-234
FUEL TANK
Replacement, page 11-232
FUEL RAIL
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
Replacement, page 11-228
11-204
03/07/29 09:24:17 61S0X050_110_0205
DTC Troubleshooting
DTC P046103-04 Models: Fuel Level
Sensor (Fuel Gauge Sending Unit) Range/
Performance Problem
NOTE: Because it requires 174 miles (280 km) of driving
without refueling before completing this diagnosis, this
DTC cannot be duplicated during troubleshooting.
1. Remove the fuel tank unit from the fuel tank (see
page 11-232).
3. Reinstall the fuel tank unit on the fuel tank (see page
11-232).
11-205
03/07/29 09:24:18 61S0X050_110_0206
Is DT C P0462 indicated?
YESGo to step 3.
FSL05
(YEL/BLU)
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at
the fuel gauge sending unit, the gauge assembly
and the PCM.
3. Measure voltage between PCM connector terminal Wire side of female terminals
E15 and body ground.
Is there battery voltage?
PCM CONNECTOR E (20P)
YESReplace the fuel gauge sending unit.
NOGo to step 9.
FSL05
Is there 0.9 V or less? (YEL/BLU)
YESGo to step 4.
5. Remove the rear seats and carpet, and the access YESRepair open in the wire between the PCM
panel from the floor. (E15) and the gauge assembly.
11-206
03/07/29 09:24:18 61S0X050_110_0207
10. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 16. Check for continuity between PCM connector
terminal E15 and body ground.
11. Disconnect the PCM connector E (20P).
PCM CONNECTOR E (20P)
12. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
Is there about 5 V ?
11-207
03/07/29 09:24:19 61S0X050_110_0208
YESGo to step 3.
4. Remove the rear seats and carpet, and the access YESGo to step 8.
panel from the floor.
NORepair open in the wire between fuel gauge
5. Disconnect the fuel tank unit 5P connector. sending unit and ground (G551).
6. Measure resistance between fuel tank unit 5P 8. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
connector terminals No. 1 and No. 2.
9. Measure voltage between fuel tank unit 5P
FUEL TANK UNIT 5P CONNECTOR connector terminal No. 2 and body ground.
FUEL TANK UNIT 5P CONNECTOR
FSL05
GND FSL05
(YEL/BLU)
NOReplace the fuel gauge sending unit (see page YESSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
11-234). (see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
away, replace the original PCM.
11-208
03/07/29 09:24:19 61S0X050_110_0209
PG1 (BLK)
6. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), and measure
voltage between body ground and PGM-FI main
relay 7P connector terminal No. 5.
PGM-FI MAIN RELAY 7P CONNECTOR
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 4.
NORepair open in the wire between the PGM-FI Wire side of female terminals
main relay and G101.
Is there battery voltage?
4. Measure voltage between body ground and PGM-FI
main relay 7P connector terminal No. 7. YESGo to step 8.
YESGo to step 6.
NOGo to step 5.
(contd)
11-209
03/07/29 09:24:20 61S0X050_110_0210
STSW (BLU/ORN)
IMOFPR (GRN/YEL)
IMOFPR
(GRN/YEL)
9. Check for a blown No. 13 STARTER SIGNAL (7.5A) 13. Reconnect PCM connector A (32P) and the PGM-FI
fuse in the drivers under-dash fuse/relay box. main relay 7P connector.
11-210
03/07/29 09:24:21 61S0X050_110_0211
15. Measure voltage between PCM connector 19. Connect battery power to PGM-FI main relay 7P
terminals B1 and B2, and between B9 and B2. connector terminal No. 2, and connect PGM-FI
main relay 7P connector terminal No. 1 to ground.
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
Then check for continuity between PGM-FI main
relay 7P connector terminals No. 5 and No. 4.
No. 4
Is there battery voltage? No. 5 No. 6 No. 7
To IGN. 1 To BAT ()
YESGo to step 16.
To GROUND
NOCheck for an open in the wires between the To PCM
(B1, B9)
PGM-FI main relay and the PCM (B1, B9). If the To ST. SWITCH
wires are OK, replace the PGM-FI main relay.
To PCM To FUEL PUMP
16. Turn the ignition switch OFF, then ON (II) again. (A15)
Wire side of female terminals NOReplace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
Is there 1.0 V or less? 21. Connect battery power to PGM-FI main relay 7P
connector terminal No. 6, and connect ground to
YESThe PGM-FI main relay may be faulty. Go to PGM-FI main relay 7P connector terminal No. 1.
step 18. Then check for continuity between PGM-FI main
relay 7P connector terminals No. 5 and No. 4.
NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If the prescribed voltage is now Is there continuity?
available, replace the original PCM.
YESThe PGM-FI main relay is OK.
18. Remove the PGM-FI main relay.
NOReplace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
11-211
03/07/29 09:24:21 61S0X050_110_0212
PG1 (BLK)
6. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), and measure
voltage between body ground and PGM-FI main
relay 7P connector terminal No. 5.
PGM-FI MAIN RELAY 7P CONNECTOR
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 4.
NORepair open in the wire between the PGM-FI Wire side of female terminals
main relay and G101.
Is there battery voltage?
4. Measure voltage between body ground and PGM-FI
main relay 7P connector terminal No. 7. YESGo to step 8.
YESGo to step 6.
NOGo to step 5.
11-212
03/07/29 09:24:22 61S0X050_110_0213
8. Shift to Park, then turn the ignition switch to the 12. Check for continuity between PGM-FI main relay 7P
START (III) position, and measure voltage between connector terminal No. 1 and the PCM connector
body ground and PGM-FI main relay 7P connector terminal E1.
terminal No. 2.
PGM-FI MAIN RELAY 7P CONNECTOR
STSW (BLU/ORN)
IMOFPR
(GRN/YEL)
YESGo to step 10. NORepair open in the wire between the PGM-FI
main relay and the PCM (E1).
NOGo to step 9.
13. Reconnect PCM connector E (31P) and the PGM-FI
9. Check for a blown No. 13 STARTER SIGNAL (7.5A) main relay 7P connector.
fuse in the drivers under-dash fuse/relay box.
14. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
Is the f use blown?
15. Measure voltage between PCM connector
YESRepair short in the wire between the PGM-FI terminals A3 and A5, and between A2 and A5.
main relay and the No. 13 STARTER SIGNAL (7.5A)
fuse. PCM CONNECTOR A (31P)
(contd)
11-213
03/07/29 09:24:23 61S0X050_110_0214
PCM CONNECTORS
NOTE: Use the terminal numbers shown. Ignore
PG1 (BLK) the terminal numbers molded into the relay.
A (31P)
No. 2
No. 1
No. 3
E (31P)
IMOFPR
(GRN/YEL) No. 4
No. 5 No. 6 No. 7
To IGN. 1 To BAT ()
Wire side of female terminals
To GROUND
Is there 1.0 V or less? To PCM
(A2, A3)
To ST. SWITCH
YESThe PGM-FI main relay may be faulty. Go to
step 18. To PCM To FUEL PUMP
(E1)
NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If the prescribed voltage is now Is there continuity?
available, replace the original PCM.
YESGo to step 20.
18. Remove the PGM-FI main relay.
NOReplace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
Is there continuity?
Is there continuity?
11-214
03/07/29 09:24:23 61S0X050_110_0215
A
22 Nm
(2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
B
*: The illustration shows 99-01 models.
11-215
03/07/29 09:24:24 61S0X050_110_0216
A
22 Nm 02-04 models
(2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
07406-0040001
B
*: The illustration shows 99-01 models.
5. Place a rag or shop towel (B) over the fuel pulsation 9. 99-01 models:
damper. Disconnect the vacuum hose (A) of the fuel
pressure regulator, and pinch it closed with a
6. Slowly loosen the fuel pulsation damper one clamp (B). (99-01 models)
complete turn.
10. Reconnect the negative cable to the battery, then
7. Remove the fuel pulsation damper from its fitting, start the engine and let it idle.
and attach the fuel pressure gauge attachment.
If the engine starts, go to step 12 (99-01 models)
07VAJ-0040100 or step 16 (02-04 models).
If the engine does not start, go to step 11.
11-216
03/07/29 09:24:25 61S0X050_110_0217
11-217
03/07/29 09:24:26 61S0X050_110_0218
FUEL PUMP
(BLK/YEL)
GND (BLK)
JUMPER WIRE
11-218
03/07/29 09:24:27 61S0X050_110_0219
99-00 models
01 model
(contd)
11-219
03/07/29 09:24:27 61S0X050_110_0220
11-220
03/07/29 09:24:28 61S0X050_110_0221
99-00 models
Check all hose clamps, and retighten if necessary.
B B
B
B
A
B
To B B
FUEL
PRESSURE
REGULATOR
To
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP)
PURGE CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
1015 mm
(0.390.59 in.) Clamp in the middle.
(contd)
11-221
03/07/29 09:24:28 61S0X050_110_0222
B
B
B
A
B
B
B
A
B
B
B
To B
FUEL
PRESSURE B
B
REGULATOR
To
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP)
CANISTER PURGE VALVE
1015 mm
(0.390.59 in.) Clamp in the middle.
11-222
03/07/29 09:24:29 61S0X050_110_0223
11-223
03/07/29 09:24:30 61S0X050_110_0224
NOTE: B
Be careful not to damage the line (D) or other
parts. 8. To prevent damage and keep foreign matter out,
Do not use tools. cover the disconnected connector and line ends
If the connector does not move, keep the retainer with plastic bags (A).
tabs pressed down, and alternately pull and push
the connector until it comes off easily. NOTE:
Do not remove the retainer from the line; once The retainer cannot be reused once it has been
removed, the retainer must be replaced with a removed from the line.
new one. Replace the retainer when:
11-224
03/07/29 09:24:31 61S0X050_110_0225
A
2. Insert a new retainer (A) into the connector (B) if the
retainer is damaged, or after:
(contd)
11-225
03/07/29 09:24:31 61S0X050_110_0226
A
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable, and turn the
ignition switch ON (II). The fuel pump will run for
about 2 seconds, and fuel pressure will rise. Repeat
two or three times, and check that there is no
leakage in the fuel supply system.
11-226
03/07/29 09:24:32 61S0X050_110_0227
NOTE:
Replace the O-ring.
When assembling the fuel pressure regulator,
apply clean engine oil to the O-ring and assemble
it into its proper position, taking care not to
damage the O-ring.
11-227
03/07/29 09:24:32 61S0X050_110_0228
C 40 5
NOTE:
Replace the O-ring.
When assembling the fuel pressure regulator,
apply clean engine oil to the O-ring and assemble
it into its proper position, taking care not to
damage the O-ring.
11-228
03/07/29 09:24:33 61S0X050_110_0229
1. Remove the fuel tank unit, '99-00 models NOTE: Place the new base gasket for the fuel tank
(see page 11-231), '01-04 models (see page unit on the tank first, then carefully insert the fuel
11-232). tank unit. If the fuel tank unit is incorrectly installed,
the MIL can come on with DTC P1456.
2. Remove the fuel filter (A).
11-229
03/07/29 09:24:33 61S0X050_110_0230
G H
5. Relieve the fuel pressure (see page 11-215).
H E
6. Disconnect the quick-connect fittings from the fuel
tank unit. H
7. Using the tool, loosen the fuel tank unit locknut (A).
F
07XAA-001010A C
D
NOTE: Place the base gasket for the fuel tank unit
on the tank first, then carefully insert the fuel tank
unit. If the fuel tank unit is incorrectly installed, the
MIL can come on with DTC P1456.
11-230
03/07/29 09:24:34 61S0X050_110_0231
3. Drain the fuel tank: Remove the fuel tank unit (see page 11-230). Using a hand pump, hose, and container suitable
for gasoline, draw the fuel from the fuel tank.
7. Remove the strap bolts, and let the straps (A) hang down.
8. Remove the fuel tank (B). If it sticks to the undercoat on its mount, carefully pry it off the mount.
11-231
03/07/29 09:24:34 61S0X050_110_0232
3. Drain the fuel tank unit: Remove the fuel tank unit (see page 11-230). Using a hand pump, hose and container
suitable for gasoline, draw the fuel from the fuel tank.
4. Disconnect the fuel tank vapor vent tube, fuel vapor hoses and quick-connect fittings.
Disconnect the hoses. Slide back the clamps, then twist the hoses as you pull to avoid damaging them.
7. Remove the strap bolts, and let the straps (A) hang down.
8. Remove the fuel tank (B). If it sticks to the undercoat on its mount, carefully pry it off the mount.
11-232
03/07/29 09:24:35 61S0X050_110_0233
11-233
03/07/29 09:24:36 61S0X050_110_0234
1. Turn the ignition switch OFF. When connecting the wire harness, make sure
the connection is secure and the connectors (A)
2. Remove the rear seats and carpet. are firmly locked into place.
Do not fold over the lower part of the suction
3. Remove the access panel from the floor (see page filter (B).
11-223). When installing the fuel gauge sending unit (C),
make sure the connection is secure and the
4. Disconnect the fuel tank unit 5P connector. connector is firmly locked into place. Be careful
not to bend or twist it excessively.
5. Remove the fuel fill cap.
NOTE: Place the base gasket (D) for the fuel tank
6. Relieve the fuel pressure (see page 11-215). unit on the tank first, then carefully insert the fuel
tank unit. If the fuel tank unit is incorrectly installed,
7. Disconnect the quick-connect fittings from the fuel the MIL can come on with DTC P1456.
tank unit.
8. Using the tool, loosen the fuel tank unit locknut (A).
07XAA-001010A
A A
93 Nm (9.5 kgfm, 69 lbfft)
Terminal side of
male terminals
1/2
LOW
E
11-234
03/07/29 09:24:36 61S0X050_110_0235
11-235
03/07/29 09:24:40 61S0X050_110_0236
AIR VALVE
Test, page 11-239
02-04 models:
THROTTLE CABLE
Adjustment, page 11-242
AIR CLEANER
Replacement,
page 11-240
11-236
03/07/29 09:24:40 61S0X050_110_0237
1. With the engine off, check the throttle cable 4. Install the throttle body (see page 11-243).
operation. The cable should move without binding
or sticking. 5. Do the PCM idle learn procedure (see page 11-202).
11-237
03/07/29 09:24:41 61S0X050_110_0238
1. Start the engine, and let it idle. If the vacuum reading changes, check for these
problems:
NOTE: Engine coolant temperature must be below
104F (40C). Misrouted, leaking, broken, or clogged intake air
bypass control thermal system.
2. Remove the vacuum hose (A) from the intake pipe, A cracked or damaged intake air bypass control
and connect a vacuum gauge to the hose. thermal valve.
A973X-041-XXXXX
11-238
03/07/29 09:24:41 61S0X050_110_0239
B
A
11-239
03/07/29 09:24:42 61S0X050_110_0240
2. Remove the cable clamp (A) from the air cleaner housing cover (B).
D B
C
5. Remove the air cleaner element (F) from the air cleaner housing (G).
8. Enter the radio and the navigation system (if equipped) anti-theft codes, then enter the radio presets, set the clock.
11-240
03/07/29 09:24:42 61S0X050_110_0241
2.9 Nm
(0.3 kgfm, 2.2 lbfft)
2.9 Nm
(0.3 kgfm, 2.2 lbfft)
3. Remove the cover (A) and the radiator (B) from the air cleaner housing (C).
11-241
03/07/29 09:24:43 61S0X050_110_0242
B A
A B
11-242
03/07/29 09:24:44 61S0X050_110_0243
99-00 models
SPACER
GASKET
Replace.
GASKET
Replace.
TP SENSOR
01 model
GASKET
Replace. THROTTLE CABLE
MAP SENSOR
CRUISE
CONTROL CABLE
22 Nm
(2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
SPACER
TP SENSOR
(contd)
11-243
03/07/29 09:24:44 61S0X050_110_0244
GASKET
Replace. THROTTLE CABLE
MAP SENSOR
CRUISE
CONTROL CABLE
22 Nm
(2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
SPACER
TP SENSOR
11-244
03/07/29 09:24:46 61S0X050_110_0245
O-RING
O-RING IDLE ADJUSTING SCREW
TP SENSOR IDLE ADJUSTING TP SENSOR
SCREW
IAC VALVE
O-RING
IAC VALVE Replace.
O-RING
Replace.
3.5 Nm
(0.35 kgfm, 2.5 lbfft)
02-04 models
00 model 2.1 Nm
(0.21 kgfm, 1.5 lbfft)
2.1 Nm (0.21 kgfm, 1.5 lbfft) MAP SENSOR
MAP SENSOR O-RING
Replace.
O-RING
Replace.
SPACER O-RING
11-245
03/07/29 09:24:46 61S0X050_110_0246
DTC Troubleshooting
DTC P0420: Catalytic System Efficiency
Below Threshold
NOTE:
If some of the DTCs listed below are stored at the
same time as DTC P0420, troubleshoot those DTCs
first, then recheck for DTC P0420.
Information marked with an asterisk ( ) applies
to 02-04 models.
11-246
03/07/29 09:24:47 61S0X050_110_0247
EGR System
DTC Troubleshooting
DTC P0401: EGR System Insufficient Flow DTC P149199-00, 02-04 Models: EGR
Valve Insufficient Lift
1. Reset the PCM (see page 11-4).
NOTE: Information marked with an asterisk ( ) applies
2. Test-drive under these conditions: to 02-04 models.
Without any electrical load. 1. Reset the PCM (see page 11-4).
Decelerate from 55 mph (88 km/h) for at least 5
seconds. 2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with
no load (in Park or neutral) until the radiator fan
3. Check for a Temporary DTC with the scan tool comes on.
or the HDS.
3. Test-drive the vehicle under load for about 10
Is T emporary DT C P0401 indicated? minutes. Try to keep the engine speed in the
1,7002,500 rpm range.
YESClean the intake manifold EGR port with
carburetor cleaner. Clean the passage inside the 4. Check for a Temporary DTC with the scan tool or
EGR valve with carburetor cleaner, or replace the the HDS.
EGR valve.
Is T emporary DT C P1491 indicated?
NOIntermittent failure, go to step 4.
YESGo to step 5.
4. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
5. Disconnect the EGR valve 6P connector. Check for poor connections or loose terminals at
the EGR valve and at the PCM.
6. Connect the battery positive terminal to EGR valve
connector terminal No. 4. 5. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
EGR GND
11-247
03/07/29 09:24:47 61S0X050_110_0248
EGR System
SG2 (GRN/BLK)
SG2 (GRN/YEL)*
YESSubstitute a known-good PCM, and recheck YESRepair open in the wire between the EGR
(see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes valve and the PCM (C18, C28).
away, replace the original PCM.
NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
NOGo to step 9. (see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
away, replace the original PCM.
9. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
13. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
10. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
14. At the sensor side, measure resistance between
11. Measure voltage between EGR valve 6P connector EGR valve 6P connector terminals No. 1 and No. 2.
terminals No. 2 and No. 3.
EGR VALVE 6P CONNECTOR
EGR VALVE 6P CONNECTOR
SG2 VCC2
(YEL/BLU) EGRP SG2
(GRN/BLK)
SG2
(GRN/YEL)*
11-248
03/07/29 09:24:48 61S0X050_110_0249
15. Measure resistance between EGR valve 6P 20. Check for continuity between PCM connector
connector terminals No. 1 and No. 3. terminal C6 and body ground.
EGR VALVE 6P CONNECTOR
PCM CONNECTOR C (31P)
EGRP (WHT/BLK)
EGRP VCC2
NOGo to step 16. NORepair open in the wire between the EGR
valve and PCM (C6).
16. Reconnect the EGR valve connector.
21. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
17. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
22. Disconnect the EGR valve 6P connector.
18. Measure voltage between PCM connector
terminals C6 and C18. 23. Connect the battery positive terminal to EGR valve
6P connector terminal No. 4 with a jumper wire.
PCM CONNECTORS C (31P)
EGR VALVE 6P CONNECTOR
SG2
EGRP (GRN/BLK)
(WHT/BLK) SG2
(GRN/YEL)*
EGR GND
Is there about 1.2 V ? 24. Start the engine and let it idle, then connect the
battery negative terminal to the EGR valve 6P
YESGo to step 21. connector terminal No. 6 with a jumper wire.
(contd)
11-249
03/07/29 09:24:49 61S0X050_110_0250
EGR System
Is there continuity?
Wire side of female terminals
YESGo to step 30.
GND (BLK)
11-250
03/07/29 09:25:45 61S0X050_110_0251
DTC P149101 Model: EGR Valve 9. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Insufficient Lift
10. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
1. Reset the PCM (see page 11-4).
11. Measure voltage between EGR valve 6P connector
2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with terminals No. 2 and No. 3.
no load (in Park or neutral) until the radiator fan
comes on. EGR VALVE 6P CONNECTOR
YESGo to step 5.
Wire side of female terminals
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at Is there about 5 V ?
the EGR valve and at the PCM.
YESGo to step 13.
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
NOGo to step 12.
6. Disconnect the EGR valve 6P connector.
12. Measure voltage between PCM connector
7. Start the engine, and let it idle. terminals A28 and A30.
8. Measure voltage between EGR valve 6P connector PCM CONNECTOR A (31P)
terminals No. 4 and No. 6.
SG2 VCC2
(GRN/BLK) (YEL/BLU)
Is there about 5 V ?
Wire side of female terminals
YESRepair open in the wire between the EGR
Is there battery voltage? valve and the PCM (A28, A30).
YESSubstitute a known-good PCM, and recheck NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes (see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
away, replace the original PCM. away, replace the original PCM.
NOGo to step 9.
(contd)
11-251
03/07/29 09:25:46 61S0X050_110_0252
EGR System
EGRP SG2
EGRP SG2
(WHT/BLK) (GRN/BLK)
EGRP VCC2
EGRP
(WHT/BLK)
NOGo to step 16. NORepair open in the wire between the EGR
valve and PCM (A16).
16. Reconnect the EGR valve connector.
21. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
17. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
22. Disconnect the EGR valve 6P connector.
11-252
03/07/29 09:25:47 61S0X050_110_0253
23. Connect the battery positive terminal to EGR valve 28. Connect EGR valve 6P connector terminal No. 4 to
6P connector terminal No. 4 with a jumper wire. body ground with a jumper wire.
EGR VALVE 6P CONNECTOR EGR VALVE 6P CONNECTOR
EGR GND
EGR JUMPER WIRE
(PNK)
24. Start the engine, and let it idle. Then connect the 29. Check for continuity between PCM connector
battery negative terminal to EGR valve 6P terminal B3 and body ground.
connector terminal No. 6 with a jumper wire.
PCM CONNECTOR B (24P)
Does the engine stall or run rough?
27. Check for continuity between PCM connector Wire side of female terminals
terminal B3 and body ground.
PCM CONNECTOR B (24P) Is there continuity?
Is there continuity?
(contd)
11-253
03/07/29 09:25:47 61S0X050_110_0254
EGR System
GND (BLK)
Is there continuity?
11-254
03/07/29 09:25:47 61S0X050_110_0255
DTC P149899-00, 02-04 Models: EGR 7. Measure voltage between the PCM connector
Valve Position Sensor Circuit High Voltage terminals C18 and C28.
Is DT C P1498 indicated?
YESGo to step 3.
VCC2 (YEL/BLU)
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time.
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at
the EGR valve and the PCM. Wire side of female terminals
4. Disconnect the EGR valve 6P connector. YESRepair open in the wire between the EGR
valve and the PCM (C18).
5. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
6. Measure voltage between EGR valve 6P connector (see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
terminals No. 2 and No. 3. away, replace the original PCM.
SG2 VCC2
(GRN/BLK) (YEL/BLU)
SG2
(GRN/YEL)*
Is there about 5 V ?
NOGo to step 7.
11-255
03/07/29 09:25:48 61S0X050_110_0256
EGR System
Is DT C P1498 indicated?
YESGo to step 3.
SG2 VCC2
NOIntermittent failure, system is OK at this time. (GRN/BLK) (YEL/BLU)
Check for poor connections or loose terminals at
the EGR valve and the PCM.
Wire side of female terminals
3. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
5. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). YESRepair open in the wire between the EGR
valve and the PCM (A28).
6. Measure voltage between EGR valve 6P connector
terminals No. 2 and No. 3. NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
away, replace the original PCM.
EGR VALVE 6P CONNECTOR
SG2 VCC2
(GRN/BLK) (YEL/BLU)
Is there about 5 V ?
NOGo to step 7.
11-256
03/07/29 09:25:50 61S0X050_110_0257
PCV System
A
99-00 models
B B
01 model
01 model
B
11-257
03/07/29 09:25:52 61S0X050_110_0258
EVAP System
11-258
03/07/29 09:25:55 61S0X050_110_0259
01 model
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP)
PURGE CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Troubleshooting,
step 3 on page 11-274,
step 1 on page 11-287
11-259
03/07/29 09:25:58 61S0X050_110_0260
EVAP System
11-260
03/07/29 09:25:59 61S0X050_110_0261
DTC Troubleshooting
DTC P045199-00, 02-04 Models: FTP 6. Connect a vacuum pump to the open end of the
Sensor Range/Performance Problem hose.
Special Tools Required
Vacuum Pump/Gauge, 030 in.Hg A973X-041-XXXXX
A973X-041-XXXXX
NOTE: Information marked with an asterisk ( ) applies
to 02-04 models.
11-261
03/07/29 09:26:00 61S0X050_110_0262
EVAP System
YESGo to step 4.
SG3 (GRN/BLK)
NOReplace the FTP sensor.
5. Disconnect the hose between the EVAP two way FTP (LT GRN)
valve and the FTP sensor at the EVAP two way
valve end.
Wire side of female terminals
11-262
03/07/29 09:26:00 61S0X050_110_0263
DTC P045299-00, 02-04 Models: FTP 6. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Sensor Circuit Low Voltage
7. Reinstall the fuel fill cap.
NOTE: Information marked with an asterisk ( ) applies
to 02-04 models. 8. Disconnect the FTP sensor 3P connector.
1. Check the vacuum lines at the FTP sensor for 9. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
misrouting, leakage, breakage, and clogging.
10. Measure voltage between FTP sensor 3P connector
Are the vacuum lines OK ? terminals No. 1 and No. 2.
YESGo to step 2. FTP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
NOGo to step 6.
(contd)
11-263
03/07/29 09:26:01 61S0X050_110_0264
EVAP System
FTP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR 1. Check the vacuum lines at the FTP sensor for
misrouting, leakage, breakage, and clogging.
YESGo to step 2.
YESReplace the FTP sensor. 5. Monitor FTP sensor voltage with the HDS, or
measure voltage between body ground and PCM
NOGo to step 12. connector terminal E28.
12. Turn the ignition switch OFF. PCM CONNECTOR E (31P)
11-264
03/07/29 09:26:02 61S0X050_110_0265
6. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 11. Measure voltage between FTP sensor 3P connector
terminals No. 2 and No. 3.
7. Reinstall the fuel fill cap.
FTP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
8. Disconnect the FTP sensor 3P connector.
Is there about 5 V ?
Wire side of female terminals 12. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Is there continuity?
11-265
03/07/29 09:26:02 61S0X050_110_0266
EVAP System
1. Check the vacuum lines of the FTP sensor for 9. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
misrouting, leakage, breakage, and clogging.
10. Measure voltage between FTP sensor 3P connector
Are the vacuum lines OK ? terminals No. 1 and No. 2.
FTP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR
YESGo to step 2.
NOGo to step 6.
11-266
03/07/29 09:26:03 61S0X050_110_0267
11. Measure voltage between FTP sensor 3P connector DTC P045301 Model: FTP Sensor Circuit
terminals No. 2 and No. 3. High Voltage
FTP SENSOR 3P CONNECTOR 1. Check the vacuum lines of the FTP sensor for
misrouting, leakage, breakage, and clogging.
YESGo to step 2.
YESReplace the FTP sensor. 5. Monitor FTP sensor voltage with the HDS, or
measure voltage between body ground and PCM
NOGo to step 12. connector terminal E28.
12. Measure voltage between PCM connector PCM CONNECTOR E (31P)
terminals A29 and C18.
PCM CONNECTORS
A (32P)
C (31P)
(contd)
11-267
03/07/29 09:26:03 61S0X050_110_0268
EVAP System
Is there about 5 V ?
Wire side of female terminals 12. Measure voltage between PCM connector
terminals E7 and E28.
Is there about 5 V ?
PCM CONNECTOR E (31P)
YESGo to step 11.
Is there about 5 V ?
11-268
03/07/29 09:26:04 61S0X050_110_0269
DTC P145699-00 Models: EVAP Control 2. Check the fuel fill cap seal.
System Leakage (fuel tank system)
Is the f uel f ill cap seal missing or damaged?
The fuel system is designed to allow specified YESReplace the fuel fill cap (gray or black
maximum vacuum and pressure conditions. Do not colored cap).
deviate from the vacuum and pressure tests as
indicated in these procedures. Excessive pressure/ NOThe fuel fill cap is OK. Go to step 3.
vacuum would damage the EVAP components or cause
eventual fuel tank failure. EVAP Purge Control Solenoid Valve Test
Special Tools Required 3. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the EVAP purge
Vacuum Pump/Gauge, 030 in.Hg A973X-041-XXXXX control solenoid valve (A), and connect a vacuum
pump to the hose.
NOTE: If DTC P0461 is stored at the same time as DTC
P1456, troubleshoot P0461 first, then recheck for DTC A
P1456.
NOTE: Fresh fuel has a higher volatility that will create 4. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
greater pressure/vacuum. The optimum condition for
testing is fresh fuel and less than a full tank of gas. If 5. Apply vacuum to the hose.
possible, to assist in leak detection, add 1 gallon of
fresh fuel to the tank (as long as it will not fill the tank), Does the valve hold vacuum?
just before starting these procedures.
YESThe EVAP purge control solenoid valve is OK.
Fuel Fill Cap Check Go to step 11.
1. Check the fuel fill cap. It must say If not tightened NOGo to step 6.
3 clicks engine light may come on.
6. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Is the correct f uel f ill cap installed and properly
tightened? 7. Disconnect the EVAP purge control solenoid valve
2P connector.
YESGo to step 2.
(contd)
11-269
03/07/29 09:26:05 61S0X050_110_0270
EVAP System
PCS (RED/YEL)
A973X-041-
XXXXX
Is there continuity? A
YESGo to step 9. 12. Turn the bypass solenoid valve on with the HDS, or
connect PCM connector terminal A3 to body
NOReplace the EVAP purge control solenoid ground with a jumper wire.
valve.
PCM CONNECTOR A (32P)
9. Disconnect PCM connector A (32P).
NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck 16. Disconnect the EVAP bypass solenoid valve 2P
(see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes connector.
away, replace the original PCM.
11-270
03/07/29 09:26:06 61S0X050_110_0271
17. Check for continuity between EVAP bypass Is there battery voltage?
solenoid valve 2P connector terminal No. 2 and
body ground. YESReplace the EVAP bypass solenoid valve (A)
and the O-rings (B).
EVAP BYPASS SOLENOID
VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
NORepair open in the wire between the EVAP
bypass solenoid valve and No. 6 ECU (PCM)
CRUISE CONTROL (15A) fuse.
2WBS (BLU)
20. Plug the upper port (A) of the EVAP two way valve.
A
Is there continuity?
19. Measure voltage between EVAP bypass solenoid 21. While monitoring the FTP sensor voltage with the
valve 2P connector terminal No. 1 and body ground. HDS, or while measuring the voltage between PCM
EVAP BYPASS SOLENOID
connector terminals A29 and C18, slowly pump the
VALVE 2P CONNECTOR vacuum pump until the voltage drops to about
1.5 V.
(contd)
11-271
03/07/29 09:26:07 61S0X050_110_0272
EVAP System
Is there continuity?
24. Apply vacuum to the hose with 5 strokes of the 28. Disconnect PCM connector A (32P).
pump.
29. Check for continuity between EVAP canister vent
Does the valve hold vacuum? shut valve 2P connector terminal No. 2 and body
ground.
YESGo to step 25.
NOThe EVAP canister vent shut valve is OK. Go EVAP CANISTER VENT
SHUT VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
to step 30.
Is there continuity?
11-272
03/07/29 09:26:07 61S0X050_110_0273
Vacuum Hoses and Connections Test DTC P145601 Model: EVAP Control System
Leakage (fuel tank system)
30. Tighten the fuel cap 3 clicks, then monitor the
fuel tank pressure readings with the HDS.
The fuel system is designed to allow specified
31. Start the engine. Let the engine idle for 5 minutes. maximum vacuum and pressure conditions. Do not
deviate from the vacuum and pressure tests as
32. Check the fuel tank pressure sensor readings. indicated in these procedures. Excessive pressure/
vacuum would damage the EVAP components or cause
B E eventual fuel tank failure.
C
Special Tools Required
Vacuum pump/gauge, 030 in.Hg A973X-041-XXXXX
YESGo to step 2.
(contd)
11-273
03/07/29 09:26:08 61S0X050_110_0274
EVAP System
Is there continuity?
NOGo to step 6.
11-274
03/07/29 09:26:09 61S0X050_110_0275
EVAP Bypass Solenoid Valve Test 17. Check for continuity continuity between EVAP
bypass solenoid valve 2P connector terminal No. 2
11. Disconnect both vacuum hoses from the EVAP two and body ground.
way valve (A), and connect a vacuum pump to the EVAP BYPASS SOLENOID
VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
canister port on the two way valve.
2WBS (BLU)
Is there continuity?
A973X-041- YESGo to step 18.
XXXXX
12. Turn the bypass solenoid valve on with the HDS, or 18. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
connect PCM connector terminal E23 to body
ground with a jumper wire. 19. Measure voltage between EVAP bypass solenoid
valve 2P connector terminal No. 1 and body ground.
PCM CONNECTOR E (31P) EVAP BYPASS SOLENOID
VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
IG1 (BLK/YEL)
2WBS (BLU)
JUMPER WIRE
Wire side of female terminals
A
Wire side of female terminals
15. Turn the ignition switch OFF. YESReplace the EVAP bypass solenoid valve (A)
and the O-rings (B).
16. Disconnect the EVAP bypass solenoid valve 2P
connector. NORepair open in the wire between the EVAP
bypass solenoid valve and No. 6 ECU (PCM)
CRUISE CONTROL (15A) fuse.
(contd)
11-275
03/07/29 09:26:10 61S0X050_110_0276
EVAP System
Is there continuity?
11-276
03/07/29 09:26:11 61S0X050_110_0277
28. Disconnect PCM connector E (31P). Vacuum Hoses and Connections Test
29. Check for continuity between EVAP canister vent 30. Do the fuel tank vapor control valve test (see page
shut valve 2P connector terminal No. 2 and body 11-298).
ground.
Is the f uel tank vapor control valve OK ?
EVAP CANISTER VENT
SHUT VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
YESGo to step 31.
VSV 31. Tighten the fuel cap 3 clicks, then monitor the
(LT GRN/WHT) fuel tank pressure readings with the HDS.
32. Start the engine. Let the engine idle for 5 minutes.
11-277
03/07/29 09:26:11 61S0X050_110_0278
EVAP System
The fuel system is designed to allow specified YESReplace the fuel fill cap (gray or black
maximum vacuum and pressure conditions. Do not colored cap).
deviate from the vacuum and pressure tests as
indicated in these procedures. Excessive pressure/ NOThe fuel fill cap is OK. Go to step 3.
vacuum would damage the EVAP components or cause
eventual fuel tank failure. EVAP Canister Purge Valve Test
Special Tools Required 3. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the EVAP
Vacuum pump/gauge, 030 in.Hg A973X-041-XXXXX canister purge valve (A), and connect a vacuum
pump to the hose.
NOTE: If DTC P0461 is stored at the same time as DTC
P1456, troubleshoot P0461 first, then recheck for DTC
P1456.
NOTE: Fresh fuel has a higher volatility that will create 4. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
greater pressure/vacuum. The optimum condition for
testing is fresh fuel and less than a full tank of gas. If 5. Apply vacuum to the hose.
possible, to assist in leak detection, add 1 gallon of
fresh fuel to the tank (as long as it will not fill the tank), Does the valve hold vacuum?
just before starting these procedures.
YESThe EVAP canister purge valve is OK. Go to
Fuel Fill Cap Check step 11.
1. Check the fuel fill cap. It must say If not tightened NOGo to step 6.
3 clicks check engine light may come on.
6. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Is the correct f uel f ill cap installed and properly
tightened? 7. Disconnect the EVAP canister purge valve 2P
connector.
YESGo to step 2.
11-278
03/07/29 09:26:12 61S0X050_110_0279
8. Check for continuity between EVAP canister purge EVAP Bypass Solenoid Valve Test
valve 2P connector terminal No. 2 and body ground.
11. Disconnect both vacuum hoses from the EVAP two
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VALVE
way valve (A), and connect a vacuum pump to the
canister port on the two way valve.
PCS (RED/YEL)
Is there continuity?
A
YESGo to step 9.
12. Turn the bypass solenoid valve on with the HDS, or
NOReplace the EVAP canister purge valve. connect PCM connector terminal A3 to body
ground with a jumper wire.
9. Disconnect PCM connector A (32P).
PCM CONNECTOR A (32P)
10. Check for continuity between EVAP canister purge
valve 2P connector terminal No. 2 and body ground.
2WBS (BLU)
JUMPER WIRE
PCS (RED/YEL)
YESRepair short in the wire between the EVAP YESGo to step 15.
canister purge valve and the PCM (A6).
NOGo to step 20.
NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes 15. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
away, replace the original PCM.
16. Disconnect the EVAP bypass solenoid valve 2P
connector.
(contd)
11-279
03/07/29 09:26:13 61S0X050_110_0280
EVAP System
2WBS (BLU) 20. Plug the upper port (A) of the EVAP two way valve.
A
Is there continuity?
19. Measure voltage between EVAP bypass solenoid 21. While monitoring the FTP sensor voltage with the
valve 2P connector terminal No. 1 and body ground. HDS, or while measuring the voltage between PCM
connector terminals A29 and C18, slowly pump the
EVAP BYPASS SOLENOID
VALVE 2P CONNECTOR vacuum pump until the voltage drops to about
1.5 V.
11-280
03/07/29 09:26:14 61S0X050_110_0281
Is there continuity?
24. Apply vacuum to the hose with 5 strokes of the 28. Disconnect PCM connector A (32P).
pump.
29. Check for continuity between EVAP canister vent
Does the valve hold vacuum? shut valve 2P connector terminal No. 2 and body
ground.
YESGo to step 25.
EVAP CANISTER VENT
SHUT VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
NOThe EVAP canister vent shut valve is OK. Go
to step 30.
(contd)
11-281
03/07/29 09:26:15 61S0X050_110_0282
EVAP System
31. Tighten the fuel cap 3 clicks, then monitor the Special Tools Required
fuel tank pressure readings with the HDS. Vacuum pump/gauge, 030 in.Hg A973X-041-XXXXX
32. Start the engine. Let the engine idle for 5 minutes. NOTE: If DTC P0461 is stored at the same time as
DTC P1457, troubleshoot P0461 first, then recheck for
33. Check the FTP sensor readings. DTC P1457.
YESSubstitute a known-good PCM and retest EVAP Purge Control Solenoid Valve Test
(see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
away, replace the original PCM. 1. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the EVAP purge
control solenoid valve (A), and connect a vacuum
NOCheck these parts for leaks: pump to the hose.
Fuel tank (A) A
Fuel fill cap (B)
Fuel fill pipe (C)
Fuel tank vapor control valve (D) A973X-
041-XXXXX
Fuel tank vapor recirculation valve (E)
Fuel tank vapor recirculation tube (F)
Fuel tank vapor signal tube (G)
Fuel tank vapor vent tube (H)
EVAP two way valve (I)
FTP sensor (J)
Repair or replace any leaking parts.
11-282
03/07/29 09:26:16 61S0X050_110_0283
2. Turn the EVAP purge control solenoid valve on with Is there continuity?
the HDS, or connect PCM connector terminal A6 to
body ground with a jumper wire. YESGo to step 8.
PCM CONNECTOR A (32P) NORepair open in the wire between the EVAP
purge control solenoid valve and the PCM (A6).
PCS (RED/YEL)
8. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
NOThe EVAP purge control solenoid valve is OK. Is there battery voltage?
Go to step 10.
YESReplace the EVAP purge control solenoid
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF. valve.
6. Disconnect the EVAP purge control solenoid valve NORepair open in the wire between the EVAP
2P connector. purge control solenoid valve and No. 6 ECU (PCM)
CRUISE CONTROL (15A) fuse.
7. Check for continuity between EVAP purge control
solenoid valve 2P connector terminal No. 2 and EVAP Bypass Solenoid Valve Test
body ground.
10. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the EVAP two
EVAP PURGE CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE 2P CONNECTOR way valve (A), and connect a vacuum pump to the
hose.
PCS (RED/YEL)
A973X-041-
XXXXX
(contd)
11-283
03/07/29 09:26:17 61S0X050_110_0284
EVAP System
12. Apply vacuum to the hose. 17. Check for continuity between EVAP bypass
solenoid valve 2P connector terminal No. 2 and
Does the valve hold vacuum? body ground.
EVAP BYPASS SOLENOID
YESThe EVAP bypass solenoid valve/EVAP two VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
way valve is OK. Go to step 18.
2WBS (BLU)
NOSubstitute a known-good PCM and recheck
(see page 11-5). If the symptom/indication goes
away, replace the original PCM.
B
A973X-041-XXXXX A
Is there continuity?
11-284
03/07/29 09:26:18 61S0X050_110_0285
19. Turn the EVAP canister vent shut valve on with the Is there continuity?
HDS, or connect PCM connector terminal A4 to
body ground with a jumper wire. YESGo to step 25.
PCM CONNECTOR A (32P) NORepair open in the wire between the EVAP
canister vent shut valve and PCM (A4).
IG1 (BLK/YEL)
20. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
YESThe EVAP control canister vent shut valve is Wire side of female terminals
OK. Go to step 27.
B
NOGo to step 22.
(contd)
11-285
03/07/29 09:26:19 61S0X050_110_0286
EVAP System
27. Turn the ignition switch OFF. Does the voltage drop to 1.5 V and hold f or at
least 20 seconds?
28. Connect 2 three-way T-fittings (A) into the hose
from the EVAP canister to the EVAP two way valve. YESInspect the EVAP canister vent shut valve
Connect the FTP sensor to one of the T-fittings and line and connections.
the vacuum pump to the other.
NOGo to step 34.
A
34. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
A
A973X-041-XXXXX
29. Remove the vent hose from the EVAP canister vent
shut valve (A) and cap the port (B) to seal the fresh B
A973X-041-XXXXX
air vent of the EVAP canister.
B A
36. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
30. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). Does the voltage drop to 1.5 V and hold f or at
least 20 seconds?
31. While monitoring FTP sensor voltage with the HDS,
or while measuring voltage between PCM YESInspect the EVAP purge control solenoid
connector terminals A29 and C18, slowly pump the valve line and connections. If they are OK, do the
vacuum pump every 12 seconds. EVAP two way valve test (see page 11-297).
32. Continue to pump vacuum until the voltage drops NOReplace the EVAP canister.
to about 1.5 V. Make sure that the engine coolant
temperature is still above 95F (35C) and your
vacuum pump does not have a leak.
11-286
03/07/29 09:26:20 61S0X050_110_0287
DTC P145701 Model: EVAP Control System 2. Turn the EVAP canister purge valve on with the
Leakage (EVAP canister system) HDS, or connect PCM connector terminal E11 to
body ground with a jumper wire.
The fuel system is designed to allow specified PCM CONNECTOR E (31P)
maximum vacuum and pressure conditions. Do not
deviate from the vacuum and pressure tests as
indicated in these procedures. Excessive pressure/ PCS
vacuum would damage the EVAP components or cause (RED/YEL)
eventual fuel tank system failure.
JUMPER WIRE
Special Tools Required
Vacuum pump/gauge, 030 in.Hg A973X-041-XXXXX
Wire side of female terminals
NOTE: If DTC P0461 is stored at the same time as DTC
P1457, troubleshoot P0461 first, then recheck for DTC
P1457. 3. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
This is a two trip code; once cleared, it cannot be 4. Apply vacuum to the hose.
reproduced in one trip. Also, certain specific driving
and ambient conditions must occur before the PCM will Does the valve hold vacuum?
complete the system checks. Additional test drives may
still not meet the specific conditions needed to YESGo to step 5.
reproduce the code. Use the test drive procedures for
setting the readiness code (see page 11-89). NOThe EVAP canister purge valve is OK. Go to
step 10.
Follow these troubleshooting procedures carefully to
ensure the integrity of the system and to confirm the 5. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
cause of the problem or code.
6. Disconnect the EVAP canister purge valve 2P
NOTE: Fresh fuel has a high volatility that creates connector.
greater pressure/vacuum. The optimum condition for
testing is fresh fuel, and there must be less than a full 7. Check for continuity between EVAP canister purge
tank of fuel. If possible, to assist in leak detection, add 1 valve 2P connector terminal No. 1 and body ground.
gallon of fresh fuel to the tank (as long as it will not fill EVAP CANISTER PURGE
the tank), just before starting these procedures. VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
A973X-
041-XXXXX
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 8.
(contd)
11-287
03/07/29 09:26:21 61S0X050_110_0288
EVAP System
9. Measure voltage between EVAP canister purge 12. Apply vacuum to the hose.
valve 2P connector terminal No. 2 and body ground.
Does the valve hold vacuum?
EVAP CANISTER PURGE
VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
YESThe EVAP bypass solenoid valve/EVAP two
way valve is OK. Go to step 18.
A973X-041-
XXXXX
B
A
Is there continuity?
11-288
03/07/29 09:26:22 61S0X050_110_0289
16. Disconnect PCM connector E (31P). 19. Turn the EVAP canister vent shut valve on with the
HDS, or connect PCM connector terminal E22 to
17. Check for continuity between EVAP bypass body ground with a jumper wire.
solenoid valve 2P connector terminal No. 2 and
body ground. PCM CONNECTOR E (31P)
YESRepair short in the wire between the EVAP YESThe EVAP canister vent shut valve is OK. Go
bypass solenoid valve and the PCM (E23). to step 27.
EVAP Canister Vent Shut Valve Test 23. Disconnect the EVAP canister vent shut valve 2P
connector.
18. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the EVAP
canister vent filter (A), and connect a vacuum pump 24. Check for continuity between EVAP canister vent
to the hose. shut valve 2P connector terminal No. 2 and body
ground.
EVAP CANISTER VENT
SHUT VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
VSV
(LT GRN/WHT)
(contd)
11-289
03/07/29 09:26:23 61S0X050_110_0290
EVAP System
26. Measure voltage between EVAP canister vent shut 27. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
valve 2P connector terminal No. 1 and body ground.
28. Connect 2 three-way T-fittings (A) into the hose
EVAP CANISTER VENT from the EVAP canister to the EVAP two way valve.
SHUT VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
Connect the FTP sensor to one of the T-fittings and
the vacuum pump to the other.
A
IG1 (BLK/YEL)
A
B
A973X-041-XXXXX
29. Remove the vent hose from the EVAP canister vent
shut valve (A) and cap the port (B) to seal the fresh
air vent of the EVAP canister.
B
A
A
11-290
03/07/29 09:26:23 61S0X050_110_0291
33. Monitor the voltage for 20 seconds. 40. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Does the voltage drop to 1.5 V and hold f or at 41. Disconnect the purge line hose (A) from the
least 20 seconds? canister at the metal line, and plug the hose (B).
YESInspect the EVAP canister vent shut valve A
line and connections.
35. Disconnect the fuel tank vapor vent tube (A) from
the canister at the metal line and plug the hose (B).
B B
A
A973X-041-XXXXX
37. While monitoring FTP sensor voltage with the HDS, 45. Monitor the voltage for 20 seconds.
or while measuring voltage between PCM
connector terminals E7 and E28, slowly pump the Does the voltage drop to 1.5 V and hold f or at
vacuum pump every 12 seconds. least 20 seconds?
38. Continue to pump vacuum until the voltage drops YESInspect the EVAP canister purge valve line
to about 1.5 V. Make sure that the engine coolant and connections. If they are OK, do the EVAP two
temperature is still above 95F (35C) and your way valve test (see page 11-297). If the line, the
vacuum pump does not have a leak. connections, and the EVAP two way valve are OK,
replace the EVAP canister purge valve.
39. Monitor the voltage for 20 seconds.
NOReplace the EVAP canister.
Does the voltage drop to 1.5 V and hold f or at
least 20 seconds?
11-291
03/07/29 09:26:24 61S0X050_110_0292
EVAP System
NOTE: If DTC P0461 is stored at the same time as DTC Wire side of female terminals
This is a two trip code; once cleared, it cannot be 4. Apply vacuum to the hose.
reproduced in one trip. Also, certain specific driving
and ambient conditions must occur before the PCM will Does the valve hold vacuum?
complete the system checks. Additional test drives may
still not meet the specific conditions needed to YESGo to step 5.
reproduce the code. Use the test drive procedures for
setting the readiness code (see page 11-89). NOThe EVAP canister purge valve is OK. Go to
step 10.
Follow these troubleshooting procedures carefully to
ensure the integrity of the system and to confirm the 5. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
cause of the problem or code.
6. Disconnect the EVAP canister purge valve 2P
NOTE: Fresh fuel has a high volatility that creates connector.
greater pressure/vacuum. The optimum condition for
testing is fresh fuel, and there must be less than a full 7. Check for continuity between EVAP canister purge
tank of fuel. If possible, to assist in leak detection, add 1 valve 2P connector terminal No. 2 and body ground.
gallon of fresh fuel to the tank (as long as it will not fill EVAP CANISTER PURGE
the tank), just before starting these procedures. VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
Is there continuity?
A973X-041-
XXXXX
YESGo to step 8.
11-292
03/07/29 09:26:25 61S0X050_110_0293
8. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 12. Apply vacuum to the hose.
9. Measure voltage between EVAP canister purge Does the valve hold vacuum?
valve 2P connector terminal No. 1 and body ground.
YESEVAP bypass solenoid valve/EVAP two way
EVAP CANISTER PURGE valve is OK. Go to step 18.
VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
A973X-041-
XXXXX
B
A
Is there continuity?
11. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
YESGo to step 16.
(contd)
11-293
03/07/29 09:26:26 61S0X050_110_0294
EVAP System
YESRepair short in the wire between the EVAP YESThe EVAP canister vent shut valve is OK. Go
bypass solenoid valve and the PCM (A3). to step 27.
EVAP Canister Vent Shut Valve Test 23. Disconnect the EVAP canister vent shut valve 2P
connector.
18. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the EVAP
canister vent filter (A), and connect a vacuum pump 24. Check for continuity between EVAP canister vent
to the hose. shut valve 2P connector terminal No. 2 and body
ground.
EVAP CANISTER VENT
SHUT VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
VSV
(LT GRN/WHT)
11-294
03/07/29 09:26:27 61S0X050_110_0295
25. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). Canister System Leak Test
26. Measure voltage between EVAP canister vent shut 27. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
valve 2P connector terminal No. 1 and body ground.
28. Connect 2 three-way T-fittings (A) into the hose
EVAP CANISTER VENT from the EVAP canister to the EVAP two way valve.
SHUT VALVE 2P CONNECTOR
Connect the FTP sensor to one of the T-fittings and
the vacuum pump to the other.
A
IG1 (BLK/YEL)
A
B
A973X-041-XXXXX
29. Remove the vent hose from the EVAP canister vent
shut valve (A) and cap the port (B) to seal the fresh
air vent of the EVAP canister.
B
A
A
(contd)
11-295
03/07/29 09:26:28 61S0X050_110_0296
EVAP System
Does the voltage drop to 1.5 V and hold f or at 41. Disconnect the purge line hose (A) from the
least 20 seconds? canister at the metal line, and plug the hose (B).
YESInspect the EVAP canister vent shut valve A
line and connections.
35. Disconnect the fuel tank vapor vent tube (A) from
the canister at the metal line, and plug the hose (B).
B B
A
A973X-041-XXXXX
37. While monitoring FTP sensor voltage with the HDS, 45. Monitor the voltage for 20 seconds.
or measuring voltage between PCM connector
terminals A29 and C18, slowly pump the vacuum Does the voltage drop to 1.5 V and hold f or at
pump every 12 seconds. least 20 seconds?
38. Continue to pump vacuum until the voltage drops YESInspect the EVAP canister purge valve line
to about 1.5 V. Make sure that the engine coolant and connections. If they are OK, do the EVAP two
temperature is still above 95F (35C) and your way valve test (see page 11-297). It the line, the
vacuum pump does not have a leak. connections, and the EVAP two way valve are OK,
replace the EVAP canister purge valve.
39. Monitor the voltage for 20 seconds.
NOReplace the EVAP canister.
Does the voltage drop to 1.5 V and hold f or at
least 20 seconds?
11-296
03/07/29 09:26:29 61S0X050_110_0297
1. Remove the fuel fill cap. If the pressure momentarily stabilizes (valve
opens) above 1.0 kPa (0.3 in.Hg, 8 mmHg), the
2. Disconnect the vapor line from the EVAP two way valve is OK.
valve (A), and connect it to a T-fitting (B) from the If the pressure stabilizes below 1.0 kPa (0.3 in.Hg,
vacuum gauge and the vacuum pump as shown. 8 mmHg), install a new valve and retest.
07JAZ-001000B
A A973X-041-
B XXXXX
07JAZ-001000B
A A973X-041-
XXXXX
11-297
03/07/29 09:26:30 61S0X050_110_0298
EVAP System
9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm, 6. Plug the fuel tank vapor recirculation port (B).
7.2 lbfft)
A
9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft)
11-298
03/07/29 09:26:31 61S0X050_110_0299
Valve Test 5. Disconnect the fuel tank vapor signal tube (A).
1. Make sure the fuel tank is less than half full.
A
2. Remove the fuel fill cap.
9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft)
C A
A973X-041-
XXXXX
B
D E
(contd)
11-299
03/07/29 09:26:31 61S0X050_110_0300
EVAP System
11-300
03/07/29 09:26:32 61S0X050_110_0301
9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft)
A
9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft)
11-301
03/07/29 09:29:07 61S0X050_140_0001
To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could lead to personal injury or death in the event of a severe frontal
collision, all SRS service work must be performed by an authorized Honda dealer.
Improper service procedures, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, could lead to personal injury
caused by unintentional deployment of the airbags and/or side airbags.
Do not bump the SRS unit. Otherwise, the system may fail in a collision, or airbags may deploy if the ignition switch
is ON (II).
SRS electrical connectors are identified by yellow color coding. Related components are located in the steering
column, front console, dashboard, dashboard lower panel, in the dashboard above the glove box, in the front seats,
and around the floor. Do not use electrical test equipment on these circuits.
03/07/29 09:29:07 61S0X050_140_0002
Transaxle
03/07/29 09:29:07 61S0X050_140_0003
03/07/29 09:29:09 61S0X050_140_0004
4-speed
Automatic Transmission
(1999-2001 Models)
Automatic Transmission Transmission End Cover
Special Tools ................................................... 14-2 End Cover and Idler Gear Removal .............. 14-188
* General Troubleshooting Information ......... 14-3 Park Lever Stop Inspection and
DTC Troubleshooting Index .......................... 14-7 Adjustment .................................................. 14-190
Symptom Troubleshooting Index ................. 14-9 End Cover and Idler Gear Installation ........... 14-231
System Description ........................................ 14-18
DTC Troubleshooting Transmission Housing
1999-2000 Models ....................................... 14-70 Housing and Shaft Assembly Removal ........ 14-191
2001 Model .................................................. 14-96 Bearing Removal and Installation ................. 14-193
Road Test ........................................................ 14-125 Shaft Assembly and Housing
Stall Speed Test .............................................. 14-127 Installation ................................................... 14-228
Pressure Test .................................................. 14-128
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Valve Body
Valve-Shift Solenoid Valve A Test ............ 14-130 Valve Body and ATF Strainer
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Removal ....................................................... 14-194
Valve-Shift Solenoid Valve A Valve Body Repair .......................................... 14-196
Replacement ............................................... 14-130 Valve Body Valve Installation ........................ 14-197
Shift Solenoid Valve B and C Test ................ 14-131 Main Valve Body Disassembly,
Shift Solenoid Valve B and C Inspection, and Reassembly ..................... 14-198
Replacement ............................................... 14-131 ATF Pump Inspection ..................................... 14-200
A/T Clutch Pressure Control Solenoid Regulator Valve Body Disassembly,
Valve A and B Test ...................................... 14-132 Inspection, and Reassembly ..................... 14-201
A/T Clutch Pressure Control Solenoid Servo Body Disassembly,
Valve A and B Replacement ...................... 14-133 Inspection, and Reassembly ..................... 14-202
Mainshaft and Countershaft Speed Sensor Accumulator Body Disassembly,
Replacement ............................................... 14-134 Inspection, and Reassembly ..................... 14-203
2nd Clutch Pressure Switch Valve Body and ATF Strainer
Replacement ............................................... 14-135 Installation ................................................... 14-226
3rd Clutch Pressure Switch
Replacement ............................................... 14-135 Torque Converter Housing
ATF Level Check ............................................. 14-136 Mainshaft Bearing and Oil Seal
ATF Replacement ........................................... 14-137 Replacement ............................................... 14-204
Transmission Removal .................................. 14-138 Countershaft Bearing Replacement ............. 14-205
Drive Plate Removal and Installation ........... 14-146 Secondary Shaft Bearing Replacement ....... 14-205
Transmission Installation .............................. 14-147
ATF Cooler Flushing ....................................... 14-155 Shafts and Clutches
ATF Cooler Hose Replacement ..................... 14-156 Mainshaft Disassembly, Inspection,
* Shift Lever Removal ....................................... 14-157 and Reassembly ......................................... 14-206
* Shift Lever Installation ................................... 14-158 3rd/4th Clutch Clearance Inspection ............. 14-207
Shift Lever Disassembly/Reassembly .......... 14-159 Mainshaft Sealing Ring Replacement .......... 14-208
* Shift Cable Replacement ............................... 14-160 Countershaft Disassembly,
* Shift Cable Adjustment .................................. 14-162 Inspection, and Reassembly ...................... 14-209
Countershaft Reverse Selector Hub,
A/T Gear Position Indicator 3rd Gear, and 1st Gear Removal ............... 14-210
Component Location Index ........................... 14-164 Countershaft Reverse Selector Hub,
Circuit Diagram ............................................... 14-165 3rd Gear, and 1st Gear Installation ........... 14-211
D4 Indicator Circuit Troubleshooting Countershaft Bearing Hub/Bearing
1999-2000 Models ....................................... 14-166 Replacement ............................................... 14-212
2001 Model .................................................. 14-169 Secondary Shaft Disassembly, Inspection,
* Indicator Input Test ........................................ 14-172 and Reassembly ......................................... 14-213
Transmission Range Switch Test ................. 14-173 Secondary Shaft Clearance Inspection ........ 14-214
Transmission Range Switch Secondary Shaft Idler Gear Bearing
Replacement ............................................... 14-174 Replacement ............................................... 14-216
* Indicator Bulb Replacement .......................... 14-176 Clutch Disassembly ........................................ 14-217
Clutch Inspection ............................................ 14-220
A/T Interlock System Clutch Reassembly ......................................... 14-222
Component Location Index ........................... 14-177
Circuit Diagram ............................................... 14-178 A/T Differential
Interlock System Troubleshooting Component Location Index ........................... 14-237
Shift Lock System Circuit ........................... 14-179 Backlash Inspection ........................................ 14-237
Key Interlock System Circuit ...................... 14-182 Differential Carrier, Final Driven Gear
* Control Unit Input Test ................................... 14-184 Replacement ............................................... 14-238
* Key Interlock Solenoid/Switch Test .............. 14-185 Carrier Bearing Replacement ........................ 14-238
* Shift Lock Solenoid Test ................................ 14-185 Oil Seal Replacement ..................................... 14-239
* Shift Lock Solenoid Replacement ................. 14-186 Carrier Bearing Outer Race
* Park Pin Switch Test ....................................... 14-187 Replacement ............................................... 14-240
Carrier Bearing Preload Inspection ............... 14-241
03/07/29 09:29:12 61S0X050_140_0005
Automatic Transmission
Special Tools
Ref. No. Tool Number Description Qty
07GAB-PF50101 or 07GAB-PF50100 Mainshaft Holder 1
07GAD-PG40101 or 07GAD-PG40100 Seal Driver Attachment 1
07GAE-PG40200 or 07GAE-PG4020A Clutch Spring Compressor Bolt Assembly 1
* 07HAC-PK40102 Housing Puller 1
07HAD-SF10100 Driver Attachment 1
07JAD-PH80101 Oil Seal Driver Attachment 1
07LAD-PW50601 Attachment, 40 x 50 mm 1
** 07LAE-PX40100 Clutch Spring Compressor Attachment 2
07MAJ-PY4011A A/T Pressure Hose, 2,210 mm 4
07MAJ-PY40120 A/T Pressure Hose Adapter 4
07SAZ-001000A Backprobe Set 2
07XAA-001030A Engine Support Fixture 1
07XAJ-S0KA100 Preload Inspection Tool 1
07ZAE-PRP0100 Clutch Compressor Attachment 1
07406-0020400 or 07406-0020401 A/T Oil Pressure Gauge Set w/Panel 1
*** 07736-A01000B or 07736-A01000A Adjustable Bearing Puller, 2540 mm 1
07746-0010300 Attachment, 42 x 47 mm 1
07746-0010500 Attachment, 62 x 68 mm 1
07746-0010600 Attachment, 72 x 75 mm 1
07746-0030100 Driver, 40 mm I.D. 1
07749-0010000 Driver 1
07947-6340500 Driver Attachment 1
* If the top arm is too short, replace it with 07SAC-P0Z01001.
** 07HAE-PL50101 may be used to substitute one of these tools.
*** Must be used with commercially available 3/8-16 slide hammer.
14-2
03/07/29 09:29:13 61S0X050_140_0006
When the data link connector (DLC) (A) (located under 5. Clear the DTC and data.
the steering column lower cover) is connected to the
Scan Tool or Honda Diagnostic System (HDS), it will NOTE: You can also reset the memory by removing
indicate the diagnostic trouble code (DTC) when the the No. 13 fuse in the passengers under-dash fuse/
ignition switch is turned ON (II). relay box for more than 10 seconds. If you do, you
need to do the following:
Get the customers radio and navigation (if
equipped) anti-theft code, and write down the
radio and navigation presets.
Enter the radio and navigation (if equipped) anti-
theft code, reset the preset stations, and set the
clock.
Do the idle learn procedure (see page 11-202).
(contd)
14-3
03/07/29 09:29:14 61S0X050_140_0007
Automatic Transmission
ON
OFF
Example: DTC 15
14-4
03/07/29 09:29:14 61S0X050_140_0008
How to Troubleshoot Circuits at the PCM Clear A/T DTCs, and PCM Reset Procedures
Special Tools Required 1. Connect the Scan Tool or the HDS to the DLC.
Backprobe set 07SAZ-001000A (two required)
2. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
1. Pull back the carpet from passengers side of the
center lower console to expose the PCM. 3. Clear the DTC(s) with the Scan Tool or the HDS.
2. Inspect the circuit on the PCM, according to the NOTE: You can also reset the memory by removing
DTC troubleshooting, with the special tools and a the No. 13 fuse in the passengers under-dash fuse/
digital multimeter. relay box for more than 10 seconds. If you do, you
need to do the following:
3. Connect the backprobe adapters (A) to the stacking Get the customers radio and navigation (if
patch cords (B), and connect the cords to a equipped) anti-theft code, and write down the
multimeter (C). radio and navigation presets.
Enter the radio and navigation (if equipped) anti-
theft code, reset the preset stations, and set the
clock.
C Do the idle learn procedure (see page 11-202).
A
B 07SAZ-001000A
07SAZ-001000A
(contd)
14-5
03/07/29 09:29:14 61S0X050_140_0009
Automatic Transmission
14-6
03/07/29 09:29:15 61S0X050_140_0010
NOTE: Record all freeze data and review General Troubleshooting information (see page 14-3) before you
troubleshoot.
(1)
DTC D4 Indicator MIL Detection Item Page
(2)
P0753 (7) Blinks ON Shift control solenoid valve A (see page 14-75)
(2)
P0758 (8) Blinks ON Shift control solenoid valve B (see page 14-77)
(2)
P0763 (22) Blinks ON Shift control solenoid valve C (see page 14-79)
(2)
P1705 (5) Blinks ON A/T gear position switch (short to ground) (see page 14-81)
(2)
P1706 (6) OFF ON A/T gear position switch (open) (see page 14-84)
P1738 (25) OFF OFF 2nd clutch pressure switch (see page 14-86)
P1739 (26) OFF OFF 3rd clutch pressure switch (see page 14-88)
P1753 (1) Blinks ON Lock-up control solenoid valve (see page 14-90)
(2)
P1768 (16) Blinks ON A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve A (see page 14-92)
(2)
P1773 (23) Blinks ON A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve B (see page 14-94)
(1): The DTC in parentheses is the code the D4 indicator indicates when the data link connector (DLC) is connected to
the HDS, and the HDS is in the SCS mode.
(2): This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the
transmission.
14-7
03/07/29 09:29:15 61S0X050_140_0011
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: Record all freeze data and review General Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before you
troubleshoot.
(1)
DTC D4 Indicator MIL Detection Item Page
(2)
P0753 (7) Blinks ON Shift solenoid valve A (see page 14-101)
(2)
P0758 (8) Blinks ON Shift solenoid valve B (see page 14-103)
(2)
P0763 (22) Blinks ON Shift solenoid valve C (see page 14-105)
P0780 (45) Blinks ON Mechanical problem in hydraulic system (see page 14-107)
(2)
P1705 (5) Blinks ON Transmission range switch (short to ground) (see page 14-108)
(2)
P1706 (6) OFF ON Transmission range switch (open) (see page 14-111)
P1738 (25) OFF OFF 2nd clutch pressure switch (see page 14-113)
P1739 (26) OFF OFF 3rd clutch pressure switch (see page 14-115)
P1750 (46) Blinks ON Mechanical problem in hydraulic system (see page 14-117)
P1751 (47) Blinks ON Mechanical problem in hydraulic system (see page 14-118)
(2)
P1753 (1) Blinks ON Torque converter clutch solenoid valve (see page 14-119)
(2)
P1768 (16) Blinks ON A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve A (see page 14-121)
(2)
P1773 (23) Blinks ON A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve B (see page 14-123)
(1): The DTC in parentheses is the code the D4 indicator indicates when the data link connector (DLC) is connected to
the HDS, and the HDS is in the SCS mode.
(2): This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the
transmission.
14-8
03/07/29 09:29:15 61S0X050_140_0012
When you turn the A problem in the D4 Check the D4 indicator circuit for 1999-2000 models (see
ignition switch ON (II), indicator circuit page 14-166), for 2001 models (see page 14-169).
the D4 indicator comes
on and stays on or never
comes on at all
Shift lever cannot be A problem in the shift lock Check interlock system - shift lock system circuit (see
moved from P while system of the interlock page 14-179).
youre pressing on the system
brake pedal
Ignition switch cannot be A problem in the key Check interlock system - key interlock system circuit
moved from ACC (I) interlock system of the (see page 14-182).
position to LOCK (0) interlock system
position (key is pushed in,
shift lever in P)
Engine runs, but vehicle 1. Low ATF level Check the ATF level, and check the ATF cooler lines
does not move in any 2. Shift cable broken or for leakage and loose connections. If necessary, flush
gear out of adjustment the ATF cooler lines.
3. Shift cable worn Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever and the
4. ATF pump worn or transmission control shaft.
binding Improper alignment of ATF pump and torque
5. Regulator valve stuck converter housing may cause ATF pump seizure. The
or spring worn symptoms are mostly an rpm-related ticking noise or
6. ATF strainer clogged a high pitched squeak.
7. Mainshaft worn or Measure line pressure.
damaged If the strainer is clogged, find the damaged
8. Final gears worn or components that caused debris.
damaged Inspect the differential pinion gear for wear. If the
9. Transmission-to- differential pinion gears are worn, replace the
engine assembly differential assembly, replace the ATF strainer,
error thoroughly clean the transmission, and flush the
10. Axle disengaged cooler and lines.
Be careful not to damage the torque converter
housing when replacing the main ball bearing. You
may also damage the ATF pump when you torque
down the main valve body. This will result in ATF
pump seizure if not detected. Use the proper tools.
Install the main seal flush with the torque converter
housing. If you push it into the torque converter
housing until it bottoms out, it will block the fluid
return passage and result in damage.
(contd)
14-9
03/07/29 09:29:16 61S0X050_140_0013
Automatic Transmission
Vehicle moves in 1. Shift solenoid valve A Check the 2 indicator, and check for loose connectors. Inspect
D4, D3, 1, and R, defective the O-rings, and check the shift solenoid valve for seizure.
but not in 2 2. Shift valve A defective Inspect the secondary shaft and 1st/2nd clutch assembly for
3. 2nd accumulator wear and damage.
defective Inspect the clutch piston and O-rings. Check the spring
4. 2nd gears worn or retainer for wear and damage. Inspect the clutch end-plate-to-
damaged top-disc clearance. If the clearance is out of tolerance, inspect
5. 2nd clutch defective the clutch discs and plates for wear and damage. If the discs
and plates are worn or damaged, replace them as a set. If they
are OK, adjust the clutch end plate clearance.
Vehicle moves in 1. Shift fork shaft stuck Check the line pressure and 4th clutch pressure.
D4, D3, 2, and 1, 2. Modulator valve Check for a missing shift fork bolt on the shift fork shaft.
but not in R (or defective If the ATF strainer is clogged with particles of steel or
moves forward 3. Reverse Clutch aluminum, inspect the ATF pump. If the ATF pump is OK, and
in R) Pressure Control (CPC) no cause for the contamination is found, replace the torque
valve defective converter.
4. 4th accumulator Inspect the reverse selector gear teeth chamfers, and inspect
defective the engagement teeth chamfers of the countershaft 4th and
5. 4th clutch defective reverse gear. Replace the reverse gears and the reverse
6. Reverse gears worn or selector if they are worn or damaged. If the transmission
damaged makes clicking, grinding, or whirring noises, also replace the
mainshaft 4th gear, reverse idler gear, and countershaft 4th
gear.
If the 4th clutch feed pipe guide in the end cover is scored by
the mainshaft, inspect the ball bearing for excessive
movement in the transmission housing. If the ball bearing is
OK, replace the end cover as it is dented. The O-ring under the
guide is probably worn.
Replace the mainshaft if the bushing for the 3rd and 4th clutch
feed pipes are loose or damaged. If the 4th clutch feed pipe is
damaged or out of round, replace the end cover.
Inspect the clutch piston, clutch piston check valve, and O-
rings. Check the spring retainer for wear and damage. Inspect
the clutch end-plate-to-top-disc clearance. If the clearance is
out of tolerance, inspect the clutch discs and plates for wear
and damage. If the discs and plates are worn or damaged,
replace them as a set. If they are OK, adjust the clearance with
the clutch end plate.
14-10
03/07/29 09:29:16 61S0X050_140_0014
Poor acceleration; 1. Low ATF level Check the ATF level, and check the ATF cooler lines for
flares on starting 2. Shift cable broken or out leakage and loose connections. If necessary, flush the
off in D4 and D3; of adjustment ATF cooler lines.
stall speed high in 3. ATF pump worn or Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever and the
D4, D3, 2, and 1 binding transmission control shaft.
4. Regulator valve stuck or Check the line pressure.
spring worn Improper alignment of ATF pump and torque converter
5. ATF strainer clogged housing may cause ATF pump seizure. The symptoms
6. Torque converter check are mostly an rpm-ticking noise or a high pitched
valve defective squeak.
Be careful not to damage the torque converter housing
when replacing the main ball bearing. You may also
damage the ATF pump when you torque down the main
valve body. This will result in ATF pump seizure if not
detected. Use the proper tools.
Poor acceleration; 1. Shift cable broken or out Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever and the
flares on starting of adjustment transmission control shaft.
off in D4 and D3; 2. 1st clutch defective Check the 1st clutch pressure.
stall speed high in Inspect the clutch piston and O-rings. Check the spring
D4, D3, and 1 retainer for wear and damage. Inspect the clutch end
plate-to-top disc clearance. If the clearance is out of
tolerance, inspect the clutch discs and plates for wear
and damage. If the discs and plates are worn or
damaged, replace them as a set. If they are OK, adjust
the clutch end plate clearance.
Poor acceleration; 1. Shift cable broken or out Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever and the
flares on starting of adjustment transmission control shaft.
off 2; 2. 2nd clutch defective Check the 2nd clutch pressure.
stall speed high in Inspect the clutch piston and O-rings. Check the spring
2 retainer for wear and damage. Inspect the clutch end
plate-to-top disc clearance. If the clearance is out of
tolerance, inspect the clutch discs and plates for wear
and damage. If the discs and plates are worn or
damaged, replace them as a set. If they are OK, adjust
the clutch end plate clearance.
Poor acceleration; 4th clutch defective Check the 4th clutch pressure.
flares on starting Inspect the clutch piston, clutch piston check valve, and
off in R; O-rings. Check the spring retainer for wear and damage.
stall speed is within Inspect the clutch end plate-to-top disc clearance. If the
specification in D4, clearance is out of tolerance, inspect the clutch discs
D3, 2, and 1, but and plates for wear and damage. If the discs and plates
high in R are worn or damaged, replace them as a set. If they are
OK, adjust the clutch end plate clearance.
(contd)
14-11
03/07/29 09:29:16 61S0X050_140_0015
Automatic Transmission
Poor acceleration; 1. Torque converter clutch Check for a stuck lock-up valve in the valve body.
stall speed low solenoid valve defective
2. Engine output low
3. Lock-up clutch piston
defective
4. Lock-up shift valve
defective
Engine idle 1. Low ATF level Set the idle rpm in gear to the specified idle speed. If it
vibration 2. Torque converter clutch doesnt fix the problem, adjust the engine and
solenoid valve defective transmission mounts.
3. Drive plate defective or Check the ATF level, and check the ATF cooler lines for
transmission leakage and loose connections. If necessary, flush the
misassembled ATF cooler lines.
4. Engine output low
5. Lock-up clutch piston
defective
6. ATF pump worn or
binding
7. Lock-up shift valve
defective
Vehicle moves in N 1. Excessive ATF Check the ATF level, and drain the ATF if it is over filled.
2. Foreign material in Inspect the clutch piston, clutch piston check valve, and
separator plate orifice O-rings. Check the spring retainer for wear and damage.
3. 1st clutch defective Inspect the clutch end plate-to-top disc clearance. If the
4. 2nd clutch defective clearance is out of tolerance, inspect the clutch discs
5. 3rd clutch defective and plates for wear and damage. If the discs and plates
6. 4th clutch defective are worn or damaged, replace them as a set. If they are
7. Clutch clearance OK, adjust the clutch end plate clearance.
incorrect Check all clutch pressures.
8. Needle bearing seized up,
worn, or damaged
9. Thrust washer seized up,
worn, or damaged
14-12
03/07/29 09:29:17 61S0X050_140_0016
Late shift after 1. Shift solenoid valve C Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
shifting from N to defective Inspect the O-ring, and check the shift solenoid valve
D4 and D3, or 2. A/T clutch pressure for seizure.
excessive shock control solenoid valves Inspect the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve
when shifted into A and B defective body gasket and ATF feed pipes for wear and damage.
D4 and D3 3. Shift cable broken or out If the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve is stuck,
of adjustment inspect the CPC valves.
4. Joint in shift cable and Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever and the
transmission or body transmission control shaft.
worn Check the ATF strainer for debris. If the ATF strainer is
5. Shift fork shaft stuck clogged with particles of steel or aluminum, inspect the
6. CPC valve A stuck ATF pump. If the ATF pump is OK, find the damaged
7. Foreign material in components that caused the debris. If no cause for the
separator plate orifice contamination is found, replace the torque converter.
8. Shift valve C defective Check the 1st clutch pressure.
9. Servo control valve Inspect the clutch piston, clutch piston check valve, and
defective O-rings. Check the spring retainer for wear and damage.
10. 1st accumulator defective Inspect the clutch-end-plate-to-top-disc clearance. If the
11. 1st check ball stuck clearance is out of tolerance, inspect the clutch discs
12. 1st clutch defective and plates for wear and damage. If the discs and plates
are worn or damaged, replace them as a set. If they are
OK, adjust the clutch end plate clearance.
Late shift after 1. Shift solenoid valve C Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
shifting from N to defective Inspect the O-ring, and check the shift solenoid valve
R 2. A/T clutch pressure for seizure.
control solenoid valves Inspect the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve
A and B defective body gasket and ATF feed pipes for wear and damage.
3. Shift cable broken or out If the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve is stuck,
of adjustment inspect the CPC valves.
4. Joint in shift cable and Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever and the
transmission or body transmission control shaft.
worn Check the ATF strainer for debris. If the ATF strainer is
5. Shift fork shaft stuck clogged with particles of steel or aluminum, inspect the
6. Foreign material in ATF pump. If the ATF pump is OK, find the damaged
separator plate orifice components that caused the debris. If no cause for the
7. Reverse CPC valve contamination is found, replace the torque converter.
defective Check the 4th clutch pressure.
8. 4th accumulator Inspect the clutch piston, clutch piston check valve, and
defective O-rings. Check the spring retainer for wear and damage.
9. 4th clutch defective Inspect the clutch-end-plate-to-top-disc clearance. If the
clearance is out of tolerance, inspect the clutch discs
and plates for wear and damage. If the discs and plates
are worn or damaged, replace them as a set. If they are
OK, adjust the clutch end plate clearance.
(contd)
14-13
03/07/29 09:29:17 61S0X050_140_0017
Automatic Transmission
The A/T does not Modulator valve defective. Check the line pressure.
shift
Erratic shifting; 1. Shift solenoid valve A Inspect the O-ring, and check the shift solenoid valve
Fails to shift in D4; defective for seizure.
does not upshift to 2. Mainshaft speed sensor Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
4th defective Inspect the transmission range switch. If the
3. Countershaft speed transmission range switch is faulty, replace it. If the
sensor defective transmission range switch is out of adjustment, adjust it
4. Shift valve A defective and the shift cable.
5. Shift valve D defective
Erratic shifting; 1. Shift solenoid valve B Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
Fails to shift in D4 defective Inspect the O-ring, and check the shift solenoid valve
and D3; does not 2. Shift fork shaft stuck for seizure.
upshift to 3rd and 3. Shift valve B defective Check for a missing shift fork bolt on the shift fork shaft.
4th 4. Servo control valve
defective
Erratic shifting; 1. Shift solenoid valve B Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
Fails to shift in D4 defective Inspect the O-ring, and check the shift solenoid valve for
and D3; starts off 2. Shift valve B defective seizure.
in 3rd 3. Shift valve E defective
Excessive shock, 1. A/T clutch pressure Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
or flares on all control solenoid valves Inspect the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve
upshifts and A and B defective body gasket and ATF feed pipes for wear and damage.
downshifts 2. CPC valve A defective If the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve is stuck,
3. CPC valve B defective inspect the CPC valves.
4. Foreign material in If the ATF strainer is clogged with particles of steel or
separator plate orifice aluminum, inspect the ATF pump. If the ATF pump is
OK and no cause for the contamination is found,
replace the torque converter.
Excessive shock or 1. Shift solenoid valve C Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
flares on 1-2 defective Inspect the O-rings, and check the shift solenoid valve
upshift or 2-1 2. 2nd clutch pressure for seizure.
downshift switch or circuit defective Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
3. Foreign material in Check that the outlet is not clogged inside of the
separator plate orifice connector.
4. Shift valve C defective Check the 1st and 2nd clutch pressures.
5. 1st accumulator defective Inspect the clutch piston and O-rings. Check the spring
6. 2nd accumulator retainer for wear and damage. Inspect the clutch-end-
defective plate-to-top-disc clearance. If the clearance is out of
7. 1st check ball stuck tolerance, inspect the clutch discs and plates for wear
8. 2nd check ball stuck and damage. If the discs and plates are worn or
9. 1st clutch defective damaged, replace them as a set. If they are OK, adjust
10. 2nd clutch defective the clutch end plate clearance.
14-14
03/07/29 09:29:17 61S0X050_140_0018
Excessive shock, 1. Shift solenoid valve C Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
or flares on 2-3 defective Inspect the O-rings, and check the shift solenoid valve
upshift or 3-2 2. 3rd clutch pressure for seizure.
downshift switch or circuit defective Check the 2nd and 3rd clutch pressures.
3. Foreign material in Inspect the clutch piston, clutch piston check valve, and
separator plate orifice O-rings. Check the spring retainer for wear and damage.
4. Shift valve C defective Inspect the clutch-end-plate-to-top-disc clearance. If the
5. 2nd accumulator clearance is out of tolerance, inspect the clutch discs
defective and plates for wear and damage. If the discs and plates
6. 3rd accumulator are worn or damaged, replace them as a set. If they are
defective OK, adjust the clutch end plate clearance.
7. 2nd check ball stuck
8. 2nd clutch defective
9. 3rd clutch defective
Excessive shock, 1. Shift solenoid valve C Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
or flares on 3-4 defective Inspect the O-rings, and check the shift solenoid valve
upshift or 4-3 2. Foreign material in for seizure.
downshift separator plate orifice Check the 3rd and 4th clutch pressures.
3. Shift valve C defective If the ATF strainer is clogged with particles of steel or
4. 3rd accumulator aluminum, inspect the ATF pump. If the ATF pump is
defective OK, and no cause for the contamination is found,
5. 4th accumulator replace the torque converter, and check the stall speed.
defective Inspect the clutch piston, clutch piston check valve, and
6. 3rd clutch defective O-rings. Check the spring retainer for wear and damage.
7. 4th clutch defective Inspect the clutch-end-plate-to-top-disc clearance. If the
clearance is out of tolerance, inspect the clutch discs
and plates for wear and damage. If the discs and plates
are worn or damaged, replace them as a set. If they are
OK, adjust the clutch end plate clearance.
Noise from 1. ATF pump worn or Improper alignment of ATF pump and torque converter
transmission in all binding housing may cause ATF pump seizure. The symptoms
shift lever 2. Torque converter are mostly an rpm-ticking noise or a high pitched
positions housing or transmission squeak.
housing bearing worn or Inspect the contact of the countershaft and secondary
damaged shaft with the bearings. Check the ATF guide plates for
damage and wear. Inspect the 1st clutch feed pipe for
damage and out of round. If the 1st clutch feed pipe is
damaged or out of round, replace it. Replace the
secondary shaft if the bushing for the 1st clutch feed
pipe is damaged or out of round.
Vehicle does not Torque converter one-way Replace the torque converter.
accelerate above clutch defective
31 mph (50 km/h)
(contd)
14-15
03/07/29 09:29:18 61S0X050_140_0019
Automatic Transmission
Vibration in all Drive plate defective or Check for a missinstalled/damaged drive plate.
shift lever transmission misassembled Set the idle rpm in gear to the specified idle speed. If it
positions doesnt fix the problem, adjust the engine mounts.
Check the stall speed.
Shift lever does 1. Transmission range Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
not operate switch defective or out of Inspect the transmission range switch. If the
smoothly adjustment transmission range switch is faulty, replace it. If the
2. Shift cable broken or out transmission range switch is out of adjustment, adjust it
of adjustment and the shift cable.
3. Joint in shift cable and Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever and the
transmission or body transmission control shaft.
worn
Transmission does 1. Shift cable broken or out Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever and the
not shift into P of adjustment transmission control shaft.
2. Joint in shift cable and Check the park pawl spring installation and the park
transmission or body lever spring installation. If installation is incorrect,
worn install the spring correctly. Make sure that the park
3. Park mechanism lever stop is not installed upside down. Check the
defective distance between the park pawl and the park lever roller
pin. If the distance is out of tolerance, adjust the
distance with the park lever stop.
Torque converter 1. Torque converter clutch Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
clutch does not solenoid valve defective Inspect the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve
disengage 2. A/T clutch pressure body gasket and ATF feed pipes for wear and damage. If
control solenoid valves the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve is stuck,
A and B defective inspect the CPC valves.
3. Torque converter clutch
piston defective
4. Lock-up shift valve
defective
5. Lock-up control valve
defective
6. Lock-up timing valve
defective
14-16
03/07/29 09:29:18 61S0X050_140_0020
Torque converter 1. Torque converter clutch Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
clutch does not solenoid valve defective Inspect the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve
operate smoothly 2. A/T clutch pressure body gasket and ATF feed pipes for wear and damage.
control solenoid valves If the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve is stuck,
A and B defective inspect the CPC valves.
3. Torque converter clutch Center all engine mounts.
piston defective
4. Torque converter check
valve defective
5. Lock-up shift valve
defective
6. Lock-up control valve
defective
7. Lock-up timing valve
defective
Torque converter 1. Torque converter clutch Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
clutch does not solenoid valve defective Inspect the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve
engage 2. A/T clutch pressure body gasket and ATF feed pipes for wear and damage. If
control solenoid valves the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve is stuck,
A and B defective inspect the CPC valves.
3. Mainshaft speed sensor
defective
4. Countershaft speed
sensor defective
5. Torque converter clutch
piston defective
6. Torque converter check
valve defective
7. Lock-up shift valve
defective
8. Lock-up control valve
defective
A/T gear position 1. Transmission range Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
indicator does not switch defective or out of Inspect the transmission range switch. If the
indicate shift lever adjustment transmission range switch is faulty, replace it. If the
positions 2. Shift cable broken or out transmission range switch is out of adjustment, adjust it
of adjustment and the shift cable.
3. Shift cable joint in Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever and the
transmission or body transmission control shaft.
worn
Speedometer does Countershaft speed sensor Check the D4 indicator, and check for loose connectors.
not work defective
14-17
03/07/29 09:29:18 61S0X050_140_0021
Automatic Transmission
System Description
General Operation
The automatic transmission is a combination of a 3-element torque converter and triple-shaft electronically controlled
unit which provides 4 speeds forward and 1 reverse. The entire unit is positioned in line with the engine.
Electronic Control
The electronic control system consists of the powertrain control module (PCM), sensors, and six solenoid valves.
Shifting and lock-up are electronically controlled for comfortable driving under all conditions. The PCM is located
below the dashboard, under the front lower panel behind the center console.
Hydraulic Control
The valve bodies include the main valve body, the regulator valve body, the servo body, and the accumulator body.
They are bolted to the torque converter housing. The main valve body contains the manual valve, the modulator valve,
the shift valve C, the shift valve D, the shift valve E, the servo control valve, the torque converter check valve, the
reverse Clutch Pressure Control C (CPC) valve, the lock-up shift valve, the relief valve, the cooler check valve, and the
ATF pump gears. The regulator valve body contains the regulator valve, the lock-up timing valve, and the lock-up
control valve. The servo body contains the servo valve, the shift valve A, the shift valve B, the CPC valves A and B, and
3rd and 4th accumulators. The accumulator body contains the 1st and 2nd accumulators and lubrication check valve.
Fluid from the regulator passes through the manual valve to the various control valves. The 1st, 3rd, and 4th clutches
receive fluid from their respective feed pipes, and the 2nd clutch receives fluid from the internal hydraulic circuit.
Lock-up Mechanism
The lock-up mechanism operates in the D4 position (3rd and 4th) and D3 position (3rd). The pressurized fluid is
drained from the back of the torque converter through a fluid passage, causing the torque converter clutch piston to be
held against the torque converter cover. As this takes place, the mainshaft rotates at the same speed as the engine
crankshaft. Together with hydraulic control, the PCM optimizes the timing of the lock-up mechanism. When the torque
converter clutch solenoid valve activates, modulator pressure changes to switch lock-up on and off. The lock-up
control valve and the lock-up timing valve control the amount of lock-up according to A/T clutch pressure control
solenoid valves A and B. The torque converter clutch solenoid valve is mounted on the torque converter housing, and
A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valves A and B are mounted on the transmission housing. They are all controlled
by the PCM.
14-18
03/07/29 09:29:19 61S0X050_140_0022
Gear Selection
The shift lever has seven positions; P: PARK, R: REVERSE, N: NEUTRAL, D4: 1st through 4th gear ranges, D3: 1st
through 3rd gear ranges, 2: 2nd gear, and 1: 1st gear.
Position Description
P: PARK Front wheels locked; park pawl engaged with park gear on countershaft. All clutches are
released.
R: REVERSE Reverse; reverse selector engaged with countershaft reverse gear and 4th clutch locked.
D4: DRIVE General driving; starts off in 1st, shifts automatically to 2nd, 3rd, then 4th, depending on
(1st through 4th) vehicle speed and throttle position. Downshift through 3rd, 2nd, and 1st on deceleration to
stop. The lock-up mechanism operates in 3rd and 4th gear.
D3: DRIVE Used for rapid acceleration at highway speeds and general driving; up-hill and down-hill
(1st through 3rd) driving; starts off in 1st, shifts automatically to 2nd, then 3rd, depending on vehicle speed and
throttle position.
Downshifts through 2nd to 1st on deceleration to stop. The lock-up mechanism operates in 3rd
gear only.
2: SECOND Used for engine braking or better traction starting off on loose or slippery surfaces; stays in
2nd gear, does not shift up or down.
1: FIRST Used for engine braking; stays in 1st gear, does not shift up.
Starting is possible only in the P and N positions because of the slide-type neutral-safety switch.
14-19
03/07/29 09:29:19 61S0X050_140_0023
Automatic Transmission
1st Clutch
The 1st clutch engages/disengages 1st gear, and is located at the middle of the secondary shaft. The 1st clutch is
joined back-to-back to the 2nd clutch. The 1st clutch is supplied hydraulic pressure by its ATF feed pipe within the
secondary shaft.
2nd Clutch
The 2nd clutch engages/disengages 2nd gear, and is located at the middle of the secondary shaft. The 2nd clutch is
joined back-to-back to the 1st clutch. The 2nd clutch is supplied hydraulic pressure through the secondary shaft by a
circuit connected to the internal hydraulic circuit.
3rd Clutch
The 3rd clutch engages/disengages 3rd gear, and is located at the middle of the mainshaft. The 3rd clutch is joined
back-to-back to the 4th clutch. The 3rd clutch is supplied hydraulic pressure by its ATF feed pipe within the mainshaft.
4th Clutch
The 4th clutch engages/disengages 4th gear, as well as reverse gear, and is located at the middle of the mainshaft. The
4th clutch is joined back-to-back to the 3rd clutch. The 4th clutch is supplied hydraulic pressure by its ATF feed pipe
within the mainshaft.
14-20
03/07/29 09:29:20 61S0X050_140_0024
LUBRICATION
PITOT PIPE
LOCK-UP CLUTCH
PISTON
MAINSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
REVERSE GEAR
PITOT PIPE
COUNTERSHAFT
2ND GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT
REVERSE
SELECTOR HUB
COUNTERSHAFT
IDLER GEAR
DRIVE PLATE
REVERSE
SELECTOR
FINAL DRIVE GEAR
PARK GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT COUNTERSHAFT
4TH GEAR 3RD GEAR
SECONDARY
SHAFT COUNTERSHAFT
1ST GEAR
SECONDARY SHAFT
IDLER GEAR
SECONDARY SHAFT
2ND GEAR
1ST CLUTCH
2ND CLUTCH
SECONDARY SHAFT
1ST GEAR
DIFFERENTIAL
ASSEMBLY
FINAL DRIVEN GEAR
14-21
03/07/29 09:29:20 61S0X050_140_0025
Automatic Transmission
Gear Operation
The 3rd gear is engaged/disengaged with the mainshaft by the 3rd clutch.
The 4th gear is engaged/disengaged with the mainshaft by the 4th clutch.
The reverse gear is engaged/disengaged with the mainshaft by the 4th clutch.
The idler gear is splined with the mainshaft and rotates with the mainshaft.
The 1st gear is engaged/disengaged with the secondary shaft by the 1st clutch.
The 2nd gear is engaged/disengaged with the secondary shaft by the 2nd clutch.
The idler gear is splined with the secondary shaft and rotates with the secondary shaft.
14-22
03/07/29 09:29:21 61S0X050_140_0026
P Position
Hydraulic pressure is not applied to the clutches. Power is not transmitted to the countershaft. The countershaft is
locked by the park pawl interlocking the park gear.
N Position
Engine power transmitted from the torque converter drives the mainshaft idler gear, the countershaft idler gear, and
the secondary shaft idler gear, but hydraulic pressure is not applied to the clutches. Power is not transmitted to the
countershaft. The countershaft 4th gear is engaged to the reverse selector hub by the shift fork reverse selector when
the shift lever is shifted in the N position from the D4 position. The countershaft reverse gear is engaged when shifted
from the R position.
TORQUE CONVERTER
REVERSE
MAINSHAFT SELECTOR
IDLER GEAR
MAINSHAFT
PARK
GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT
SECONDARY
SHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT
IDLER GEAR
(contd)
14-23
03/07/29 09:29:21 61S0X050_140_0027
Automatic Transmission
MAINSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
1ST CLUTCH
SECONDARY SHAFT
IDLER GEAR
14-24
03/07/29 09:29:21 61S0X050_140_0028
MAINSHAFT
IDLER GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT
2ND GEAR
MAINSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
IDLER GEAR
FINAL DRIVE GEAR
SECONDARY
SHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT
IDLER GEAR
2ND CLUTCH
SECONDARY SHAFT
2ND GEAR
(contd)
14-25
03/07/29 09:29:22 61S0X050_140_0029
Automatic Transmission
MAINSHAFT
3RD CLUTCH 3RD GEAR
MAINSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
SECONDARY
SHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
3RD GEAR
14-26
03/07/29 09:29:22 61S0X050_140_0030
MAINSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
REVERSE
SELECTOR HUB
(contd)
14-27
03/07/29 09:29:23 61S0X050_140_0031
Automatic Transmission
TORQUE CONVERTER
MAINSHAFT
REVERSE GEAR 4TH CLUTCH
MAINSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
SERVO VALVE
SHIFT FORK
REVERSE SELECTOR
REVERSE
SELECTOR HUB
COUNTERSHAFT COUNTERSHAFT
REVERSE GEAR
REVERSE SELECTOR
HUB
REVERSE SELECTOR
14-28
03/07/29 09:29:23 61S0X050_140_0032
PGM-FI
Control System
Engine Coolant Temperature
Sensor Signal
MULTIPLEX
CONTROL UNIT, P Shift Solenoid Valve B
DRIVERS
D4 Indicator
Mainshaft Speed Sensor
Signal
Self-Diagnosis Signal Self-Diagnosis
Function
Countershaft Speed
Sensor Signal
(contd)
14-29
03/07/29 09:29:24 61S0X050_140_0033
Automatic Transmission
MAINSHAFT SPEED
SENSOR
14-30
03/07/29 09:29:24 61S0X050_140_0034
Shift Control
Shifting is related to engine torque through the solenoid valves, which are controlled by the PCM. The PCM instantly
determines which gear should be selected by various signals sent from sensors, and actuates the shift solenoid valves
A, B, and C to control shifting. Also, a grade logic control system has been adopted to control shifting in the D4 and D3
positions while the vehicle is ascending or descending a slope, or reducing speed.
The combination of driving signals to shift solenoid valves A, B, and C are shown in the table.
Lock-up Control
The torque converter clutch solenoid valve controls modulator pressure to switch the lock-up shift valve and lock-up
ON and OFF. The PCM controls the torque converter clutch solenoid valve and the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid
valves A and B. When the torque converter clutch solenoid valve is turned ON, the condition of lock-up starts. The A/T
clutch pressure control solenoid valves A and B regulate A/T clutch pressure control solenoid pressure and apply the
pressure to the lock-up control valve and the lock-up timing valve. The lock-up control mechanism operates in 3rd and
4th gear in D4, and in 3rd gear in D3 positions.
(contd)
14-31
03/07/29 09:29:25 61S0X050_140_0035
Automatic Transmission
Countershaft Speed
Sensor
Judgment of controlling area
Throttle Position
Driving resistance
Driving Conditions
Sensor
Detection of
Calculation standard Calculation
of actual acceleration of decelera-
acceleration (in Memory) tion
Engine Coolant
Temperature Sensor Coolant temperature Calculation of gradient
Transmission Range
Switch D4 or D3 Position
Selection of shifting mode
14-32
03/07/29 09:29:25 61S0X050_140_0036
NOTE: Shift schedules stored in the PCM between 2nd and 3rd gears, and between 3rd and 4th gears, enable to
automatically select the most suitable gear according to the magnitude of a gradient.
100%
1ST 2ND 2ND 3RD 3RD 4TH
Throttle opening
0
62 mph Vehicle speed
(100 km/h)
100%
1ST 2ND 2ND 3RD 3RD 4TH
Throttle opening
50
: FLAT ROAD MODE
: GRADUAL DESCENDING MODE
: STEEP DESCENDING MODE
0
62 mph Vehicle speed
(100 km/h)
(contd)
14-33
03/07/29 09:29:27 61S0X050_140_0037
Automatic Transmission
PCM
D2
SH B
CRUISE CONTROL A5
UNIT CRS
SHIFT CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE B
A11
ABS/TCS UNIT ATSFTP D3
SH C
SHIFT CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE C
DATA LINK A10
CONNECTOR SCS
D1
LC
MULTIPLEX CONTROL A28
UNIT (DRIVERS) ILU LOCKUP CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE
GAUGE ASSEMBLY
SPEEDOMETER A9 D11
CIRCUIT VSS OUT NM
MAINSHAFT
SPEED SENSOR
A/T GEAR POSITION INDICATOR D12
NMSG
D10
P R N D3 2 1 NC
COUNTERSHAFT
SPEED SENSOR
D16
NCSG
P
A/T GEAR
POSITION R D6 C28
SWITCH ATP R VCC2 THROTTLE
N C27
TPS POSITION
C18 SENSOR
D4 D9 SG2
ATP D4
D3 D8
ATP D3 ENGINE COOLANT
2 D14 C26 TEMPERATURE
ATP 2 ECT SENSOR
1 D15
ATP 1
B14
ATP NP 2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE SWITCH
A14 D13
D4INDICATOR D4 D4 IND OP2SW
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 2 3 5
12 13 14 15 17 18 19 20 21 23 24 9 10 11 12 14 15 17 18 12 13 14 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 20 21 22 23 24 25 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 13 14 15 16
14-34
03/07/29 09:29:28 61S0X050_140_0038
PCM
BRAKE LIGHT
C9
SH B
CRUISE CONTROL E17
UNIT CRS
SHIFT SOLENOID
VALVE B
D11
ABS/TCS UNIT ATSFTP C17
SH C
SHIFT SOLENOID
VALVE C
DATA LINK E16
CONNECTOR SCS
C10
LC
MULTIPLEX CONTROL E15 TORQUE CONVERTER
UNIT (DRIVERS) ILU
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE
GAUGE ASSEMBLY
SPEEDOMETER E26 C7
CIRCUIT VSS OUT NM
MAINSHAFT
SPEED SENSOR
A/T GEAR POSITION INDICATOR C6
NMSG
C15
P R N D3 2 1 NC
COUNTERSHAFT
SPEED SENSOR
C14
NCSG
P
TRANSMISSION
RANGE R C21 A30
SWITCH ATP R VCC2 THROTTLE
N A15
TPS POSITION
A28 SENSOR
SG2
D4 C13
ATP D4
D3 C4
ATP D3 ENGINE COOLANT
2 C12 A13 TEMPERATURE
ATP 2 ECT SENSOR
1 C20
ATP 1
C22
ATP NP 2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE SWITCH
E5 C11
D4INDICATOR D4 D4 IND OP2SW
1 2 3 4 5 6 9 2 3 5 6 7 1 2 4 6 7 3 5 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 19 20 8 9 10 12 13 14 16 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 9 11 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 17 19 20 21 22 16 22 23 24 26 27 28 29 30 31
(contd)
14-35
03/07/29 09:29:29 61S0X050_140_0039
Automatic Transmission
14-36
03/07/29 09:29:29 61S0X050_140_0040
(contd)
14-37
03/07/29 09:29:29 61S0X050_140_0041
Automatic Transmission
14-38
03/07/29 09:29:30 61S0X050_140_0042
(contd)
14-39
03/07/29 09:29:30 61S0X050_140_0043
Automatic Transmission
14-40
03/07/29 09:29:30 61S0X050_140_0044
(contd)
14-41
03/07/29 09:29:31 61S0X050_140_0045
Automatic Transmission
14-42
03/07/29 09:29:31 61S0X050_140_0046
Hydraulic Controls
The valve body includes the main valve body, the regulator valve body, the servo body and the accumulator body. The
ATF pump is driven by splines on the left end of the torque converter which is attached to the engine. Fluid flows
through the regulator valve to maintain specified pressure through the main valve body to the manual valve, directing
pressure to each of the clutches. The shift solenoid valves B and C are mounted on the outside of the torque converter
housing. The shift solenoid valve A and the torque converter clutch solenoid valve are mounted on the torque
converter housing as an assembly. The A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valves A and B are mounted on the
transmission housing.
3RD CLUTCH
PRESSURE SWITCH
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE B
SERVO BODY
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE A
SHIFT SOLENOID
VALVE C
SHIFT SOLENOID
VALVE B
2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE SWITCH
ACCUMULATOR BODY
(contd)
14-43
03/07/29 09:29:32 61S0X050_140_0047
Automatic Transmission
SHIFT VALVE E
SHIFT VALVE C
RELIEF VALVE
REVERSE CPC VALVE
14-44
03/07/29 09:29:33 61S0X050_140_0048
Regulator Valve
The regulator valve maintains constant hydraulic pressure from the ATF pump to the hydraulic control system, while
also furnishing fluid to the lubricating system and torque converter. Fluid from the ATF pump flows through B and B.
Fluid entering from B flows through the valve orifice to the A cavity. This pressure of the A cavity pushes the regulator
valve to the right side, and this movement of the regulator valve uncovers the fluid port to the torque converter and
the relief valve. The fluid flows out to the torque converter and the relief valve, and the regulator valve moves to the
left side. According to the level of the hydraulic pressure through B, the position of the regulator valve changes, and
the amount of fluid from B through torque converter changes. This operation is continued, maintaining the line
pressure.
VALVE
ORIFICE
A B B
REGULATOR VALVE
Increases in hydraulic pressure according to torque are performed by the regulator valve using stator torque reaction.
The stator shaft is splined with the stator in the torque converter, and its arm end contacts the regulator spring cap.
When the vehicle is accelerating or climbing (torque converter range), stator torque reaction acts on the stator shaft,
and the stator arm pushes the regulator spring cap in the direction of the arrow in proportion to the reaction. The
stator reaction spring compresses, and the regulator valve moves to increase the line pressure which is regulated by
the regulator valve. The line pressure reaches its maximum when the stator torque reaction reaches its maximum.
REGULATOR VALVE BODY TORQUE CONVERTER
REGULATOR VALVE
STATOR
REGULATOR
SPRING CAP
(contd)
14-45
03/07/29 09:29:34 61S0X050_140_0049
Automatic Transmission
CPC VALVE A
SERVO BODY
CPC VALVE B
SHIFT VALVE A
SHIFT VALVE B
SERVO VALVE
SERVO BODY
Accumulator Body
The accumulator body is on the torque converter housing, next to the main valve body. It contains the 1st and the 2nd
accumulators, and the lubrication check valve.
14-46
03/07/29 09:29:34 61S0X050_140_0050
Hydraulic Flow
Distribution of Hydraulic Pressure
As the engine turns, the ATF pump starts to operate. Automatic transmission fluid (ATF) is drawn through the ATF
strainer (filter) and discharged into the hydraulic circuit. Then, ATF flowing from the ATF pump becomes line pressure
thats regulated by the regulator valve. Torque converter pressure from the regulator valve enters the torque converter
through the lock-up shift valve and it is discharged from the torque converter. The torque converter check valve
prevents torque converter pressure from rising.
The PCM controls the shift solenoid valves ON and OFF, and the shift solenoid valves control shift solenoid pressure
to the shift valves. Applying shift control solenoid pressure to the shift valves moves the position of the shift valve,
and switches the port of hydraulic pressure. The PCM also controls A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valves A and
B. The A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valves regulate the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid pressure and
apply the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid pressure to CPC valves A and B.
When shifting between upper gear and lower gear, the clutch is engaged by pressure from the CPC pressure mode.
The PCM controls one of the shift solenoid valves to move the position of the shift valve. This movement switches the
port of the CPC and line pressure. Line pressure is then applied to the clutch, and the CPC pressure is intercepted.
Engaging the clutch with line pressure happens after CPC pressure mode has completed.
NOTE:
CPC: Clutch Pressure Control pressure
SH: Shift Solenoid pressure
LS: A/T Clutch Pressure Control Solenoid pressure
LC: Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid pressure
(contd)
14-47
03/07/29 09:30:24 61S0X050_140_0051
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND 3RD
1ST ACCUMULATOR 1ST CLUTCH 2ND CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH 4TH CLUTCH
TORQUE 3RD CLUTCH
CONVERTER PRESSURE 4TH ACCUMULATOR
SWITCH
2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE
SWITCH
10 20
30 40
10 20 30 40
SHIFT VALVE E
AX
CPC
4B VALVE B
5K 4 4 5F SHIFT VALVE B SHIFT SOLENOID
X
VALVE B
6
4 30 10 5F 50 5C SB X 4 57 X
91
90
SHIFT SOLENOID
94 VALVE C
9 5E H3X 5F 5G 5K
X
H3X H7X SHIFT VALVE C
5C 48 50 SC X
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE SHIFT SOLENOID
5E 5F 5K 5K 20 5A 4A 58 4
VALVE A
5G 57 58 56
M1X M2X X
LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE
5A 5A 58 5A 5H X 5J
X X X
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
90 91 X CPC VALVE 4 AX
CONTROL SOLENOID
SHIFT
VALVE A VALVE B
A
57
90 91 58 5J 5H 57 X 4A 56 HX
X X X HX AX
6
9 25 41 H6X
SHIFT VALVE D A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID
LA 94 91 91 6 VALVE A
6
HX HX AX
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE 56
4 25 41 40 6
90 90 58 97
90
95 1 3 3 1 X
93 92 MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR
X
93
X LOCK-UP CONTROL VALVE
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX AX
93 CHECK VALVE MX 4 3 56 SC 3 10 9 4
SECONDARY
SERVO CONTROL
SHAFT VALVE
3 3 4 4
92 2 95 95 95 X
REVERSE
X CPC VALVE 4
X X 3 X
LUBRICATION 4
RELIEF VALVE CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
14-48
03/07/29 09:30:26 61S0X050_140_0052
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND 3RD
1ST ACCUMULATOR 1ST CLUTCH 2ND CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH 4TH CLUTCH
TORQUE 3RD CLUTCH
CONVERTER PRESSURE 4TH ACCUMULATOR
SWITCH
2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE
SWITCH
10 20
30 40
10 20 30 40
SHIFT VALVE E
AX
CPC
4B VALVE B
5K 4 4 5F SHIFT VALVE B SHIFT SOLENOID
X
VALVE B
6
4 30 10 5F 50 5C SB X 4 57 X
91
90
SHIFT SOLENOID
94 VALVE C
9 5E H3X 5F 5G 5K
X
H3X H7X SHIFT VALVE C
5C 48 50 SC X
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID SHIFT SOLENOID
VALVE VALVE A
5E 5F 5K 5K 20 5G 57 58 56 5A 4A 58 4
M1X M2X X
LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE
5A 5A 58 5A 5H X 5J
X X X
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
90 91 X CPC VALVE 4 AX
CONTROL SOLENOID
SHIFT
VALVE A VALVE B
A
57
90 91 58 5J 5H 57 X 4A 56 HX HX AX
X X X
6
9 25 41 H6X
SHIFT VALVE D A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID
LA 94 91 91 6 VALVE A
6
HX HX AX
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE 56
4 25 41 40 6
90 90 58 97
90
95 1 3 3 1 X
93 92 MANUAL VALVE
X MODULATOR
93
X LOCK-UP CONTROL VALVE
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX AX
93 CHECK VALVE MX 4 3 56 SC 3 10 9 4
SECONDARY
SERVO CONTROL
SHAFT VALVE
3 3 4 4
92 2 95 95 95 X
REVERSE
X CPC VALVE 4
X X 3 X
LUBRICATION 4
RELIEF VALVE CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
(contd)
14-49
03/07/29 09:30:28 61S0X050_140_0053
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
10 20
30 40
10 20 30 40
SHIFT VALVE E
AX
CPC
4B VALVE B
5K 4 4 5F SHIFT VALVE B SHIFT SOLENOID
X
VALVE B
6
4 30 10 5F 50 5C SB X 4 57 X
90 91
SHIFT SOLENOID
94 VALVE C
9 5E H3X 5F 5G 5K
X
H3X H7X SHIFT VALVE C
5C 48 50 SC X
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE SHIFT SOLENOID
5E 5F 5K 5K 20 5G 5A 4A 58 4
VALVE A
57 58 56 M1X M2X X
LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE
5A 5A 58 5A 5H X 5J
X X X
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
90 91 X CPC VALVE
SHIFT A CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE VALVE B
A 57
90 91 58 5J 5H 57 HX HX AX
X X X
6
9 25 41 H6X
SHIFT VALVE D A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID
LA 94 91 91 6 VALVE A
6
HX HX
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE 56
4 25 41 40 6
90 90 58 97
90
95 1 3 1 X
93 92
X
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR
93 LOCK-UP CONTROL
X VALVE
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX
AX
93 CHECK VALVE MX
4 3 56 SC 3 10 9 4
SECONDARY
SERVO CONTROL
SHAFT VALVE
3 3 4 4
2 95 95 95 X
92
REVERSE
X CPC VALVE 4
X X 3 X
LUBRICATION 4
RELIEF VALVE CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
14-50
03/07/29 09:30:30 61S0X050_140_0054
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
10 20
30 40
10 20 30 40
SHIFT VALVE E
AX
CPC
4B VALVE B
5K 4 4 5F SHIFT VALVE B SHIFT SOLENOID
X
VALVE B
6
4 30 10 5F 50 5C SB X 4 57 X
90 91
SHIFT SOLENOID
94 VALVE C
9 5E H3X 5F 5G 5K
X
H3X H7X SHIFT VALVE C
5C 48 50 SC X
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE SHIFT SOLENOID
5E 5F 5K 5K 20 5A 4A 58 4
VALVE A
5G 57 58 56 M1X M2X X
LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE
5A 5A 58 5A 5H X 5J X
X X
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
90 91 X CPC VALVE 4 AX
CONTROL SOLENOID
SHIFT
VALVE A VALVE B
A 57
90 91 58 5J 5H 57 X 4A 56 HX HX AX
X X X
6
9 25 41 H6X
SHIFT VALVE D A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID
LA 94 91 91 6 VALVE A
6
HX HX AX
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE 56
4 25 41 40 6
90 90 58 97
90
95 1 3 3 1 X
93 92
X
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR
93
X LOCK-UP CONTROL VALVE
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX AX
93 CHECK VALVE MX 4 3 56 SC 3 10 9 4
SECONDARY
SERVO CONTROL
SHAFT VALVE
3 3 4 4
2 95 95 95 X
92
REVERSE
X CPC VALVE 4
X X 3 X
LUBRICATION 4
RELIEF VALVE CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
(contd)
14-51
03/07/29 09:30:32 61S0X050_140_0055
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicate direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND 3RD
1ST ACCUMULATOR 1ST CLUTCH 2ND CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH 4TH CLUTCH
TORQUE 3RD CLUTCH
CONVERTER PRESSURE 4TH ACCUMULATOR
SWITCH
2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE
SWITCH
10 20
30 40
10 20 30 40
SHIFT VALVE E
AX
CPC
4B VALVE B
5K 4 4 5F SHIFT VALVE B SHIFT SOLENOID
X
VALVE B
6
4 30 10 5F 50 5C SB X 4 57 X
90 91
SHIFT SOLENOID
94 VALVE C
9 5E H3X 5F 5G 5K
X
H3X H7X SHIFT VALVE C
5C 48 50 SC X
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE SHIFT SOLENOID
5E 5F 5K 5K 20 5A 4A 58 4
VALVE A
5G 57 58 56 M1X M2X X
LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE
5A 5A 58 5A 5H X 5J
X X X
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
90 91 X CPC VALVE
SHIFT A CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE VALVE B
A 57
90 91 58 5J 5H 57 HX AX
X X X HX
6
9 25 41 H6X
SHIFT VALVE D A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID
LA 94 91 91 6 VALVE A
6
HX HX
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE 56
4 25 41 40 6
90 90 58 97
90
95 1 3 1 X
93 92
X
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR
93 LOCK-UP CONTROL
X VALVE
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX AX
93 CHECK VALVE MX
4 3 56 SC 3 10 9 4
SECONDARY
SERVO CONTROL
SHAFT VALVE
3 3 4 4
92 2 95 95 95 X
REVERSE
X CPC VALVE 4
X X 3 X
LUBRICATION 4
RELIEF VALVE CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
14-52
03/07/29 09:30:34 61S0X050_140_0056
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND 3RD
1ST ACCUMULATOR 1ST CLUTCH 2ND CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH 4TH CLUTCH
TORQUE 3RD CLUTCH
CONVERTER PRESSURE 4TH ACCUMULATOR
SWITCH
2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE
SWITCH
10 20
30 40
10 20 30 40
SHIFT VALVE E
AX
CPC
4B VALVE B
5K 4 4 5F SHIFT VALVE B SHIFT SOLENOID
X
VALVE B
6
4 30 10 5F 50 5C SB X 4 57 X
90 91
SHIFT SOLENOID
94 VALVE C
9 5E H3X 5F 5G 5K
X
H3X H7X SHIFT VALVE C
5C 48 50 SC X
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE SHIFT SOLENOID
5E 5F 5K 5K 20 5G 5A 4A 58 4
VALVE A
57 58 56 M1X M2X X
LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE
5A 5A 58 5A 5H X 5J
X X X
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
90 91 X CPC VALVE
SHIFT A CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE VALVE B
A 57
90 91 58 5J 5H 57 HX AX
X X X HX
6
9 25 41 H6X
SHIFT VALVE D A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID
LA 94 91 91 6 VALVE A
6
HX HX
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE 56
4 25 41 40 6
90 90 58 97
90
95 1 3 1 X
93 92
X
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR
93
X LOCK-UP CONTROL VALVE
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX AX
93 CHECK VALVE MX 4 3 56 SC 3 10 9 4
SECONDARY
SERVO CONTROL
SHAFT VALVE
3 3 4 4
92 2 95 95 95 X
REVERSE
X CPC VALVE 4
X X 3 X
LUBRICATION 4
RELIEF VALVE CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
(contd)
14-53
03/07/29 09:30:36 61S0X050_140_0057
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND 3RD
1ST ACCUMULATOR 1ST CLUTCH 2ND CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH 4TH CLUTCH
TORQUE 3RD CLUTCH
CONVERTER PRESSURE 4TH ACCUMULATOR
SWITCH
2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE
SWITCH
10 20
30 40
10 20 30 40
SHIFT VALVE E
AX
CPC
4B VALVE B
5K 4 4 5F SHIFT VALVE B SHIFT SOLENOID
X
VALVE B
6
4 30 10 5F 50 5C SB X 4 57 X
90 91
SHIFT SOLENOID
94 VALVE C
9 5E H3X 5F 5G 5K
X
H3X H7X SHIFT VALVE C
5C 48 50 SC X
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE SHIFT SOLENOID
5E 5F 5K 5K 20 5A 4A 58 4
VALVE A
5G 57 58 56 M1X M2X X
LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE X 5J
5A 5A 58 5A 5H X
X X
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
90 91 X CPC VALVE
SHIFT A CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE VALVE B
A 57
90 91 58 5J 5H 57 HX HX AX
X X X
6
9 25 41 H6X
SHIFT VALVE D A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID
LA 94 91 91 6 VALVE A
6
HX HX
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE 56
4 25 41 40 6
90 90 58 97
90
95 1 3 1 X
93 92
X
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR
93 LOCK-UP CONTROL
X VALVE
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX
AX
93 CHECK VALVE MX 4 3 56 SC 3 10 9 4
SECONDARY
SERVO CONTROL
SHAFT VALVE
3 3 4 4
2 95 95 95 X
92
REVERSE
X CPC VALVE 4
X X 3 X
LUBRICATION 4
RELIEF VALVE CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
14-54
03/07/29 09:30:38 61S0X050_140_0058
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND 3RD
1ST ACCUMULATOR 1ST CLUTCH 2ND CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH 4TH CLUTCH
TORQUE 3RD CLUTCH
CONVERTER PRESSURE 4TH ACCUMULATOR
SWITCH
2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE
SWITCH
10 20
30 40
10 20 30 40
SHIFT VALVE E
AX
CPC
4B VALVE B
5K 4 4 5F SHIFT VALVE B SHIFT SOLENOID
X
VALVE B
6
4 30 10 5F 50 5C SB X 4 57 X
90 91
SHIFT SOLENOID
94 VALVE C
9 5E H3X 5F 5G 5K
X
H3X H7X SHIFT VALVE C
5C 48 50 SC X
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE SHIFT SOLENOID
5E 5F 5K 5K 20 5G 5A 4A 58 4
VALVE A
57 58 56 M1X M2X X
LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE X 5J
5A 5A 58 5A 5H
X X X
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
90 91 X CPC VALVE
SHIFT A CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE VALVE B
A 57
90 91 58 5J 5H 57 HX AX
X X X HX
6
9 25 41 H6X
SHIFT VALVE D A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID
LA 94 91 91 6 VALVE A
6
HX HX
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE 56
4 25 41 40 6
90 90 58 97
90
95 1 3 1 X
93 92
X
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR
93
X LOCK-UP CONTROL VALVE
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX AX
93 CHECK VALVE MX 4 3 56 SC 3 10 9 4
SECONDARY
SERVO CONTROL
SHAFT VALVE
3 3 4 4
92 2 95 95 95 X
REVERSE
X CPC VALVE 4
X X 3 X
LUBRICATION 4
RELIEF VALVE CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
(contd)
14-55
03/07/29 09:30:40 61S0X050_140_0059
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND 3RD
1ST ACCUMULATOR 1ST CLUTCH 2ND CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH 4TH CLUTCH
TORQUE 3RD CLUTCH
CONVERTER PRESSURE 4TH ACCUMULATOR
SWITCH
2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE
SWITCH
10 20
30 40
10 20 30 40
SHIFT VALVE E
AX
CPC
4B VALVE B
5K 4 4 5F SHIFT VALVE B SHIFT SOLENOID
X
VALVE B
6
4 30 10 5F 50 5C SB X 4 57 X
91
90
SHIFT SOLENOID
94 VALVE C
9 5E H3X 5F 5G 5K
X
H3X H7X SHIFT VALVE C
5C 48 50 SC
X
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE SHIFT SOLENOID
5E 5F 5K 5K 20 5A 4A 58 4
VALVE A
5G 57 58 56 M1X M2X X
LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE X 5J
5A 5A 58 5A 5H X
X X
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
90 91 X CPC VALVE
SHIFT A CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE VALVE B
A 57
90 91 58 5J 5H 57 HX AX
X X X HX
6
9 25 41 H6X
SHIFT VALVE D A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID
LA 94 91 91 6 VALVE A
6
HX HX
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE 56
4 25 41 40 6
90 90 58 97
90
95 1 3 1 X
93 92
X
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR
93 LOCK-UP CONTROL
X VALVE
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX AX
93 CHECK VALVE MX
4 3 56 SC 3 10 9 4
SECONDARY
SERVO CONTROL
SHAFT VALVE
3 3 4 4
95 95 95 X
92 2
REVERSE
X CPC VALVE 4
X X 3 X
LUBRICATION 4
RELIEF VALVE CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
14-56
03/07/29 09:30:42 61S0X050_140_0060
2 Position
The PCM controls the shift solenoid valves and the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valves. The conditions of the
shift solenoid valves and the positions of the shift valve are as follows:
Shift solenoid valve A is turned ON, and the shift valve A stays on the right side.
Shift solenoid valve B is turned ON, and the shift valve B stays on the right side.
Shift solenoid valve C is turned OFF, and the shift valve C moves to the left side.
The PCM also controls A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve B to apply LS B pressure (57) to CPC valve B. Line
pressure (4) from the manual valve becomes line pressure (5C) at shift valve C. Line pressure (5C) flows to shift valve
A via shift valve B, and becomes 2nd clutch pressure (20). The 2nd clutch pressure is applied to the 2nd clutch, and
2nd clutch is engaged.
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND 3RD
1ST ACCUMULATOR 1ST CLUTCH 2ND CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH 4TH CLUTCH
TORQUE 3RD CLUTCH
CONVERTER PRESSURE 4TH ACCUMULATOR
SWITCH
2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE
SWITCH
10 20
30 40
10 20 30 40
SHIFT VALVE E
AX
CPC
4B VALVE B
5K 4 4 5F SHIFT VALVE B SHIFT SOLENOID
X
VALVE B
6
4 30 10 5F 50 5C SB X 4 57 X
91
90
SHIFT SOLENOID
94 VALVE C
9 5E H3X 5F 5G 5K
X
H3X H7X SHIFT VALVE C
5C 48 50 SC X
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID SHIFT SOLENOID
VALVE
5E 5F 5K 5K 20 5G 5A 4A 58 4
VALVE A
57 58 56 M1X M2X X
LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE X 5J
5A 5A 58 5A 5H
X X X
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
90 91 X CPC VALVE
SHIFT A CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE VALVE B
A 57
90 91 58 5J 5H 57 HX AX
X X X HX
6
9 25 41 H6X
SHIFT VALVE D A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID
LA 94 91 91 6 VALVE A
6
HX HX
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE 56
4 25 41 40 6
90 90 58 97
90
95 1 3 1 X
93 92
X
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR
93
X LOCK-UP CONTROL VALVE
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX AX
93 CHECK VALVE MX 4 3 56 SC 3 10 9 4
SECONDARY
SERVO CONTROL
SHAFT VALVE
3 3 4 4
92 2 95 95 95 X
REVERSE
X CPC VALVE 4
X X 3 X
LUBRICATION 4
RELIEF VALVE CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
(contd)
14-57
03/07/29 09:30:43 61S0X050_140_0061
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND 3RD
1ST ACCUMULATOR 1ST CLUTCH 2ND CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH 4TH CLUTCH
TORQUE 3RD CLUTCH
CONVERTER PRESSURE 4TH ACCUMULATOR
SWITCH
2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE
SWITCH
10 20
30 40
10 20 30 40
SHIFT VALVE E
AX
CPC
4B VALVE B
5K 4 4 5F SHIFT VALVE B SHIFT SOLENOID
X
VALVE B
6
4 30 10 5F 50 5C SB X 4 57 X
91
90
SHIFT SOLENOID
94 VALVE C
9 5E H3X 5F 5G 5K
X
H3X H7X SHIFT VALVE C
5C 48 50 SC
X
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE SHIFT SOLENOID
5E 5F 5K 5K 20 5A 4A 58 4
VALVE A
5G 57 58 56 M1X M2X X
LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE X 5J
5A 5A 58 5A 5H X
X X
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
90 91 X CPC VALVE
SHIFT A CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE VALVE B
A 57
90 91 58 5J 5H 57 HX AX
X X X HX
6
9 25 41 H6X
SHIFT VALVE D A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID
LA 94 91 91 6 VALVE A
6
HX HX
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE 56
4 25 41 40 6
90 90 58 97
90
95 1 3 1 X
93 92
X
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR
93 LOCK-UP CONTROL
X VALVE
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX AX
93 CHECK VALVE MX
4 3 56 SC 3 10 9 4
SECONDARY
SERVO CONTROL
SHAFT VALVE
3 3 4 4
92 2 95 95 95 X
REVERSE
X CPC VALVE 4
X X 3 X
LUBRICATION 4
RELIEF VALVE CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
14-58
03/07/29 09:30:45 61S0X050_140_0062
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND 3RD
1ST ACCUMULATOR 1ST CLUTCH 2ND CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH 4TH CLUTCH
TORQUE 3RD CLUTCH
CONVERTER PRESSURE 4TH ACCUMULATOR
SWITCH
2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE
SWITCH
10 20
30 40
10 20 30 40
SHIFT VALVE E
AX
CPC
4B VALVE B
5K 4 4 5F SHIFT VALVE B SHIFT SOLENOID
X
VALVE B
6
4 30 10 5F 50 5C SB X 4 57 X
90 91
SHIFT SOLENOID
94 VALVE C
9 5E H3X 5F 5G 5K
X
H3X H7X SHIFT VALVE C
5C 48 50 SC X
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE SHIFT SOLENOID
5E 5F 5K 5K 20 5A 4A 58 4
VALVE A
5G 57 58 56 M1X M2X X
LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE X 5J
5A 5A 58 5A 5H
X X X
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
90 91 X CPC VALVE
SHIFT A CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE VALVE B
A 57
90 91 58 5J 5H 57 HX HX AX
X X X
6
9 25 41 H6X
SHIFT VALVE D A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID
LA 94 91 91 6 VALVE A
6
HX HX
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE 56
4 25 41 40 6
90 90 58 97
90
95 1 3 1 X
93 92
X
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR
93
X LOCK-UP CONTROL VALVE
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX AX
93 CHECK VALVE MX 4 3 56 SC 3 10 9 4
SECONDARY
SERVO CONTROL
SHAFT VALVE
3 3 4 4
2 95 95 95 X
92
REVERSE
X CPC VALVE 4
X X 3 X
LUBRICATION 4
RELIEF VALVE CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
(contd)
14-59
03/07/29 09:30:47 61S0X050_140_0063
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
3RD
1ST ACCUMULATOR 2ND
1ST CLUTCH 2ND CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH 4TH CLUTCH
TORQUE 3RD CLUTCH
CONVERTER PRESSURE 4TH ACCUMULATOR
SWITCH
2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE
SWITCH
10 20
30 40
10 20 30 40
SHIFT VALVE E
AX
CPC
4B VALVE B
5K 4 4 5F SHIFT VALVE B SHIFT SOLENOID
X
VALVE B
6
4 30 10 5F 50 5C SB X 4 57 X
91
90
SHIFT SOLENOID
94 VALVE C
9 5E H3X 5F 5G 5K
X
H3X H7X SHIFT VALVE C
5C 48 50 SC X
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID SHIFT SOLENOID
VALVE
5E 5F 5K 5K 20 5A 4A 58 4
VALVE A
5G 57 58 56 M1X M2X X
LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE X 5J
5A 5A 58 5A 5H
X X X
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
90 91 X CPC VALVE
SHIFT A CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE VALVE B
A 57
90 91 58 5J 5H 57 HX AX
X X X HX
6
9 25 41 H6X
SHIFT VALVE D A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID
LA 94 91 91 6 VALVE A
6
HX HX
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE 56
4 25 41 40 6
90 90 58 97
90
95 1 3 1 X
93 92
X
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR
93
X LOCK-UP CONTROL VALVE
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX AX
93 CHECK VALVE MX 4 3 56 SC 3 10 9 4
SECONDARY
SERVO CONTROL
SHAFT VALVE
3 3 4 4
92 2 95 95 95 X
REVERSE
X CPC VALVE 4
X X 3 X
LUBRICATION 4
RELIEF VALVE CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
14-60
03/07/29 09:30:49 61S0X050_140_0064
P Position
Shift solenoid valve C is turned OFF by the PCM, and SH C pressure (SC) is applied to the right side of the reverse CPC
valve. Then the reverse CPC valve is moved to the left side to uncover the port leading line pressure (3) to the servo
valve. Line pressure (3) passes through the servo valve and flows to the manual valve. Line pressure (3) is
intercepted at the manual valve, and is not applied to the clutches.
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
3RD
1ST ACCUMULATOR 2ND
1ST CLUTCH 2ND CLUTCH ACCUMULATOR ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH 4TH CLUTCH
TORQUE 3RD CLUTCH
CONVERTER PRESSURE 4TH ACCUMULATOR
SWITCH
2ND CLUTCH
PRESSURE
SWITCH
10 20
30 40
10 20 30 40
SHIFT VALVE E
AX
CPC
4B VALVE B
5K 4 4 5F SHIFT VALVE B SHIFT SOLENOID
X
VALVE B
6
4 30 10 5F 50 5C SB X 4 57 X
91
90
SHIFT SOLENOID
94 VALVE C
9 5E H3X 5F 5G 5K
X
H3X H7X SHIFT VALVE C
5C 48 50 SC X
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
SOLENOID VALVE SHIFT SOLENOID
5E 5F 5K 5K 20 5G 5A 4A 58 4
VALVE A
57 58 56 M1X M2X X
LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE X 5J
5A 5A 58 5A 5H
X X X
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
90 91 X CPC VALVE
SHIFT A CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE VALVE B
A 57
90 91 58 5J 5H 57 HX HX AX
X X X
6
9 25 41 H6X
SHIFT VALVE D A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID
LA 94 91 91 6 VALVE A
6
HX HX
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE 56
4 25 41 40 6
90 90 58 97
90
95 1 3 1 X
93 92
X
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR
93
X LOCK-UP CONTROL VALVE
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX AX
93 CHECK VALVE MX 4 3 56 SC 3 10 9 4
SECONDARY
SERVO CONTROL
SHAFT VALVE
3 3 4 4
2 95 95 95 X
92
REVERSE
X CPC VALVE 4
X X 3 X
LUBRICATION 4
RELIEF VALVE CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
14-61
03/07/29 09:30:50 61S0X050_140_0065
Automatic Transmission
General Operation
1. Operation (clutch on)
With the torque converter clutch on, fluid in the chamber between the torque converter clutch cover and the
torque converter clutch piston is drained off, and the converter fluid exerts pressure through the piston against
the torque converter cover. As a result, the converter turbine is locked to the converter cover. The effect is to
bypass the converter, placing the vehicle in direct drive.
Power flow
LOCK-UP PISTON DAMPER SPRING
The power flows by way of:
Engine TURBINE
Drive plate
Torque converter cover
TORQUE CONVERTER
Lock-up piston COVER
To ATF cooler
Damper spring
INLET OUTLET
Turbine
Mainshaft
MAINSHAFT
MAINSHAFT
14-62
03/07/29 09:30:51 61S0X050_140_0066
No Lock-up
The torque converter clutch solenoid valve is turned OFF by the PCM. The lock-up shift valve receives LC pressure (LA)
on the left side, and modulator pressure (6) on the right side. The lock-up shift valve is in the right side to uncover the
port leading torque converter pressure (92) to the left side of the torque converter. Torque converter pressure (92)
becomes torque converter pressure (94), and enters into the left side of the torque converter to disengage the torque
converter clutch. The torque converter clutch is OFF.
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
TORQUE CONVERTER
90 91
94
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE
LOCK-UP TIMING
X VALVE
90 91
90 91 58
X X
MODULATOR PRESSURE
LA 94 91 91 6
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE
90 90 58 97
90
93 92
X
93
X LOCK-UP CONTROL
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER
CHECK VALVE MAINSHAFT
COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX
93
CHECK VALVE MX
SECONDARY
SHAFT
92 2 95 95 95
X
X X
RELIEF VALVE LUBRICATION
CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
(contd)
14-63
03/07/29 09:30:52 61S0X050_140_0067
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
TORQUE CONVERTER
91
90
94
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE
X LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE
X
90 91
90 91 58
X X
MODULATOR PRESSURE
LA 94 91 91 6
LS A or LS B PRESSURE
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE
90 90 58 97
90
93 92
93 X
X LOCK-UP CONTROL
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE
COUNTER-
SHAFT
COOLER AX
93 CHECK VALVE MX
SECONDARY
SHAFT
92 2 95 95 95
X
X X
LUBRICATION
RELIEF VALVE CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
14-64
03/07/29 09:30:52 61S0X050_140_0068
Full Lock-up
When the vehicle speed further increases, the PCM controls A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valves A and B to
increase LS A or LS B pressure (58). The LS A or LS B pressure (58) is applied to the lock-up control valve and the lock-
up timing valve, and moves them to the left side. Under this condition, torque converter back pressure is released fully,
causing the torque converter clutch to be fully engaged.
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
TORQUE CONVERTER
91
90
94
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE
X
LOCK-UP TIMING
VALVE
90 91 X
90 91 58
X X
MODULATOR PRESSURE
LA 94 91 91 6
LS A or LS B PRESSURE
96 92 93
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE
90 90 58 97
90
93 92
X
93
X LOCK-UP CONTROL
VALVE
TORQUE
CONVERTER MAINSHAFT
CHECK VALVE
COUNTER-
SHAFT
AX
COOLER
93 CHECK VALVE MX
SECONDARY
SHAFT
92 2 95 95 95
X
X X
LUBRICATION
CHECK VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
99
ATF PUMP
ATF COOLER
14-65
03/07/29 09:30:54 61S0X050_140_0069
Automatic Transmission
BAT
No.6 (15A)
IGNITION
SWITCH No.1 (15A) MULTIPLEX CONTROL
UNIT (DRIVERS)
B22 SHIFT LOCK
DRIVERS YEL GRN SOLENOID
UNDERDASH 1 2
No.54 (40A) No.46 (15A) FUSE/RELAY BOX
A/T GEAR
POSITION
WHT/YEL YEL/BLK YEL/BLK BLK BLK SWITCH G401
P POSITION
B21 B1 B9 B2 B10 G101 D5 A28
VBU IGP1 IGP2 PG1 PG2 VB SOL ILU
To 5V
To 12V
5V 5V
REGULATOR REGULATOR
CPU
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
C4 STARTER
R WHT WHT WHT
YEL CUT RELAY
C16
B11
N RED/BLK RED/BLK
DIMMING
CIRCUIT D4 CRUISE
C13
YEL YEL CONTROL
UNIT
B10 C6
DASH LIGHT RED D3 PNK PNK
BRIGHTNESS
B22 C7
CONTROLLER RED/BLK 2 BLU BLU LT BLU
C5
1 BRN BRN BLK
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 1 2 3
B16
G101
BLK BLK/BLU RED GRN BRN PNK
G503 D4 ST A E
N D3
R 2
P 1
14-66
03/07/29 09:30:55 61S0X050_140_0070
WHT/YEL
WHT/YEL
7
MAINSHAFT COUNTERSHAFT
SPEED SENSOR SPEED SENSOR
KEY
INTERLOCK ENGINE
SWITCH BRAKE THROTTLE COOLANT
SWITCH POSITION TEMPERATURE
SENSOR SENSOR
KEY CRUISE
INTERLOCK DATA LINK CONTROL ABS/TCS
SOLENOID 1 2 1 2 3 2 1
5 CONNECTOR UNIT UNIT
G401
PARK
PIN WHT/BLK BRN BLU/GRN LT GRN RED WHT BLU GRN RED/BLK RED/WHT
SWITCH
YEL/BLU GRN/BLK
A32 A10 A5 A11 D11 D12 D10 D16 C28 C27 C18 C26
BK SW SCS CRS ATSFTP NM NMSG NC NCSG VCC2 TPS SG2 ECT
WHT RED GRN ORN YEL BLU/YEL GRN/WHT GRN BLU/BLK WHT/RED BRN/BLK BRN/BLK
3 1
G101 G101
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 2 3 5
12 13 14 15 17 18 19 20 21 23 24 9 10 11 12 14 15 17 18 12 13 14 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 20 21 22 23 24 25 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 13 14 15 16
14-67
03/07/29 09:30:57 61S0X050_140_0071
Automatic Transmission
A/T GEAR
POSITION
WHT/YEL YEL/BLK YEL/BLK BLK BLK SWITCH G401
P POSITION
A1 A3 A2 A5 A4 G101 B24 E15
VBU IGP1 IGP2 PG1 PG2 VB SOL ILU
To 5V
To 12V
5V 5V
REGULATOR REGULATOR
CPU
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
C4 STARTER
R WHT WHT WHT CUT RELAY
YEL
C16
B11
N RED/BLK RED/BLK
DIMMING
CIRCUIT D4 CRUISE
C13
YEL YEL CONTROL
UNIT
B10 C6
DASH LIGHT RED D3 PNK PNK
BRIGHTNESS
B22 C7
CONTROLLER RED/BLK 2 BLU BLU LT BLU
C5
1 BRN BRN BLK
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 1 2 3
D4 ST A E
N D3
R 2
G503 P 1
14-68
03/07/29 09:30:59 61S0X050_140_0072
WHT/YEL
WHT/YEL
7
MAINSHAFT COUNTERSHAFT
SPEED SENSOR SPEED SENSOR
KEY
INTERLOCK BRAKE ENGINE
SWITCH PEDAL THROTTLE COOLANT
POSITION POSITION
SENSOR TEMPERATURE
SWITCH SENSOR
KEY
INTERLOCK
SOLENOID 1 2 1 2 3 2 1
5 CRUISE
DATA LINK CONTROL ABS/TCS
CONNECTOR UNIT UNIT
STEERING LOCK WHT/RED BLK
ASSSEMBLY 3 1
G401
PARK
PIN WHT/BLK BRN BLU/GRN LT GRN RED WHT BLU GRN RED/BLK RED/WHT
SWITCH
YEL/BLU GRN/BLK
WHT RED GRN ORN YEL BLU/YEL GRN/WHT GRN BLU/BLK WHT/RED BRN/BLK BRN/BLK
3 1
G101 G101
1 2 3 4 5 6 9 2 3 5 6 7 1 2 4 6 7 3 5 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 19 20 8 9 10 12 13 14 16 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 9 11 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 17 19 20 21 22 16 22 23 24 26 27 28 29 30 31
14-69
03/07/29 09:30:59 61S0X050_140_0073
Automatic Transmission
DTC Troubleshooting
1999-2000 Models 4. Disconnect the D (16P) connector from the PCM.
DTC P0715: Problem in Mainshaft Speed 5. Check for continuity between body ground and the
Sensor Circuit D11 terminal and D12 terminal individually.
NOTE: Record all freeze data and review General PCM CONNECTOR D (16P)
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before
you troubleshoot.
3. Measure mainshaft speed sensor resistance at the 7. Measure the resistance between the D11 and D12
sensor connector. terminals.
MAINSHAFT SPEED SENSOR PCM CONNECTOR D (16P)
CONNECTOR
NMSG (WHT)
NM (RED)
NOGo to step 8.
14-70
03/07/29 09:31:00 61S0X050_140_0074
NM (RED)
MAINSHAFT SPEED
SENSOR CONNECTOR
RED
Is there continuity?
NMSG (WHT)
MAINSHAFT SPEED
SENSOR CONNECTOR
WHT
Is there continuity?
14-71
03/07/29 09:31:00 61S0X050_140_0075
Automatic Transmission
YESGo to step 2.
Wire side of female terminals
NOReinstall and recheck.
Is there continuity?
2. Disconnect the 2P connector from the countershaft
speed sensor. YESRepair short to ground in the wires between
the D10 and D16 terminals and the countershaft
3. Measure countershaft speed sensor resistance at speed sensor.
the sensor connector.
NOGo to step 6.
COUNTERSHAFT SPEED
SENSOR CONNECTOR
6. Connect the countershaft speed sensor connector.
NC (BLU)
Is there 400600 ?
NOReplace the countershaft speed sensor (see Wire side of female terminals
page 14-134).
Is there 400600 ?
4. Disconnect the D (16P) connector from the PCM.
YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
PCM and recheck.
14-72
03/07/29 09:31:01 61S0X050_140_0076
DTC P0730: Problem in Shift Control System Does the scan tool or the HDS indicate code
P07 30?
NOTE:
Record all freeze data and review General YESReplace the transmission.
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before
you troubleshoot. NOThe system is OK at this time.
Keep replacement control solenoid valves on hand:
Lock-up control solenoid valve/shift control
solenoid valve A assembly
Shift control solenoid valves B and C
A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve A/B
assembly
NOGo to step 2.
YESGo to step 3.
14-73
03/07/29 09:31:01 61S0X050_140_0077
Automatic Transmission
NOGo to step 2.
YESGo to step 3.
14-74
03/07/29 09:31:02 61S0X050_140_0078
DTC P0753: Problem in Shift Control Solenoid 6. Measure the resistance between the D7 and B20 or
Valve A Circuit B22 terminals.
NOTE: PCM CONNECTORS
Record all freeze data and review General SH A (BLU/YEL)
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before
you troubleshoot. B (25P) D (16P)
This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem
and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the
transmission.
Is there voltage?
(contd)
14-75
03/07/29 09:31:02 61S0X050_140_0079
Automatic Transmission
B (25P) D (16P)
SH A (GRN/WHT)
Is there 1225 ?
14-76
03/07/29 09:31:03 61S0X050_140_0080
DTC P0758: Problem in Shift Control Solenoid 6. Measure the resistance between the D2 and B20 or
Valve B Circuit B22 terminals.
NOTE: PCM CONNECTORS
Record all freeze data and review General SH B (GRN/WHT)
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before
you troubleshoot. B (25P) D (16P)
This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem
and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the
transmission.
Is there voltage?
(contd)
14-77
03/07/29 09:31:04 61S0X050_140_0081
Automatic Transmission
14-78
03/07/29 09:31:05 61S0X050_140_0082
DTC P0763: Problem in Shift Control Solenoid 6. Measure the resistance between the D3 and B20 or
Valve C Circuit B22 terminals.
NOTE: Record all freeze data and review General PCM CONNECTORS
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before SH C (GRN)
you troubleshoot.
B (25P) D (16P)
PCM CONNECTORS
Is there 1225 ?
SH C (GRN)
B (25P) D (16P) YESGo to step 11.
NOGo to step 7.
Is there voltage?
LG1 (BRN/BLK) LG2 (BRN/BLK)
YESRepair short to power in the wire between
the D3 terminal and the shift control solenoid
valve C.
NOGo to step 5.
Wire side of female terminals
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 8.
(contd)
14-79
03/07/29 09:31:05 61S0X050_140_0083
Automatic Transmission
Is there 1225 ?
14-80
03/07/29 09:31:06 61S0X050_140_0084
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 8. Shift to all positions other than P or N.
2. Observe the A/T gear position indicator, and shift 9. Measure the voltage between the B14 and B20 or
each position separately. B22 terminals.
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
Do any indicators stay on when the shif t lever is
not in that position?
YESGo to step 3.
ATP R (WHT)
LG2 (BRN/BLK)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
(contd)
14-81
03/07/29 09:31:06 61S0X050_140_0085
Automatic Transmission
LG2 (BRN/BLK)
ATP D3
(PNK)
LG2 (BRN/BLK)
LG1 (BRN/BLK) ATP D4 (YEL)
NOCheck for a short in the wire between the D9 YESGo to step 14.
terminal and the A/T gear position switch or A/T
gear position indicator. If wire is OK, check for NOCheck for a short in the wire between the D8
loose terminal fit in the PCM connectors. If terminal and the A/T gear position switch or A/T
necessary, substitute a known-good PCM and gear position indicator. If wires are OK, check for
recheck. loose terminal fit in the PCM connectors. If
necessary, substitute a known-good PCM and
recheck.
14-82
03/07/29 09:31:07 61S0X050_140_0086
14. Shift to all positions other than 2. 16. Shift to all positions other than 1.
15. Measure the voltage between the D14 and B20 or 17. Measure the voltage between the D15 and B20 or
B22 terminals. B22 terminals.
PCM CONNECTORS PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P) D (16P) B (25P) D (16P)
YESGo to step 16. YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
NOCheck for a short in the wire between the D14 PCM and recheck.
terminal and the A/T gear position switch or A/T
gear position indicator. If wires are OK, check for NOCheck for a short in the wire between the D15
loose terminal fit in the PCM connectors. If terminal and the A/T gear position switch or A/T
necessary, substitute a known-good PCM and gear position indicator. If wires are OK, check for
recheck. loose terminal fit in the PCM connectors. If
necessary, substitute a known-good PCM and
recheck.
14-83
03/07/29 09:31:08 61S0X050_140_0087
Automatic Transmission
DTC P1706: Open in A/T Gear Position Switch 6. Measure the voltage between the D9 and B20 or
Circuit B22 terminals.
PCM CONNECTORS
NOTE: B (25P) D (16P)
Record all freeze data and review General
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before
you troubleshoot.
This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem
and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the
transmission.
LG2 (BRN/BLK)
1. Test the A/T gear position switch (see page 14-173).
3. Check for continuity between the B20 and B22 NOGo to step 7.
terminals and body ground.
7. Shift to R position.
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
8. Measure the voltage between the D6 and B20 or
B22 terminals.
PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P) D (16P)
ATP R (WHT)
NORepair open in the wires between the B20 and Is there voltage?
B22 terminals and ground (G101), or repair poor
ground (G101). YESRepair open in the wire between the D6
terminal and the A/T gear position switch.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
NOGo to step 9.
14-84
03/07/29 09:31:09 61S0X050_140_0088
10. Measure the voltage between the B14 and B20 or 14. Measure the voltage between the D14 and B20 or
B22 terminals. B22 terminals.
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P) PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P) D (16P)
ATP NP (BLU/WHT)
ATP 2 (BLU)
LG2 (BRN/BLK)
LG2 (BRN/BLK)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
Wire side of female terminals Wire side of female terminals
YESRepair open in the wire between the B14 YESRepair open in the wire between the D14
terminal and the A/T gear position switch. terminal and the A/T gear position switch.
12. Measure the voltage between the D8 and B20 or 16. Measure the voltage between the D15 and B20 or
B22 terminals. B22 terminals.
PCM CONNECTORS PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P) D (16P) B (25P) D (16P)
YESRepair open in the wire between the D8 YESRepair open in the wire between the D15
terminal and the A/T gear position switch. terminal and the A/T gear position switch.
NOGo to step 13. NOCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
PCM and recheck.
14-85
03/07/29 09:31:09 61S0X050_140_0089
Automatic Transmission
DTC P1738: Problem in 2nd Clutch Pressure 4. Disconnect the D (16P) connector from the PCM.
Switch Circuit
5. Disconnect the 2nd clutch pressure switch
NOTE: Record all freeze data and review General connector.
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before
you troubleshoot. 6. Check for continuity between the D13 terminal and
body ground.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
PCM CONNECTOR D (16P)
2. Measure the voltage between the D13 and B20 or
B22 terminals.
PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P) D (16P)
OP2SW (BLU/BLK)
OP2SW (BLU/BLK)
LG2 (BRN/BLK)
Wire side of female terminals
Wire side of female terminals YESRepair short to ground in the wire between
the D13 terminal and the 2nd clutch pressure
Is there battery voltage? switch.
14-86
03/07/29 09:31:10 61S0X050_140_0090
7. Raise the front of the vehicle, and make sure it is 14. Measure the voltage between the 2nd clutch
securely supported. pressure switch connector terminal and body
ground.
8. Set the parking brake, and block rear wheels
2ND CLUTCH PRESSURE
securely. SWITCH CONNECTOR
10. Measure the voltage between the D13 and B20 or BLU/BLK
B22 terminals.
PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P) D (16P)
Is there 10 M or more?
14-87
03/07/29 09:31:10 61S0X050_140_0091
Automatic Transmission
DTC P1739: Problem in 3rd Clutch Pressure 4. Disconnect the B (25P) connector from the PCM.
Switch Circuit
5. Disconnect the 3rd clutch pressure switch
NOTE: Record all freeze data and review General connector.
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before
you troubleshoot. 6. Check for continuity between the B24 terminal and
body ground.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
2. Measure the voltage between the B24 and B20 or
B22 terminals.
OP3SW (WHT/RED)
LG2 (BRN/BLK)
Wire side of female terminals YESRepair short to ground in the wire between
the B24 terminal and the 3rd clutch pressure
Is there battery voltage? switch.
14-88
03/07/29 09:31:11 61S0X050_140_0092
7. Raise the front of the vehicle, and make sure it is 14. Measure the voltage between the 3rd clutch
securely supported. pressure switch connector terminal and body
ground.
8. Set the parking brake, and block rear wheels
securely. 3RD CLUTCH PRESSURE
SWITCH CONNECTOR
Wire side of female terminals 15. Measure the resistance between the 3rd clutch
pressure switch connector terminal and body
Is there about 0 V ? ground.
3RD CLUTCH PRESSURE
YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM SWITCH CONNECTOR
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
PCM and recheck.
Is there 10 M or more?
14-89
03/07/29 09:31:12 61S0X050_140_0093
Automatic Transmission
DTC P1753: Problem in Lock-up Control 6. Measure the resistance between the D1 and B20 or
Solenoid Valve Circuit B22 terminals.
NOTE: Record all freeze data and review General PCM CONNECTORS
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before LC (YEL)
you troubleshoot.
B (25P) D (16P)
NOGo to step 7.
Is there voltage?
YESRepair short to power in the wire between LG1 (BRN/BLK) LG2 (BRN/BLK)
the D1 terminal and the lock-up control solenoid
valve.
NOGo to step 5.
Wire side of female terminals
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 8.
14-90
03/07/29 09:31:12 61S0X050_140_0094
8. Disconnect the 3P connector from the lock-up 11. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
control solenoid valve/shift control solenoid valve
A assembly. 12. Measure the voltage between the D5 and B20 or
B22 terminals.
9. Check for continuity between the D1 and B20 or
B22 terminals. PCM CONNECTORS
VB SOL (BLK/YEL)
PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P) D (16P)
LC (YEL)
B (25P) D (16P)
LC (BLU/YEL)
14-91
03/07/29 09:31:13 61S0X050_140_0095
Automatic Transmission
DTC P1768: Problem in A/T Clutch Pressure 4. Check for continuity between body ground and the
Control Solenoid Valve A Circuit B8 terminal and the B17 terminal individually.
NOTE: PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
Record all freeze data and review General LS AM (WHT)
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before
you troubleshoot.
This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem
and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the
transmission.
LS AP (RED)
1. Disconnect the 2P connector from A/T clutch
pressure control solenoid valve A.
NOGo to step 5.
LS AP (RED)
YESGo to step 7.
14-92
03/07/29 09:31:14 61S0X050_140_0096
7. Disconnect the D (16P) connector from the PCM. 10. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
8. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 11. Check for continuity between the B20 and B22
terminals and body ground.
9. Measure the voltage between the D5 and B20 or
B22 terminals. PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
PCM CONNECTORS
VB SOL (BLK/YEL)
B (25P) D (16P)
Is there battery voltage? YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
YESGo to step 10. PCM and recheck.
NOCheck for blown No. 6 (15A) fuse in the NORepair open in the wire between the B2, B10,
drivers under-dash fuse/relay box. If the fuse is OK, B20, and B22 terminals and ground (G101), or
repair open in the wire between the D5 terminal repair poor ground (G101).
and the drivers under-dash fuse/relay box.
14-93
03/07/29 09:31:14 61S0X050_140_0097
Automatic Transmission
DTC P1773: Problem in A/T Clutch Pressure 4. Check for continuity between body ground and the
Control Solenoid Valve B Circuit B18 terminal and the B25 terminal individually.
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
NOTE:
Record all freeze data and review General
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before
you troubleshoot.
This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem
and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the LS BM (GRN)
transmission. LS BP (ORN)
NOGo to step 5.
YESGo to step 3.
LS BP (ORN)
YESGo to step 7.
14-94
03/07/29 09:31:15 61S0X050_140_0098
7. Disconnect the D (16P) connector from the PCM. 10. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
8. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 11. Check for continuity between the B20 and B22
terminals and body ground individually.
9. Measure the voltage between the D5 and B20 or
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
B22 terminals.
PCM CONNECTORS
VB SOL (BLK/YEL)
B (25P) D (16P)
Is there battery voltage? YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
YESGo to step 10. PCM and recheck.
NOCheck for blown No. 6 (15A) fuse in the NORepair open in the wire between the B2, B10,
drivers under-dash fuse/relay box. If the fuse is OK, B20, and B22 terminals and ground (G101), or
repair open in the wire between the D5 terminal repair poor ground (G101).
and the drivers under-dash fuse/relay box.
14-95
03/07/29 09:31:15 61S0X050_140_0099
Automatic Transmission
Are the mainshaf t and the countershaf t speed YESRepair short in the wires between PCM
sensors installed properly? connector terminals C6 and C7, and the mainshaft
speed sensor.
YESGo to step 2.
NOGo to step 6.
NOReinstall and recheck.
6. Connect the mainshaft speed sensor connector.
2. Disconnect the mainshaft speed sensor connector
(2P). 7. Measure the resistance between PCM connector
terminals C6 and C7.
3. Measure the mainshaft speed sensor resistance at
the sensor connector. PCM CONNECTOR C (22P)
14-96
03/07/29 09:31:16 61S0X050_140_0100
8. Disconnect the mainshaft speed sensor connector 10. Check for continuity between PCM connector
(2P). terminal C6 and the No. 2 terminal of the mainshaft
speed sensor connector.
9. Check for continuity between PCM connector
terminal C7 and the No. 1 terminal of the mainshaft PCM CONNECTOR C (22P)
speed sensor connector.
NM SG (WHT)
PCM CONNECTOR C (22P)
NM (RED)
MAINSHAFT SPEED
SENSOR CONNECTOR
WHT
MAINSHAFT SPEED
SENSOR CONNECTOR
RED Wire side of female terminals
14-97
03/07/29 09:32:18 61S0X050_140_0101
Automatic Transmission
COUNTERSHAFT SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR 7. Measure the resistance between PCM connector
terminals C14 and C15.
PCM CONNECTOR C (22P)
NC (BLU)
NC SG (GRN)
YESGo to step 4.
Is there 400600 ?
NOReplace the countershaft speed sensor (see
page 14-134). YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
4. Disconnect PCM connector C (22P). PCM and recheck.
14-98
03/07/29 09:32:19 61S0X050_140_0102
2001 Model 4. Clear the DTC with the scan tool or the HDS.
DTC P0730: Problem in Shift Control System 5. Drive the vehicle at speeds over 12 mph (20 km/h)
in 1st, 2nd, 3rd, and 4th gear in D4 position for
NOTE: more than 30 seconds.
Record all freeze data and review General
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before 6. Recheck for code P0730.
you troubleshoot.
Keep replacement solenoid valves on hand: Does the scan tool or the HDS indicate code
Torque converter clutch solenoid valve-shift P07 30?
solenoid valve A
Shift solenoid valves B and C YESReplace the transmission.
A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valves A and B
NOThe system is OK at this time.
1. Check whether the scan tool or the HDS indicates
another code.
NOGo to step 2.
YESGo to step 3.
14-99
03/07/29 09:32:19 61S0X050_140_0103
Automatic Transmission
DTC P0740: Problem in Lock-up Control 5. Using the scan tool, check to be sure that the
System engine coolant temperature is 176F (80C) or
above.
NOTE:
Record all freeze data and review General 6. Drive the vehicle under the same conditions as
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before those indicated by the freeze data for more than 1
you troubleshoot. minute, or drive the vehicle at 55 mph (88 km/h)
Keep replacement solenoid valves on hand: with TPS voltage 0.8 V for more than 1 minute.
Torque converter clutch solenoid valve-shift
solenoid valve A 7. Recheck for code P0740.
A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valves A and B
Does the scan tool or the HDS indicate code
1. Check whether the scan tool or the HDS indicates P07 40?
another code.
YESInspect the O-ring on the torque converter. If
Does the scan tool or the HDS indicate another the O-ring is missing, replace the O-ring. If the O-
code? ring is damaged or OK, replace the transmission
and torque converter.
YESPerform the Troubleshooting Flowchart for
the indicated Code(s). Recheck for code P0740 after NOThe system is OK at this time.
troubleshooting.
NOGo to step 2.
YESGo to step 3.
14-100
03/07/29 09:32:20 61S0X050_140_0104
DTC P0753: Problem in Shift Solenoid Valve 6. Measure the resistance between PCM connector
A Circuit terminals C2 and A25 or A26.
NOTE: PCM CONNECTORS
Record all freeze data and review General
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before SH A (BLU/YEL)
you troubleshoot. C (22P)
A (31P)
This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem
and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the
transmission.
NOGo to step 5.
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 8.
(contd)
14-101
03/07/29 09:32:20 61S0X050_140_0105
Automatic Transmission
9. Check for continuity between PCM connector 13. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals C2 and A25 or A26. terminals B24 and A25 or A26.
PCM CONNECTORS PCM CONNECTORS
A (31P) C (22P)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
LG2 (BRN/BLK) LG1 (BRN/BLK)
LG2 (BRN/BLK) VB SOL (BLK/YEL)
Wire side of female terminals Wire side of female terminals
YESRepair short to ground in the wire between YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
PCM connector terminal C2 and the shift solenoid connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
valve A. PCM and recheck.
NOGo to step 10. NOCheck for blown No. 6 (15A) fuse in the drivers
under-dash fuse/relay box. If the fuse is OK, repair
10. Measure the resistance between the No. 1 terminal open in the wire between PCM connector terminal
of torque converter clutch solenoid valve-shift B24 and the drivers under-dash fuse/relay box.
solenoid valve A connector and body ground.
SH A (GRN/WHT)
Is there 1225 ?
14-102
03/07/29 09:32:21 61S0X050_140_0106
DTC P0758: Problem in Shift Solenoid Valve 6. Measure the resistance between PCM connector
B Circuit terminals C9 and A25 or A26.
NOTE: PCM CONNECTORS
Record all freeze data and review General
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before A (31P) C (22P)
you troubleshoot.
This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem
and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the
transmission.
NOGo to step 5.
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 8.
(contd)
14-103
03/07/29 09:32:22 61S0X050_140_0107
Automatic Transmission
9. Check for continuity between PCM connector 12. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
terminals C9 and A25 or A26.
13. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
PCM CONNECTORS terminals B24 and A25 or A26.
A (31P) C (22P)
PCM CONNECTORS
A (31P) B (24P)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
10. Measure the shift solenoid valve B resistance at the NOCheck for blown No. 6 (15A) fuse in the drivers
solenoid valve connector. under-dash fuse/relay box. If the fuse is OK, repair
open in the wire between PCM connector terminal
SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE B B24 and the drivers under-dash fuse/relay box.
CONNECTOR
Is there 1225 ?
14-104
03/07/29 09:32:23 61S0X050_140_0108
DTC P0763: Problem in Shift Solenoid Valve 6. Measure the resistance between PCM connector
C Circuit terminals C17 and A25 or A26.
NOTE: PCM CONNECTORS
Record all freeze data and review General
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before A (31P) C (22P)
you troubleshoot.
This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem
and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the
transmission. SH C (GRN)
LG2 (BRN/BLK)
2. Disconnect PCM connectors A (31P) and C (22P).
Wire side of female terminals
3. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
LG2 (BRN/BLK)
NOGo to step 5.
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 8.
(contd)
14-105
03/07/29 09:32:23 61S0X050_140_0109
Automatic Transmission
SH C (GRN)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
LG2 (BRN/BLK)
LG2 (BRN/BLK) VB SOL (BLK/YEL)
Wire side of female terminals
Wire side of female terminals
Is there continuity?
Is there battery voltage?
YESRepair short to ground in the wire between
PCM connector terminal C17 and the shift solenoid YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
valve C. connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
PCM and recheck.
NOGo to step 10.
NOCheck for blown No. 6 (15A) fuse in the
10. Measure the shift solenoid valve C resistance at the drivers under-dash fuse/relay box. If the fuse is OK,
solenoid valve connector. repair open in the wire between PCM connector
terminal B24 and the drivers under-dash fuse/relay
SHIFT SOLENOID VALVE C box.
CONNECTOR
Is there 1225 ?
14-106
03/07/29 09:32:24 61S0X050_140_0110
2001 Model
NOGo to step 2.
14-107
03/07/29 09:32:24 61S0X050_140_0111
Automatic Transmission
A (31P) C (22P)
NOTE:
Record all freeze data and review General
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before
you troubleshoot. LG1 (BRN/BLK)
This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem LG2 (BRN/BLK) ATP R (WHT)
and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the Wire side of female terminals
transmission.
Is there battery voltage?
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
YESGo to step 8.
2. Observe the A/T gear position indicator, and shift
each position separately. NOCheck for a short in the wire between PCM
connector terminal C21 and the transmission range
Do any indicators stay on when the shif t lever is switch or A/T gear position indicator, and check for
not in that position? an open in the wires between PCM connector
terminals A25 and A26, and body ground (G101). If
YESGo to step 3. the wires are OK, check for loose terminal fit in the
PCM connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-
NOThe system is OK at this time. Check the wire good PCM and recheck.
harness for damage.
8. Shift to any position other than P or N.
3. Disconnect the transmission range switch
connector. 9. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals C22 and A25 or A26.
Do all gear position indicators go out?
PCM CONNECTORS
NOGo to step 4.
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
4. Turn the ignition switch OFF, and connect the
transmission range switch connector. LG2 (BRN/BLK) ATP NP (BLU/WHT)
14-108
03/07/29 09:32:25 61S0X050_140_0112
10. Shift to any position other than D4. 12. Shift to any position other than D3.
11. Measure the voltage between PCM connector 13. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals C13 and A25 or A26. terminals C4 and A25 or A26.
PCM CONNECTORS PCM CONNECTORS
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
NOCheck for a short in the wire between PCM NOCheck for a short in the wire between PCM
connector terminal C13 and the transmission range connector terminal C4 and the transmission range
switch or A/T gear position indicator. If the wire is switch or A/T gear position indicator. If the wire is
OK, check for loose terminal fit in the PCM OK, check for loose terminal fit in the PCM
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
PCM and recheck. PCM and recheck.
(contd)
14-109
03/07/29 09:32:25 61S0X050_140_0113
Automatic Transmission
15. Measure the voltage between PCM connector 17. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals C12 and A25 or A26. terminals C20 and A25 or A26.
PCM CONNECTORS PCM CONNECTORS
YESGo to step 16. YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
NOCheck for a short in the wire between PCM PCM and recheck.
connector terminal C12 and the transmission range
switch or A/T gear position indicator. If the wire is NOCheck for a short in the wire between PCM
OK, check for loose terminal fit in the PCM connector terminal C20 and the transmission range
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good switch or A/T gear position indicator. If the wire is
PCM and recheck. OK, check for loose terminal fit in the PCM
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
PCM and recheck.
14-110
03/07/29 09:32:26 61S0X050_140_0114
DTC P1706: Open in Transmission Range 6. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
Switch Circuit terminals C13 and A25 or A26.
NOTE: PCM CONNECTORS
Record all freeze data and review General
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before A (31P) C (22P)
you troubleshoot.
This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem
and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the
transmission.
1. Test the transmission range switch (see page 14- LG1 (BRN/BLK)
173).
LG2 (BRN/BLK) ATP D4 (YEL)
YESGo to step 2.
Is there voltage?
NOReplace the transmission range switch (see
page 14-174). YESRepair open in the wire between PCM
connector terminal C13 and the transmission range
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF. switch.
A (31P) C (22P)
LG2 (BRN/BLK) LG1 (BRN/BLK)
YESGo to step 4.
Is there voltage?
NORepair open in the wires between PCM
connector terminals A25 and A26, and ground YESRepair open in the wire between PCM
(G101), or repair poor ground (G101). connector terminal C21 and the transmission range
switch.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
NOGo to step 9.
(contd)
14-111
03/07/29 09:32:27 61S0X050_140_0115
Automatic Transmission
10. Measure the voltage between PCM connector 14. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals C22 and A25 or A26. terminals C12 and A25 or A26.
PCM CONNECTORS PCM CONNECTORS
YESRepair open in the wire between PCM YESRepair open in the wire between PCM
connector terminal C22 and the transmission range connector terminal C12 and the transmission range
switch. switch.
12. Measure the voltage between PCM connector 16. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals C4 and A25 or A26. terminals C20 and A25 or A26.
PCM CONNECTORS PCM CONNECTORS
A (31P) C (22P)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
LG2 (BRN/BLK) LG1 (BRN/BLK)
LG2 (BRN/BLK) ATP 1 (BRN)
YESRepair open in the wire between PCM YESRepair open in the wire between PCM
connector terminal C4 and the transmission range connector terminal C20 and the transmission range
switch. switch.
NOGo to step 13. NOCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
PCM and recheck.
14-112
03/07/29 09:32:28 61S0X050_140_0116
DTC P1738: Problem in 2nd Clutch Pressure 4. Disconnect PCM connector C (22P).
Switch Circuit
5. Disconnect the 2nd clutch pressure switch
NOTE: Record all freeze data and review General connector.
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before
you troubleshoot. 6. Check for continuity between PCM connector
terminal C11 and body ground.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
PCM CONNECTOR C (22P)
2. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals C11 and A25 or A26.
PCM CONNECTORS
(contd)
14-113
03/07/29 09:32:28 61S0X050_140_0117
Automatic Transmission
PCM CONNECTORS
A (31P) C (22P)
Is there 10 M or more?
14-114
03/07/29 09:32:29 61S0X050_140_0118
DTC P1739: Problem in 3rd Clutch Pressure 4. Disconnect PCM connector C (22P).
Switch Circuit
5. Disconnect the 3rd clutch pressure switch
NOTE: Record all freeze data and review General connector.
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before
you troubleshoot. 6. Check for continuity between PCM connector
terminal C19 and body ground.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
PCM CONNECTOR C (22P)
2. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals C19 and A25 or A26.
PCM CONNECTORS
(contd)
14-115
03/07/29 09:32:30 61S0X050_140_0119
Automatic Transmission
PCM CONNECTORS
A (31P) C (22P)
Wire side of female terminal
Is there 10 M or more?
14-116
03/07/29 09:32:30 61S0X050_140_0120
2001 Model
NOGo to step 2.
14-117
03/07/29 09:32:30 61S0X050_140_0121
Automatic Transmission
NOGo to step 2.
14-118
03/07/29 09:32:31 61S0X050_140_0122
DTC P1753: Problem in Torque Converter 6. Measure the resistance between PCM connector
Clutch Solenoid Valve Circuit terminals C10 and A25 or A26.
NOTE: PCM CONNECTORS
Record all freeze data and review General
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-3) before A (31P) C (22P)
you troubleshoot.
This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem
and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the
transmission. LC (YEL)
LG2 (BRN/BLK)
2. Disconnect PCM connectors A (31P) and C (22P).
Wire side of female terminals
3. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
LG2 (BRN/BLK)
NOGo to step 5.
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 8.
(contd)
14-119
03/07/29 09:32:31 61S0X050_140_0123
Automatic Transmission
LC (YEL)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
LG2 (BRN/BLK)
LG2 (BRN/BLK) VB SOL (BLK/YEL)
Wire side of female terminals
Wire side of female terminals
Is there continuity?
Is there battery voltage?
YESRepair short to ground in the wire between
PCM connector terminal C10 and the torque YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
converter clutch solenoid valve. connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
PCM and recheck.
NOGo to step 10.
NOCheck for blown No. 6 (15A) fuse in the drivers
10. Measure the resistance between the No. 3 terminal under-dash fuse/relay box. If the fuse is OK, repair
of the torque converter clutch solenoid valve-shift open in the wire between PCM connector terminal
solenoid valve A connector and body ground. B24 and the drivers under-dash fuse/relay box.
LC (BLU/YEL)
Is there 1225 ?
14-120
03/07/29 09:32:32 61S0X050_140_0124
NOGo to step 5.
Is there 310 ?
YESGo to step 7.
(contd)
14-121
03/07/29 09:32:33 61S0X050_140_0125
Automatic Transmission
8. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 11. Check for continuity between PCM connector
terminal A25 and body ground, and between
9. Measure the voltage between PCM connector terminal A26 and body ground.
terminals B24 and A25 or A26.
PCM CONNECTOR A (31P)
PCM CONNECTORS
A (31P) B (24P)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
Is there continuity?
Is there battery voltage?
YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
YESGo to step 10. connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
PCM and recheck.
NOCheck for blown No. 6 (15A) fuse in the
drivers under-dash fuse/relay box. If the fuse is OK, NORepair open in the wire between PCM
repair open in the wire between PCM connector connector terminals A25 and A26, and body ground
terminal B24 and the drivers under-dash fuse/relay (G101), or repair poor ground (G101).
box.
14-122
03/07/29 09:32:33 61S0X050_140_0126
NOGo to step 5.
Is there 310 ?
YESGo to step 7.
(contd)
14-123
03/07/29 09:32:34 61S0X050_140_0127
Automatic Transmission
8. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 11. Check for continuity between PCM connector
terminal A25 and body ground, and between
9. Measure the voltage between PCM connector terminal A26 and body ground.
terminals B24 and A25 or A26.
PCM CONNECTOR A (31P)
PCM CONNECTORS
A (31P) B (24P)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
Is there continuity?
Is there battery voltage?
YESCheck for blown No. 6 (15A) fuse in the
YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM drivers under-dash fuse/relay box. If the fuse is OK,
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good repair open in the wire between PCM connector
PCM and recheck. terminal B24 and the drivers under-dash fuse/relay
box.
NOGo to step 10.
NORepair open in the wire between PCM
connector terminals A25 and A26, and ground
(G101), or repair poor ground (G101).
14-124
03/07/29 09:32:35 61S0X050_140_0128
Road Test
Special Tools Required 8. Connect a digital multimeter (A) and the special
Backprobe set 07SAZ-001000A (two required) tools (B) to check voltage between these PCM
connector terminals.
1. Warm up the engine to normal operating
temperature (the radiator fan comes on). 1999-2000 models: Between PCM connector
terminals C27 and B20 or B22.
2. Apply the parking brake, and block both rear 2001 model: Between PCM connector terminals
wheels. Start the engine, then shift to the D position A15 and A25 or A26.
while pressing the brake pedal. Press the
accelerator pedal, and release it suddenly. The
engine should not stall.
A
4. Connect the HDS to the DLC (A), and go to the
PGM-FI Data List; then go to step 7. If you dont
have a HDS, go to step 5.
B
07SAZ-001000A
1999-2000 models:
PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P) C (31P)
6. Remove the PCM cover from the passengers side Wire side of female terminals
under-dash fuse to access the PCM mounting nut.
7. Remove the PCM mounting bolt, then remove the 2001 model:
PCM.
PCM CONNECTOR A (31P)
TPS (RED/BLK)
(contd)
14-125
03/07/29 09:32:35 61S0X050_140_0129
Automatic Transmission
14-126
03/07/29 09:32:35 61S0X050_140_0130
14-127
03/07/29 09:32:36 61S0X050_140_0131
Automatic Transmission
Pressure Test
Special Tools Required 6. Connect the oil pressure gauges to the 1st clutch
A/T oil pressure gauge set 07406-0020400 or pressure inspection hole (B), 3rd clutch pressure
07406-0020401 inspection hole (D), and 4th clutch pressure
A/T pressure hose, 2,210 mm 07MAJ-PY4011A inspection hole (E).
A/T pressure hose adapter 07MAJ-PY40120
B
1. Before testing, be sure the transmission fluid is
filled to the proper level.
14-128
03/07/29 09:32:37 61S0X050_140_0132
8. Start the engine, and run it at 2,000 rpm in the N or 19. Shift to the R position. Raise the engine rpm to
P position. 2,000 rpm, and measure 4th clutch pressure at the
4th clutch pressure inspection hole (E).
9. Measure line pressure at the line pressure
inspection hole (A) in the N or P position. Pressure Fluid Pressure
Standard Service Limit
NOTE: Higher pressure may be indicated if 1st clutch 840920 kPa 790 kPa
measurements are made in shift lever position (B) (8.69.4 kgf/cm2, (8.1 kgf/cm2,
other than N or P. 2nd clutch 120130 psi) 120 psi)
(C)
Pressure Fluid Pressure 3rd clutch
Standard Service Limit (D)
Line (A) 850910 kPa 800 kPa 4th clutch
(8.79.3 kgf/cm2, (8.2 kgf/cm2, (B)
120130 psi) 120 psi)
20. If the measurements are out service limit, problems
10. Shift to the 1 position, and measure 1st clutch and probable causes are listed in the table:
pressure at the 1st clutch pressure inspection hole
(B). Problem Probable causes
No or low line Torque converter
11. Shift to the 2 position, and measure 2nd clutch pressure ATF pump
pressure at the 2nd clutch pressure inspection hole Regulator valve
(B). Torque converter check
valve
12. Shift to the P position, then press the brake pedal No or low 1st 1st clutch
and hold it. clutch pressure O-rings
No or low 2nd 2nd clutch
13. Shift to the D4 position, and release the brake pedal clutch pressure O-rings
(the transmission should be in 1st gear). No or low 3rd 3rd clutch
clutch pressure O-rings
14. Accelerate the engine to 2,500 rpm (the No or low 4th 4th clutch
transmission will shift to 2nd gear). clutch pressure O-rings
No or low 4th Servo valve
15. Release the accelerator for more than 5 seconds clutch pressure 5th clutch
after the transmission is shifted to 2nd gear (the in the R position O-rings
engine will come down to about 1,000 rpm).
21. Install the sealing bolts with the new sealing
16. Press the accelerator very slowly to increase washers, and tighten the bolts to the specified
engine speed to 2,000 rpm gradually over 5 torque. Do not reuse old sealing washers.
seconds, then hold it at 2,000 rpm.
Torque: 18 Nm (1.8 kgfm, 13 lbfft)
17. Measure 3rd and 4th clutch pressure at 3rd clutch
pressure inspection hole (D), and 4th clutch
pressure inspection hole (E) (the transmission will
shift from 2nd gear to 3rd gear, and then 4th gear).
14-129
03/07/29 09:32:37 61S0X050_140_0133
Automatic Transmission
Standard: 1225
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
3. Measure the resistance of the shift solenoid valve A 8.7 lbfft)
between the No. 1 terminal of the 3P connector and
body ground.
Standard: 1225
3. Clean the mounting surface and fluid passage, and
4. Replace the torque converter clutch solenoid valve/ install a new torque converter clutch solenoid valve
shift solenoid valve A if either resistance is out of /shift solenoid valve A with a new filter/gasket (B).
specification.
4. Install the harness cover on the transmission
5. If the resistance is within the standard, connect the hanger.
No. 1 terminal of the 3P connector to the battery
positive terminal. A clicking sound should be heard. 5. Install the male terminal connector (C) of the
Connect the No. 3 terminal to the battery positive solenoid connector on the harness cover.
terminal. A clicking sound should be heard.
Replace the torque converter clutch solenoid valve/ 6. Check the connector for rust, dirt or oil, then
shift solenoid valve A if no sound is heard. reconnect it.
14-130
03/07/29 09:32:38 61S0X050_140_0134
2. Disconnect the shift solenoid valve B (A) or C (B) NOTE: If the shift solenoid valve B and C are replaced or
connector. removed at the same time, be sure to reinstall them
correctly. The connector color of shift solenoid valve B
is black, and the connector color of shift solenoid valve
A C is brown.
Standard: 1225
14-131
03/07/29 09:32:38 61S0X050_140_0135
Automatic Transmission
Standard: 310
4. Connect the No. 1 terminal of the A/T clutch 8. Disconnect one of the battery terminals and check
pressure control solenoid valves A and B to the valve movement.
battery positive terminal, and connect the No. 2
terminal to the battery negative terminal. A clicking NOTE: You can see the valve movement through
sound should be heard. the fluid passage in the mounting surface of the
assembly body (C).
5. If not, remove the A/T clutch pressure control
solenoid valves A and B. 9. If either valve binds, or moves sluggishly, or if the
solenoid does not operate, replace the A/T clutch
6. Check the fluid passage of the A/T clutch pressure pressure control solenoid valves A and B.
control solenoid valves for dust and dirt, and clean
the passage if necessary.
14-132
03/07/29 09:32:39 61S0X050_140_0136
3. Remove the ATF cooler line (outlet line) from the 7. Install new O-rings (F) over the feed pipes, and
transmission housing. install the 8 x 40 mm ATF feed pipe (G).
4. Remove the mounting bolts and the A/T clutch 8. Install the new A/T clutch pressure control solenoid
pressure control solenoid valves A and B (A). valves A and B (A) and harness clamp bracket (H).
6 x 1.0 mm A
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7lbfft) 9. Check the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid
valve connectors for rust, dirt, or oil then connect
H
them securely.
F 10. Install the ATF cooler outlet line, and connect the
G ATF cooler hose to the cooler line.
C
14-133
03/07/29 09:32:39 61S0X050_140_0137
Automatic Transmission
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
14-134
03/07/29 09:32:40 61S0X050_140_0138
1. Disconnect the connector from the 2nd clutch 1. Disconnect the connector from the 3rd clutch
pressure switch. pressure switch.
14-135
03/07/29 09:32:41 61S0X050_140_0139
Automatic Transmission
2. Park the vehicle on the level ground. Turn off the 7. If necessary, fill the transmission into the filler hole
engine. (A) to bring the fluid level up to the upper mark.
Always use Honda ATF-Z1 Automatic Transmission
NOTE: Check the fluid level within 6090 seconds Fluid (ATF). Using a non-Honda ATF can affect shift
after turning the engine off. quality
B
3. Remove the dipstick (yellow loop) (A) from the 24 x 1.5 mm
transmission, and wipe it with a clean cloth. 44 Nm (4.5 kgfm,
33 lbfft) C
A
4. Insert the dipstick into the transmission. 9. Install the ATF filler bolt (B) with a new sealing
washer (C).
5. Remove the dipstick and check the fluid level. It
should be between the upper mark (B) and lower 10. Insert the dipstick back into the transmission.
mark (C).
14-136
03/07/29 09:32:41 61S0X050_140_0140
ATF Replacement
NOTE: Keep all foreign particles out of the transmission. 5. Refill the transmission with the recommended fluid
into the filler hole (A) to the upper mark on the
1. Bring the transmission up to operating temperature dipstick. Always use Honda ATF-Z1 Automatic
(the radiator fan comes on) by driving the vehicle. Transmission Fluid (ATF). Using a non-Honda ATF
can affect shift quality.
2. Park the vehicle on the level ground, and turn the
engine off. Automatic Transmission Fluid Capacity:
2.9 (3.1 US qt) at changing
3. Remove the ATF filler bolt and the drain plug (A), 7.2 (7.6 US qt) at overhaul
and drain the automatic transmission fluid (ATF).
B
NOTE: If a cooler flusher is used, refer to ATF 24 x 1.5 mm
Cooler Flushing (see page 14-155). 44 Nm (4.5 kgfm,
33 lbfft) C
A
18 x 1.5 mm
49 Nm (5.0 kgfm,
36 lbfft)
14-137
03/07/29 09:32:42 61S0X050_140_0141
Automatic Transmission
Transmission Removal
Special Tools Required 9. Remove the ATF cooler hose (A) from the clamp (B)
Engine support hanger 07XAA-001030A on the starter.
Engine hanger balance bar VSB02C000019
Subframe adapter EQS07AODSY0
(Available through the Honda Tool and Equipment
Program, 888-424-6857)
5. Remove the battery hold-down bracket, then NOTE: Check for any signs of leakage at the hose
remove the battery and battery tray. joints.
6. Remove the battery cable clamps, connector, and 11. Remove the starter cables (A) from the starter (B)
relay bracket from the battery base. and clamp bracket (C), then remove the starter.
B A
7. Remove the battery base.
A
49 Nm (5.0 kgfm,
36 lbfft) F
D
A
14-138
03/07/29 09:32:43 61S0X050_140_0142
14. Disconnect the connectors from the 3rd clutch 18. Disconnect the connectors from the countershaft
pressure switch (A), mainshaft speed sensor (B), speed sensor (A), and 2nd clutch pressure switch
and A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valves A (B).
and B (C), then remove the harness clamps from B
C
the clamp brackets.
C
B D
A
C
C
A D
(contd)
14-139
03/07/29 09:32:44 61S0X050_140_0143
Automatic Transmission
A
(07XAA-001030A)
E G
B
(VSB02C000019)
14-140
03/07/29 09:32:46 61S0X050_140_0144
25. Remove the oxygen sensor connectors (A) from 29. Remove the bolts securing the shift cable holder (A),
their connector brackets (B), and remove the then remove the shift cable cover (B).
harnesses from the clamps (C).
NOTE: To prevent damage to the control lever (C),
remove the bolts securing the holder before
removing the bolts securing the cover.
C
B
E D
C A
A C
D B
26. Remove the exhaust pipe A (D) and three way 30. Remove the lock bolt (D) securing the control lever,
catalytic converter (E). then remove the shift cable (E) with the control
lever. Do not bend the shift cable excessively.
27. Remove the spring pins (A) and castle nuts (B), and
separate the lower arms (C) from the knuckles (D) 31. Install a 6 x 1.0 x 14 mm bolt (A) and nut (B) on the
(see page 18-11). shift cable cover (C), then reinstall the shift cable
cover to the torque converter housing.
A G E
H If you dont do this, the bolt head of the cable cover
may prevent you from removing the torque
B
converter during transmission removal.
B
C F
(contd)
14-141
03/07/29 09:32:47 61S0X050_140_0145
Automatic Transmission
B
A
C A
B
33. Remove the engine stiffener bolts (C).
34. Remove the clip (A) on the power steering fluid 37. Remove the steering gearbox mounting bolts (A)
return hose (B) from the bracket (C). and nut (B), and remove the stiffener (C).
A D A B
E D
C
B F
D A
35. Remove the power steering fluid pipe bracket bolts
(D) and bracket (E), and remove the steering 38. Remove the rear mount mounting bolts (D).
gearbox mounting bolt (F).
14-142
03/07/29 09:32:47 61S0X050_140_0146
39. Unclamp the power steering fluid pipe clamps (A), 41. Make reference marks (A) on the body across the
and remove the bolt (B) securing the power marks (B) on the edge of the front subframe (C).
steering fluid pipe bracket (C).
A B
A
A
B C C
EQS07AODSY0
(contd)
14-143
03/07/29 09:32:49 61S0X050_140_0147
Automatic Transmission
C C
A
EQS07ODSY0 B B
A A
B B
44. Raise the jack to vehicle height, then attach the
adapter to the front subframe by sliding the 47. Hang the steering gearbox on passenger side with
adapters nut plates (B), between the subframe and a rope to the body.
the body.
48. Remove the transmission lower mounts.
B
C
54 Nm
(5.5 kgfm, 40 lbfft)
45. Insert the nut plate bolts through the holes in the
adapter and the subframe; then thread the bolts (C)
into the nut plates and tighten them to 54 Nm (5.5
kgfm, 40 lbfft).
14-144
03/07/29 09:32:50 61S0X050_140_0148
49. Pry the left driveshaft out of the differential and the 53. Remove the front mount bracket.
right driveshaft from the intermediate shaft (see
step 10 on page 16-4).
50. Move the left driveshaft to the front side. Coat all
precision finished surfaces with clean engine oil,
then tie the plastic bags over the driveshaft ends.
(contd)
14-145
03/07/29 09:32:50 61S0X050_140_0149
Automatic Transmission
12 x 1.25 mm
74 Nm (7.5 kgfm, 54 lbfft)
14-146
03/07/29 09:32:51 61S0X050_140_0150
Transmission Installation
1. Flush the ATF cooler (see page 14-155). 6. Attach the transmission to the engine, then install
the transmission housing mounting bolts.
2. Install the transmission lower mounts (A).
A 10 x 1.25 mm
38 Nm (3.9 kgfm,
28 lbfft)
12 x 1.25 mm
64 Nm,
(6.5 kgfm,
47 lbfft)
10 x 1.25 mm
38 Nm (3.9 kgfm,
28 lbfft) 7. Install the front mount bracket.
3. Install the torque converter assembly (A) on the
mainshaft (B) with a new O-ring (C).
D
A
10 x 1.25 mm
38 Nm
(3.9 kgfm, 28 lbfft)
C B
E
(contd)
14-147
03/07/29 09:33:46 61S0X050_140_0151
Automatic Transmission
C
6 x 1.0 mm B
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft) B
A 6 x 1.0 mm
10 x 1.25 mm 12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
38 Nm (3.9 kgfm, 28 lbfft) 8.7 lbfft)
14-148
03/07/29 09:33:47 61S0X050_140_0152
14. Install a new set ring on the right driveshaft. 17. Loosely install the subframe mounting bolts (4) (A)
and the 12 x 1.25 mm bolts (6) (B) with the
15. Install the right and left driveshaft. While installing stiffeners (C), then tighten the bolts to the specified
the left driveshaft in the differential, be sure not to torque by aligning all reference marks (D).
allow dust or other foreign particles to enter the
B
transmission. 12 x 1.25 mm
74 Nm (7.5 kgfm, 54 lbfft)
NOTE:
Clean the areas where the left driveshaft contacts
the transmission (differential) with solvent or
carburetor cleaner, and dry with compressed air.
Turn the right and left steering knuckle fully
outward, and slide the left driveshaft into the
C C
differential until you feel its spring clip engage
the side gear. Slide the right driveshaft into the
intermediate shaft until you feel its spring clip
engage the intermediate shaft.
D D
EQS07AODSY0
(contd)
14-149
03/07/29 09:33:48 61S0X050_140_0153
Automatic Transmission
10 x 1.25 mm
38 Nm (3.9 kgfm,
28 lbfft)
A B
19. Install the power steering fluid pipe (A) on the 10 x 1.25 mm 10 x 1.25 mm
38 Nm (3.9 kgfm, 58 Nm (5.9 kgfm,
clamps (B), and install the power steering fluid pipe 28 lbfft) 43 lbfft)
bracket (C).
21. Install the steering gearbox mounting bolts (B) and
6 x 1.0 mm the stiffener (C).
B 9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft) 22. Install the stiffener (A) and the steering gearbox
B mounting bolt (B) with nut (C).
10 x 1.25 mm
C 59 Nm (6.0 kgfm,
43 lbfft)
A
B
10 x 1.25 mm
58 Nm (5.9 kgfm, 43 lbfft)
14-150
03/07/29 09:33:50 61S0X050_140_0154
23. Install the steering gearbox mounting bolt (A) and 28. Install the ball joints on each lower arms (A) with
the power steering fluid pipe bracket bolts (B). the castle nuts (hex nuts) (B) and spring pins (C).
B D
6 x 1.0 mm 12 x 1.25 mm
9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm, C 78 Nm (7.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft) F E 51 lbfft)
C G
A
10 x 1.25 mm
D 39 Nm (4.0 kgfm,
29 lbfft)
B
12 x 1.25 mm
5969 Nm (6.07.0 kgfm,
4351 lbfft) A
24. Install the power steering fluid return hose clip (C)
on the bracket (D). 29. Install the nut (D) to the ball joint pin (E) on the
stabilizer link (F), then use a 6 mm Allen-type
25. Install the control lever (A) with the shift cable (B) wrench (G), and tighten the nut to the specified
on the control shaft (C). Do not bend the shift cable torque.
excessively.
6 x 1.0 mm 30. Install the exhaust pipe A (A) and the three way
9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft) catalytic converter (B) assembly.
C
B 10 x 1.25 mm 10 x 1.25 mm
33 Nm (3.4 kgfm, 54 Nm (5.5 kgfm,
25 lbfft) 40 lbfft)
Replace. Replace.
G C
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm, D
A D 16 lbfft)
E 6 x 1.0 mm
14 Nm (1.4 kgfm, 10 lbfft)
26. Install the lock bolt (D) with a new lock washer (E), D
then bend the lock washer tab against the bolt. B
A
27. Install the shift cable cover (F), then install the shift E
cable holder (G) on the shift cable cover.
C E
NOTE: To prevent damage to the control lever, be
sure to install the shift cable holder after installing 31. Connect the oxygen sensor connectors (C), then
the shift cable cover to the torque converter install them on their connector brackets (D).
housing. Install the harnesses on the clamps (E).
(contd)
14-151
03/07/29 09:33:51 61S0X050_140_0155
Automatic Transmission
12 x 1.25 mm
64 Nm
(6.5 kgfm, 47 lbfft)
B
C
14-152
03/07/29 09:33:52 61S0X050_140_0156
39. Install the harness cover (A) on the transmission 42. Connect the connectors to the shift solenoid valve
hanger (B), then install the connector bracket (C). B (A) and shift solenoid valve C (B), then install the
clamp on the clamp bracket.
8 x 1.25 mm C
26 Nm (2.7 kgfm, 10 x 1.25 mm
20 lbfft) 44 Nm (4.5 kgfm, 33 lbfft)
D
E
A
E
B
8 x 1.25 mm
26 Nm (2.7 kgfm,
20 lbfft)
12 x 1.25 mm
B D 64 Nm
(6.5 kgfm,
40. Install the torque converter clutch solenoid valve/ 6 x 1.0 mm 47 lbfft)
shift solenoid valve A connector (D) on the harness 9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm, 9 Nm (0.9 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft) C 6.5 lbfft)
cover, then connect the connector.
43. Install the transmission ground cable terminal (C).
41. Connect the connectors to the 3rd clutch pressure
switch (A), mainshaft speed sensor (B), and A/T 44. Install the starter (D) on the torque converter
clutch pressure control solenoid valves A and B (C), housing. Connect the starter cables (E) to the
then install the clamps on the clamp brackets. Do starter, and install the harness clamp on the clamp
not allow fluid, oil, dust, or other foreign particles bracket. Make sure the crimped side of the starter
to enter the connectors. cable ring terminal is facing out.
C
(contd)
14-153
03/07/29 09:33:53 61S0X050_140_0157
Automatic Transmission
53. Set the parking brake. Start the engine, and shift
the transmission through all gears three times.
49. Install the intake air duct, resonator cover, and air 59. Do a road test (see page 14-125).
cleaner housing assembly.
60. Enter the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter
50. Install the engine covers. the radio station presets, and set the clock.
61. Loosen the front mount nut after the road test, then
retighten the nut to the specified torque.
12 x 1.25 mm
54 Nm (5.5 kgfm,
40 lbfft)
14-154
03/07/29 09:33:53 61S0X050_140_0158
3. Secure the flusher filler cap, and pressurize the Air Pressure: MAX 845 kPa (8.45 kgf/cm2,
flusher with compressed air to 550829 kPa (5.6 120 psi)
8.45 kgf/cm2, 80120 psi). The air line should be
equipped with a water trap to ensure a dry air 11. Turn the water valve off. Release the trigger, then
system. reverse the hoses to the cooler so you can flush in
the opposite direction. Repeat step 8 through 10.
4. Hang the flusher under the vehicle.
12. Release the trigger, and rinse the cooler with water
5. Attach the flusher discharge hose (B) to the return for one minute.
line of the ATF cooler using a clamp.
13. Turn the water valve and the water supply off.
6. Connect the drain hose (C) to the inlet line on the
ATF cooler using a clamp. Securely clamp the 14. Turn the air valve on for two minutes, or until no
opposite end of the drain hose to a bucket (D) or moisture is visible leaving the drain hose. Residual
floor drain. moisture in the cooler or lines can damage the
transmission.
15. Remove the flusher from the cooler line. Attach the
drain hose to an ATF container.
(contd)
14-155
03/07/29 09:33:54 61S0X050_140_0159
Automatic Transmission
A B
24 mm 28 mm
(0.10.2 in.) C C (0.20.3 in.)
14-156
03/07/29 09:33:54 61S0X050_140_0160
3. Remove the nut (A) securing the shift cable end (B),
then separate the shift cable (C) from the shift lever
assembly (D).
A C
B C
A
G
E
14-157
03/07/29 09:33:55 61S0X050_140_0161
Automatic Transmission
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
16 lbfft)
14-158
03/07/29 09:33:56 61S0X050_140_0162
DETENT SPRING
4 mm SCREW
3 Nm (0.3 kgfm, 2 lbfft)
8 x 1.25 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
CONTROL BRACKET
COLLAR
SELECT LINK
WASHER
SHIFT LEVER BUSHING
SELF-LOCKING NUT
6 x 1.0 mm
9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm, SHIFT LEVER KNOB
SHIFT CABLE 9 Nm (0.9 kgfm, 7 lbfft)
7.2 lbfft)
14-159
03/07/29 09:33:56 61S0X050_140_0163
Automatic Transmission
5. Remove the nut (A) securing the shift cable end (B),
then separate the shift cable (C) from the shift lever A
assembly (D).
8. Remove the bolts securing the shift cable holder (A),
D then remove the shift cable cover (B).
B C
A
B
E
14-160
03/07/29 09:33:57 61S0X050_140_0164
10. Insert the new shift cable through the grommet 15. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), and verify that the
hole, then install the shift cable guide bracket. N position indicator comes on.
11. Verify that the transmission is in the N position on 16. Install the shift cable end to the shift cable. If
the control shaft. necessary, adjust the shift cable (see step 5 on
page 14-162).
12. Install the control lever (A) with the shift cable (B)
on the control shaft (C). Do not bend the shift cable
excessively.
6 x 1.0 mm
9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft)
C
A
8 x 1.25 mm
E D 22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
6 x 1.0 mm 16 lbfft)
14 Nm (1.4 kgfm,
10 lbfft)
13. Install the lock bolt (D) with a new lock washer (E),
then bend the lock washer tab against the bolt head.
14. Install the shift cable cover (F), then install the shift
cable holder (G) on the shift cable cover.
14-161
03/07/29 09:33:58 61S0X050_140_0165
Automatic Transmission
3. Remove the nut (A) securing the shift cable end (B),
then separate the shift cable (C) from the shift lever
assembly (D).
B C
A
G
E
14-162
03/07/29 09:33:58 61S0X050_140_0166
9. Align the socket holder (A) on the shift cable (B) 11. If improperly installed, remove the shift cable from
with the slot in the shift cable bracket (C), then slide the shift cable bracket, and reinstalled the shift
the holder into the bracket. Install the shift cable cable. Do not install the shift cable end on the
end (D) over the mounting stud (E) by aligning its mounting stud while the shift cable is on the shift
square hole (F) with the square fitting (G) at the cable bracket.
bottom of the stud, and rotate the holder clockwise
a quarter turn to secure the shift cable. 12. Install and tighten the nut to the specified torque.
NOTE: Do not install the shift cable by twisting the
shift cable guide (H).
A
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm
B (2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
G 13. Remove the 6.0 mm (0.24 in.) pin that was installed
to hold the shift lever.
E H
F 14. Move the shift lever to each gear, and verify that
D
the A/T gear position indicator follows the
transmission range switch.
10. Verify that the shift cable end (A) is properly 15. Push the shift lock release, and verify that the shift
installed on the mounting stud (B). lever releases.
Properly Installed:
A B
Improperly Installed:
14-163
03/07/29 09:34:00 61S0X050_140_0167
14-164
03/07/29 09:34:01 61S0X050_140_0168
Circuit Diagram
NOTE: PCM terminal number shows the number of the 19992000 models/2001 models.
DRIVERS
UNDERDASH
UNDERHOOD FUSE/RELAY BOX IGNITION FUSE/RELAY BOX
SWITCH
BATTERY
No.41 (120A) No.42 (50A) IG1 No.9 (10A)
BAT
YEL
C16
N RED/BLK RED/BLK
B11
DIMMING D4 C17 CRUISE
CIRCUIT YEL YEL YEL CONTROL
UNIT
C6
D3 PNK PNK PNK LT BLU
C7
2 BLU BLU BLU
C5
1 BRN BRN BRN
B16
BLK
G101
BLK 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 1 2 3
D4 ST A E
N D3
R 2
P 1
14-165
03/07/29 09:34:02 61S0X050_140_0169
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), and watch the D4 10. Shift to any position other than D4.
indicator.
11. Measure the voltage between the D9 terminal and
Does the D4 indicator come on and stay on? body ground.
YESGo to step 2. PCM CONNECTOR D (16P)
2. Make sure the HDS is not connected to the Data ATP D4 (YEL)
Link Connector (DLC).
6. Measure the voltage between the A14 terminal and YESFaulty PCM or gauge assembly.
body ground.
NOCheck for a short to ground in the wire
PCM CONNECTOR A (32P)
between the D9 terminal and the transmission
range switch. If the wire is OK, check the
transmission range switch.
14-166
03/07/29 09:34:02 61S0X050_140_0170
15. Disconnect the B (25P) connector from the PCM. 19. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
16. Check for continuity between body ground and B20 20. Reconnect the B (25P) connector to the PCM.
and B22 terminals.
21. Connect the digital multimeter between the A14
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P) and B20 or B22 terminals.
A (32P) B (25P)
LG1 (BRN/BLK) LG2 (BRN/BLK)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
Wire side of female terminals
D4 IND (GRN/BLK) LG2 (BRN/BLK)
Is there continuity?
NORepair open in the wire(s) between the B20 or Is there battery voltage f or at least 2 seconds?
B22 terminal and ground (G101), or repair poor
ground (G101). YESCheck for an open in the wire between the
A14 terminal and the gauge assembly. If the wire is
17. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). OK, check for a faulty D4 indicator bulb or a faulty
printed circuit board in the gauge assembly.
18. Measure the voltage between terminals B1 and B22,
and between terminals B9 and B20. NOGo to step 23.
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
IGP1 (YEL/BLK)
IGP2 (YEL/BLK)
(contd)
14-167
03/07/29 09:34:03 61S0X050_140_0171
D4 IND (GRN/BLK)
Is there continuity?
14-168
03/07/29 09:34:03 61S0X050_140_0172
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), and watch the D4 10. Shift to any position other than D4.
indicator.
11. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
Does the D4 indicator come on and stay on? terminal C13 and body ground.
YESGo to step 2. PCM CONNECTOR C (22P)
2. Make sure the HDS is not connected to the Data ATP D4 (YEL)
Link Connector (DLC).
4. Disconnect PCM connector C (22P) and E (31P). Wire side of female terminals
Wire side of female terminals YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
connectors and recheck the D4 indicator several
times. If the problem is intermittent, substitute a
Is there voltage? known-good PCM and recheck. If the light then
works OK every time, replace the original PCM.
YESRepair short to power in the wire between
PCM connector terminal E5 and the gauge NOGo to step 14.
assembly.
14. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
NOGo to step 7.
(contd)
14-169
03/07/29 09:34:04 61S0X050_140_0173
16. Check for continuity between PCM connector 20. Reconnect PCM connector A (31P).
terminal A25 and body ground, and between
terminal A26 and body ground. 21. Connect the digital multimeter between PCM
connector terminals E5 and A25 or A26.
PCM CONNECTOR A (31P)
22. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
PCM CONNECTORS
14-170
03/07/29 09:34:04 61S0X050_140_0174
D4 IND (GRN/BLK)
Is there continuity?
14-171
03/07/29 09:34:05 61S0X050_140_0175
1. Remove the gauge assembly from the dashboard, then disconnect the gauge assembly B (22P) and C (16P) connectors.
2. Inspect the connectors and connector terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the gauge assembly B (22P) and C (16P) connectors.
If a test indicates a problem, find a correct the cause, then recheck the system.
If all the input tests prove OK, but the indicator is faulty, replace the printed circuit board.
B(22P) C(16P)
Cavity Wire Color Test Condition Test: Desired Result Possible Cause
(If result is not obtained)
B11 YEL Ignition switch ON (II) Check for voltage to ground: Blown No. 9 (10A) fuse in the drivers
There should be battery voltage. under-dash fuse/relay box
An open in the wire
B16 BLK Under all conditions Check for continuity to ground: Poor ground (G501)
There should be continuity. An open in the wire
B22 RED/BLK Headlights ON Check for voltage to ground: Blown No. 10 (15A) fuse in the
There should be battery voltage. passengers under-dash fuse/relay box
An open in the wire
C4 WHT Ignition switch ON (II) and Check for voltage to ground: Faulty transmission range switch
shift lever in R There should be 1 V or less. An open in the wire
C5 BRN Ignition switch ON (II) and There should be no battery voltage
shift lever in 1 in any other shift lever position.
C6 PNK Ignition switch ON (II) and
shift lever in D3
C7 BLU Ignition switch ON (II) and
shift lever in 2
C12 GRN/BLK Ignition switch ON (II) and Check for voltage to ground: Faulty transmission range switch
shift lever in D4 There should be battery voltage. Faulty PCM
An open in the wire
C13 YEL Ignition switch ON (II) and Check for voltage to ground: Faulty transmission range switch
shift lever in D4 There should be 1 V or less. An open in the wire
There should be no battery voltage
in any other shift lever position.
C15 BLK/BLU Shift lever in P Check for continuity to ground: Faulty transmission range switch
There should be no continuity in any An open in the wire
other shift lever position.
C16 RED/BLK Ignition switch ON (II) and Check for voltage to ground:
shift lever in N There should be 1 V or less.
There should be battery voltage in
any other shift lever position.
14-172
03/07/29 09:34:05 61S0X050_140_0176
2. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
B
Transmission Range Switch Continuity Check
Terminal
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Position
P
D4
D3
14-173
03/07/29 09:34:06 61S0X050_140_0177
B
A
C
14-174
03/07/29 09:34:07 61S0X050_140_0178
9. Install the transmission range switch (A) gently on 12. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). Move the shift lever
the control shaft (B), then secure it with the bolts. through all gears, and check the transmission
range switch synchronization with the A/T gear
NOTE: Take care not to move the transmission position indicator.
range switch when tightening the bolts.
6 x 1.0 mm
E D 12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
13. Start the engine. Move the shift lever through all
gears, and verify the following:
C
The engine will not start in any position, other
A
than the N or P.
6 x 1.0 mm
B 12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft) The back-up lights come on when the shift lever
is in the R position.
10. Install the transmission range switch cover (C), and
the harness clamp (D) on the end cover (E).
14-175
03/07/29 09:34:07 61S0X050_140_0179
A B
14-176
03/07/29 09:34:10 61S0X050_140_0180
MULTIPLEX CONTROL
UNIT (DRIVERS)
Shift Lock System Circuit
Troubleshooting, page 14-179 POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Input Test, page 14-184 BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH
14-177
03/07/29 09:34:10 61S0X050_140_0181
Circuit Diagram
IGNITION SWITCH
IG1
STEERING LOCK
YEL ASSEMBLY
7 BRAKE
PEDAL
KEY POSITION
INTERLOCK SWITCH
1 SWITCH (BRAKE
SWITCH)
KEY
SHIFT LOCK INTERLOCK
SOLENOID SOLENOID
5
A12 B22
IG1 SHIFT LOCK
SOLENOID
MULTIPLEX CONTROL
UNIT (DRIVERS)
PARK
PG LG ATP P ILU PIN
SWITCH
A2 B11 A15 B12
G401
A (24P) B (22P)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 3 4 5 8
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 22
14-178
03/07/29 09:34:11 61S0X050_140_0182
Are the brake lights ON? 6. Disconnect these connectors from the PCM:
2. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), and shift to P 7. Press the brake pedals and measure the voltage
position. between these terminals.
3. Press the brake pedal, and release the accelerator 1999-2000 models: Between the A32 and B20 or
pedal. B22 terminals.
2001 model: Between the E9 and A25 or A26
4. Measure ILU voltage between these terminals and terminals.
body ground:
1999-2000 Models:
1999-2000 models: Between A28 terminal and
PCM CONNECTORS
ground.
2001 model: Between E15 terminal and ground. A (32P) B (25P)
1999-2000 Models:
PCM CONNECTOR A (32P)
BK SW (WHT/BLK)
LG1 (BRN/BLK)
BK SW (WHT/BLK)
A (31P) E (31P)
ILU (WHT/RED)
(contd)
14-179
03/07/29 09:34:12 61S0X050_140_0183
9. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 14. Measure the voltage between the No. 1 and No. 3
terminals of the TPS connector.
10. Measure the voltage between these terminals:
THROTTLE POSITION
1999-2000 models: Between the C27 and B20 or B SENSOR CONNECTOR
22 terminals.
2001 model: Between the A15 and A25 or A26
terminals.
SG2 (GRN/BLK) VCC2 (YEL/BLU)
1999-2000 Models:
PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P) C (31P)
Wire side of female terminals
Is there about 5 V ?
14-180
03/07/29 09:34:13 61S0X050_140_0184
17. Check for continuity between the No. 2 terminal of 20. Connect the No. 1 terminal of the shift lock solenoid
the shift lock solenoid connector and the No. 22 connector to the battery positive terminal, and
terminal of the multiplex control unit (drivers) 22P connect the No. 2 terminal to the battery negative
connector B. terminal.
Is there continuity?
18. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). YESCheck for a loose multiplex control unit
(drivers) connector. If necessary, substitute a
19. Measure the voltage between the No. 1 terminal of known-good multiplex control unit (drivers) and
the shift lock solenoid connector and body ground. recheck.
SHIFT LOCK SOLENOID NOReplace the shift lock solenoid (see page 14-
CONNECTOR
186).
YEL
14-181
03/07/29 09:34:13 61S0X050_140_0185
WHT/YEL
YESGo to step 6.
Terminal side of male terminals
NOCheck for a blown No. 47 (20A) fuse in the
under-hood fuse/relay box. If the fuse is OK, repair
3. Turn the ignition switch to ACC (I), then push the open or short in the wire between the No. 7
ignition key. terminal of the key switch connector and under-
hood fuse/relay box.
4. Check the key interlock solenoid operation. A
clicking sound should be heard while pushing the 6. Disconnect the park pin switch connector on the
ignition key, and you should not be able to turn it to shift lever.
the OFF position.
7. With the shift lever in Park and pulled back toward
Does the key interlock solenoid operate properly? the driver, check for continuity between the No. 1
and No. 3 terminals of the park pin switch
YESGo to step 5. connector.
NOFaulty key interlock solenoid/switch. Replace
the ignition key cylinder/steering lock assembly. PARK PIN SWITCH CONNECTOR
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 8.
14-182
03/07/29 09:34:14 61S0X050_140_0186
WHT/RED
PARK PIN SWITCH
CONNECTOR
WHT/RED
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 9.
BLK
Is there continuity?
14-183
03/07/29 09:34:14 61S0X050_140_0187
1. Disconnect the 22P connector from the multiplex control unit, drivers, then remove the control unit from the
drivers under-dash fuse/relay box.
2. Inspect the connectors and connector terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
If the terminals look OK, go to step 3.
NOTE: If the shift lock solenoid clicks when the ignition switch is turned ON (II) while pressing the brake pedal with
the shift lever in the P position, the shift lock system is OK. If the shift lever cannot be shifted from the P position,
test the A/T gear position switch.
3. With the control unit still disconnected from its connectors and the fuse/relay box, make these input tests.
If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
If all the input tests prove OK, go to step 4.
4. Reconnect the connectors to the multiplex control unit, and make this input test.
If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
If all the input tests prove OK, substitute a known-good multiplex control unit, and recheck the system.
If the system is OK, the multiplex control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Cavity Wire Color Test Condition Test: Desired Result Possible Cause (If result is not obtained)
B12 WHT/RED Ignition switch Check for voltage to ground: Faulty brake pedal position
ON (II) and brake There should be battery voltage. switch (brake switch)
pedal pushed Faulty PCM
Ignition switch Check for voltage to ground: Faulty multiplex control unit
ON (II), brake pedal There should be 1 V or less. (drivers)
and accelerator An open in the wire
pedal pressed at
the same time
14-184
03/07/29 09:34:15 61S0X050_140_0188
1. Remove the steering lower cover (see page 17-25). 1. Remove the steering column upper cover (see page
17-25).
2. Disconnect the key switch connector (7P) from the
steering lock assembly. 2. Disconnect the shift lock solenoid 2P connector.
3. Check for continuity between the No. 5 and No. 7
terminals when the key is pushed, and check for no
continuity when the key is released.
If the key cannot be removed, the key interlock 4. Check that the shift lever can be moved from the P
solenoid is OK. position. Release the battery terminals from the
If the key can be removed, replace the steering shift lock solenoid connector. Move the shift lever
lock assembly (the key interlock solenoid is not back to the P position, and make sure it locks.
available separately).
NOTE: Do not connect power to the No. 2 terminal
(reverse polarity) or you will damage the diode
inside the solenoid.
14-185
03/07/29 09:34:16 61S0X050_140_0189
3. Remove the nut (A) securing the shift cable end (B),
then separate the shift cable (C) from the shift lever
assembly (D).
D
E
C
A 8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
16 lbfft)
14-186
03/07/29 09:34:16 61S0X050_140_0190
14-187
03/07/29 09:34:17 61S0X050_140_0191
COUNTERSHAFT LOCKNUT
Replace.
CONICAL SPRING
WASHER
Replace. PARK
LEVER
CONICAL SPRING WASHER
BEARING HUB/ Replace.
BALL BEARING
ASSEMBLY PITOT PIPE FLANGE
MAINSHAFT IDLER GEAR
THRUST NEEDLE
BEARING CONICAL SPRING WASHER
Replace.
COUNTERSHAFT SECONDARY SHAFT
IDLER GEAR IDLER GEAR
NEEDLE BEARING
THRUST NEEDLE
BEARING
BREATHER TUBE
PARK GEAR
ATF COOLER LINE
PARK PAWL
SHAFT
LINE BOLT
14-188
03/07/29 09:34:18 61S0X050_140_0192
Special Tools Required 5. Slip the special tool onto the mainshaft.
Mainshaft holder
07GAB-PF50101 or 07GAB-PF50100
NOTE:
D Countershaft and secondary shaft locknuts have
E left-hand threads.
Clean the old locknuts; they are used to install the
press fit idler gears on the mainshaft and
secondary shaft, and the park gear and bearing
hub on the countershaft.
Keep all of the chiseled particles out of the
transmission.
C
C
(contd)
14-189
03/07/29 09:34:19 61S0X050_140_0193
End Cover and Idler Gear Removal Park Lever Stop Inspection and
(contd) Adjustment
9. Remove the mainshaft idler gear (A) and the 1. Set the park lever (A) in the P position.
secondary shaft idler gear (B) with a puller (C).
D C
A B
6 x 1.0 mm
14 Nm (1.4 kgfm, 10 lbfft)
E
2. Measure the distance (B) between the park pawl
F B
shaft (C) and the park lever roller pin (D).
10. Remove the bearing hub (D) with the puller from Standard: 84.685.6 mm (3.333.37 in.)
the countershaft, then remove the countershaft
idler gear (E) and bearings. 3. If the measurement is out of tolerance, select and
install the appropriate park lever stop (E) from the
11. Remove the park gear (F) with the puller. table.
12. Remove the park pawl, spring, shaft, and shaft stop.
14-190
03/07/29 09:34:20 61S0X050_140_0194
Transmission Housing
TRANSMISSION HOUSING
REVERSE IDLER GEAR MOUNTING BOLTS
SHAFT HOLDER
REVERSE IDLER GEAR SHAFT HARNESS CLAMP BRACKET
COUNTERSHAFT
2ND GEAR
TRANSMISSION HANGER/
HARNESS CLAMP BRACKET
COUNTERSHAFT
REVERSE GEAR
LOCK WASHER
Replace.
SHIFT FORK
TRANSMISSION HOUSING
TRANSMISSION HANGER
REVERSE IDLER
REVERSE SELECTOR GEAR
REVERSE SELECTOR
HUB
COUNTERSHAFT
4TH GEAR
MAINSHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT SUBASSEMBLY
SUBASSEMBLY
TRANSMISSION HOUSING
GASKET
Replace.
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
COUNTERSHAFT
SUBASSEMBLY
TORQUE CONVERTER HOUSING
(contd)
14-191
03/07/29 09:34:21 61S0X050_140_0195
Transmission Housing
B D
14-192
03/07/29 09:34:22 61S0X050_140_0196
C
B
A
B
14-193
03/07/29 09:34:23 61S0X050_140_0197
Valve Body
ATF FEED
PIPES,
ATF STRAINER Two Pipes
O-RING
Replace.
O-RING
Replace. CONTROL
SHAFT REGULATOR
6 x 1.0 mm, VALVE BODY
Two Bolts DETENT
ARM STATOR SHAFT
STATOR SHAFT STOP
DETENT
ARM SHAFT DOWEL PINS, Two Pins
REGULATOR
ACCUMULATOR SEPARATOR PLATE
COVER
6 x 1.0 mm, One Bolt
8 x 1.25 mm, Three Bolts
6 x 1.0 mm,
Nine Bolts MAIN VALVE BODY
6 x 1.0 mm,
Six Bolts
TORQUE CONVERTER
CHECK VALVE SPRING
14-194
03/07/29 09:34:24 61S0X050_140_0198
NOTE: Refer to the Exploded View as needed during the 16. Clean the inlet opening (A) of the ATF strainer (B)
following procedure. thoroughly with compressed air, then check that it
is in good condition, and the inlet opening is not
1. Remove the ATF feed pipes from the regulator clogged.
valve body, servo body and accumulator body.
10. Unhook the detent spring from the detent arm, then
remove the detent arm shaft, detent arm, and
control shaft.
14-195
03/07/29 09:34:24 61S0X050_140_0199
Valve Body
1. Soak a sheet of 600 abrasive paper in ATF for 6. Coat the valve with ATF, then drop it into its bore. It
about 30 minutes. should drop to the bottom of the bore under its
own weight. If not, repeat steps 4 and 5, then retest.
2. Carefully tap the valve body so the sticking valve If the valve still sticks, replace the valve body.
drops out of its bore. It may be necessary to use a
small screwdriver to pry the valve free. Be careful
not to scratch the bore with the screwdriver.
3. Inspect the valve for any scuff marks. Use the ATF-
soaked 600 paper to polish off any burrs that are
on the valve, then wash the valve in solvent and
dry it with compressed air.
14-196
03/07/29 09:34:25 61S0X050_140_0200
3. Install all the springs and seats. Insert the spring (A)
in the valve, then install the valve in the valve body
(B). Push the spring in with a screwdriver, then
install the spring seat (C).
C
A
B
14-197
03/07/29 09:35:21 61S0X050_140_0201
Valve Body
2. Do not use a magnet to remove the check valve ball; it may magnetize the ball.
3. Check all valves for free movement. If any fail to slide freely, refer to Valve Body Repair (see page 14-196).
4. Replace the valve body as an assembly if any parts are worn or damaged.
SHIFT VALVE E
VALVE
SLEEVE
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE
RELIEF VALVE
MANUAL VALVE
14-198
03/07/29 09:35:21 61S0X050_140_0202
Sectional View
FILTER
MANUAL VALVE
SPRING SPECIFICATIONS
No. Spring Standard (New)-Unit: mm (in.)
Wire Dia. O.D. Free Length No. of Coils
Modulator valve spring 1.6 (0.063) 10.4 (0.409) 33.5 (1.319) 9.8
Shift valve C spring 0.8 (0.031) 6.6 (0.260) 49.1 (1.933) 21.7
Shift valve D spring 0.7 (0.028) 6.6 (0.260) 35.7 (1.406) 17.2
Shift valve E spring 0.7 (0.028) 6.1 (0.240) 17.8 (0.701) 7.9
Relief valve spring 1.1 (0.043) 8.6 (0.339) 30.1 (1.185) 10.7
Lock-up shift valve spring 0.9 (0.035) 7.6 (0.299) 63.0 (2.480) 22.4
Cooler check valve spring 0.6 (0.024) 5.8 (0.228) 14.5 (0.571) 6.8
Torque converter check valve 1.2 (0.047) 8.6 (0.339) 34.4 (1.354) 11.7
Servo control valve spring 0.7 (0.028) 6.6 (0.260) 35.7 (1.406) 17.2
Reverse CPC valve spring 0.7 (0.028) 6.1 (0.240) 17.8 (0.701) 7.9
14-199
03/07/29 09:35:22 61S0X050_140_0203
Valve Body
A B
14-200
03/07/29 09:35:23 61S0X050_140_0204
2. Check all valves for free movement. If any fail to slide freely, refer to Valve Body Repair (see page 14-196).
3. Replace the valve body as an assembly if any parts are worn or damaged.
4. Hold the regulator spring cap in place while removing the stop bolt. The regulator spring cap is spring loaded.
Once the stop bolt is removed, release the spring cap slowly so it does not pop out.
5. Reassembly is the reverse of disassembly. Install the filter in the direction shown.
7. Align the hole in the regulator spring cap with the hole in the valve body, then press the spring cap into the valve
body, and tighten the stop bolt.
STOP BOLT
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
VALVE CAP
FILTER
Install in this direction.
VALVE SLEEVE
SPRING SPECIFICATIONS
No. Spring Standard (New)-Unit: mm (in.)
Wire Dia. O.D. Free Length No. of Coils
Stator reaction spring 5.5 (0.217) 37.4 (1.472) 30.3 (1.193) 2.12
Regulator valve spring A 1.9 (0.075) 14.7 (0.579) 77.4 (3.047) 15.2
Regulator valve spring B 1.6 (0.063) 9.2 (0.362) 44.0 (1.732) 12.5
Lock-up control valve spring 0.8 (0.031) 6.6 (0.260) 44.3 (1.744) 25.5
Lock-up timing valve spring 0.65 (0.026) 6.6 (0.260) 34.8 (1.370) 15.6
14-201
03/07/29 09:35:23 61S0X050_140_0205
Valve Body
2. Check all valves for free movement. If any fail to slide freely, refer to Valve Body Repair (see page 14-196).
3. Replace the valve body as an assembly if any parts are worn or damaged.
CPC VALVE A
CPC VALVE B
SHIFT VALVE A
4TH ACCUMULATOR
PISTON
VALVE SEAT
VALVE CAP
3RD ACCUMULATOR
PISTON
O-RINGS
Replace. VALVE CAP
CLIP
SHIFT VALVE B
SERVO BODY
Inspect for scoring
and damage.
SHIFT FORK
SHAFT/SERVO VALVE O-RING
Replace.
SPRING SPECIFICATIONS
No. Spring Standard (New)-Unit: mm (in.)
Wire Dia. O.D. Free Length No. of Coils
Shift valve B spring 0.8 (0.031) 7.1 (0.280) 40.4 (1.591) 16.9
Shift valve A spring 0.8 (0.031) 7.1 (0.280) 40.4 (1.591) 16.9
CPC valve A spring 0.7 (0.028) 6.1 (0.240) 17.8 (0.701) 7.9
CPC valve B spring 0.7 (0.028) 6.1 (0.240) 17.8 (0.701) 7.9
4th accumulator spring A 2.6 (0.102) 19.6 (0.772) 66.4 (2.614) 9.7
4th accumulator spring B 2.4 (0.094) 12.8 (0.504) 51.5 (2.028) 11.5
3rd accumulator spring A 2.6 (0.102) 19.6 (0.772) 66.4 (2.614) 9.7
3rd accumulator spring B 2.4 (0.094) 12.8 (0.504) 51.5 (2.028) 11.5
14-202
03/07/29 09:35:24 61S0X050_140_0206
2. Clean all parts thoroughly in solvent or carburetor cleaner, and dry them with compressed air. Blow out all
passages.
VALVE CLIP
ACCUMULATOR BODY
Inspect for scoring and
damage.
CHECK BALLS, 2
O-RING
Replace.
O-RING
Replace. SNAP RINGS
SPRING SPECIFICATIONS
No. Springs Standard (New)-Unit: mm (in.)
Wire Dia. O.D. Free Length No. of Coils
1st accumulator spring B 2.7 (0.106) 14.8 (0.583) 52.5 (2.067) 11.3
1st accumulator spring A 2.6 (0.102) 21.6 (0.850) 80.5 (3.169) 11.2
2nd accumulator spring B 2.4 (0.094) 12.6 (0.496) 53.5 (2.106) 12.9
2nd accumulator spring A 2.7 (0.106) 19.6 (0.772) 66.3 (2.610) 9.9
14-203
03/07/29 09:35:24 61S0X050_140_0207
07746-0010600
07736-A01000B or
07736-A01000A
07746-0010500
14-204
03/07/29 09:35:25 61S0X050_140_0208
B B
07736-A01000B or
07736-A01000A A
07736-A01000B or
2. Install the ATF guide plate (A). 07736-A01000A A
07749-0010000 2. Install the ATF guide plate (A).
07749-0010000
07746-0010500 07947-6340500
B
B
00.03 mm 00.03 mm
(00.001 in.) (00.001 in.)
C A C A
3. Install the new bearing (B) into the housing (C) with 3. Install the new bearing (B) into the housing (C) with
the special tools. the special tools.
14-205
03/07/29 09:35:26 61S0X050_140_0209
6 x 1.0 mm
9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm,
4TH GEAR 7.2 lbfft)
IDLER GEAR
THRUST NEEDLE BEARING
TRANSMISSION
HOUSING BEARING
O-RINGS
Replace.
THRUST SHIM, 41 x 73 mm
Selective part
SEALING RINGS,
29 mm NEEDLE BEARING
SET RING
NEEDLE BEARING
2. Check the clearance of the 3rd/4th clutch assembly (see page 14-207).
3. Inspect the thrust needle bearing and the needle bearing for galling and rough movement.
5. Check shaft bearing surfaces for scoring, scratches, and excessive wear.
6. Before installing the O-rings, wrap the shaft splines with tape to prevent damage to the O-rings.
7. Install the conical spring washer and 41 x 73 mm thrust shim in the direction shown.
8. Inspect condition of the sealing rings. If the sealing rings are worn, distorted, or damaged, replace them (see page
14-208).
14-206
03/07/29 09:35:27 61S0X050_140_0210
A E
THRUST SHIM, 41 x 73 mm
No. Part Number Thickness
1 90414-P7T-000 7.85 mm (0.309 in.)
2 90415-P7T-000 7.90 mm (0.311 in.)
3 90416-P7T-000 7.95 mm (0.313 in.)
4 90417-P7T-000 8.00 mm (0.315 in.)
5 90418-P7T-000 8.05 mm (0.317 in.)
6 90419-P7T-000 8.10 mm (0.319 in.)
14-207
03/07/29 09:35:27 61S0X050_140_0211
14-208
03/07/29 09:35:28 61S0X050_140_0212
2ND GEAR
BALL BEARING
BEARING HUB
Selective part
REVERSE GEAR
THRUST NEEDLE BEARING
REVERSE SELECTOR
NEEDLE BEARING
REVERSE SELECTOR HUB
THRUST NEEDLE
BEARING
4TH GEAR
PARK GEAR
NEEDLE BEARING
SNAP RING
DISTANCE COLLAR
TRANSMISSION HOUSING
BEARING
COTTERS, 31 mm
3RD GEAR
1ST GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT
2. Remove the reverse selector hub, 3rd gear, and 1st gear (see page 14-210).
3. Check the bearing in the bearing hub for wear and rough movement. If the bearing is worn or damaged, replace it
(see page 14-212).
4. Inspect the thrust needle bearing and the needle bearing for galling and rough movement.
6. Check the shaft bearing surfaces for scoring, scratches, and excessive wear.
7. Lubricate all parts with ATF, and reassemble the shafts and gears.
8. Install the conical spring washer, reverse selector, reverse selector hub, and distance collar in the direction shown.
14-209
03/07/29 09:35:28 61S0X050_140_0213
Countershaft Reverse Selector Hub, 3rd Gear, and 1st Gear Removal
1. Remove the reverse selector hub (A) and the 4th 2. Remove the needle bearing, snap ring, distance
gear (B) from the countershaft with a press. Place a collar, and 31 mm cotters from the countershaft.
shaft protector (C) between the countershaft and
press to prevent damaging the countershaft. 3. Remove the 1st gear (A) and 3rd gear (B) together
from the countershaft with a press. Place a shaft
NOTE: Some reverse selector hubs are not press- protector (C) between the countershaft and press to
fitted, and can be removed without using a puller. prevent damaging the countershaft.
C
C
14-210
03/07/29 09:35:29 61S0X050_140_0214
Countershaft Reverse Selector Hub, 3rd Gear, and 1st Gear Installation
Special Tools Required 4. Install the 31 mm cotters, distance collar, snap ring,
Driver, 40 mm I.D. 07746-0030100 needle bearing, and 4th gear (A) on the
countershaft.
1. Apply ATF to the parts.
5. Slide the reverse selector hub (B) over the
2. Align the shaft splines with those on 1st gear, then countershaft (C), and then press it into place with
press the countershaft (A) into the 1st gear (B) with the special tool and a press.
a press.
NOTE: Some reverse selector hubs are not press-
Place an attachment (C) between the press and fitted and can be installed without using the special
countershaft to prevent damaging the tool and a press.
countershaft.
Stop pressing the countershaft when the 1st gear
contacts the final drive gear (D). 07746-0030100
C
A
A
B
D
C
3. Align the shaft splines with those on 3rd gear, then
press the countershaft into the 3rd gear with a
press.
14-211
03/07/29 09:35:29 61S0X050_140_0215
07746-0010300 07749-0010000
A
B
07749-0010000
07746-0010500
14-212
03/07/29 09:35:30 61S0X050_140_0216
NEEDLE BEARING
TRANSMISSION
HOUSING BEARING
THRUST NEEDLE
BEARING
NEEDLE BEARING
1ST/2ND CLUTCH
ASSEMBLY
SPLINED WASHER,
38 x 56.5 mm COTTERS, 32 mm
Selective part COTTER RETAINER
SNAP RING
SEALING RINGS, 25 mm
2. Inspect the thrust needle bearing and the needle bearing for galling and rough movement.
5. Check the shaft bearing surfaces for scoring, scratches, and excessive wear.
6. Check the idler gear bearing for wear and rough movement. If the bearing is worn or damaged, replace it (see
page 14-216).
7. Before installing the O-rings, wrap the shaft splines with tape to prevent damage to the O-rings.
9. Install the conical spring washer and 38 x 56.5 splined washer in the direction shown.
14-213
03/07/29 09:35:31 61S0X050_140_0217
J
A
B F E
C
E
F
G J
H
4. If the clearance is out of standard, remove the
splined washer, and measure its thickness.
14-214
03/07/29 09:35:32 61S0X050_140_0218
6. Remove the 27 x 47 x 5 mm thrust washer from the 9. Hold the 27 x 47 x 5 mm thrust washer (G) against
mainshaft. the clutch assembly (A), and measure the 2nd gear
axial clearance in at least three places while
7. Assemble the 1st/2nd clutch assembly (A), 37 x 55 moving the 2nd gear (E). Use the average as the
mm thrust shim (B), thrust needle bearing (C), actual clearance.
needle bearing (D), 2nd gear (E), thrust needle
bearing (F), and 27 x 47 x 5 mm thrust washer Standard: 0.040.12 mm (0.0020.005 in.)
(removed from mainshaft ) (G) on the secondary E
shaft (H).
C
B
A G
A I
THRUST SHIM, 37 x 55 mm
8. Set the dial indicator (I) on 2nd gear (E). No. Part Number Thickness
E I 1 90406-P0Z-000 4.90 mm (0.193 in.)
2 90407-P0Z-000 4.95 mm (0.195 in.)
3 90408-P0Z-000 5.00 mm (0.197 in.)
4 90409-P0Z-000 5.05 mm (0.199 in.)
5 90410-P0Z-000 5.10 mm (0.201 in.)
6 90411-P0Z-000 5.15 mm (0.203 in.)
7 90412-P0Z-000 5.20 mm (0.205 in.)
14-215
03/07/29 09:35:32 61S0X050_140_0219
A B
14-216
03/07/29 09:35:33 61S0X050_140_0220
Clutch Disassembly
Special Tools Required 3. Install the special tools on the clutch assembly.
Clutch spring compressor attachment 07LAE-PX40100
07LAE-PX40100
Clutch spring compressor attachment
07HAE-PL50101
Clutch spring compressor bolt assembly
07GAE-PG40200 or 07GAE-PG4020A
07LAE-PX40100 or
07HAE-PL50101
07GAE-PG40200 or
07GAE-PG4020A
(contd)
14-217
03/07/29 09:35:34 61S0X050_140_0221
C
8. Remove the snap ring (A). Then remove the special
6. If either end of the special tool is set over an area of tool (B), spring retainer (C) and return spring.
the spring retainer which is unsupported by the
return spring, the retainer may be damaged.
B
A C
14-218
03/07/29 09:35:34 61S0X050_140_0222
9. For 3rd and 4th clutch: Wrap a shop rag around the
clutch drum (A), and apply air pressure to the fluid
passage to remove the piston (B). Place a finger tip
on the other end while applying air pressure.
14-219
03/07/29 09:35:35 61S0X050_140_0223
Clutch Inspection
1ST/2ND CLUTCH
SNAP RING
O-RINGS
Replace.
CLUTCH END
PLATE
CLUTCH PISTON
CLUTCH PLATE
Standard thickness:
2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
DISC SPRING CLUTCH DISCS
Standard thickness:
1.94 mm (0.076 in.)
RETURN SPRING
O-RING
Replace.
SPRING RETAINER
SNAP RING
SNAP RING
SPRING RETAINER
CLUTCH DISCS
Standard thickness:
1.94 mm (0.076 in.) O-RING
CLUTCH PLATE Replace.
Standard thickness:
2.0 mm (0.079 in.) RETURN SPRING
CLUTCH PISTON
O-RINGS
Replace.
2ND CLUTCH
DRUM
1ST CLUTCH
CLUTCH END DRUM
PLATE SNAP RING
14-220
03/07/29 09:35:36 61S0X050_140_0224
3RD/4TH CLUTCH
SNAP RING
CLUTCH DISCS
Standard thickness:
1.94 mm (0.076 in.) CLUTCH END PLATE
CLUTCH PLATES
Standard thickness:
2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
O-RINGS
Replace.
CHECK VALVE
CLUTCH PISTON
SNAP RING
DISC SPRING
CLUTCH DISCS
Standard thickness:
1.94 mm (0.076 in.) CLUTCH PISTON
O-RINGS
Replace.
SNAP RING
14-221
03/07/29 09:35:36 61S0X050_140_0225
Clutch Reassembly
Special Tools Required 3. Install new O-rings (A) on the piston (B).
Clutch spring compressor attachment
07LAE-PX40100 A
A
Clutch spring compressor attachment
07HAE-PL50101
Clutch spring compressor bolt assembly
07GAE-PG40200 or 07GAE-PG4020A
Clutch compressor attachment B
07ZAE-PRP0100
14-222
03/07/29 09:35:37 61S0X050_140_0226
5. Install the return spring (A) and spring retainer (B), 7. Be sure the special tool (A) is adjusted to have full
and position the snap ring (C) on the retainer. contact with the spring retainer (B) on the 3rd and
C 4th clutches.
B
A
(contd)
14-223
03/07/29 09:35:38 61S0X050_140_0227
13. Install the disc spring in the 1st, 3rd, and 4th
clutches in the direction shown.
14-224
03/07/29 09:35:39 61S0X050_140_0228
17. Set a dial indicator (A) on the clutch end plate (B). 21. If the clearance is not within the service limit, select
a new clutch end plate from the following table.
A
NOTE: If the thickest clutch end plate is installed,
but the clearance is still over the standard, replace
the clutch discs and clutch plates as a set.
C
B
18. Zero the dial indicator with the clutch end plate
lifted up to the snap ring (C).
19. Release the clutch end plate to lower the clutch end 1ST and 2ND CLUTCH END PLATES
plate, then put the special tool on the end plate (A). Mark Part Number Thickness
6 22551-P7T-003 2.6 mm (0.102 in.)
7 22552-P7T-003 2.7 mm (0.106 in.)
B 39 N
(4 kgf, 91 lbf) 8 22553-P7T-003 2.8 mm (0.110 in.)
9 22554-P7T-003 2.9 mm (0.114 in.)
0 22555-P7T-003 3.0 mm (0.118 in.)
1 22556-P7T-003 3.1 mm (0.122 in.)
07ZAE-PRP0100
2 22557-P7T-003 3.2 mm (0.126 in.)
3 22558-P7T-003 3.3 mm (0.130 in.)
A 4 22559-P7T-003 3.4 mm (0.134 in.)
D
3RD and 4TH CLUTCH END PLATES
Mark Part Number Thickness
C
1 22561-P7T-003 2.1 mm (0.083 in.)
2 22562-P7T-003 2.2 mm (0.087 in.)
3 22563-P7T-003 2.3 mm (0.091 in.)
20. Press the special tool down with 39 N (4 kgf, 9 lbf) 4 22564-P7T-003 2.4 mm (0.094 in.)
using a force gauge, and read the dial indicator (B). 5 22565-P7T-003 2.5 mm (0.098 in.)
The dial indicator reads the clearance (C) between 6 22566-P7T-003 2.6 mm (0.102 in.)
the clutch end plate and top disc (D). Take 7 22567-P7T-003 2.7 mm (0.106 in.)
measurements in at least three places, and use the 8 22568-P7T-003 2.8 mm (0.110 in.)
average as the actual clearance. 9 22569-P7T-003 2.9 mm (0.114 in.)
14-225
03/07/29 09:35:40 61S0X050_140_0229
Valve Body
Torque:
6 x 1.0 mm: 12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
8 x 1.25 mm: 18 Nm (1.8 kgfm, 13 lbfft)
ATF FEED
PIPES,
ATF STRAINER Two Pipes
O-RING
Replace.
O-RING REGULATOR
Replace. CONTROL
SHAFT VALVE BODY
6 x 1.0 mm,
Two Bolts DETENT
ARM STATOR SHAFT
STATOR SHAFT STOP
DETENT
ARM SHAFT DOWEL PINS, Two Pins
REGULATOR
ACCUMULATOR SEPARATOR PLATE
COVER
6 x 1.0 mm, One Bolt
8 x 1.25 mm, Three Bolts
6 x 1.0 mm,
Nine Bolts MAIN VALVE BODY
14-226
03/07/29 09:35:41 61S0X050_140_0230
1. Install the main separator plate (A) and three dowel 4. Install the cooler check valve and spring on the
pins on the torque converter housing. Then install main valve body, then install the two dowel pins
the ATF pump drive gear (B), driven gear (C) and and the regulator separator plate.
ATF pump driven gear shaft (D). Install the ATF
pump driven gear with its grooved and chamfered 5. Install the stator shaft and stator shaft stop.
side facing down.
B
6. Install the regulator valve body (eight bolts).
C
A F
B E
9. Install the detent arm (C) and arm shaft (D) in the
main valve body (E), then hook the detent arm
spring (F) to the detent arm.
B D
12. Install the ATF strainer (two bolts).
3. If the ATF pump drive gear and ATF pump driven 13. Install the servo detent base (two bolts).
gear shaft do not move smoothly, loosen the main
valve body bolts. Realign the ATF pump driven 14. Install the accumulator body (six bolts).
gear shaft, retighten the bolts to the specified
torque, and recheck movement. Failure to align the 15. Install the two ATF feed pipes in the servo body,
ATF pump driven gear shaft correctly will result in four pipes in the regulator valve body, and one pipe
a seized ATF pump drive gear or ATF pump driven in the accumulator body.
gear shaft.
14-227
03/07/29 09:35:42 61S0X050_140_0231
Transmission Housing
COUNTERSHAFT
2ND GEAR
TRANSMISSION HANGER/
6 x 1.0 mm HARNESS CLAMP BRACKET
14 Nm (1.4 kgfm,
10 lbfft)
LOCK WASHER
Replace.
SHIFT FORK
TRANSMISSION HOUSING
TRANSMISSION HANGER
DOWEL PIN
REVERSE IDLER
REVERSE SELECTOR GEAR
REVERSE SELECTOR
HUB DOWEL PIN
COUNTERSHAFT
4TH GEAR
MAINSHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT SUBASSEMBLY
SUBASSEMBLY
TRANSMISSION HOUSING
GASKET
Replace.
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
COUNTERSHAFT
SUBASSEMBLY TORQUE CONVERTER HOUSING
14-228
03/07/29 09:35:43 61S0X050_140_0232
NOTE: Refer to the Exploded View as needed during the 5. Place the thrust washer (A) in the transmission
following procedure. housing.
1. Install the differential assembly, countershaft
subassembly, mainshaft subassembly, and
secondary shaft subassembly in the torque
converter housing.
E
6 x 1.0 mm
14 Nm (1.4 kgfm, 10 lbfft)
F
A
B
(contd)
14-229
03/07/29 09:35:44 61S0X050_140_0233
Transmission Housing
14-230
03/07/29 09:35:45 61S0X050_140_0234
C
D
6 x 1.0 mm
14 Nm (1.4 kgfm, 10 lbfft)
2. Lubricate the following parts with ATF: 4. Remove the locknut and the collar, then install only
the bearing hub/bearing assembly (A) and old
Splines of the countershaft, the park gear, and conical spring washer (B). Tighten the old locknut
the old locknut. (C) to 226 Nm (23.0 kgfm, 166 lbfft), then remove
Threads of the countershaft and the old locknut. the locknut and conical spring washer.
Old conical spring washer.
NOTE: Use a torque wrench to tighten the locknut.
Do not use an impact wrench.
C B
(contd)
14-231
03/07/29 09:35:46 61S0X050_140_0235
NOTE: Use a torque wrench to tighten the locknut. Standard: 0.0150.045 mm (0.00060.0018 in.)
Do not use an impact wrench.
G F
D
C
14-232
03/07/29 09:35:47 61S0X050_140_0236
9. If the clearance is out of standard, remove the 14. Lubricate the following parts with ATF:
bearing hub/bearing assembly using a puller as
described. Splines of the mainshaft, secondary shaft, and
idler gears.
10. Select and install the new bearing hub/bearing Threads of the mainshaft and secondary shaft.
assembly, then recheck. Threads of the old mainshaft and secondary shaft
locknuts.
Old conical spring washers.
15. Install the mainshaft idler gear (A) and the old
conical spring washer (B) on the mainshaft (C).
Tighten the old locknut (D) to 226 Nm (23.0 kgfm,
166 lbfft) to seat the mainshaft idler gear.
BEARING HUB D
Mark Part Number Difference
A
A 90520-P6H-000 3.503 mm (0.1379 in.)
B 90521-P6H-000 3.490 mm (0.1374 in.) B
C 90522-P6H-000 3.477 mm (0.1369 in.) C
D 90523-P6H-000 3.464 mm (0.1364 in.)
NOTE:
Use a torque wrench to tighten the locknut. Do
not use an impact wrench.
Secondary shaft locknut has left-hand threads.
(contd)
14-233
03/07/29 09:35:49 61S0X050_140_0237
B B
A A
A B
B
A
23. Set the park lever in P position, then verify that the
20. Tighten the locknut to 167 Nm, (17.0 kgfm, 123 park pawl (A) engages the park gear (B).
lbfft).
B
NOTE:
Use a torque wrench to tighten the locknut. Do
not use an impact wrench.
Countershaft and secondary shaft locknuts have
left-hand threads.
24. If the park pawl does not engage fully, check the
distance between the pawl shaft (C) and the park
lever roller pin (D) (see page 14-190).
25. Tighten the lock bolt (E), and bend the lock tab of
the lock washer (F) against the lock bolt head.
14-234
03/07/29 09:35:49 61S0X050_140_0238
26. Install the end cover (A) with the two dowel pins, 28. Set the control shaft (A) to the N position by turning
new O-rings, new gasket, and harness clamp it.
bracket (B). Tighten the 16 bolts to 12 Nm, (1.2
kgfm, 8.7 lbfft). NOTE: Be careful not to squeeze the end of the
control shaft tips together when turning into
position. If the tips are squeezed together it will
B cause a faulty shift signal or position due to the
play between the control shaft and position switch.
(contd)
14-235
03/07/29 09:35:50 61S0X050_140_0239
C 6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm(1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
B G
14-236
03/07/29 09:35:52 61S0X050_140_0240
A/T Differential
A
THRUST SHIM, 76 mm
THRUST WASHER
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER
Backlash Inspection,
page 14-237
CARRIER BEARING
Replacement, page 14-238
THRUST WASHER
14-237
03/07/29 09:35:52 61S0X050_140_0241
A/T Differential
D
2. Install the final driven gear with the chamfered side
on the inner bore facing the differential carrier.
NOTE:
Press the bearings on until they bottom.
Use the small end of the special tool to install the
bearing.
Press the bearings on securely so there is no
clearance between the bearings and the
differential carrier.
07LAD-PW50601
14-238
03/07/29 09:35:53 61S0X050_140_0242
B
A
3. Remove the oil seal (A) from the torque converter
housing (B).
07JAD-PH80101
A B
14-239
03/07/29 09:35:54 61S0X050_140_0243
A/T Differential
07HAD-SF10100
07749-0010000
07HAD-SF10100
14-240
03/07/29 09:35:55 61S0X050_140_0244
A
07HAD-SF10100
2. Replace the tapered roller bearing when the outer
race is to be replaced.
(contd)
14-241
03/07/29 09:35:56 61S0X050_140_0245
A/T Differential
Standard:
New bearing: 2.73.9 Nm
(2840 kgfcm, 2435 lbfin.)
Reused bearings: 2.53.6 Nm
F G (2537 kgfcm, 2232 lbfin.)
C
E
B 07XAJ-S0KA100
A D
14-242
03/07/29 09:35:56 61S0X050_140_0246
THRUST SHIM, 76 mm
NO. Part Number Thickness
S 41438-PX4-700 2.05 mm (0.081 in.)
T 41439-PX4-700 2.01 mm (0.083 in.)
U 41440-PX4-700 2.15 mm (0.085 in.)
A 41441-PK4-000 2.20 mm (0.087 in.)
B 41442-PK4-000 2.25 mm (0.089 in.)
C 41443-PK4-000 2.30 mm (0.091 in.)
D 41444-PK4-000 2.35 mm (0.093 in.)
E 41445-PK4-000 2.40 mm (0.094 in.)
F 41446-PK4-000 2.45 mm (0.096 in.)
G 41447-PK4-000 2.50 mm (0.098 in.)
H 41448-PK4-000 2.55 mm (0.100 in.)
I 41449-PK4-000 2.60 mm (0.102 in.)
J 41450-PK4-000 2.65 mm (0.104 in.)
K 41451-PK4-000 2.70 mm (0.106 in.)
L 41452-PK4-000 2.75 mm (0.108 in.)
M 41453-PK4-000 2.80 mm (0.110 in.)
N 41454-PK4-000 2.85 mm (0.112 in.)
O 41455-PK4-000 2.90 mm (0.114 in.)
P 41456-PK4-000 2.95 mm (0.116 in.)
Q 41457-PK4-000 3.00 mm (0.118 in.)
R 41458-PK4-000 3.05 mm (0.120 in.)
14-243
03/07/29 09:35:57 61S0X050_140_0247
5-speed
Automatic Transmission
(2002-2004 Models)
Automatic Transmission A/T Gear Position Indicator
Special Tools ................................................... 14-246 Component Location Index ........................... 14-397
General Troubleshooting Information ......... 14-247 Circuit Diagram ............................................... 14-398
DTC Troubleshooting Index ............................14-251 D Indicator Circuit Troubleshootig ................ 14-399
Symptom Troubleshooting Index ................. 14-252 Indicator Input Test ........................................ 14-402
System Description ........................................ 14-262 Transmission Range Switch Test ................. 14-403
DTC Troubleshooting ..................................... 14-316 Transmission Range Switch
Road Test ........................................................ 14-352 Replacement ............................................... 14-404
Stall Speed Test .............................................. 14-354 Indicator Bulb Replacement .......................... 14-406
Pressure Test .................................................. 14-355
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Valve A/T Interlock System
Test ............................................................... 14-357 Component Location Index ........................... 14-407
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid Valve Circuit Diagram ............................................... 14-408
Replacement ............................................... 14-357 Shift Lock System Circuit
Shift Solenoid Valve A Test ........................... 14-359 Troubleshooting ......................................... 14-409
Shift Solenoid Valve A Replacement ............ 14-359 Key Interlock System Troubleshooting ........ 14-412
Shift Solenoid Valve B Test ........................... 14-358 Control Unit Input Test ................................... 14-414
Shift Solenoid Valve B Replacement ............ 14-358 Key Interlock Solenoid/Switch Test .............. 14-415
Shift Solenoid Valve C Test ........................... 14-359 Shift Lock Solenoid Test ................................ 14-415
Shift Solenoid Valve C Replacement ............ 14-359 Shift Lock Solenoid Replacement ................. 14-416
A/T Clutch Pressure Control Solenoid Valve Park Pin Switch Test/Replacement ............... 14-417
Solenoid Valve A Test ................................ 14-360
Solenoid Valve A Replacement ................. 14-361 Transmission End Cover
Solenoid Valve B Test ................................ 14-360 End Cover, 3rd Gear, Idler Gear,
Solenoid Valve B Replacement ................. 14-361 and 3rd Clutch Removal ............................. 14-418
Solenoid Valve C Test ................................ 14-362 Park Lever Stop
Solenoid Valve C Replacement ................. 14-363 Inspection and Adjustment ........................ 14-420
Input Shaft (Mainshaft) Speed Sensor Control Shaft Oil Seal Replacement ............. 14-421
Replacement ............................................... 14-364 Control Shaft Bearing Replacement ............. 14-421
Output Shaft (Countershaft) Speed Sensor ATF Feed Pipe Replacement ......................... 14-422
Replacement ............................................... 14-364 End Cover, 3rd Gear, Idler Gear,
3rd Clutch Transmission Fluid and 3rd Clutch Installation ......................... 14-469
Pressure Switch Replacement ................... 14-365
4th Clutch Transmission Fluid Transmission Housing
Pressure Switch Replacement ................... 14-365 Housing and Shaft Assembly Removal ........ 14-423
ATF Temperature Sensor Replacement ....... 14-366 Bearing Removal and Installation ................. 14-425
ATF Level Check ............................................. 14-367 Shaft Assembly and Housing
ATF Replacement ........................................... 14-368 Installation ................................................... 14-466
Transmission Removal .................................. 14-369
Drive Plate Removal and Installation ........... 14-378
Transmission Installation .............................. 14-379
ATF Cooler Flushing ....................................... 14-388
ATF Cooler Hoses Replacement ................... 14-389
Shift Lever Removal ....................................... 14-390
Shift Lever Installation ................................... 14-391
Shift Lever Disassembly/Reassembly .......... 14-392
Shift Cable Replacement ............................... 14-393
Shift Cable Adjustment .................................. 14-395
03/07/29 09:35:58 61S0X050_140_0248
Automatic Transmission
Special Tools
Ref. No. Tool Number Description Qty
07GAB-PF50101 or 07GAB-PF50100 Mainshaft Holder 1
07GAD-PG40101 or 07GAD-PG40100 Seal Driver Attachment 1
07GAD-SD40101 Attachment, 78 x 90 mm 1
07GAE-PG40200 or 07GAE-PG4020A Clutch Spring Compressor Bolt Assembly 1
07HAC-PK40102 Housing Puller 1
07JAD-PH80101 Oil Seal Driver Attachment 1
07LAD-PW50601 Attachment, 40 x 50 mm 1
07LAE-PX40100 Clutch Spring Compressor Attachment 2
07MAJ-PY4011A A/T Pressure Hose, 2,210 mm 4
07MAJ-PY40120 A/T Pressure Hose Adapter 4
07NAD-PX40100 Attachment, 78 x 80 mm 1
07SAZ-001000A Backprobe Set 2
07XAA-001030A Engine Support Fixture 1
07YAJ-S3V0100 Preload Inspection Tool 1
07ZAA-S0XA100 Cable Eyebolt Assembly 1
07ZAE-PRP0100 Clutch Compressor Attachment 1
07406-0020400 or 07406-0020401 A/T Oil Pressure Gauge Set w/Panel 1
07736-A01000B or 07736-A01000A Adjustable Bearing Puller, 2540 mm 1
07746-0010500 Attachment, 62 x 68 mm 1
07746-0010600 Attachment, 72 x 75 mm 1
07746-0010800 Attachment, 22 x 24 mm 1
07746-0030100 Driver, 40 mm I.D. 1
07749-0010000 Driver 1
07947-6340500 Driver Attachment 1
If the top arm is too short, replace it with 07SAC-P0Z01001.
07HAE-PL50101 may be used to substitute one of these tools.
Must be used with commercially available 3/8-16 slide hammer.
14-246
03/07/29 09:36:02 61S0X050_140_0250
B
2. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), select A/T system
and observe the DTC in the DTCs MENU or the
tester screen.
When the data link connector (DLC) (A) (located under NOTE: You can also reset the memory by removing
the steering column lower cover) is connected to the the No. 13 fuse in the passengers under-dash fuse/
Scan Tool or Honda diagnostic system (HDS), it will relay box for more than 10 seconds. If you do, you
indicate the diagnostic trouble code (DTC) when the need to do the following:
ignition switch is turned ON (II). Get the customers radio and navigation (if
equipped) anti-theft code, and write down the
radio and navigation presets.
Enter the radio and navigation (if equipped) anti-
theft code, reset the preset stations, and set the
clock.
Do the idle learn procedure (see page 11-202).
(contd)
14-247
03/07/29 09:37:00 61S0X050_140_0251
Automatic Transmission
B
2. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), select Honda
System, and then SCS mode, then observe the D
indicator in the gauge assembly.
Codes 1 through 9 are indicated by individual short
blinks. Code 10 and above are indicated by a series
of long and short blinks. One long blink equals 10
short blinks. Add the long and short blinks together
to determine the code.
Example: DTC 1
Short blink (once)
ON
A OFF
Example: DTC 15
ON
OFF
When the D indicator has been reported on, connect the
HDS to the DLC (A) (located under the steering column 3. Record all fuel and emissions DTCs and A/T DTCs.
lower cover). Turn the ignition switch ON (II), select
Honda System, and SCS mode, then the D indicator will 4. If there is a fuel and emissions DTC, first check the
indicate the DTC. fuel and emissions system as indicated by the DTC
(except DTC 70, DTC 70 means there is one or more
A/T DTCs, and no problems were detected in the
fuel and emissions circuit of the PCM).
14-248
03/07/29 09:37:00 61S0X050_140_0252
How to Troubleshoot Circuits at the PCM Clear A/T DTCs, and PCM Reset Procedures
Special Tools Required 1. Connect the Scan Tool or the HDS to the DLC.
Backprobe set 07SAZ-001000A (two required)
2. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
1. Pull back the carpet from passengers side of the
center lower console to expose the PCM. 3. Clear the DTC(s) with the scan tool or the HDS.
2. Inspect the circuit on the PCM, according to the NOTE: You can also reset the memory by removing
DTC troubleshooting, with the special tools and a the No. 13 fuse in the passengers under-dash fuse/
digital multimeter. relay box for more than 10 seconds. If you do, you
need to do the following:
3. Connect the backprobe adapters (A) to the stacking Get the customers radio and navigation (if
patch cords (B), and connect the cords to a equipped) anti-theft code, and write down the
multimeter (C). radio and navigation presets.
Enter the radio and navigation (if equipped) anti-
theft code, reset the preset stations, and set the
clock.
C Do the idle learn procedure (see page 11-202).
A
B 07SAZ-001000A
07SAZ-001000A
(contd)
14-249
03/07/29 09:37:00 61S0X050_140_0253
Automatic Transmission
14-250
03/07/29 09:37:01 61S0X050_140_0254
(1)
DTC D Indicator MIL Detection Item Page
(2)
P0710 (28) Blinks OFF ATF temperature sensor (see page 14-316)
P0715 (15) Blinks ON Input shaft (mainshaft) speed sensor (see page 14-318)
P0720 (9) Blinks ON Output shaft (countershaft) speed sensor (see page 14-321)
(2)
P0743 (1) Blinks ON Torque converter clutch solenoid valve (see page 14-326)
(2)
P0748 (16) Blinks ON A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve A (see page 14-328)
(2)
P0753 (7) Blinks ON Shift solenoid valve A (see page 14-330)
(2)
P0758 (8) Blinks ON Shift solenoid valve B (see page 14-332)
(2)
P0763 (22) Blinks ON Shift solenoid valve C (see page 14-334)
(2)
P0778 (23) Blinks ON A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve B (see page 14-336)
P0780 (45) Blinks ON Mechanical problem in hydraulic system (see page 14-338)
(2)
P0798 (29) Blinks ON A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve C (see page 14-339)
P0845 (26) Blinks OFF 3rd clutch transmission fluid pressure switch (see page 14-341)
(2)
P1705 (5) Blinks ON Transmission range switch (short to ground) (see page 14-343)
(2)
P1706 (6) OFF ON Transmission range switch (open) (see page 14-346)
P1740 (27) Blinks OFF 4th clutch transmission fluid pressure switch (see page 14-348)
P1750 (46) Blinks ON Mechanical problem in hydraulic system (see page 14-350)
P1751 (47) Blinks ON Mechanical problem in hydraulic system (see page 14-351)
(1): The DTC in parentheses is the flash code the D indicator indicates when the date link connector is
connected to the HDS, and the HDS is in the SCS mode (see page 14-247).
(2): This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the
transmission.
14-251
03/07/29 09:37:01 61S0X050_140_0255
Automatic Transmission
When you turn the A problem in the D Check the D indicator circuit (see page 14-399).
ignition switch ON (II), indicator circuit
the D indicator comes on
stays on or never comes
on at all
Shift lever cannot be A problem in the shift lock Check interlock system shift lock system circuit (see
moved from P while system of the interlock page 14-409).
youre pressing on the system
brake pedal
Ignition switch cannot be A problem in the key Check interlock system key interlock system circuit
moved from ACC (I) interlock system of the (see page 14-412).
position to LOCK (0) interlock system
position (key is pushed in,
shift lever in P)
14-252
03/07/29 09:37:01 61S0X050_140_0256
Engine runs, but 1. Low ATF level Check the ATF level and check the ATF cooler lines for
vehicle does not 2. Shift cable broken or out leakage and loose connections. If necessary, flush the
move in any gear of adjustment ATF cooler lines.
3. Shift cable worn Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever and the
4. ATF pump worn or transmission control shaft.
binding Improper alignment of ATF pump and torque converter
5. Regulator valve stuck or housing may cause ATF pump seizure. The symptoms
spring worn are mostly an rpm-related ticking noise or a high
6. ATF strainer clogged pitched squeak.
7. Mainshaft worn or Check the line pressure.
damaged Check the ATF strainer for debris. If the strainer is
8. Final gears worn or clogged, find the damaged components that caused
damaged debris.
9. Transmission-to-engine Inspect the differential pinion gears for wear. If the
assembly error differential pinion gears are worn, replace the
10. Axle disengaged differential assembly, replace the ATF strainer,
thoroughly clean the transmission, and flush the cooler
and lines. Replace the torque converter.
Be careful not to damage the torque converter housing
when replacing the main ball bearing. You may also
damage the ATF pump when you torque down the main
valve body. This will result in ATF pump seizure if not
detected. Use the proper tools.
Install the main seal flush with the torque converter
housing. If you push it into the torque converter
housing until it bottoms out, it will block the fluid return
passage and result in damage.
Vehicle moves in R, 1. 1st accumulator defective Check the 1st clutch pressure.
but not in D, D3, or 2. 1st clutch defective Inspect the secondary shaft and 1st/1st-hold/2nd clutch
1 assembly for wear and damage.
Inspect the clutch piston and O-rings. Check the spring
retainer for wear and damage. Inspect the clutch end
plate-to-top disc clearance. If the clearance is out of
tolerance, inspect the clutch discs and plates for wear
and damage. If the discs and plates are worn and
damaged, replace them as a set. If they are OK, adjust
the clutch end plate clearance.
Vehicle moves in 2 1. 1st gear one-way clutch Check the 1st clutch pressure.
and R, but not in D, defective Inspect the secondary shaft and 1st/1st-hold/2nd clutch
D3, or 1 2. 1st gears worn or assembly for wear and damage.
damaged Inspect the clutch piston and O-rings. Check the spring
3. 1st clutch defective retainer for wear and damage. Inspect the clutch end-
plate-to-top-disc clearance. If the clearance is out of
tolerance, inspect the clutch discs and plates for wear
and damage. If the discs and plates are worn or
damaged, replace them as a set. If they are OK, adjust
the clutch end plate clearance.
(contd)
14-253
03/07/29 09:37:01 61S0X050_140_0257
Automatic Transmission
Vehicle moves in 1. Shift fork shaft stuck Check the line pressure and 5th clutch pressure.
D, D3, 2, and 1, 2. Modulator valve Check for a missing shift fork bolt on the shift fork shaft.
but not in R (or defective Check the ATF strainer for debris. If the ATF strainer is
moves forward 3. Reverse CPC valve clogged with particles of steel or aluminum, inspect the ATF
in R) defective pump. If the ATF pump is OK, find the damaged
4. 5th accumulator components that caused the debris. If no cause for the
defective contamination is found, replace the torque converter.
5. 5th clutch defective Inspect the reverse selector gear teeth chamfers, and
6. Reverse gears worn or inspect engagement teeth chamfers of the countershaft 5th
damaged gear and reverse gear. Replace the reverse gears and the
reverse selector if they are worn or damaged. If the
transmission makes clicking, grinding, or whirring noises,
also replace the mainshaft 5th gear, reverse idler gear, and
countershaft 5th gear.
If the 5th clutch feed pipe guide in the end cover is scored
by the mainshaft, inspect the ball bearing for excessive
movement in the transmission housing. If the ball bearing is
OK, replace the end cover as it is dented. The O-ring under
the guide is probably worn.
Replace the mainshaft if the bushing for the 4th and 5th
clutch feed pipes are loose or damaged. If the 5th clutch
feed pipe is damaged or out of round, replace the end cover.
Inspect the clutch piston, clutch piston check valve, and O-
rings. Check the spring retainer for wear and damage.
Inspect the clutch end-plate-to-top-disc clearance. If the
clearance is out of tolerance, inspect the clutch discs and
plates for wear and damage. If the discs and plates are worn
or damaged, replace them as a set. If they are OK, adjust the
clearance with the clutch end plate.
14-254
03/07/29 09:37:02 61S0X050_140_0258
Poor acceleration; 1. Low ATF level Check the ATF level and check the ATF cooler lines for
flares on starting 2. Shift cable broken or out leakage and loose connections. If necessary, flush the
off in D and D3; of adjustment ATF cooler lines.
stall speed high in 3. ATF pump worn or Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever and the
D, D3, 2, and 1 binding transmission control shaft.
4. Regulator valve stuck or Check the line pressure.
spring worn Improper alignment of ATF pump and torque converter
5. ATF strainer clogged housing may cause ATF pump seizure. The symptom is
6. Torque converter check mostly an rpm-ticking noise or a high pitched squeak.
valve defective Be careful not to damage the torque converter housing
when replacing the main ball bearing. You may also
damage the ATF pump when you torque down the main
valve body. This will result in ATF pump seizure if not
detected. Use the proper tools.
Poor acceleration; 2nd clutch defective Check the 2nd clutch pressure.
flares on starting Inspect the clutch piston and O-rings. Check the spring
off in D and D3; retainer for wear and damage. Inspect the clutch end-
stall speed high in plate-to-top-disc clearance. If the clearance is out of
2 tolerance, inspect the clutch discs and plates for wear
and damage. If the discs and plates are worn or
damaged, replace them as a set. If they are OK, adjust
the clutch end plate clearance.
Poor acceleration; 1. Shift cable broken or out Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever and the
flares on starting of adjustment transmission control shaft.
off in R; 2. 5th clutch defective Check the 5th clutch pressure.
stall speed high in Inspect the clutch piston and O-rings. Check the spring
R retainer for wear and damage. Inspect the clutch end-
plate-to-top-disc clearance. If the clearance is out of
tolerance, inspect the clutch discs and plates for wear
and damage. If the discs and plates are worn or
damaged, replace them as a set. If they are OK, adjust
the clutch end plate clearance.
(contd)
14-255
03/07/29 09:37:02 61S0X050_140_0259
Automatic Transmission
Poor acceleration; 1. Torque converter clutch Check for a stuck lock-up valve in the valve body.
stall speed low solenoid valve defective
2. Engine output low
3. Lock-up clutch piston
defective
4. Lock-up shift valve
defective
Engine idle 1. Low ATF level Set idle rpm in gear to the specified idle speed. If still no
vibration 2. Torque converter clutch good, adjust the engine and transmission mounts.
solenoid valve defective Check the ATF level and check the ATF cooler lines for
3. Drive plate defective or leakage and loose connections. If necessary, flush the
transmission ATF cooler lines.
misassembled
4. Engine output low
5. Lock-up clutch piston
defective
6. ATF pump worn or
binding
7. Lock-up shift valve
defective
Vehicle moves in N 1. Excessive ATF Check the ATF level, and drain the ATF if it is over filled.
2. Foreign material in Inspect the clutch piston, clutch piston check valve, and
separator plate orifice O-rings. Check the spring retainer for wear and damage.
3. Relief valve defective Inspect the clutch end-plate-to-top-disc clearance. If the
4. 1st-hold clutch defective clearance is out of tolerance, inspect the clutch discs
5. 1st clutch defective and plates for wear and damage. If the discs and plates
6. 2nd clutch defective are worn or damaged, replace them as a set. If they are
7. 3rd clutch defective OK, adjust the clutch end plate clearance.
8. 4th clutch defective Check all clutch pressures.
9. 5th clutch defective
10. Clutch clearance
incorrect
11. Needle bearing seized up,
worn, or damaged
12. Thrust washer seized up,
worn, or damaged
14-256
03/07/29 09:37:02 61S0X050_140_0260
Late shift after 1. Shift solenoid valve C defective Check the D indicator, and check for loose
shifting from N 2. A/T clutch pressure control connectors. Inspect the O-ring, and check the shift
to D and D3, or solenoid valves A and B defective solenoid valve for seizure.
excessive shock 3. A/T clutch pressure control Inspect the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid
when shifted solenoid valve C defective valve body gasket and ATF feed pipes for wear and
into D or D3 4. Shift cable broken or out of damage. If the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid
adjustment valve is stuck, inspect the CPC valves.
5. Joint in shift cable and Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever and
transmission or body worn the transmission control shaft.
6. Input shaft (mainshaft) speed Check the ATF strainer for debris. If the ATF
sensor defective strainer is clogged with particles of steel or
7. Output shaft (countershaft) speed aluminum, inspect the ATF pump. If the ATF pump
sensor defective is OK, find the damaged components that caused
8. ATF temperature sensor defective the debris. If no cause for the contamination is
9. CPC valve C stuck found, replace the torque converter.
10. Foreign material in separator Check the 1st clutch pressure.
plate orifice Inspect the clutch piston, clutch piston check valve,
11. Shift valve C defective and O-rings. Check the spring retainer for wear and
12. Shift valve E defective damage. Inspect the clutch end-plate-to-top-disc
13. Servo control valve defective clearance. If the clearance is out of tolerance,
14. 1st accumulator defective inspect the clutch discs and plates for wear and
15. 1st check ball stuck damage. If the discs and plates are worn or
16. 1st clutch defective damaged, replace them as a set. If they are OK,
adjust the clutch end plate clearance.
Late shift after 1. Shift solenoid valve C defective Check the D indicator, and check for loose
shifting from N 2. A/T clutch pressure control connectors. Inspect the O-ring, and check the shift
to R solenoid valves A and B defective solenoid valve for seizure.
3. A/T clutch pressure control Inspect the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid
solenoid valve C defective valve body gasket and ATF feed pipes for wear and
4. Shift cable broken or out of damage. If the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid
adjustment valve is stuck, inspect the CPC valves.
5. Joint in shift cable and Check for a loose shift cable on the shift lever and
transmission or body worn the transmission control shaft.
6. Input shaft (mainshaft) Check the ATF strainer for debris. If the ATF
speed sensor defective strainer is clogged with particles of steel or
7. Output shaft (countershaft) speed aluminum, inspect the ATF pump. If the ATF pump
sensor defective is OK, find the damaged components that caused
8. ATF temperature sensor defective the debris. If no cause for the contamination is
9. Shift fork shaft stuck found, replace the torque converter.
10. CPC valve C stuck Check the 5th clutch pressure.
11. Reverse CPC valve defective Inspect the clutch piston, clutch piston check valve,
12. Foreign material in separator and O-rings. Check the spring retainer for wear and
plate orifice damage. Inspect the clutch end-plate-to-top-disc
13. Shift valve E defective clearance. If the clearance is out of tolerance,
14. 5th accumulator defective inspect the clutch discs and plates for wear and
15. 5th clutch defective damage. If the discs and plates are worn or
damaged, replace them as a set. If they are OK,
adjust the clutch end plate clearance.
(contd)
14-257
03/07/29 09:37:03 61S0X050_140_0261
Automatic Transmission
The A/T does not 1. Input shaft (mainshaft) Check the D indicator, and check for loose connectors.
shift speed sensor defective Check the line pressure.
2. Output shaft
(countershaft) speed
sensor defective
3. Modulator valve
defective
Erratic shifting: 1. Shift solenoid valve B Check the D indicator, and check for loose connectors.
Fails to shift in defective Inspect the O-ring, and check the shift solenoid valve for
D and D3; 2. Shift valve B defective seizure.
starts off in 5th
Erratic shifting: 1. Shift solenoid valve B Check the D indicator, and check for loose connectors.
Fails to shift in 2; defective Inspect the O-ring, and check the shift solenoid valve for
starts off in 4th 2. Shift valve B defective seizure.
Erratic shifting: 1. Shift solenoid valve A Check the D indicator, and check for loose connectors.
Fails to shift in defective Inspect the O-ring, and check the shift solenoid valve for
D and D3; 2. Shift valve A defective seizure.
starts off in 3rd
Excessive shock, 1. A/T clutch pressure Check the D indicator, and check for loose connectors.
or flares on all control solenoid valves Inspect the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve
upshifts and A and B defective body gasket and ATF feed pipes for wear and damage.
downshifts 2. Input shaft (mainshaft) If the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve is stuck,
speed sensor defective inspect the CPC valves.
3. Output shaft Inspect the sensor O-rings.
(countershaft) speed
sensor defective
4. ATF temperature sensor
defective
5. CPC valve A defective
6. Foreign material in
separator plate orifice
Excessive shock, 1. Foreign material in Check the 1st and 2nd clutch pressures.
or flares on 1-2 separator plate orifice Inspect the clutch piston and O-rings. Check the spring
upshift or 2-1 2. 2nd accumulator retainer for wear and damage. Inspect the clutch end-
downshift defective plate-to-top-disc clearance. If the clearance is out of
3. 2nd check ball stuck tolerance, inspect the clutch discs and plates for wear
4. 2nd clutch defective and damage. If the discs and plates are worn or
damaged, replace them as a set. If they are OK, adjust
the clutch end plate clearance.
14-258
03/07/29 09:37:03 61S0X050_140_0262
Excessive shock, 1. Shift solenoid valve C defective Check the D indicator, and check for loose connectors.
or flares on 2-3 2. A/T clutch pressure control Inspect the O-rings, and check the shift solenoid valve
upshift or 3-2 solenoid valves A and B defective for seizure.
downshift 3. 3rd clutch transmission fluid Check for clogged orifice in the clutch transmission
pressure switch defective fluid pressure switch connector. If the orifice is
4. CPC valve B defective clogged, remove it and clean the connector.
5. Foreign material in separator Check the 2nd and 3rd clutch pressures.
plate orifice Inspect the clutch piston and O-rings. Check the
6. Shift valve C defective spring retainer for wear and damage. Inspect the
7. 2nd accumulator defective clutch end-plate-to-top-disc clearance. If the
8. 3rd accumulator defective clearance is out of tolerance, inspect the clutch discs
9. 2nd check ball stuck and plates for wear and damage. If the discs and
10. 2nd clutch defective plates are worn or damaged, replace them as a set. If
11. 3rd clutch defective they are OK, adjust the clutch end plate clearance.
Excessive shock, 1. Shift solenoid valve C defective Check the D indicator, and check for loose connectors.
or flares on 3-4 2. A/T clutch pressure control Inspect the O-rings, and check the shift solenoid valve
upshift or 4-3 solenoid valves A and B defective for seizure.
downshift 3. 4th clutch transmission fluid Check for clogged orifice in the clutch transmission
pressure switch defective fluid pressure switch connector. If the orifice is
4. CPC valve B defective clogged, remove it and clean the connector.
5. Foreign material in separator Check the 3rd and 4th clutch pressures.
plate orifice Inspect the clutch piston and O-rings. Check the
6. Shift valve C defective spring retainer for wear and damage. Inspect the
7. 3rd accumulator defective clutch end-plate-to-top-disc clearance. If the
8. 4th accumulator defective clearance is out of tolerance, inspect the clutch discs
9. 3rd clutch defective and plates for wear and damage. If the discs and
10. 4th clutch defective plates are worn or damaged, replace them as a set. If
they are OK, adjust the clutch end plate clearance.
Excessive shock, 1. Shift solenoid valve C defective Check the D indicator, and check for loose connectors.
or flares on 4-5 2. A/T clutch pressure control Inspect the O-rings, and check the shift solenoid valve
upshift or 5-4 solenoid valves A and B defective for seizure.
downshift 3. A/T clutch pressure control Check the 4th and 5th clutch pressures.
solenoid valve C defective Inspect the clutch piston and O-rings. Check the
4. CPC valve B defective spring retainer for wear and damage. Inspect the
5. CPC valve C defective clutch end-plate-to-top-disc clearance. If the
6. Foreign material in separator clearance is out of tolerance, inspect the clutch discs
plate orifice and plates for wear and damage. If the discs and
7. Shift valve C defective plates are worn or damaged, replace them as a set. If
8. Shift valve E defective they are OK, adjust the clutch end plate clearance.
9. Kick-down valve or kick-down
short valve defective
10. 4th accumulator defective
11. 5th accumulator defective
12. 4th clutch defective
13. 5th clutch defective
(contd)
14-259
03/07/29 09:37:03 61S0X050_140_0263
Automatic Transmission
Noise from 1. ATF pump worn or binding Improper alignment of ATF pump and torque
transmission in all 2. Torque converter housing or converter housing may cause ATF pump seizure. The
shift lever transmission housing bearing symptoms are mostly an rpm-related ticking noise or
positions worn or damaged a high pitched squeak.
Inspect the contact of the countershaft and secondary
shaft with the bearings. Check the ATF guide plates
for damage and wear. Inspect the 1st clutch feed pipe
for damage and out of round. If the 1st clutch feed
pipe is damaged or out of round, replace it. Replace
the secondary shaft if the bushing for the 1st clutch
feed pipe is damaged or out of round.
Vehicle does not Torque converter one-way clutch Replace the torque converter.
accelerate above defective
31 mph (50 km/h)
Vibration in all Drive plate defective or transmission Check for a misinstalled/damaged drive plate.
shift lever misassembled Set idle rpm in gear to the specified idle speed. If still
positions no good, adjust the engine mounts.
Check the stall speed.
Shift lever does 1. Transmission range switch Check the D indicator, and check for loose connectors.
not operate defective or out of adjustment Inspect the transmission range switch. If the
smoothly 2. Shift cable broken or out of transmission range switch is faulty, replace it. If the
adjustment transmission range switch is out of adjustment,
3. Joint in shift cable and adjust it and the shift cable.
transmission or body worn Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever and the
transmission control shaft.
Transmission does 1. Shift cable broken or out of Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever and the
not shift into P adjustment transmission control shaft.
2. Joint in shift cable and Check the park pawl spring installation and the park
transmission or body worn lever spring installation. If installation is incorrect,
3. Park mechanism defective install the spring correctly. Make sure that the park
lever stop is not installed upside down. Check the
distance between the park pawl shaft and the park
lever roller pin. If the distance is out of tolerance,
adjust the distance with the park lever stop.
Torque converter 1. Torque converter clutch Check the D indicator, and check for loose connectors.
clutch does not solenoid valve defective Inspect the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve
disengage 2. A/T clutch pressure control body gasket for wear and damage. If the A/T clutch
solenoid valve C defective pressure control solenoid valve is stuck, inspect the
3. Torque converter clutch piston CPC valves.
defective
4. Lock-up shift valve defective
5. Lock-up control valve defective
6. Lock-up timing valve defective
14-260
03/07/29 09:37:04 61S0X050_140_0264
Torque converter clutch 1. Torque converter clutch Check the D indicator, and check for loose
does not operate solenoid valve defective connectors. Inspect the A/T clutch pressure
smoothly 2. A/T clutch pressure control control solenoid valve body gasket for wear
solenoid valve C defective and damage. If the A/T clutch pressure control
3. Torque converter clutch solenoid valve is stuck, inspect the CPC valves.
piston defective Center all engine mounts.
4. Torque converter check valve
defective
5. Lock-up shift valve defective
6. Lock-up control valve
defective
7. Lock-up timing valve
defective
Torque converter clutch 1. Torque converter clutch Check the D indicator, and check for loose
does not engage solenoid valve defective connectors. Inspect the A/T clutch pressure
2. A/T clutch pressure control control solenoid valve body gasket for wear and
solenoid valve C defective damage. If the A/T clutch pressure control
3. Input shaft (mainshaft) speed solenoid valve is stuck, inspect the CPC valves.
sensor defective
4. Output shaft (countershaft)
speed sensor defective
5. Torque converter clutch
piston defective
6. Torque converter check valve
defective
7. Lock-up shift valve defective
8. Lock-up control valve
defective
A/T gear position 1. Transmission range switch Check the D indicator, and check for loose
indicator does not defective or out of adjustment connectors. Inspect the transmission range
indicate shift lever 2. Shift cable broken or out of switch. If the transmission range switch is
positions adjustment faulty, replace it. If the transmission range
3. Joint in shift cable and switch is out of adjustment, adjust it and the
transmission or body worn shift cable.
Check for a loose shift cable at the shift lever
and the transmission control shaft.
Speedometer and Output shaft (countershaft) speed Check the D indicator, and check for loose
odometer do not work sensor defective connectors.
The engine does not rev VTEC rocker arms defective Check the engine rocker arms as described.
to high rpm, and the
transmission upshifts at
low rpm. (Engine at
normal operating
temperature)
14-261
03/07/29 09:37:04 61S0X050_140_0265
Automatic Transmission
System Description
General Operation
The automatic transmission is a combination of a 3-element torque converter and triple-shaft electronically controlled
unit which provides 5 speeds forward and 1 reverse. The entire unit is positioned in line with the engine.
Electronic Control
The electronic control system consists of the powertrain control module (PCM), sensors, and seven solenoid valves.
Shifting and lock-up are electronically controlled for comfortable driving under all conditions. The PCM is located
below the dashboard, under the front lower panel behind the center console.
Hydraulic Control
The valve bodies include the main valve body, the regulator valve body, the servo body, and the accumulator body.
They are bolted to the torque converter housing. The main valve body contains the manual valve, the modulator valve,
the shift valve C, the shift valve D, the kick-down valve, the servo control valve, the torque converter check valve, the
reverse CPC valve, the lock-up shift valve, the relief valve, the cooler check valve, and the ATF pump gears. The
regulator valve body contains the regulator valve, the lock-up timing valve, and the lock-up control valve. The servo
body contains the servo valve, the shift valve A, the shift valve B, the CPC valves A and B. The top accumulator body
contains shift valve E, CPC valve C, 1st-hold accumulator piston, 4th accumulator piston, and 5th accumulator piston.
The accumulator body contains the 1st and 2nd accumulators and lubrication check valve. Fluid from the regulator
passes through the manual valve to the various control valves. The 1st/1st-hold, 3rd, 4th, and 5th clutches receive fluid
from their respective feed pipes, and the 2nd clutch receives fluid from the internal hydraulic circuit.
Lock-up Mechanism
The lock-up mechanism operates in the D position (3rd, 4th, and 5th), and D3 position (3rd). The pressurized fluid is
drained from the back of the torque converter through a fluid passage, causing the torque converter clutch piston to be
held against the torque converter cover. As this takes place, the mainshaft rotates at the same speed as the engine
crankshaft. Together with hydraulic control, the PCM optimizes the timing of the lock-up mechanism. When the torque
converter clutch solenoid valve activates, modulator pressure changes to switch lock-up on and off. The lock-up
control valve and the lock-up timing valve control the amount of lock-up according to A/T clutch pressure control
solenoid valve C. The torque converter clutch solenoid valve is mounted on the torque converter housing, and A/T
clutch pressure control solenoid valve C is mounted on the transmission housing. They are all controlled by the PCM.
14-262
03/07/29 09:37:04 61S0X050_140_0266
Gear Selection
The shift lever has seven positions; P: PARK, R: REVERSE, N: NEUTRAL, D: 1st through 5th gear ranges, D3: 1st
through 3rd gear ranges, 2: 2nd gear, 1: 1st gear.
Position Description
P: PARK Front wheels locked; park pawl engaged with park gear on countershaft. All clutches are
released.
R: REVERSE Reverse; reverse selector engaged with countershaft reverse gear and 5th clutch locked.
D: DRIVE General driving; starts off in 1st, shifts automatically to 2nd, 3rd, 4th, then 5th, depending on
(1st through 5th) vehicle speed and throttle position. Downshift through 4th, 3rd, 2nd, and 1st on deceleration to
stop. The lock-up mechanism operates in 3rd, 4th, and 5th gear.
D3: DRIVE Used for rapid acceleration at highway speeds and general driving; up-hill and down-hill
(1st through 3rd) driving; starts off in 1st, shifts automatically to 2nd, then 3rd, depending on vehicle speed and
throttle position.
Downshifts through 2nd to 1st on deceleration to stop. The lock-up mechanism operates in 3rd
gear only.
2: SECOND Used for engine braking or better traction starting off on loose or slippery surfaces; stays in
2nd gear, does not shift up or down.
1: FIRST Used for engine braking; stays in 1st gear, does not shift up.
Starting is possible only in the P and N positions because of a slide-type neutral-safety switch.
14-263
03/07/29 09:37:05 61S0X050_140_0267
Automatic Transmission
1st Clutch
The 1st clutch engages/disengages 1st gear, and is located at the middle of the secondary shaft. The 1st clutch is
joined back-to-back to the 2nd clutch. The 1st clutch is supplied hydraulic pressure by its ATF feed pipe within the
secondary shaft.
1st-hold Clutch
The 1st-hold clutch engages/disengages 1st-hold, and is located in the 1st clutch drum. The 1st-hold clutch is supplied
hydraulic pressure through the orifice inside the secondary shaft by a circuit connected to the internal hydraulic circuit.
2nd Clutch
The 2nd clutch engages/disengages 2nd gear, and is located at the middle of the secondary shaft. The 2nd clutch is
joined back-to-back to the 1st clutch. The 2nd clutch is supplied hydraulic pressure through the secondary shaft by a
circuit connected to the internal hydraulic circuit.
3rd Clutch
The 3rd clutch engages/disengages 3rd gear, and is located at the end of the countershaft, just behind the end cover.
The 3rd clutch is supplied hydraulic pressure by its ATF feed pipe in the countershaft.
4th Clutch
The 4th clutch engages/disengages 4th gear, and is located at the middle of the mainshaft. The 4th clutch is joined
back-to-back to the 5th clutch. The 4th clutch is supplied hydraulic pressure by its ATF feed pipe within the mainshaft.
5th Clutch
The 5th clutch engages/disengages 5th gear, as well as reverse gear, and is located at the middle of the mainshaft. The
5th clutch is joined back-to-back to the 4th clutch. The 5th clutch is supplied hydraulic pressure by its ATF feed pipe
within the mainshaft.
One-way Clutch
The one-way clutch is positioned between the 1st clutch hub and the secondary shaft 1st gear. The secondary shaft 1st
gear is splined to the 1st-hold clutch hub, with the 1st-hold clutch hub splined to the secondary shaft. The secondary
shaft 1st gear provides the outer race surface, and the 1st clutch hub provides the inner race surface. The one-way
clutch locks when power is transmitted from the secondary shaft 1st gear to the countershaft 1st gear. The 1st clutch
and gears remain engaged in the 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th, and 5th gear ranges in the D, D3, or 2 position.
However, the one-way clutch disengages when the 2nd, 3rd, 4th, or 5th clutches and gears are applied in the D, D3, or
2 position. This is because the increased rotational speed of the gears on the secondary shaft causes the one-way
clutch to free-wheel with the 1st clutch still engaged.
14-264
03/07/29 09:37:06 61S0X050_140_0268
MAINSHAFT
5TH GEAR ATF PUMP DRIVEN GEAR
5TH CLUTCH
RING GEAR
MAINSHAFT 4TH CLUTCH
REVERSE GEAR TORQUE CONVERTER
MAINSHAFT
4TH GEAR
MAINSHAFT
LOCK-UP CLUTCH
MAINSHAFT PISTON
3RD GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT
REVERSE GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT
2ND GEAR
3RD CLUTCH
REVERSE
SELECTOR HUB
COUNTERSHAFT
REVERSE SELECTOR
DRIVE PLATE
COUNTERSHAFT
3RD GEAR
PARK GEAR
FINAL DRIVE GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT
5TH GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT 4TH GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT
1ST GEAR
SECONDARY SHAFT
IDLER GEAR
SECONDARY SHAFT
2ND GEAR
1ST-HOLD
CLUTCH
2ND CLUTCH
1ST CLUTCH
SECONDARY SHAFT
1ST GEAR
DIFFERENTIAL
ASSEMBLY
FINAL DRIVEN GEAR
14-265
03/07/29 09:37:06 61S0X050_140_0269
Automatic Transmission
REVERSE
SELECTOR
COUNTERSHAFT
3RD GEAR
3RD CLUTCH
COUNTERSHAFT
REVERSE SELECTOR
HUB
COUNTERSHAFT 4TH GEAR
SECONDARY SHAFT
IDLER GEAR 2ND CLUTCH
SECONDARY SHAFT
2ND GEAR 1ST-HOLD
CLUTCH
COUNTERSHAFT
1ST CLUTCH 5TH GEAR
14-266
03/07/29 09:37:07 61S0X050_140_0270
P Position
Hydraulic pressure is not applied to the clutches. Power is not transmitted to the countershaft. The countershaft is
locked by the park pawl interlocking the park gear.
N Position
Engine power transmitted from the torque converter drives the mainshaft 3rd gear, the countershaft 3rd gear, and the
secondary shaft idler gear, but hydraulic pressure is not applied to the clutches. Power is not transmitted to the
countershaft. The countershaft 5th gear is engaged to the reverse selector hub by the shift fork reverse selector when
the shift lever is shifted to the N position from any of the forward range positions (D, D3, 2, and 1 positions). The
countershaft reverse gear is engaged when shifted from the R position.
MAINSHAFT
3RD GEAR
MAINSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
3RD GEAR
3RD CLUTCH
COUNTERSHAFT
PARK GEAR
SECONDARY SHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT
IDLER GEAR
(contd)
14-267
03/07/29 09:37:07 61S0X050_140_0271
Automatic Transmission
Hydraulic pressure is applied to the 1st clutch, then the 1st clutch engages the secondary shaft 1st gear with the
secondary shaft by the one-way clutch.
Hydraulic pressure is also applied to the 1st-hold clutch, and the 1st-hold clutch engages the secondary shaft 1st
gear with the secondary shaft.
The mainshaft 3rd gear drives the secondary shaft via the countershaft 3rd gear and the secondary shaft idler gear.
The secondary shaft 1st gear drives the countershaft 1st gear and the countershaft.
Power is transmitted to the final drive gear, which in turn drives the final driven gear.
COUNTERSHAFT
1ST GEAR TORQUE CONVERTER
MAINSHAFT
3RD GEAR
MAINSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
3RD GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT
14-268
03/07/29 09:37:08 61S0X050_140_0272
1 Position
The power flow when decelerating is as follows:
Hydraulic pressure is applied to the 1st clutch and the 1st-hold clutch. Rolling resistance from the road surface goes
through the front wheels to the final drive gear, then to the secondary shaft idler gear.
The one-way clutch disengages because the application of torque is reversed.
The counterforce conveyed to the secondary shaft idler gear turns the mainshaft 3rd gear via the countershaft 3rd
gear. As a result, engine braking can be obtained with 1st gear.
COUNTERSHAFT
1ST GEAR TORQUE CONVERTER
MAINSHAFT
3RD GEAR
MAINSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
3RD GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT
IDLER GEAR ONE-WAY
CLUTCH
1ST CLUTCH
SECONDARY SHAFT
1ST GEAR FINAL DRIVEN GEAR
(contd)
14-269
03/07/29 09:37:08 61S0X050_140_0273
Automatic Transmission
COUNTERSHAFT
1ST GEAR TORQUE CONVERTER
MAINSHAFT
3RD GEAR
MAINSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
3RD GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT
ONE-WAY
CLUTCH
SECONDARY SHAFT
IDLER GEAR
1ST CLUTCH
SECONDARY SHAFT
1ST GEAR FINAL DRIVEN GEAR
14-270
03/07/29 09:37:09 61S0X050_140_0274
COUNTERSHAFT
2ND GEAR TORQUE CONVERTER
MAINSHAFT
3RD GEAR
MAINSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
3RD GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT
ONE-WAY
SECONDARY SHAFT CLUTCH
IDLER GEAR
2ND CLUTCH
(contd)
14-271
03/07/29 09:37:09 61S0X050_140_0275
Automatic Transmission
TORQUE CONVERTER
MAINSHAFT
3RD GEAR
MAINSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
3RD GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT
IDLER GEAR
ONE-WAY
CLUTCH
FINAL DRIVEN GEAR
14-272
03/07/29 09:37:10 61S0X050_140_0276
MAINSHAFT
4TH GEAR TORQUE CONVERTER
4TH CLUTCH
MAINSHAFT
3RD GEAR
MAINSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
4TH GEAR
ONE-WAY
CLUTCH
FINAL DRIVEN GEAR
(contd)
14-273
03/07/29 09:37:10 61S0X050_140_0277
Automatic Transmission
5TH CLUTCH
MAINSHAFT TORQUE CONVERTER
5TH GEAR
MAINSHAFT
3RD GEAR
MAINSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT
ONE-WAY
CLUTCH
FINAL DRIVEN GEAR
14-274
03/07/29 09:37:11 61S0X050_140_0278
R Position
Hydraulic pressure is applied to the servo valve to engage the reverse selector with the countershaft (reverse gear
while the shift lever is in the R position).
Hydraulic pressure is also applied to the 5th clutch, then the 5th clutch engages the mainshaft reverse gear with the
mainshaft.
The mainshaft reverse gear drives the countershaft reverse gear via the reverse idler gear.
The rotation direction of the countershaft reverse gear is changed via the reverse idler gear.
The countershaft reverse gear drives the countershaft via the reverse selector which drives the reverse selector hub.
Power is transmitted to the final drive gear, which in turn drives the final driven gear.
REVERSE
SELECTOR HUB
SHIFT FORK
REVERSE SELECTOR
TORQUE CONVERTER
REVERSE IDLER GEAR
MAINSHAFT
REVERSE GEAR
5TH CLUTCH
MAINSHAFT
3RD GEAR
MAINSHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT
COUNTERSHAFT
REVERSE GEAR REVERSE
SELECTOR
HUB
REVERSE
SELECTOR
FINAL DRIVEN GEAR
14-275
03/07/29 09:37:12 61S0X050_140_0279
Automatic Transmission
The PCM recieves input signals from the sensors, switches, and other control units, perform processing data, and
outputs signals for the engine control system and A/T control system. The A/T control system includes shift control,
grade logic control, clutch pressure control, and lock-up control is stored in the PCM.
The PCM switches the shift solenoid valves and the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valves to control shifting
transmission gears and lock-up torque converter clutch.
PCM
Throttle Position
Sensor Signal
Gauge Assembly
PGM-FI Control A/T Gear Position Indicator
Engine Coolant System D Indicator
Temperature Sensor Signal
Barometric Pressure
Sensor Signal
Manifold Absolute
Pressure Sensor Signal
A/T Control System
ATF Temperature
Sensor Signal Shift Solenoid Valve A
14-276
03/07/29 09:37:12 61S0X050_140_0280
MULTIPLEX CONTROL
UNIT, DRIVERS POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
OUTPUT SHAFT
(COUNTERSHAFT)
SPEED SENSOR
TORQUE CONVERTER A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CLUTCH SOLENOID VALVE CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE B
TRANSMISSION
RANGE SWITCH
INPUT SHAFT
(MAINSHAFT)
SPEED SENSOR
3RD CLUTCH
TRANSMISSION FLUID
PRESSURE SWITCH
(contd)
14-277
03/07/29 09:37:13 61S0X050_140_0281
Automatic Transmission
Also, as grade logic control system has been adopted to control shifting in the D and D3 positions. The PCM compares
actual driving conditions with memorized driving conditions, based on the input from the throttle position sensor, the
engine coolant temperature sensor, the barometric pressure sensor, the brake pedal position switch signal, and the
shift lever position signal, to control shifting while the vehicle is ascending or descending a slope.
PCM
Fail-safe Control
Transmission Range
Switch Signal
Actual Driving
Throttle Position Shift Position
Sensor Signal
ATF
Output Shaft (Countershaft) Temperature Comparison
Speed Sensor Signal with Shift Solenoid Valve A
Master Target of Signals
Shifting Position Shift Solenoid Valve B
Input Shaft (Mainshaft) Shift Solenoid Valve C
Speed Sensor Signal
Correction of Data
Selection of Shifting
ATF Temperature mode
Sensor Signal Grade Logic Control
14-278
03/07/29 09:37:13 61S0X050_140_0282
The PCM turns on the shift solenoid valves A, B, and C to control shifting transmission gear.
The combination of driving signals to shift solenoid valves A, B, and C are shown in the table.
(contd)
14-279
03/07/29 09:37:14 61S0X050_140_0283
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: Shift schedules stored in the PCM between 2nd and 3rd gears, between 3rd and 4th gears, and between 4th and
5th gear, enable to automatically select the most suitable gear according to the magnitude of a gradient.
100 %
1ST 2ND 2ND 3RD 3RD 4TH 4TH 5TH
Throttle opening
100 %
1ST 2ND 2ND 3RD 3RD 4TH 4TH 5TH
Throttle opening
14-280
03/07/29 09:37:14 61S0X050_140_0284
PCM
Throttle Position
Sensor Signal
Master Target of Current A/T Clutch Pressure
Controlling Current feedback Control Solenoid
Valves A, B, and C
Manifold Absolute
Pressure Sensor Signal
Correction of Data
Engine RPM Signal
Correction of engine
Barometric Pressure torque signal data
Sensor Signal
3rd Clutch Transmission Correction of
Fluid Pressure Switch hydraulic pressure
Signal application timing
4th Clutch Transmission
Fluid Pressure Switch Correction of engine
Signal coolant temperature
sensor signal data
Engine Coolant
Temperature
Sensor Signal Correction of ATF
temperature sensor
data
ATF Temperature
Sensor Signal
(contd)
14-281
03/07/29 09:37:15 61S0X050_140_0285
Automatic Transmission
PCM
Shifting position
control
Barometric Pressure
Sensor Signal
Gradient control
by magnitude
Transmission Range
Switch Signal Fail-safe control
Actual
Throttle Position Driving
Sensor Signal Shift
Position
Torque Converter
Output Shaft (Countershaft) Lock-up Control Clutch Solenoid Valve
Speed Sensor Signal
14-282
03/07/29 09:37:16 61S0X050_140_0286
PCM
D2
SH B
E17
ABS/TCS UNIT ATSFTP
SHIFT SOLENOID
VALVE B
SHIFT SOLENOID
VALVE C
SPEEDOMETER A9 C28
CIRCUIT VSS OUT VCC2 INPUT SHAFT
D11 (MAINSHAFT)
NM
SPEED
D12 SENSOR
A/T GEAR POSITION INDICATOR NMSG
P R N D D3 2 1 C27 THROTTLE
TPS POSITION
C18 SENSOR
SG2
ENGINE COOLANT
P A14 C26 TEMPERATURE
TRANSMISSION D5 IND ECT SENSOR
RANGE R D6
SWITCH ATP R
N
ATF
D5 D9 TEMPERATURE
ATP D5 C24
D3 TATF SENSOR
D8
ATP D3
2 D14 C19
ATP 2 VCC1 OUTPUT SHAFT
1 D15 D10 (COUNTERSHAFT)
ATP 1 NC
SPEED
B14 D16 SENSOR
ATP NP NCSG
3RD CLUTCH
TRANSMISSION FLUID
PRESSURE SWITCH
B20 D13
LG1 OP3SW
B22
LG2 4TH CLUTCH
TRANSMISSION FLUID
PRESSURE SWITCH
B19
OP4SW
1 2 3 4 5 6 8 9 10 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 2 3 5
14 15 17 18 19 20 21 24 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 17 18 12 13 14 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 (5) (6) (7)
26 27 28 29 30 31 32 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 13 14 15 16 12 (16) (17)
(contd)
14-283
03/07/29 09:37:17 61S0X050_140_0287
Automatic Transmission
14-284
03/07/29 09:37:17 61S0X050_140_0288
(contd)
14-285
03/07/29 09:37:18 61S0X050_140_0289
Automatic Transmission
14-286
03/07/29 09:37:18 61S0X050_140_0290
14-287
03/07/29 09:37:19 61S0X050_140_0291
Automatic Transmission
14-288
03/07/29 09:37:19 61S0X050_140_0292
SHIFT VALVE C
SHIFT VALVE D
KICK-DOWN VALVE
MODULATOR VALVE
RELIEF VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE
REGULATOR VALVE BODY
(contd)
14-289
03/07/29 09:37:20 61S0X050_140_0293
Automatic Transmission
VALVE
ORIFICE
A B B
REGULATOR VALVE
Increases in hydraulic pressure according to torque are performed by the regulator valve using stator torque reaction.
The stator shaft is splined to the stator in the torque converter, and its arm end contacts the regulator spring cap.
When the vehicle is accelerating or climbing (torque converter range), stator torque reaction acts on the stator shaft,
and the stator arm pushes the regulator spring cap in the direction of the arrow in proportion to the reaction. The
stator reaction spring compresses, and the regulator valve moves to increase the line pressure which is regulated by
the regulator valve. The line pressure reaches its maximum when the stator torque reaction reaches its maximum.
REGULATOR VALVE BODY
TORQUE CONVERTER
REGULATOR VALVE
14-290
03/07/29 09:37:21 61S0X050_140_0294
Servo Body
The servo body is on the main valve body. It contains the servo valve, the shift valve A, the shift valve B, CPC valves A
and B.
CPC VALVE B
CPC VALVE A
SERVO BODY
SHIFT VALVE A
4TH ACCUMULATOR
TOP ACCUMULATOR BODY
Accumulator Body
The accumulator body is on the torque converter housing, next to the main valve body. It contains the 1st and the 2nd
accumulators and the lubrication check valve.
3rd Accumulator
The 3rd accumulator is in the end cover.
3RD ACCUMULATOR
LUBRICATION CHECK VALVE
1ST ACCUMULATOR
2ND ACCUMULATOR
END COVER
ACCUMULATOR BODY
14-291
03/07/29 09:37:22 61S0X050_140_0295
Automatic Transmission
NOTE:
CPC: Clutch Pressure Control pressure
SH: Shift Solenoid pressure
LS A: A/T Clutch Pressure Control Solenoid A pressure
LS B: A/T Clutch Pressure Control Solenoid B pressure
LS C: A/T Clutch Pressure Control Solenoid C pressure
LC: Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid pressure
14-292
03/07/29 09:37:24 61S0X050_140_0296
N Position
The PCM controls the shift solenoid valves. The conditions of the shift solenoid valve and positions of the shift valve
are as follows:
The shift solenoid valve A is turned OFF, and the shift valve A moves to the left side.
The shift solenoid valve B is turned ON, and the shift valve B stays on the right side.
The shift solenoid valve C is turned OFF, and the shift valve C stays on the left side.
Line pressure (1) passes through the manual valve and becomes line pressure (25). Line pressure (25) stops at shift
valve D. Line pressure (1) also flows to the modulator valve and becomes modulator pressure (6). Modulator pressure
(6) flows to the shift solenoid valves and the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valves. Under this condition,
hydraulic pressure is not applied to the clutches.
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB
4A AX SB
20 4A 30 ON SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X SBX9 KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B OFF
CLUTCH SHIFT SOLENOID
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
OFF SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X VALVE A
X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
1
X 1 3 3 MODULATOR VALVE
MANUAL VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE 3
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99 LUBRICATION
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
(contd)
14-293
03/07/29 09:37:26 61S0X050_140_0297
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH
1ST-HOLD/4TH 4TH CLUTCH
ACCUMULATOR 1ST/1ST-HOLD CLUTCH 3RD CLUTCH
1ST ACCUMULATOR TRANSMISSION FLUID 4TH CLUTCH
PRESSURE TRANSMISSION FLUID 5TH CLUTCH
SWITCH 3RD PRESSURE
10 ACCUMULATOR SWITCH
5TH
ACCUMULATOR
15
4C
15 10 20 2ND 30
CLUTCH 40 50
30
40 15 SHIFT 55
40
VALVE D
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB
4A AX SB
20 4A 30 ON SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SBX9
SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B OFF
CLUTCH SHIFT SOLENOID
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
OFF SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE VALVE A SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
X 1 3 3 1
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE 3
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE LUBRICATION
CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
14-294
03/07/29 09:37:28 61S0X050_140_0298
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB
4A AX SB
20 4A 30 ON SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X SBX9 KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B ON
CLUTCH SHIFT SOLENOID
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
ON SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE VALVE A SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
1
X 1 3 3 MODULATOR VALVE
MANUAL VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE 3
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99 LUBRICATION
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
(contd)
14-295
03/07/29 09:37:30 61S0X050_140_0299
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH
1ST-HOLD/4TH 4TH CLUTCH
ACCUMULATOR 1ST/1ST-HOLD CLUTCH 3RD CLUTCH
1ST ACCUMULATOR TRANSMISSION FLUID 4TH CLUTCH
PRESSURE TRANSMISSION FLUID 5TH CLUTCH
SWITCH 3RD PRESSURE
10 ACCUMULATOR SWITCH
5TH
ACCUMULATOR
15
4C
15 10 20 2ND 30
CLUTCH 40 50
30
40 15 SHIFT 55
40
VALVE D
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB 4A AX SB
20 4A 30 ON SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X SBX9 KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B ON SHIFT SOLENOID
CLUTCH
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
ON SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE VALVE A SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
X 1 3 3 1
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE 3
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99 LUBRICATION
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
14-296
03/07/29 09:37:32 61S0X050_140_0300
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB
4A AX SB
20 4A 30 ON SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X SBX9 KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B OFF
CLUTCH SHIFT SOLENOID
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
ON SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE VALVE A SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
1
X 1 3 3 MODULATOR VALVE
MANUAL VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE 3
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99 LUBRICATION
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
(contd)
14-297
03/07/29 09:38:26 61S0X050_140_0301
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH
1ST-HOLD/4TH 4TH CLUTCH
ACCUMULATOR 1ST/1ST-HOLD CLUTCH 3RD CLUTCH
1ST ACCUMULATOR TRANSMISSION FLUID 4TH CLUTCH
PRESSURE TRANSMISSION FLUID 5TH CLUTCH
SWITCH 3RD PRESSURE
10 ACCUMULATOR SWITCH
5TH
ACCUMULATOR
15
4C
15 10 20 2ND 30
CLUTCH 40 50
30
40 15 SHIFT 55
40
VALVE D
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB
4A AX SB
20 4A 30 ON SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SBX9
SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B OFF
CLUTCH SHIFT SOLENOID
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
OFF SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE VALVE A SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
X 1 3 3 1
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE 3
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99 LUBRICATION
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
14-298
03/07/29 09:38:28 61S0X050_140_0302
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH
1ST-HOLD/4TH 4TH CLUTCH
ACCUMULATOR 1ST/1ST-HOLD CLUTCH 3RD CLUTCH
1ST ACCUMULATOR TRANSMISSION FLUID 4TH CLUTCH
PRESSURE TRANSMISSION FLUID 5TH CLUTCH
SWITCH 3RD PRESSURE
10 ACCUMULATOR SWITCH
5TH
ACCUMULATOR
15
4C
15 10 20 2ND 30
CLUTCH 40 50
30
40 15 SHIFT 55
40
VALVE D
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB
4A AX SB
20 4A 30 ON SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SBX9
SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B ON SHIFT SOLENOID
CLUTCH
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
OFF SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE VALVE A SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
X 1 3 3 1
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE 3
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99 LUBRICATION
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
(contd)
14-299
03/07/29 09:38:30 61S0X050_140_0303
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB
4A AX SB
20 4A 30 OFF SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X SBX9 KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B ON
CLUTCH SHIFT SOLENOID
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
OFF SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE VALVE A SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
1
X 1 3 3 MODULATOR VALVE
MANUAL VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE 3
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99 LUBRICATION
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
14-300
03/07/29 09:38:33 61S0X050_140_0304
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
1ST-HOLD/4TH
2ND ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH 4TH CLUTCH
ACCUMULATOR 1ST/1ST-HOLD CLUTCH 3RD CLUTCH
1ST ACCUMULATOR TRANSMISSION FLUID 4TH CLUTCH
PRESSURE TRANSMISSION FLUID 5TH CLUTCH
SWITCH 3RD PRESSURE
10 ACCUMULATOR SWITCH
5TH
ACCUMULATOR
15
4C
15 10 20 2ND 30
CLUTCH 40 50
30
40 15 SHIFT 55
40
VALVE D
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB
4A AX SB
20 4A 30 OFF SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X SBX9 KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B OFF
CLUTCH SHIFT SOLENOID
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
OFF SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X VALVE A
X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
1
X 1 3 3 MODULATOR VALVE
MANUAL VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE 3
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE LUBRICATION
CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
(contd)
14-301
03/07/29 09:38:35 61S0X050_140_0305
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB
4A AX SB
20 4A 30 OFF SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X SBX9 KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B OFF
CLUTCH SHIFT SOLENOID
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
ON SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE VALVE A SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
1
X 1 3 3 MODULATOR VALVE
MANUAL VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE 3
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE LUBRICATION
CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
14-302
03/07/29 09:38:37 61S0X050_140_0306
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
1ST-HOLD/4TH
2ND ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH 4TH CLUTCH
ACCUMULATOR 1ST/1ST-HOLD CLUTCH 3RD CLUTCH
1ST ACCUMULATOR TRANSMISSION FLUID 4TH CLUTCH
PRESSURE TRANSMISSION FLUID 5TH CLUTCH
SWITCH 3RD PRESSURE
10 ACCUMULATOR SWITCH
5TH
ACCUMULATOR
15
4C
15 10 20 2ND 30
CLUTCH 40 50
30
40 15 SHIFT 55
40
VALVE D
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB
4A AX SB
20 4A 30 OFF SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X SBX9 KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B ON SHIFT SOLENOID
CLUTCH
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
ON SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X VALVE A
X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
1
X 1 3 3 MODULATOR VALVE
MANUAL VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE 3
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE LUBRICATION
CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
(contd)
14-303
03/07/29 09:38:39 61S0X050_140_0307
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH
1ST-HOLD/4TH 4TH CLUTCH
ACCUMULATOR 1ST/1ST-HOLD CLUTCH 3RD CLUTCH
1ST ACCUMULATOR TRANSMISSION FLUID 4TH CLUTCH
PRESSURE TRANSMISSION FLUID 5TH CLUTCH
SWITCH 3RD PRESSURE
10 ACCUMULATOR SWITCH
5TH
ACCUMULATOR
15
4C
15 10 20 2ND 30
CLUTCH 40 50
30
40 15 SHIFT 55
40
VALVE D
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB
4A AX SB
20 4A 30 ON SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SBX9
SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B OFF
CLUTCH SHIFT SOLENOID
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
ON SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE VALVE A SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
X 1 3 3 1
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE 3
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99 LUBRICATION
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
14-304
03/07/29 09:38:42 61S0X050_140_0308
1 Position
The PCM controls the shift solenoid valves and the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valves. The conditions of the
shift solenoid valves and the positions of shift valves are as follows:
Shift solenoid valve A is turned ON, and shift valve A stays on the right side.
Shift solenoid valve B is turned ON, and shift valve B stays on the right side.
Shift solenoid valve C is turned ON, and shift valve C moves to the right side by modulator pressure (6).
The PCM also controls A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve B to apply LS B pressure (57) to CPC valve B. Line
pressure (4) from the manual valve becomes 1st clutch pressure (10) at shift valve C. 1st clutch pressure (10) is applied
to the 1st clutch, and the 1st clutch is engaged. Line pressure (4) also flows to CPC valve B, and becomes CPC B
pressure (4B). CPC B pressure (4B) becomes 1st-hold clutch pressure (15) at shift valve D, via shift valves C, B, and A.
1st-hold clutch pressure (15) is applied to the 1st-hold clutch, and the 1st-hold clutch is engaged.
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH
1ST-HOLD/4TH 4TH CLUTCH
ACCUMULATOR 1ST/1ST-HOLD CLUTCH 3RD CLUTCH
1ST ACCUMULATOR TRANSMISSION FLUID 4TH CLUTCH
PRESSURE TRANSMISSION FLUID 5TH CLUTCH
SWITCH 3RD PRESSURE
10 ACCUMULATOR SWITCH
5TH
ACCUMULATOR
15
4C
15 10 20 2ND 30
CLUTCH 40 50
30
40 15 SHIFT 55
40
VALVE D
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB 4A AX SB
20 4A 30 ON SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X SBX9 KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B ON
CLUTCH SHIFT SOLENOID
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
ON SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE VALVE A SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
X 1 3 3 1
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE
X 3
92 1 95 95 95
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99 LUBRICATION
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
(contd)
14-305
03/07/29 09:38:44 61S0X050_140_0309
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH
1ST-HOLD/4TH 4TH CLUTCH
ACCUMULATOR 1ST/1ST-HOLD CLUTCH 3RD CLUTCH
1ST ACCUMULATOR TRANSMISSION FLUID 4TH CLUTCH
PRESSURE TRANSMISSION FLUID 5TH CLUTCH
SWITCH 3RD PRESSURE
10 ACCUMULATOR SWITCH
5TH
ACCUMULATOR
15
4C
15 10 20 2ND 30
CLUTCH 40 50
30
40 15 SHIFT 55
40
VALVE D
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB
4A AX SB
20 4A 30 ON SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SBX9
SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B ON
CLUTCH SHIFT SOLENOID
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
OFF SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE VALVE A SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
X 1 3 3 1
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE 3
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE LUBRICATION
CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
14-306
03/07/29 09:38:46 61S0X050_140_0310
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH
1ST-HOLD/4TH 4TH CLUTCH
ACCUMULATOR 1ST/1ST-HOLD CLUTCH 3RD CLUTCH
1ST ACCUMULATOR TRANSMISSION FLUID 4TH CLUTCH
PRESSURE TRANSMISSION FLUID 5TH CLUTCH
SWITCH 3RD PRESSURE
10 ACCUMULATOR SWITCH
5TH
ACCUMULATOR
15
4C
15 10 20 2ND 30
CLUTCH 40 50
30
40 15 SHIFT 55
40
VALVE D
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB 4A AX SB
20 4A 30 ON SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X SBX9 KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B OFF
CLUTCH SHIFT SOLENOID
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
OFF SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE VALVE A SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
X 1 3 3 1
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE
X 3
92 1 95 95 95
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99 LUBRICATION
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
(contd)
14-307
03/07/29 09:38:48 61S0X050_140_0311
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
2ND ACCUMULATOR 3RD CLUTCH
1ST-HOLD/4TH 4TH CLUTCH
ACCUMULATOR 1ST/1ST-HOLD CLUTCH 3RD CLUTCH
1ST ACCUMULATOR TRANSMISSION FLUID 4TH CLUTCH
PRESSURE TRANSMISSION FLUID 5TH CLUTCH
SWITCH 3RD PRESSURE
10 ACCUMULATOR SWITCH
5TH
ACCUMULATOR
15
4C
15 10 20 2ND 30
CLUTCH 40 50
30
40 15 SHIFT 55
40
VALVE D
X 58 H6X 5N 5M X 5J 4A 25
TORQUE KICK-DOWN VALVE 50
CONVERTER
5H 5M SHIFT VALVE B SB 4A AX SB
20 4A 30 ON SHIFT SOLENOID
91 VALVE B
90
94 9 5F 5E H4X 5D 5G H5X 5H 5C 5K
5D H9X SBX9 KICK-DOWN CPC VALVE A 4 56
TORQUE SHORT VALVE X
CONVERTER CPC VALVE B OFF
CLUTCH SHIFT SOLENOID
SOLENOID VALVE C
VALVE 4 SC
6
X
6
OFF SHIFT SOLENOID
H10X
VALVE A
LOCK-UP SHIFT 4B X 4B 57
LA TIMING VALVE VALVE A SHIFT VALVE C 5A
X X
5F 5E 50X 5G 5K 30 5J 5H 5C 5D 4A SC
90 91 X HX HX AX
95 5
HX HX AX
90 96 58 96 57
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
6 CONTROL SOLENOID
4 25 2 51 50 VALVE B
93
X 90 92
X 1 3 3 1
MANUAL VALVE MODULATOR VALVE
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2 AX AX
93 10 3 57 SC 3 9 4 X 10
MAINSHAFT
SERVO
TORQUE X 95 HX COUNTERSHAFT CONTROL
X SECONDARY VALVE
CONVERTER SHAFT 3 X 4 4
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE
X 3
92 1 95 95 95
93 X REVERSE 4
CPC 3 X
COOLER CHECK VALVE 4
VALVE 1
99 LUBRICATION
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE CHECK VALVE
3
SERVO VALVE
ATF PUMP
14-308
03/07/29 09:38:49 61S0X050_140_0312
Lock-up System
The lock-up mechanism operates in the D position (3rd, 4th, and 5th), and D3 position (3rd). The pressurized fluid is
drained from the back of the torque converter through a fluid passage, causing the torque converter clutch piston to be
held against the torque converter cover. As this takes place, the mainshaft rotates at the same speed as the engine
crankshaft. Together with hydraulic control, the PCM optimizes the timing of the lock-up mechanism. When the torque
converter clutch solenoid valve activates, modulator pressure changes to switch lock-up ON and OFF. The lock-up
control valve and the lock-up timing valve control the amount of lock-up according to A/T clutch pressure control
solenoid valve C. The torque converter clutch solenoid valve is mounted on the torque converter housing, and A/T
clutch pressure control solenoid valve C is mounted on the transmission housing. They are controlled by the PCM.
TORQUE
CONVERTER
91
90
94
6
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE LA
X
90 91 X
LOCK-UP X X 90 91 58
TIMING VALVE
LOCK-UP
LA 94 91 91 SHIFT VALVE
96 92 93 X 6
95
90 96 58 96
93
92
X90
X
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2
AX
93
MAINSHAFT
AX COUNTERSHAFT
TORQUE X X 95 HX
SECONDARY
CONVERTER SHAFT
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X
COOLER CHECK
VALVE 1
99 LUBRICATION
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE CHECK VALVE
ATF PUMP
(contd)
14-309
03/07/29 09:38:50 61S0X050_140_0313
Automatic Transmission
MAINSHAFT
14-310
03/07/29 09:38:50 61S0X050_140_0314
No Lock-up
The torque converter clutch solenoid valve is turned OFF by the PCM. The lock-up shift valve receives LC pressure (LA)
on the left side, and modulator pressure (6) on the right side. The lock-up shift valve is in the right side to uncover the
port leading torque converter pressure (92) to the left side of the torque converter. Torque converter pressure (92)
becomes torque converter pressure (94), and enters into the left side of the torque converter to disengage the torque
converter clutch. The torque converter clutch is OFF.
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
TORQUE
CONVERTER
91
90
94
6
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE LA
X
90 91 X
LOCK-UP X X 90 91 58
TIMING VALVE
LOCK-UP
LA 94 91 91 SHIFT VALVE
96 92 93 X 6 MODULATOR PRESSURE
95
90 96 58 96
93
92
X90
X
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2
AX
93
MAINSHAFT
AX COUNTERSHAFT
TORQUE X X 95 HX
SECONDARY
CONVERTER SHAFT
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X
COOLER CHECK
VALVE 1
99 LUBRICATION
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE CHECK VALVE
ATF PUMP
(contd)
14-311
03/07/29 09:38:51 61S0X050_140_0315
Automatic Transmission
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
TORQUE
CONVERTER
91
90
94
6
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE
LA
X
90 91 X
LOCK-UP X X 90 91 58
TIMING VALVE
LOCK-UP
LA 94 91 91 SHIFT VALVE
96 92 93 X 6 MODULATOR PRESSURE
LS C PRESSURE
95
90 96 58 96
93
92
X90
X
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2
AX
93
MAINSHAFT
AX COUNTERSHAFT
TORQUE X X 95 HX
SECONDARY
CONVERTER SHAFT
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X
COOLER CHECK
VALVE 1
99 LUBRICATION
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE CHECK VALVE
ATF PUMP
14-312
03/07/29 09:38:52 61S0X050_140_0316
Full Lock-up
When the vehicle speed further increases, the PCM controls A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve C to increase
LS C pressure (58). The LS C pressure (58) is applied to the lock-up control valve and the lock-up timing valve, and
moves them to the left side. Under this condition, torque converter back pressure (F2) is released fully, causing the
torque converter clutch to be fully engaged.
NOTE: When used, left or right indicates direction on the hydraulic circuit.
TORQUE
CONVERTER
91
90
94
6
TORQUE CONVERTER
CLUTCH SOLENOID
VALVE LA
X
90 91 X
LOCK-UP X X 90 91 58
TIMING VALVE
LOCK-UP
LA 94 91 91 SHIFT VALVE
96 92 93 X 6 MODULATOR PRESSURE
LS C PRESSURE
95
90 96 58 96
93
92
X90
X
LOCK-UP
CONTROL
90 VALVE 95
2
AX
93
MAINSHAFT
AX COUNTERSHAFT
TORQUE X X 95 HX
SECONDARY
CONVERTER SHAFT
CHECK VALVE RELIEF VALVE
92 1 95 95 95 X
93 X
COOLER CHECK
VALVE 1
99 LUBRICATION
ATF FILTER REGULATOR VALVE CHECK VALVE
ATF PUMP
14-313
03/07/29 09:38:53 61S0X050_140_0317
Automatic Transmission
TRANSMISSION
RANGE SWITCH
WHT/RED YEL/BLK YEL/BLK BLK BLK P POSITION G401
CPU
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
C4 STARTER
R WHT WHT WHT CUT RELAY
YEL
C16
N RED/BLK RED/BLK
C6
D3 RED RED
C7
2 BLU BLU BLU/YEL
C5
1 BRN BRN BLK
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 1 2 3
D5 ST A E
N D3
R 2
G503 P 1
14-314
03/07/29 09:38:55 61S0X050_140_0318
ENGINE
3 OUTPUT SHAFT INPUT SHAFT COOLANT ATF
(COUNTERSHAFT) MAINFOLD ABSOLUTE (MAINSHAFT) THROTTLE TEMPERATURE TEMPERATURE
SPEED SENSOR PRESSURE SENSOR SPEED SENSOR POSITION SENSOR SENSOR SENSOR
WHT/RED
7 5
1
PARK
KEY KEY PIN
INTERLOCK INTERLOCK SWITCH
SWITCH SOLENOID
1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 3 2 1 1 2
BLK
GRN BLU
WHT/BLK BRN BLU/GRN LT GRN YEL/RED GRN GRN/RED YEL/BLU WHT RED/BLK RED/WHT BLU/YEL
A32 A10 A5 E17 C19 D10 D16 C17 C7 C28 D11 D12 C27 C18 C26 C24
BK SW SCS CRS ATSFTP VCC1 NC NCSG MAP SG1 VCC2 NM NMSG TPS SG2 ECT TATF
(PB)
WHT GRN RED/BLU BLU/YEL GRN/WHT GRN YEL BLU/WHT BLU/YEL BRN/YEL
BRN/YEL
2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1
A/T CLUTCH A/T CLUTCH A/T CLUTCH SHIFT SOLENOID SHIFT SOLENOID SHIFT SOLENOID TORQUE 3RD 4TH
PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE VALVE A VALVE B VALVE C CONVERTER CLUTCH CLUTCH
CONTROL CONTROL CONTROL CLUTCH TRANSMISSION TRANSMISSION
SOLENOID SOLENOID SOLENOID SOLENOID FLUID FLUID
VALVE A VALVE B VALVE C VALVE PRESSURE PRESSURE
SWITCH SWITCH
G101 G101
1 2 3 4 5 6 8 9 10 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 2 3 5
14 15 17 18 19 20 21 24 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 17 18 12 13 14 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 (5) (6) (7)
26 27 28 29 30 31 32 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 13 14 15 16 12 (16) (17)
14-315
03/07/29 09:38:56 61S0X050_140_0319
Automatic Transmission
DTC Troubleshooting
DTC P0710: Problem in ATF Temperature 4. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
Sensor Circuit
5. Measure the voltage between terminal No. 2 ATF
NOTE: temperature sensor connector and body ground.
Record all freeze data and review General
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-247) ATF TEMPERATURE
SENSOR CONNECTOR
before you troubleshoot.
This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem
and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the
transmission.
1. Check whether the scan tool or the HDS indicates a ATFT (BLU/YEL)
code for the fuel and emissions system.
14-316
03/07/29 09:38:57 61S0X050_140_0320
7. Measure the voltage between PCM connector 8. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
terminal C24 and body ground.
9. Disconnect PCM connector C (31P).
PCM CONNECTOR C (31P)
10. Check for continuity between PCM connector
terminal C24 and body ground.
PCM CONNECTOR C (31P)
ATFT (BLU/YEL)
ATFT (BLU/YEL)
Wire side of female terminals
Is there about 5 V ?
YESRepair open in the wire between PCM Wire side of female terminals
connector terminal C24 terminal and the ATF
temperature sensor. Check fit at all terminals from Is there continuity?
C24 to the sensor.
YESRepair short to ground in the wire between
NOGo to step 8. PCM connector terminal C24 and the ATF
temperature sensor.
14-317
03/07/29 09:38:57 61S0X050_140_0321
Automatic Transmission
Is there continuity?
14-318
03/07/29 09:38:58 61S0X050_140_0322
10. Connect PCM connector D (16P). 14. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals D11 and D12.
11. Check for continuity between input shaft
(mainshaft) speed sensor connector terminal No. 3
PCM CONNECTOR D (16P)
and body ground.
INPUT SHAFT
(MAINSHAFT) SPEED
SENSOR CONNECTOR
NMSG (WHT)
Is there about 5 V ?
Wire side of female terminals
YESRepair open in the wire between PCM
Is there continuity? connector terminal D11 and the input shaft
(mainshaft) speed sensor.
YESGo to step 12.
NOCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
NORepair open in the wire between PCM connectors D11, D12, and C28. If necessary,
connector terminal D12 and the input shaft substitute a known-good PCM and recheck only if
(mainshaft) speed sensor. the code resets after being cleared.
INPUT SHAFT
(MAINSHAFT) SPEED
SENSOR CONNECTOR
Is there about 5 V ?
(contd)
14-319
03/07/29 09:38:59 61S0X050_140_0323
Automatic Transmission
VCC2 (YEL/BLU)
17. Disconnect PCM connector C (31P). 21. Start the engine, and run it at idle in P position.
18. Check for continuity between PCM connector 22. Hold the engine at idle, and measure the voltage
terminal C28 and body ground. between PCM connector terminals D11 and D12.
PCM CONNECTOR C (31P)
PCM CONNECTOR D (16P)
VCC2 (YEL/BLU)
NM (RED) NMSG (WHT)
YESRepair short to ground in the wire between YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
PCM connector terminal C28 and the input shaft connectors D11, D12, and C28. Clear DTCs. If
(mainshaft) speed sensor. necessary (only if the DTC recodes), substitute a
known-good PCM and recheck only if the DTC
NOCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM recodes.
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
PCM and recheck only if the code resets after being NOReplace the input shaft (mainshaft) speed
cleared. sensor (see page 14-364).
14-320
03/07/29 09:38:59 61S0X050_140_0324
DTC P0720: Problem in Output Shaft 7. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(Countershaft) Speed Sensor Circuit
8. Disconnect PCM connector D (16P).
NOTE: Record all freeze data and review General
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-247) before 9. Check for continuity between output shaft
you troubleshoot. (countershaft) speed sensor connector terminal
No. 2 and body ground.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
OUTPUT SHAFT
(COUNTERSHAFT) SPEED
2. Check whether the scan tool or the HDS indicates SENSOR CONNECTOR
the code for the manifold absolute pressure (MAP)
sensor.
NOGo to step 3.
Is there continuity?
3. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
YESRepair short to ground in the wire between
4. Disconnect the output shaft (countershaft) speed PCM connector terminal D10 and the output shaft
sensor connector. (countershaft) speed sensor.
6. Measure the voltage between output shaft 10. Check for continuity between output shaft
(countershaft) speed sensor connector terminal (countershaft) speed sensor connector terminal
No. 1 and body ground. No. 3 and body ground.
OUTPUT SHAFT OUTPUT SHAFT
(COUNTERSHAFT) SPEED (COUNTERSHAFT) SPEED
SENSOR CONNECTOR SENSOR CONNECTOR
NCSG (GRN)
VCC1 (YEL/RED)
(contd)
14-321
03/07/29 09:39:00 61S0X050_140_0325
Automatic Transmission
OUTPUT SHAFT
(COUNTERSHAFT) SPEED
SENSOR CONNECTOR
VCC1 (YEL/RED)
Wire side of female terminals YESRepair open in the wire between PCM
connector terminal C19 and the output shaft
Is there about 5 V ? (countershaft) speed sensor.
13. Measure the voltage between PCM connector 16. Disconnect PCM connector (31P).
terminals D10 and D16.
17. Check for continuity between PCM connector
terminal C19 and body ground.
PCM CONNECTOR D (16P)
PCM CONNECTOR C (31P)
NC (BLU)
14-322
03/07/29 09:39:01 61S0X050_140_0326
18. Connect the output shaft (countershaft) speed 20. Raise the front of the vehicle, and make sure it is
sensor connector. securely supported.
19. Measure the voltage between PCM connector 21. Set the parking brake, and block both rear wheels
terminals D10 and D16. securely.
22. Start the engine, then shift to D position and let the
PCM CONNECTOR D (16P)
wheels spin the vehicle.
NCSG (GRN)
NC (BLU)
14-323
03/07/29 09:39:01 61S0X050_140_0327
Automatic Transmission
NOGo to step 2.
YESGo to step 3.
14-324
03/07/29 09:39:01 61S0X050_140_0328
DTC P0740: Problem in Lock-up Control 5. Clear the DTC with the scan tool or the HDS.
System
6. Using the scan tool, check to be sure that the
NOTE: engine coolant temperature is 176F (80C) or
Record all freeze data and review General above.
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-247)
before you troubleshoot. 7. Drive the vehicle under the same conditions as
Keep these replacement solenoid valves on hand: those indicated by the freeze data, or at 55 mph
Torque converter clutch solenoid valve (88 km/h) with very steady throttle for more than 1
A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve C minute.
1. Check whether the scan tool or the HDS indicates 8. Recheck for code P0740.
another code.
Does the scan tool or the HDS indicate code
Does the scan tool or the HDS indicate another P07 40?
code?
YESRemove the torque converter and inspect the
YESPerform the Troubleshooting Flowchart for O-ring. If the O-ring is missing, replace the O-ring.
the indicated code(s). Recheck for code P0740 after If the O-ring is damaged or OK, replace the
troubleshooting. transmission and torque converter.
YESGo to step 3.
14-325
03/07/29 09:39:02 61S0X050_140_0329
Automatic Transmission
4. Measure the voltage between PCM connector Wire side of female terminals
terminals D1 and B20 or B22.
Is the resistance 1225 ?
PCM CONNECTORS
Is there voltage?
YESRepair short to power in the wire between LG1 (BRN/YEL) LG2 (BRN/YEL)
PCM connector terminal D1 and the torque
converter clutch solenoid valve.
NOGo to step 5.
Wire side of female terminals
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 8.
14-326
03/07/29 09:39:02 61S0X050_140_0330
8. Disconnect the torque converter clutch solenoid 11. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
valve connector (2P).
12. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
9. Check for continuity between PCM connector terminals D5 and B20 or B22.
terminals D1 and B20 or B22.
PCM CONNECTORS
PCM CONNECTORS
VB SOL (BLK/YEL)
LC (YEL)
B (25P) D (16P)
B (25P) D (16P)
14-327
03/07/29 09:39:03 61S0X050_140_0331
Automatic Transmission
NOGo to step 5.
Terminal side of male terminals 6. Measure the resistance between PCM connector
terminals B8 and B17.
Is the resistance 310 ?
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
YESGo to step 3. LS A (WHT)
LS A (RED)
YESGo to step 7.
14-328
03/07/29 09:39:03 61S0X050_140_0332
PCM CONNECTORS
VB SOL (BLK/YEL)
B (25P) D (16P)
14-329
03/07/29 09:39:04 61S0X050_140_0333
Automatic Transmission
4. Measure the voltage between PCM connector Wire side of female terminals
terminals D7 and B20 or B22.
Is the resistance 1225 ?
PCM CONNECTORS
Is there voltage?
LG1 (BRN/YEL) LG2 (BRN/YEL)
YESRepair short to power in the wire between
PCM connector terminal D7 and the shift solenoid
valve A.
NOGo to step 5.
Wire side of female terminals
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 8.
14-330
03/07/29 09:39:05 61S0X050_140_0334
8. Disconnect the 2P connector from shift solenoid 11. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
valve A.
12. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
9. Check for continuity between PCM connector terminals D5 and B20 or B22 .
terminals D7 and B20 or B22 .
PCM CONNECTORS
PCM CONNECTORS
VB SOL (BLK/YEL)
SH A (BLU/YEL)
B (25P) D (16P)
B (25P) D (16P)
14-331
03/07/29 09:39:06 61S0X050_140_0335
Automatic Transmission
4. Measure the voltage between PCM connector Wire side of female terminals
terminals D2 and B20 or B22.
Is the resistance 1225 ?
PCM CONNECTORS
Is there voltage?
LG1 (BRN/YEL) LG2 (BRN/YEL)
YESRepair short to power in the wire between
PCM connector terminal D2 and the shift solenoid
valve B.
NOGo to step 5.
Wire side of female terminals
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 8.
14-332
03/07/29 09:39:06 61S0X050_140_0336
8. Disconnect the 2P connector from shift solenoid 11. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
valve B.
12. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
9. Check for continuity between PCM connector terminals D5 and B20 or B22.
terminals D2 and B20 or B22 .
PCM CONNECTORS
PCM CONNECTORS
VB SOL (BLK/YEL)
SH B (GRN/WHT)
B (25P) D (16P)
B (25P) D (16P)
14-333
03/07/29 09:39:07 61S0X050_140_0337
Automatic Transmission
4. Measure the voltage between PCM connector Wire side of female terminals
terminals D3 and B20 or B22.
Is the resistance 1225 ?
PCM CONNECTORS
Is there voltage?
YESRepair short to power in the wire between LG1 (BRN/YEL) LG2 (BRN/YEL)
PCM connector terminal D3 and the shift solenoid
valve C.
NOGo to step 5.
Wire side of female terminals
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 8.
14-334
03/07/29 09:39:08 61S0X050_140_0338
8. Disconnect the 2P connector from shift solenoid 11. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
valve C.
12. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
9. Check for continuity between PCM connector terminals D5 and B20 or B22.
terminals D3 and B20 or B22.
PCM CONNECTORS
PCM CONNECTORS
VB SOL (BLK/YEL)
SH C (GRN)
B (25P) D (16P)
B (25P) D (16P)
14-335
03/07/29 09:39:09 61S0X050_140_0339
Automatic Transmission
Is there continuity?
NOGo to step 5.
LS B (GRN)
LS B (BRN/WHT)
YESGo to step 7.
14-336
03/07/29 09:39:09 61S0X050_140_0340
PCM CONNECTORS
VB SOL (BLK/YEL)
B (25P) D (16P)
14-337
03/07/29 09:39:09 61S0X050_140_0341
Automatic Transmission
NOGo to step 2.
14-338
03/07/29 09:39:10 61S0X050_140_0342
DTC P0798: Problem in A/T Clutch Pressure 3. Disconnect PCM connector B (25P).
Control Solenoid Valve C Circuit
4. Check for continuity between PCM connector
NOTE: terminals B13 and body ground, and between B24
Record all freeze data and review General and body ground.
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-247)
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
before you troubleshoot.
This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem
and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the
transmission.
Is there continuity?
NOGo to step 5.
LS C (GRN/RED) LS C (RED/BLU)
YESGo to step 7.
(contd)
14-339
03/07/29 09:39:10 61S0X050_140_0343
Automatic Transmission
PCM CONNECTORS
VB SOL (BLK/YEL)
B (25P) D (16P)
14-340
03/07/29 09:39:11 61S0X050_140_0344
DTC P0845: Problem in 3rd Clutch 3. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
Transmission Fluid Pressure Switch Circuit
4. Disconnect PCM connector D (16P).
NOTE: Record all freeze data and review General
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-247) before 5. Disconnect the 3rd clutch transmission fluid
you troubleshoot. pressure switch connector.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 6. Check for continuity between PCM connector
terminal D13 and body ground.
2. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals D13 and B20 or B22.
PCM CONNECTOR D (16P)
PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P) D (16P)
OP3SW (BLU/WHT)
(contd)
14-341
03/07/29 09:39:11 61S0X050_140_0345
Automatic Transmission
PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P) D (16P)
14-342
03/07/29 09:39:12 61S0X050_140_0346
DTC P1705: Short in Transmission Range 4. Shift to all positions other than P or N.
Switch Circuit
5. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
NOTE: terminals B14 and B20 or B22 .
Record all freeze data and review General
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
Troubleshooting Information (see page 14-247)
before you troubleshoot.
This code is caused by an electrical circuit problem
and cannot be caused by a mechanical problem in the
transmission.
YESGo to step 6.
YESGo to step 4.
(contd)
14-343
03/07/29 09:39:12 61S0X050_140_0347
Automatic Transmission
7. Measure the voltage between PCM connector 9. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals D9 and B20 or B22 . terminals D8 and B20 or B22.
PCM CONNECTORS PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P) D (16P) B (25P) D (16P)
ATP D3 (RED)
LG2 (BRN/YEL) LG2 (BRN/YEL)
NOCheck for a short in the wire between PCM NOCheck for a short in the wire between PCM
connector terminal D9 and the transmission range connector terminal D8 and the transmission range
switch or A/T gear position indicator. If the wire is switch or A/T gear position indicator. If the wires
OK, check for loose terminal fit in the PCM are OK, check for loose terminal fit in the PCM
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
PCM and recheck. PCM and recheck.
14-344
03/07/29 09:39:13 61S0X050_140_0348
10. Shift to all positions other than 2. 12. Shift to all positions other than 1.
11. Measure the voltage between PCM connector 13. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals D14 and B20 or B22 . terminals D15 and B20 or B22.
PCM CONNECTORS PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P) D (16P) B (25P) D (16P)
YESGo to step 12. YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
NOCheck for a short in the wire between PCM PCM and recheck.
connector terminal D14 and the transmission range
switch or A/T gear position indicator. If the wires NOCheck for a short in the wire between PCM
are OK, check for loose terminal fit in the PCM connector terminal D15 and the transmission range
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good switch or A/T gear position indicator. If the wires
PCM and recheck. are OK, check for loose terminal fit in the PCM
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
PCM and recheck.
14-345
03/07/29 09:39:14 61S0X050_140_0349
Automatic Transmission
Is the switch OK ?
LG2 (BRN/YEL)
NOReplace the transmission range switch (see Wire side of female terminals
page 14-404).
Is there voltage?
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
YESRepair open in the wire between PCM
3. Check for continuity between PCM connector connector terminal D9 and the transmission range
terminals B20 and body ground, and between B22 switch.
and body ground.
NOGo to step 7.
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
7. Shift to the R position.
NORepair open in the wire between PCM Wire side of female terminals
connector terminals B20, B22, and ground (G101),
or repair poor ground (G101). Is there voltage?
NOGo to step 9.
14-346
03/07/29 09:39:15 61S0X050_140_0350
10. Measure the voltage between PCM connector 14. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals B14 and B20 or B22. terminals D14 and B20 or B22.
PCM CONNECTOR B (25P) PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P) D (16P)
ATP NP (BLU/WHT)
ATP 2 (BLU)
LG2 (BRN/YEL)
LG2 (BRN/YEL)
LG1 (BRN/YEL) LG1 (BRN/YEL)
YESRepair open in the wire between PCM YESRepair open in the wire between PCM
connector terminal B14 and the transmission range connector terminal D14 and the transmission range
switch. switch.
12. Measure the voltage between PCM connector 16. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals D8 and B20 or B22. terminals D15 and B20 or B22.
PCM CONNECTORS PCM CONNECTORS
B (25P) D (16P) B (25P) D (16P)
YESRepair open in the wire between PCM YESRepair open in the wire between PCM
connector terminal D8 and the transmission range connector terminal D15 and the transmission range
switch. switch.
NOGo to step 13. NOCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
PCM and recheck.
14-347
03/07/29 09:40:09 61S0X050_140_0351
Automatic Transmission
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 6. Check for continuity between PCM connector
terminal B19 and body ground.
2. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals B19 and B20 or B22. PCM CONNECTOR B (25P)
OP4SW (BLU/YEL)
OP4SW
(BLU/YEL) LG1 (BRN/YEL) Wire side of female terminals
LG2 (BRN/YEL)
Wire side of female terminals Is there continuity?
14-348
03/07/29 09:40:10 61S0X050_140_0352
7. Raise the front of the vehicle, and make sure it is 14. Measure the voltage between the 4th clutch
securely supported. transmission fluid pressure switch connector
terminal and body ground.
8. Set the park brake, and block the rear wheels
4TH CLUTCH TRANSMISSION FLUID
securely. PRESSURE SWITCH CONNECTOR
Is there about 0 V ? 15. Measure the resistance between the 4th clutch
transmission fluid pressure switch connector
YESCheck for loose terminal fit in the PCM terminal and body ground.
connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-good
4TH CLUTCH TRANSMISSION FLUID
PCM and recheck. PRESSURE SWITCH CONNECTOR
14-349
03/07/29 09:40:10 61S0X050_140_0353
Automatic Transmission
NOGo to step 2.
14-350
03/07/29 09:40:10 61S0X050_140_0354
NOGo to step 2.
14-351
03/07/29 09:40:11 61S0X050_140_0355
Automatic Transmission
Road Test
Special Tools Required 6. Pull back the carpet, and remove the passengers
Backprobe set 07SAZ-001000A (Two required) and drivers side center lower covers to expose the
PCM (see page 11-4).
1. Warm up the engine to normal operating
temperature (the radiator fan comes on). 7. Remove the PCM cover from the passengers side
under-dash to access the PCM mounting nut.
2. Apply parking brake, and block rear wheels
securely. 8. Remove the PCM mounting bolt, then remove the
PCM (A).
3. Start the engine, then shift to the D position while
A
depressing the brake pedal. Depress the
accelerator pedal, and release it suddenly. Make
sure that the engine should not stall.
C
07SAZ-001000A
4. Repeat the same test in the D3, 2, and 1 position.
B (25P) C (31P)
LG2 (BRN/BLK)
LG1 (BRN/BLK) TPS (RED/BLK)
14-352
03/07/29 09:40:11 61S0X050_140_0356
10. Test-drive the vehicle on a flat road in the D 11. Accelerate to about 35 mph (57 km/h) so the
position. Check for abnormal noise and clutch transmission is in 4th or 5th, then shift from the D
slippage. While driving, check that the shift points position to the 2 position. The vehicle should
occur at the proper speeds by monitoring the immediately begin slowing down from engine
throttle position sensor voltage and comparing braking.
your shift point speeds and voltage to those in the
table. (The throttle position sensor voltage 12. Check for abnormal noise and clutch slippage in
represents the throttle opening.) the following positions.
14-353
03/07/29 09:40:12 61S0X050_140_0357
Automatic Transmission
14-354
03/07/29 09:40:12 61S0X050_140_0358
Pressure Test
Special Tools Required 6. Connect the oil pressure gauges to the 1st clutch
A/T clutch pressure gauge set pressure inspection hole (D), 3rd clutch pressure
07406-0020400 or 07406-0020401 inspection hole (E), 4th clutch pressure inspection
A/T pressure hose, 2,210 mm 07MAJ-PY4011A hole (F), and 5th clutch pressure inspection hole (G).
A/T pressure hose adapter 07MAJ-PY40120
D
1. Before testing, be sure the transmission fluid is F
filled to the proper level.
E
2. Raise the vehicle, and make sure it is securely
supported.
(contd)
14-355
03/07/29 09:40:13 61S0X050_140_0359
Automatic Transmission
10. Shift to the 2 position, and measure 2nd clutch 19. If the measurements are out of service limit,
pressure at the 2nd clutch pressure inspection hole problems and probable causes are listed in the
(B). table below:
11. Shift to the P position, then press the brake pedal Problem Probable causes
and hold it. No or low line Torque converter
pressure ATF pump
12. Shift to the 2 position, and release the brake pedal Regulator valve
(the transmission should be in 2nd gear). Torque converter
check valve
13. Press the accelerator very slowly to increase No or low 1st clutch 1st clutch
engine speed to 2,000 rpm gradually over 10 pressure O-rings
seconds, then hold it at 2,000 rpm. No or low 2nd clutch 2nd clutch
pressure O-rings
14. Hold in the 2 position at 2,000 rpm, shift into N for 1 No or low 3rd clutch 3rd clutch
second, then shift to the D3 position (the pressure O-rings
transmission will shift to 3rd gear), and measure No or low 4th clutch 4th clutch
3rd clutch pressure at the 3rd clutch pressure pressure O-rings
inspection hole (D). No or low 5th clutch 5th clutch
pressure O-rings
15. Shift to the D position, and measure 4th clutch No or low 5th clutch Servo valve
pressure at the 4th clutch pressure inspection hole pressure in the R 5th clutch
(E), then in about 15 seconds, the transmission will position O-rings
shift to 5th gear.
20. Install the sealing bolts with the new sealing
16. Measure 5th clutch pressure at the 5th clutch washers, and tighten the bolts to the specified
pressure inspection hole (F). torque. Do not reuse old sealing washers.
17. Bring the engine back to an idle, then apply the Torque: 18 Nm (1.8 kgfm,13 lbfft)
brake to stop the wheels from rotating.
14-356
03/07/29 09:40:13 61S0X050_140_0360
1. Disconnect the connector from the torque 1. Remove the mounting bolt and torque converter
converter clutch solenoid valve. clutch solenoid valve.
6 x 1.0 mm A
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
14-357
03/07/29 09:40:14 61S0X050_140_0361
Automatic Transmission
14-358
03/07/29 09:40:15 61S0X050_140_0362
2. Disconnect the shift control solenoid valve A and C NOTE: If shift solenoid valves A and C are replaced or
connectors. removed at the same time, be sure to reinstall them
correctly. The connector color of shift solenoid valve A
is black, and the connector color of shift solenoid valve
A C is brown.
Standard: 1225
14-359
03/07/29 09:40:15 61S0X050_140_0363
Automatic Transmission
Standard: 310
4. Connect the No. 1 terminal of A/T clutch pressure 7. Disconnect one of the battery terminals and check
control solenoid valves A and B to the battery valve movement.
positive terminal, and connect the No. 2 terminal to
the battery negative terminal. A clicking sound NOTE: You can see the valve movement through
should be heard. Remove A/T clutch pressure the fluid passage in the mounting surface of the
control solenoid valves A and B, if no sound is solenoid valve body (C).
heard.
8. If either valve binds, or moves sluggishly, or if the
5. Check the fluid passage of the A/T clutch pressure solenoid does not operate, replace the A/T clutch
control solenoid valves for dust and dirt, and clean pressure control solenoid valves A and B.
the passage if necessary.
14-360
03/07/29 09:40:15 61S0X050_140_0364
14-361
03/07/29 09:40:16 61S0X050_140_0365
Automatic Transmission
Standard: 310 A
14-362
03/07/29 09:40:16 61S0X050_140_0366
B
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
14-363
03/07/29 09:40:17 61S0X050_140_0367
Automatic Transmission
1. Disconnect the input shaft (mainshaft) speed 1. Disconnect the output shaft (countershaft) speed
sensor connector. sensor connector.
2. Remove the bolt securing the input shaft 2. Remove the bolt securing the output shaft
(mainshaft) speed sensor, then remove the input (countershaft) speed sensor, then remove the
shaft (mainshaft) speed sensor (A) from the end output shaft (countershaft) speed sensor (A) from
cover. the transmission housing.
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm
(1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
A
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm
(1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
14-364
03/07/29 09:40:18 61S0X050_140_0368
1. Remove the switch cover (A). 1. Disconnect the connector from the 4th clutch
transmission fluid pressure switch (A).
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
C A
20 Nm
(2.0 kgfm, 14 lbfft)
14-365
03/07/29 09:40:18 61S0X050_140_0369
Automatic Transmission
10 x 1.25 mm
38 Nm (3.9 kgfm,
28 lbfft)
14-366
03/07/29 09:40:19 61S0X050_140_0370
2. Park the vehicle on the level ground. Turn off the 7. If necessary, fill the transmission into the filler hole
engine. (A) to bring the fluid level up to the upper mark.
Always use Honda ATF-Z1 Automatic Transmission
NOTE: Check the fluid level within 6090 seconds Fluid (ATF). Using a non-Honda ATF can affect shift
after turning the engine off. quality.
C
3. Remove the dipstick (yellow loop) (A) from the
transmission, and wipe it with a clean cloth.
B
24 x 1.5 mm
44 Nm
A (4.5 kgfm,
33 lbfft)
4. Insert the dipstick into the transmission. 9. Install the ATF filler bolt (B) with a new sealing
washer (C).
5. Remove the dipstick and check the fluid level. It
should be between the upper mark (B) and lower 10. Insert the dipstick back into the transmission.
mark (C).
14-367
03/07/29 09:40:20 61S0X050_140_0371
Automatic Transmission
ATF Replacement
NOTE: Keep all foreign particles out of the transmission. 5. Refill the transmission with the recommended fluid
into the filler hole (A) to the upper mark on the
1. Bring the transmission up to operating temperature dipstick. Always use Honda ATF-Z1 Automatic
(the radiator fan comes on) by driving the vehicle. Transmission Fluid (ATF). Using a non-Honda ATF
can affect shift quality.
2. Park the vehicle on the level ground, and turn the
engine off. Automatic Transmission Fluid Capacity:
3.3 (3.5 US qt) at changing
3. Remove the ATF filler bolt and the drain plug (A), 7.9 (8.3 US qt) at overhaul
and drain the automatic transmission fluid (ATF).
C
NOTE: If a cooler flusher is used, refer to ATF
Cooler Flushing (see page 14-388).
B
24 x 1.5 mm
44 Nm
A (4.5 kgfm,
18 x 1.5 mm 33 lbfft)
49 Nm (5.0 kgfm,
36 lbfft)
14-368
03/07/29 09:40:20 61S0X050_140_0372
Transmission Removal
Special Tools Required 11. Remove the drain plug (A), and drain the automatic
Engine support hanger 07XAA-001030A transmission fluid (ATF). Reinstall the drain plug
Engine hanger balance bar VSB02C000019 and a new sealing washer (B).
Subframe adapter EQS07AODSY0
(Available through the Honda Tool and Equipment A
18 x 1.5 mm
Program, 888-424-6857) 49 Nm (5.0 kgfm,
36 lbfft)
1. Before disconnecting the battery, make sure you
have the anti-theft code for the radio, then write
down the frequencies for the radios preset stations.
12. Remove the breather tube (A) from its clamp (B) on
the radiator hose (C).
A
B
4. Remove the intake air duct, resonator cover, and air
cleaner housing assembly. C
(contd)
14-369
03/07/29 09:40:21 61S0X050_140_0373
Automatic Transmission
D C
C
A A
G
14. Remove the ATF cooler hose (A) from the ATF B
cooler lines (D). Turn the ends of the ATF cooler E F
hoses up to prevent ATF from flowing out, then
plug the ATF cooler hoses and lines. Check for any 17. Remove the 8P connector (C) from the connector
signs of leakage at the hose joints. bracket (D), then disconnect the connector.
15. Remove the starter cables (A) from the starter (B), A B C
then remove the starter.
D
B
E C
A
F
F
A
18. Remove the harness clamps (E) from the brackets
(F), then disconnect the connectors from the A/T
clutch pressure control solenoid valves A and B.
14-370
03/07/29 09:40:23 61S0X050_140_0374
19. Disconnect the connectors from the torque 24. Remove the primary heated oxygen sensor
converter clutch solenoid valve (A) and shift (Primary HO2S) connector (A) from its connector
solenoid valve B. bracket (B).
A
A
B
20. Remove the transmission range switch connector
(A) from the connector bracket (B).
25. Disconnect the Primary HO2S connector (A), and
F
remove the Primary HO2S harness from the
harness clamp (C).
G
26. Remove the transmission housing mounting bolts
(3).
E C
(contd)
14-371
03/07/29 09:40:24 61S0X050_140_0375
Automatic Transmission
B C
E A
28. Lift and support the engine with engine support
hanger (A) and engine balancer bar (B). Attatch the D
front arm (C) to the front cylinder head with a C
spacer (D) and the 10 x 1.25 mm bolt (E). Attatch the
rear arm (F) the rear cylinder head with the B
8 x 1.25 mm bolt (G).
30. Remove the exhaust pipe A and three-way catalytic
converter (E).
31. Remove the spring pins (A) and castle nuts (B), and
A separate the lower arms (C) from the knuckles (D)
(07XAA-001030A)
(see page 18-17).
A G E
H
F
C
E G
B
(VSB02C000019)
D
C F
14-372
03/07/29 09:40:25 61S0X050_140_0376
33. Remove the bolts securing the shift cable holder (A), 36. Remove the torque converter cover (A), then
then remove the shift cable cover (B). remove the eight drive plate bolts (B) one at a time
while rotating the crankshaft pulley.
NOTE: To prevent damage to the control lever joint,
B
remove the bolts securing the holder before
removing the bolt securing the cover.
D
C A
C
A
(contd)
14-373
03/07/29 09:40:26 61S0X050_140_0377
Automatic Transmission
A B
B C
41. Remove the steering gearbox mounting bolts (A) 44. Remove the transmission lower mount nuts.
and nut (B), and remove the stiffener (C).
A B
C
D A
14-374
03/07/29 09:40:27 61S0X050_140_0378
45. Make reference marks (A) on the body across the 47. Line up the slots in the arms with the bolt holes on
marks (B) on the edge of the front subframe (C). the corner of the jack base, then attach the adapter
to the jack base with the bolts (A) that came with
the jack. Tighten the bolts securely.
C
A
B
B
46. Loosen the four bolts (A) holding the adjustable EQS07AODSY0
arms (B) of the front subframe adapter (T/N
EQS07AODSY0) to its center plate. 48. Raise the jack to vehicle height, then attach the
adapter to the front subframe by sliding the
NOTE: The adapter is designed to be used with the adapters nut plates (B), between the subframe and
Honda transmission jack (model number LSL- the body.
W93714) or powertrain lift (model number OTC-
1585), both available through the Honda Tool and B
Equipment Program. It will also work with most
commercially available transmission jack.
C
A 54 Nm
(5.5 kgfm, 40 lbfft)
49. Insert the nut plate bolts through the holes in the
EQS07AODSY0 adapter and the subframe; then thread the bolts (C)
into the nut plates and tighten them to 54 Nm
(5.5 kgfm, 40 lbfft).
(contd)
14-375
03/07/29 09:40:28 61S0X050_140_0379
Automatic Transmission
C
C
B
B
A A
B B
14-376
03/07/29 09:40:29 61S0X050_140_0380
56. Remove the front mount bracket. 58. Pull the transmission away from the engine until it
clears the dowel pins, then lower it on the
transmission jack.
C
A
14-377
03/07/29 09:40:29 61S0X050_140_0381
Automatic Transmission
12 x 1.25 mm
74 Nm (7.5 kgfm, 54 lbfft)
14-378
03/07/29 09:40:30 61S0X050_140_0382
Transmission Installation
1. Flush the ATF cooler (see page 14-388). 6. Attach the transmission to the engine, then install
the transmission housing mounting bolts.
2. Install the transmission lower mounts.
A 10 x 1.25 mm
38 Nm (3.9 kgfm,
28 lbfft)
12 x 1.25 mm
64 Nm (6.5 kgfm, 47 lbfft)
10 x 1.25 mm
38 Nm
(3.9 kgfm, 28 lbfft)
B
C
E
(contd)
14-379
03/07/29 09:40:31 61S0X050_140_0383
Automatic Transmission
C
6 x 1.0 mm B
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft) B
A 6 x 1.0 mm
10 x 1.25 mm 12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
38 Nm (3.9 kgfm, 28 lbfft) 8.7 lbfft)
14-380
03/07/29 09:40:32 61S0X050_140_0384
14. Install a new set ring (A) on the right driveshaft (B). 17. Loosely install the subframe mounting bolts (4) (A)
and the 12 x 1.25 mm bolts (6) (B) with the
stiffeners (C), then tighten the bolts to the specified
torque by aligning all reference marks (D).
B
12 x 1.25 mm
74 Nm (7.5 kgfm, 54 lbfft)
A C
C
NOTE: A
Clean the areas where the left driveshaft contacts
A
the transmission (differential) with solvent or 14 x 1.5 mm B
carburetor cleaner, and dry with compressed air. 103 Nm 12 x 1.25 mm
(10.5 kgfm, 117 Nm
Turn the right and left steering knuckle fully 75.9 lbfft) A (11.9 kgfm,
outward, and slide the left driveshaft into the Replace. 86.1 lbfft)
B
differential until you feel its spring clip engage 12 x 1.25 mm
the side gear. Slide the right driveshaft into the 117 Nm (11.9 kgfm, 86.1 lbfft)
intermediate shaft until you feel its spring clip
engage the intermediate shaft.
EQS07AODSY0
(contd)
14-381
03/07/29 09:40:33 61S0X050_140_0385
Automatic Transmission
10 x 1.25 mm
38 Nm (3.9 kgfm,
28 lbfft)
A B
19. Install the power steering fluid line (A) on the 10 x 1.25 mm 10 x 1.25 mm
38 Nm (3.9 kgfm, 58 Nm (5.9 kgfm,
clamps (B), and install the power steering fluid line 28 lbfft) 43 lbfft)
bracket (C).
21. Install the steering gearbox mounting bolts (B) and
6 x 1.0 mm the stiffener (C).
B 9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft) 22. Install the stiffener (A) and the steering gearbox
B mounting bolt (B) with nut (C).
10 x 1.25 mm
C 59 Nm (6.0 kgfm,
43 lbfft)
A
B
10 x 1.25 mm
58 Nm (5.9 kgfm, 43 lbfft)
14-382
03/07/29 09:40:35 61S0X050_140_0386
23. Install the steering gearbox mounting bolt (A) and 28. Install the ball joints on each lower arms (A) with
the power steering fluid line bracket bolts (B). the castle nuts (hex nuts) (B) and spring pins (C).
B D
6 x 1.0 mm 12 x 1.25 mm
9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm, C 78 Nm (7.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft) F E 51 lbfft)
C G
A
10 x 1.25 mm
D 39 Nm (4.0 kgfm,
29 lbfft)
B
12 x 1.25 mm
5969 Nm (6.07.0 kgfm,
4351 lbfft) A
24. Install the power steering fluid return hose clamp
(C) on the bracket (D). 29. Install the nut (D) to the ball joint pin (E) on the
stabilizer link (F), then use a 6 mm Allen wrench (G),
25. Install the control lever (A) with the shift cable (B) and tighten the nut to the specified torque.
on the control shaft (C). Do not bend the shift cable
excessively. 30. Install the exhaust pipe A and the three way
6 x 1.0 mm catalytic converter (B) assembly.
9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
C 10 x 1.25 mm 10 x 1.25 mm
33 Nm (3.4 kgfm, 54 Nm (5.5 kgfm,
B 25 lbfft) 40 lbfft)
Replace. Replace.
C
G
8 x 1.25 mm D
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
A D 16 lbfft)
E 6 x 1.0 mm
14 Nm (1.4 kgfm, 10 lbfft)
B A
26. Install the lock bolt (D) with a new lock washer (E),
then bend the lock washer tab against the bolt. E
D E
27. Install the shift cable cover (F), then install the shift C
cable holder (G) on the shift cable cover.
31. Connect the oxygen sensor connectors (C), then
NOTE: To prevent damage to the control lever joint, install them on their connector brackets (D).
be sure to install the shift cable holder after Install the harnesses on the clamps (E).
installing the shift cable cover to the torque
converter housing.
(contd)
14-383
03/07/29 09:40:36 61S0X050_140_0387
Automatic Transmission
12 x 1.25 mm
64 Nm
(6.5 kgfm, 47 lbfft)
C
14-384
03/07/29 09:40:37 61S0X050_140_0388
37. Install the harness cover (A) on bracket (B). 41. Connect the connectors to the A/T clutch pressure
control solenoid valves A and B, then install the
6 x 1.0 mm
A 12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft) harness clamps (C) on the brackets (D).
A B E
C E
B
C
D
D
C
B
D
F
42. Connect the 8P connector (E), then install it on its
G E connector bracket (F).
38. Connect the transmission range switch connector 43. Connect the connectors to the shift solenoid valves
(C), then install it on its connector bracket (D). A and C, A/T clutch pressure control solenoid valve
Install the harness clamp (E) on the bracket (F). C (B), 4th clutch transmission fluid pressure switch
(D), and input shaft (mainshaft) speed sensor (E),
39. Connect the output shaft (countershaft) speed then install the harness clamps (F) on the brackets
sensor connector (G). (G).
A F
40. Connect the connectors to the torque converter G
solenoid valve (A) and the shift solenoid valve B.
A
C
B
E
F
B D
(contd)
14-385
03/07/29 09:40:38 61S0X050_140_0389
Automatic Transmission
9 Nm
(0.9 kgfm, 6.5 lbfft)
A
D
A A
B
46. Install the transmission breather tube (A) in the
C clamp (B) by aligning the dot (C) with the clamp.
A
12 x 1.25 mm
D 64 Nm
(6.5 kgfm, 47 lbfft)
C
49. Install the battery tray and battery, then secure the
battery with its hold-down bracket.
50. Install the intake air duct, resonator cover, and air
cleaner housing assembly.
14-386
03/07/29 09:40:38 61S0X050_140_0390
51. Install the engine covers. 63. Loosen the front mount nut after the road test, then
retighten the nut to the specified torque.
12 x 1.25 mm
54 Nm
(5.5 kgfm, 40 lbfft)
54. Set the parking brake. Start the engine, and shift
the transmission through all gears three times.
62. Enter the anti-theft code for the radio and the
navigation system, then enter the radio station
presets, and set the clock.
14-387
03/07/29 09:40:39 61S0X050_140_0391
Automatic Transmission
3. Secure the flusher filler cap, and pressurize the Air Pressure: MAX 845 kPa (8.45 kgf/cm2, 120 psi)
flusher with compressed air to 550829 kpa (5.6
8.45 kgf/cm2, 80120 psi). The air line should be 11. Turn the water valve off. Release the trigger, then
equipped with a water trap to ensure a dry air reverse the hoses to the cooler so you can flush in
system. the opposite direction. Repeat steps 8 through 10.
4. Hang the flusher under the vehicle. 12. Release the trigger, and rinse the cooler with water
for 1 minute.
5. Attach the flusher discharge hose (B) to the return
line of the ATF cooler using a clamp. 13. Turn the water valve and the water supply off.
6. Connect the drain hose (C) to the inlet line on the 14. Turn the air valve on for 2 minutes, or until no
ATF cooler using a clamp. Securely clamp the moisture is visible leaving the drain hose. Residual
opposite end of the drain hose to a bucket (D) or moisture in the cooler or lines can damage the
floor drain. transmission.
15. Remove the flusher from the cooler line. Attach the
drain hose to an ATF container.
14-388
03/07/29 09:40:40 61S0X050_140_0392
24 mm
(0.10.2 in.)
C
A
14-389
03/07/29 09:40:40 61S0X050_140_0393
Automatic Transmission
3. Remove the nut (A) securing the shift cable end (B),
then separate the shift cable (C) from the shift lever
assembly (D).
A C
B C
A
G
E
14-390
03/07/29 09:40:41 61S0X050_140_0394
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm
(2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
14-391
03/07/29 09:40:42 61S0X050_140_0395
Automatic Transmission
DETENT SPRING
4 mm SCREW
3 Nm (0.3 kgfm, 2 lbfft)
PIVOT WASHER
8 x 1.25 mm
12 Nm
(1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
CONTROL BRACKET
CONTROL BRACKET
COLLAR
WASHER
SHIFT CABLE
14-392
03/07/29 09:40:42 61S0X050_140_0396
5. Remove the nut (A) securing the shift cable end (B), A
then separate the shift cable (C) from the shift lever
assembly (D). 8. Remove the bolts securing the shift cable holder (A),
then remove the shift cable cover (B).
D
B C
A
A
E D
C
6. Rotate the socket holder (E) on the shift cable
counterclockwise a quarter turn, then slide the 9. Remove the lock bolt (C) securing the control lever
holder to remove the shift cable from the shift cable (D), then remove the shift cable (E) with the control
bracket (F). lever.
(contd)
14-393
03/07/29 09:40:43 61S0X050_140_0397
Automatic Transmission
11. Verify that the transmission is in the N position on 16. Install the shift cable end to the shift lever. If
the control shaft. necessary, adjust the shift cable (see step 5 on
page 14-395).
12. Install the control lever (A) with the shift cable (B)
on the control shaft (C). Do not bend the shift cable
excessively.
6 x 1.0 mm
9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft)
C
A
8 x 1.25 mm
E D 22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
6 x 1.0 mm 16 lbfft)
14 Nm (1.4 kgfm,
10 lbfft)
13. Install the lock bolt (D) with a new lock washer (E),
then bend the lock washer tab against the bolt head.
14. Install the shift cable cover (F), then install the shift
cable holder (G) on the shift cable cover.
14-394
03/07/29 09:40:43 61S0X050_140_0398
3. Remove the nut (A) securing the shift cable end (B),
then separate the shift cable (C) from the shift lever
assembly (D).
D
6. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), and verify that the
N position indicator comes on.
B C
A
G
E
B
4. Rotate the socket holder (E) on the shift cable
C
counterclockwise a quarter turn, then slide the
holder to remove the shift cable from the shift cable
bracket (F).
(contd)
14-395
03/07/29 09:40:44 61S0X050_140_0399
Automatic Transmission
A
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm
B (2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
G 13. Remove the 6.0 mm (0.24 in.) pin that was installed
to hold the shift lever.
E H
F 14. Move the shift lever to each gear, and verify that
D
the A/T gear position indicator follows the
transmission range switch.
10. Verify that the shift cable end (A) is properly 15. Push the shift lock release, and verify that the shift
installed on the mounting stud (B). lever releases.
Properly Installed:
A B
Improperly Installed:
14-396
03/07/29 09:40:46 61S0X050_140_0400
14-397
03/07/29 09:45:26 61S0X050_140_0401
Circuit Diagram
UNDERDASH
UNDERHOOD FUSE/RELAY BOX IGNITION SWITCH FUSE/RELAY BOX
BATTERY
No.41 (120A) No.42 (50A) IG1 No.9 (10A)
BAT
YEL
C15
SPEEDOMETER P BLK/BLU BLU/BLK
CIRCUIT
C4 STARTER
R WHT WHT WHT WHT CUT
RELAY
C16
N RED/BLK RED/BLK
C6 CRUISE
D3 RED RED RED CONTROL
UNIT
C7
2 BLU BLU BLU
C5
1 BRN BRN BRN BLU/YEL
B16 BLK
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 1 2 3
D5 ST A E
N D3
G503 R 2
P 1
14-398
03/07/29 09:45:26 61S0X050_140_0402
(contd)
14-399
03/07/29 09:45:27 61S0X050_140_0403
A (32P) B (25P)
LG1 (BRN/YEL)
Is there continuity between ground and each Wire side of female terminals
terminal?
22. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
YESGo to step 17.
Is there voltage f or at least 2 seconds?
NORepair open in the wire(s) between PCM
connector terminal B20, B22, and ground (G101), or YESCheck for an open in the wire between PCM
repair poor ground (G101). connector terminal A14 and the gauge assembly. If
the wire is OK, check for a faulty D indicator bulb or
17. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). a faulty printed circuit board in the gauge
assembly.
18. Measure the voltage between PCM connector
terminals B1 and B22, and between B9 and B20. NOGo to step 23.
IGP1 (YEL/BLK)
IGP2 (YEL/BLK)
14-400
03/07/29 09:45:27 61S0X050_140_0404
D5 IND (GRN/BLK)
Is there continuity?
14-401
03/07/29 09:45:28 61S0X050_140_0405
1. Remove the gauge assembly from the dashboard, then disconnect the gauge assembly B (22P) and C (16P) connectors.
2. Inspect the connectors and connector terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the gauge assembly B (22P) and C (16P) connectors.
If a test indicates a problem, find a correct the cause, then recheck the system.
If all the input tests prove OK, but the indicator is faulty, replace the printed circuit board.
B (22P) C (16P)
Cavity Wire Color Test Condition Test: Desired Result Possible Cause
(If result is not obtained)
B11 YEL Ignition switch ON (II) Check for voltage to ground: Blown No. 9 (10A) fuse in the drivers
There should be battery voltage. under-dash fuse/relay box
An open in the wire
B16 BLK Under all conditions Check for continuity to ground: Poor ground (G503)
There should be continuity. An open in the wire
B22 RED/BLK Headlights ON Check for voltage to ground: Blown No. 10 (15A) fuse in the
There should be battery voltage. passengers under-dash fuse/relay box
An open in the wire
C4 WHT Ignition switch ON (II) Check for voltage to ground: Faulty transmission range switch
and shift lever in R There should be 1 V or less. An open in the wire
C5 BRN Ignition switch ON (II) There should be no battery voltage
and shift lever in 1 in any other shift lever position.
C6 RED Ignition switch ON (II)
and shift lever in D3
C7 BLU Ignition switch ON (II)
and shift lever in 2
C12 GRN/BLK Ignition switch ON (II) Check for voltage to ground: Faulty transmission range switch
and shift lever in D There should be battery voltage. Faulty PCM
An open in the wire
C13 YEL Ignition switch ON (II) Check for voltage to ground: Faulty transmission range switch
and shift lever in D There should be 1 V or less. An open in the wire
There should be no battery voltage
in any other shift lever position.
C15 BLK/BLU Shift lever in P Check for continuity to ground: Faulty transmission range switch
There should be no continuity in any An open in the wire
other shift lever position.
C16 RED/BLK Ignition switch ON (II) Check for voltage to ground:
and shift lever in N There should be 1 V or less.
There should be battery voltage in
any other shift lever position.
14-402
03/07/29 09:45:28 61S0X050_140_0406
2. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Terminal
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Position
P
D3
14-403
03/07/29 09:45:29 61S0X050_140_0407
14-404
03/07/29 09:45:31 61S0X050_140_0408
8. Install the transmission range switch (A) on the 12. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). Move the shift lever
control shaft (B), then secure it with the bolts. through all gears, and check the transmission
range switch synchronization with the A/T gear
NOTE: Do not move the transmission range switch position indicator.
when tightening the bolts.
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm
E (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
C
D
14-405
03/07/29 09:45:31 61S0X050_140_0409
A B
14-406
03/07/29 09:45:33 61S0X050_140_0410
MULTIPLEX CONTROL
UNIT (DRIVERS)
Shift Lock System Circuit
Troubleshooting, page 14-409 POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Input Test, page 14-414 BRAKE PEDAL POSITION SWITCH
14-407
03/07/29 09:45:34 61S0X050_140_0411
Circuit Diagram
DRIVERS
UNDERDASH STEERING LOCK WHT/YEL
IGNITION SWITCH FUSE/RELAY BOX ASSEMBLY
SHIFT LOCK
SOLENOID
2
YEL GRN WHT/RED
A12 B22 3
PG LG ATP P ILU
A2 B11 A15 B12 1
G401
TRANSMISSION A28 A32 C28 C27 C18
RANGE SWITCH
P POSITION ILU BK SW VCC2 TPS SG2
G401
A (24P) B (22P)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 3 4 5 8
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 22
14-408
03/07/29 09:45:34 61S0X050_140_0412
NOGo to step 5.
LG2 (BRN/YEL)
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF, and disconnect the
battery negative terminal.
LG1 (BRN/YEL) TPS (RED/BLK)
6. Disconnect PCM connectors A (32P) and B (25P). Wire side of female terminals
(contd)
14-409
03/07/29 09:45:35 61S0X050_140_0413
NOGo to step 15. 19. Check for continuity between shift lock solenoid
connector terminal No. 2 and multiplex control unit
15. Turn the ignition switch OFF. (drivers) connector terminal B22.
MULTIPLEX CONTROL UNIT
16. Disconnect PCM connector C (31P). (DRIVERS) 22P CONNECTOR B
Is there continuity?
14-410
03/07/29 09:45:36 61S0X050_140_0414
20. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 22. Connect the battery positive terminal to shift lock
solenoid connector terminal No. 1, and connect the
21. Measure the voltage between shift lock solenoid battery negative terminal to the terminal No. 2.
connector terminal No. 1 and body ground.
NOTE: Do not connect the terminal No. 2 to the
SHIFT LOCK SOLENOID battery positive terminal or you will damage the
CONNECTOR
diode inside the shift lock solenoid.
SHIFT LOCK SOLENOID
CONNECTOR
YEL
14-411
03/07/29 09:45:36 61S0X050_140_0415
WHT/YEL
KEY SWITCH CONNECTOR (7P)
Does the key interlock solenoid operate properly? 7. With the shift lever in P and pulled back toward the
driver, check for continuity between park pin switch
YESGo to step 5. connector terminals No. 1 and No. 3.
NOFaulty key interlock solenoid/switch. Replace
the ignition key cylinder/steering lock assembly. PARK PIN SWITCH CONNECTOR
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 8.
14-412
03/07/29 09:45:37 61S0X050_140_0416
WHT/RED
PARK PIN SWITCH
CONNECTOR
WHT/RED
Is there continuity?
YESGo to step 9.
BLK
Is there continuity?
14-413
03/07/29 09:45:37 61S0X050_140_0417
2. Inspect the connectors and connector terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
If the terminals look OK, go to step 3.
NOTE: If the shift lock solenoid clicks when the ignition switch is turned ON (II) while pressing the brake pedal with
the shift lever in the P position, the shift lock system is OK. If the shift lever cannot be shifted from the P position,
test the transmission range switch.
3. With the control unit still disconnected from its connectors and the fuse/relay box, make these input tests.
If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
If all the input tests prove OK, go to step 4.
4. Reconnect the connectors to the multiplex control unit, and make this input test.
If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
If all the input tests prove OK, substitute a known-good multiplex control unit, and recheck the system.
If the system is OK, the multiplex control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Cavity Wire Color Test Condition Test: Desired Result Possible Cause(If result is not obtained)
B12 WHT/RED Ignition switch Check for voltage to ground: Faulty brake pedal position
ON (II) and brake There should be battery voltage. switch
pedal pushed Faulty PCM
Ignition switch Check for voltage to ground: Faulty multiplex control unit
ON (II), brake pedal There should be 1 V or less. (drivers)
and accelerator An open in the wire
pedal pressed at
the same time
14-414
03/07/29 09:45:38 61S0X050_140_0418
1. Remove the steering lower cover (see page 17-25). 1. Remove the steering column upper cover (see page
17-25).
2. Disconnect the key switch connector (7P) from the
steering lock assembly. 2. Disconnect the shift lock solenoid 2P connector.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals No. 5
and No. 7 when the key is pushed, and check for no
continuity when the key is released.
14-415
03/07/29 09:45:39 61S0X050_140_0419
3. Remove the nut (A) securing the shift cable end (B),
then separate the shift cable (C) from the shift lever
assembly (D).
D E
B
10. Install the shift cable end to the shift lever. If
A C
necessary, adjust the shift cable (see step 5 on
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft) page 14-395).
A
C
8 x 1.25 mm
22 Nm
(2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
14-416
03/07/29 09:45:39 61S0X050_140_0420
14-417
03/07/29 09:45:41 61S0X050_140_0421
End Cover, 3rd Gear, Idler Gear, and 3rd Clutch Removal
Exploded View
A/T WIRE
HARNESS
TRANSMISSION
RANGE SWITCH
ATF FILTER LINE
BRACKET
END COVER
HARNESS
PARK PAWL CLAMP
3RD CLUTCH BRACKET
THRUST NEEDLE
BEARING A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
SPLINED CONTROL SOLENOID
WASHER VALVE C
COUNTERSHAFT
3RD GEAR
NEEDLE BEARING
THRUST
NEEDLE
BEARING
PARK GEAR
A/T CLUTCH PRESSURE
CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVES A and B
ATF HOSE
SEALING WASHERS
Replace. ATF LINE BOLT
14-418
03/07/29 09:45:41 61S0X050_140_0422
Special Tools Required 11. Slip the special tool onto the mainshaft.
Mainshaft holder
07GAB-PF50101 or 07GAB-PF50100
Adjustable bearing puller, 2540 mm
07736-A01000B or 07736-A01000A
3. Remove the A/T wire harness ground terminal from 12. Engage the park pawl with the park gear.
the connector bracket, and disconnect the 3rd
clutch transmission fluid pressure switch connector, 13. Cut the lock tabs (A) of each shaft locknut (B) using
then remove the connector bracket. a chisel (C). Then remove the locknuts and conical
spring washers from each shaft.
4. Remove the transmission range switch cover.
NOTE:
5. Remove the transmission range switch harness Countershaft and secondary shaft locknuts have
clamp bolts and harness clamp, then remove the left-hand threads.
transmission range switch. Clean the old locknut; they are used to install the
press fit mainshaft 3rd gear, secondary shaft
6. Remove the harness clamp bracket, ATF cooler line idler gear, park gear, and 3rd clutch assembly on
bolts (two), and lines. the countershaft.
Keep all of the chiseled particles out of the
7. Remove the line bolt, the ATF hose, and the ATF transmission.
filter line.
C
8. Remove the ATF filter line bracket and ATF filter.
Remove the ATF passage body if necessary.
A
9. Remove the A/T clutch pressure control solenoid
valve C.
(contd)
14-419
03/07/29 09:45:43 61S0X050_140_0423
End Cover, 3rd Gear, Idler Gear, and Park Lever Stop Inspection and
3rd Clutch Removal (contd) Adjustment
15. Remove the 3rd clutch assembly using the special 1. Set the park lever (A) in the P position.
tool and a commercially available 3/8-16 slide
hammer (A).
A
C
07736-A01000B or
07736-A01000A
D E
A
B
6 x 1.0 mm
14 Nm (1.4 kgfm, 10 lbfft)
16. Remove the splined washer, thrust needle bearing, 2. Measure the distance (B) between the park pawl
countershaft 3rd gear, needle bearing, and thrust shaft (C) and the park lever roller pin (D).
needle bearing from the countershaft.
Standard: 84.685.6 mm (3.333.37 in.)
17. Remove the mainshaft 3rd gear (A), secondary
shaft idler gear (B), and park gear (C) with a puller 3. If the measurement is out of tolerance, select and
(D). install the appropriate park lever stop (E) from the
table.
D
L1 L2
20. Remove A/T clutch pressure control solenoid 4. After replacing the park lever stop, make sure the
valves A and B. distance is within tolerance.
14-420
03/07/29 09:45:43 61S0X050_140_0424
1. Remove the oil seal (A) from the end cover (B). 1. Remove the oil seal from the end cover, then
remove the bearing.
A
2. Install the new oil seal flush to the end cover with
the special tools.
07749-0010000
2. Install the new bearing flush to the end cover with
the special tools.
07749-0010000
07746-0010800
07746-0010800
14-421
03/07/29 09:45:44 61S0X050_140_0425
B
B
E
E
F
C
F A
B
E
C
F
A C
A
2. Install the new O-ring (E) over the ATF feed pipe.
5. Secure the ATF feed pipe and feed pipe flange with
the snap ring.
14-422
03/07/29 09:45:45 61S0X050_140_0426
Transmission Housing
TRANSMISSION HANGER
COUNTERSHAFT
2ND GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT O-RING
REVERSE GEAR Replace.
NEEDLE
BEARING
REVERSE SELECTOR
OUTPUT SHAFT
TRANSMISSION (COUNTERSHAFT)
HANGER O-RING
Replace. SPEED SENSOR
REVERSE SELECTOR HUB
COUNTERSHAFT
5TH GEAR
REVERSE
IDLER GEAR
MAINSHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT SUBASSEMBLY
SUBASSEMBLY
TRANSMISSION HOUSING
GASKET
Replace.
COUNTERSHAFT
SUBASSEMBLY
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
(contd)
14-423
03/07/29 09:45:46 61S0X050_140_0427
Transmission Housing
A
D
B
6. Install the special tool over the mainshaft, then
remove the transmission housing (D).
NOTE: The transmission housing will not separate 9. Remove the lock bolt securing the shift fork, then
from the torque converter housing if the reverse remove the shift fork with the reverse selector.
idler gear is not moved. If the reverse selector hub is not press-fitted,
remove the reverse selector hub, countershaft 5th
gear, and needle bearing from the countershaft.
14-424
03/07/29 09:45:47 61S0X050_140_0428
A
B
B A
14-425
03/07/29 09:45:49 61S0X050_140_0429
Valve Body
6 x 1.0 mm,
Two Bolts
O-RING
Replace.
ATF FEED PIPES,
8 x 180.5 mm, REGULATOR
ATF Two Pipes VALVE BODY
STRAINER O-RING
Replace. STATOR SHAFT
6 x 1.0 mm, STATOR SHAFT STOP
Seven Bolts CONTROL
SHAFT DOWEL PINS,
Two Pins
REGULATOR
DETENT SEPARATOR PLATE
ATF FEED PIPES, ARM
8 x 62 mm, Two Pipes 6 x 1.0 mm,
One Bolt
TOP ACCUMULATOR 8 x 1.25 mm,
BODY Three Bolts
MAIN VALVE BODY
TOP ACCUMULATOR COOLER CHECK VALVE
SEPARATOR PLATE SPRING
DOWEL
PINS, COOLER CHECK VALVE
ATF FEED Two Pins ATF PUMP DRIVEN
PIPE, GEAR SHAFT
8 x 220 mm
ATF PUMP DRIVEN GEAR
SHIFT SOLENOID
VALVE C
ATF
FEED
PIPE
6 x 1.0 mm, SHIFT SOLENOID
Five Bolts VALVE A
6 x 1.0 mm,
Seven Bolts
SHIFT SOLENOID
ATF PUMP VALVE B
TORQUE CONVERTER DRIVE GEAR
CHECK VALVE TORQUE CONVERTER
ACCUMULATOR CLUTCH SOLENOID VALVE
BODY TORQUE CONVERTER
TORQUE CONVERTER CHECK VALVE SPRING
HOUSING
14-426
03/07/29 09:45:49 61S0X050_140_0430
NOTE: Refer to the exploded view as needed during the 16. Clean the inlet opening (A) of the ATF strainer (B)
following procedure. thoroughly with compressed air, then check that it
is in good condition and that the inlet opening is
1. Remove the ATF feed pipes from the regulator not clogged.
valve body, servo body, top accumulator body, and
accumulator body.
10. Unhook the detent spring from the detent arm, then
remove the detent arm shaft, detent arm, and
control shaft.
14-427
03/07/29 09:45:50 61S0X050_140_0431
Valve Body
1. Soak a sheet of 600 abrasive paper in ATF for 6. Coat the valve with ATF, then drop it into its bore. It
about 30 minutes. should drop to the bottom of the bore under its
own weight. If not, repeat steps 4 and 5, then retest.
2. Carefully tap the valve body so the sticking valve If the valve still sticks, replace the valve body.
drops out of its bore. It may be necessary to use a
small screwdriver to pry the valve free. Be careful
not to scratch the bore with the screwdriver.
3. Inspect the valve for any scuff marks. Use the ATF-
soaked 600 paper to polish off any burrs that are
on the valve, then wash the valve in solvent and
dry it with compressed air.
14-428
03/07/29 09:45:50 61S0X050_140_0432
3. Install all the springs and seats. Insert the spring (A)
in the valve, then install the valve in the valve body
(B). Push the spring in with a screwdriver, then
install the spring seat (C).
A
B
14-429
03/07/29 09:45:51 61S0X050_140_0433
Valve Body
2. Do not use a magnet to remove the check ball, it may magnetize the ball.
3. Check all valves for free movement. If any fail to slide freely, refer to Valve Body Repair (see page 14-428).
SPRING
SEAT KICK-DOWN VALVE
SHIFT VALVE D
MODULATOR
VALVE
FILTER CHECK BALL
Install in this
direction.
REVERSE CPC
VALVE MAIN VALVE BODY
Inspect for scoring
and damage.
VALVE
SLEEVE RELIEF
VALVE
VALVE
CAP
LOCK-UP SHIFT
VALVE
COOLER CHECK
VALVE (BALL)
TORQUE CONVERTER
CHECK VALVE
MANUAL VALVE SERVO CONTROL
VALVE
14-430
03/07/29 09:45:51 61S0X050_140_0434
Sectional View
FILTER
CHECK BALL
MANUAL VALVE
SPRING SPECIFICATIONS
No. Spring Standard (New)-Unit: mm (in.)
Wire Dia. O.D. Free Length No. of Coils
Shift valve D spring 0.7 (0.028) 6.6 (0.260) 33.7 (1.327) 11.6
Shift valve C spring 0.8 (0.031) 6.6 (0.260) 49.1 (1.933) 21.7
Kick-down valve spring 0.8 (0.031) 6.6 (0.260) 49.1 (1.933) 21.7
Modulator valve spring 1.6 (0.063) 10.4 (0.409) 33.5 (1.319) 9.8
Relief valve spring 1.2 (0.047) 11.1 (0.437) 39.0 (1.535) 9.9
Lock-up shift valve spring 0.9 (0.035) 7.6 (0.299) 63.0 (2.480) 22.4
Cooler check valve spring 0.6 (0.024) 5.8 (0.228) 14.5 (0.571) 6.8
Torque converter check valve spring 1.2 (0.047) 8.6 (0.339) 34.4 (1.354) 11.7
Servo control valve spring 0.9 (0.035) 6.4 (0.252) 32.5 (1.280) 17.5
Reverse CPC valve spring 0.7 (0.028) 6.1 (0.240) 17.8 (0.701) 7.9
14-431
03/07/29 09:45:52 61S0X050_140_0435
Valve Body
A B
14-432
03/07/29 09:45:52 61S0X050_140_0436
2. Check all valves for free movement. If any fail to slide freely, refer to Valve Body Repair (see page 14-428).
3. Replace the valve body as an assembly if any parts are worn or damaged.
4. Hold the regulator spring cap in place while removing the stop bolt. The regulator spring cap is spring loaded.
Once the stop bolt is removed, release the spring cap slowly so it does not pop out.
5. Reassembly is the reverse of the disassembly. Install the filter in the direction shown.
7. Align the hole in the regulator spring cap with the hole in the valve body, then press the spring cap into the valve
body, and tighten the stop bolt.
REGULATOR VALVE
REGULATOR SPRING CAP
STOP BOLT
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm
(1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
VALVE CAP
FILTER
Install in this direction.
VALVE SLEEVE
SPRING SPECIFICATIONS
No. Spring Standard (New)-Unit: mm (in.)
Wire Dia. O.D. Free Length No. of Coils
Stator reaction spring 5.5 (0.217) 37.4 (1.472) 30.3 (1.193) 2.1
Regulator valve spring A 1.9 (0.075) 14.7 (0.579) 80.6 (3.173) 16.1
Regulator valve spring B 1.6 (0.063) 9.2 (0.362) 44.0 (1.732) 12.5
Lock-up control valve spring 0.7 (0.028) 6.6 (0.260) 42.9 (1.689) 14.2
Lock-up timing valve spring 0.65 (0.026) 6.6 (0.260) 34.8 (1.370) 15.6
14-433
03/07/29 09:45:53 61S0X050_140_0437
Valve Body
2. Check all valves for free movement. If any fail to slide freely, refer to Valve Body Repair (see page 14-428).
3. Replace the valve body as an assembly if any parts are worn or damaged.
CPC VALVE B
SHIFT VALVE B
CPC VALVE A VALVE CAP
SERVO BODY
Inspect for scoring
and damage.
VALVE CAP CLIP
SPRING SEAT
SHIFT VALVE A
SERVO VALVE/
O-RING SHIFT FORK SHAFT
Replace.
SPRING SPECIFICATIONS
No. Spring Standard (New)-Unit: mm (in.)
Wire Dia. O.D. Free Length No. of Coils
CPC valve A spring 0.7 (0.028) 6.1 (0.240) 17.8 (0.701) 7.9
CPC valve B spring 0.7 (0.028) 6.1 (0.240) 17.8 (0.701) 7.9
Shift valve B spring 0.8 (0.031) 6.6 (0.260) 49.1 (1.933) 21.7
Shift valve A spring 0.8 (0.031) 6.6 (0.260) 49.1 (1.933) 21.7
14-434
03/07/29 09:45:53 61S0X050_140_0438
2. Check all valves for free movement. If any fail to slide freely, refer to Valve Body Repair (see page 14-428).
3. Replace the valve body as an assembly if any parts are worn or damaged.
SPRING SEAT
O-RING
Replace.
1ST-HOLD ACCUMULATOR
PISTON
O-RING
Replace.
O-RING O-RING
Replace. Replace.
SNAP RINGS
SPRING SPECIFICATIONS
No. Springs Standard (New)-Unit: mm (in.)
Wire Dia. O.D. Free Length No. of Coils
CPC valve C spring 0.7 (0.028) 6.1 (0.240) 17.8 (0.701) 7.9
Shift valve E spring 0.8 (0.031) 7.1 (0.280) 49.0 (1.929) 17.2
5th accumulator spring A 2.2 (0.087) 16.4 (0.646) 75.7 (2.980) 14.2
5th accumulator spring B 2.0 (0.079) 10.0 (0.394) 45.5 (1.791) 11.6
4th/1st-hold accumulator spring 3.4 (0.134) 19.6 (0.772) 57.4 (2.260) 8.4
14-435
03/07/29 09:45:54 61S0X050_140_0439
Valve Body
2. Clean all parts thoroughly in solvent or carburetor cleaner, and dry them with compressed air. Blow out all
passages.
ACCUMULATOR BODY
Inspect for scoring and damage.
CHECK BALLS, 2
O-RING
Replace.
O-RING
Replace.
SNAP RINGS
SPRING SPECIFICATIONS
No. Springs Standard (New)-Unit: mm (in.)
Wire Dia. O.D. Free Length No. of Coils
1st accumulator spring B 2.3 (0.091) 12.6 (0.496) 42.0 (1.654) 9.9
1st accumulator spring A 2.4 (0.094) 19.5 (0.768) 67.7 (2.665) 10.2
2nd accumulator spring B 2.6 (0.102) 13.2 (0.520) 44.0 (1.732) 8.5
2nd accumulator spring A 2.3 (0.091) 19.6 (0.772) 57.7 (2.272) 6.6
14-436
03/07/29 09:45:54 61S0X050_140_0440
END COVER
O-RING
Replace.
SNAP RING
SPRING SPECIFICATIONS
No. Springs Standard (New)-Unit: mm (in.)
Wire Dia. O.D. Free Length No. of Coils
3rd accumulator spring 3.1 (0.122) 19.6 (0.772) 39.4 (1.551) 5.5
14-437
03/07/29 09:45:55 61S0X050_140_0441
07746-0010600
07736-A01000B or
07736-A01000A
07749-0010000
07746-0010500
14-438
03/07/29 09:45:56 61S0X050_140_0442
07736-A01000B or
07736-A01000A A
07736-A01000B or
07736-A01000A
2. Install the ATF guide plate (A). A
07746-0010500
B
00.03 mm 07947-6340500
(00.001 in.) B
A
C 00.03 mm
(00.001 in.)
C A
3. Install the new bearing (B) into the housing (C) with
the special tools.
3. Install the new bearing (B) into the housing (C) with
the special tools.
14-439
03/07/29 09:45:56 61S0X050_140_0443
07749-0010000
07746-0010800
14-440
03/07/29 09:45:57 61S0X050_140_0444
4TH GEAR
NEEDLE BEARINGS
IDLER GEAR
O-RINGS
Replace.
THRUST SHIM, 41 x 73 mm
Selective part
SEALING RINGS,
32 mm 4TH GEAR
NEEDLE BEARING
SET RING
NEEDLE BEARING
3. Inspect the thrust needle bearing and the needle bearing for galling and rough movement.
6. Before installing the O-rings, wrap the shaft splines with tape to prevent O-ring damage.
7. Install the conical spring washer and 41 x 73 mm thrust shim in the direction shown.
8. Inspect the condition of the sealing rings. If the sealing rings are worn, distorted, or damaged, replace them (see
page 14-443).
14-441
03/07/29 09:45:58 61S0X050_140_0445
C
Standard: 0.030.11 mm (0.0010.004 in.)
B C
A E
THRUST SHIM, 41 x 73 mm
No. Part Number Thickness
1 90414-P7W-000 7.85 mm (0.309 in.)
2 90415-P7W-000 7.90 mm (0.311 in.)
3 90416-P7W-000 7.95 mm (0.313 in.)
4 90417-P7W-000 8.00 mm (0.315 in.)
5 90418-P7W-000 8.05 mm (0.317 in.)
6 90419-P7W-000 8.10 mm (0.319 in.)
14-442
03/07/29 09:45:58 61S0X050_140_0446
14-443
03/07/29 09:45:59 61S0X050_140_0447
2ND GEAR
CONICAL SPRING
WASHER
BALL BEARING Replace.
NEEDLE BEARING
THRUST NEEDLE O-RINGS
BEARING Replace.
REVERSE
SELECTOR SPLINED WASHER,
REVERSE 31 x 63.5 mm
5TH GEAR SELECTOR HUB Selective part
NEEDLE BEARING
DISTANCE COLLAR,
35 x 47 x 7.8 mm 3RD GEAR
SNAP RING, 31 mm
NEEDLE BEARING
DISTANCE COLLAR,
35 x 47 x 45.6 mm
THRUST NEEDLE
COTTERS, 31 mm BEARING
PARK GEAR
4TH GEAR
TRANSMISSION
HOUSING BEARING
1ST GEAR
COUNTERSHAFT
2. Remove the reverse selector hub, 4th gear, and 1st gear (see page 14-445).
3. Check the bearing on the 3rd clutch for wear and rough movement. If the bearing is worn or damaged, replace it
(see page 14-447).
4. Inspect the thrust needle bearing and the needle bearing for galling and rough movement.
6. Check the shaft bearing surfaces for scoring and excessive wear.
7. Lubricate all parts with ATF, and reassemble the shafts and gears.
8. Install the distance collars, reverse selector hub, reverse selector, splined washer, and conical spring washer in
the direction shown.
14-444
03/07/29 09:46:00 61S0X050_140_0448
NOTE: Some reverse selector hubs are not press- 3. Remove the 1st gear (A) and 4th gear (B) from the
fitted, and can be removed without using a press. countershaft with a press. Place a shaft protector
(C) between the countershaft and press to prevent
damaging the countershaft.
C
14-445
03/07/29 09:46:00 61S0X050_140_0449
2. Install the 1st gear on the countershaft by hand. 6. Slide the reverse selector hub (B) over the
countershaft (C), and then press it into place with
3. Align the shaft splines with those on 4th gear, then the special tool and a press.
press the countershaft (A) into the 4th gear with a
press. Place a shaft protector (B) between the NOTE: Some reverse selector hubs are not press-
countershaft and press to prevent damaging the fitted, and can be installed without using the
countershaft. special tool and a press.
07746-0030100
B
A
C
A
14-446
03/07/29 09:46:00 61S0X050_140_0450
B C
D A
07749-0010000
07746-0010500
14-447
03/07/29 09:46:01 61S0X050_140_0451
BALL BEARING
THRUST NEEDLE
BEARING CONICAL SPRING WASHER
SECONDARY SHAFT Replace.
THRUST NEEDLE
BEARING
NEEDLE BEARINGS
1ST-HOLD
CLUTCH HUB
THRUST SHIM, 37 x 55 mm
Selective part
1ST CLUTCH
HUB
1ST/1ST-HOLD/2ND CLUTCH
ASSEMBLY
1ST GEAR O-RINGS
Replace.
NEEDLE BEARINGS
SPLINED WASHER,
38 x 56.5 mm
THRUST NEEDLE Selective part
BEARING
COTTERS, 32 mm
COTTER RETAINER
SNAP RING
SEALING RINGS, 35 mm
2. Inspect the thrust needle bearing and needle bearing for galling and rough movement.
5. Check the shaft bearing surfaces for scoring and excessive wear.
6. Check the idler gear bearing for wear and rough movement. If the bearing is worn or damaged, replace it (see
page 14-451).
7. Before installing the O-rings, wrap the shaft splines with tape to prevent damage to the O-rings.
9. Install the conical spring washer and splined washer in the direction shown.
14-448
03/07/29 09:46:02 61S0X050_140_0452
J
A F E
D
B
J
(contd)
14-449
03/07/29 09:46:03 61S0X050_140_0453
G
F
C G
A I
A
14-450
03/07/29 09:46:03 61S0X050_140_0454
07GAD-SD40101
A B
14-451
03/07/29 09:46:04 61S0X050_140_0455
A
1. Remove the 1st-hold clutch hub (A) from the 1st
gear (B) with the special tools and a press.
07749-0010000
B 07947-6340500
A
C B
2. If any problem occurs on the 1st gear one-way 2. Remove the 1st clutch hub (C) from the 1st gear,
clutch, replace the 1st clutch hub (C). The 1st gear then install the new 1st clutch hub in the 1st gear.
one-way clutch is not available separately from the
1st clutch hub. 3. Install the 1st-hold clutch hub (A) in the 1st gear (B)
with the special tools and a press.
07GAD-SD40101
07749-0010000
14-452
03/07/29 09:46:05 61S0X050_140_0456
Clutch Disassembly
Special Tools Required 3. Install the special tools on the 4th/5th clutch
Clutch spring compressor attachment assembly and 1st clutch.
07LAE-PX40100
07LAE-PX40100
Clutch spring compressor attachment
07HAE-PL50101
Clutch spring compressor bolt assembly
07GAE-PG40200 or 07GAE-PG4020A
07LAE-PX40100 or
07HAE-PL50101
07GAE-PG40200 or
07GAE-PG4020A
(contd)
14-453
03/07/29 09:46:06 61S0X050_140_0457
C
A C
14-454
03/07/29 09:46:07 61S0X050_140_0458
Clutch Inspection
1st/1st-hold/2nd Clutch
1. Inspect the clutch piston and clutch piston check valve. If the clutch check valve is loose or stuck damaged, replace
the clutch piston.
SNAP RING
CLUTCH DISCS,
Six Discs
Standard thickness:
1ST CLUTCH 1.94 mm (0.076 in.)
O-RINGS PISTON
Replace.
CLUTCH PLATES,
O-RINGS Six Plates
CHECK VALVE Standard thickness:
Replace.
1.6 mm (0.063 in.)
1ST-HOLD
CLUTCH PISTON
CHECK VALVE
RETURN SPRING
SPRING RETAINER
SNAP RING
CLUTCH PLATES,
Three Plates SNAP RING
Standard thickness:
1.8 mm (0.071 in.)
SPRING RETAINER
CLUTCH DISCS,
Three Discs
Standard thickness:
1.94 mm (0.076 in.) RETURN SPRING
1ST-HOLD
CLUTCH 2ND CLUTCH PISTON
PLATE B
CLUTCH PLATES,
Five Plates
Standard thickness:
1.6 mm (0.063 in.)
CLUTCH DISCS,
Five Discs
Standard thickness:
1.94 mm (0.076 in.)
CLUTCH END PLATE 1ST/1ST-HOLD CLUTCH
DRUM
SNAP RING
3. Inspect the clutch discs, clutch plates, and clutch end plate for wear, damage, and discoloration.
If the clutch discs are worn or damaged, replace the discs as a set.
If the clutch plates are worn, damaged, or discolored, replace the plates as a set.
If the clutch end plate is worn, damaged, or discolored, inspect the clutch end-plate-to-top-disc clearance, then
replace the clutch-end-plate.
If the 1st-hold clutch plate B is worn, damaged, or discoloration, inspect the 1st-hold clutch plate B-to-top-disc
clearance, then replace plate B.
(contd)
14-455
03/07/29 09:46:08 61S0X050_140_0459
CLUTCH DRUM
O-RINGS
Replace.
CHECK VALVE
CLUTCH PISTON
DISC SPRING
RETURN SPRING
SPRING RETAINER
SNAP RING
CLUTCH PLATES,
Five Plates
Standard thickness:
2.3 mm (0.091 in.)
CLUTCH DISCS,
Five Discs
Standard thickness:
1.94 mm (0.076 in.)
SNAP RING
3. Inspect the clutch discs, clutch plates, and clutch end plate for wear, damage, and discoloration.
If the clutch discs are worn or damaged, replace the discs as a set.
If the clutch plates are worn, damaged, or discolored, replace the plates as a set.
If the clutch end plate is worn, damaged, or discolored, inspect the clutch end-plate-to-top-disc clearance, then
replace the clutch-end-plate.
4. If the 3rd clutch assembly, clutch discs, or clutch plates are replaced, replace the PCM (see page 11-4).
14-456
03/07/29 09:46:09 61S0X050_140_0460
4th/5th Clutch
1. Inspect the clutch piston and clutch piston check valve. If the clutch check valve is loose or stuck damaged, replace
the clutch piston.
SNAP RING
CLUTCH DISCS,
Four Discs
Standard thickness:
1.94 mm (0.076 in.)
CLUTCH PLATES,
Four Plates
Standard thickness:
O-RINGS 4TH CLUTCH PISTON 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
Replace.
RETURN SPRING
SNAP RING
SPRING RETAINER
SPRING RETAINER
SNAP RING
RETURN SPRING
DISC SPRING
CLUTCH END
PLATE
4TH CLUTCH DRUM
SNAP RING
3. Inspect the clutch discs, clutch plates, and clutch end plate for wear, damage, and discoloration.
If the clutch discs are worn or damaged, replace the discs as a set.
If the clutch plates are worn, damaged, or discolored, replace the plates as a set.
If the clutch end plate is worn, damaged, or discolored, inspect the clutch end-plate-to-top-disc clearance, then
replace the clutch-end-plate.
14-457
03/07/29 09:46:09 61S0X050_140_0461
Clutch Reassembly
Special Tools Required 3. Install new O-rings (A) on the piston (B).
Clutch spring compressor attachment
07LAE-PX40100 A
A
Clutch spring compressor attachment
07HAE-PL50101
Clutch spring compressor bolt assembly
07GAE-PG40200 or 07GAE-PG4020A
Clutch compressor attachment B
07ZAE-PRP0100
A
4. Install the piston (A) in the clutch drum (B). Apply
pressure and rotate to ensure proper seating.
Lubricate the piston O-ring with ATF before
installing. Do not pinch the O-ring by installing the
piston with too much force.
A
14-458
03/07/29 09:46:10 61S0X050_140_0462
5. Check the 1st-hold clutch plate-to-top-disc 9. Install the special tools on the clutch assembly.
clearance; starting with a clutch plate, alternately 07LAE-PX40100
install the clutch plate and discs in the 1st-hold
clutch drum, then install the 1st-hold clutch plate.
07LAE-PX40100 or
C 07HAE-PL50101
07GAE-PG40200 or
A 07GAE-PG4020A
(contd)
14-459
03/07/29 09:46:11 61S0X050_140_0463
14-460
03/07/29 09:46:12 61S0X050_140_0464
16. Install the disc spring in the 1st, 3rd, 4th, and 5th 19. Install the snap ring (A) with a screwdriver (B).
clutches in the direction shown. B
20. Set a dial indicator (A) on the clutch end plate (B).
A
21. Zero the indicator with the clutch end plate lifted up
to the snap ring (C).
(contd)
14-461
03/07/29 09:46:12 61S0X050_140_0465
A
D
14-462
03/07/29 09:46:12 61S0X050_140_0466
14-463
03/07/29 09:46:14 61S0X050_140_0467
Valve Body
6 x 1.0 mm,
Two Bolts
O-RING
Replace.
ATF FEED PIPES,
8 x 180.5 mm, REGULATOR
ATF Two Pipes VALVE BODY
STRAINER O-RING
Replace. STATOR SHAFT
6 x 1.0 mm, STATOR SHAFT STOP
Seven Bolts CONTROL
SHAFT DOWEL PINS,
Two Pins
REGULATOR
DETENT SEPARATOR PLATE
ATF FEED PIPES, ARM
8 x 62 mm, Two Pipes 6 x 1.0 mm,
One Bolt
TOP ACCUMULATOR 8 x 1.25 mm,
BODY Three Bolts
MAIN VALVE BODY
TOP ACCUMULATOR COOLER CHECK VALVE
SEPARATOR PLATE SPRING
DOWEL
PINS, COOLER CHECK VALVE
ATF FEED Two Pins ATF PUMP DRIVEN
PIPE, GEAR SHAFT
8 x 220 mm
ATF PUMP DRIVEN GEAR
SHIFT SOLENOID
VALVE C
ATF
FEED
PIPE
6 x 1.0 mm, SHIFT SOLENOID
Five Bolts VALVE A
6 x 1.0 mm,
Seven Bolts
SHIFT SOLENOID
ATF PUMP VALVE B
TORQUE CONVERTER DRIVE GEAR
CHECK VALVE TORQUE CONVERTER
ACCUMULATOR CLUTCH SOLENOID VALVE
BODY TORQUE CONVERTER
TORQUE CONVERTER CHECK VALVE SPRING
HOUSING
14-464
03/07/29 09:46:15 61S0X050_140_0468
1. Install the main separator plate (A) and three dowel 4. Install the torque converter check valve and spring,
pins on the torque converter housing. Then install and the cooler check valve and spring on the main
the ATF pump drive gear (B), driven gear (C), and valve body, then install the two dowel pins and the
ATF pump driven gear shaft (D). Install the ATF regulator separator plate.
pump driven gear with its grooved and chamfered
side facing down. 5. Install the stator shaft and stator shaft stop.
B
6. Install the regulator valve body (eight bolts).
C
F G
A
9. Install the detent arm (C) and arm shaft (D) in the
main valve body (E), then hook the detent arm
spring (F) to the detent arm.
14-465
03/07/29 09:46:16 61S0X050_140_0469
Transmission Housing
TRANSMISSION HOUSING
TRANSMISSION HANGER
COUNTERSHAFT
2ND GEAR O-RING
Replace.
COUNTERSHAFT 6 x 1.0 mm
REVERSE GEAR 12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
8.7 lbfft)
NEEDLE
BEARING ATF DIPSTICK
GUIDE PIPE
6 x 1.0 mm
14 Nm (1.4 kgfm,
10 lbfft)
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm,
LOCK WASHER 8.7 lbfft)
Replace.
REVERSE
SELECTOR O-RING OUTPUT SHAFT
TRANSMISSION Replace. (COUNTERSHAFT)
REVERSE SELECTOR HUB HANGER SPEED SENSOR
COUNTERSHAFT
5TH GEAR
REVERSE
IDLER GEAR
MAINSHAFT
SECONDARY SHAFT SUBASSEMBLY
SUBASSEMBLY
TRANSMISSION HOUSING
GASKET
Replace.
COUNTERSHAFT
SUBASSEMBLY
DIFFERENTIAL ASSEMBLY
14-466
03/07/29 09:46:17 61S0X050_140_0470
NOTE: Refer to the exploded view as needed during the 6. Place the thrust washer (A) in the transmission
following procedure. housing.
1. Install the differential assembly in the torque
converter housing.
4. Turn the shift fork shaft (A) so the large chamfered 7. Place the reverse idler gear (A) in the transmission
hole is facing the fork bolt hole. Then install the housing as shown, then slide it in the direction
shift fork (B) and reverse selector (C) together on shown.
the shift fork shaft and countershaft (D). Secure the
shift fork to the shift fork shaft with the lock bolt (E)
and a new lock washer (F), then bend the lock
washer against the bolt head.
E
6 x 1.0 mm
14 Nm (1.4 kgfm, 10 lbfft)
F A
B
(contd)
14-467
03/07/29 09:46:19 61S0X050_140_0471
Transmission Housing
10 x 1.25 mm
C 44 Nm (4.5 kgfm, 33 lbfft) 13. Engage the reverse idler gear with the countershaft
A 17 Bolts reverse gear and mainshaft reverse gear. Then
H install the needle bearings (A), reverse idler gear
shaft (B), and thrust washer (C) in the reverse idler
gear, and install the reverse idler gear shaft holder
(D) on the transmission housing.
I
8 x 1.25 mm
26 Nm (2.7 kgfm,
20 lbfft)
G
I
J
D
D D
6 x 1.0 mm B
E 9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft)
C
D
A
14-468
03/07/29 09:46:20 61S0X050_140_0472
End Cover, 3rd Gear, Idler Gear, and 3rd Clutch Installation
Special Tools Required 4. Remove the locknut and collar.
Mainshaft holder
07GAB-PF50101 or 07GAB-PF50100 5. Install the thrust needle bearing (A), needle bearing
Adjustable bearing puller, 2540 mm (B), 3rd gear (C), thrust needle bearing (D),
07736-A01000B or 07736-A01000A 31 x 63.5 mm splined washer (E), 3rd clutch
assembly (F), and old conical spring washer (G) on
1. Install the park lever (A) and park lever stop (B), on the countershaft (H). Tighten the old locknut (I) to
the control shaft (C), then install the lock bolt (D) 226 Nm (23.0 kgfm, 166 lbfft).
with a new lock washer (E). Do not bend the lock
tab of the lock washer until step 28. NOTE: Use a torque wrench to tighten the locknut.
Do not use an impact wrench.
A
I
B
G
E
F
D
C
D
6 x 1.0 mm
14 Nm (1.4 kgfm, 10 lbfft) C
2. Lubricate the following parts with ATF:
B
3. Install the park gear (A) using the old locknut (B)
and a collar (C). Hold the park pawl (D) against the
park gear, then tighten the old locknut until the
shaft splines come out over the park gear splines.
NOTE: H
Do not use an impact wrench.
Countershaft locknut has left-hand threads.
C B
D
A
(contd)
14-469
03/07/29 09:46:21 61S0X050_140_0473
End Cover, 3rd Gear, Idler Gear, and 3rd Clutch Installation (contd)
6. Set the dial indicator (A) to the countershaft 3rd 8. Remove the locknut and conical spring washer.
gear (B).
9. Remove the 3rd clutch assembly (A) with the
special tool and a commercially available 3/8-16
A slide hammer (B).
Standard: 0.0150.045 mm (0.00060.0018 in.) 11. Install the special tool onto the mainshaft.
07GAB-PF50101 or
07GAB-PF50100
14-470
03/07/29 09:46:22 61S0X050_140_0474
12. Lubricate the following parts with ATF: 16. If the 3rd gear axial clearance is out of standard
(measured in step 7), measure the difference of the
Splines of the mainshaft 3rd gear and secondary 31 x 63.5 mm splined washer, and select the
shaft idler gear. appropriate splined washer from the table.
Threads of the mainshaft and secondary shaft.
Threads of the old mainshaft and secondary shaft
locknuts.
Old conical spring washer.
13. Install the mainshaft 3rd gear (A) and the old
conical spring washer (B) on the mainshaft (C).
Tighten the old locknut (D) to seat the 3rd gear to
226 Nm (23.0 kgfm, 166 lbfft).
SPLINED WASHER, 31 x 63.5 mm
NOTE: Use a torque wrench to tighten the locknut. Mark Part Number Difference
Do not use an impact wrench. A 90520-P7W-000 3.503 mm (0.1379 in.)
B 90521-P7W-000 3.490 mm (0.1374 in.)
H F C 90522-P7W-000 3.477 mm (0.1369 in.)
E D 90523-P7W-000 3.464 mm (0.1364 in.)
NOTE:
C
Use a torque wrench to tighten the locknut. Do
not use an impact wrench. B
Secondary shaft locknut has left-hand threads. A
(contd)
14-471
03/07/29 09:46:23 61S0X050_140_0475
End Cover, 3rd Gear, Idler Gear, and 3rd Clutch Installation (contd)
20. Remove the old locknut and old conical spring 26. Set the park lever in P position, then verify that the
washer from the countershaft. park pawl (A) engages the park gear (B).
21. Lubricate the threads of each shaft, the new
locknuts, and new conical spring washers with ATF.
A B B
C
A
A
E
6 x 1.0 mm F
A 14 Nm (1.4 kgfm, 10 lbfft)
27. If the park pawl does not engage fully, check the
distance between the pawl shaft (C) and the park
23. Tighten the locknuts to 167 Nm (17.0 kgfm, lever roller pin (D) (see page 14-420).
123 lbfft).
28. Tighten the lock bolt (E), and bend the lock tab of
NOTE: the lock washer (F) against the lock bolt head.
Use a torque wrench to tighten the locknuts. Do
not use an impact wrench.
Countershaft and secondary shaft locknuts have
left-hand threads.
14-472
03/07/29 09:46:24 61S0X050_140_0476
29. Install the new gasket (A) on the transmission 33. Install the 8 x 12 mm ATF feed pipe (A) with its filter
housing, and install the two dowel pins (B) and new side into the transmission housing.
O-rings (C) over the top of the ATF feed pipes.
C 6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm
6 x 1.0 mm 6 x 1.0 mm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
12 Nm 12 Nm A
(1.2 kgfm, E (1.2 kgfm, B
8.7 lbfft) 8.7 lbfft)
G
D K
F
C
B H
I
E
B F 6 x 1.0 mm
D 12 Nm
A 6 x 1.0 mm (1.2 kgfm,
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft) 8.7 lbfft)
37. Install the new O-rings (H) over the feed pipes, and
install the 8 x 40 mm ATF feed pipe (I).
(contd)
14-473
03/07/29 09:46:25 61S0X050_140_0477
End Cover, 3rd Gear, Idler Gear, and 3rd Clutch Installation (contd)
39. Place the new ATF passage body gasket (A) on the 40. Install the new ATF filter (A) on the transmission
transmission housing, then install the 8 x 14 mm housing.
dowel pin (B) and the 10 x 25.5 mm ATF feed pipe
H
(C) with the new O-ring (D). Install the ATF passage 6 x 1.0 mm
body (E) on the transmission housing, if it was G 9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
6 x 1.0 mm
removed. 9.8 Nm C E
(1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft) 6 x 1.0 mm
9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft) D
B E
F
B
A
22 Nm
C L (2.2 kgfm,
A D 16 lbfft)
6 x 1.0 mm J
I 28 Nm
12 Nm
(1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft) (2.9 kgfm,
K 21 lbfft)
41. Install the filter line bracket (B) on the ATF filter,
and loosely install the bolts (C).
42. Install the new O-ring (D) to the filter line (E), then
install the filter line on the ATF filter.
43. Secure the end of the filter line on the bracket (F)
with the bolt (G).
44. Secure the filter line on the filter line bracket with
the bolts (H).
45. Tighten the bolts (C) on the filter line bracket to the
specified torque.
46. Install the ATF hose (I) and line bolt (J) with the new
sealing washers (K).
14-474
03/07/29 09:46:26 61S0X050_140_0478
48. Install the ATF cooler lines (A) with the new sealing 50. Set the control shaft (A) to the N position by turning
washers (B) and the line bolts, then install the it.
harness clamp bracket (C).
NOTE: Be careful not to squeeze the end of the
A 6 x 1.0 mm
9.8 Nm
control shaft tips together when turning into
(1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft) position. If the tips are squeezed together it will
cause a faulty signal or position due to the play
A
between the control shaft and the switch.
Clearance: 2 mm (0.08 in.)
12 x 1.25 mm A
28 Nm B
(2.9 kgfm,
21 lbfft)
8 x 1.25 mm
26 Nm (2.6 kgfm, 20 lbfft)
6 x 1.0 mm
9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
D
B
(contd)
14-475
03/07/29 09:46:27 61S0X050_140_0479
End Cover, 3rd Gear, Idler Gear, and 3rd Clutch Installation (contd)
53. Connect the 3rd clutch pressure switch connector
(A) and A/T wire harness ground terminal (B) on the
connector bracket (C), then install the clips (D) on
the bracket (E).
6 x 1.0 mm
12 Nm (1.2 kgfm, 8.7 lbfft)
6 x 1.0 mm
9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
A
D
G
B
H D
C E
55. Install the ATF temperature sensor (G) with the new
O-ring (H), then secure the harness with the bolts.
Connect the sensor connector to the A/T wire
harness connector, then install it on the connector
bracket (C).
14-476
03/07/29 09:46:29 61S0X050_140_0480
A/T Differential
CARRIER BEARING
Replacement, page 14-478
DIFFERENTIAL CARRIER
Backlash Inspection,
page 14-477
CARRIER BEARING
Replacement, page 14-478
THRUST WASHER
14-477
03/07/29 09:46:30 61S0X050_140_0481
A/T Differential
NOTE:
Press the bearing on until it bottoms.
Use the small end of the special tool to install the
bearing.
Press the bearing on securely so there is no
clearance between the bearing and the
differential carrier.
07LAD-PW50601
14-478
03/07/29 09:46:31 61S0X050_140_0482
07GAD-PG40101 or
07GAD-PG40100
A B
07JAD-PH80101
A B
14-479
03/07/29 09:46:31 61S0X050_140_0483
A/T Differential
D C
07NAD-PX40100
07749-0010000
07NAD-PX40100
14-480
03/07/29 09:46:32 61S0X050_140_0484
E
5. Drive in the outer race with the special tools.
07749-0010000
C
07NAD-PX40100
B
A 6. Check that there is no clearance between the thrust
washer, outer race, shim, and transmission
2. Replace the tapered roller bearing when the outer housing.
race is to be replaced.
(contd)
14-481
03/07/29 09:46:33 61S0X050_140_0485
A/T Differential
Standard:
New bearing: 2.73.9 Nm
G (2840 kgfcm, 2435 lbfin.)
Reused bearings: 2.53.6 Nm
(2537 kgfcm, 2232 lbfin.)
A
F B
G
E
C
B 07YAJ-S3V0100
14-482
03/07/29 09:46:34 61S0X050_140_0486
THRUST SHIM, 81 mm
No. Part Number Thickness
A 41438-P7T-700 2.05 mm (0.081 in.)
AA 41438-PGH-000 2.075 mm (0.082 in.)
B 41439-P7T-700 2.10 mm (0.083 in.)
BB 41439-PGH-000 2.125 mm (0.084 in.)
C 41440-P7T-700 2.15 mm (0.085 in.)
CC 41440-PGH-000 2.175 mm (0.086 in.)
D 41441-P7T-000 2.20 mm (0.087 in.)
DD 41441-PGH-000 2.225 mm (0.088 in.)
E 41442-P7T-000 2.25 mm (0.089 in.)
EE 41442-PGH-000 2.275 mm (0.090 in.)
F 41443-P7T-000 2.30 mm (0.091 in.)
FF 41443-PGH-000 2.325 mm (0.092 in.)
G 41444-P7T-000 2.35 mm (0.093 in.)
GG 41444-PGH-000 2.375 mm (0.094 in.)
H 41445-P7T-000 2.40 mm (0.094 in.)
HH 41445-PGH-000 2.425 mm (0.095 in.)
I 41446-P7T-000 2.45 mm (0.096 in.)
II 41446-PGH-000 2.475 mm (0.097 in.)
J 41447-P7T-000 2.50 mm (0.098 in.)
JJ 41447-PGH-000 2.525 mm (0.099 in.)
K 41448-P7T-000 2.55 mm (0.100 in.)
KK 41448-PGH-000 2.575 mm (0.101 in.)
L 41449-P7T-000 2.60 mm (0.102 in.)
LL 41449-PGH-000 2.625 mm (0.103 in.)
M 41450-P7T-000 2.65 mm (0.104 in.)
MM 41450-PGH-000 2.675 mm (0.105 in.)
N 41451-P7T-000 2.70 mm (0.106 in.)
NN 41451-PGH-000 2.725 mm (0.107 in.)
O 41452-P7T-000 2.75 mm (0.108 in.)
OO 41452-PGH-000 2.775 mm (0.109 in.)
P 41453-P7T-000 2.80 mm (0.110 in.)
PP 41453-PGH-000 2.825 mm (0.111 in.)
Q 41454-P7T-000 2.85 mm (0.112 in.)
QQ 41454-PGH-000 2.875 mm (0.113 in.)
R 41455-P7T-000 2.90 mm (0.114 in.)
RR 41455-PGH-000 2.925 mm (0.115 in.)
S 41456-P7T-000 2.95 mm (0.116 in.)
SS 41456-PGH-000 2.975 mm (0.117 in.)
T 41457-P7T-000 3.00 mm (0.118 in.)
TT 41457-PGH-000 3.025 mm (0.119 in.)
U 41458-P7T-000 3.05 mm (0.120 in.)
14-483
03/07/29 09:46:34 61S0X050_140_0487
03/07/29 09:47:20 61S0X050_160_0001
Transaxle
Driveline/Axle
Special Tools ................................................................. 16-2
Driveshaft Inspection ................................................... 16-3
Driveshaft Removal ...................................................... 16-3
Driveshaft Disassembly ............................................... 16-5
Driveshaft Reassembly ................................................ 16-9
Driveshaft Installation .................................................. 16-16
Intermediate Shaft Removal ........................................ 16-17
Intermediate Shaft Disassembly ................................. 16-18
Intermediate Shaft Reassembly .................................. 16-19
Intermediate Shaft Installation .................................... 16-21
03/07/29 09:47:21 61S0X050_160_0002
Driveline/Axle
Special Tools
Ref. No. Tool Number Description Qty
07AAF-SDAA100 Ball Joint Thread Protector 1
07JAD-PH80101 Oil Seal Driver Attachment 1
07LAF-SM40300 Support Base Attachment 1
07MAC-SL00100 Ball Joint Remover, 32 mm 1
07XAC-001020A Threaded Adapter, 24 x 1.5 mm 1
07746-0010300 Attachment, 42 x 47 mm 1
07749-0010000 Driver 1
07947-4630100 Fork Seal Driver, 39.2 x 49.5 x 15 mm 1
07965-SD90100 Support Base 1
16-2
03/07/29 09:47:22 61S0X050_160_0003
A
B
(contd)
16-3
03/07/29 09:47:23 61S0X050_160_0004
Driveline/Axle
B
07MAC-SL00100
8. Separate the ball joint from the lower arm (C) with Right driveshaft:
the special tool (see page 18-10).
A
9. Pull the knuckle outward, and remove the
driveshaft outboard joint from the front wheel hub
using a plastic hammer.
16-4
03/07/29 09:47:23 61S0X050_160_0005
Driveshaft Disassembly
Special Tools Required Double loop type
Threaded adapter, 24 x 1.5 mm 07XAC-001020A
(contd)
16-5
03/07/29 09:47:24 61S0X050_160_0006
Driveline/Axle
A B A
E
B
16-6
03/07/29 09:47:25 61S0X050_160_0007
Outboard Joint Side 3. Wipe off the grease to expose the driveshaft and
the outboard joint inner race.
1. Remove the boot bands (A). Lift up the three tabs
(B) with a screwdriver. Be careful not to damage 4. Make a mark (A) on the driveshaft (B) at the same
the boot. position of the outboard joint end (C).
A B
A
C
B
A
(contd)
16-7
03/07/29 09:47:25 61S0X050_160_0008
Driveline/Axle
16-8
03/07/29 09:47:26 61S0X050_160_0009
Driveshaft Reassembly
Exploded View
(Left driveshaft)
(Right driveshaft)
SET RING
Replace.
INBOARD JOINT
(Left driveshaft)
(Right driveshaft)
INBOARD BOOT
CIRCLIP
DRIVESHAFT Replace.
OUTBOARD BOOT
Use the grease included in
the outboard boot set.
OUTBOARD JOINT
(contd)
16-9
03/07/29 09:47:27 61S0X050_160_0010
Driveline/Axle
A B
16-10
03/07/29 09:47:27 61S0X050_160_0011
6. Fit the inboard joint onto the driveshaft, and note 8. Fit the boot ends onto the driveshaft and the
these items: inboard joint, then install the boot band.
Reinstall the inboard joint onto the driveshaft by
aligning the marks (A) on the inboard joint and
the rollers.
Hold the driveshaft so the inboard joint points up
to prevent it from falling off.
(contd)
16-11
03/07/29 09:47:28 61S0X050_160_0012
Driveline/Axle
A
C
NOTE:
Make sure the band and clip do not interfere with
anything on the vehicle and the band does not
move.
12. Place a wrench on the winding mandrel of the boot Remove any grease remaining on the
band tool, and tighten the band until the marked surrounding surfaces.
spot (C) on the band meets the edge of the clip.
A
13. Lift up the boot band tool to bend the free end of
the band 90 degrees to the clip. Center-punch the
clip, then fold over the remaining tail onto the clip.
90 degrees
16-12
03/07/29 09:47:29 61S0X050_160_0013
(contd)
16-13
03/07/29 09:47:30 61S0X050_160_0014
Driveline/Axle
Push.
Push. 7. Pack the outboard joint (A) with the joint grease
included in the new joint boot set.
10 cm
(4 in.)
16-14
03/07/29 09:47:30 61S0X050_160_0015
8. Fit the boot (A) ends onto the driveshaft (B) and 10. Check the clearance between the closed ear portion
outboard joint (C). of the band. If the clearance is not within the
standard, close the ear portion of the band farther.
6.0 mm
(0.24 in.) MAX
B 3.0 mm
A (0.12 in.) MAX
C 11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 for the band on the other end
of the boot.
16-15
03/07/29 09:47:31 61S0X050_160_0016
Driveline/Axle
Driveshaft Installation
1. Apply 0.31.0 g (0.010.04 oz) 99-01 models, 0.5 4. Install the outboard joint (A) into the front hub (B).
1.0 g (0.020.04 oz) 02-04 models of specified
grease to the whole splined surface (A) of the left
B
driveshaft. After applying grease, remove the
grease from the splined grooves at intervals of
23 splines and from the set ring groove (B) so
that air can bleed from the intermediate shaft.
B
A
A D E
B
D
C B
A
6. Install the new lock pin (E) into the pin hole as
shown.
C E
16-16
03/07/29 09:47:32 61S0X050_160_0017
12 x 1.5 mm
108 Nm C B
(11.0 kgfm,
80.0 lbfft)
B 4. Remove the intermediate shaft (B) from the
differential. Hold the intermediate shaft horizontal
until it is clear of the differential to prevent damage
to the differential oil seal (C).
A
24 x 1.5 mm
245 Nm (25.0 kgfm, 181 lbfft)
10. Turn the front wheel by hand, and make sure there
is no interference between the driveshaft and
surrounding parts.
16-17
03/07/29 09:47:33 61S0X050_160_0018
Driveline/Axle
E
5. Press the intermediate shaft bearing (A) out of the
D bearing support (B) using the special tools and a
press.
A
07746-0010300 PRESS 07749-0010000
B
2. Remove the set ring (D) and the external snap ring
(E). A
B
PRESS
07LAF-SM40300
07LAF-SM40300
07965-SD90100
A
16-18
03/07/29 09:47:33 61S0X050_160_0019
FLANGE BOLTS
6 x 1.0 mm
10 Nm (1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
HEAT SHIELD
INTERNAL
SNAP RING
INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
EXTERNAL
SNAP RING
BEARING SUPPORT RING
INTERMEDIATE
SHAFT BEARING
Replace.
BEARING SUPPORT
SET RING
Replace.
OUTER SEAL
Replace.
(contd)
16-19
03/07/29 09:47:34 61S0X050_160_0020
Driveline/Axle
07JAD-PH80101 5. Install, then seat the external snap ring (A) in the
groove of the intermediate shaft (B).
B A
16-20
03/07/29 09:47:35 61S0X050_160_0021
B
07LAF-SM40300
07965-SD90100
16-21
03/07/29 09:47:35 61S0X050_160_0022
03/07/29 09:48:44 61S0X050_170_0001
Steering
Power Steering
Special Tools ................................................................. 17-2
Component Location Index ......................................... 17-3
Symptom Troubleshooting Index ............................... 17-4
Symptom Troubleshooting ......................................... 17-6
Steering Wheel Rotational Play Check ....................... 17-7
Power Assist Check ...................................................... 17-7
Steering Linkage and Gearbox
Inspection .................................................................... 17-8
Pump Pressure Test with T/N 07406-0010001 ........... 17-9
Pump Pressure Test with T/N 07406-001000A ........... 17-10
Fluid Leakage Inspection ............................................. 17-11
Pump Belt Inspection and Adjustment ....................... 17-12
Fluid Replacement ........................................................ 17-14
Power Steering Hose, Line, and Pressure Switch
Replacement ............................................................... 17-15
Pump Replacement ...................................................... 17-16
Pump Overhaul ............................................................. 17-17
Steering Wheel Removal ............................................. 17-22
Steering Wheel Disassembly/
Reassembly ................................................................. 17-23
Steering Wheel Installation ......................................... 17-24
Steering Column Removal and
Installation ................................................................... 17-25
Steering Column/Tilt Lever
Inspection/Adjustment ............................................... 17-27
Steering Lock Replacement ......................................... 17-28
Rack Guide Adjustment ............................................... 17-29
Steering Gearbox Removal ......................................... 17-30
Steering Gearbox Overhaul ......................................... 17-34
Steering Gearbox Installation ..................................... 17-44
Tie-rod Ball Joint Boot Replacement .......................... 17-48
03/07/29 09:48:46 61S0X050_170_0002
Power Steering
Special Tools
Ref.No. Tool Number Description Qty
07LAG-SM40100 or 07LAG-SM4010A Piston Seal Ring Guide 1
07LAG-SM40200 or 07LAG-SM4020A Piston Seal Ring Sizing Tool 1
07JGG-001010A Belt Tension Gauge 1
07MAA-SL00200 Locknut Wrench, 43 mm 1
07MAC-SL00200 Ball Joint Remover, 28 mm 1
07TAF-SZ50100 Cylinder End Seal Remover Attachment 1
07RAK-S040122 P/S Joint Adaptor (Hose) 1
07VAK-P8A011A P/S Joint Adaptor (Pump) 1
07VAK-P8A012B P/S Joint Adaptor Plate (Pump) 1
07XAA-001030A Engine Support Fixture 1
07ZAA-S0XA100 Cable Eyebolt Assembly 1
07406-0010001 or 07406-001000A P/S Pressure Gauge 1
07725-0030000 Universal Holder 1
07749-0010000 Driver 1
07746-0010300 Attachment, 42 x 47 mm 1
07965-SA50500 Front Hub Dis/Assembly Tool 1
Included in the Belt Tension Gauge Set, 07TGG-001000A.
17-2
03/07/29 09:48:51 61S0X050_170_0003
DRIVERS AIRBAG
Replacement, page 23-368
STEERING WHEEL
Removal, page 17-22
Disassembly/Reassembly,
page 17-23
Installation, page 17-24
STEERING COLUMN
Steering Column Removal/Installation,
page 17-25
Steering Column/Tilt Lever Inspection/
Adjustment, page 17-27
Steering Lock Replacement,
page 17-28
17-3
03/07/29 09:48:52 61S0X050_170_0004
Power Steering
17-4
03/07/29 09:48:52 61S0X050_170_0005
Power steering rack 1. Check for loose steering components (tie-rod and ball joints).
rattle or chattering Tighten or replace as necessary.
2. Check the steering column shaft for wobbling. If the steering
column wobbles, replace the steering column assembly (see page
17-25).
3. Check the rack guide adjustment (see page 17-29).
Check the power steering pump pulley.
If the pulley is loose, tighten it (see step 33 on page 17-21).
If the pump shaft is loose, replace the pump (see page 17-16).
Hissing noise/ Check the fluid level. If low, fill the power steering reservoir to the Air in the P/S
foaming fluid in proper level and check for leaks. fluid
reservoir Check the reservoir for leaks.
Check for a damaged inlet hose or loose hose clamp allowing air into
the suction side of the system.
Check the power steering pump shaft oil seal for leaks.
Noise from the Compare the pump noise at normal operating temperature to P/S pump
power steering pump another alike vehicle, (pump noise up to 23 minutes after starting pressure
the engine in cold weather is normal). Air in the P/S
Remove and inspect the power steering pump for wear and damage fluid
(see page 17-17).
Squeaking from the Check the power steering pump belt tension and adjust as necessary
power steering pump (see page 17-12).
Fluid Leaks from the Fluid leaks from the left tie-rod boot:
steering gearbox Replace the valve body unit.
Replace the cylinder end seal on the gearbox side.
Fluid leaks from the right tie-rod boot: Replace the cylinder end seal.
Fluid leaks from pinion shaft near the lower steering joint bolt:
Replace the valve body unit.
Fluid leaks from the Fluid leaks from the cylinder line A or B connections (flare nuts):
power steering line Tighten the connection and retest. If it still leaks, replace the fitting
O-rings.
Fluid leaks from a damaged cylinder line A or B: Replace the cylinder
line.
Fluid leaks from the pump outlet hose or return line fitting on the
valve body unit (flair nuts): Tighten the fitting and retest. If it still
leaks, replace the hose, the line, or valve body unit as necessary.
Fluid leaks from the Fluid leaks from the front oil seal: Replace the front oil seal.
power steering pump Fluid leaks from the power steering pump housing: Replace the
leaking O-rings or seals (see page 17-17), and if necessary replace
the power steering pump (see page 17-16).
Fluid leaks from the Fluid leaks from around the reservoir cap:
power steering Fluid level is too high: Drain the reservoir to the proper level.
reservoir Aerated fluid: Check for an air leak on the inlet side of pump.
Fluid leaks from reservoir: Check for the reservoir for cracks and
replace as necessary.
Fluid leaks from the Check the fitting for loose bolts. If the bolts are tight, replace the
power steering pump fitting O-ring.
outlet hose Fluid leaks at the swagged joint: Replace the outlet hose.
(high-pressure)
Fluid leaks from the Check the hose for damage, deterioration, or improper assembly.
power steering pump Replace or repair as necessary.
inlet hose
(low-pressure)
17-5
03/07/29 09:48:52 61S0X050_170_0006
Power Steering
Symptom Troubleshooting
Hard steering 6. Adjust the rack guide (see page 17-29), and retest.
Is the pressure 1,500 kPa ( 15 kgf / cm2 , 213 psi) or NOReplace the valve body unit.
less?
8. Check the flow control valve (see page 17-17) for
YESGo to step 3. smooth movement and leaks.
NOGo to step 7.
Is the f low control valve OK ?
3. Measure the pump relief pressure at idle with
T/N 07406-0010001 (see step 10 on page 17-9) or YESReplace the pump assembly.
T/N 07406-001000A (see step 9 on page 17-10).
NOReplace the flow control valve.
Is the pressure 8.3008.800 kPa ( 85 90 kgf / cm2 ,
1.2101.280 psi) or less? 9. Check the cylinder lines A and B for deformation
(see page 17-34).
YESGo to step 4.
NOGo to step 8. Are the A or B lines def ormed?
4. With a spring scale, measure the power assist in YESReplace the lines.
both directions, to the left and to the right.
NOGo to step 10.
Are the two measurements within 5.0 N ( 0.51 kgf ,
1.12 lbf ) of each other? 10. Check for a bent rack shaft or misadjusted rack
guide (too tight).
YESGo to step 5.
NOGo to step 9. Is the rack shaf t bent or the rack guide adjusted
too tight?
5. Measure the fluid pressure with T/N 07406-0010001
(see step 11 on page 17-9) or T/N 07406-001000A YESReplace the rack shaft or readjust the rack
(see step 10 on page 17-10) with both pressure guide.
gauge valves open (if so equipped), while turning
the steering wheel fully to the left and fully to the NOReplace the valve body unit.
right.
YESGo to step 6.
NOReplace the gearbox.
17-6
03/07/29 09:48:53 61S0X050_170_0007
17-7
03/07/29 09:48:54 61S0X050_170_0008
Power Steering
STEERING COLUMN
Inspect for loose
mounting hardware.
STEERING JOINTS
Check for a loose joint bolts, or
faulty movement.
DUST SEAL
Inspect for damage and deterioration.
TIE-ROD LOCKNUT
Check for loose locknut.
STEERING GEARBOX
Inspect loose mounting bolts.
GEARBOX MOUNTING CUSHIONS TIE-ROD END BALL JOINT
Inspect for deterioration. Inspect for faulty movement
and damage.
17-8
03/07/29 09:48:54 61S0X050_170_0009
07RAK-S040122
7. Start the engine and let it idle.
A
8. Turn the steering wheel from lock-to-lock several
times to warm the fluid to operating temperature at
158F (70C).
3. Connect the P/S joint adapter (hose) to the P/S Do not keep the pressure control valve
pressure gauge, then connect the pump outlet hose closed more than 5 seconds or the pump
(A) to the P/S joint adapter (hose). could be damaged by over-heating.
4. Install the P/S pressure gauge to the P/S joint 11. Immediately open the shut-off valve fully.
adapter (pump). If the pump is in good condition, the gauge should
read at least 8,3008,800 kPa (8590 kgf/cm2,
1,2101,280 psi). A low reading means pump
output is too low for full assist. Repair or replace
the pump.
17-9
03/07/29 09:48:55 61S0X050_170_0010
Power Steering
3. Connect the P/S joint adapter (hose) to the P/S 10. Immediatery open the pressure control valve fully.
pressure gauge, then connect the pump outlet hose If the pump is in good condition, the gauge should
(A) to the P/S joint adapter (hose). read at least 8,3008,800 kPa (8590 kgf/cm2,
1,2101,280 psi). A low reading means pump
4. Install the P/S pressure gauge to the P/S joint output is too low for full assist. Repair or replace
adapter (pump). the pump.
17-10
03/07/29 09:48:56 61S0X050_170_0011
PUMP ASSEMBLY
Check for leaks at the pump
seal, inlet and outlet fittings.
00-04 models:
17-11
03/07/29 09:48:56 61S0X050_170_0012
Power Steering
Inspection
17-12
03/07/29 09:48:57 61S0X050_170_0013
Deflection:
Used Belt: 13.016.5 mm (0.510.65 in.)
New Belt: 8.511.0 mm (0.330.43 in.)
B C
24 Nm
(2.4 kgfm,
17 lbfft) A
24 Nm (2.4 kgfm, 17 lbfft)
17-13
03/07/29 09:48:57 61S0X050_170_0014
Power Steering
Fluid Replacement
Check the reservoir (A) at regular intervals, and add the 1. Raise the reservoir, then disconnect the return hose
recommended fluid as necessary. Always use Honda (A) to drain the reservoir. Take care not to spill the
Power Steering Fluid. Using any other type of power fluid on the body and parts. Wipe off any spilled
steering fluid or automatic transmission fluid can cause fluid at once.
increased wear and poor steering in cold weather.
SYSTEM CAPACITY: B
1.1 (1.16 US. qt) at disassembly
RESERVOIR CAPACITY: C
0.4 (0.42 US. qt)
6. Start the engine and run it at fast idle, then turn the
steering from lock-to-lock several times to bleed air
from the system.
17-14
03/07/29 09:48:58 61S0X050_170_0015
2.55.5 mm
(0.100.22 in.)
2.55.5 mm 2.04.0 mm
(0.100.22 in.) (0.080.16 in.)
FEED HOSE
14 x 1.5 mm
37 Nm (3.8 kgfm, 27 lbfft)
A CYLINDER LINES
B 13 Nm (1.3 kgfm, 9.4 lbfft)
A
00-04 models:
17-15
03/07/29 09:48:59 61S0X050_170_0016
Power Steering
Pump Replacement
1. Place a suitable container under the vehicle. 6. Loosely install the new pump in the pump bracket with
the mounting bolts and nut.
2. Drain the power steering fluid from the reservoir.
7. Install the pump belt (A) on the pulley (B).
3. Cover the crankshaft pulley with several shop
towels to protect if from spilled power steering Note these items during belt installation:
fluid. Disconnect the pump inlet hose (A) and pump Make sure that the power steering pump belt is
outlet hose (B) from the pump (C), and plug them. properly positioned on the pulleys.
Take care not to spill the fluid on the body or parts. Do not get the power steering fluid or grease on
Wipe off any spilled fluid at once. the belt or pulley faces. Clean off any fluid or
grease before installation.
F 6 x 1.0 mm BOLT
11 Nm
24 Nm A
(2.4. kgfm, (1.1 kgfm,
17 lbfft) 8 lbfft)
B
B
G F
24 Nm
(2.4 kgfm, E
17 lbfft)
8. Adjust the pump belt adjustment (see page 17-12).
17-16
03/07/29 09:49:00 61S0X050_170_0017
Pump Overhaul
Exploded View
Replace the pump as an assembly if the parts indicated with asterisk (*) are worn or damage.
* PUMP VANES
(10 plates)
*PUMP ROTOR
15.2 x 2.4 mm O-RING
Replace.
*SNAP RING
51 x 2.4 mm O-RING
Replace.
*SUBVALVE
13 x 1.9 mm O-RING
Replace.
PUMP SEAL SPACER
INLET JOINT
PUMP SEAL
Replace. *SPRING
*PUMP HOUSING
16.7 x 1.8 mm O-RING
Replace.
BALL BEARING
(contd)
17-17
03/07/29 09:49:00 61S0X050_170_0018
Power Steering
07725-0030000
C
17-18
03/07/29 09:49:01 61S0X050_170_0019
13. Attach a hose (A) to the end of the flow control Reassembly
valve (B) as shown. Then submerge the flow
control valve in a container of power steering fluid 16. Clean the disassembled parts with solvent, and dry
or solvent (C), and blow in the hose. them with compressed air. Do not dip the rubber
parts in solvent.
If air bubbles leak through the valve at less than
98 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 14.2 psi), replace the pump 17. Align the pin (A) of the subvalve (B) with the oil
as an assembly. The flow control valve is not passage (C) in the pump housing. Push the
available separately. subvalve into place, then install the snap ring (D).
If the flow control valve tests OK, set it aside for
reassembly later.
A
B A
C B
D C
18. Install the new pump seal (A) (with its grooved side
facing in) into the pump housing by hand, then
14. Inspect the ball bearing by rotating the outer race install the pump seal spacer (B).
slowly. If you feel any play (axial or radial) or
F
roughness remove the faulty ball bearing (A), and
install a new one (B). E
B
C
A B
D
A
15. Inspect each part shown with an asterisk in the 20. Install the 40 mm snap ring (F) with its radiused
Exploded View; if any of them are worn or side facing out.
damaged, replace the pump as an assembly.
(contd)
17-19
03/07/29 09:49:02 61S0X050_170_0020
Power Steering
D
E
B
C
27. Install the side plate on the cam ring (C) by aligning
the roll pins set holes (D) in the side plate with the
roll pins (E).
17-20
03/07/29 09:49:03 61S0X050_170_0021
28. Coat the new 51 mm O-ring (A) with power steering 32. Coat the new 13 mm O-ring (A) with power steering
fluid, and position it in the bottom of the pump fluid, and install it on the inlet joint (B). Install the
housing (B). inlet joint on the pump housing, and tighten the
flange bolt.
8 x 1.25 mm
20 Nm
(2.0 kgfm, 14 lbfft)
C
A
A
11 Nm
(1.1 kgfm, 8 lbfft)
29. Install the pump cover assembly (C) in the pump 33. Install the pulley (A), then loosely install the pulley
housing. nut (B). Hold the steering pump in a vise with soft
jaws. Be careful not to damage the pump housing
30. Coat the flow control valve (A) with power steering with the jaws of the vise.
fluid, then install it and the spring (B) in the pump
07725-0030000
housing.
B
64 Nm
A (6.5 kgfm, 47 lbfft)
B
C
A
D
49 Nm
(5.0 kgfm, 36 lbfft) 34. Hold the pulley with the special tool, and tighten
the pulley nut.
31. Coat the new 16.7 mm O-ring (C) with power
steering fluid, and install it on the flow control 35. Check that the pump turns smoothly by turning the
valve cap (D), then install the cap on the pump pulley by hand. If it turns hard, loosen the four
housing, and tighten it. flange bolts on the cover, then retighten them in
the same manner as in step 28. Turn the pump
again by hand.
17-21
03/07/29 09:49:04 61S0X050_170_0022
Power Steering
17-22
03/07/29 09:49:04 61S0X050_170_0023
STEERING WHEEL
5 mm SCREWS
4 mm SCREWS
HOOK PLATE
COVER
COVER
ACCESS PANEL
CRUISE CONTROL SET/RESUME SWITCH
17-23
03/07/29 09:49:05 61S0X050_170_0024
Power Steering
C
A
17-24
03/07/29 09:49:06 61S0X050_170_0025
Removal
1. Record the radio station presets, and disconnect the battery.
2. Remove the drivers airbag, steering wheel, and cable reel (see page 23-368).
3. Set the column shaft (A) in the neutral position by pulling up the steering column to uppermost position, then
lower it 8 mm (0.31 in.). Tighten the tilt lever (B).
FULL STROKE: 23 mm (0.9 in.)
8 mm (5/16 in.)
A
C
F
B
22 Nm
(2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft)
D
A
22 Nm
(2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft) 16 Nm (1.6 kgfm, 12 lbfft)
5. Move the shift lever (B) to the N position, and remove the shift cable from the column, and set it aside.
6. Remove the combination switch assembly (C) from the steering column shaft by disconnecting the connectors and
removing the screws.
7. Disconnect the ignition switch connectors and disconnect the harness clips.
9. Disconnect the steering joint (E), and remove it from the column shaft.
10. Remove the steering column (F) by removing the attaching nuts and bolts.
(contd)
17-25
03/07/29 09:49:06 61S0X050_170_0026
Power Steering
1. Install the steering column and make sure the wires Make sure the wire harness is routed and
are not caught or pinched by any parts. fastened properly.
Make sure the connectors are properly connected.
2. Insert the upper end of the steering joint onto the Reinstall the steering wheel (see page 17-24).
steering shaft (A) (line up the bolt hole (B) with the Reconnect the battery.
flat portion (C) on the shaft). Do the PCM idle learn procedure (see page 11-
202).
22 Nm Do the power window control unit reset
(2.2 kgfm,
16 lbfft) procedure (see page 22-200).
Set the clock.
Enter the anti-theft codes for the radio and the
navigation system, then the customers radio
station presets.
Verify cruise control, horn, radio remote, and
turn signal switch operation.
Check wheel alignment (see page 18-5).
22 Nm A
(2.2 kgfm, 16 lbfft) C
B
F
G
17-26
03/07/29 09:49:07 61S0X050_170_0027
G F
B
C
E
D
(contd)
17-27
03/07/29 09:49:07 61S0X050_170_0028
Power Steering
1. Move the tilt lever (A) from the loose position to the 2. Center punch each of the two shear bolts, and drill
lock position 3 to 5 times; then measure the tilt their heads off with a 5 mm (3/16 in.) drill bit. Be
lever preload 10 mm (0.4 in.) from the end of the tilt careful not to damage the switch body when
lever. removing the shear bolts.
Preload: 7090 N (79 kgf, 1520 lbf)
10 mm (0.4 in.) A C 3. Remove the shear bolts from the switch body.
2. If the measurement is out of the specification, 4. Install the switch body without the key inserted.
adjust the preload using the following procedures.
5. Loosely tighten the new shear bolts.
Loosen the tilt lever, and set the steering column
in the neutral position. 6. Insert the ignition key, and check for proper
Remove the 6 mm lock bolt (B), and remove the operation of the steering wheel lock and that the
stop (C). Be careful not to loosen the tilt lever ignition key turns freely.
when installing the stop or tightening the 6 mm
lock bolt. 7. Tighten the shear bolts (A) until the hex heads (B)
Adjust the preload by turning the tilt lock bolt (D) twist off.
left or right.
Pull up the tilt lever to the uppermost position, A
and install the stop. Check the preload again. If
the measurement is still out of specification,
repeat the above procedures to adjust.
17-28
03/07/29 09:49:08 61S0X050_170_0029
1. Set the wheels in the straight ahead position. 8. Check the steering wheel rotational play (see page
17-7) and power assist (see page 17-7).
2. Loosen the rack guide screw locknut (A) with a
special tool, then remove the rack guide screw (B).
A
69 Nm (7.0kgfm,
51 lbfft)
07MAA-SL00200
17-29
03/07/29 09:49:09 61S0X050_170_0030
Power Steering
A 07MAC-SL00200
10. Separate the tie-rod ball joint and knuckle using the
special tool (see page 18-10).
17-30
03/07/29 09:49:30 61S0X050_170_0031
11. Remove the following parts. 15. Lift and support the engine with the special tools.
Position the tool over the hood latch. Loop the
Exhaust pipe (A) (see page 9-11) cable (A) around the throttle body (B), and tighten
Three way catalytic converter (TWC) (B) (see the wing nut (C) on the tool by hand until the cable
page 9-11) is tight.
Splash shield (C)
NOTE: For 02-04 models, replace the cable eyebolt
assembly (A) on the engine support fixture with
07ZAA-S0XA100.
07XAA-001030A C
07ZAA-S0XA100
C A
A
A A
B A
17-31
03/07/29 09:49:31 61S0X050_170_0032
Power Steering
A
21. Remove the two 12 mm flange bolts from the rear
B stiffener plates (A).
30 mm (1.18 in.)
B C
A C
17-32
03/07/29 09:49:32 61S0X050_170_0033
22. Lower the jack slowly until the front subframe is 24. Remove the two 10 mm mounting bolts from the
held with the 14 mm special bolts that were left gearbox.
loosened in step 19.
17-33
03/07/29 09:49:33 61S0X050_170_0034
Power Steering
CYLINDER LINE B
CYLINDER END SEAL VALVE BODY UNIT
Replace.
CYLINDER LINE A
GASKET
O-RINGS
Replace.
RACK STOP
O-RING LOCKNUT
FLARE NUTS
Replace. 13 Nm (1.3 kgfm, 9.4 lbfft)
RACK GUIDE SCREW
CYLINDER END SEAL
SPRING
GEARBOX HOUSING RACK GUIDE
NUT
CIRCLIP 25 Nm (2.5 kgfm, 18 lbfft)
END PLUG
RACK BUSHING 59 Nm (6.0 kgfm, 43 lbfft)
O-RING
Replace.
17-34
03/07/29 09:49:34 61S0X050_170_0035
Removal
4. Hold the flat surface sections (A) on the right side
1. Remove the steering gearbox (see page 17-30). steering rack (B) with a wrench, and unscrew the
both rack ends (C) with another wrench. Be careful
Disassembly not to damage the rack surface with the wrench.
Remove the lock washer (D) and stop washer (E).
2. Remove the boot band (A) and tie-rod clips (B). Pull
the boots away from the ends of the steering
A
gearbox.
B
C
D E
(contd)
17-35
03/07/29 09:49:35 61S0X050_170_0036
Power Steering
D
C D
B
A
A
6. Remove the spring (C) and the rack guide (D) from
the gearbox.
7. Remove the cylinder lines from the gearbox. 10. Remove the two flange bolts, the valve body unit
(C) and gasket (D) from the gearbox. Check that the
valve turns smoothly by turning the pinion shaft. If
any play or roughness is felt, replace the valve
body unit with a new part if necessary. Do not try to
disassemble the valve body unit.
11. Slide the steering rack all the way to the left.
C
D
17-36
03/07/29 09:49:36 61S0X050_170_0037
13. Remove the rack stop (A), rack bushing (B) and 16. Install a washer (O.D. 27.5 mm, P/N 94103-10400)
steering rack (C) from the steering gearbox. (A) so it will fit through the rack guide hole of the
gearbox housing, then position the washer on the
cylinder end seal (B). Make sure that the washer is
securely positioned on the cylinder end seal edges.
B
A
A
C
14. Remove the O-ring (A) and cylinder end seal (B)
from the rack bushing (C). B
B 17. Install the socket wrench with a 27.5 mm O.D. (A)
onto the 24 long 3/8 drive extension (B), and
carefully place it on the washer (C).
C
D C
56 mm
15. Carefully pry the piston seal ring (A) and O-ring (B) (0.200.24 in.)
E
off the rack piston. Be careful not to damage the
inside of seal ring groove and piston edges when
removing the seal ring.
18. Install a commercially available bearing separator
(D) on the gearbox housing. Set the steering
gearbox in a press so the gearbox housing points
upward, then push out the cylinder end seal (E)
56 mm (0.200.24 in.) by pressing on the 24
long 3/8 drive extension end.
(contd)
17-37
03/07/29 09:49:37 61S0X050_170_0038
Power Steering
A
07LAG-SM4010A or
07LAG-SM40100
21. Insert a 24 long 3/8 drive extension (A), on the
special tool. Place the steering gearbox in a press,
then remove the cylinder end seal (B) from of the
gearbox by pressing on the 24 long 3/8 drive
extension.
A
Note these items when pressing the cylinder end
seal:
B
Keep the tool straight to avoid damaging the
cylinder wall. Check the tool angle, and correct it
if necessary, when removing the cylinder end 24. Pull the O-ring off into the piston groove, then pull
seal. the piston seal ring off into the piston groove on
Use a press to remove the cylinder end seal. Do top of the O-ring.
not try to remove the seal by striking the tool;
striking the tool would break the cylinder end 25. Coat the piston seal ring (A) and the inside of the
seal, and the seal would remain in the gearbox. special tool with power steering fluid, then
carefully slide the tool onto the rack and over the
A piston seal ring.
07TAF-SZ50100
B
07LAG-SM4010A or
07LAG-SM40100
17-38
03/07/29 09:49:38 61S0X050_170_0039
26. Move the special tool back and forth several times 30. Grease the steering rack teeth, then insert the
to make sure the piston seal ring fits snugly in the steering rack into the gearbox housing. Be careful
piston. not to damage the inner surface of the cylinder wall
with the rack edges.
27. Wrap vinyl tape around the rack teeth and rack end
edges, then coat the surface of the tape with power
steering fluid. Make sure that the vinyl tape is
wrapped carefully so that there is no stepped
portion.
32. Install the cylinder end seal (B) into the bottom of
the cylinder by pressing on the tool with a press.
Do not push on the tool with excessive force as it
may damage the cylinder end seal.
29. Remove the vinyl tape from the steering rack, then
remove any adhesive residue.
(contd)
17-39
03/07/29 09:49:38 61S0X050_170_0040
Power Steering
38. Remove the vinyl tape from the steering rack, then
35. Coat the inside surface of the new cylinder end seal remove any adhesive residue.
(A) with power steering fluid, then press it into the
rack bushing (B) using the special tools. 39. Install the rack stop (A) onto the steering rack so the
hole (B) is aligned with the slot (C) on the steering
NOTE: The open end of the seal should be facing rack.
down.
C
A 0779-0010000
07746-0010300
36. Coat the new O-ring (C) with power steering fluid,
and carefully fit it in the groove of the rack bushing.
17-40
03/07/29 09:49:39 61S0X050_170_0041
40. Insert the end of the circlip (A) into the hole (B) of 45. Before installing the cylinder lines, coat the new
the rack stop (C). Turn the rack stop O-rings with power steering fluid, then install the
counterclockwise until the circlip is fully seated in lines.
the rack stop.
Note these items during reassembly:
A Thoroughly clean the joints of the cylinder lines.
The joints must be free of foreign material.
Install the cylinder lines by tightening the flare
nuts by hand first, then tighten the flare nuts to
the specified torque.
B 13 Nm (1.3 kgfm, 9.4 lbfft)
A
E D
25 Nm
(2.5 kgfm,
18 lbfft)
F
59 Nm A
(6.0 kgfm, C
43 lbfft) B
D
42. Install the nut (D) onto the pinion shaft end, and 47. Apply new sealant to around the first three threads
tighten to specified torque. of the rack guide screw (B), then install the spring
(C), rack guide screw and locknut (D).
43. Install the plug end (F) onto the gearbox housing
and tighten it to the specified torque. After 48. Adjust the rack guide screw (see page 17-29). After
tightening, use a drift to stake the plug shoulder (E) adjusting, check that the rack moves smoothly by
against the grearbox housing. sliding it right and left.
(contd)
17-41
03/07/29 09:49:40 61S0X050_170_0042
Power Steering
B
A
B
(P/N 08798-9013)
F
88 Nm
(9.0 kgfm, 53. Apply a light coat of silicone grease to the boot
65 lbfft) grooves (B) of the rack ends.
D E C
54. Center the steering rack within its stroke. Install the
boots on the rack ends with the tie-rod clips. After
installing the boots, wipe the grease off the
50. Hold the flat surface sections of the right side threaded section (A) of the rack end.
steering rack with a wrench, and tighten the both
rack ends with another wrench. Be careful not to
damage the rack surface with the wrench.
51. Bend the lock washer (A) back against the flat spots
on the rack end joint housing.
17-42
03/07/29 09:49:41 61S0X050_170_0043
55. Install the new boot bands by aligning the tabs (A)
with the holes (B) of the band.
2 mm
(0.08 in.)
57. Slide the rack right and left to be certain that the
boots are not deformed or twisted.
Installation
17-43
03/07/29 09:49:42 61S0X050_170_0044
Power Steering
A
A
6. Install the clamp for the feed line (D) on the right
mounting bracket.
17-44
03/07/29 09:49:43 61S0X050_170_0045
7. Carefully raise the front subframe with the jack. 9. Install the rear stiffener plates (A) and tighten the
mounting bolts to the specified torque.
A
A
117 Nm (11.9 kgfm, 86.1 lbfft)
A
103 Nm (10.5 kgfm, 75.9 lbfft)
A
103 Nm (10.5 kgfm,
75.9 lbfft)
(contd)
17-45
03/07/29 09:49:44 61S0X050_170_0046
Power Steering
A A
A D
37 Nm (3.8 kgfm,
27 lbfft)
C A
C
17-46
03/07/29 09:49:44 61S0X050_170_0047
18. Wipe off any greese contamination from the ball 21. Install the steering joint (A), and reconnect the
joint tapered section and threads then reconnect tie steering shaft (B) and pinion shaft (C). Make sure
rod ends (A) to the steering knuckles. Install the the steering joint is connected as follows:
12 mm nut (B) and tighten it.
Insert the upper end of the steering joint onto the
A steering shaft (line up the bolt hole (D) with the
flat portion (E) on the shaft).
Slip the lower end of the steering joint onto the
pinion shaft (line up the bolt hole (F) with the
groove around the shaft), and loosely install the
lower joint bolt. Be sure that the lower joint bolt
is securely in the groove in the pinion shaft.
Pull on the steering joint to make sure that the
steering joint is fully seated. Then install the
upper joint bolt and tighten it.
22 Nm (2.2 kgfm,
16 lbfft)
B
54 Nm (5.5 kgfm,
40 lbfft) C
B
A
19. Install the new cotter pin (C) and bend it as shown. E
22. Tighten bolts the upper and lower joint bolts to the
specified torque.
(contd)
17-47
03/07/29 09:49:45 61S0X050_170_0048
Power Steering
C A
E
26. Fill the system with power steering fluid, and bleed
air from the system (see page 17-14).
3. Pack the interior of the new boot (B) and lip (C) with
27. After installation, perform the following: multipurpose grease.
Start the engine, allow it to idle, and turn the Note these items when installing new grease:
steering wheel from lock-to-lock several times to Keep grease off the boot installation section (D)
warm up the fluid. Check the gearbox for leaks and the tapered section (E) if the ball pin.
(see page 17-11). Do not allow dust, dirt, or other foreign materials
Adjust the front toe (see step 1 on page 18-7). to enter the boot.
Check the steering wheel spoke angle. Adjust by
turning the right and left tie-rods equally, if 4. Install the new boot (A) using the special tool. The
necessary. boot must not have a gap at the boot installation
Do the PCM idle learn procedure (see page 11- sections (B). After installing the boot, check the ball
202). pin tapered section for grease contamination, and
Do the power window control unit reset wipe it if necessary.
procedure (see page 22-200).
07965-SA50500
Set the clock.
Enter the anti-theft codes for the radio and the
navigation system, the custmers radio station
presets.
A
17-48
03/07/29 09:50:54 61S0X050_180_0001
Suspension
Front Suspension
Knuckle/Hub Replacement .......................................... 18-11
Ball Joint Boot Replacement ....................................... 18-16
Lower Arm Removal/Installation ................................ 18-17
Damper/Spring Replacement ...................................... 18-18
Rear Suspension
Hub/Bearing Replacement ........................................... 18-22
Upper Arm Removal/Installation ................................ 18-26
Lower Arm A Removal/Installation ............................. 18-27
Lower Arm B Removal and Installation ...................... 18-28
Trailing Arm Removal/Installation .............................. 18-29
Damper Removal and Installation .............................. 18-30
Spring/Bump Stop Replacement ................................ 18-32
03/07/29 09:50:56 61S0X050_180_0002
Special Tools
Ref. No. Tool Number Description Qty
07AAF-SDAA100 Ball Joint Thread Protector, 12 mm 1
07GAF-SE00100 Hub Dis/Assembly Tool 1
07MAC-SL00200 Ball Joint Remover, 28 mm 1
07746-0010500 Attachment, 62 x 68 mm 1
07749-0010000 Driver 1
07948-SB00101 Attachment, 96 mm 1
07965-SD90100 Support Base 1
07974-SA50700 Ball Joint Boot Clip Guide 1
18-2
03/07/29 09:50:57 61S0X050_180_0003
FRONT DAMPER
Removal, page 18-19
Disassembly/Inspection, page 18-19
Reassembly, page 18-20
Installation, page 18-20
LOWER ARM
Removal/Installation, page 18-17
KNUCKLE/
HUB
Replacement, page 18-11
18-3
03/07/29 09:51:03 61S0X050_180_0004
SPRING/
BUMP STOP
Removal, page 18-33
Installation, page 18-34
UPPER ARM
Removal/Installation, page 18-26
LOWER ARM B
Removal,
page 18-28
Installation,
page 18-28
LOWER ARM A
Removal/Installation,
page 18-27
HUB/BEARING
Replacement, page 18-22
REAR DAMPER
Removal, page 18-30
TRAILING ARM Inspection, page 18-30
Removal/Installation, page 18-29 Installation, page 18-31
SPRING/
BUMP STOP
Removal, page 18-33
Installation, page 18-34
UPPER ARM
Removal/Installation, page 18-26
LOWER ARM B
Removal,
page 18-28
Installation,
page 18-28
LOWER ARM A
Removal/Installation,
page 18-27
HUB/BEARING
Replacement, page 18-22
REAR DAMPER
TRAILING ARM Removal, page 18-30
Removal/Installation, page 18-29 Inspection, page 18-30
Installation, page 18-31
18-4
03/07/29 09:51:03 61S0X050_180_0005
Wheel Alignment
Front Caster Inspection Front Camber Inspection
For proper inspection/adjustment of the wheel Use commercially-available computerized four wheel
alignment, check and adjust the following before alignment equipment to measure wheel alignment
checking the alignment: (caster, camber, toe, and turning angle). Follow the
equipment manufacturers instructions.
Check that the suspension is not modified.
Check the tire size and tire pressure. 1. Check the camber angle.
Check the runout of the wheels and tires.
Check the suspension ball joints. (Hold a wheel with Camber angle:
your hands, and move it up and down and right and Front: 0 00 1
left to check for wobbling.) Rear: 0 30 45
Caster angle: 2 07 1
(contd)
18-5
03/07/29 09:51:04 61S0X050_180_0006
The front camber can be adjusted by exchanging one or If the measurement is within specification,
both of the damper pinch bolts with a smaller diameter measure the toe-in.
adjusting bolt, P/N 90120-S0X-A00. The difference If the measurement is not within specification, go
between the adjusting bolt diameter and the pinch bolt to step 7.
hole diameter allows for a small range of adjustment.
7. Raise the front of the vehicle, and support it with
Damper Pinch Bolt: Adjusting Bolt: safety stands in the proper locations
(see page 1-15). Remove the front wheels.
Camber angle: 0 00 1
Maximum difference between the right and left
side: 1 00
18-6
03/07/29 09:51:05 61S0X050_180_0007
1. Check the tire pressure. 1. Release the parking brake to avoid an incorrect
measurement.
2. Center the steering wheel spokes.
2. Check the toe.
3. Check the toe with the wheels pointed straight
ahead. Rear toe: 02 mm (01/16 in.)
A
14 x 1.5 mm
44 Nm
(4.5 kgfm,
33 lbfft)
C
B 12 x 1.25 mm
83 Nm A
(8.5 kgfm, 61 lbfft)
5. Turn both tie-rods equally until the toe reading on 4. Adjust the rear toe by turning the adjusting bolt
the turning radius gauge is correct. until the toe is correct.
6. After adjusting, tighten the tie-rod locknuts. 5. Install the self-locking nut, and tighten it while
Reposition the tie-rod boot if it is twisted or holding the adjusting bolt.
displaced.
(contd)
18-7
03/07/29 09:51:05 61S0X050_180_0008
Rear:
18-8
03/07/29 09:51:06 61S0X050_180_0009
18-9
03/07/29 09:51:07 61S0X050_180_0010
07AAF-SDAA100
07AAF-SDAA100
A
4. Once the special tool is in place, turn the adjusting
bolt (A) as necessary to make the jaws parallel.
Then hand-tighten the pressure bolt (B), and
2. Apply grease (A) to the special tool on the areas recheck the jaws to make sure they are still parallel.
shown. This will ease installation of the tool and B
prevent damage to the pressure bolt (B) threads.
A B
A C
18-10
03/07/29 09:51:07 61S0X050_180_0011
Front Suspension
Knuckle/Hub Replacement
Exploded View
FLANGE NUT
16 x 1.5 mm
157 Nm (16.0 kgfm, 116 lbfft)
WHEEL BEARING
Replace.
SPLASH GUARD
SNAP RING
DAMPER PINCH BOLT
16 x 1.5 mm
SCREW-WASHER
6 x 14 mm
9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
KNUCKLE
FRONT HUB
Check for damage and
cracks. CENTER CAP
WHEEL NUT
12 x 1.5 mm
BRAKE DISC 108 Nm
Check for wear and (11.0 kgfm,
rust. 79.6 lbfft)
SPINDLE NUT
24 x 1.5 mm
245 Nm
(25.0 kgfm, 181 lbfft)
Replace.
(contd)
18-11
03/07/29 09:51:08 61S0X050_180_0012
Front Suspension
C
245 Nm (25.0 kgfm,
181 lbfft)
B
108 Nm
(11.0 kgfm, 79.6 lbfft) C
18-12
03/07/29 09:51:09 61S0X050_180_0013
9. Remove the brake disc from the knuckle. 15. Remove the damper pinch bolts (A) and flange nuts
(B) from the damper.
10. Check the front hub for damage and cracks.
B
16 x 1.5 mm
11. Remove the cotter pin (A) from the tie-rod end ball 157 Nm
joint, then loosen the nut (B). (16.0 kgfm, 116 lbfft)
07MAC-SL00200 A
B
12 x 1.25 mm
5969 Nm A
(6.07.0 kgfm,
07MAC-SL00200 4351 lbfft)
14. Remove the lower ball joint from the knuckle using
the special tool (see page 18-10).
(contd)
18-13
03/07/29 09:51:10 61S0X050_180_0014
Front Suspension
C
22. Press a new wheel bearing (A) into the knuckle (B)
using the old bearing (C), a steel plate (D), the
B special tool, and a press. Place the wheel bearing
on the knuckle with the pack seal side facing (metal
color) toward the inside. Be careful not to damage
the sleeve of the pack seal.
D
BLACK COLOR
Press
C
19. Press the wheel bearing (A) out of the knuckle (B) METAL COLOR
using the special tools and a press.
INSIDE
Press 07749-0010000
B
07965-SD90100 07948-SB00101
07746-0010500
23. Install the snap ring (A) securely in the knuckle (B).
D B
9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
C
B
20. Press the wheel bearing inner race (A) from the hub
(B) using the special tool, a commercially available
bearing separator (C), and a press.
Press
07GAF-SE00100
A
A
24. Install the splash guard (C), and tighten the screws
(D).
18-14
03/07/29 09:51:11 61S0X050_180_0015
25. Install the hub (A) onto the knuckle (B) using the
special tools shown and a hydraulic press. Be
careful not to distort the splash guard (C).
Press
07749-0010000
07746-0010500
C
B
A
07965-SD90100
18-15
03/07/29 09:51:11 61S0X050_180_0016
Front Suspension
A C
6. For an upper ball joint, just hold the tool over the
B B joint, then slide the clip over the tool and into
position on the boot.
3. Wipe the grease off the tapered portion of the shaft
(C), and pack fresh grease into the base. Do not let 7. After installing a boot, wipe any grease off the
dirt or other foreign materials get into the boot. exposed portion of the ball joint shaft.
18-16
03/07/29 09:51:12 61S0X050_180_0017
1. Raise the front of the vehicle, and support it with Be careful not to damage the ball joint boot when
safety stands in the proper locations connecting the lower arm to the knuckle.
(see page 1-15). Place a jack under the lower arm, and raise the
lower arm to load the suspension with the
2. Remove the lock pin from the lower arm ball joint vehicles weight.
castle nut, and remove the nut. Tighten all mounting hardware to the specified
torque values.
Tighten the castle nut to the lower torque value,
then tighten it only far enough to align the slot
with the hole in the stud. Do not align the castle
nut by loosening it.
Use a new lock pin on the castle nut.
Before installing the wheel, clean the mating
surfaces on the brake disc and the inside of the
wheel.
Check the front wheel alignment, and adjust it if
12 x 1.25 mm necessary (see page 18-5).
5969 Nm
(6.07.0 kgfm,
4351 lbfft)
07MAC-SL00200
B C
14 x 1.5 mm 14 x 1.5 mm
93 Nm 93 Nm
(9.5 kgfm, (9.5 kgfm,
69 lbfft) 69 lbfft)
18-17
03/07/29 09:51:12 61S0X050_180_0018
Front Suspension
Damper/Spring Replacement
Exploded View
DAMPER MOUNTING
SPRING UPPER SEAT BEARING
Check for any play or
roughness.
DUST COVER
Check for bending
and damage.
DAMPER SPRING
Check for weakened compression
and damage.
BUMP STOP
Check for weakness
and damage.
DAMPER UNIT
18-18
03/07/29 09:51:13 61S0X050_180_0019
4. Remove the service caps (A), and remove the 5. Check for oil leaks, abnormal noises, or binding
damper by removing the three flange nuts. during these tests.
(contd)
18-19
03/07/29 09:51:15 61S0X050_180_0020
Front Suspension
C
A
A A
B 22 Nm
16 x 1.5 mm (2.2 kgfm,
157 Nm 16 lbfft)
(16.0 kgfm, 116 lbfft)
18-20
03/07/29 09:51:15 61S0X050_180_0021
18-21
03/07/29 09:51:16 61S0X050_180_0022
Rear Suspension
Hub/Bearing Replacement
Exploded View
REAR DRUM BRAKE TYPE: 99-01 models
KNUCKLE
FLANGE BOLTS
10 x 1.25 mm
35 Nm (3.5 kgfm, 25 lbfft) SPINDLE NUT 24 x 1.5 mm
245 Nm (25.0 kgfm, 181 lbfft)
Replace.
CENTER
CAP
BACKING PLATE
BRAKE SHOE
HUB
(includes bearing)
BRAKE DRUM
HUB CAP
Replace. WHEEL NUTS 12 x 1.5 mm
108 Nm (11.0 kgfm, 79.6 lbfft)
12 x 1.25 mm
93 Nm (9.5 kgfm, 69 lbfft)
6 mm BRAKE DISC
BRAKE DISC/DRUM RETAINING FLAT SCREWS
9.8 Nm
10 x 1.25 mm (1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
38 Nm
(3.9 kgfm,
28 lbfft) SPINDLE NUT
24 x 1.5 mm
245 Nm
(25.0 kgfm,
181 lbfft)
Replace.
KNUCKLE
18-22
03/07/29 09:51:17 61S0X050_180_0023
REAR DRUM BRAKE TYPE: 99-01 models 7. Screw two 8 x 1.25 mm bolts into the drum to push
it away from the hub bearing unit. Turn each bolt
1. Raise the rear of the vehicle, and support it with two turns at a time to prevent cocking the brake
safety stands in the proper locations drum excessively. Remove the brake drum from
(see page 1-15). the hub bearing unit. If the drum does not come off
easily, back off the brake adjuster one full turn
2. Remove the wheel nuts (A) and rear wheel (B). (23 teeth).
C
8 x 1.25 mm
(contd)
18-23
03/07/29 09:51:18 61S0X050_180_0024
Rear Suspension
1. Loosen the wheel nuts slightly. 6. Remove the hub cap (A).
2. Raise the rear of the vehicle, and support it with A
safety stands in the proper locations
(see page 1-15).
B
24 x 1.5 mm
245 Nm
(25.0 kgfm,
181 lbfft)
A
6 x 1.0 mm
9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
18-24
03/07/29 09:51:18 61S0X050_180_0025
18-25
03/07/29 09:51:19 61S0X050_180_0026
Rear Suspension
A
12 x 1.25 mm
A 64 Nm
(6.5 kgfm, 47 lbfft)
3. Remove the lock pin from the upper ball joint castle
nut, and remove the nut. A
07MAC-SL00200 12 x 1.25 mm
4959 Nm
(5.06.0 kgfm,
3643 lbfft)
18-26
03/07/29 09:51:20 61S0X050_180_0027
2. Remove the lower arm A mounting bolt (B). 7. Position a floor jack at the connecting point of
lower arm B and the knuckle (A).
C
12 x 1.25 mm
64 Nm (6.5 kgfm,
47 lbfft)
A
18-27
03/07/29 09:51:21 61S0X050_180_0028
Rear Suspension
A B
D 6 x 1.0 mm
9.8 Nm
B (1.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft)
A
A 12 x 1.25 mm
74 Nm
(7.5 kgfm,
54 lbfft)
18-28
03/07/29 09:51:21 61S0X050_180_0029
A
9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
B
14 x 1.5 mm
A 103 Nm
12 x 1.25 mm (10.5 kgfm, 75.9 lbfft)
64 Nm
(6.5 kgfm, 47 lbfft)
18-29
03/07/29 09:51:22 61S0X050_180_0030
Rear Suspension
18-30
03/07/29 09:51:22 61S0X050_180_0031
Installation
1. Lower the rear suspension. Compress the damper
(A) by hand, and move it into position. Loosely
install the flange bolt (B) and self-locking nut (C).
B
12 x 1.25 mm
64 Nm (6.5 kgfm, 47 lbfft)
C
12 x 1.25 mm
64 Nm
(6.5 kgfm,
47 lbfft)
18-31
03/07/29 09:51:23 61S0X050_180_0032
Rear Suspension
BUMP STOP
Check for weakness
and damage.
10 x 1.25 mm
39 Nm
(4.0 kgfm, 29 lbfft)
SPRING
Check for weakened compression
and damage.
18-32
03/07/29 09:51:23 61S0X050_180_0033
(contd)
18-33
03/07/29 09:51:24 61S0X050_180_0034
Rear Suspension
10 x 1.25 mm A
39 Nm
(4.0 kgfm, 29 lbfft)
D 9.8 Nm
(1.0 kgfm,
7.2 lbfft)
C
B
A
12 x 1.25 mm
E 74 Nm (7.5 kgfm,
54 lbfft)
B
5. Slowly raise the jack until you can align the bolt
hole with the holes in the lower arm B and the
knuckle by raising the flange bolt.
18-34
03/07/29 09:53:38 61S0X050_190_0001
Brakes
03/07/29 09:53:42 61S0X050_190_0002
INDICATOR
Brake System Indicator Circuit
Diagram, page 19-10
Parking Brake Switch
Test, page 19-11
Brake Fluid Level Switch
Test, page 19-11
REAR BRAKES
Rear Drum Brake
Inspection, page 19-19
Rear Brake Shoe
Replacement, page 19-21
Rear Wheel Cylinder
Replacement, page 19-24
19-2
03/07/29 09:53:47 61S0X050_190_0003
INDICATOR
Brake System Indicator Circuit
Diagram, page 19-10
Parking Brake Switch
Test, page 19-11
Brake Fluid Level Switch
Test, page 19-11
19-3
03/07/29 09:53:48 61S0X050_190_0004
2. Attach a 50 mm (2 in.) piece of masking tape along the bottom of the steering wheel, and draw a horizontal
reference mark across it.
3. With the transmission in Neutral, press and hold the brake pedal lightly (about the same pressure needed to keep
an A/T-equipped car from creeping). Then release the parking brake.
4. While still holding the brake pedal, hook the end of the tape measure behind it. Then, pull the tape up to the
steering wheel, noting where the tape measure lines up with the reference mark you made on the masking tape.
19-4
03/07/29 09:53:48 61S0X050_190_0005
Rapid brake pad wear, vehicle vibration (after a long drive), or high, hard brake pedal
1. Drive the vehicle until the brakes drag or until the pedal is high and hard. This can take 20 or more brake pedal
applications during an extended test drive.
2. With the engine running, raise the vehicle on a lift, and spin all four wheels by hand.
YESGo to step 3.
NOLook for other causes of the pad wear, high pedal, or vehicle vibration.
3. Turn the engine off, pump the brake pedal to deplete the vacuum in the brake booster, and then spin the wheels
again to check for brake drag.
YESGo to step 4.
4. Without removing the brake lines, unbolt and separate the master cylinder from the booster, then spin the wheels
to check for brake drag.
YESGo to step 5.
NOCheck the brake pedal position switch adjustment and pedal free play.
5. Loosen the hydraulic lines at the master cylinder, then spin the wheels to check for brake drag.
YESGo to step 6.
6. Loosen the bleeder screws at each caliper, then spin the wheels to check for brake drag.
YESDisassemble and repair the caliper on the wheel(s) with brake drag.
NOLook for and replace any damaged brake lines. If all brake lines are OK, replace the ABS modulator.
19-5
03/07/29 09:53:48 61S0X050_190_0006
Brake Pedal Height Check and Brake Pedal Position Switch Adjustment
Pedal Height Pedal Free Play
1. Disconnect the brake pedal position switch 3. With the engine off, inspect the pedal free play (A)
connector, loosen the brake pedal position switch on the pedal pad (B) by pushing the brake pedal by
locknut (A), and back off the brake pedal position hand.
switch (B) until it is no longer touching the brake
pedal. Free Play: 15 mm (0.040.20 in.)
A C
B
B
D
A
E
B A
0.3 mm
(0.01 in.)
19-6
03/07/29 09:53:49 61S0X050_190_0007
A
Pressed with
294 N
(30 kgf, 66 lbf)
(contd)
19-7
03/07/29 09:53:50 61S0X050_190_0008
A
A
B C
19-8
03/07/29 09:53:51 61S0X050_190_0009
2. Attach a length of clear drain tube to the bleed 3. Have someone slowly pump the brake pedal
screw. several times, then apply steady pressure.
19-9
03/07/29 09:53:51 61S0X050_190_0010
BLK/YEL
BLK/YEL
UNDER-DASH DRIVERS
FUSE 6 FUSE 9 FUSE/RELAY BOX
(15A) (10A)
YEL Canada
YEL YEL
GAUGE
ASSEMBLY B11
B8 B14 C14
WHT/BLU YEL/WHT
GRN/RED
BLU/WHT
ALTERNATOR
ABS/TCS CONTROL UNIT
ABS CONTROL UNIT
DAYTIME RUNNING
LIGHTS CONTROL UNIT
GRN/RED
GRN/RED
GRN/WHT
Canada USA
BRAKE FLUID
PARKING BRAKE SWITCH LEVEL SWITCH
CLOSED: Pedal pressed CLOSED: Float down
OPEN: Pedal released OPEN: Float up
BLK
G301
19-10
03/07/29 09:53:52 61S0X050_190_0011
B
D
C
B
With the parking brake pedal pressed, there With the float up, there should be no continuity.
should be continuity. With the float down, there should be continuity.
With the parking brake pedal released, there
should be no continuity.
NOTE:
If both the ABS or TCS indicator and the brake
system indicator come on at the same time,
check the ABS (see page 19-41) or TCS (see page
19-81) first.
If the parking brake switch/fluid level switch is
OK, but the brake system indicator does not
function, check the ABS or TCS (For Canada
model: do the input test for the daytime running
lights control unit first.
19-11
03/07/29 09:53:53 61S0X050_190_0012
A
1. Loosen the front wheel nuts slightly. Raise the front
of the vehicle, and support it with safety stands in
the proper locations (see page 1-15). Remove the
front wheels.
A
B C
19-12
03/07/29 09:53:53 61S0X050_190_0013
9. Check the brake disc for damage and cracks. 13. Push in the piston (A) so that the caliper will fit over
the pads. Make sure that the piston boot is in
10. Install the pad retainers (A). position to prevent damaging it when pivoting the
caliper down.
19-13
03/07/29 09:53:54 61S0X050_190_0014
2. Remove the brake pads (see page 19-12). 2. Remove the brake pads (see page 19-12).
3. Inspect the disc surface for damage and cracks. 3. Using a micrometer, measure brake disc thickness
Clean the brake disc thoroughly and remove all rust. at eight points, approximately 45 apart and 10 mm
(0.4 in.) in from the outer edge of the brake disc.
4. Use wheel nuts and suitable flat washers (A) to Replace the brake disc if the smallest measurement
hold the disc securely against the hub, then mount is less than the max. refinishing limit.
a dial indicator as shown, and measure the runout
at 10 mm (0.4 in.) from the outer edge of the disc. Brake Disc Thickness:
Standard: 27.928.1 mm (1.101.11 in.)
Brake Disc Runout: Max. Refinishing Limit: 26.0 mm (1.02 in.)
Service Limit: 0.10 mm (0.004 in.) Brake Disc Parallelism:
0.015 mm (0.0006 in.) max.
10 mm (0.4 in.)
108 Nm
(11.0 kgfm, 79.6 lbfft)
A
19-14
03/07/29 09:53:55 61S0X050_190_0015
Frequent inhalation of brake pad dust, regardless of material composition, could be hazardous to your health.
Avoid breathing dust particles.
Never use an air hose or brush to clean brake assemblies. Use an OSHA-approved vacuum cleaner.
Remove, disassemble, inspect, reassemble, and install the caliper, and note these items:
Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid gets on the paint, wash it off
immediately with water.
To prevent dripping brake fluid, cover disconnected hose joints with rags or shop towels.
Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
Before reassembling, check that all parts are free of dust and other foreign particles.
Replace parts with new ones as specified in the illustration.
Make sure no dirt or other foreign matter gets in the brake fluid.
Make sure no grease or oil gets on the brake discs or pads.
When reusing pads, always reinstall them in their original positions to prevent loss of braking efficiency.
Do not reuse drained brake fluid. Use only clean Honda DOT 3 Brake Fluid. Non-Honda brake fluid can cause
corrosion and shorten the life of the system.
Do not mix different brands of brake fluid as they may not be compatible.
Coat the piston, piston seal groove, and caliper bore with clean brake fluid.
Replace all rubber parts with new ones whenever disassembled.
After installing the caliper, check the brake hose and line for leaks, interference, and twisting.
PIN CALIPER
BRACKET
MAIN PIN
BRAKE HOSE
8 x 1.0 mm
26 Nm
(2.7 kgfm,
20 lbfft)
19-15
03/07/29 09:53:56 61S0X050_190_0016
RESERVOIR
SCREW Check for damage.
F GROMMETS
Check for damage and
E deterioration.
25 Nm (2.5 kgfm, 18 lbfft)
2. Remove the brake fluid from the master cylinder MASTER CYLINDER
Check for leaks, rust, and
reservoir (C) with a syringe. damage.
19-16
03/07/29 09:53:56 61S0X050_190_0017
19-17
03/07/29 09:53:57 61S0X050_190_0018
C B E F
3. Remove the cable bracket (B) from the throttle body, 8. Install the brake booster in the reverse order of
then disconnect the throttle cable end (C) and removal, and note these items:
actuator cable end (D) from the throttle linkage.
After installation, adjust brake pedal height and
4. Disconnect the vacuum hose (E) from the brake brake pedal free play (see page 19-6).
booster (F). After installation, check for the cable free play,
and adjust the actuator cable (see page 4-52) and
5. Remove the lock pin (A) and joint pin (B). the throttle cable (see page 11-242) if necessary.
C
8 x 1.25 mm
25 Nm (2.5 kgfm, 18 lbfft)
19-18
03/07/29 09:53:58 61S0X050_190_0019
Frequent inhalation of brake pad dust, regardless of material composition, could be hazardous to your health.
Avoid breathing dust particles.
Never use an air hose or brush to clean brake assemblies. Use an OSHA-approved vacuum cleaner.
NOTE:
Contaminated brake linings or drums reduce stopping ability.
Block the front wheels before raising the rear of the vehicle.
1. Raise the rear of the vehicle, and support it with safety stands in the proper locations (see page 1-15).
2. Release the parking brake, and remove the rear brake drum (see page 18-22).
PIVOT PIN
THERMO CLIP
UPPER RETURN SPRING
Check for weakness
and damage.
U-CLIP
Replace.
FLANGE BOLTS
10 x 1.25 mm
39 Nm (4.0 kgfm,
29 lbfft)
ADJUSTER NUT
ADJUSTER BOLT
Check ratchet teeth
for wear and damage. RETAINER SPRING
Install securely on
BRAKE SHOE tension pin.
If brake shoes are to be
reused, mark and reassemble
in same position.
SELF-ADJUSTER
LEVER LOWER RETURN SPRING
SELF-ADJUSTER Check for weakness
SPRING and damage.
Check for weakness
and damage.
(contd)
19-19
03/07/29 09:53:59 61S0X050_190_0020
B C
19-20
03/07/29 09:53:59 61S0X050_190_0021
19-21
03/07/29 09:54:00 61S0X050_190_0022
E G
C
B A
13. Install the parking brake lever (B) on the pivot pin,
7. Remove the lower return spring (B). and secure with a new U-clip (C). Pinch the U-clip
securely to prevent the pivot pin from coming out
8. Expand the top of the brake shoes equally, and of the brake shoe.
remove them from the wheel cylinder. Do not let
the piston push into the cylinder, and be careful not 14. Apply Molykote 44MA grease on each sliding
to damage the boots during removal. surface shown. Wipe off any excess. Do not get
grease on the brake linings.
9. Remove the upper return spring (C), adjuster bolt
(D), self-adjuster spring (E), and lever (F), and Sliding surface
separate the brake shoes.
19-22
03/07/29 09:54:01 61S0X050_190_0023
15. Apply Molykote 44MA grease to the brake shoe 17. Clean the threaded portions of the adjuster bolt (A)
ends and opposite edges of the brake shoes shown. and nut (B), and coat the threads with grease.
Wipe off any excess. Do not get grease on the Install the adjuster nut, thermo clip (C), and
brake lining. connecting rod (D) on the adjuster bolt. To shorten
the adjuster bolt, turn the adjuster nut.
Opposite edge of the shoe
Brake shoe ends
(Shoe side ends and backing
plate contact surface) D
C
B
A
G
21. Fit the top of the brake shoes on the wheel cylinder
pistons. Connect the upper return spring (G). Note
the installation direction.
22. Hook the lower return spring (H) on the brake shoes.
(contd)
19-23
03/07/29 09:54:02 61S0X050_190_0024
A
1. Remove the brake shoes (see page 19-21).
B
2. Disconnect the brake line (A) from the wheel
cylinder (B).
9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm, C
7.2 lbfft) 9.0 Nm (0.9 kgfm,
6.5 lbfft)
19-24
03/07/29 09:54:03 61S0X050_190_0025
A
3. Remove the pad shims (A) and pads (B).
B
A
B
(contd)
19-25
03/07/29 09:54:04 61S0X050_190_0026
B
8 x 1.0 mm
37 Nm
(3.8 kgfm,
27 lbfft)
19-26
03/07/29 09:54:04 61S0X050_190_0027
2. Remove the brake pads (see page 19-25). 3. Using a micrometer, measure disc thickness at
eight points, about 45 apart and 10 mm (0.4 in.) in
3. Inspect the brake disc surface for damage and from the outer edge of the brake disc. Replace the
cracks. Clean the disc thoroughly, and remove all brake disc if the smallest measurement is less than
rust. the max. refinishing limit.
4. Install suitable flat washers (A) and wheel nuts, and Brake Disc Thickness:
tighten the nuts to the specified torque to hold the Standard: 10.911.1 mm (0.430.44 in.)
brake disc securely against the hub. Max. Refinishing Limit: 9.0 mm (0.35 in.)
Brake Disc Parallelism:
0.015 mm (0.0006 in.) max.
10 mm (0.4 in.)
108 Nm
(11.0 kgfm, 79.6 lbfft)
NOTE:
If the brake disc is beyond the service limit for
refinishing, replace it (see step 8 page 18-24).
A new disc should be refinished if its runout is
greater than 0.10 mm (0.004 in.).
19-27
03/07/29 09:54:05 61S0X050_190_0028
Frequent inhalation of brake pad dust, regardless of material composition, could be hazardous to your health.
Avoid breathing dust particles.
Never use an air hose or brush to clean brake assemblies. Use an OSHA-approved vacuum cleaner.
Remove, disassemble, inspect, reassemble, and install the caliper, and note these items:
Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; it may damage the paint. If brake fluid gets on the paint, wash it off
immediately with water.
To prevent dripping brake fluid, cover disconnected hose joints with rags or shop towels.
Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
Before reassembling, check that all parts are free of dirt and other foreign particles.
Replace parts with new ones as specified in the illustration.
Make sure no dirt or other foreign matter gets into the brake fluid.
Make sure no grease or oil gets on the brake discs or pads.
When reusing pads, always reinstall them in their original positions to prevent loss of braking efficiency.
Do not reuse drained brake fluid. Use only clean Honda DOT 3 Brake Fluid. Non-Honda brake fluid can cause
corrosion and shorten the life of the system.
Do not mix different brands of brake fluid as they may not be compatible.
Coat the piston, piston seal groove, and caliper bore with clean brake fluid.
Replace all rubber parts with new ones whenever disassembled.
After installing the caliper, check the brake hose and line for leaks, interference, and twisting.
CALIPER BODY
BANJO BOLT
34 Nm
CALIPER (3.5 kgfm,
BRACKET 25 lbfft)
PIN BRAKE HOSE
8 x 1.0 mm
37 Nm (3.8 kgfm, 27 lbfft)
PISTON SEAL
INNER PAD Replace. BOOT RING
PIN BOOTS SHIM A PISTON
Replace.
INNER PAD
SHIM B
PISTON BOOT
Replace.
BRAKE PADS
OUTER PAD SHIM
WEAR INDICATOR
Install inner pad
with its wear
PINS indicator downward.
PAD RETAINERS
10 x 1.25 mm
55 Nm
(5.6 kgfm, 41 lbfft) CALIPER BRACKET
19-28
03/07/29 09:54:06 61S0X050_190_0029
Frequent inhalation of brake pad dust, regardless of material composition, could be hazardous to your health.
Avoid breathing dust particles.
Never use an air hose or brush to clean brake assemblies. Use an OSHA-approved vacuum cleaner.
1. Raise the rear of the vehicle, and support it with safety stands in the proper locations (see page 1-15). Remove the
rear wheels.
2. Release the parking brake, and remove the rear caliper and brake disc/drum (see page 18-24).
FLANGE NUTS
10 x 1.25 mm
39 Nm RETAINER
(3.8 kgfm, 28 lbfft) SPRINGS
ROD SPRING
Check for weakness
and damage.
RETAINERS
Install securely on
tension pin.
BACKING PLATE
Marked left and right. CONNECTING ROD
(contd)
19-29
03/07/29 09:54:06 61S0X050_190_0030
A
Parking Brake Drum Inside Diameter:
Standard: 210.0210.1 mm (8.2688.272 in.)
B
Service limit: 211.0 mm (8.307 in.)
Parking Brake Lining Thickness: 8. If the inside diameter of the parking brake drum is
Standard: 4.0 mm (0.16 in.) more than service limit, replace the rear brake
Service limit: 1.0 mm (0.04 in.) disc/drum.
5. If the brake lining thickness is less than the service 9. Check the parking brake drum for scoring, grooves,
limit, replace all the parking brake shoes as a set. and cracks.
19-30
03/07/29 09:54:07 61S0X050_190_0031
A
Disassembly
1. Raise the rear of the vehicle, and support it with
safety stands in the proper locations 6. Lower the parking brake shoe assembly.
(see page 1-15). Remove the rear wheels.
7. Remove the forward brake shoe by removing the
2. Release the parking brake, and remove the rear lower return spring (A) and adjuster assembly (B).
brake caliper and brake disc/drum (see page 18-24).
A
A
B
(contd)
19-31
03/07/29 09:54:08 61S0X050_190_0032
B
C
A
19-32
03/07/29 09:54:09 61S0X050_190_0033
4. Apply Molykote 44 MA grease to the shoe ends and 6. Clean the threaded portions of the clevis A, and
connecting rod ends (A), sliding surfaces (B), and coat the threads with multipurpose grease. Clean
opposite edges of the parking brake shoe (C) as the sliding surface of the clevis B, and coat the
shown. Wipe off any excess grease Keep grease off sliding surface with multipurpose grease. Install
the brake linings. the clevis A and B on the adjuster (C), and shorten
the clevis A by turning the adjuster.
E
A A
B
C
C
A A
C C
C C
D
A A
Greasing symbols:
Brake shoe ends and connecting rod ends B
Opposite edge of the shoe
C A
Sliding surface
7. Reinstall the brake shoe adjuster assembly (D), and
5. Install the tension pin (A), retainer spring (B), and hook the lower return spring (E) on the parking
retainer (C) of the rearward brake shoe (D). Make brake shoes.
sure the tension pin does not contact the parking
brake lever. 8. Install the rod spring (A) to the connecting rod (B)
first. Then install the connecting rod on the parking
brake shoes.
A
A
(contd)
19-33
03/07/29 09:54:10 61S0X050_190_0034
10. Install the upper return springs (A). 4. Press the parking brake pedal two to four clicks.
A
19-34
03/07/29 09:54:11 61S0X050_190_0035
2. Check the brake lines for damage, rusting, and leakage. Also check for bent brake lines.
3. Check for leaks at hose and line joints or connections, and retighten if necessary.
4. Check the master cylinder and ABS or ABS/TCS modulator unit for damage and leakage.
NOTE: Replace the brake hose clip whenever the brake hose is serviced.
19-35
03/07/29 09:54:12 61S0X050_190_0036
D
C
A
7. Install the brake hose (A) on the upper brake hose
bracket (B) with a new brake hose clip (C).
2. Disconnect the brake hose from the brake line (B) D
using a 10 mm flare-nut wrench (C). 15 Nm
(1.5 kgfm,
11 lbfft)
3. Remove and discard the brake hose clip (A) from
C
the brake hose (B).
Check the brake hose and line joint for leaks, and
tighten if necessary.
4. Remove the banjo bolt (C), and disconnect the Check the brake hoses for interference and
brake hose from the caliper. twisting.
19-36
03/07/29 09:54:13 61S0X050_190_0037
EQUALIZER
CABLE CLIP
(contd)
19-37
03/07/29 09:54:13 61S0X050_190_0038
Rear Drum Brake: 99-01 Models 2. Remove the parking brake cable (A) from the
backing plate (B) using a 12 mm offset wrench (C).
1. Release the parking brake pedal fully, and
disconnect the parking brake cable from the pedal.
B
C
19-38
03/07/29 09:54:14 61S0X050_190_0039
Brakes
03/07/29 09:54:17 61S0X050_190_0040
ABS Components
PASSENGERS UNDER-DASH
FUSE/RELAY BOX ABS CONTROL UNIT
Replacement, page 19-77
LEFT-REAR
WHEEL SENSOR
Inspection, page 19-77
Replacement, page 19-78
19-40
03/07/29 09:54:17 61S0X050_190_0041
Pump Motor
The pump motor operates when the ABS is
functioning.
The ABS control unit checks the pump motor
operation during initial diagnosis when the vehicle is
started. You may hear the motor operate at this time,
but it is normal.
(contd)
19-41
03/07/29 09:54:18 61S0X050_190_0042
ABS Components
19-42
03/07/29 09:54:19 61S0X050_190_0043
4. The blinking frenquency indicates the DTC. DTCs How to Clear DTCs
are indicated by a series of long and short blinks.
One long blink equals 10 short blinks. Add the long HDS (Honda Diagnostic System) Method
and short blinks together to determine the DTC.
After determining the DTC, refer to the DTC 1. With the ignition switch OFF, connect the HDS to
Troubleshooting Index. the 16P data link connector (DLC) (A) under the
drivers side of the dashboard.
NOTE: If the DTC is not memorized, the ABS
indicator will go off for 3.6 seconds, and then come
back on.
Example of DTC 15 A
Short blinks
Long blink (5 times)
2. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), and clear the
ON DTC(s) by following the screen prompts on the HDS.
OFF
NOTE: See the HDS help menu for specific
instructions.
(contd)
19-43
03/07/29 09:54:19 61S0X050_190_0044
ABS Components
19-44
03/07/29 09:54:19 61S0X050_190_0045
19-45
03/07/29 09:54:19 61S0X050_190_0046
ABS Components
19-46
03/07/29 09:54:20 61S0X050_190_0047
System Description
ABS Control Unit Inputs and Outputs for Connector B (12P)
19-47
03/07/29 09:54:20 61S0X050_190_0048
ABS Components
19-48
03/07/29 09:54:20 61S0X050_190_0049
(contd)
19-49
03/07/29 09:54:21 61S0X050_190_0050
ABS Components
COEFFICIENT OF
FRICTION
TARGET SLIP RATE
ROTATIONAL
DIRECTION
RADIAL
DIRECTION
OF THE
ROTATIONAL
DIRECTION
SLIP RATE
FR RR
MASTER CYLINDER WHEEL
SENSOR
WHEEL
SENSOR WHEEL WHEEL
SENSOR SENSOR
SIGNAL SIGNAL
SOLENOID
VALVE
CONTROL
NO NO DAMPING NO NO
CHAMBER
ABS
P M P CONTROL
PUMP PUMP UNIT
MOTOR
NC NC WHEEL
SOLENOID SENSOR
NC VALVE SIGNAL
NC CONTROL
RESERVOIR RESERVOIR
MODULATOR UNIT
WHEEL
SENSOR WHEEL
SENSOR
SIGNAL WHEEL
SENSOR
FL RL
19-50
03/07/29 09:55:39 61S0X050_190_0051
The ABS control unit calculates the slip rate of each wheel, and it transmits the control signal to the modulator unit
solenoid valve when the slip rate is high.
The pressure reduction control has three modes: pressure reducing, pressure retaining, and pressure intensifying.
DETECT REFERENCE
VEHICLE SPEED SLIP RATE
REAR
RIGHT-REAR DETECT DETECT ABS DRIVE RIGHT-REAR
WHEEL SENSOR WHEEL SPEED SLIP RATE CONTROL SOLENOID SOLENOID
RIGHT-FRONT
RIGHT-FRONT DETECT DETECT ABS DRIVE RIGHT-FRONT
WHEEL SENSOR WHEEL SPEED SLIP RATE CONTROL SOLENOID SOLENOID
LEFT-FRONT
LEFT-FRONT DETECT DETECT ABS DRIVE LEFT-FRONT
WHEEL SENSOR WHEEL SPEED SLIP RATE CONTROL SOLENOID SOLENOID
(contd)
19-51
03/07/29 09:55:39 61S0X050_190_0052
ABS Components
1. The ABS control unit is equipped with a main CPU and a sub-CPU. Each CPU checks the other for problems.
Initial diagnosis: Done right after the engine starts and until the ABS indicator goes off.
Regular diagnosis: Done right after the initial diagnosis until the ignition switch is turned OFF.
Self-diagnosis Table
NOTE:
At the DTCs with mark, there are cases that the ABS control unit shifts to fail-safe mode A1, L1 when the ABS
control unit detects more than one DTC and for different wheel.
If the ABS control unit detects the DTCs which have different fail-safe mode individually, the control unit take
priority the large number mode.
19-52
03/07/29 09:55:39 61S0X050_190_0053
(contd)
19-53
03/07/29 09:55:42 61S0X050_190_0054
ABS Components
SOLENOID VALVE
PUMP MOTOR
Motor operation mode: When starting the pressure reducing mode, the pump motor is ON.
When stopping ABS operation, the pump motor is OFF.
The caliper fluid is pumped out by the pump, through the damping chamber, to the
master cylinder.
19-54
03/07/29 09:55:43 61S0X050_190_0055
Wheel Sensors
The wheel sensors are the magnetic contactless type. As the gear pulser teeth rotate past the wheel sensors magnetic
coil, AC current is generated. The AC frequency changes in accordance with the wheel speed. The ABS control unit
detects the wheel sensor signal frequency and thereby detects the wheel speed.
VOLTAGE
Wheel Speed and Modulator Control
WHEEL SPEED
TIME
PRESSURE
OUTLET
VALVE ON
OFF
INLET
VALVE ON
OFF
MOTOR
ON
OFF
When the wheel speed drops sharply below the vehicle speed, the inlet valve closes and if necessary the outlet valve
opens momentarily to reduce the caliper fluid pressure. The pump motor starts at this time. As the wheel speed is
restored, the outlet valve closes, and the inlet valve opens momentarily to increase the caliper fluid pressure.
19-55
03/07/29 09:55:44 61S0X050_190_0056
ABS Components
Circuit Diagram
BATTERY
5 1
ABS
PUMP YEL/GRN
MOTOR
RELAY
4 3
YEL/RED
BRN/BLK
WHT/BLU BRN/BLK
GRN GRN
MODULATOR UNIT
PASSENGERS UNDER-DASH 10
FUSE/RELAY BOX FL-IN
IN
4 RED/BLU
ABS MOTOR CHECK (7.5A) LEFT-FRONT
SOLENOID FL-OUT
C4 J5 8 YEL/BLU
OUT
FR-IN
IN
1 RED/BLK
RIGHT-FRONT
SOLENOID FR-OUT
OUT
5 YEL/BLK
RL-IN
IN
2 RED/GRN
LEFT-REAR
SOLENOID RL-OUT
OUT
6 YEL/GRN
RR-IN
IN
3 RED/WHT
RIGHT-REAR
SOLENOID RR-OUT
OUT
7 YEL/WHT
PUMP MOTOR
WHT/BLU 1
M 2 BLK
G302
UNDER-HOOD FUSE/RELAY BOX CONNECTORS BRAKE SWITCH CONNECTOR ABS PUMP MOTOR MODULATOR UNIT
CONNECTOR A (18P) CONNECTOR B (7P) 2P CONNECTOR 4P CONNECTOR RELAY CONNECTOR CONNECTOR
(With cruise control) ( number)
19-56
03/07/29 09:55:46 61S0X050_190_0057
WALP
BLU/WHT B1
IG2 5V
YEL/BLK A11
REGULATOR
To IG2 To VCC
FSR
YEL/GRN A21 IG2
PMR
YEL/RED B12
IG2
FL-OUT FRW ()
YEL/BLU B4 A9 GRN/BLK 1
FR-IN () RIGHT-
FRW () FRONT
RED/BLK B11 A8 GRN 2
FR-OUT ( )
YEL/BLK B6 RLW ()
A17 LT BLU 2
RL-IN LEFT-
RED/GRN B10 RLW () REAR
A18 GRY 1
RL-OUT
YEL/GRN B5 RRW ()
RR-IN A19 GRN/YEL 2
RIGHT-
RED/WHT B8 RRW () REAR
A20 BLU/YEL 1
RR-OUT
YEL/WHT B3
GND1
B2 BLK
GND2
B7 BLK
GND3
A1 BLK
GND4
A12
G303 G303
CONNECTOR B (12P)
Terminal side of Wire side of
male terminals female terminals
19-57
03/07/29 09:55:46 61S0X050_190_0058
ABS Components
DTC Troubleshooting
DTC 11, 13, 15, 17: Wheel Sensor (Open/ 4. Check for continuity between the appropriate
Short to Body Ground/Short to Power) wheel sensor () circuit terminal and body ground
(see table).
1. Disconnect the ABS control unit connector A (22P).
DTC Appropriate Terminal
2. Start the engine. 11 (Right-front) No. 9: FRW ()
13 (Left-front) No. 7: FLW ()
3. Measure the voltage between the appropriate 15 (Right-rear) No. 19: RRW ()
wheel sensor () circuit terminal and body ground 17 (Left-rear) No. 17: RLW ()
(see table).
ABS CONTROL UNIT CONNECTOR A (22P)
DTC Appropriate Terminal
11 (Right-front) No. 9: FRW () FLW () (GRN/BLU) FRW () (GRN/BLK)
13 (Left-front) No. 7: FLW ()
15 (Right-rear) No. 19: RRW ()
17 (Left-rear) No. 17: RLW ()
RRW ()
ABS CONTROL UNIT CONNECTOR A (22P) RLW () (LT BLU)
(GRN/YEL)
YESGo to step 5.
NOGo to step 6.
Wire side of female terminals
5. Disconnect the harness 2P connector from the
Is there 2 V or more? appropriate wheel sensor, then check for continuity
between the () and () terminals of the harness
YESRepair short to power in the () circuit wire and body ground.
between the ABS control unit and the appropriate
wheel sensor. Is there continuity?
19-58
03/07/29 09:55:47 61S0X050_190_0059
6. Check the resistance between the appropriate DTC 12, 14, 16, 18: Wheel Sensor (Electrical
wheel sensor () and () circuit terminals (see Noise/Intermittent Interruption)
table).
NOTE: If the ABS indicator comes on because of
DTC Appropriate Terminal electrical noise, the indicator goes off when you test-
() Side () Side drive the vehicle at 19 mph (30 km/h).
11 (Right-front) No. 9: FRW () No. 8: FRW ()
13 (Left-front) No. 7: FLW () No. 6: FLW () 1. Visually check for appropriate wheel sensor and
15 (Right-rear) No. 19: RRW () No. 20: RRW () pulser installation (see table).
17 (Left-rear) No. 17: RLW () No. 18: RLW ()
DTC Appropriate Wheel Sensor
ABS CONTROL UNIT CONNECTOR A (22P)
12 Right-front
FLW () (GRN/BLU) FRW () (GRN)
14 Left-front
16 Right-rear
18 Left-rear
FLW () (BRN) FRW () (GRN/BLK) Are they installed correctly?
YESGo to step 2.
RLW () (LT BLU) RRW () (BLU/YEL)
NOReinstall or replace the appropriate wheel
sensor or pulser.
RLW () (GRY) RRW () (GRN/YEL) 2. Disconnect the ABS control unit connector A (22P).
Wire side of female terminals
3. Measure the resistance between the appropriate
Is the resistance between 4502,000 ? wheel sensor () and () circuit terminals (see
table).
YESCheck for loose ABS control unit connectors.
If necessary, substitute a known-good ABS control DTC Appropriate Terminal
unit, and recheck. () Side () Side
12 (Right-front) No. 9: FRW () No. 8: FRW ()
NOGo to step 7. 14 (Left-front) No. 7: FLW () No. 6: FLW ()
16 (Right-rear) No. 19: RRW () No. 20: RRW ()
7. Disconnect the harness 2P connector from the 18 (Left-rear) No. 17: RLW () No. 18: RLW ()
appropriate wheel sensor, and check the resistance ABS CONTROL UNIT CONNECTOR A (22P)
between the () and () terminals of the wheel FLW () (GRN/BLU) FRW () (GRN)
sensor.
NOGo to step 4.
(contd)
19-59
03/07/29 09:55:47 61S0X050_190_0060
ABS Components
DTC Appropriate Other Terminal 2. Test-drive the vehicle at 19 mph (30 km/h) or more.
Terminal
12 No. 9: No. 7: No. 19: No. 17: Does the ABS indicator come on and are DT Cs 21,
FRW () FLW () RRW () RLW () 22, 23, 24 indicated?
14 No. 7: No. 9: No. 19: No. 17:
FLW () FRW () RRW () RLW () YESGo to step 3.
16 No. 19: No. 9: No. 7: No. 17:
RRW () FRW () FLW () RLW () NOThe system is OK at this time.
18 No. 17: No. 9: No. 7: No. 19:
RLW () FRW () FLW () RRW () 3. Check the appropriate pulser gears for a chipped
tooth (see table).
Is there continuity?
DTC Appropriate Pulser
YESRepair a short in the wires between the 21 Right-front
appropriate wheel sensor and the other wheel 22 Left-front
sensor. 23 Right-rear
24 Left-rear
NOClear the DTC, and test-drive the vehicle. If
the ABS indicator comes on and the same DTC is Are the pulser gears OK ?
indicated, replace the ABS control unit.
YESCheck for loose terminals in the ABS control
unit connectors. If necessary, substitute a known-
good ABS control unit, and recheck.
19-60
03/07/29 09:55:48 61S0X050_190_0061
DTC 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38: Solenoid 5. Connect the modulator unit connector.
1. Verify the DTC. 6. Check for continuity between the appropriate ABS
control unit connector B (12P) solenoid circuit
Is DT C 54 indicated? terminal and body ground (see table).
4. Check for continuity between the appropriate ABS ABS CONTROL UNIT CONNECTOR B (12P)
control unit connector B (12P) solenoid circuit FL-OUT (YEL/BLU) RL-OUT (YEL/GRN)
terminal and body ground (see table).
RR-OUT FR-OUT
(YEL/WHT) (YEL/BLK)
DTC Appropriate Terminal
31: FR-IN No. 11
32: FR-OUT No. 6
33: FL-IN No. 9
34: FL-OUT No. 4 RR-IN (RED/WHT) FR-IN (RED/BLK)
35: RR-IN No. 8 FL-IN (RED/BLU) RL-IN (RED/GRN)
36: RR-OUT No. 3
37: RL-IN No. 10
38: RL-OUT No. 5
Wire side of female terminals
Is there continuity?
NOGo to step 5.
(contd)
19-61
03/07/29 09:55:48 61S0X050_190_0062
ABS Components
FL-OUT FR-OUT
(YEL/BLU) (YEL/BLK)
19-62
03/07/29 09:55:49 61S0X050_190_0063
12. Connect the ABS fail-safe relay connector terminal 14. Disconnect the modulator unit connector, and
No. 2 to body ground with a jumper wire. remove the jumper wire from the ABS fail-safe
relay connector terminal.
NOTE: The wire colors of the ABS fail-safe relay
connector; are WHT/GRN, BRN/BLK, BLK, YEL/GRN. 15. Check for continuity between the appropriate ABS
control unit connector B (12P) terminal and all other
ABS FAIL-SAFE RELAY CONNECTOR solenoid circuit terminals (see table).
Is the resistance OK ?
19-63
03/07/29 09:55:49 61S0X050_190_0064
ABS Components
Is it installed correctly?
19-64
03/07/29 09:55:50 61S0X050_190_0065
B MOTOR
(WHT) (WHT/BLU)
JUMPER WIRE
MCK (GRN)
Is there about 10 V ?
YESGo to step 6.
NORepair open in the wire between the
passengers under-dash fuse/relay box and the
ABS control unit.
(contd)
19-65
03/07/29 09:55:51 61S0X050_190_0066
ABS Components
B MOTOR
(WHT) (WHT/BLU) Is there battery voltage?
circuit.
MOTOR GND (BLK) MOTOR (WHT/BLU)
NOGo to step 7.
YESGo to step 8.
Is there battery voltage?
NOReplace the pump motor relay.
YESReplace the modulator unit.
8. Connect the pump motor relay connector terminal NORepair open in the wire between the pump
No. 4 to No. 5 with a jumper wire for a moment. motor and body ground (G302).
Does the pump motor operate? 13. Disconnect the pump motor connector.
YESGo to step 13. 14. Connect the pump motor relay connector terminal
No. 1 to No. 5 with a jumper wire.
NOGo to step 9. PUMP MOTOR RELAY CONNECTOR
10. Connect the pump motor relay connector terminal PMR (YEL/RED)
No. 4 to No. 5 with a jumper wire. JUMPER
WIRE
B (WHT)
19-66
03/07/29 09:55:51 61S0X050_190_0067
15. Measure the voltage between the ABS control unit DTC 53: Motor Stuck ON
connector B (12P) terminal No. 12 and body ground.
1. Check that the pump motor operates with the
ABS CONTROL UNIT CONNECTOR B (12P) ignition switch OFF.
Is there about 10 V ?
YESGo to step 5.
Wire side of female terminals
NORepair open in the wire between the
passengers under-dash fuse/relay box and the
Is there battery voltage? ABS control unit.
YESRepair a short to power in the wire between 5. Reinstall the ABS MOTOR CHECK (7.5A) fuse in the
the under-hood ABS relay box and the ABS control passengers under-dash fuse/relay box.
unit.
6. Disconnect the pump motor connector.
NOIf the problem recurs, replace the ABS control
unit.
(contd)
19-67
03/07/29 09:55:52 61S0X050_190_0068
ABS Components
MOTOR (WHT/BLU)
PMR (YEL/RED)
NORepair open in the wire between the under- YESRepair short to body ground in the wire
hood ABS relay box and the pump motor. between the under-hood ABS relay box and the
ABS control unit.
8. Measure the voltage between the pump motor
connector terminal No. 1 and No. 2. NOIf the problem recurs, replace the ABS control
unit.
PUMP MOTOR CONNECTOR
12. Disconnect the ABS control unit connector B (12P).
MOTOR GND (BLK) MOTOR (WHT/BLU) 13. Check for continuity between terminal No. 12 and
body ground.
ABS CONTROL UNIT CONNECTOR B (12P)
PMR (YEL/RED)
Is there about 10 V ?
YESGo to step 9.
NORepair open in the wire between the pump Wire side of female terminals
motor and body ground (G302).
Is there continuity?
9. Remove the pump motor relay, then connect relay
terminals No. 4 and No. 5 together with a jumper YESRepair short to body ground in the wire
wire. between the under-hood ABS relay box and the
ABS control unit.
Does the pump motor run?
NOReplace the pump motor relay (Pump motor
YESGo to step 10. relay stuck ON).
19-68
03/07/29 09:55:53 61S0X050_190_0069
DTC 54: ABS Fail-safe Relay 5. Connect the ABS fail-safe relay connector terminal
No. 1 to No. 2 with a jumper wire.
1. Check the ABS F/S (20A) fuse in the under-hood
fuse/relay box, and reinstall the fuse if it is OK. ABS FAIL-SAFE RELAY CONNECTOR
Is the f use OK ?
B (WHT/GRN)
YESGo to step 2.
JUMPER WIRE
NOReplace the fuse, and recheck.
SOLENOID
(BRN/BLK)
2. Reinstall the fuse, and turn the ignition switch ON
(II).
4. Measure the voltage between the ABS fail-safe Terminal side of female terminals
relay connector terminal No. 1 and body ground.
Is there battery voltage?
ABS FAIL-SAFE RELAY CONNECTOR
YESGo to step 8.
YESGo to step 5.
19-69
03/07/29 09:55:54 61S0X050_190_0070
ABS Components
SOLENOID
(BRN/BLK)
FSR (YEL/GRN)
YESRepair short to power in the wire between YESRepair short to body ground in the wire
the ABS fail-safe relay, modulator unit, and ABS between the ABS control unit and the ABS fail-safe
relay box. relay.
10. Disconnect the ABS control unit connector A (22P). 14. Check for continuity between the ABS fail-safe
relay connector terminal No. 3 and body ground.
11. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
ABS FAIL-SAFE RELAY CONNECTOR
12. Measure the voltage between terminal No. 21 and
body ground.
ABS CONTROL UNIT CONNECTOR A (22P)
GND (BLK)
FSR (YEL/GRN)
Terminal side of female terminals
Is there continuity?
Is there battery voltage? NOCheck for an open in the wire between the
ABS fail-safe relay and body ground. If the wire is
YESRepair short to power in the wire between OK, check for poor ground at G201.
the ABS control unit and the ABS fail-safe relay.
19-70
03/07/29 09:55:54 61S0X050_190_0071
15. Connect the ABS fail-safe relay connector terminals DTC 61, 62: Battery Voltage
No. 3 and No. 4 with a jumper wire.
1. Clear the DTC (see step 1 on page 19-43).
ABS FAIL-SAFE RELAY CONNECTOR
2. Test-drive the vehicle at 6 mph (10 km/h) or more.
YESGo to step 3.
Is DT C 61 or 62 indicated?
Wire side of female terminals
YESCheck the charging system.
16. Check for continuity between the ABS control unit
connector terminal No. 21 and body ground. NODo the appropriate troubleshooting for the
code.
ABS CONTROL UNIT CONNECTOR A (22P)
FSR (YEL/GRN)
Is there continuity?
19-71
03/07/29 09:55:54 61S0X050_190_0072
ABS Components
NOIntermittent failure; the vehicle is OK at this NOIntermittent failure; the vehicle is OK at this
time. time.
19-72
03/07/29 09:55:55 61S0X050_190_0073
NOGo to step 2.
WALP (BLU/WHT)
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF then ON (II) again.
YESGo to step 3.
Wire side of female terminals
NORepair open in the indicator power source
circuit. Is there continuity?
Blown BACKUP LIGHT (7.5A) fuse. YESRepair short to body ground in the wire
Open in the wire between the BACKUP LIGHT between the gauge assembly and the ABS control
(7.5A) fuse and the gauge assembly. unit.
Open circuit inside the fuse box.
NOGo to step 10.
3. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
10. Connect the gauge assembly connector C (16P).
4. Disconnect the ABS control unit connector A (12P).
11. Connect the gauge assembly connector B (22P)
5. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). terminal No. 16 to body ground with a jumper wire.
GAUGE ASSEMBLY CONNECTOR B (22P)
Does the ABS indicator come on?
NOGo to step 6.
JUMPER WIRE GND (BLK)
6. Check the ABS indicator bulb in the gauge
assembly.
Is the bulb OK ?
Wire side of female terminals
YESGo to step 7.
12. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
NOReplace the ABS indicator bulb.
Does the ABS indicator come on?
7. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
YESRepair open in the wire between the gauge
8. Disconnect the gauge assembly connector C (16P). assembly and body ground (G503).
(contd)
19-73
03/07/29 09:55:56 61S0X050_190_0074
ABS Components
15. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). 18. Connect the gauge assembly connector C (16P)
terminal No. 10 to body ground with a jumper wire.
Does the ABS indicator go of f ?
GAUGE ASSEMBLY CONNECTOR C (16P)
YESRepair open in the wire between the ABS
control unit and body ground (G303).
IG2 (YEL/BLK)
Wire side of female terminals
Wire side of female terminals NOReplace the printed circuit board in the gauge
assembly.
Is there battery voltage?
19-74
03/07/29 09:55:56 61S0X050_190_0075
2. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), and check the brake 8. Disconnect the ABS control unit connector A (22P).
system indicator for the following conditions:
9. Start the engine, and check the brake system
Brake system indicator does not come on at all, indicator.
go to step 3.
Brake system indicator stays on all the time, go Does the brake system indicator turn of f ?
to step 5.
Brake system indicator comes on for 2 seconds, YESReplace the ABS control unit.
then turns off. Repair open in the wire between
No. 3 terminal of the ALT 4P connector and B8 NOCheck the brake system indicator circuit
terminal of the gauge assembly. (short to body ground between No. 3 terminal of
the ALT 4P connector and B8 terminal of the gauge
3. Turn the ignition switch OFF then ON (II) again. assembly), parking brake switch (stuck ON), and
brake fluid level switch (stuck ON).
Does the ABS indicator come on?
YESGo to step 4.
Is the bulb OK ?
NOGo to step 6.
NOGo to step 7.
19-75
03/07/29 09:55:56 61S0X050_190_0076
ABS Components
Removal
1. Remove the intake air duct (see step 6 on page 5-3).
2. Disconnect the modulator unit connector (A) and the pump motor connector (B).
From From
From right-rear left-front
left-rear
From
right-front
A B
6 mm NUT
9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
3. Disconnect the brake lines, then remove the modulator unit (C).
Installation
1. Install the modulator unit, then connect the brake lines. Tighten the flare nuts to 15 Nm (1.5 kgfm, 11 lbfft).
2. Connect the modulator unit connector and the pump motor connector.
5. Start the engine, and check that the ABS indicator goes off.
6. Test-drive the vehicle, and check that the ABS indicator does not come on.
19-76
03/07/29 09:55:57 61S0X050_190_0077
Standard:
Front: 0.51.0 mm (0.020.04 in.)
Rear: 0.21.1 mm (0.010.04 in.)
A Front
B
0.51.0 mm
2. Disconnect the ABS control unit connectors (B). (0.020.04 in.)
Rear
0.21.1 mm
(0.010.04 in.)
19-77
03/07/29 09:55:58 61S0X050_190_0078
ABS Components
Front
6 mm BOLT
9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
WHEEL SENSOR
Rear
6 mm BOLT
9.8 Nm (1.0 kgfm, 7.2 lbfft)
WHEEL SENSOR
19-78
03/07/29 09:55:58 61S0X050_190_0079
Brakes
03/07/29 09:56:02 61S0X050_190_0080
ABS/TCS Components
LEFT-REAR
WHEEL SENSOR
Inspection, page 19-160
Replacement, page 19-161
MULTI-RELAY BOX
(PUMP MOTOR RELAY) LEFT-FRONT WHEEL SENSOR
Inspection, page 22-88 Inspection, page 19-160
Replacement, page 19-161
MULTI-RELAY BOX
(ABS FAIL-SAFE RELAY) MODULATOR UNIT
Inspection, page 22-88 Removal and Installation,
page 19-158
MULTI-FUSE/RELAY BOX
(TCS RELAY)
Inspection, page 22-88
19-80
03/07/29 09:56:02 61S0X050_190_0081
(contd)
19-81
03/07/29 09:56:03 61S0X050_190_0082
ABS/TCS Components
How to Retrieve DTCs 2. Short the SCS circuit to body ground using the HDS.
HDS (Honda Diagnostic System) Method 3. Turn the ignition switch ON (II) without pressing the
brake pedal.
1. With the ignition switch OFF, connect the HDS to
the 16P Data Link Connector (DLC) (A) under the NOTE: If the brake pedal is pressed when turning
drivers side of the dashboard. the ignition switch ON (II), the system shifts to the
DTC clearing mode.
19-82
03/07/29 09:56:03 61S0X050_190_0083
4. The blinking frequency indicates the DTC. DTCs are How to Clear ABS DTCs
indicated by a series of long and short blinks. One
long blink equals 10 short blinks. Add the long and HDS (Honda Diagnostic System) Method
short blinks together to determine the DTC. After
determining the DTC, refer to the DTC 1. With the ignition switch OFF, connect the HDS to
Troubleshooting Index. the 16P Data Link Connector (DLC) (A) under the
drivers side of the dashboard.
NOTE: If the DTC is not memorized, the ABS or TCS
indicator will go off for 3.6 seconds, and then come
back on.
(contd)
19-83
03/07/29 09:56:04 61S0X050_190_0084
ABS/TCS Components
19-84
03/07/29 09:56:04 61S0X050_190_0085
How to Clear TCS DTCs Without the HDS (Honda Diagnostic System)
With the HDS (Honda Diagnostic System) 1. Press the parking brake pedal with the SCS circuit
opened. Keep the pedal pressed during the entire
1. With the ignition switch OFF, connect the HDS to DTC clearing procedure.
the 16P Data Link Connector (DLC) (A) under the
drivers side of the dashboard. 2. Press and hold the TCS switch, then turn the
ignition switch ON (II) without starting the engine.
a a
Ignition Switch ON (II)
a a a: 0.3 sec.
Ignition Switch ON (II)
19-85
03/07/29 09:56:04 61S0X050_190_0086
ABS/TCS Components
19-86
03/07/29 09:56:05 61S0X050_190_0087
TCS DTCs
DTC Detection Item Note
DTC 24 RF TCS NO solenoid (see page 19-127)
DTC 25 RF TCS NC solenoid (see page 19-127)
DTC 26 LF TCS NO solenoid (see page 19-127)
DTC 27 LF TCS NC solenoid (see page 19-127)
DTC 28 TCS relay (see page 19-131)
DTC31 1 Engine retard command (PFINH) signal (see page 19-134)
DTC 32 1 Engine speed (NEP) signal (see page 19-136)
DTC 34 1 Reference voltage (VREF) signal (see page 19-137)
DTC 36 1 Throttle position sensor output (THLOUT) signal (see page 19-138)
DTC 61 1 A/T shift position (ATSFTP) signal (see page 19-139)
DTC 31 2 Engine retard command (PFINH) signal (see page 19-140)
DTC 32 2 Engine speed (NEP) signal (see page 19-142)
DTC 34 2 Reference voltage (VREF) signal (see page 19-143)
DTC 36 2 Throttle position sensor output (THLOUT) signal (see page 19-144)
DTC 61 2 A/T shift position (ATSFTP) signal (see page 19-145)
DTC 31 3 Engine retard command (PFINH) signal (see page 19-146)
DTC 32 3 Engine speed (NEP) signal (see page 19-148)
DTC 34 3 Reference voltage (VREF) signal (see page 19-149)
DTC 36 3 Throttle position sensor output (THLOUT) signal (see page 19-150)
DTC 61 3 A/T shift position (ATSFTP) signal (see page 19-151)
DTC 81 Continuous TCS operation (see page 19-152)
1: 99-00 models
2: 01 model
3: 02-04 models
19-87
03/07/29 09:56:05 61S0X050_190_0088
ABS/TCS Components
19-88
03/07/29 09:56:05 61S0X050_190_0089
System Description
ABS/TCS Control Unit Inputs and Outputs for Connector A (26P)
(contd)
19-89
03/07/29 09:56:06 61S0X050_190_0090
ABS/TCS Components
19-90
03/07/29 09:56:06 61S0X050_190_0091
(contd)
19-91
03/07/29 09:56:07 61S0X050_190_0092
ABS/TCS Components
19-92
03/07/29 09:56:07 61S0X050_190_0093
Outline
This system consists of the ABS/TCS control unit, the modulator unit, four wheel sensors, and the PCM. The system
integrates the ABS (Anti-lock Brake System) and the TCS (Traction Control System) and controls both systems using
the brakes.
ABS/TCS
Improves accelerating ability from a standstill on slippery road surfaces.
TCS control
Improves traction when one drive wheel is on a slippery road surface.
FR RR
WHEEL
SENSOR WHEEL
WHEEL
SENSOR SENSOR
SIGNAL SIGNAL
TCS NC
TCS NO TCS NO SOLENOID VALVE
CONTROL
NO DAMPING NO NO
NO CHAMBER
ABS/ TCS
PUMP P M P PUMP CONTROL
UNIT
MOTOR
NC NC
WHEEL
SENSOR
NC NC SOLENOID VALVE SIGNAL
CONTROL
RESERVOIR RESERVOIR
MODULATOR UNIT
WHEEL
SENSOR WHEEL
SENSOR
SIGNAL
WHEEL
SENSOR
FL RL
(contd)
19-93
03/07/29 09:56:08 61S0X050_190_0094
ABS/TCS Components
COEFFICIENT OF
FRICTION
TARGET SLIP RATE
ROTATIONAL
DIRECTION
RADIAL
DIRECTION
OF THE
ROTATIONAL
DIRECTION
SLIP RATE
TCS Features
The TCS provides low-speed traction. When a drive wheel loses traction on a slipperly road surface and starts to spin,
the ABS/TCS control unit sends a brake signal to the modulator unit, which applies brake pressure to slow the
spinning wheel. At that time, the ABS/TCS control unit sends an engine retard signal to the PCM to prevent damage to
the transmission.
19-94
03/07/29 09:56:08 61S0X050_190_0095
Detect Reference
Vehicle Speed Slip Rate
REAR
RIGHT-REAR Detect Detect ABS Drive RIGHT-REAR
WHEEL SENSOR Wheel Speed Slip Rate Control Solenoid SOLENOID
RIGHT-FRONT
RIGHT-FRONT Detect Detect ABS Drive RIGHT-FRONT
WHEEL SENSOR Wheel Speed Slip Rate Control Solenoid SOLENOID
LEFT-FRONT
LEFT-FRONT Detect Detect ABS Drive LEFT-FRONT
WHEEL SENSOR Wheel Speed Slip Rate Control Solenoid SOLENOID
(contd)
19-95
03/07/29 09:56:09 61S0X050_190_0096
ABS/TCS Components
THROTTLE
ANGLE SENSOR Calculate
traction torque
Calculate control
condition signal To PCM
Engine speed signal
Calculate control
target value
LEFT-REAR Detect
WHEEL SENSOR wheel speed
Calculate drive Calculate
wheel speed deviation
average
RIGHT-FRONT Detect
WHEEL SENSOR wheel speed
19-96
03/07/29 09:56:09 61S0X050_190_0097
ABS Self-Diagnosis
The ABS/TCS control unit is equipped with a main CPU and a sub-CPU. Each CPU checks the other for problems.
The CPUs check the circuit of the system.
Self-diagnosis can be classified into two categories:
Initial diagnosis: Done right after the engine starts and until the ABS or TCS indicator goes off
Regular diagnosis: Done right after the initial diagnosis until the ignition switch is turned OFF
When a problem is detected by self-diagnosis, the ABS/TCS control unit shifts to fail-safe mode.
NOTE:
At the DTCs with mark, there are cases that the ABS/TCS control unit shifts to fail-safe mode A1, L1 when the
ABS/TCS control unit detects more than one DTC and for different wheel.
If the ABS/TCS control unit detects the DTCs which have different fail-safe mode individually, the ABS/TCS control
unit take priority the large number mode.
(contd)
19-97
03/07/29 09:56:09 61S0X050_190_0098
ABS/TCS Components
19-98
03/07/29 09:56:09 61S0X050_190_0099
TCS Self-diagnosis
The ABS/TCS control unit is equipped with a main CPU and a sub-CPU. Each CPU checks the other for problems.
The CPUs check the circuit of the system.
Self-diagnosis can be classified into two categories:
Initial diagnosis: Done right after the engine starts and until the ABS or TCS indicator goes off
Regular diagnosis: Done right after the initial diagnosis until the ignition switch is turned OFF
When a problem is detected by self-diagnosis, the ABS/TCS control unit shifts to fail-safe mode.
(contd)
19-99
03/07/29 09:56:10 61S0X050_190_0100
ABS/TCS Components
19-100
03/07/29 09:57:20 61S0X050_190_0101
Modulator Unit
The modulator unit consists of the inlet solenoid valve, outlet solenoid valve, TCS normally open (NO) solenoid valve,
TCS normally closed (NC) solenoid valve, reservoir, pump, pump motor, and the damping chamber.
The modulator controls the caliper fluid pressure directly. It is a circulating-type modulator because the brake fluid
circulates through the caliper, the reservoir, and the master cylinder.
The hydraulic control has three modes: pressure intensifying, pressure retaining, and pressure reducing.
The hydraulic circuit is an independent four channel type, one channel for each wheel.
ABS Control
Pressure intensifying mode
TCS NO valve open, TCS NC valve closed, inlet valve open, outlet valve closed.
Master cylinder fluid is pumped out to the caliper.
Pump Motor
When starting the pressure reducing mode, the pump motor is ON. When stopping ABS operation, the pump motor is
OFF.
The reservoir fluid is pumped out by the pump, through the damping chamber, to the master cylinder.
MASTER CYLINDER
MODULATOR UNIT
IN IN IN IN
RESERVOIR RESERVOIR
RL FR FL RR
MODULATOR UNIT
IN IN IN IN
RESERVOIR RESERVOIR
RL FR FL RR
(contd)
19-101
03/07/29 09:57:21 61S0X050_190_0102
ABS/TCS Components
MODULATOR UNIT
IN IN IN IN
RESERVOIR RESERVOIR
RL FR FL RR
TCS Control
Pressure intensifying mode
TCS NO valve closed, TCS NC valve open, inlet valve open, outlet valve closed, pump motor ON.
The reservoir and master cylinder fluid is pumped out by the pump, through the damping chamber, to the front caliper.
MASTER CYLINDER
MODULATOR UNIT
IN IN IN IN
DAMPING DAMPING
MOTOR CHAMBER
OUT OUT CHAMBER OUT OUT
PUMP M PUMP
RESERVOIR RESERVOIR
RL FR FL RR
19-102
03/07/29 09:57:22 61S0X050_190_0103
MODULATOR UNIT
IN IN IN IN
DAMPING DAMPING
CHAMBER MOTOR CHAMBER
OUT OUT OUT OUT
PUMP M PUMP
RESERVOIR RESERVOIR
RL FR FL RR
MODULATOR UNIT
IN IN IN IN
RESERVOIR RESERVOIR
RL FR FL RR
(contd)
19-103
03/07/29 09:57:23 61S0X050_190_0104
ABS/TCS Components
VOLTAGE
Wheel Speed and Modulator Control (ABS)
WHEEL SPEED
TIME
PRESSURE
OUTLET
VALVE ON
OFF
INLET
VALVE ON
OFF
MOTOR
ON
OFF
When the wheel speed drops sharply below the vehicle speed, the outlet valve opens momentarily to reduce the
caliper fluid pressure. The pump motor starts at this time. As the wheel speed is restored, the inlet valve opens
momentarily to increase the caliper fluid pressure.
19-104
03/07/29 09:57:23 61S0X050_190_0105
SPEED
REFERENCE DRIVE
WHEEL SPEED
TIME
BRAKE
PRESSURE
OUTLET ON
VALVE OFF
INLET ON
VALVE OFF
ON
TCS NC VALVE
OFF
ON
TCS NO VALVE
OFF
ON
MOTOR
OFF
When the front wheel speed rises sharply above the vehicle speed, the TCS NC valve opens, the TCS NO valve closes,
and the pump motor starts to intensify the front caliper fluid pressure. When the wheel speed drops, the front inlet
valve closes momentarity to retain the front caliper fluid pressure. When the wheel speed drops further, the front
outlet valve opens momentarily to reduce the front caliper fluid pressure.
19-105
03/07/29 09:57:25 61S0X050_190_0106
ABS/TCS Components
Circuit Diagram
99-00 models
5 6 BLU/ORN
G201
YEL/RED YEL/BLK
5 1 1 4 YEL/RED
ABS
PUMP TCS GRN/YEL
MOTOR RELAY
RELAY
3 4 2 3
BRN/BLK BRN/BLK
BRN/BLK RED/BLU
WHT/BLU GRN GRN
MODULATOR UNIT
2
PASSENGERS UNDER-DASH
FUSE/RELAY BOX FL-IN
IN
14 RED/BLU
ABS MOTOR CHECK(7.5A) LEFT-FRONT
SOLENOID FL-OUT
C4 J5 OUT
22 YEL/BLU
FR-IN
IN
11 RED/BLK
RIGHT-FRONT
SOLENOID FR-OUT
OUT
19 YEL/BLK
RL-IN
IN
12 RED/GRN
LEFT-REAR
SOLENOID RL-OUT
OUT
20 YEL/GRN
RR-IN
IN
13 RED/WHT
RIGHT-REAR
SOLENOID RR-OUT
OUT
21 YEL/WHT
NOL
8 RED/GRN
LEFT TCS
SOLENOID NCL
7 YEL/GRN
NOR
5 LT BLU
RIGHT TCS
SOLENOID NCR
RED/BLU 17 6 GRY
PUMP MOTOR
WHT/BLU 1 M 16 BLK
G302
UNDER-HOOD FUSE/RELAY BOX CONNECTORS BRAKE PEDAL POSITION CRUISE CONTROL/ ABS PUMP MOTOR
CONNECTOR A (18P) CONNECTOR B (7P) SWITCH CONNECTOR TCS SWITCH CONNECTOR RELAY CONNECTOR
MODULATOR UNIT
CONNECTOR
19-106
03/07/29 09:57:26 61S0X050_190_0107
BLU/WHT
NEP
B11 BLU A19
TCS1 THLOUT
RED/WHT RED/WHT A18 VCC B9 RED/BLK A31
TCS2
RED/WHT B16 VREF
TCS SW B2 WHT/RED A7
BLU/ORN B4
VCC
IG2 VCC
YEL/BLK 5V
A13 REGULATOR FPTDR
B1 PNK/BLK E1
FSR To IG2 To VCC
YEL/GRN A25 IG2
PMR PFINH
YEL/RED B15 B10 LT GRN/RED E3
TCSR ATSFTP
GRN/YEL B13 B7 LT GRN A11
LG
C2 BRN/BLK
IG2
MCK
GRN A20 WHEEL SENSOR
FLW() G101
A9 GRN/BLU 1
LEFT-
FL-IN FLW() FRONT
RED/BLU C9 A8 BRN 2
FL-OUT FRW()
YEL/BLU C4 A11 GRN/BLK 1
FR-IN () RIGHT-
FRW() FRONT
RED/BLK C11 A10 GRN 2
FR-OUT
C6 () RLW()
YEL/BLK 1
A21 LT BLU
RL-IN LEFT-
RLW() REAR
RED/GRN C10 A22 GRY 2
RL-OUT
YEL/GRN C5 RRW()
RR-IN A23 GRN/YEL 1
RIGHT-
RED/WHT C8 RRW() REAR
RR-OUT A24 BLU/YEL 2
YEL/WHT C3
NOL
RED/GRN A3
NCL
YEL/GRN A2 GND1
NOR A1 BLK
LT BLU A16 GND2
NCR C12 BLK
GRY A15 GND3
C7 BLK
G303 G303
REAR
19-107
03/07/29 09:57:28 61S0X050_190_0108
ABS/TCS Components